ATMEGA1280V-8CU-SL383 [ATMEL]
Microcontroller, 8-Bit, FLASH, AVR RISC CPU, 8MHz, CMOS, PBGA100, 9 X 9 MM, 1.20 MM HEIGHT, 0.80 MM PITCH, GREEN, CBGA-100;型号: | ATMEGA1280V-8CU-SL383 |
厂家: | ATMEL |
描述: | Microcontroller, 8-Bit, FLASH, AVR RISC CPU, 8MHz, CMOS, PBGA100, 9 X 9 MM, 1.20 MM HEIGHT, 0.80 MM PITCH, GREEN, CBGA-100 时钟 微控制器 |
文件: | 总448页 (文件大小:7518K) |
中文: | 中文翻译 | 下载: | 下载PDF数据表文档文件 |
Features
• High Performance, Low Power AVR® 8-Bit Microcontroller
• Advanced RISC Architecture
– 135 Powerful Instructions – Most Single Clock Cycle Execution
– 32 x 8 General Purpose Working Registers
– Fully Static Operation
– Up to 16 MIPS Throughput at 16 MHz
– On-Chip 2-cycle Multiplier
• High Endurance Non-volatile Memory Segments
– 64K/128K/256K Bytes of In-System Self-Programmable Flash
– 4K Bytes EEPROM
– 8K Bytes Internal SRAM
8-bit
Microcontroller
with
64K/128K/256K
Bytes In-System
Programmable
Flash
– Write/Erase Cycles:10,000 Flash/100,000 EEPROM
– Data retention: 20 years at 85°C/ 100 years at 25°C
– Optional Boot Code Section with Independent Lock Bits
• In-System Programming by On-chip Boot Program
• True Read-While-Write Operation
– Programming Lock for Software Security
Endurance: Up to 64K Bytes Optional External Memory Space
• JTAG (IEEE std. 1149.1 compliant) Interface
– Boundary-scan Capabilities According to the JTAG Standard
– Extensive On-chip Debug Support
– Programming of Flash, EEPROM, Fuses, and Lock Bits through the JTAG Interface
• Peripheral Features
– Two 8-bit Timer/Counters with Separate Prescaler and Compare Mode
– Four 16-bit Timer/Counter with Separate Prescaler, Compare- and Capture Mode
– Real Time Counter with Separate Oscillator
– Four 8-bit PWM Channels
– Six/Twelve PWM Channels with Programmable Resolution from 2 to 16 Bits
(ATmega1281/2561, ATmega640/1280/2560)
– Output Compare Modulator
– 8/16-channel, 10-bit ADC (ATmega1281/2561, ATmega640/1280/2560)
– Two/Four Programmable Serial USART (ATmega1281/2561,ATmega640/1280/2560)
– Master/Slave SPI Serial Interface
ATmega640/V
ATmega1280/V
ATmega1281/V
ATmega2560/V
ATmega2561/V
– Byte Oriented 2-wire Serial Interface
– Programmable Watchdog Timer with Separate On-chip Oscillator
– On-chip Analog Comparator
– Interrupt and Wake-up on Pin Change
• Special Microcontroller Features
– Power-on Reset and Programmable Brown-out Detection
– Internal Calibrated Oscillator
– External and Internal Interrupt Sources
– Six Sleep Modes: Idle, ADC Noise Reduction, Power-save, Power-down, Standby,
and Extended Standby
• I/O and Packages
– 54/86 Programmable I/O Lines (ATmega1281/2561, ATmega640/1280/2560)
– 64-pad QFN/MLF, 64-lead TQFP (ATmega1281/2561)
– 100-lead TQFP, 100-ball CBGA (ATmega640/1280/2560)
– RoHS/Fully Green
Preliminary
• Temperature Range:
– -40°C to 85°C Industrial
• Ultra-Low Power Consumption
– Active Mode: 1 MHz, 1.8V: 500 µA
– Power-down Mode: 0.1 µA at 1.8V
• Speed Grade:
– ATmega640V/ATmega1280V/ATmega1281V:
0 - 4 MHz @ 1.8 - 5.5V, 0 - 8 MHz @ 2.7 - 5.5V
– ATmega2560V/ATmega2561V:
0 - 2 MHz @ 1.8 - 5.5V, 0 - 8 MHz @ 2.7 - 5.5V
– ATmega640/ATmega1280/ATmega1281:
0 - 8 MHz @ 2.7 - 5.5V, 0 - 16 MHz @ 4.5 - 5.5V
– ATmega2560/ATmega2561:
0 - 16 MHz @ 4.5 - 5.5V
1. Pin Configurations
Figure 1-1. TQFP-pinout ATmega640/1280/2560
99 98 97 96 95 94 93 92 91 90 89 88 87 86 85 84 83 82 81 80 79 78 77 76
100
(OC0B) PG5
(RXD0/PCINT8) PE0
(TXD0) PE1
1
75
74
73
72
71
70
69
68
67
66
65
64
63
62
61
60
59
58
57
56
55
54
53
52
51
PA3 (AD3)
2
PA4 (AD4)
INDEX CORNER
3
PA5 (AD5)
(XCK0/AIN0) PE2
(OC3A/AIN1) PE3
(OC3B/INT4) PE4
(OC3C/INT5) PE5
(T3/INT6) PE6
4
PA6 (AD6)
5
PA7 (AD7)
6
PG2 (ALE)
7
PJ6 (PCINT15)
PJ5 (PCINT14)
PJ4 (PCINT13)
PJ3 (PCINT12)
PJ2 (XCK3/PCINT11)
PJ1 (TXD3/PCINT10)
PJ0 (RXD3/PCINT9)
GND
8
(CLKO/ICP3/INT7) PE7
VCC
9
10
11
12
13
14
15
16
17
18
19
20
21
22
23
24
25
GND
(RXD2) PH0
(TXD2) PH1
(XCK2) PH2
(OC4A) PH3
VCC
(OC4B) PH4
PC7 (A15)
(OC4C) PH5
PC6 (A14)
(OC2B) PH6
PC5 (A13)
(SS/PCINT0) PB0
(SCK/PCINT1) PB1
(MOSI/PCINT2) PB2
(MISO/PCINT3) PB3
(OC2A/PCINT4) PB4
(OC1A/PCINT5) PB5
(OC1B/PCINT6) PB6
PC4 (A12)
PC3 (A11)
PC2 (A10)
PC1 (A9)
PC0 (A8)
PG1 (RD)
PG0 (WR)
26 27 28 29 30 31 32 33 34 35 36 37 38 39 40 41 42 43 44 45 46 47 48 49 50
2
ATmega640/1280/1281/2560/2561
2549L–AVR–08/07
ATmega640/1280/1281/2560/2561
Figure 1-2. CBGA-pinout ATmega640/1280/2560
Top view
Bottom view
1
2
3
4
5
6
7
8
9
10
10
9
8
7
6
5
4
3
2
1
A
B
C
D
E
F
A
B
C
D
E
F
G
H
J
G
H
J
K
K
Table 1-1.
CBGA-pinout ATmega640/1280/2560.
1
2
3
PF0
4
5
6
7
8
9
10
A
B
C
D
E
F
GND
AVCC
PE2
AREF
PG5
PE0
PE4
PH0
PH4
PB1
PB4
PG3
PG4
PF2
PF3
PF4
PE6
PH3
PB0
PB5
PL1
PL0
GND
PF5
PK0
PK1
PK2
PA4
PJ6
PD1
PD0
PL7
PL6
PL5
PK3
PK4
PK5
PA5
PJ5
PJ1
PD5
PD4
PD3
PD2
PK6
PK7
PJ7
PA6
PJ4
PJ0
PC5
PC4
PC1
PD6
GND
PA0
PA1
PA7
PJ3
VCC
PA2
PA3
PG2
PJ2
PF1
PF6
PE1
PE5
PH1
PH6
PB2
RESET
PB6
VCC
PF7
PE3
PH2
PH5
PL4
PE7
VCC
GND
PB3
PC7
PC6
PC3
PC0
PD7
GND
VCC
PC2
PG1
PG0
G
H
J
PL2
PL3
PH7
PB7
XTAL2
XTAL1
K
3
2549L–AVR–08/07
Figure 1-3. Pinout ATmega1281/2561
1
PA3 (AD3)
PA4 (AD4)
PA5 (AD5)
PA6 (AD6)
PA7 (AD7)
PG2 (ALE)
PC7 (A15)
PC6 (A14)
PC5 (A13)
PC4 (A12)
PC3 (A11)
PC2 (A10)
PC1 (A9)
48
47
46
45
44
43
42
41
40
39
38
37
36
35
34
33
(OC0B) PG5
2
3
(RXD0/PCINT8/PDI) PE0
(TXD0/PDO) PE1
INDEX CORNER
4
(XCK0/AIN0) PE2
5
(OC3A/AIN1) PE3
(OC3B/INT4) PE4
(OC3C/INT5) PE5
(T3/INT6) PE6
6
7
8
ATmega1281/2561
9
(ICP3/CLKO/INT7) PE7
(SS/PCINT0) PB0
(SCK/PCINT1) PB1
(MOSI/PCINT2) PB2
(MISO/PCINT3) PB3
(OC2A/PCINT4) PB4
(OC1A/PCINT5) PB5
(OC1B/PCINT6) PB6
10
11
12
13
14
15
16
PC0 (A8)
PG1 (RD)
PG0 (WR)
Note:
The large center pad underneath the QFN/MLF package is made of metal and internally con-
nected to GND. It should be soldered or glued to the board to ensure good mechanical stability. If
the center pad is left unconnected, the package might loosen from the board.
2. Disclaimer
Typical values contained in this datasheet are based on simulations and characterization of
other AVR microcontrollers manufactured on the same process technology. Min. and Max val-
ues will be available after the device is characterized.
4
ATmega640/1280/1281/2560/2561
2549L–AVR–08/07
ATmega640/1280/1281/2560/2561
3. Overview
The ATmega640/1280/1281/2560/2561 is a low-power CMOS 8-bit microcontroller based on the
AVR enhanced RISC architecture. By executing powerful instructions in a single clock cycle, the
ATmega640/1280/1281/2560/2561 achieves throughputs approaching 1 MIPS per MHz allowing
the system designer to optimize power consumption versus processing speed.
3.1
Block Diagram
Figure 3-1. Block Diagram
PF7..0
PK7..0
PJ7..0
PE7..0
VCC
Power
Supervision
POR / BOD &
RESET
PORT F (8)
PORT K (8)
PORT J (8)
PORT E (8)
RESET
Watchdog
Timer
GND
Analog
Comparator
A/D
Converter
Watchdog
Oscillator
JTAG
USART 0
USART 3
USART 1
USART 2
XTAL1
Oscillator
Circuits /
Clock
Internal
Bandgap reference
16bit T/C 3
EEPROM
Generation
16bit T/C 5
16bit T/C 4
16bit T/C 1
XTAL2
CPU
PORT A (8)
PORT G (6)
PA7..0
PG5..0
FLASH
SRAM
XRAM
TWI
SPI
8bit T/C 0
8bit T/C 2
PC7..0
PORT C (8)
NOTE:
Shaded parts only available
in the 100-pin version.
Complete functionality for
the ADC, T/C4, and T/C5 only
available in the 100-pin version.
PORT D (8)
PORT B (8)
PORT H (8)
PORT L (8)
PD7..0
PB7..0
PH7..0
PL7..0
5
2549L–AVR–08/07
The AVR core combines a rich instruction set with 32 general purpose working registers. All the
32 registers are directly connected to the Arithmetic Logic Unit (ALU), allowing two independent
registers to be accessed in one single instruction executed in one clock cycle. The resulting
architecture is more code efficient while achieving throughputs up to ten times faster than con-
ventional CISC microcontrollers.
The ATmega640/1280/1281/2560/2561 provides the following features: 64K/128K/256K bytes of
In-System Programmable Flash with Read-While-Write capabilities, 4K bytes EEPROM, 8K
bytes SRAM, 54/86 general purpose I/O lines, 32 general purpose working registers, Real Time
Counter (RTC), six flexible Timer/Counters with compare modes and PWM, 4 USARTs, a byte
oriented 2-wire Serial Interface, a 16-channel, 10-bit ADC with optional differential input stage
with programmable gain, programmable Watchdog Timer with Internal Oscillator, an SPI serial
port, IEEE std. 1149.1 compliant JTAG test interface, also used for accessing the On-chip
Debug system and programming and six software selectable power saving modes. The Idle
mode stops the CPU while allowing the SRAM, Timer/Counters, SPI port, and interrupt system
to continue functioning. The Power-down mode saves the register contents but freezes the
Oscillator, disabling all other chip functions until the next interrupt or Hardware Reset. In Power-
save mode, the asynchronous timer continues to run, allowing the user to maintain a timer base
while the rest of the device is sleeping. The ADC Noise Reduction mode stops the CPU and all
I/O modules except Asynchronous Timer and ADC, to minimize switching noise during ADC
conversions. In Standby mode, the Crystal/Resonator Oscillator is running while the rest of the
device is sleeping. This allows very fast start-up combined with low power consumption. In
Extended Standby mode, both the main Oscillator and the Asynchronous Timer continue to run.
The device is manufactured using Atmel’s high-density nonvolatile memory technology. The On-
chip ISP Flash allows the program memory to be reprogrammed in-system through an SPI serial
interface, by a conventional nonvolatile memory programmer, or by an On-chip Boot program
running on the AVR core. The boot program can use any interface to download the application
program in the application Flash memory. Software in the Boot Flash section will continue to run
while the Application Flash section is updated, providing true Read-While-Write operation. By
combining an 8-bit RISC CPU with In-System Self-Programmable Flash on a monolithic chip,
the Atmel ATmega640/1280/1281/2560/2561 is a powerful microcontroller that provides a highly
flexible and cost effective solution to many embedded control applications.
The ATmega640/1280/1281/2560/2561 AVR is supported with a full suite of program and sys-
tem development tools including: C compilers, macro assemblers, program
debugger/simulators, in-circuit emulators, and evaluation kits.
6
ATmega640/1280/1281/2560/2561
2549L–AVR–08/07
ATmega640/1280/1281/2560/2561
3.2
Comparison Between ATmega1281/2561 and ATmega640/1280/2560
Each device in the ATmega640/1280/1281/2560/2561 family differs only in memory size and
number of pins. Table 3-1 summarizes the different configurations for the six devices.
Table 3-1.
Device
Configuration Summary
General
Purpose I/O pins
16 bits resolution
PWM channels
Serial
USARTs
ADC
Channels
Flash
64KB
EEPROM
4KB
RAM
8KB
8KB
8KB
8KB
8KB
ATmega640
86
86
54
86
54
12
12
6
4
4
2
4
2
16
16
8
ATmega1280
ATmega1281
ATmega2560
ATmega2561
128KB
128KB
256KB
256KB
4KB
4KB
4KB
12
6
16
8
4KB
3.3
Pin Descriptions
3.3.1
VCC
Digital supply voltage.
Ground.
3.3.2
3.3.3
GND
Port A (PA7..PA0)
Port A is an 8-bit bi-directional I/O port with internal pull-up resistors (selected for each bit). The
Port A output buffers have symmetrical drive characteristics with both high sink and source
capability. As inputs, Port A pins that are externally pulled low will source current if the pull-up
resistors are activated. The Port A pins are tri-stated when a reset condition becomes active,
even if the clock is not running.
Port
A
also serves the functions of various special features of the
ATmega640/1280/1281/2560/2561 as listed on page 78.
3.3.4
Port B (PB7..PB0)
Port B is an 8-bit bi-directional I/O port with internal pull-up resistors (selected for each bit). The
Port B output buffers have symmetrical drive characteristics with both high sink and source
capability. As inputs, Port B pins that are externally pulled low will source current if the pull-up
resistors are activated. The Port B pins are tri-stated when a reset condition becomes active,
even if the clock is not running.
Port B has better driving capabilities than the other ports.
Port
B
also serves the functions of various special features of the
ATmega640/1280/1281/2560/2561 as listed on page 79.
3.3.5
Port C (PC7..PC0)
Port C is an 8-bit bi-directional I/O port with internal pull-up resistors (selected for each bit). The
Port C output buffers have symmetrical drive characteristics with both high sink and source
capability. As inputs, Port C pins that are externally pulled low will source current if the pull-up
7
2549L–AVR–08/07
resistors are activated. The Port C pins are tri-stated when a reset condition becomes active,
even if the clock is not running.
Port C also serves the functions of special features of the ATmega640/1280/1281/2560/2561 as
listed on page 82.
3.3.6
3.3.7
3.3.8
Port D (PD7..PD0)
Port D is an 8-bit bi-directional I/O port with internal pull-up resistors (selected for each bit). The
Port D output buffers have symmetrical drive characteristics with both high sink and source
capability. As inputs, Port D pins that are externally pulled low will source current if the pull-up
resistors are activated. The Port D pins are tri-stated when a reset condition becomes active,
even if the clock is not running.
Port
D
also serves the functions of various special features of the
ATmega640/1280/1281/2560/2561 as listed on page 83.
Port E (PE7..PE0)
Port E is an 8-bit bi-directional I/O port with internal pull-up resistors (selected for each bit). The
Port E output buffers have symmetrical drive characteristics with both high sink and source
capability. As inputs, Port E pins that are externally pulled low will source current if the pull-up
resistors are activated. The Port E pins are tri-stated when a reset condition becomes active,
even if the clock is not running.
Port
E
also serves the functions of various special features of the
ATmega640/1280/1281/2560/2561 as listed on page 86.
Port F (PF7..PF0)
Port F serves as analog inputs to the A/D Converter.
Port F also serves as an 8-bit bi-directional I/O port, if the A/D Converter is not used. Port pins
can provide internal pull-up resistors (selected for each bit). The Port F output buffers have sym-
metrical drive characteristics with both high sink and source capability. As inputs, Port F pins
that are externally pulled low will source current if the pull-up resistors are activated. The Port F
pins are tri-stated when a reset condition becomes active, even if the clock is not running. If the
JTAG interface is enabled, the pull-up resistors on pins PF7(TDI), PF5(TMS), and PF4(TCK) will
be activated even if a reset occurs.
Port F also serves the functions of the JTAG interface.
3.3.9
Port G (PG5..PG0)
Port G is a 6-bit I/O port with internal pull-up resistors (selected for each bit). The Port G output
buffers have symmetrical drive characteristics with both high sink and source capability. As
inputs, Port G pins that are externally pulled low will source current if the pull-up resistors are
activated. The Port G pins are tri-stated when a reset condition becomes active, even if the clock
is not running.
Port
G
also serves the functions of various special features of the
ATmega640/1280/1281/2560/2561 as listed on page 90.
3.3.10
Port H (PH7..PH0)
Port H is a 8-bit bi-directional I/O port with internal pull-up resistors (selected for each bit). The
Port H output buffers have symmetrical drive characteristics with both high sink and source
capability. As inputs, Port H pins that are externally pulled low will source current if the pull-up
8
ATmega640/1280/1281/2560/2561
2549L–AVR–08/07
ATmega640/1280/1281/2560/2561
resistors are activated. The Port H pins are tri-stated when a reset condition becomes active,
even if the clock is not running.
Port H also serves the functions of various special features of the ATmega640/1280/2560 as
listed on page 92.
3.3.11
Port J (PJ7..PJ0)
Port J is a 8-bit bi-directional I/O port with internal pull-up resistors (selected for each bit). The
Port J output buffers have symmetrical drive characteristics with both high sink and source capa-
bility. As inputs, Port J pins that are externally pulled low will source current if the pull-up
resistors are activated. The Port J pins are tri-stated when a reset condition becomes active,
even if the clock is not running.
Port J also serves the functions of various special features of the ATmega640/1280/2560 as
listed on page 95.
3.3.12
Port K (PK7..PK0)
Port K serves as analog inputs to the A/D Converter.
Port K is a 8-bit bi-directional I/O port with internal pull-up resistors (selected for each bit). The
Port K output buffers have symmetrical drive characteristics with both high sink and source
capability. As inputs, Port K pins that are externally pulled low will source current if the pull-up
resistors are activated. The Port K pins are tri-stated when a reset condition becomes active,
even if the clock is not running.
Port K also serves the functions of various special features of the ATmega640/1280/2560 as
listed on page 96.
3.3.13
Port L (PL7..PL0)
Port L is a 8-bit bi-directional I/O port with internal pull-up resistors (selected for each bit). The
Port L output buffers have symmetrical drive characteristics with both high sink and source
capability. As inputs, Port L pins that are externally pulled low will source current if the pull-up
resistors are activated. The Port L pins are tri-stated when a reset condition becomes active,
even if the clock is not running.
Port L also serves the functions of various special features of the ATmega640/1280/2560 as
listed on page 98.
3.3.14
RESET
Reset input. A low level on this pin for longer than the minimum pulse length will generate a
reset, even if the clock is not running. The minimum pulse length is given in “System and Reset
Characteristics” on page 375. Shorter pulses are not guaranteed to generate a reset.
3.3.15
3.3.16
XTAL1
XTAL2
Input to the inverting Oscillator amplifier and input to the internal clock operating circuit.
Output from the inverting Oscillator amplifier.
9
2549L–AVR–08/07
3.3.17
3.3.18
AVCC
AREF
AVCC is the supply voltage pin for Port F and the A/D Converter. It should be externally con-
nected to VCC, even if the ADC is not used. If the ADC is used, it should be connected to VCC
through a low-pass filter.
This is the analog reference pin for the A/D Converter.
4. Resources
A comprehensive set of development tools and application notes, and datasheets are available
for download on http://www.atmel.com/avr.
5. About Code Examples
This documentation contains simple code examples that briefly show how to use various parts of
the device. Be aware that not all C compiler vendors include bit definitions in the header files
and interrupt handling in C is compiler dependent. Please confirm with the C compiler documen-
tation for more details.
These code examples assume that the part specific header file is included before compilation.
For I/O registers located in extended I/O map, "IN", "OUT", "SBIS", "SBIC", "CBI", and "SBI"
instructions must be replaced with instructions that allow access to extended I/O. Typically
"LDS" and "STS" combined with "SBRS", "SBRC", "SBR", and "CBR".
6. Data Retention
Reliability Qualification results show that the projected data retention failure rate is much less
than 1 PPM over 20 years at 85°C or 100 years at 25°C.
10
ATmega640/1280/1281/2560/2561
2549L–AVR–08/07
ATmega640/1280/1281/2560/2561
7. AVR CPU Core
7.1
Introduction
This section discusses the AVR core architecture in general. The main function of the CPU core
is to ensure correct program execution. The CPU must therefore be able to access memories,
perform calculations, control peripherals, and handle interrupts.
7.2
Architectural Overview
Figure 7-1. Block Diagram of the AVR Architecture
Data Bus 8-bit
Program
Counter
Status
and Control
Flash
Program
Memory
Interrupt
Unit
32 x 8
General
Purpose
Registrers
Instruction
Register
SPI
Unit
Instruction
Decoder
Watchdog
Timer
ALU
Analog
Comparator
Control Lines
I/O Module1
I/O Module 2
I/O Module n
Data
SRAM
EEPROM
I/O Lines
In order to maximize performance and parallelism, the AVR uses a Harvard architecture – with
separate memories and buses for program and data. Instructions in the program memory are
executed with a single level pipelining. While one instruction is being executed, the next instruc-
tion is pre-fetched from the program memory. This concept enables instructions to be executed
in every clock cycle. The program memory is In-System Reprogrammable Flash memory.
11
2549L–AVR–08/07
The fast-access Register File contains 32 x 8-bit general purpose working registers with a single
clock cycle access time. This allows single-cycle Arithmetic Logic Unit (ALU) operation. In a typ-
ical ALU operation, two operands are output from the Register File, the operation is executed,
and the result is stored back in the Register File – in one clock cycle.
Six of the 32 registers can be used as three 16-bit indirect address register pointers for Data
Space addressing – enabling efficient address calculations. One of the these address pointers
can also be used as an address pointer for look up tables in Flash program memory. These
added function registers are the 16-bit X-, Y-, and Z-register, described later in this section.
The ALU supports arithmetic and logic operations between registers or between a constant and
a register. Single register operations can also be executed in the ALU. After an arithmetic opera-
tion, the Status Register is updated to reflect information about the result of the operation.
Program flow is provided by conditional and unconditional jump and call instructions, able to
directly address the whole address space. Most AVR instructions have a single 16-bit word for-
mat. Every program memory address contains a 16- or 32-bit instruction.
Program Flash memory space is divided in two sections, the Boot Program section and the
Application Program section. Both sections have dedicated Lock bits for write and read/write
protection. The SPM instruction that writes into the Application Flash memory section must
reside in the Boot Program section.
During interrupts and subroutine calls, the return address Program Counter (PC) is stored on the
Stack. The Stack is effectively allocated in the general data SRAM, and consequently the Stack
size is only limited by the total SRAM size and the usage of the SRAM. All user programs must
initialize the SP in the Reset routine (before subroutines or interrupts are executed). The Stack
Pointer (SP) is read/write accessible in the I/O space. The data SRAM can easily be accessed
through the five different addressing modes supported in the AVR architecture.
The memory spaces in the AVR architecture are all linear and regular memory maps.
A flexible interrupt module has its control registers in the I/O space with an additional Global
Interrupt Enable bit in the Status Register. All interrupts have a separate Interrupt Vector in the
Interrupt Vector table. The interrupts have priority in accordance with their Interrupt Vector posi-
tion. The lower the Interrupt Vector address, the higher the priority.
The I/O memory space contains 64 addresses for CPU peripheral functions as Control Regis-
ters, SPI, and other I/O functions. The I/O Memory can be accessed directly, or as the Data
Space locations following those of the Register File, 0x20 - 0x5F. In addition, the
ATmega640/1280/1281/2560/2561 has Extended I/O space from 0x60 - 0x1FF in SRAM where
only the ST/STS/STD and LD/LDS/LDD instructions can be used.
7.3
ALU – Arithmetic Logic Unit
The high-performance AVR ALU operates in direct connection with all the 32 general purpose
working registers. Within a single clock cycle, arithmetic operations between general purpose
registers or between a register and an immediate are executed. The ALU operations are divided
into three main categories – arithmetic, logical, and bit-functions. Some implementations of the
architecture also provide a powerful multiplier supporting both signed/unsigned multiplication
and fractional format. See the “Instruction Set” section for a detailed description.
12
ATmega640/1280/1281/2560/2561
2549L–AVR–08/07
ATmega640/1280/1281/2560/2561
7.4
Status Register
The Status Register contains information about the result of the most recently executed arith-
metic instruction. This information can be used for altering program flow in order to perform
conditional operations. Note that the Status Register is updated after all ALU operations, as
specified in the Instruction Set Reference. This will in many cases remove the need for using the
dedicated compare instructions, resulting in faster and more compact code.
The Status Register is not automatically stored when entering an interrupt routine and restored
when returning from an interrupt. This must be handled by software.
7.4.1
SREG – AVR Status Register
The AVR Status Register – SREG – is defined as:
Bit
7
I
6
T
5
H
4
S
3
V
2
N
1
Z
0
C
0x3F (0x5F)
Read/Write
Initial Value
SREG
R/W
0
R/W
0
R/W
0
R/W
0
R/W
0
R/W
0
R/W
0
R/W
0
• Bit 7 – I: Global Interrupt Enable
The Global Interrupt Enable bit must be set for the interrupts to be enabled. The individual inter-
rupt enable control is then performed in separate control registers. If the Global Interrupt Enable
Register is cleared, none of the interrupts are enabled independent of the individual interrupt
enable settings. The I-bit is cleared by hardware after an interrupt has occurred, and is set by
the RETI instruction to enable subsequent interrupts. The I-bit can also be set and cleared by
the application with the SEI and CLI instructions, as described in the instruction set reference.
• Bit 6 – T: Bit Copy Storage
The Bit Copy instructions BLD (Bit LoaD) and BST (Bit STore) use the T-bit as source or desti-
nation for the operated bit. A bit from a register in the Register File can be copied into T by the
BST instruction, and a bit in T can be copied into a bit in a register in the Register File by the
BLD instruction.
• Bit 5 – H: Half Carry Flag
The Half Carry Flag H indicates a Half Carry in some arithmetic operations. Half Carry Is useful
in BCD arithmetic. See the “Instruction Set Description” for detailed information.
• Bit 4 – S: Sign Bit, S = N ⊕ V
The S-bit is always an exclusive or between the Negative Flag N and the Two’s Complement
Overflow Flag V. See the “Instruction Set Description” for detailed information.
• Bit 3 – V: Two’s Complement Overflow Flag
The Two’s Complement Overflow Flag V supports two’s complement arithmetics. See the
“Instruction Set Description” for detailed information.
• Bit 2 – N: Negative Flag
The Negative Flag N indicates a negative result in an arithmetic or logic operation. See the
“Instruction Set Description” for detailed information.
• Bit 1 – Z: Zero Flag
The Zero Flag Z indicates a zero result in an arithmetic or logic operation. See the “Instruction
Set Description” for detailed information.
13
2549L–AVR–08/07
• Bit 0 – C: Carry Flag
The Carry Flag C indicates a carry in an arithmetic or logic operation. See the “Instruction Set
Description” for detailed information.
7.5
General Purpose Register File
The Register File is optimized for the AVR Enhanced RISC instruction set. In order to achieve
the required performance and flexibility, the following input/output schemes are supported by the
Register File:
•
•
•
•
One 8-bit output operand and one 8-bit result input
Two 8-bit output operands and one 8-bit result input
Two 8-bit output operands and one 16-bit result input
One 16-bit output operand and one 16-bit result input
Figure 7-2 shows the structure of the 32 general purpose working registers in the CPU.
Figure 7-2. AVR CPU General Purpose Working Registers
7
0
Addr.
R0
R1
0x00
0x01
0x02
R2
…
R13
R14
R15
R16
R17
…
0x0D
0x0E
0x0F
0x10
0x11
General
Purpose
Working
Registers
R26
R27
R28
R29
R30
R31
0x1A
0x1B
0x1C
0x1D
0x1E
0x1F
X-register Low Byte
X-register High Byte
Y-register Low Byte
Y-register High Byte
Z-register Low Byte
Z-register High Byte
Most of the instructions operating on the Register File have direct access to all registers, and
most of them are single cycle instructions.
As shown in Figure 7-2 on page 14, each register is also assigned a data memory address,
mapping them directly into the first 32 locations of the user Data Space. Although not being
physically implemented as SRAM locations, this memory organization provides great flexibility in
access of the registers, as the X-, Y- and Z-pointer registers can be set to index any register in
the file.
7.5.1
The X-register, Y-register, and Z-register
The registers R26..R31 have some added functions to their general purpose usage. These reg-
isters are 16-bit address pointers for indirect addressing of the data space. The three indirect
address registers X, Y, and Z are defined as described in Figure 7-3.
14
ATmega640/1280/1281/2560/2561
2549L–AVR–08/07
ATmega640/1280/1281/2560/2561
Figure 7-3. The X-, Y-, and Z-registers
15
XH
XL
0
0
X-register
7
0
0
7
R27 (0x1B)
R26 (0x1A)
15
YH
YL
ZL
0
0
Y-register
Z-register
7
7
R29 (0x1D)
R28 (0x1C)
15
ZH
0
0
7
7
0
R31 (0x1F)
R30 (0x1E)
In the different addressing modes these address registers have functions as fixed displacement,
automatic increment, and automatic decrement (see the instruction set reference for details).
7.6
Stack Pointer
The Stack is mainly used for storing temporary data, for storing local variables and for storing
return addresses after interrupts and subroutine calls. The Stack Pointer Register always points
to the top of the Stack. Note that the Stack is implemented as growing from higher memory loca-
tions to lower memory locations. This implies that a Stack PUSH command decreases the Stack
Pointer.
The Stack Pointer points to the data SRAM Stack area where the Subroutine and Interrupt
Stacks are located. This Stack space in the data SRAM must be defined by the program before
any subroutine calls are executed or interrupts are enabled. The Stack Pointer must be set to
point above 0x0200. The initial value of the stack pointer is the last address of the internal
SRAM. The Stack Pointer is decremented by one when data is pushed onto the Stack with the
PUSH instruction, and it is decremented by two for ATmega640/1280/1281 and three for
ATmega2560/2561 when the return address is pushed onto the Stack with subroutine call or
interrupt. The Stack Pointer is incremented by one when data is popped from the Stack with the
POP instruction, and it is incremented by two for ATmega640/1280/1281 and three for
ATmega2560/2561 when data is popped from the Stack with return from subroutine RET or
return from interrupt RETI.
The AVR Stack Pointer is implemented as two 8-bit registers in the I/O space. The number of
bits actually used is implementation dependent. Note that the data space in some implementa-
tions of the AVR architecture is so small that only SPL is needed. In this case, the SPH Register
will not be present.
Bit
15
SP15
SP7
7
14
SP14
SP6
6
13
SP13
SP5
5
12
SP12
SP4
4
11
SP11
SP3
3
10
SP10
SP2
2
9
SP9
SP1
1
8
SP8
SP0
0
0x3E (0x5E)
0x3D (0x5D)
SPH
SPL
Read/Write
R/W
R/W
0
R/W
R/W
0
R/W
R/W
1
R/W
R/W
0
R/W
R/W
0
R/W
R/W
0
R/W
R/W
0
R/W
R/W
1
Initial Value
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
15
2549L–AVR–08/07
7.6.1
RAMPZ – Extended Z-pointer Register for ELPM/SPM
Bit
7
6
5
4
3
2
1
0
RAMPZ7
RAMPZ6
RAMPZ5
RAMPZ4
RAMPZ3
RAMPZ2
RAMPZ1
RAMPZ0
0x3B (0x5B)
Read/Write
Initial Value
RAMPZ
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
For ELPM/SPM instructions, the Z-pointer is a concatenation of RAMPZ, ZH, and ZL, as shown
in Figure 7-4. Note that LPM is not affected by the RAMPZ setting.
Figure 7-4. The Z-pointer used by ELPM and SPM
Bit (
Individually)
7
0
7
0
8
7
7
0
0
RAMPZ
ZH
ZL
Bit (Z-pointer)
23
16
15
The actual number of bits is implementation dependent. Unused bits in an implementation will
always read as zero. For compatibility with future devices, be sure to write these bits to zero.
7.6.2
EIND – Extended Indirect Register
Bit
0x3C (0x5C)
7
6
EIND6
R/W
0
5
EIND5
R/W
0
4
EIND4
R/W
0
3
EIND3
R/W
0
2
EIND2
R/W
0
1
EIND1
R/W
0
0
EIND0
R/W
0
EIND7
EIND
Read/Write
R/W
Initial Value
0
For EICALL/EIJMP instructions, the Indirect-pointer to the subroutine/routine is a concatenation
of EIND, ZH, and ZL, as shown in Figure 7-5. Note that ICALL and IJMP are not affected by the
EIND setting.
Figure 7-5. The Indirect-pointer used by EICALL and EIJMP
Bit (Individual-
ly)
7
0
7
0
7
7
0
0
EIND
ZH
ZL
Bit (Indirect-
pointer)
23
16
15
8
The actual number of bits is implementation dependent. Unused bits in an implementation will
always read as zero. For compatibility with future devices, be sure to write these bits to zero.
7.7
Instruction Execution Timing
This section describes the general access timing concepts for instruction execution. The AVR
CPU is driven by the CPU clock clkCPU, directly generated from the selected clock source for the
chip. No internal clock division is used.
Figure 7-6 shows the parallel instruction fetches and instruction executions enabled by the Har-
vard architecture and the fast-access Register File concept. This is the basic pipelining concept
to obtain up to 1 MIPS per MHz with the corresponding unique results for functions per cost,
functions per clocks, and functions per power-unit.
16
ATmega640/1280/1281/2560/2561
2549L–AVR–08/07
ATmega640/1280/1281/2560/2561
Figure 7-6. The Parallel Instruction Fetches and Instruction Executions
T1
T2
T3
T4
clkCPU
1st Instruction Fetch
1st Instruction Execute
2nd Instruction Fetch
2nd Instruction Execute
3rd Instruction Fetch
3rd Instruction Execute
4th Instruction Fetch
Figure 7-7 shows the internal timing concept for the Register File. In a single clock cycle an ALU
operation using two register operands is executed, and the result is stored back to the destina-
tion register.
Figure 7-7. Single Cycle ALU Operation
T1
T2
T3
T4
clkCPU
Total Execution Time
Register Operands Fetch
ALU Operation Execute
Result Write Back
7.8
Reset and Interrupt Handling
The AVR provides several different interrupt sources. These interrupts and the separate Reset
Vector each have a separate program vector in the program memory space. All interrupts are
assigned individual enable bits which must be written logic one together with the Global Interrupt
Enable bit in the Status Register in order to enable the interrupt. Depending on the Program
Counter value, interrupts may be automatically disabled when Boot Lock bits BLB02 or BLB12
are programmed. This feature improves software security. See the section “Memory Program-
ming” on page 337 for details.
The lowest addresses in the program memory space are by default defined as the Reset and
Interrupt Vectors. The complete list of vectors is shown in “Interrupts” on page 105. The list also
determines the priority levels of the different interrupts. The lower the address the higher is the
priority level. RESET has the highest priority, and next is INT0 – the External Interrupt Request
0. The Interrupt Vectors can be moved to the start of the Boot Flash section by setting the IVSEL
bit in the MCU Control Register (MCUCR). Refer to “Interrupts” on page 105 for more informa-
tion. The Reset Vector can also be moved to the start of the Boot Flash section by programming
the BOOTRST Fuse, see “Memory Programming” on page 337.
When an interrupt occurs, the Global Interrupt Enable I-bit is cleared and all interrupts are dis-
abled. The user software can write logic one to the I-bit to enable nested interrupts. All enabled
interrupts can then interrupt the current interrupt routine. The I-bit is automatically set when a
Return from Interrupt instruction – RETI – is executed.
17
2549L–AVR–08/07
There are basically two types of interrupts. The first type is triggered by an event that sets the
Interrupt Flag. For these interrupts, the Program Counter is vectored to the actual Interrupt Vec-
tor in order to execute the interrupt handling routine, and hardware clears the corresponding
Interrupt Flag. Interrupt Flags can also be cleared by writing a logic one to the flag bit position(s)
to be cleared. If an interrupt condition occurs while the corresponding interrupt enable bit is
cleared, the Interrupt Flag will be set and remembered until the interrupt is enabled, or the flag is
cleared by software. Similarly, if one or more interrupt conditions occur while the Global Interrupt
Enable bit is cleared, the corresponding Interrupt Flag(s) will be set and remembered until the
Global Interrupt Enable bit is set, and will then be executed by order of priority.
The second type of interrupts will trigger as long as the interrupt condition is present. These
interrupts do not necessarily have Interrupt Flags. If the interrupt condition disappears before the
interrupt is enabled, the interrupt will not be triggered.
When the AVR exits from an interrupt, it will always return to the main program and execute one
more instruction before any pending interrupt is served.
Note that the Status Register is not automatically stored when entering an interrupt routine, nor
restored when returning from an interrupt routine. This must be handled by software.
When using the CLI instruction to disable interrupts, the interrupts will be immediately disabled.
No interrupt will be executed after the CLI instruction, even if it occurs simultaneously with the
CLI instruction. The following example shows how this can be used to avoid interrupts during the
timed EEPROM write sequence.
Assembly Code Example
in r16, SREG
; store SREG value
cli ; disable interrupts during timed sequence
sbiEECR, EEMPE ; start EEPROM write
sbiEECR, EEPE
outSREG, r16
; restore SREG value (I-bit)
C Code Example
char cSREG;
cSREG = SREG;/* store SREG value */
/* disable interrupts during timed sequence */
__disable_interrupt();
EECR |= (1<<EEMPE); /* start EEPROM write */
EECR |= (1<<EEPE);
SREG = cSREG; /* restore SREG value (I-bit) */
When using the SEI instruction to enable interrupts, the instruction following SEI will be exe-
cuted before any pending interrupts, as shown in this example.
18
ATmega640/1280/1281/2560/2561
2549L–AVR–08/07
ATmega640/1280/1281/2560/2561
Assembly Code Example
sei ; set Global Interrupt Enable
sleep; enter sleep, waiting for interrupt
; note: will enter sleep before any pending
; interrupt(s)
C Code Example
__enable_interrupt(); /* set Global Interrupt Enable */
__sleep(); /* enter sleep, waiting for interrupt */
/* note: will enter sleep before any pending interrupt(s) */
7.8.1
Interrupt Response Time
The interrupt execution response for all the enabled AVR interrupts is five clock cycles minimum.
After five clock cycles the program vector address for the actual interrupt handling routine is exe-
cuted. During these five clock cycle period, the Program Counter is pushed onto the Stack. The
vector is normally a jump to the interrupt routine, and this jump takes three clock cycles. If an
interrupt occurs during execution of a multi-cycle instruction, this instruction is completed before
the interrupt is served. If an interrupt occurs when the MCU is in sleep mode, the interrupt exe-
cution response time is increased by five clock cycles. This increase comes in addition to the
start-up time from the selected sleep mode.
A return from an interrupt handling routine takes five clock cycles. During these five clock cycles,
the Program Counter (three bytes) is popped back from the Stack, the Stack Pointer is incre-
mented by three, and the I-bit in SREG is set.
19
2549L–AVR–08/07
8. AVR Memories
This section describes the different memories in the ATmega640/1280/1281/2560/2561. The
AVR architecture has two main memory spaces, the Data Memory and the Program Memory
space. In addition, the ATmega640/1280/1281/2560/2561 features an EEPROM Memory for
data storage. All three memory spaces are linear and regular.
8.1
In-System Reprogrammable Flash Program Memory
The ATmega640/1280/1281/2560/2561 contains 64K/128K/256K bytes On-chip In-System
Reprogrammable Flash memory for program storage, see Table 8-1 on page 20. Since all AVR
instructions are 16 or 32 bits wide, the Flash is organized as 32K/64K/128K x 16. For software
security, the Flash Program memory space is divided into two sections, Boot Program section
and Application Program section.
The Flash memory has an endurance of at least 10,000 write/erase cycles. The
ATmega640/1280/1281/2560/2561 Program Counter (PC) is 15/16/17 bits wide, thus addressing
the 32K/64K/128K program memory locations. The operation of Boot Program section and asso-
ciated Boot Lock bits for software protection are described in detail in “Boot Loader Support –
Read-While-Write Self-Programming” on page 318. “Memory Programming” on page 337 con-
tains a detailed description on Flash data serial downloading using the SPI pins or the JTAG
interface.
Constant tables can be allocated within the entire program memory address space (see the LPM
– Load Program Memory instruction description and ELPM - Extended Load Program Memory
instruction description).
Timing diagrams for instruction fetch and execution are presented in “Instruction Execution Tim-
ing” on page 16.
Figure 8-1. Program Flash Memory Map
Address (HEX)
0
Application Flash Section
Boot Flash Section
0x7FFF/0xFFFF/0x1FFFF
8.2
SRAM Data Memory
Table 8-2 on page 22 shows how the ATmega640/1280/1281/2560/2561 SRAM Memory is
organized.
The ATmega640/1280/1281/2560/2561 is a complex microcontroller with more peripheral units
than can be supported within the 64 location reserved in the Opcode for the IN and OUT instruc-
tions. For the Extended I/O space from $060 - $1FF in SRAM, only the ST/STS/STD and
LD/LDS/LDD instructions can be used.
The first 4,608/8,704 Data Memory locations address both the Register File, the I/O Memory,
Extended I/O Memory, and the internal data SRAM. The first 32 locations address the Register
20
ATmega640/1280/1281/2560/2561
2549L–AVR–08/07
ATmega640/1280/1281/2560/2561
file, the next 64 location the standard I/O Memory, then 416 locations of Extended I/O memory
and the next 8,192 locations address the internal data SRAM.
An optional external data SRAM can be used with the ATmega640/1280/1281/2560/2561. This
SRAM will occupy an area in the remaining address locations in the 64K address space. This
area starts at the address following the internal SRAM. The Register file, I/O, Extended I/O and
Internal SRAM occupies the lowest 4,608/8,704 bytes, so when using 64KB (65,536 bytes) of
External Memory, 60,478/56,832 Bytes of External Memory are available. See “External Mem-
ory Interface” on page 27 for details on how to take advantage of the external memory map.
When the addresses accessing the SRAM memory space exceeds the internal data memory
locations, the external data SRAM is accessed using the same instructions as for the internal
data memory access. When the internal data memories are accessed, the read and write strobe
pins (PG0 and PG1) are inactive during the whole access cycle. External SRAM operation is
enabled by setting the SRE bit in the XMCRA Register.
Accessing external SRAM takes one additional clock cycle per byte compared to access of the
internal SRAM. This means that the commands LD, ST, LDS, STS, LDD, STD, PUSH, and POP
take one additional clock cycle. If the Stack is placed in external SRAM, interrupts, subroutine
calls and returns take three clock cycles extra because the three-byte program counter is
pushed and popped, and external memory access does not take advantage of the internal pipe-
line memory access. When external SRAM interface is used with wait-state, one-byte external
access takes two, three, or four additional clock cycles for one, two, and three wait-states
respectively. Interrupts, subroutine calls and returns will need five, seven, or nine clock cycles
more than specified in the instruction set manual for one, two, and three wait-states.
The five different addressing modes for the data memory cover: Direct, Indirect with Displace-
ment, Indirect, Indirect with Pre-decrement, and Indirect with Post-increment. In the Register file,
registers R26 to R31 feature the indirect addressing pointer registers.
The direct addressing reaches the entire data space.
The Indirect with Displacement mode reaches 63 address locations from the base address given
by the Y- or Z-register.
When using register indirect addressing modes with automatic pre-decrement and post-incre-
ment, the address registers X, Y, and Z are decremented or incremented.
The 32 general purpose working registers, 64 I/O registers, and the 4,196/8,192 bytes of internal
data SRAM in the ATmega640/1280/1281/2560/2561 are all accessible through all these
addressing modes. The Register File is described in “General Purpose Register File” on page
14.
21
2549L–AVR–08/07
Figure 8-2. Data Memory Map
Address (HEX)
0 - 1F
32 Registers
64 I/O Registers
20 - 5F
60 - 1FF
200
416 External I/O Registers
Internal SRAM
(8192 x 8)
21FF
2200
External SRAM
(0 - 64K x 8)
FFFF
8.2.1
Data Memory Access Times
This section describes the general access timing concepts for internal memory access. The
internal data SRAM access is performed in two clkCPU cycles as described in Figure 8-3.
Figure 8-3. On-chip Data SRAM Access Cycles
T1
T2
T3
clkCPU
Address valid
Compute Address
Address
Data
WR
Data
RD
Memory Access Instruction
Next Instruction
8.3
EEPROM Data Memory
The ATmega640/1280/1281/2560/2561 contains 4K bytes of data EEPROM memory. It is orga-
nized as a separate data space, in which single bytes can be read and written. The EEPROM
has an endurance of at least 100,000 write/erase cycles. The access between the EEPROM and
the CPU is described in the following, specifying the EEPROM Address Registers, the EEPROM
Data Register, and the EEPROM Control Register.
For a detailed description of SPI, JTAG and Parallel data downloading to the EEPROM, see
“Serial Downloading” on page 351, “Programming via the JTAG Interface” on page 357, and
“Programming the EEPROM” on page 345 respectively.
22
ATmega640/1280/1281/2560/2561
2549L–AVR–08/07
ATmega640/1280/1281/2560/2561
8.3.1
EEPROM Read/Write Access
The EEPROM Access Registers are accessible in the I/O space, see “Register Description” on
page 34.
The write access time for the EEPROM is given in Table 8-4 on page 23. A self-timing function,
however, lets the user software detect when the next byte can be written. If the user code con-
tains instructions that write the EEPROM, some precautions must be taken. In heavily filtered
power supplies, VCC is likely to rise or fall slowly on power-up/down. This causes the device for
some period of time to run at a voltage lower than specified as minimum for the clock frequency
used. See “Preventing EEPROM Corruption” on page 25. for details on how to avoid problems in
these situations.
In order to prevent unintentional EEPROM writes, a specific write procedure must be followed.
See the description of the EEPROM Control Register for details on this, “Register Description”
on page 34.
When the EEPROM is read, the CPU is halted for four clock cycles before the next instruction is
executed. When the EEPROM is written, the CPU is halted for two clock cycles before the next
instruction is executed.
The calibrated Oscillator is used to time the EEPROM accesses. Table 8-4 lists the typical pro-
gramming time for EEPROM access from the CPU.
Figure 8-4. EEPROM Programming Time
Symbol
Number of Calibrated RC Oscillator Cycles
Typ Programming Time
EEPROM write
(from CPU)
26,368
3.3 ms
The following code examples show one assembly and one C function for writing to the
EEPROM. The examples assume that interrupts are controlled (e.g. by disabling interrupts glo-
bally) so that no interrupts will occur during execution of these functions. The examples also
assume that no Flash Boot Loader is present in the software. If such code is present, the
EEPROM write function must also wait for any ongoing SPM command to finish.
23
2549L–AVR–08/07
Assembly Code Example(1)
EEPROM_write:
; Wait for completion of previous write
sbic EECR,EEPE
rjmp EEPROM_write
; Set up address (r18:r17) in address register
out EEARH, r18
out EEARL, r17
; Write data (r16) to Data Register
out EEDR,r16
; Write logical one to EEMPE
sbi EECR,EEMPE
; Start eeprom write by setting EEPE
sbi EECR,EEPE
ret
C Code Example(1)
void EEPROM_write(unsigned int uiAddress, unsigned char ucData)
{
/* Wait for completion of previous write */
while(EECR & (1<<EEPE))
;
/* Set up address and Data Registers */
EEAR = uiAddress;
EEDR = ucData;
/* Write logical one to EEMPE */
EECR |= (1<<EEMPE);
/* Start eeprom write by setting EEPE */
EECR |= (1<<EEPE);
}
Note:
1. See “About Code Examples” on page 10.
24
ATmega640/1280/1281/2560/2561
2549L–AVR–08/07
ATmega640/1280/1281/2560/2561
The next code examples show assembly and C functions for reading the EEPROM. The exam-
ples assume that interrupts are controlled so that no interrupts will occur during execution of
these functions.
Assembly Code Example(1)
EEPROM_read:
; Wait for completion of previous write
sbic EECR,EEPE
rjcmp EEPROM_read
; Set up address (r18:r17) in address register
out EEARH, r18
out EEARL, r17
; Start eeprom read by writing EERE
sbi EECR,EERE
; Read data from Data Register
in r16,EEDR
ret
C Code Example(1)
unsigned char EEPROM_read(unsigned int uiAddress)
{
/* Wait for completion of previous write */
while(EECR & (1<<EEPE))
;
/* Set up address register */
EEAR = uiAddress;
/* Start eeprom read by writing EERE */
EECR |= (1<<EERE);
/* Return data from Data Register */
return EEDR;
}
Note:
1. See “About Code Examples” on page 10.
8.3.2
Preventing EEPROM Corruption
During periods of low VCC, the EEPROM data can be corrupted because the supply voltage is
too low for the CPU and the EEPROM to operate properly. These issues are the same as for
board level systems using EEPROM, and the same design solutions should be applied.
An EEPROM data corruption can be caused by two situations when the voltage is too low. First,
a regular write sequence to the EEPROM requires a minimum voltage to operate correctly. Sec-
ondly, the CPU itself can execute instructions incorrectly, if the supply voltage is too low.
EEPROM data corruption can easily be avoided by following this design recommendation:
Keep the AVR RESET active (low) during periods of insufficient power supply voltage. This can
be done by enabling the internal Brown-out Detector (BOD). If the detection level of the internal
BOD does not match the needed detection level, an external low VCC reset Protection circuit can
be used. If a reset occurs while a write operation is in progress, the write operation will be com-
pleted provided that the power supply voltage is sufficient.
25
2549L–AVR–08/07
8.4
I/O Memory
The I/O space definition of the ATmega640/1280/1281/2560/2561 is shown in “Register Sum-
mary” on page 414.
All ATmega640/1280/1281/2560/2561 I/Os and peripherals are placed in the I/O space. All I/O
locations may be accessed by the LD/LDS/LDD and ST/STS/STD instructions, transferring data
between the 32 general purpose working registers and the I/O space. I/O Registers within the
address range 0x00 - 0x1F are directly bit-accessible using the SBI and CBI instructions. In
these registers, the value of single bits can be checked by using the SBIS and SBIC instructions.
Refer to the instruction set section for more details. When using the I/O specific commands IN
and OUT, the I/O addresses 0x00 - 0x3F must be used. When addressing I/O Registers as data
space using LD and ST instructions, 0x20 must be added to these addresses. The
ATmega640/1280/1281/2560/2561 is a complex microcontroller with more peripheral units than
can be supported within the 64 location reserved in Opcode for the IN and OUT instructions. For
the Extended I/O space from 0x60 - 0x1FF in SRAM, only the ST/STS/STD and LD/LDS/LDD
instructions can be used.
For compatibility with future devices, reserved bits should be written to zero if accessed.
Reserved I/O memory addresses should never be written.
Some of the Status Flags are cleared by writing a logical one to them. Note that, unlike most
other AVRs, the CBI and SBI instructions will only operate on the specified bit, and can therefore
be used on registers containing such Status Flags. The CBI and SBI instructions work with reg-
isters 0x00 to 0x1F only.
The I/O and peripherals control registers are explained in later sections.
8.4.1
General Purpose I/O Registers
The ATmega640/1280/1281/2560/2561 contains three General Purpose I/O Registers. These
registers can be used for storing any information, and they are particularly useful for storing glo-
bal variables and Status Flags. General Purpose I/O Registers within the address range 0x00 -
0x1F are directly bit-accessible using the SBI, CBI, SBIS, and SBIC instructions. See “Register
Description” on page 34.
26
ATmega640/1280/1281/2560/2561
2549L–AVR–08/07
ATmega640/1280/1281/2560/2561
9. External Memory Interface
With all the features the External Memory Interface provides, it is well suited to operate as an
interface to memory devices such as External SRAM and Flash, and peripherals such as LCD-
display, A/D, and D/A. The main features are:
• Four different wait-state settings (including no wait-state).
• Independent wait-state setting for different External Memory sectors (configurable sector size)
• The number of bits dedicated to address high byte is selectable
• Bus keepers on data lines to minimize current consumption (optional)
9.1
Overview
When the eXternal MEMory (XMEM) is enabled, address space outside the internal SRAM
becomes available using the dedicated External Memory pins (see Figure 1-3 on page 4, Table
13-3 on page 78, Table 13-9 on page 82, and Table 13-20 on page 90). The memory configura-
tion is shown in Figure 9-1.
Figure 9-1. External Memory with Sector Select
Memory Configuration A
0x0000
Internal memory
0x21FF
0x2200
Lower sector
SRW01
SRW00
SRL[2..0]
External Memory
Upper sector
(0-60K x 8)
SRW11
SRW10
0xFFFF
9.1.1
Using the External Memory Interface
The interface consists of:
•
AD7:0: Multiplexed low-order address bus and data bus.
• A15:8: High-order address bus (configurable number of bits).
•
ALE: Address latch enable.
27
2549L–AVR–08/07
•
•
RD: Read strobe.
WR: Write strobe.
The control bits for the External Memory Interface are located in two registers, the External
Memory Control Register A – XMCRA, and the External Memory Control Register B – XMCRB.
When the XMEM interface is enabled, the XMEM interface will override the setting in the data
direction registers that corresponds to the ports dedicated to the XMEM interface. For details
about the port override, see the alternate functions in section “I/O-Ports” on page 70. The XMEM
interface will auto-detect whether an access is internal or external. If the access is external, the
XMEM interface will output address, data, and the control signals on the ports according to Fig-
ure 9-3 (this figure shows the wave forms without wait-states). When ALE goes from high-to-low,
there is a valid address on AD7:0. ALE is low during a data transfer. When the XMEM interface
is enabled, also an internal access will cause activity on address, data and ALE ports, but the
RD and WR strobes will not toggle during internal access. When the External Memory Interface
is disabled, the normal pin and data direction settings are used. Note that when the XMEM inter-
face is disabled, the address space above the internal SRAM boundary is not mapped into the
internal SRAM. Figure 9-2 illustrates how to connect an external SRAM to the AVR using an
octal latch (typically “74 x 573” or equivalent) which is transparent when G is high.
9.1.2
Address Latch Requirements
Due to the high-speed operation of the XRAM interface, the address latch must be selected with
care for system frequencies above 8 MHz @ 4V and 4 MHz @ 2.7V. When operating at condi-
tions above these frequencies, the typical old style 74HC series latch becomes inadequate. The
External Memory Interface is designed in compliance to the 74AHC series latch. However, most
latches can be used as long they comply with the main timing parameters. The main parameters
for the address latch are:
•
•
•
D to Q propagation delay (tPD).
Data setup time before G low (tSU).
Data (address) hold time after G low (TH).
The External Memory Interface is designed to guaranty minimum address hold time after G is
asserted low of th = 5 ns. Refer to tLAXX_LD/tLLAXX_ST in “External Data Memory Timing” Tables 31-
9 through Tables 31-16 on pages 381 - 384. The D-to-Q propagation delay (tPD) must be taken
into consideration when calculating the access time requirement of the external component. The
data setup time before G low (tSU) must not exceed address valid to ALE low (tAVLLC) minus PCB
wiring delay (dependent on the capacitive load).
Figure 9-2. External SRAM Connected to the AVR
AVR
SRAM
D[7:0]
AD7:0
D
G
Q
A[7:0]
ALE
A[15:8]
A15:8
RD
RD
WR
WR
28
ATmega640/1280/1281/2560/2561
2549L–AVR–08/07
ATmega640/1280/1281/2560/2561
9.1.3
Pull-up and Bus-keeper
The pull-ups on the AD7:0 ports may be activated if the corresponding Port register is written to
one. To reduce power consumption in sleep mode, it is recommended to disable the pull-ups by
writing the Port register to zero before entering sleep.
The XMEM interface also provides a bus-keeper on the AD7:0 lines. The bus-keeper can be dis-
abled and enabled in software as described in “XMCRB – External Memory Control Register B”
on page 37. When enabled, the bus-keeper will keep the previous value on the AD7:0 bus while
these lines are tri-stated by the XMEM interface.
9.1.4
Timing
External Memory devices have different timing requirements. To meet these requirements, the
XMEM interface provides four different wait-states as shown in Table 9-2. It is important to con-
sider the timing specification of the External Memory device before selecting the wait-state. The
most important parameters are the access time for the external memory compared to the set-up
requirement. The access time for the External Memory is defined to be the time from receiving
the chip select/address until the data of this address actually is driven on the bus. The access
time cannot exceed the time from the ALE pulse must be asserted low until data is stable during
a read sequence (See tLLRL+ tRLRH - tDVRH in Tables 31-9 through Tables 31-16 on pages 381 -
384). The different wait-states are set up in software. As an additional feature, it is possible to
divide the external memory space in two sectors with individual wait-state settings. This makes it
possible to connect two different memory devices with different timing requirements to the same
XMEM interface. For XMEM interface timing details, please refer to Table 31-9 to Table 31-16
and Figure 31-9 to Figure 31-12 in the “External Data Memory Timing” on page 381.
Note that the XMEM interface is asynchronous and that the waveforms in the following figures
are related to the internal system clock. The skew between the internal and external clock
(XTAL1) is not guarantied (varies between devices temperature, and supply voltage). Conse-
quently, the XMEM interface is not suited for synchronous operation.
Figure 9-3. External Data Memory Cycles without Wait-state (SRWn1=0 and SRWn0=0)(1)
T1
T2
T3
T4
System Clock (CLKCPU
)
ALE
A15:8 Prev. addr.
DA7:0 Prev. data
WR
Address
Data
Address
XX
DA7:0 (XMBK = 0) Prev. data
DA7:0 (XMBK = 1) Prev. data
RD
Address
Address
Data
Data
XXXXXXXX
XXXXX
Note:
1. SRWn1 = SRW11 (upper sector) or SRW01 (lower sector), SRWn0 = SRW10 (upper sector) or
SRW00 (lower sector). The ALE pulse in period T4 is only present if the next instruction
accesses the RAM (internal or external).
29
2549L–AVR–08/07
Figure 9-4. External Data Memory Cycles with SRWn1 = 0 and SRWn0 = 1(1)
T1
T2
T3
T4
T5
System Clock (CLKCPU
)
ALE
A15:8 Prev. addr.
DA7:0 Prev. data
WR
Address
Data
Address
Address
XX
DA7:0 (XMBK = 0) Prev. data
DA7:0 (XMBK = 1) Prev. data
RD
Data
Data
Address
Note:
1. SRWn1 = SRW11 (upper sector) or SRW01 (lower sector), SRWn0 = SRW10 (upper sector) or
SRW00 (lower sector).
The ALE pulse in period T5 is only present if the next instruction accesses the RAM (internal
or external).
Figure 1. External Data Memory Cycles with SRWn1 = 1 and SRWn0 = 0(1)
T1
T2
T3
T4
T5
T6
System Clock (CLKCPU
)
ALE
A15:8 Prev. addr.
DA7:0 Prev. data
WR
Address
Data
Address
Address
XX
DA7:0 (XMBK = 0) Prev. data
DA7:0 (XMBK = 1) Prev. data
RD
Data
Data
Address
Note:
1. SRWn1 = SRW11 (upper sector) or SRW01 (lower sector), SRWn0 = SRW10 (upper sector) or
SRW00 (lower sector).
The ALE pulse in period T6 is only present if the next instruction accesses the RAM (internal
or external).
30
ATmega640/1280/1281/2560/2561
2549L–AVR–08/07
ATmega640/1280/1281/2560/2561
Figure 9-5. External Data Memory Cycles with SRWn1 = 1 and SRWn0 = 1(1)
T1
T2
T3
T4
T5
T6
T7
System Clock (CLKCPU
)
ALE
A15:8 Prev. addr.
DA7:0 Prev. data
WR
Address
Data
Address
Address
XX
DA7:0 (XMBK = 0) Prev. data
DA7:0 (XMBK = 1) Prev. data
RD
Data
Data
Address
Note:
1. SRWn1 = SRW11 (upper sector) or SRW01 (lower sector), SRWn0 = SRW10 (upper sector) or
SRW00 (lower sector).
The ALE pulse in period T7 is only present if the next instruction accesses the RAM (internal
or external).
9.1.5
Using all Locations of External Memory Smaller than 64 KB
Since the external memory is mapped after the internal memory as shown in Figure 9-1, the
external memory is not addressed when addressing the first 8,704 bytes of data space. It may
appear that the first 8,704 bytes of the external memory are inaccessible (external memory
addresses 0x0000 to 0x21FF). However, when connecting an external memory smaller than 64
KB, for example 32 KB, these locations are easily accessed simply by addressing from address
0x8000 to 0xA1FF. Since the External Memory Address bit A15 is not connected to the external
memory, addresses 0x8000 to 0xA1FF will appear as addresses 0x0000 to 0x21FF for the
external memory. Addressing above address 0xA1FF is not recommended, since this will
address an external memory location that is already accessed by another (lower) address. To
the Application software, the external 32 KB memory will appear as one linear 32 KB address
space from 0x2200 to 0xA1FF. This is illustrated in Figure 9-6.
31
2549L–AVR–08/07
Figure 9-6. Address Map with 32 KB External Memory
AVR Memory Map
External 32K SRAM
0x0000
0x0000
Internal Memory
0x21FF
0x2200
External
0x7FFF
0x7FFF
0x8000
Memory
0x90FF
0x9100
9.1.6
Using all 64KB Locations of External Memory
Since the External Memory is mapped after the Internal Memory as shown in Figure 9-1, only
56KB of External Memory is available by default (address space 0x0000 to 0x21FF is reserved
for internal memory). However, it is possible to take advantage of the entire External Memory by
masking the higher address bits to zero. This can be done by using the XMMn bits and control
by software the most significant bits of the address. By setting Port C to output 0x00, and releas-
ing the most significant bits for normal Port Pin operation, the Memory Interface will address
0x0000 - 0x2FFF. See the following code examples.
Care must be exercised using this option as most of the memory is masked away.
32
ATmega640/1280/1281/2560/2561
2549L–AVR–08/07
ATmega640/1280/1281/2560/2561
Assembly Code Example(1)
; OFFSET is defined to 0x4000 to ensure
; external memory access
; Configure Port C (address high byte) to
; output 0x00 when the pins are released
; for normal Port Pin operation
ldi r16, 0xFF
out DDRC, r16
ldi r16, 0x00
out PORTC, r16
; release PC7:6
ldi r16, (1<<XMM1)
sts XMCRB, r16
; write 0xAA to address 0x0001 of external
; memory
ldi r16, 0xaa
sts 0x0001+OFFSET, r16
; re-enable PC7:6 for external memory
ldi r16, (0<<XMM1)
sts XMCRB, r16
; store 0x55 to address (OFFSET + 1) of
; external memory
ldi r16, 0x55
sts 0x0001+OFFSET, r16
C Code Example(1)
#define OFFSET 0x4000
void XRAM_example(void)
{
unsigned char *p = (unsigned char *) (OFFSET + 1);
DDRC = 0xFF;
PORTC = 0x00;
XMCRB = (1<<XMM1);
*p = 0xaa;
XMCRB = 0x00;
*p = 0x55;
}
Note:
1. See “About Code Examples” on page 10.
33
2549L–AVR–08/07
9.2
Register Description
9.2.1
9.2.1.1
EEPROM registers
EEARH and EEARL – The EEPROM Address Register
Bit
15
14
13
12
11
EEAR11
EEAR3
3
10
EEAR10
EEAR2
2
9
EEAR9
EEAR1
1
8
EEAR8
EEAR0
0
0x22 (0x42)
0x21 (0x41)
–
–
–
–
EEARH
EEARL
EEAR7
EEAR6
EEAR5
EEAR4
7
R
6
R
5
R
4
R
Read/Write
R/W
R/W
X
R/W
R/W
X
R/W
R/W
X
R/W
R/W
X
R/W
0
R/W
0
R/W
0
R/W
0
Initial Value
X
X
X
X
X
X
X
X
• Bits 15:12 – Res: Reserved Bits
These bits are reserved bits and will always read as zero.
• Bits 11:0 – EEAR8:0: EEPROM Address
The EEPROM Address Registers – EEARH and EEARL specify the EEPROM address in the 4K
bytes EEPROM space. The EEPROM data bytes are addressed linearly between 0 and 4096.
The initial value of EEAR is undefined. A proper value must be written before the EEPROM may
be accessed.
9.2.1.2
EEDR – The EEPROM Data Register
Bit
0x20 (0x40)
7
6
5
4
3
2
1
0
MSB
LSB
R/W
0
EEDR
Read/Write
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
Initial Value
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
• Bits 7:0 – EEDR7:0: EEPROM Data
For the EEPROM write operation, the EEDR Register contains the data to be written to the
EEPROM in the address given by the EEAR Register. For the EEPROM read operation, the
EEDR contains the data read out from the EEPROM at the address given by EEAR.
9.2.1.3
EECR – The EEPROM Control Register
Bit
0x1F (0x3F)
7
6
5
EEPM1
R/W
X
4
EEPM0
R/W
X
3
EERIE
R/W
0
2
EEMPE
R/W
0
1
EEPE
R/W
X
0
EERE
R/W
0
–
–
R
0
EECR
Read/Write
R
0
Initial Value
• Bits 7:6 – Res: Reserved Bits
These bits are reserved bits and will always read as zero.
• Bits 5, 4 – EEPM1 and EEPM0: EEPROM Programming Mode Bits
The EEPROM Programming mode bit setting defines which programming action that will be trig-
gered when writing EEPE. It is possible to program data in one atomic operation (erase the old
value and program the new value) or to split the Erase and Write operations in two different
operations. The Programming times for the different modes are shown in Table 9-1. While EEPE
is set, any write to EEPMn will be ignored. During reset, the EEPMn bits will be reset to 0b00
unless the EEPROM is busy programming.
34
ATmega640/1280/1281/2560/2561
2549L–AVR–08/07
ATmega640/1280/1281/2560/2561
Table 9-1.
EEPROM Mode Bits
Programming
Time
EEPM1
EEPM0
Operation
0
0
1
1
0
1
0
1
3.4 ms
1.8 ms
1.8 ms
–
Erase and Write in one operation (Atomic Operation)
Erase Only
Write Only
Reserved for future use
• Bit 3 – EERIE: EEPROM Ready Interrupt Enable
Writing EERIE to one enables the EEPROM Ready Interrupt if the I bit in SREG is set. Writing
EERIE to zero disables the interrupt. The EEPROM Ready interrupt generates a constant inter-
rupt when EEPE is cleared.
• Bit 2 – EEMPE: EEPROM Master Programming Enable
The EEMPE bit determines whether setting EEPE to one causes the EEPROM to be written.
When EEMPE is set, setting EEPE within four clock cycles will write data to the EEPROM at the
selected address If EEMPE is zero, setting EEPE will have no effect. When EEMPE has been
written to one by software, hardware clears the bit to zero after four clock cycles. See the
description of the EEPE bit for an EEPROM write procedure.
• Bit 1 – EEPE: EEPROM Programming Enable
The EEPROM Write Enable Signal EEPE is the write strobe to the EEPROM. When address
and data are correctly set up, the EEPE bit must be written to one to write the value into the
EEPROM. The EEMPE bit must be written to one before a logical one is written to EEPE, other-
wise no EEPROM write takes place. The following procedure should be followed when writing
the EEPROM (the order of steps 3 and 4 is not essential):
1. Wait until EEPE becomes zero.
2. Wait until SPMEN in SPMCSR becomes zero.
3. Write new EEPROM address to EEAR (optional).
4. Write new EEPROM data to EEDR (optional).
5. Write a logical one to the EEMPE bit while writing a zero to EEPE in EECR.
6. Within four clock cycles after setting EEMPE, write a logical one to EEPE.
The EEPROM can not be programmed during a CPU write to the Flash memory. The software
must check that the Flash programming is completed before initiating a new EEPROM write.
Step 2 is only relevant if the software contains a Boot Loader allowing the CPU to program the
Flash. If the Flash is never being updated by the CPU, step 2 can be omitted. See “Memory Pro-
gramming” on page 337 for details about Boot programming.
Caution: An interrupt between step 5 and step 6 will make the write cycle fail, since the
EEPROM Master Write Enable will time-out. If an interrupt routine accessing the EEPROM is
interrupting another EEPROM access, the EEAR or EEDR Register will be modified, causing the
interrupted EEPROM access to fail. It is recommended to have the Global Interrupt Flag cleared
during all the steps to avoid these problems.
When the write access time has elapsed, the EEPE bit is cleared by hardware. The user soft-
ware can poll this bit and wait for a zero before writing the next byte. When EEPE has been set,
the CPU is halted for two cycles before the next instruction is executed.
35
2549L–AVR–08/07
• Bit 0 – EERE: EEPROM Read Enable
The EEPROM Read Enable Signal EERE is the read strobe to the EEPROM. When the correct
address is set up in the EEAR Register, the EERE bit must be written to a logic one to trigger the
EEPROM read. The EEPROM read access takes one instruction, and the requested data is
available immediately. When the EEPROM is read, the CPU is halted for four cycles before the
next instruction is executed.
The user should poll the EEPE bit before starting the read operation. If a write operation is in
progress, it is neither possible to read the EEPROM, nor to change the EEAR Register.
9.3
General Purpose registers
9.3.1
GPIOR2 – General Purpose I/O Register 2
Bit
7
MSB
R/W
0
6
5
4
3
2
1
0
0x2B (0x4B)
Read/Write
Initial Value
LSB
R/W
0
GPIOR2
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
0
0
0
0
0
0
9.3.2
9.3.3
GPIOR1 – General Purpose I/O Register 1
Bit
7
MSB
R/W
0
6
5
4
3
2
1
0
0x2A (0x4A)
Read/Write
Initial Value
LSB
R/W
0
GPIOR1
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
0
0
0
0
0
0
GPIOR0 – General Purpose I/O Register 0
Bit
7
MSB
R/W
0
6
5
4
3
2
1
0
0x1E (0x3E)
Read/Write
Initial Value
LSB
R/W
0
GPIOR0
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
0
0
0
0
0
0
9.4
External Memory registers
9.4.1
XMCRA – External Memory Control Register A
Bit
7
6
SRL2
R/W
0
5
SRL1
R/W
0
4
SRL0
R/W
0
3
SRW11
R/W
0
2
SRW10
R/W
0
1
SRW01
R/W
0
0
SRW00
R/W
0
“(0x74)”
Read/Write
Initial Value
SRE
R/W
0
XMCRA
• Bit 7 – SRE: External SRAM/XMEM Enable
Writing SRE to one enables the External Memory Interface.The pin functions AD7:0, A15:8,
ALE, WR, and RD are activated as the alternate pin functions. The SRE bit overrides any pin
direction settings in the respective data direction registers. Writing SRE to zero, disables the
External Memory Interface and the normal pin and data direction settings are used.
• Bit 6:4 – SRL2:0: Wait-state Sector Limit
It is possible to configure different wait-states for different External Memory addresses. The
external memory address space can be divided in two sectors that have separate wait-state bits.
The SRL2, SRL1, and SRL0 bits select the split of the sectors, see Table 9-7 and Figure 9-1. By
36
ATmega640/1280/1281/2560/2561
2549L–AVR–08/07
ATmega640/1280/1281/2560/2561
default, the SRL2, SRL1, and SRL0 bits are set to zero and the entire external memory address
space is treated as one sector. When the entire SRAM address space is configured as one sec-
tor, the wait-states are configured by the SRW11 and SRW10 bits.
Figure 9-7. Sector limits with different settings of SRL2:0
SRL2
SRL1
SRL0
Sector Limits
Lower sector = N/A
Upper sector = 0x2200 - 0xFFFF
0
0
x
Lower sector = 0x2200 - 0x3FFF
Upper sector = 0x4000 - 0xFFFF
0
0
1
1
1
1
1
1
0
0
1
1
0
1
0
1
0
1
Lower sector = 0x2200 - 0x5FFF
Upper sector = 0x6000 - 0xFFFF
Lower sector = 0x2200 - 0x7FFF
Upper sector = 0x8000 - 0xFFFF
Lower sector = 0x2200 - 0x9FFF
Upper sector = 0xA000 - 0xFFFF
Lower sector = 0x2200 - 0xBFFF
Upper sector = 0xC000 - 0xFFFF
Lower sector = 0x2200 - 0xDFFF
Upper sector = 0xE000 - 0xFFFF
• Bit 3:2 – SRW11, SRW10: Wait-state Select Bits for Upper Sector
The SRW11 and SRW10 bits control the number of wait-states for the upper sector of the exter-
nal memory address space, see Table 9-2.
• Bit 1:0 – SRW01, SRW00: Wait-state Select Bits for Lower Sector
The SRW01 and SRW00 bits control the number of wait-states for the lower sector of the exter-
nal memory address space, see Table 9-2.
Table 9-2.
Wait States(1)
SRWn0
SRWn1
Wait States
0
0
1
0
1
0
No wait-states
Wait one cycle during read/write strobe
Wait two cycles during read/write strobe
Wait two cycles during read/write and wait one cycle before driving out new
1
1
address
Note:
1. n = 0 or 1 (lower/upper sector).
For further details of the timing and wait-states of the External Memory Interface, see Figures
9-3 through Figures 9-5 for how the setting of the SRW bits affects the timing.
9.4.2
XMCRB – External Memory Control Register B
Bit
7
XMBK
R/W
0
6
–
5
–
4
–
3
–
2
XMM2
R/W
0
1
XMM1
R/W
0
0
XMM0
R/W
0
(0x75)
XMCRB
Read/Write
Initial Value
R
0
R
0
R
0
R
0
• Bit 7– XMBK: External Memory Bus-keeper Enable
37
2549L–AVR–08/07
Writing XMBK to one enables the bus keeper on the AD7:0 lines. When the bus keeper is
enabled, AD7:0 will keep the last driven value on the lines even if the XMEM interface has tri-
stated the lines. Writing XMBK to zero disables the bus keeper. XMBK is not qualified with SRE,
so even if the XMEM interface is disabled, the bus keepers are still activated as long as XMBK is
one.
• Bit 6:3 – Res: Reserved Bits
These bits are reserved and will always read as zero. When writing to this address location,
write these bits to zero for compatibility with future devices.
• Bit 2:0 – XMM2, XMM1, XMM0: External Memory High Mask
When the External Memory is enabled, all Port C pins are default used for the high address byte.
If the full 60KB address space is not required to access the External Memory, some, or all, Port
C pins can be released for normal Port Pin function as described in Table 9-3. As described in
“Using all 64KB Locations of External Memory” on page 32, it is possible to use the XMMn bits to
access all 64KB locations of the External Memory.
Table 9-3.
Port C Pins Released as Normal Port Pins when the External Memory is Enabled
XMM2 XMM1 XMM0
# Bits for External Memory Address
Released Port Pins
None
0
0
0
0
1
1
1
1
0
0
1
1
0
0
1
1
0
1
0
1
0
1
0
1
8 (Full 56KB space)
7
PC7
6
PC7 - PC6
PC7 - PC5
PC7 - PC4
PC7 - PC3
PC7 - PC2
Full Port C
5
4
3
2
No Address high bits
38
ATmega640/1280/1281/2560/2561
2549L–AVR–08/07
ATmega640/1280/1281/2560/2561
10. System Clock and Clock Options
This section describes the clock options for the AVR microcontroller.
10.1 Overview
Figure 10-1 presents the principal clock systems in the AVR and their distribution. All of the
clocks need not be active at a given time. In order to reduce power consumption, the clocks to
modules not being used can be halted by using different sleep modes, as described in “Power
Management and Sleep Modes” on page 52. The clock systems are detailed below.
Figure 10-1. Clock Distribution
Asynchronous
Timer/Counter
General I/O
Modules
Flash and
EEPROM
ADC
CPU Core
RAM
clkADC
clkI/O
clkCPU
AVR Clock
Control Unit
clkASY
clkFLASH
Reset Logic
Watchdog Timer
Source clock
Watchdog clock
Watchdog
Oscillator
System Clock
Prescaler
Clock
Multiplexer
Timer/Counter
Oscillator
Crystal
Oscillator
Low-frequency
Crystal Oscillator
Calibrated RC
Oscillator
External Clock
10.2 Clock Systems and their Distribution
10.2.1
CPU Clock – clkCPU
The CPU clock is routed to parts of the system concerned with operation of the AVR core.
Examples of such modules are the General Purpose Register File, the Status Register and the
data memory holding the Stack Pointer. Halting the CPU clock inhibits the core from performing
general operations and calculations.
39
2549L–AVR–08/07
10.2.2
I/O Clock – clkI/O
The I/O clock is used by the majority of the I/O modules, like Timer/Counters, SPI, and USART.
The I/O clock is also used by the External Interrupt module, but note that some external inter-
rupts are detected by asynchronous logic, allowing such interrupts to be detected even if the I/O
clock is halted. Also note that start condition detection in the USI module is carried out asynchro-
nously when clkI/O is halted, TWI address recognition in all sleep modes.
10.2.3
10.2.4
Flash Clock – clkFLASH
The Flash clock controls operation of the Flash interface. The Flash clock is usually active simul-
taneously with the CPU clock.
Asynchronous Timer Clock – clkASY
The Asynchronous Timer clock allows the Asynchronous Timer/Counter to be clocked directly
from an external clock or an external 32 kHz clock crystal. The dedicated clock domain allows
using this Timer/Counter as a real-time counter even when the device is in sleep mode.
10.2.5
ADC Clock – clkADC
The ADC is provided with a dedicated clock domain. This allows halting the CPU and I/O clocks
in order to reduce noise generated by digital circuitry. This gives more accurate ADC conversion
results.
10.3 Clock Sources
The device has the following clock source options, selectable by Flash Fuse bits as shown
below. The clock from the selected source is input to the AVR clock generator, and routed to the
appropriate modules.
Table 10-1. Device Clocking Options Select(1)
Device Clocking Option
Low Power Crystal Oscillator
Full Swing Crystal Oscillator
Low Frequency Crystal Oscillator
Internal 128 kHz RC Oscillator
Calibrated Internal RC Oscillator
External Clock
CKSEL3:0
1111 - 1000
0111 - 0110
0101 - 0100
0011
0010
0000
Reserved
0001
Note:
1. For all fuses “1” means unprogrammed while “0” means programmed.
40
ATmega640/1280/1281/2560/2561
2549L–AVR–08/07
ATmega640/1280/1281/2560/2561
10.3.1
10.3.2
Default Clock Source
The device is shipped with internal RC oscillator at 8.0 MHz and with the fuse CKDIV8 pro-
grammed, resulting in 1.0 MHz system clock. The startup time is set to maximum and time-out
period enabled. (CKSEL = "0010", SUT = "10", CKDIV8 = "0"). The default setting ensures that
all users can make their desired clock source setting using any available programming interface.
Clock Start-up Sequence
Any clock source needs a sufficient VCC to start oscillating and a minimum number of oscillating
cycles before it can be considered stable.
To ensure sufficient VCC, the device issues an internal reset with a time-out delay (tTOUT) after
the device reset is released by all other reset sources. “On-chip Debug System” on page 55
describes the start conditions for the internal reset. The delay (tTOUT) is timed from the Watchdog
Oscillator and the number of cycles in the delay is set by the SUTx and CKSELx fuse bits. The
selectable delays are shown in Table 10-2. The frequency of the Watchdog Oscillator is voltage
dependent as shown in “Typical Characteristics” on page 387.
Table 10-2. Number of Watchdog Oscillator Cycles
Typ Time-out (VCC = 5.0V)
Typ Time-out (VCC = 3.0V)
Number of Cycles
0 ms
4.1 ms
65 ms
0 ms
4.3 ms
69 ms
0
512
8K (8,192)
Main purpose of the delay is to keep the AVR in reset until it is supplied with minimum Vcc. The
delay will not monitor the actual voltage and it will be required to select a delay longer than the
Vcc rise time. If this is not possible, an internal or external Brown-Out Detection circuit should be
used. A BOD circuit will ensure sufficient Vcc before it releases the reset, and the time-out delay
can be disabled. Disabling the time-out delay without utilizing a Brown-Out Detection circuit is
not recommended.
The oscillator is required to oscillate for a minimum number of cycles before the clock is consid-
ered stable. An internal ripple counter monitors the oscillator output clock, and keeps the internal
reset active for a given number of clock cycles. The reset is then released and the device will
start to execute. The recommended oscillator start-up time is dependent on the clock type, and
varies from 6 cycles for an externally applied clock to 32K cycles for a low frequency crystal.
The start-up sequence for the clock includes both the time-out delay and the start-up time when
the device starts up from reset. When starting up from Power-save or Power-down mode, Vcc is
assumed to be at a sufficient level and only the start-up time is included.
10.4 Low Power Crystal Oscillator
Pins XTAL1 and XTAL2 are input and output, respectively, of an inverting amplifier which can be
configured for use as an On-chip Oscillator, as shown in Figure 10-2. Either a quartz crystal or a
ceramic resonator may be used.
This Crystal Oscillator is a low power oscillator, with reduced voltage swing on the XTAL2 out-
put. It gives the lowest power consumption, but is not capable of driving other clock inputs, and
may be more susceptible to noise in noisy environments. In these cases, refer to the “Full Swing
Crystal Oscillator” on page 43.
41
2549L–AVR–08/07
C1 and C2 should always be equal for both crystals and resonators. The optimal value of the
capacitors depends on the crystal or resonator in use, the amount of stray capacitance, and the
electromagnetic noise of the environment. Some initial guidelines for choosing capacitors for
use with crystals are given in Table 10-3. For ceramic resonators, the capacitor values given by
the manufacturer should be used.
Figure 10-2. Crystal Oscillator Connections
C2
XTAL2
C1
XTAL1
GND
The Low Power Oscillator can operate in three different modes, each optimized for a specific fre-
quency range. The operating mode is selected by the fuses CKSEL3:1 as shown in Table 10-3.
Table 10-3. Low Power Crystal Oscillator Operating Modes(3)
Recommended Range for Capacitors C1
Frequency Range (MHz)
0.4 - 0.9
CKSEL3:1(1)
100(2)
101
and C2 (pF)
–
0.9 - 3.0
12 - 22
12 - 22
12 - 22
3.0 - 8.0
110
8.0 - 16.0(4)
111
Notes: 1. This is the recommended CKSEL settings for the different frequency ranges.
2. This option should not be used with crystals, only with ceramic resonators.
3. If 8 MHz frequency exceeds the specification of the device (depends on VCC), the CKDIV8
Fuse can be programmed in order to divide the internal frequency by 8. It must be ensured
that the resulting divided clock meets the frequency specification of the device.
4. Max frequency when using ceramic oscillator is 10 MHz.
The CKSEL0 Fuse together with the SUT1:0 Fuses select the start-up times as shown in Table
10-4.
Table 10-4. Start-up Times for the Low Power Crystal Oscillator Clock Selection
Start-up Time from
Power-down and
Power-save
Additional Delay
from Reset
Oscillator Source /
Power Conditions
(VCC = 5.0V)
CKSEL0
SUT1:0
Ceramic resonator, fast
rising power
258 CK
258 CK
1K CK
14CK + 4.1 ms(1)
14CK + 65 ms(1)
14CK(2)
0
00
Ceramic resonator, slowly
rising power
0
0
01
10
Ceramic resonator, BOD
enabled
42
ATmega640/1280/1281/2560/2561
2549L–AVR–08/07
ATmega640/1280/1281/2560/2561
Table 10-4. Start-up Times for the Low Power Crystal Oscillator Clock Selection (Continued)
Start-up Time from
Power-down and
Power-save
Additional Delay
from Reset
Oscillator Source /
Power Conditions
(VCC = 5.0V)
CKSEL0
SUT1:0
Ceramic resonator, fast
rising power
1K CK
14CK + 4.1 ms(2)
0
11
Ceramic resonator, slowly
rising power
1K CK
14CK + 65 ms(2)
14CK
1
1
1
1
00
01
Crystal Oscillator, BOD
enabled
16K CK
Crystal Oscillator, fast
rising power
16K CK
16K CK
14CK + 4.1 ms
14CK + 65 ms
10
11
Crystal Oscillator, slowly
rising power
Notes: 1. These options should only be used when not operating close to the maximum frequency of the
device, and only if frequency stability at start-up is not important for the application. These
options are not suitable for crystals.
2. These options are intended for use with ceramic resonators and will ensure frequency stability
at start-up. They can also be used with crystals when not operating close to the maximum fre-
quency of the device, and if frequency stability at start-up is not important for the application.
10.5 Full Swing Crystal Oscillator
Pins XTAL1 and XTAL2 are input and output, respectively, of an inverting amplifier which can be
configured for use as an On-chip Oscillator, as shown in Figure 10-2. Either a quartz crystal or a
ceramic resonator may be used.
This Crystal Oscillator is a full swing oscillator, with rail-to-rail swing on the XTAL2 output. This is
useful for driving other clock inputs and in noisy environments. The current consumption is
higher than the “Low Power Crystal Oscillator” on page 41. Note that the Full Swing Crystal
Oscillator will only operate for Vcc = 2.7 - 5.5 volts.
C1 and C2 should always be equal for both crystals and resonators. The optimal value of the
capacitors depends on the crystal or resonator in use, the amount of stray capacitance, and the
electromagnetic noise of the environment. Some initial guidelines for choosing capacitors for
use with crystals are given in Table 10-6. For ceramic resonators, the capacitor values given by
the manufacturer should be used.
The operating mode is selected by the fuses CKSEL3:1 as shown in Table 10-5.
Table 10-5. Full Swing Crystal Oscillator operating modes(1)
Recommended Range for Capacitors C1
Frequency Range (MHz)
CKSEL3:1
and C2 (pF)
0.4 - 16
011
12 - 22
Note:
1. If 8 MHz frequency exceeds the specification of the device (depends on VCC), the CKDIV8
Fuse can be programmed in order to divide the internal frequency by 8. It must be ensured
that the resulting divided clock meets the frequency specification of the device.
43
2549L–AVR–08/07
Figure 10-3. Crystal Oscillator Connections
C2
XTAL2
XTAL1
GND
C1
44
ATmega640/1280/1281/2560/2561
2549L–AVR–08/07
ATmega640/1280/1281/2560/2561
Table 10-6. Start-up Times for the Full Swing Crystal Oscillator Clock Selection
Start-up Time from
Power-down and
Power-save
Additional Delay
from Reset
Oscillator Source /
Power Conditions
(VCC = 5.0V)
CKSEL0
SUT1:0
Ceramic resonator, fast
rising power
258 CK
258 CK
1K CK
14CK + 4.1 ms(1)
14CK + 65 ms(1)
14CK(2)
0
00
Ceramic resonator, slowly
rising power
0
0
0
1
1
1
1
01
10
11
00
01
10
11
Ceramic resonator, BOD
enabled
Ceramic resonator, fast
rising power
1K CK
14CK + 4.1 ms(2)
14CK + 65 ms(2)
14CK
Ceramic resonator, slowly
rising power
1K CK
Crystal Oscillator, BOD
enabled
16K CK
16K CK
16K CK
Crystal Oscillator, fast
rising power
14CK + 4.1 ms
14CK + 65 ms
Crystal Oscillator, slowly
rising power
Notes: 1. These options should only be used when not operating close to the maximum frequency of the
device, and only if frequency stability at start-up is not important for the application. These
options are not suitable for crystals.
2. These options are intended for use with ceramic resonators and will ensure frequency stability
at start-up. They can also be used with crystals when not operating close to the maximum fre-
quency of the device, and if frequency stability at start-up is not important for the application.
10.6 Low Frequency Crystal Oscillator
The device can utilize a 32.768 kHz watch crystal as clock source by a dedicated Low Fre-
quency Crystal Oscillator. The crystal should be connected as shown in Figure 10-2. When this
Oscillator is selected, start-up times are determined by the SUT Fuses and CKSEL0 as shown in
Table 10-7.
Table 10-7. Start-up Times for the Low Frequency Crystal Oscillator Clock Selection
Start-up Time from
Power-down and
Power-save
Additional Delay
from Reset
Power Conditions
BOD enabled
(VCC = 5.0V)
CKSEL0
SUT1:0
00
1K CK
1K CK
14CK(1)
0
0
0
0
1
1
1
1
Fast rising power
Slowly rising power
14CK + 4.1 ms(1)
14CK + 65 ms(1)
01
1K CK
10
Reserved
32K CK
32K CK
32K CK
Reserved
11
BOD enabled
Fast rising power
Slowly rising power
14CK
00
14CK + 4.1 ms
14CK + 65 ms
01
10
11
45
2549L–AVR–08/07
Note:
1. These options should only be used if frequency stability at start-up is not important for the
application.
10.7 Calibrated Internal RC Oscillator
By defaylt, the Internal RC Oscillator provides an approximate 8 MHz clock. Though voltage and
temperature dependent, this clock can be very accurately calibrated by the user. See Table 31-1
on page 374 and “Internal Oscillator Speed” on page 406 for more details. The device is shipped
with the CKDIV8 Fuse programmed. See “System Clock Prescaler” on page 49 for more details.
This clock may be selected as the system clock by programming the CKSEL Fuses as shown in
Table 10-8. If selected, it will operate with no external components. During reset, hardware loads
the pre-programmed calibration value into the OSCCAL Register and thereby automatically cal-
ibrates the RC Oscillator. The accuracy of this calibration is shown as Factory calibration in
Table 31-1 on page 374.
By changing the OSCCAL register from SW, see “OSCCAL – Oscillator Calibration Register” on
page 50, it is possible to get a higher calibration accuracy than by using the factory calibration.
The accuracy of this calibration is shown as User calibration in Table 31-1 on page 374.
When this Oscillator is used as the chip clock, the Watchdog Oscillator will still be used for the
Watchdog Timer and for the Reset Time-out. For more information on the pre-programmed cali-
bration value, see the section “Calibration Byte” on page 340.
Table 10-8. Internal Calibrated RC Oscillator Operating Modes(1)(2)
Frequency Range (MHz)
CKSEL3:0
7.3 - 8.1
0010
Notes: 1. The device is shipped with this option selected.
2. If 8 MHz frequency exceeds the specification of the device (depends on VCC), the CKDIV8
Fuse can be programmed in order to divide the internal frequency by 8.
When this Oscillator is selected, start-up times are determined by the SUT Fuses as shown in
Table 10-9 on page 47.
46
ATmega640/1280/1281/2560/2561
2549L–AVR–08/07
ATmega640/1280/1281/2560/2561
Table 10-9. Start-up times for the internal calibrated RC Oscillator clock selection
Start-up Time from Power-
down and Power-save
Additional Delay from
Reset (VCC = 5.0V)
Power Conditions
BOD enabled
SUT1:0
00
6 CK
6 CK
14CK
Fast rising power
Slowly rising power
14CK + 4.1 ms
14CK + 65 ms(1)
01
6 CK
10
Reserved
11
Note:
1. The device is shipped with this option selected.
10.8 128 kHz Internal Oscillator
The 128 kHz internal Oscillator is a low power Oscillator providing a clock of 128 kHz. The fre-
quency is nominal at 3V and 25°C. This clock may be select as the system clock by
programming the CKSEL Fuses to “11” as shown in Table 10-10.
Table 10-10. 128 kHz Internal Oscillator Operating Modes(1)
Nominal Frequency
CKSEL3:0
128 kHz
0011
Note:
1. Note that the 128 kHz oscillator is a very low power clock source, and is not designed for high
accuracy.
When this clock source is selected, start-up times are determined by the SUT Fuses as shown in
Table 10-11.
Table 10-11. Start-up Times for the 128 kHz Internal Oscillator
Start-up Time from Power-
down and Power-save
Additional Delay from
Reset
Power Conditions
BOD enabled
SUT1:0
00
6 CK
6 CK
14CK
Fast rising power
Slowly rising power
14CK + 4 ms
14CK + 64 ms
01
6 CK
10
Reserved
11
10.9 External Clock
To drive the device from an external clock source, XTAL1 should be driven as shown in Figure
10-4. To run the device on an external clock, the CKSEL Fuses must be programmed to “0000”.
47
2549L–AVR–08/07
Figure 10-4. External Clock Drive Configuration
NC
XTAL2
EXTERNAL
CLOCK
XTAL1
GND
SIGNAL
When this clock source is selected, start-up times are determined by the SUT Fuses as shown in
Table 10-14.
Table 10-12. Crystal Oscillator Clock Frequency
Nominal Frequency
CKSEL3:0
0 - 16 MHz
0000
Table 10-13. Start-up Times for the External Clock Selection
Start-up Time from Power-
down and Power-save
Additional Delay from
Reset (VCC = 5.0V)
Power Conditions
BOD enabled
SUT1:0
00
6 CK
6 CK
14CK
Fast rising power
Slowly rising power
14CK + 4.1 ms
14CK + 65 ms
01
6 CK
10
Reserved
11
When applying an external clock, it is required to avoid sudden changes in the applied clock fre-
quency to ensure stable operation of the MCU. A variation in frequency of more than 2% from
one clock cycle to the next can lead to unpredictable behavior. If changes of more than 2% is
required, ensure that the MCU is kept in Reset during the changes.
Note that the System Clock Prescaler can be used to implement run-time changes of the internal
clock frequency while still ensuring stable operation. Refer to “System Clock Prescaler” on page
49 for details.
10.10 Clock Output Buffer
The device can output the system clock on the CLKO pin. To enable the output, the CKOUT
Fuse has to be programmed. This mode is suitable when the chip clock is used to drive other cir-
cuits on the system. The clock also will be output during reset, and the normal operation of I/O
pin will be overridden when the fuse is programmed. Any clock source, including the internal RC
Oscillator, can be selected when the clock is output on CLKO. If the System Clock Prescaler is
used, it is the divided system clock that is output.
48
ATmega640/1280/1281/2560/2561
2549L–AVR–08/07
ATmega640/1280/1281/2560/2561
10.11 Timer/Counter Oscillator
The device can operate its Timer/Counter2 from an external 32.768 kHz watch crystal or a exter-
nal clock source. See Figure 10-2 on page 42 for crystal connection.
Applying an external clock source to TOSC1 requires EXCLK in the ASSR Register written to
logic one. See “Asynchronous Operation of Timer/Counter2” on page 185 for further description
on selecting external clock as input instead of a 32 kHz crystal.
10.12 System Clock Prescaler
The ATmega640/1280/1281/2560/2561 has a system clock prescaler, and the system clock can
be divided by setting the “CLKPR – Clock Prescale Register” on page 50. This feature can be
used to decrease the system clock frequency and the power consumption when the requirement
for processing power is low. This can be used with all clock source options, and it will affect the
clock frequency of the CPU and all synchronous peripherals. clkI/O, clkADC, clkCPU, and clkFLASH
are divided by a factor as shown in Table 10-14.
When switching between prescaler settings, the System Clock Prescaler ensures that no
glitches occurs in the clock system. It also ensures that no intermediate frequency is higher than
neither the clock frequency corresponding to the previous setting, nor the clock frequency corre-
sponding to the new setting.
The ripple counter that implements the prescaler runs at the frequency of the undivided clock,
which may be faster than the CPU's clock frequency. Hence, it is not possible to determine the
state of the prescaler - even if it were readable, and the exact time it takes to switch from one
clock division to the other cannot be exactly predicted. From the time the CLKPS values are writ-
ten, it takes between T1 + T2 and T1 + 2 * T2 before the new clock frequency is active. In this
interval, 2 active clock edges are produced. Here, T1 is the previous clock period, and T2 is the
period corresponding to the new prescaler setting.
To avoid unintentional changes of clock frequency, a special write procedure must be followed
to change the CLKPS bits:
Write the Clock Prescaler Change Enable (CLKPCE) bit to one and all other bits in CLKPR to
zero.
Within four cycles, write the desired value to CLKPS while writing a zero to CLKPCE.
Interrupts must be disabled when changing prescaler setting to make sure the write procedure is
not interrupted.
49
2549L–AVR–08/07
10.13 Register Description
10.13.1 OSCCAL – Oscillator Calibration Register
Bit
7
6
5
4
3
2
1
0
(0x66)
CAL7
R/W
CAL6
R/W
CAL5
R/W
CAL4
R/W
CAL3
R/W
CAL2
R/W
CAL1
R/W
CAL0
R/W
OSCCAL
Read/Write
Initial Value
Device Specific Calibration Value
• Bits 7:0 – CAL7:0: Oscillator Calibration Value
The Oscillator Calibration Register is used to trim the Calibrated Internal RC Oscillator to
remove process variations from the oscillator frequency. A pre-programmed calibration value is
automatically written to this register during chip reset, giving the Factory calibrated frequency as
specified in Table 31-1 on page 374. The application software can write this register to change
the oscillator frequency. The oscillator can be calibrated to frequencies as specified in Table 31-
1 on page 374. Calibration outside that range is not guaranteed.
Note that this oscillator is used to time EEPROM and Flash write accesses, and these write
times will be affected accordingly. If the EEPROM or Flash are written, do not calibrate to more
than 8.8 MHz. Otherwise, the EEPROM or Flash write may fail.
The CAL7 bit determines the range of operation for the oscillator. Setting this bit to 0 gives the
lowest frequency range, setting this bit to 1 gives the highest frequency range. The two fre-
quency ranges are overlapping, in other words a setting of OSCCAL = 0x7F gives a higher
frequency than OSCCAL = 0x80.
The CAL6..0 bits are used to tune the frequency within the selected range. A setting of 0x00
gives the lowest frequency in that range, and a setting of 0x7F gives the highest frequency in the
range.
10.13.2 CLKPR – Clock Prescale Register
Bit
7
6
–
5
–
4
–
3
2
1
0
CLKPCE
R/W
0
CLKPS3
R/W
CLKPS2
R/W
CLKPS1
R/W
CLKPS0
R/W
CLKPR
(0x61)
Read/Write
Initial Value
R
0
R
0
R
0
See Bit Description
• Bit 7 – CLKPCE: Clock Prescaler Change Enable
The CLKPCE bit must be written to logic one to enable change of the CLKPS bits. The CLKPCE
bit is only updated when the other bits in CLKPR are simultaneously written to zero. CLKPCE is
cleared by hardware four cycles after it is written or when CLKPS bits are written. Rewriting the
CLKPCE bit within this time-out period does neither extend the time-out period, nor clear the
CLKPCE bit.
• Bits 3:0 – CLKPS3:0: Clock Prescaler Select Bits 3 - 0
These bits define the division factor between the selected clock source and the internal system
clock. These bits can be written run-time to vary the clock frequency to suit the application
requirements. As the divider divides the master clock input to the MCU, the speed of all synchro-
nous peripherals is reduced when a division factor is used. The division factors are given in
Table 10-14.
50
ATmega640/1280/1281/2560/2561
2549L–AVR–08/07
ATmega640/1280/1281/2560/2561
The CKDIV8 Fuse determines the initial value of the CLKPS bits. If CKDIV8 is unprogrammed,
the CLKPS bits will be reset to “0000”. If CKDIV8 is programmed, CLKPS bits are reset to
“0011”, giving a division factor of 8 at start up. This feature should be used if the selected clock
source has a higher frequency than the maximum frequency of the device at the present operat-
ing conditions. Note that any value can be written to the CLKPS bits regardless of the CKDIV8
Fuse setting. The Application software must ensure that a sufficient division factor is chosen if
the selected clock source has a higher frequency than the maximum frequency of the device at
the present operating conditions. The device is shipped with the CKDIV8 Fuse programmed.
Table 10-14. Clock Prescaler Select
CLKPS3
CLKPS2
CLKPS1
CLKPS0
Clock Division Factor
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
0
0
0
0
1
1
1
1
0
0
0
0
1
1
1
1
0
0
1
1
0
0
1
1
0
0
1
1
0
0
1
1
0
1
0
1
0
1
0
1
0
1
0
1
0
1
0
1
1
2
4
8
16
32
64
128
256
Reserved
Reserved
Reserved
Reserved
Reserved
Reserved
Reserved
51
2549L–AVR–08/07
11. Power Management and Sleep Modes
Sleep modes enable the application to shut down unused modules in the MCU, thereby saving
power. The AVR provides various sleep modes allowing the user to tailor the power consump-
tion to the application’s requirements.
11.1 Sleep Modes
Figure 10-1 on page 39 presents the different clock systems in the
ATmega640/1280/1281/2560/2561, and their distribution. The figure is helpful in selecting an
appropriate sleep mode. Table 11-1 shows the different sleep modes and their wake-up
sources.
Table 11-1. Active Clock Domains and Wake-up Sources in the Different Sleep Modes.
Active Clock Domains Oscillators Wake-up Sources
Sleep Mode
Idle
X
X
X
X
X
X
X
X(2)
X(2)
X
X
X
X
X
X
X
X
X
X
X
X
X
X
X
X
X
X
X
ADCNRM
X(3)
X(3)
X(3)
X(3)
X(3)
X(2)
Power-down
Power-save
Standby(1)
X
X(2)
X
X
X
X
Extended Standby
X(2)
X(2)
Notes: 1. Only recommended with external crystal or resonator selected as clock source.
2. If Timer/Counter2 is running in asynchronous mode.
3. For INT7:4, only level interrupt.
To enter any of the sleep modes, the SE bit in “SMCR – Sleep Mode Control Register” on page
56 must be written to logic one and a SLEEP instruction must be executed. The SM2, SM1, and
SM0 bits in the SMCR Register select which sleep mode will be activated by the SLEEP instruc-
tion. See Table 11-2 on page 56 for a summary.
If an enabled interrupt occurs while the MCU is in a sleep mode, the MCU wakes up. The MCU
is then halted for four cycles in addition to the start-up time, executes the interrupt routine, and
resumes execution from the instruction following SLEEP. The contents of the Register File and
SRAM are unaltered when the device wakes up from sleep. If a reset occurs during sleep mode,
the MCU wakes up and executes from the Reset Vector.
11.2 Idle Mode
When the SM2:0 bits are written to 000, the SLEEP instruction makes the MCU enter Idle mode,
stopping the CPU but allowing the SPI, USART, Analog Comparator, ADC, 2-wire Serial Inter-
face, Timer/Counters, Watchdog, and the interrupt system to continue operating. This sleep
mode basically halts clkCPU and clkFLASH, while allowing the other clocks to run.
52
ATmega640/1280/1281/2560/2561
2549L–AVR–08/07
ATmega640/1280/1281/2560/2561
Idle mode enables the MCU to wake up from external triggered interrupts as well as internal
ones like the Timer Overflow and USART Transmit Complete interrupts. If wake-up from the
Analog Comparator interrupt is not required, the Analog Comparator can be powered down by
setting the ACD bit in the Analog Comparator Control and Status Register – ACSR. This will
reduce power consumption in Idle mode. If the ADC is enabled, a conversion starts automati-
cally when this mode is entered.
11.3 ADC Noise Reduction Mode
When the SM2:0 bits are written to 001, the SLEEP instruction makes the MCU enter ADC
Noise Reduction mode, stopping the CPU but allowing the ADC, the external interrupts, 2-wire
Serial Interface address match, Timer/Counter2 and the Watchdog to continue operating (if
enabled). This sleep mode basically halts clkI/O, clkCPU, and clkFLASH, while allowing the
other clocks to run.
This improves the noise environment for the ADC, enabling higher resolution measurements. If
the ADC is enabled, a conversion starts automatically when this mode is entered. Apart form the
ADC Conversion Complete interrupt, only an External Reset, a Watchdog System Reset, a
Watchdog interrupt, a Brown-out Reset, a 2-wire serial interface interrupt, a Timer/Counter2
interrupt, an SPM/EEPROM ready interrupt, an external level interrupt on INT7:4 or a pin
change interrupt can wakeup the MCU from ADC Noise Reduction mode.
11.4 Power-down Mode
When the SM2:0 bits are written to 010, the SLEEP instruction makes the MCU enter Power-
down mode. In this mode, the external Oscillator is stopped, while the external interrupts, the 2-
wire Serial Interface, and the Watchdog continue operating (if enabled). Only an External Reset,
a Watchdog Reset, a Brown-out Reset, 2-wire Serial Interface address match, an external level
interrupt on INT7:4, an external interrupt on INT3:0, or a pin change interrupt can wake up the
MCU. This sleep mode basically halts all generated clocks, allowing operation of asynchronous
modules only.
Note that if a level triggered interrupt is used for wake-up from Power-down mode, the changed
level must be held for some time to wake up the MCU. Refer to “External Interrupts” on page 112
for details.
When waking up from Power-down mode, there is a delay from the wake-up condition occurs
until the wake-up becomes effective. This allows the clock to restart and become stable after
having been stopped. The wake-up period is defined by the same CKSEL Fuses that define the
Reset Time-out period, as described in “Clock Sources” on page 40.
11.5 Power-save Mode
When the SM2:0 bits are written to 011, the SLEEP instruction makes the MCU enter Power-
save mode. This mode is identical to Power-down, with one exception:
If Timer/Counter2 is enabled, it will keep running during sleep. The device can wake up from
either Timer Overflow or Output Compare event from Timer/Counter2 if the corresponding
Timer/Counter2 interrupt enable bits are set in TIMSK2, and the Global Interrupt Enable bit in
SREG is set. If Timer/Counter2 is not running, Power-down mode is recommended instead of
Power-save mode.
The Timer/Counter2 can be clocked both synchronously and asynchronously in Power-save
mode. If the Timer/Counter2 is not using the asynchronous clock, the Timer/Counter Oscillator is
53
2549L–AVR–08/07
stopped during sleep. If the Timer/Counter2 is not using the synchronous clock, the clock source
is stopped during sleep. Note that even if the synchronous clock is running in Power-save, this
clock is only available for the Timer/Counter2.
11.6 Standby Mode
When the SM2:0 bits are 110 and an external crystal/resonator clock option is selected, the
SLEEP instruction makes the MCU enter Standby mode. This mode is identical to Power-down
with the exception that the Oscillator is kept running. From Standby mode, the device wakes up
in six clock cycles.
11.7 Extended Standby Mode
When the SM2:0 bits are 111 and an external crystal/resonator clock option is selected, the
SLEEP instruction makes the MCU enter Extended Standby mode. This mode is identical to
Power-save mode with the exception that the Oscillator is kept running. From Extended Standby
mode, the device wakes up in six clock cycles.Power Reduction Register
The Power Reduction Register (PRR), see “PRR0 – Power Reduction Register 0” on page 56
and “PRR1 – Power Reduction Register 1” on page 57, provides a method to stop the clock to
individual peripherals to reduce power consumption. The current state of the peripheral is frozen
and the I/O registers can not be read or written. Resources used by the peripheral when stop-
ping the clock will remain occupied, hence the peripheral should in most cases be disabled
before stopping the clock. Waking up a module, which is done by clearing the bit in PRR, puts
the module in the same state as before shutdown.
Module shutdown can be used in Idle mode and Active mode to significantly reduce the overall
power consumption. See “Supply Current of IO modules” on page 392 for examples. In all other
sleep modes, the clock is already stopped.
11.8 Minimizing Power Consumption
There are several issues to consider when trying to minimize the power consumption in an AVR
controlled system. In general, sleep modes should be used as much as possible, and the sleep
mode should be selected so that as few as possible of the device’s functions are operating. All
functions not needed should be disabled. In particular, the following modules may need special
consideration when trying to achieve the lowest possible power consumption.
11.8.1
11.8.2
Analog to Digital Converter
If enabled, the ADC will be enabled in all sleep modes. To save power, the ADC should be dis-
abled before entering any sleep mode. When the ADC is turned off and on again, the next
conversion will be an extended conversion. Refer to “ADC – Analog to Digital Converter” on
page 275 for details on ADC operation.
Analog Comparator
When entering Idle mode, the Analog Comparator should be disabled if not used. When entering
ADC Noise Reduction mode, the Analog Comparator should be disabled. In other sleep modes,
the Analog Comparator is automatically disabled. However, if the Analog Comparator is set up
to use the Internal Voltage Reference as input, the Analog Comparator should be disabled in all
sleep modes. Otherwise, the Internal Voltage Reference will be enabled, independent of sleep
54
ATmega640/1280/1281/2560/2561
2549L–AVR–08/07
ATmega640/1280/1281/2560/2561
mode. Refer to “AC – Analog Comparator” on page 271 for details on how to configure the Ana-
log Comparator.
11.8.3
11.8.4
Brown-out Detector
If the Brown-out Detector is not needed by the application, this module should be turned off. If
the Brown-out Detector is enabled by the BODLEVEL Fuses, it will be enabled in all sleep
modes, and hence, always consume power. In the deeper sleep modes, this will contribute sig-
nificantly to the total current consumption. Refer to “Brown-out Detection” on page 61 for details
on how to configure the Brown-out Detector.
Internal Voltage Reference
The Internal Voltage Reference will be enabled when needed by the Brown-out Detection, the
Analog Comparator or the ADC. If these modules are disabled as described in the sections
above, the internal voltage reference will be disabled and it will not be consuming power. When
turned on again, the user must allow the reference to start up before the output is used. If the
reference is kept on in sleep mode, the output can be used immediately. Refer to “Internal Volt-
age Reference” on page 62 for details on the start-up time.
11.8.5
11.8.6
Watchdog Timer
If the Watchdog Timer is not needed in the application, the module should be turned off. If the
Watchdog Timer is enabled, it will be enabled in all sleep modes, and hence, always consume
power. In the deeper sleep modes, this will contribute significantly to the total current consump-
tion. Refer to “Interrupts” on page 105 for details on how to configure the Watchdog Timer.
Port Pins
When entering a sleep mode, all port pins should be configured to use minimum power. The
most important is then to ensure that no pins drive resistive loads. In sleep modes where both
the I/O clock (clkI/O) and the ADC clock (clkADC) are stopped, the input buffers of the device will
be disabled. This ensures that no power is consumed by the input logic when not needed. In
some cases, the input logic is needed for detecting wake-up conditions, and it will then be
enabled. Refer to the section “Digital Input Enable and Sleep Modes” on page 74 for details on
which pins are enabled. If the input buffer is enabled and the input signal is left floating or have
an analog signal level close to VCC/2, the input buffer will use excessive power.
For analog input pins, the digital input buffer should be disabled at all times. An analog signal
level close to VCC/2 on an input pin can cause significant current even in active mode. Digital
input buffers can be disabled by writing to the Digital Input Disable Registers (DIDR2, DIDR1
and DIDR0). Refer to “DIDR2 – Digital Input Disable Register 2” on page 296, “DIDR1 – Digital
Input Disable Register 1” on page 273 and “DIDR0 – Digital Input Disable Register 0” on page
296 for details.
11.8.7
On-chip Debug System
If the On-chip debug system is enabled by the OCDEN Fuse and the chip enters sleep mode,
the main clock source is enabled, and hence, always consumes power. In the deeper sleep
modes, this will contribute significantly to the total current consumption. There are three alterna-
tive ways to disable the OCD system:
•
•
•
Disable the OCDEN Fuse.
Disable the JTAGEN Fuse.
Write one to the JTD bit in MCUCR.
55
2549L–AVR–08/07
11.9 Register Description
11.9.1
SMCR – Sleep Mode Control Register
The Sleep Mode Control Register contains control bits for power management.
Bit
7
–
6
–
5
–
4
–
3
2
1
0
SE
R/W
0
0x33 (0x53)
Read/Write
Initial Value
SM2
R/W
0
SM1
R/W
0
SM0
R/W
0
SMCR
R
0
R
0
R
0
R
0
• Bits 3, 2, 1 – SM2:0: Sleep Mode Select Bits 2, 1, and 0
These bits select between the five available sleep modes as shown in Table 11-2.
Table 11-2. Sleep Mode Select
SM2
SM1
SM0
Sleep Mode
Idle
0
0
0
0
1
1
1
1
0
0
1
1
0
0
1
1
0
1
0
1
0
1
0
1
ADC Noise Reduction
Power-down
Power-save
Reserved
Reserved
Standby(1)
Extended Standby(1)
Note:
1. Standby modes are only recommended for use with external crystals or resonators.
• Bit 1 – SE: Sleep Enable
The SE bit must be written to logic one to make the MCU enter the sleep mode when the SLEEP
instruction is executed. To avoid the MCU entering the sleep mode unless it is the programmer’s
purpose, it is recommended to write the Sleep Enable (SE) bit to one just before the execution of
the SLEEP instruction and to clear it immediately after waking up.
11.9.2
PRR0 – Power Reduction Register 0
Bit
(0x64)
7
6
PRTIM2
R/W
0
5
PRTIM0
R/W
0
4
–
3
PRTIM1
R/W
0
2
PRSPI
R/W
0
1
PRUSART0
R/W
0
PRADC
R/W
0
PRTWI
PRR0
Read/Write
R/W
R
0
Initial Value
0
0
• Bit 7 - PRTWI: Power Reduction TWI
Writing a logic one to this bit shuts down the TWI by stopping the clock to the module. When
waking up the TWI again, the TWI should be re initialized to ensure proper operation.
• Bit 6 - PRTIM2: Power Reduction Timer/Counter2
Writing a logic one to this bit shuts down the Timer/Counter2 module in synchronous mode (AS2
is 0). When the Timer/Counter2 is enabled, operation will continue like before the shutdown.
56
ATmega640/1280/1281/2560/2561
2549L–AVR–08/07
ATmega640/1280/1281/2560/2561
• Bit 5 - PRTIM0: Power Reduction Timer/Counter0
Writing a logic one to this bit shuts down the Timer/Counter0 module. When the Timer/Counter0
is enabled, operation will continue like before the shutdown.
• Bit 4 - Res: Reserved bit
This bit is reserved bit and will always read as zero.
• Bit 3 - PRTIM1: Power Reduction Timer/Counter1
Writing a logic one to this bit shuts down the Timer/Counter1 module. When the Timer/Counter1
is enabled, operation will continue like before the shutdown.
• Bit 2 - PRSPI: Power Reduction Serial Peripheral Interface
Writing a logic one to this bit shuts down the Serial Peripheral Interface by stopping the clock to
the module. When waking up the SPI again, the SPI should be re initialized to ensure proper
operation.
• Bit 1 - PRUSART0: Power Reduction USART0
Writing a logic one to this bit shuts down the USART0 by stopping the clock to the module.
When waking up the USART0 again, the USART0 should be re initialized to ensure proper
operation.
• Bit 0 - PRADC: Power Reduction ADC
Writing a logic one to this bit shuts down the ADC. The ADC must be disabled before shut down.
The analog comparator cannot use the ADC input MUX when the ADC is shut down.
11.9.3
PRR1 – Power Reduction Register 1
Bit
(0x65)
7
6
5
PRTIM5
R/W
0
4
PRTIM4
R/W
0
3
PRTIM3
R/W
0
2
PRUSART3
R/W
1
PRUSART2
R/W
0
PRUSART1
R/W
–
–
PRR1
Read/Write
R
0
R
0
Initial Value
0
0
0
• Bit 7:6 - Res: Reserved bits
These bits are reserved and will always read as zero.
• Bit 5 - PRTIM5: Power Reduction Timer/Counter5
Writing a logic one to this bit shuts down the Timer/Counter5 module. When the Timer/Counter5
is enabled, operation will continue like before the shutdown.
• Bit 4 - PRTIM4: Power Reduction Timer/Counter4
Writing a logic one to this bit shuts down the Timer/Counter4 module. When the Timer/Counter4
is enabled, operation will continue like before the shutdown.
• Bit 3 - PRTIM3: Power Reduction Timer/Counter3
Writing a logic one to this bit shuts down the Timer/Counter3 module. When the Timer/Counter3
is enabled, operation will continue like before the shutdown.
57
2549L–AVR–08/07
• Bit 2 - PRUSART3: Power Reduction USART3
Writing a logic one to this bit shuts down the USART3 by stopping the clock to the module.
When waking up the USART3 again, the USART3 should be re initialized to ensure proper
operation.
• Bit 1 - PRUSART2: Power Reduction USART2
Writing a logic one to this bit shuts down the USART2 by stopping the clock to the module.
When waking up the USART2 again, the USART2 should be re initialized to ensure proper
operation.
• Bit 0 - PRUSART1: Power Reduction USART1
Writing a logic one to this bit shuts down the USART1 by stopping the clock to the module.
When waking up the USART1 again, the USART1 should be re initialized to ensure proper
operation.
58
ATmega640/1280/1281/2560/2561
2549L–AVR–08/07
ATmega640/1280/1281/2560/2561
12. System Control and Reset
12.1 Resetting the AVR
During reset, all I/O Registers are set to their initial values, and the program starts execution
from the Reset Vector. The instruction placed at the Reset Vector must be a JMP – Absolute
Jump – instruction to the reset handling routine. If the program never enables an interrupt
source, the Interrupt Vectors are not used, and regular program code can be placed at these
locations. This is also the case if the Reset Vector is in the Application section while the Interrupt
Vectors are in the Boot section or vice versa. The circuit diagram in Figure 12-1 shows the reset
logic. “System and Reset Characteristics” on page 375 defines the electrical parameters of the
reset circuitry.
The I/O ports of the AVR are immediately reset to their initial state when a reset source goes
active. This does not require any clock source to be running.
After all reset sources have gone inactive, a delay counter is invoked, stretching the internal
reset. This allows the power to reach a stable level before normal operation starts. The time-out
period of the delay counter is defined by the user through the SUT and CKSEL Fuses. The dif-
ferent selections for the delay period are presented in “Clock Sources” on page 40.
12.2 Reset Sources
The ATmega640/1280/1281/2560/2561 has five sources of reset:
•
Power-on Reset. The MCU is reset when the supply voltage is below the Power-on Reset
threshold (VPOT).
•
•
•
•
External Reset. The MCU is reset when a low level is present on the RESET pin for longer
than the minimum pulse length.
Watchdog Reset. The MCU is reset when the Watchdog Timer period expires and the
Watchdog is enabled.
Brown-out Reset. The MCU is reset when the supply voltage VCC is below the Brown-out
Reset threshold (VBOT) and the Brown-out Detector is enabled.
JTAG AVR Reset. The MCU is reset as long as there is a logic one in the Reset Register,
one of the scan chains of the JTAG system. Refer to the section “IEEE 1149.1 (JTAG)
Boundary-scan” on page 303 for details.
59
2549L–AVR–08/07
Figure 12-1. Reset Logic
DATA BUS
MCU Status
Register (MCUSR)
Power-on Reset
Circuit
Brown-out
Reset Circuit
BODLEVEL [2..0]
Pull-up Resistor
SPIKE
FILTER
JTAG Reset
Register
Watchdog
Oscillator
Delay Counters
Clock
CK
Generator
TIMEOUT
CKSEL[3:0]
SUT[1:0]
12.2.1
Power-on Reset
A Power-on Reset (POR) pulse is generated by an On-chip detection circuit. The detection level
is defined in “System and Reset Characteristics” on page 375. The POR is activated whenever
V
CC is below the detection level. The POR circuit can be used to trigger the start-up Reset, as
well as to detect a failure in supply voltage.
A Power-on Reset (POR) circuit ensures that the device is reset from Power-on. Reaching the
Power-on Reset threshold voltage invokes the delay counter, which determines how long the
device is kept in RESET after VCC rise. The RESET signal is activated again, without any delay,
when VCC decreases below the detection level.
Figure 12-2. MCU Start-up, RESET Tied to VCC
VPOT
VCC
VRST
RESET
tTOUT
TIME-OUT
INTERNAL
RESET
60
ATmega640/1280/1281/2560/2561
2549L–AVR–08/07
ATmega640/1280/1281/2560/2561
Figure 12-3. MCU Start-up, RESET Extended Externally
VPOT
VCC
VRST
RESET
tTOUT
TIME-OUT
INTERNAL
RESET
12.2.2
External Reset
An External Reset is generated by a low level on the RESET pin. Reset pulses longer than the
minimum pulse width (see “System and Reset Characteristics” on page 375) will generate a
reset, even if the clock is not running. Shorter pulses are not guaranteed to generate a reset.
When the applied signal reaches the Reset Threshold Voltage – VRST – on its positive edge, the
delay counter starts the MCU after the Time-out period – tTOUT – has expired.
Figure 12-4. External Reset During Operation
CC
12.2.3
Brown-out Detection
ATmega640/1280/1281/2560/2561 has an On-chip Brown-out Detection (BOD) circuit for moni-
toring the VCC level during operation by comparing it to a fixed trigger level. The trigger level for
the BOD can be selected by the BODLEVEL Fuses. The trigger level has a hysteresis to ensure
spike free Brown-out Detection. The hysteresis on the detection level should be interpreted as
V
BOT+ = VBOT + VHYST/2 and VBOT- = VBOT - VHYST/2.
When the BOD is enabled, and VCC decreases to a value below the trigger level (VBOT- in Figure
12-5), the Brown-out Reset is immediately activated. When VCC increases above the trigger
level (VBOT+ in Figure 12-5), the delay counter starts the MCU after the Time-out period tTOUT has
expired.
The BOD circuit will only detect a drop in VCC if the voltage stays below the trigger level for
longer than tBOD given in “System and Reset Characteristics” on page 375.
61
2549L–AVR–08/07
Figure 12-5. Brown-out Reset During Operation
VBOT+
VCC
VBOT-
RESET
t
TOUT
TIME-OUT
INTERNAL
RESET
12.2.4
Watchdog Reset
When the Watchdog times out, it will generate a short reset pulse of one CK cycle duration. On
the falling edge of this pulse, the delay timer starts counting the Time-out period tTOUT. See
“Watchdog Timer” on page 55. for details on operation of the Watchdog Timer.
Figure 12-6. Watchdog Reset During Operation
CC
CK
12.3 Internal Voltage Reference
ATmega640/1280/1281/2560/2561 features an internal bandgap reference. This reference is
used for Brown-out Detection, and it can be used as an input to the Analog Comparator or the
ADC.
12.3.1
Voltage Reference Enable Signals and Start-up Time
The voltage reference has a start-up time that may influence the way it should be used. The
start-up time is given in “System and Reset Characteristics” on page 375. To save power, the
reference is not always turned on. The reference is on during the following situations:
1. When the BOD is enabled (by programming the BODLEVEL [2:0] Fuse).
2. When the bandgap reference is connected to the Analog Comparator (by setting the
ACBG bit in ACSR).
3. When the ADC is enabled.
Thus, when the BOD is not enabled, after setting the ACBG bit or enabling the ADC, the user
must always allow the reference to start up before the output from the Analog Comparator or
62
ATmega640/1280/1281/2560/2561
2549L–AVR–08/07
ATmega640/1280/1281/2560/2561
ADC is used. To reduce power consumption in Power-down mode, the user can avoid the three
conditions above to ensure that the reference is turned off before entering Power-down mode
12.4 Watchdog Timer
12.4.1
Features
• Clocked from separate On-chip Oscillator
• 3 Operating modes
– Interrupt
– System Reset
– Interrupt and System Reset
• Selectable Time-out period from 16ms to 8s
• Possible Hardware fuse Watchdog always on (WDTON) for fail-safe mode
Figure 12-7. Watchdog Timer
128kHz
OSCILLATOR
WDP0
WDP1
WATCHDOG
WDP2
RESET
WDP3
WDE
MCU RESET
WDIF
INTERRUPT
WDIE
12.4.2
Overview
ATmega640/1280/1281/2560/2561 has an Enhanced Watchdog Timer (WDT). The WDT is a
timer counting cycles of a separate on-chip 128 kHz oscillator. The WDT gives an interrupt or a
system reset when the counter reaches a given time-out value. In normal operation mode, it is
required that the system uses the WDR - Watchdog Timer Reset - instruction to restart the
counter before the time-out value is reached. If the system doesn't restart the counter, an inter-
rupt or system reset will be issued.
In Interrupt mode, the WDT gives an interrupt when the timer expires. This interrupt can be used
to wake the device from sleep-modes, and also as a general system timer. One example is to
limit the maximum time allowed for certain operations, giving an interrupt when the operation
has run longer than expected. In System Reset mode, the WDT gives a reset when the timer
expires. This is typically used to prevent system hang-up in case of runaway code. The third
mode, Interrupt and System Reset mode, combines the other two modes by first giving an inter-
rupt and then switch to System Reset mode. This mode will for instance allow a safe shutdown
by saving critical parameters before a system reset.
The Watchdog always on (WDTON) fuse, if programmed, will force the Watchdog Timer to Sys-
tem Reset mode. With the fuse programmed the System Reset mode bit (WDE) and Interrupt
63
2549L–AVR–08/07
mode bit (WDIE) are locked to 1 and 0 respectively. To further ensure program security, alter-
ations to the Watchdog set-up must follow timed sequences. The sequence for clearing WDE
and changing time-out configuration is as follows:
1. In the same operation, write a logic one to the Watchdog change enable bit (WDCE) and
WDE. A logic one must be written to WDE regardless of the previous value of the WDE
bit.
2. Within the next four clock cycles, write the WDE and Watchdog prescaler bits (WDP) as
desired, but with the WDCE bit cleared. This must be done in one operation.
The following code example shows one assembly and one C function for turning off the Watch-
dog Timer. The example assumes that interrupts are controlled (e.g. by disabling interrupts
globally) so that no interrupts will occur during the execution of these functions.
64
ATmega640/1280/1281/2560/2561
2549L–AVR–08/07
ATmega640/1280/1281/2560/2561
Assembly Code Example(1)
WDT_off:
; Turn off global interrupt
cli
; Reset Watchdog Timer
wdr
; Clear WDRF in MCUSR
in
andi r16, (0xff & (0<<WDRF))
out MCUSR, r16
r16, MCUSR
; Write logical one to WDCE and WDE
; Keep old prescaler setting to prevent unintentional time-out
ldi r16, WDTCSR
ori
r16, (1<<WDCE) | (1<<WDE)
sts WDTCSR, r16
; Turn off WDT
ldi
r16, (0<<WDE)
sts WDTCSR, r16
; Turn on global interrupt
sei
ret
C Code Example(1)
void WDT_off(void)
{
__disable_interrupt();
__watchdog_reset();
/* Clear WDRF in MCUSR */
MCUSR &= ~(1<<WDRF);
/* Write logical one to WDCE and WDE */
/* Keep old prescaler setting to prevent unintentional time-out
*/
WDTCSR |= (1<<WDCE) | (1<<WDE);
/* Turn off WDT */
WDTCSR = 0x00;
__enable_interrupt();
}
Note:
1. The example code assumes that the part specific header file is included.
2. If the Watchdog is accidentally enabled, for example by a runaway pointer or brown-out condi-
tion, the device will be reset and the Watchdog Timer will stay enabled. If the code is not set up
to handle the Watchdog, this might lead to an eternal loop of time-out resets. To avoid this sit-
uation, the application software should always clear the Watchdog System Reset Flag
(WDRF) and the WDE control bit in the initialisation routine, even if the Watchdog is not in use.
The following code example shows one assembly and one C function for changing the time-out
value of the Watchdog Timer.
65
2549L–AVR–08/07
Assembly Code Example(1)
WDT_Prescaler_Change:
; Turn off global interrupt
cli
; Reset Watchdog Timer
wdr
; Start timed sequence
in
r16, WDTCSR
ori
out
r16, (1<<WDCE) | (1<<WDE)
WDTCSR, r16
; -- Got four cycles to set the new values from here -
; Set new prescaler(time-out) value = 64K cycles (~0.5 s)
ldi
out
r16, (1<<WDE) | (1<<WDP2) | (1<<WDP0)
WDTCSR, r16
; -- Finished setting new values, used 2 cycles -
; Turn on global interrupt
sei
ret
C Code Example(2)
void WDT_Prescaler_Change(void)
{
__disable_interrupt();
__watchdog_reset();
/* Start timed equence */
WDTCSR |= (1<<WDCE) | (1<<WDE);
/* Set new prescaler(time-out) value = 64K cycles (~0.5 s) */
WDTCSR = (1<<WDE) | (1<<WDP2) | (1<<WDP0);
__enable_interrupt();
}
Notes: 1. The example code assumes that the part specific header file is included.
2. Note: The Watchdog Timer should be reset before any change of the WDP bits, since a
change in the WDP bits can result in a time-out when switching to a shorter time-out period.
66
ATmega640/1280/1281/2560/2561
2549L–AVR–08/07
ATmega640/1280/1281/2560/2561
12.5 Register Description
12.5.1
MCUSR – MCU Status Register
The MCU Status Register provides information on which reset source caused an MCU reset.
Bit
7
–
6
–
5
–
4
3
2
1
0
0x35 (0x55)
Read/Write
Initial Value
JTRF
R/W
WDRF
R/W
BORF
R/W
EXTRF
R/W
PORF
R/W
MCUSR
R
0
R
0
R
0
See Bit Description
• Bit 4 – JTRF: JTAG Reset Flag
This bit is set if a reset is being caused by a logic one in the JTAG Reset Register selected by
the JTAG instruction AVR_RESET. This bit is reset by a Power-on Reset, or by writing a logic
zero to the flag.
• Bit 3 – WDRF: Watchdog Reset Flag
This bit is set if a Watchdog Reset occurs. The bit is reset by a Power-on Reset, or by writing a
logic zero to the flag.
• Bit 2 – BORF: Brown-out Reset Flag
This bit is set if a Brown-out Reset occurs. The bit is reset by a Power-on Reset, or by writing a
logic zero to the flag.
• Bit 1 – EXTRF: External Reset Flag
This bit is set if an External Reset occurs. The bit is reset by a Power-on Reset, or by writing a
logic zero to the flag.
• Bit 0 – PORF: Power-on Reset Flag
This bit is set if a Power-on Reset occurs. The bit is reset only by writing a logic zero to the flag.
To make use of the Reset Flags to identify a reset condition, the user should read and then
Reset the MCUSR as early as possible in the program. If the register is cleared before another
reset occurs, the source of the reset can be found by examining the Reset Flags.
12.5.2
WDTCSR – Watchdog Timer Control Register
Bit
(0x60)
7
6
5
4
WDCE
R/W
0
3
2
WDP2
R/W
0
1
WDP1
R/W
0
0
WDP0
R/W
0
WDIF
WDIE
WDP3
R/W
0
WDE
R/W
X
WDTCSR
Read/Write
R/W
R/W
Initial Value
0
0
• Bit 7 - WDIF: Watchdog Interrupt Flag
This bit is set when a time-out occurs in the Watchdog Timer and the Watchdog Timer is config-
ured for interrupt. WDIF is cleared by hardware when executing the corresponding interrupt
handling vector. Alternatively, WDIF is cleared by writing a logic one to the flag. When the I-bit in
SREG and WDIE are set, the Watchdog Time-out Interrupt is executed.
67
2549L–AVR–08/07
• Bit 6 - WDIE: Watchdog Interrupt Enable
When this bit is written to one and the I-bit in the Status Register is set, the Watchdog Interrupt is
enabled. If WDE is cleared in combination with this setting, the Watchdog Timer is in Interrupt
Mode, and the corresponding interrupt is executed if time-out in the Watchdog Timer occurs.
If WDE is set, the Watchdog Timer is in Interrupt and System Reset Mode. The first time-out in
the Watchdog Timer will set WDIF. Executing the corresponding interrupt vector will clear WDIE
and WDIF automatically by hardware (the Watchdog goes to System Reset Mode). This is use-
ful for keeping the Watchdog Timer security while using the interrupt. To stay in Interrupt and
System Reset Mode, WDIE must be set after each interrupt. This should however not be done
within the interrupt service routine itself, as this might compromise the safety-function of the
Watchdog System Reset mode. If the interrupt is not executed before the next time-out, a Sys-
tem Reset will be applied.
Table 12-1. Watchdog Timer Configuration
WDTON(1)
WDE
WDIE
Mode
Stopped
Action on Time-out
None
1
1
1
0
0
1
0
1
0
Interrupt Mode
System Reset Mode
Interrupt
Reset
Interrupt and System
Reset Mode
Interrupt, then go to
System Reset Mode
1
0
1
x
1
x
System Reset Mode
Reset
Note:
1. WDTON Fuse set to “0“ means programmed and “1” means unprogrammed.
• Bit 4 - WDCE: Watchdog Change Enable
This bit is used in timed sequences for changing WDE and prescaler bits. To clear the WDE bit,
and/or change the prescaler bits, WDCE must be set.
Once written to one, hardware will clear WDCE after four clock cycles.
• Bit 3 - WDE: Watchdog System Reset Enable
WDE is overridden by WDRF in MCUSR. This means that WDE is always set when WDRF is
set. To clear WDE, WDRF must be cleared first. This feature ensures multiple resets during con-
ditions causing failure, and a safe start-up after the failure.
• Bit 5, 2:0 - WDP3:0: Watchdog Timer Prescaler 3, 2, 1 and 0
The WDP3:0 bits determine the Watchdog Timer prescaling when the Watchdog Timer is run-
ning. The different prescaling values and their corresponding time-out periods are shown in
“System and Reset Characteristics” on page 375.
68
ATmega640/1280/1281/2560/2561
2549L–AVR–08/07
ATmega640/1280/1281/2560/2561
.
Table 12-2. Watchdog Timer Prescale Select
Number of WDT Oscillator
Typical Time-out at
VCC = 5.0V
WDP3 WDP2 WDP1 WDP0
Cycles
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
0
0
0
0
1
1
1
1
0
0
0
0
1
1
1
1
0
0
1
1
0
0
1
1
0
0
1
1
0
0
1
1
0
1
0
1
0
1
0
1
0
1
0
1
0
1
0
1
2K (2048) cycles
16 ms
32 ms
64 ms
0.125 s
0.25 s
0.5 s
4K (4096) cycles
8K (8192) cycles
16K (16384) cycles
32K (32768) cycles
64K (65536) cycles
128K (131072) cycles
256K (262144) cycles
512K (524288) cycles
1024K (1048576) cycles
1.0 s
2.0 s
4.0 s
8.0 s
Reserved
69
2549L–AVR–08/07
13. I/O-Ports
13.1 Introduction
All AVR ports have true Read-Modify-Write functionality when used as general digital I/O ports.
This means that the direction of one port pin can be changed without unintentionally changing
the direction of any other pin with the SBI and CBI instructions. The same applies when chang-
ing drive value (if configured as output) or enabling/disabling of pull-up resistors (if configured as
input). Each output buffer has symmetrical drive characteristics with both high sink and source
capability. The pin driver is strong enough to drive LED displays directly. All port pins have indi-
vidually selectable pull-up resistors with a supply-voltage invariant resistance. All I/O pins have
protection diodes to both VCC and Ground as indicated in Figure 13-1. Refer to “Electrical Char-
acteristics” on page 370 for a complete list of parameters.
Figure 13-1. I/O Pin Equivalent Schematic
Rpu
Pxn
Logic
Cpin
See Figure
"General Digital I/O" for
Details
All registers and bit references in this section are written in general form. A lower case “x” repre-
sents the numbering letter for the port, and a lower case “n” represents the bit number. However,
when using the register or bit defines in a program, the precise form must be used. For example,
PORTB3 for bit no. 3 in Port B, here documented generally as PORTxn. The physical I/O Regis-
ters and bit locations are listed in “Table 13-31 and Table 13-32 relates the alternate functions of
Port L to the overriding signals shown in Figure 13-5 on page 76.” on page 99.
Three I/O memory address locations are allocated for each port, one each for the Data Register
– PORTx, Data Direction Register – DDRx, and the Port Input Pins – PINx. The Port Input Pins
I/O location is read only, while the Data Register and the Data Direction Register are read/write.
However, writing a logic one to a bit in the PINx Register, will result in a toggle in the correspond-
ing bit in the Data Register. In addition, the Pull-up Disable – PUD bit in MCUCR disables the
pull-up function for all pins in all ports when set.
Using the I/O port as General Digital I/O is described in “Ports as General Digital I/O” on page
71. Most port pins are multiplexed with alternate functions for the peripheral features on the
device. How each alternate function interferes with the port pin is described in “Alternate Port
Functions” on page 75. Refer to the individual module sections for a full description of the alter-
nate functions.
70
ATmega640/1280/1281/2560/2561
2549L–AVR–08/07
ATmega640/1280/1281/2560/2561
Note that enabling the alternate function of some of the port pins does not affect the use of the
other pins in the port as general digital I/O.
13.2 Ports as General Digital I/O
The ports are bi-directional I/O ports with optional internal pull-ups. Figure 13-2 shows a func-
tional description of one I/O-port pin, here generically called Pxn.
Figure 13-2. General Digital I/O(1)
PUD
Q
D
DDxn
Q CLR
WDx
RDx
RESET
1
0
Q
D
Pxn
PORTxn
Q CLR
RESET
WPx
WRx
SLEEP
RRx
SYNCHRONIZER
RPx
D
Q
D
L
Q
Q
PINxn
Q
clk I/O
WDx:
RDx:
WRx:
RRx:
RPx:
WPx:
WRITE DDRx
READ DDRx
WRITE PORTx
PUD:
SLEEP:
clkI/O
PULLUP DISABLE
SLEEP CONTROL
I/O CLOCK
:
READ PORTx REGISTER
READ PORTx PIN
WRITE PINx REGISTER
Note:
1. WRx, WPx, WDx, RRx, RPx, and RDx are common to all pins within the same port. clkI/O
,
SLEEP, and PUD are common to all ports.
13.2.1
Configuring the Pin
Each port pin consists of three register bits: DDxn, PORTxn, and PINxn. As shown in “Table 13-
31 and Table 13-32 relates the alternate functions of Port L to the overriding signals shown in
Figure 13-5 on page 76.” on page 99, the DDxn bits are accessed at the DDRx I/O address, the
PORTxn bits at the PORTx I/O address, and the PINxn bits at the PINx I/O address.
The DDxn bit in the DDRx Register selects the direction of this pin. If DDxn is written logic one,
Pxn is configured as an output pin. If DDxn is written logic zero, Pxn is configured as an input
pin.
If PORTxn is written logic one when the pin is configured as an input pin, the pull-up resistor is
activated. To switch the pull-up resistor off, PORTxn has to be written logic zero or the pin has to
be configured as an output pin. The port pins are tri-stated when reset condition becomes active,
even if no clocks are running.
71
2549L–AVR–08/07
If PORTxn is written logic one when the pin is configured as an output pin, the port pin is driven
high (one). If PORTxn is written logic zero when the pin is configured as an output pin, the port
pin is driven low (zero).
13.2.2
13.2.3
Toggling the Pin
Writing a logic one to PINxn toggles the value of PORTxn, independent on the value of DDRxn.
Note that the SBI instruction can be used to toggle one single bit in a port.
Switching Between Input and Output
When switching between tri-state ({DDxn, PORTxn} = 0b00) and output high ({DDxn, PORTxn}
= 0b11), an intermediate state with either pull-up enabled {DDxn, PORTxn} = 0b01) or output
low ({DDxn, PORTxn} = 0b10) must occur. Normally, the pull-up enabled state is fully accept-
able, as a high-impedant environment will not notice the difference between a strong high driver
and a pull-up. If this is not the case, the PUD bit in the MCUCR Register can be set to disable all
pull-ups in all ports.
Switching between input with pull-up and output low generates the same problem. The user
must use either the tri-state ({DDxn, PORTxn} = 0b00) or the output high state ({DDxn, PORTxn}
= 0b11) as an intermediate step.
Table 13-1 summarizes the control signals for the pin value.
Table 13-1. Port Pin Configurations
I/O
Pull-up
No
Comment
Tri-state (Hi-Z)
0
0
0
1
1
0
1
1
0
1
X
0
Input
Input
Yes
No
Pxn will source current if ext. pulled low.
Tri-state (Hi-Z)
1
Input
X
X
Output
Output
No
Output Low (Sink)
No
Output High (Source)
13.2.4
Reading the Pin Value
Independent of the setting of Data Direction bit DDxn, the port pin can be read through the
PINxn Register bit. As shown in Figure 13-2, the PINxn Register bit and the preceding latch con-
stitute a synchronizer. This is needed to avoid metastability if the physical pin changes value
near the edge of the internal clock, but it also introduces a delay. Figure 13-3 shows a timing dia-
gram of the synchronization when reading an externally applied pin value. The maximum and
minimum propagation delays are denoted tpd,max and tpd,min respectively.
72
ATmega640/1280/1281/2560/2561
2549L–AVR–08/07
ATmega640/1280/1281/2560/2561
Figure 13-3. Synchronization when Reading an Externally Applied Pin value
SYSTEM CLK
INSTRUCTIONS
SYNC LATCH
PINxn
XXX
XXX
in r17, PINx
0x00
tpd, max
0xFF
r17
tpd, min
Consider the clock period starting shortly after the first falling edge of the system clock. The latch
is closed when the clock is low, and goes transparent when the clock is high, as indicated by the
shaded region of the “SYNC LATCH” signal. The signal value is latched when the system clock
goes low. It is clocked into the PINxn Register at the succeeding positive clock edge. As indi-
cated by the two arrows tpd,max and tpd,min, a single signal transition on the pin will be delayed
between ½ and 1½ system clock period depending upon the time of assertion.
When reading back a software assigned pin value, a nop instruction must be inserted as indi-
cated in Figure 13-4. The out instruction sets the “SYNC LATCH” signal at the positive edge of
the clock. In this case, the delay tpd through the synchronizer is 1 system clock period.
Figure 13-4. Synchronization when Reading a Software Assigned Pin Value
SYSTEM CLK
0xFF
r16
out PORTx, r16
nop
in r17, PINx
INSTRUCTIONS
SYNC LATCH
PINxn
0x00
tpd
0xFF
r17
73
2549L–AVR–08/07
The following code example shows how to set port B pins 0 and 1 high, 2 and 3 low, and define
the port pins from 4 to 7 as input with pull-ups assigned to port pins 6 and 7. The resulting pin
values are read back again, but as previously discussed, a nop instruction is included to be able
to read back the value recently assigned to some of the pins.
Assembly Code Example(1)
...
; Define pull-ups and set outputs high
; Define directions for port pins
ldi r16,(1<<PB7)|(1<<PB6)|(1<<PB1)|(1<<PB0)
ldi r17,(1<<DDB3)|(1<<DDB2)|(1<<DDB1)|(1<<DDB0)
out PORTB,r16
out DDRB,r17
; Insert nop for synchronization
nop
; Read port pins
in
r16,PINB
...
C Code Example
unsigned char i;
...
/* Define pull-ups and set outputs high */
/* Define directions for port pins */
PORTB = (1<<PB7)|(1<<PB6)|(1<<PB1)|(1<<PB0);
DDRB = (1<<DDB3)|(1<<DDB2)|(1<<DDB1)|(1<<DDB0);
/* Insert nop for synchronization*/
__no_operation();
/* Read port pins */
i = PINB;
...
Note:
1. For the assembly program, two temporary registers are used to minimize the time from pull-
ups are set on pins 0, 1, 6, and 7, until the direction bits are correctly set, defining bit 2 and 3
as low and redefining bits 0 and 1 as strong high drivers.
13.2.5
Digital Input Enable and Sleep Modes
As shown in Figure 13-2, the digital input signal can be clamped to ground at the input of the
schmitt-trigger. The signal denoted SLEEP in the figure, is set by the MCU Sleep Controller in
Power-down mode, Power-save mode, and Standby mode to avoid high power consumption if
some input signals are left floating, or have an analog signal level close to VCC/2.
SLEEP is overridden for port pins enabled as external interrupt pins. If the external interrupt
request is not enabled, SLEEP is active also for these pins. SLEEP is also overridden by various
other alternate functions as described in “Alternate Port Functions” on page 75.
If a logic high level (“one”) is present on an asynchronous external interrupt pin configured as
“Interrupt on Rising Edge, Falling Edge, or Any Logic Change on Pin” while the external interrupt
is not enabled, the corresponding External Interrupt Flag will be set when resuming from the
74
ATmega640/1280/1281/2560/2561
2549L–AVR–08/07
ATmega640/1280/1281/2560/2561
above mentioned Sleep mode, as the clamping in these sleep mode produces the requested
logic change.
13.2.6
Unconnected Pins
If some pins are unused, it is recommended to ensure that these pins have a defined level. Even
though most of the digital inputs are disabled in the deep sleep modes as described above, float-
ing inputs should be avoided to reduce current consumption in all other modes where the digital
inputs are enabled (Reset, Active mode and Idle mode).
The simplest method to ensure a defined level of an unused pin, is to enable the internal pull-up.
In this case, the pull-up will be disabled during reset. If low power consumption during reset is
important, it is recommended to use an external pull-up or pull-down. Connecting unused pins
directly to VCC or GND is not recommended, since this may cause excessive currents if the pin is
accidentally configured as an output.
13.3 Alternate Port Functions
Most port pins have alternate functions in addition to being general digital I/Os. Figure 13-5
shows how the port pin control signals from the simplified Figure 13-2 can be overridden by
alternate functions. The overriding signals may not be present in all port pins, but the figure
serves as a generic description applicable to all port pins in the AVR microcontroller family.
75
2549L–AVR–08/07
Figure 13-5. Alternate Port Functions(Note:)
PUOExn
PUOVxn
1
PUD
0
DDOExn
DDOVxn
1
Q
D
0
DDxn
Q CLR
WDx
RDx
PVOExn
PVOVxn
RESET
1
1
0
Pxn
Q
D
0
PORTxn
PTOExn
Q CLR
DIEOExn
WPx
DIEOVxn
RESET
WRx
1
RRx
0
SLEEP
SYNCHRONIZER
RPx
SET
D
Q
D
L
Q
Q
PINxn
CLR Q
CLR
clk I/O
DIxn
AIOxn
PUOExn: Pxn PULL-UP OVERRIDE ENABLE
PUOVxn: Pxn PULL-UP OVERRIDE VALUE
DDOExn: Pxn DATA DIRECTION OVERRIDE ENABLE
DDOVxn: Pxn DATA DIRECTION OVERRIDE VALUE
PVOExn: Pxn PORT VALUE OVERRIDE ENABLE
PVOVxn: Pxn PORT VALUE OVERRIDE VALUE
PUD:
WDx:
RDx:
RRx:
WRx:
RPx:
WPx:
PULLUP DISABLE
WRITE DDRx
READ DDRx
READ PORTx REGISTER
WRITE PORTx
READ PORTx PIN
WRITE PINx
DIEOExn: Pxn DIGITAL INPUT-ENABLE OVERRIDE ENABLE
DIEOVxn: Pxn DIGITAL INPUT-ENABLE OVERRIDE VALUE
clkI/O
:
I/O CLOCK
SLEEP:
SLEEP CONTROL
DIxn:
DIGITAL INPUT PIN n ON PORTx
AIOxn:
ANALOG INPUT/OUTPUT PIN n ON PORTx
PTOExn: Pxn, PORT TOGGLE OVERRIDE ENABLE
Note:
WRx, WPx, WDx, RRx, RPx, and RDx are common to all pins within the same port. clkI/O, SLEEP,
and PUD are common to all ports. All other signals are unique for each pin.
76
ATmega640/1280/1281/2560/2561
2549L–AVR–08/07
ATmega640/1280/1281/2560/2561
Table 13-2 summarizes the function of the overriding signals. The pin and port indexes from Fig-
ure 13-5 are not shown in the succeeding tables. The overriding signals are generated internally
in the modules having the alternate function.
Table 13-2. Generic Description of Overriding Signals for Alternate Functions
Signal Name
Full Name
Description
If this signal is set, the pull-up enable is controlled by the PUOV
signal. If this signal is cleared, the pull-up is enabled when
{DDxn, PORTxn, PUD} = 0b010.
Pull-up Override
Enable
PUOE
If PUOE is set, the pull-up is enabled/disabled when PUOV is
set/cleared, regardless of the setting of the DDxn, PORTxn,
and PUD Register bits.
Pull-up Override
Value
PUOV
DDOE
DDOV
If this signal is set, the Output Driver Enable is controlled by the
DDOV signal. If this signal is cleared, the Output driver is
enabled by the DDxn Register bit.
Data Direction
Override Enable
If DDOE is set, the Output Driver is enabled/disabled when
DDOV is set/cleared, regardless of the setting of the DDxn
Register bit.
Data Direction
Override Value
If this signal is set and the Output Driver is enabled, the port
value is controlled by the PVOV signal. If PVOE is cleared, and
the Output Driver is enabled, the port Value is controlled by the
PORTxn Register bit.
Port Value
Override Enable
PVOE
Port Value
Override Value
If PVOE is set, the port value is set to PVOV, regardless of the
setting of the PORTxn Register bit.
PVOV
PTOE
Port Toggle
Override Enable
If PTOE is set, the PORTxn Register bit is inverted.
Digital Input
Enable Override
Enable
If this bit is set, the Digital Input Enable is controlled by the
DIEOV signal. If this signal is cleared, the Digital Input Enable is
determined by MCU state (Normal mode, sleep mode).
DIEOE
DIEOV
Digital Input
Enable Override
Value
If DIEOE is set, the Digital Input is enabled/disabled when
DIEOV is set/cleared, regardless of the MCU state (Normal
mode, sleep mode).
This is the Digital Input to alternate functions. In the figure, the
signal is connected to the output of the schmitt trigger but
before the synchronizer. Unless the Digital Input is used as a
clock source, the module with the alternate function will use its
own synchronizer.
DI
Digital Input
This is the Analog Input/output to/from alternate functions. The
signal is connected directly to the pad, and can be used bi-
directionally.
Analog
Input/Output
AIO
The following subsections shortly describe the alternate functions for each port, and relate the
overriding signals to the alternate function. Refer to the alternate function description for further
details.
77
2549L–AVR–08/07
13.3.1
Alternate Functions of Port A
The Port A has an alternate function as the address low byte and data lines for the External
Memory Interface.
Table 13-3. Port A Pins Alternate Functions
Port Pin
Alternate Function
PA7
PA6
PA5
PA4
PA3
PA2
PA1
PA0
AD7 (External memory interface address and data bit 7)
AD6 (External memory interface address and data bit 6)
AD5 (External memory interface address and data bit 5)
AD4 (External memory interface address and data bit 4)
AD3 (External memory interface address and data bit 3)
AD2 (External memory interface address and data bit 2)
AD1 (External memory interface address and data bit 1)
AD0 (External memory interface address and data bit 0)
Table 13-4 and Table 13-5 relates the alternate functions of Port A to the overriding signals
shown in Figure 13-5 on page 76.
Table 13-4. Overriding Signals for Alternate Functions in PA7:PA4
Signal
Name
PA7/AD7
PA6/AD6
PA5/AD5
PA4/AD4
PUOE
SRE
SRE
SRE
SRE
~(WR | ADA(1)) •
PORTA7 • PUD
~(WR | ADA) •
PORTA6 • PUD
~(WR | ADA) •
PORTA5 • PUD
~(WR | ADA) •
PORTA4 • PUD
PUOV
DDOE
DDOV
PVOE
SRE
WR | ADA
SRE
SRE
WR | ADA
SRE
SRE
WR | ADA
SRE
SRE
WR | ADA
SRE
A7 • ADA | D7
OUTPUT • WR
A6 • ADA | D6
OUTPUT • WR
A5 • ADA | D5
OUTPUT • WR
A4 • ADA | D4
OUTPUT • WR
PVOV
DIEOE
DIEOV
DI
0
0
0
0
0
D7 INPUT
–
0
D6 INPUT
–
0
D5 INPUT
–
0
D4 INPUT
–
AIO
Note:
1. ADA is short for ADdress Active and represents the time when address is output. See “Exter-
nal Memory Interface” on page 27 for details.
78
ATmega640/1280/1281/2560/2561
2549L–AVR–08/07
ATmega640/1280/1281/2560/2561
Table 13-5. Overriding Signals for Alternate Functions in PA3:PA0
Signal
Name
PA3/AD3
PA2/AD2
PA1/AD1
PA0/AD0
PUOE
PUOV
SRE
SRE
SRE
SRE
~(WR | ADA) •
PORTA3 • PUD
~(WR | ADA) •
PORTA2 • PUD
~(WR | ADA) •
PORTA1 • PUD
~(WR | ADA) •
PORTA0 • PUD
DDOE
DDOV
PVOE
SRE
WR | ADA
SRE
SRE
WR | ADA
SRE
SRE
WR | ADA
SRE
SRE
WR | ADA
SRE
A3 • ADA | D3
OUTPUT • WR
A2• ADA | D2
OUTPUT • WR
A1 • ADA | D1
OUTPUT • WR
A0 • ADA | D0
OUTPUT • WR
PVOV
DIEOE
DIEOV
DI
0
0
0
0
0
D3 INPUT
–
0
D2 INPUT
–
0
D1 INPUT
–
0
D0 INPUT
–
AIO
13.3.2
Alternate Functions of Port B
The Port B pins with alternate functions are shown in Table 13-6.
Table 13-6. Port B Pins Alternate Functions
Port Pin
Alternate Functions
OC0A/OC1C/PCINT7 (Output Compare and PWM Output A for Timer/Counter0, Output
Compare and PWM Output C for Timer/Counter1 or Pin Change Interrupt 7)
PB7
OC1B/PCINT6 (Output Compare and PWM Output B for Timer/Counter1 or Pin Change
PB6
PB5
PB4
Interrupt 6)
OC1A/PCINT5 (Output Compare and PWM Output A for Timer/Counter1 or Pin Change
Interrupt 5)
OC2A/PCINT4 (Output Compare and PWM Output A for Timer/Counter2 or Pin Change
Interrupt 4)
PB3
PB2
PB1
PB0
MISO/PCINT3 (SPI Bus Master Input/Slave Output or Pin Change Interrupt 3)
MOSI/PCINT2 (SPI Bus Master Output/Slave Input or Pin Change Interrupt 2)
SCK/PCINT1 (SPI Bus Serial Clock or Pin Change Interrupt 1)
SS/PCINT0 (SPI Slave Select input or Pin Change Interrupt 0)
The alternate pin configuration is as follows:
• OC0A/OC1C/PCINT7, Bit 7
OC0A, Output Compare Match A output: The PB7 pin can serve as an external output for the
Timer/Counter0 Output Compare. The pin has to be configured as an output (DDB7 set “one”) to
serve this function. The OC0A pin is also the output pin for the PWM mode timer function.
OC1C, Output Compare Match C output: The PB7 pin can serve as an external output for the
Timer/Counter1 Output Compare C. The pin has to be configured as an output (DDB7 set (one))
to serve this function. The OC1C pin is also the output pin for the PWM mode timer function.
79
2549L–AVR–08/07
PCINT7, Pin Change Interrupt source 7: The PB7 pin can serve as an external interrupt source.
• OC1B/PCINT6, Bit 6
OC1B, Output Compare Match B output: The PB6 pin can serve as an external output for the
Timer/Counter1 Output Compare B. The pin has to be configured as an output (DDB6 set (one))
to serve this function. The OC1B pin is also the output pin for the PWM mode timer function.
PCINT6, Pin Change Interrupt source 6: The PB6 pin can serve as an external interrupt source.
• OC1A/PCINT5, Bit 5
OC1A, Output Compare Match A output: The PB5 pin can serve as an external output for the
Timer/Counter1 Output Compare A. The pin has to be configured as an output (DDB5 set (one))
to serve this function. The OC1A pin is also the output pin for the PWM mode timer function.
PCINT5, Pin Change Interrupt source 5: The PB5 pin can serve as an external interrupt source.
• OC2A/PCINT4, Bit 4
OC2A, Output Compare Match output: The PB4 pin can serve as an external output for the
Timer/Counter2 Output Compare. The pin has to be configured as an output (DDB4 set (one)) to
serve this function. The OC2A pin is also the output pin for the PWM mode timer function.
PCINT4, Pin Change Interrupt source 4: The PB4 pin can serve as an external interrupt source.
• MISO/PCINT3 – Port B, Bit 3
MISO: Master Data input, Slave Data output pin for SPI channel. When the SPI is enabled as a
master, this pin is configured as an input regardless of the setting of DDB3. When the SPI is
enabled as a slave, the data direction of this pin is controlled by DDB3. When the pin is forced to
be an input, the pull-up can still be controlled by the PORTB3 bit.
PCINT3, Pin Change Interrupt source 3: The PB3 pin can serve as an external interrupt source.
• MOSI/PCINT2 – Port B, Bit 2
MOSI: SPI Master Data output, Slave Data input for SPI channel. When the SPI is enabled as a
slave, this pin is configured as an input regardless of the setting of DDB2. When the SPI is
enabled as a master, the data direction of this pin is controlled by DDB2. When the pin is forced
to be an input, the pull-up can still be controlled by the PORTB2 bit.
PCINT2, Pin Change Interrupt source 2: The PB2 pin can serve as an external interrupt source.
• SCK/PCINT1 – Port B, Bit 1
SCK: Master Clock output, Slave Clock input pin for SPI channel. When the SPI is enabled as a
slave, this pin is configured as an input regardless of the setting of DDB1. When the SPI0 is
enabled as a master, the data direction of this pin is controlled by DDB1. When the pin is forced
to be an input, the pull-up can still be controlled by the PORTB1 bit.
PCINT1, Pin Change Interrupt source 1: The PB1 pin can serve as an external interrupt source.
• SS/PCINT0 – Port B, Bit 0
SS: Slave Port Select input. When the SPI is enabled as a slave, this pin is configured as an
input regardless of the setting of DDB0. As a slave, the SPI is activated when this pin is driven
low. When the SPI is enabled as a master, the data direction of this pin is controlled by DDB0.
When the pin is forced to be an input, the pull-up can still be controlled by the PORTB0 bit.
80
ATmega640/1280/1281/2560/2561
2549L–AVR–08/07
ATmega640/1280/1281/2560/2561
Table 13-7 and Table 13-8 relate the alternate functions of Port B to the overriding signals
shown in Figure 13-5 on page 76. SPI MSTR INPUT and SPI SLAVE OUTPUT constitute the
MISO signal, while MOSI is divided into SPI MSTR OUTPUT and SPI SLAVE INPUT.
PCINT0, Pin Change Interrupt source 0: The PB0 pin can serve as an external interrupt source.
Table 13-7. Overriding Signals for Alternate Functions in PB7:PB4
Signal
Name
PUOE
PUOV
DDOE
DDOV
PVOE
PVOV
DIEOE
DIEOV
DI
PB7/OC0A/OC1C
PB6/OC1B
PB5/OC1A
PB4/OC2A
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
OC0/OC1C ENABLE
OC0/OC1C
PCINT7 • PCIE0
1
0
0
0
OC1B ENABLE
OC1A ENABLE
OC2A ENABLE
OC1B
OC1A
OC2A
PCINT6 • PCIE0
PCINT5 • PCIE0
PCINT4 • PCIE0
1
1
1
PCINT7 INPUT
–
PCINT6 INPUT
PCINT5 INPUT
PCINT4 INPUT
AIO
–
–
–
Table 13-8. Overriding Signals for Alternate Functions in PB3:PB0
Signal
Name
PUOE
PUOV
DDOE
DDOV
PVOE
PVOV
DIEOE
DIEOV
PB3/MISO
SPE • MSTR
PORTB3 • PUD
SPE • MSTR
0
PB2/MOSI
SPE • MSTR
PORTB2 • PUD
SPE • MSTR
0
PB1/SCK
SPE • MSTR
PORTB1 • PUD
SPE • MSTR
0
PB0/SS
SPE • MSTR
PORTB0 • PUD
SPE • MSTR
0
SPE • MSTR
SPI SLAVE OUTPUT
PCINT3 • PCIE0
1
SPE • MSTR
SPI MSTR OUTPUT
PCINT2 • PCIE0
1
SPE • MSTR
SCK OUTPUT
PCINT1 • PCIE0
1
0
0
PCINT0 • PCIE0
1
SPI MSTR INPUT
PCINT3 INPUT
SPI SLAVE INPUT
PCINT2 INPUT
SCK INPUT
SPI SS
DI
PCINT1 INPUT
PCINT0 INPUT
AIO
–
–
–
–
81
2549L–AVR–08/07
13.3.3
Alternate Functions of Port C
The Port C alternate function is as follows:
Table 13-9. Port C Pins Alternate Functions
Port Pin
Alternate Function
PC7
PC6
PC5
PC4
PC3
PC2
PC1
PC0
A15(External Memory interface address bit 15)
A14(External Memory interface address bit 14)
A13(External Memory interface address bit 13)
A12(External Memory interface address bit 12)
A11(External Memory interface address bit 11)
A10(External Memory interface address bit 10)
A9(External Memory interface address bit 9)
A8(External Memory interface address bit 8)
Table 13-10 and Table 13-11 relate the alternate functions of Port C to the overriding signals
shown in Figure 13-5 on page 76.
Table 13-10. Overriding Signals for Alternate Functions in PC7:PC4
Signal
Name
PUOE
PUOV
DDOE
DDOV
PVOE
PVOV
DIEOE
DIEOV
DI
PC7/A15
PC6/A14
PC5/A13
PC4/A12
SRE • (XMM<1)
SRE • (XMM<2)
SRE • (XMM<3)
SRE • (XMM<4)
0
0
0
0
SRE • (XMM<1)
SRE • (XMM<2)
SRE • (XMM<3)
SRE • (XMM<4)
1
1
1
1
SRE • (XMM<1)
SRE • (XMM<2)
SRE • (XMM<3)
SRE • (XMM<4)
A15
0
A14
0
A13
0
A12
0
0
0
0
0
–
–
–
–
AIO
–
–
–
–
82
ATmega640/1280/1281/2560/2561
2549L–AVR–08/07
ATmega640/1280/1281/2560/2561
Table 13-11. Overriding Signals for Alternate Functions in PC3:PC0
Signal
Name
PC3/A11
PC2/A10
PC1/A9
PC0/A8
PUOE
PUOV
DDOE
DDOV
PVOE
PVOV
DIEOE
DIEOV
DI
SRE • (XMM<5)
SRE • (XMM<6)
SRE • (XMM<7)
SRE • (XMM<7)
0
0
0
0
SRE • (XMM<5)
SRE • (XMM<6)
SRE • (XMM<7)
SRE • (XMM<7)
1
1
1
1
SRE • (XMM<5)
SRE • (XMM<6)
SRE • (XMM<7)
SRE • (XMM<7)
A11
0
A10
0
A9
0
A8
0
0
0
0
0
–
–
–
–
AIO
–
–
–
–
13.3.4
Alternate Functions of Port D
The Port D pins with alternate functions are shown in Table 1.
Table 1. Port D Pins Alternate Functions
Port Pin
PD7
Alternate Function
T0 (Timer/Counter0 Clock Input)
PD6
T1 (Timer/Counter1 Clock Input)
PD5
XCK1 (USART1 External Clock Input/Output)
ICP1 (Timer/Counter1 Input Capture Trigger)
PD4
PD3
INT3/TXD1 (External Interrupt3 Input or USART1 Transmit Pin)
INT2/RXD1 (External Interrupt2 Input or USART1 Receive Pin)
INT1/SDA (External Interrupt1 Input or TWI Serial DAta)
INT0/SCL (External Interrupt0 Input or TWI Serial CLock)
PD2
PD1
PD0
The alternate pin configuration is as follows:
• T0 – Port D, Bit 7
T0, Timer/Counter0 counter source.
• T1 – Port D, Bit 6
T1, Timer/Counter1 counter source.
• XCK1 – Port D, Bit 5
XCK1, USART1 External clock. The Data Direction Register (DDD5) controls whether the clock
is output (DDD5 set) or input (DDD5 cleared). The XCK1 pin is active only when the USART1
operates in Synchronous mode.
• ICP1 – Port D, Bit 4
ICP1 – Input Capture Pin 1: The PD4 pin can act as an input capture pin for Timer/Counter1.
83
2549L–AVR–08/07
• INT3/TXD1 – Port D, Bit 3
INT3, External Interrupt source 3: The PD3 pin can serve as an external interrupt source to the
MCU.
TXD1, Transmit Data (Data output pin for the USART1). When the USART1 Transmitter is
enabled, this pin is configured as an output regardless of the value of DDD3.
• INT2/RXD1 – Port D, Bit 2
INT2, External Interrupt source 2. The PD2 pin can serve as an External Interrupt source to the
MCU.
RXD1, Receive Data (Data input pin for the USART1). When the USART1 receiver is enabled
this pin is configured as an input regardless of the value of DDD2. When the USART forces this
pin to be an input, the pull-up can still be controlled by the PORTD2 bit.
• INT1/SDA – Port D, Bit 1
INT1, External Interrupt source 1. The PD1 pin can serve as an external interrupt source to the
MCU.
SDA, 2-wire Serial Interface Data: When the TWEN bit in TWCR is set (one) to enable the 2-wire
Serial Interface, pin PD1 is disconnected from the port and becomes the Serial Data I/O pin for
the 2-wire Serial Interface. In this mode, there is a spike filter on the pin to suppress spikes
shorter than 50 ns on the input signal, and the pin is driven by an open drain driver with slew-
rate limitation.
• INT0/SCL – Port D, Bit 0
INT0, External Interrupt source 0. The PD0 pin can serve as an external interrupt source to the
MCU.
SCL, 2-wire Serial Interface Clock: When the TWEN bit in TWCR is set (one) to enable the 2-
wire Serial Interface, pin PD0 is disconnected from the port and becomes the Serial Clock I/O
pin for the 2-wire Serial Interface. In this mode, there is a spike filter on the pin to suppress
spikes shorter than 50 ns on the input signal, and the pin is driven by an open drain driver with
slew-rate limitation.
Table 13-12 and Table 13-13 relates the alternate functions of Port D to the overriding signals
shown in Figure 13-5 on page 76.
84
ATmega640/1280/1281/2560/2561
2549L–AVR–08/07
ATmega640/1280/1281/2560/2561
Table 13-12. Overriding Signals for Alternate Functions PD7:PD4
Signal Name
PUOE
PUOV
DDOE
DDOV
PVOE
PVOV
DIEOE
DIEOV
DI
PD7/T0
PD6/T1
PD5/XCK1
PD4/ICP1
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
XCK1 OUTPUT ENABLE
0
0
0
1
0
0
0
XCK1 OUTPUT ENABLE
0
0
0
XCK1 OUTPUT
0
0
0
0
0
0
T0 INPUT
–
0
T1 INPUT
–
0
0
XCK1 INPUT
ICP1 INPUT
AIO
–
–
Table 13-13. Overriding Signals for Alternate Functions in PD3:PD0(1)
Signal Name
PUOE
PUOV
DDOE
DDOV
PVOE
PVOV
DIEOE
DIEOV
DI
PD3/INT3/TXD1
PD2/INT2/RXD1
PD1/INT1/SDA
TWEN
PD0/INT0/SCL
TWEN
TXEN1
RXEN1
0
PORTD2 • PUD
PORTD1 • PUD
TWEN
PORTD0 • PUD
TWEN
TXEN1
RXEN1
1
TXEN1
TXD1
0
SDA_OUT
TWEN
SCL_OUT
TWEN
0
0
0
0
INT3 ENABLE
1
INT2 ENABLE
INT1 ENABLE
1
INT0 ENABLE
1
1
INT3 INPUT
–
INT2 INPUT/RXD1
INT1 INPUT
SDA INPUT
INT0 INPUT
SCL INPUT
AIO
–
Note:
1. When enabled, the 2-wire Serial Interface enables Slew-Rate controls on the output pins PD0
and PD1. This is not shown in this table. In addition, spike filters are connected between the
AIO outputs shown in the port figure and the digital logic of the TWI module.
85
2549L–AVR–08/07
13.3.5
Alternate Functions of Port E
The Port E pins with alternate functions are shown in Table 13-14.
Table 13-14. Port E Pins Alternate Functions
Port Pin
Alternate Function
INT7/ICP3/CLK0 (External Interrupt 7 Input, Timer/Counter3 Input Capture Trigger or
PE7
Divided System Clock)
PE6
INT6/ T3 (External Interrupt 6 Input or Timer/Counter3 Clock Input)
INT5/OC3C (External Interrupt 5 Input or Output Compare and PWM Output C for
PE5
Timer/Counter3)
INT4/OC3B (External Interrupt4 Input or Output Compare and PWM Output B for
PE4
PE3
Timer/Counter3)
AIN1/OC3A (Analog Comparator Negative Input or Output Compare and PWM Output A for
Timer/Counter3)
PE2
PE1
AIN0/XCK0 (Analog Comparator Positive Input or USART0 external clock input/output)
PDO(1)/TXD0 (Programming Data Output or USART0 Transmit Pin)
PDI(1)/RXD0/PCINT8 (Programming Data Input, USART0 Receive Pin or Pin Change
PE0
Interrupt 8)
Note:
1. Only for ATmega1281/2561. For ATmega640/1280/2560 these functions are placed on
MISO/MOSI pins.
• INT7/ICP3/CLKO – Port E, Bit 7
INT7, External Interrupt source 7: The PE7 pin can serve as an external interrupt source.
ICP3, Input Capture Pin 3: The PE7 pin can act as an input capture pin for Timer/Counter3.
CLKO - Divided System Clock: The divided system clock can be output on the PE7 pin. The
divided system clock will be output if the CKOUT Fuse is programmed, regardless of the
PORTE7 and DDE7 settings. It will also be output during reset.
• INT6/T3 – Port E, Bit 6
INT6, External Interrupt source 6: The PE6 pin can serve as an external interrupt source.
T3, Timer/Counter3 counter source.
• INT5/OC3C – Port E, Bit 5
INT5, External Interrupt source 5: The PE5 pin can serve as an External Interrupt source.
OC3C, Output Compare Match C output: The PE5 pin can serve as an External output for the
Timer/Counter3 Output Compare C. The pin has to be configured as an output (DDE5 set “one”)
to serve this function. The OC3C pin is also the output pin for the PWM mode timer function.
• INT4/OC3B – Port E, Bit 4
INT4, External Interrupt source 4: The PE4 pin can serve as an External Interrupt source.
OC3B, Output Compare Match B output: The PE4 pin can serve as an External output for the
Timer/Counter3 Output Compare B. The pin has to be configured as an output (DDE4 set (one))
to serve this function. The OC3B pin is also the output pin for the PWM mode timer function.
86
ATmega640/1280/1281/2560/2561
2549L–AVR–08/07
ATmega640/1280/1281/2560/2561
• AIN1/OC3A – Port E, Bit 3
AIN1 – Analog Comparator Negative input. This pin is directly connected to the negative input of
the Analog Comparator.
OC3A, Output Compare Match A output: The PE3 pin can serve as an External output for the
Timer/Counter3 Output Compare A. The pin has to be configured as an output (DDE3 set “one”)
to serve this function. The OC3A pin is also the output pin for the PWM mode timer function.
• AIN0/XCK0 – Port E, Bit 2
AIN0 – Analog Comparator Positive input. This pin is directly connected to the positive input of
the Analog Comparator.
XCK0, USART0 External clock. The Data Direction Register (DDE2) controls whether the clock
is output (DDE2 set) or input (DDE2 cleared). The XCK0 pin is active only when the USART0
operates in Synchronous mode.
• PDO/TXD0 – Port E, Bit 1
PDO, SPI Serial Programming Data Output. During Serial Program Downloading, this pin is
used as data output line for the ATmega1281/2561. For ATmega640/1280/2560 this function is
placed on MISO.
TXD0, USART0 Transmit pin.
• PDI/RXD0/PCINT8 – Port E, Bit 0
PDI, SPI Serial Programming Data Input. During Serial Program Downloading, this pin is used
as data input line for the ATmega1281/2561. For ATmega640/1280/2560 this function is placed
on MOSI.
RXD0, USART0 Receive Pin. Receive Data (Data input pin for the USART0). When the
USART0 receiver is enabled this pin is configured as an input regardless of the value of DDRE0.
When the USART0 forces this pin to be an input, a logical one in PORTE0 will turn on the inter-
nal pull-up.
PCINT8, Pin Change Interrupt source 8: The PE0 pin can serve as an external interrupt source.
Table 13-15 and Table 13-16 relates the alternate functions of Port E to the overriding signals
shown in Figure 13-5 on page 76.
87
2549L–AVR–08/07
Table 13-15. Overriding Signals for Alternate Functions PE7:PE4
Signal
Name
PUOE
PUOV
DDOE
DDOV
PVOE
PVOV
DIEOE
DIEOV
PE7/INT7/ICP3
PE6/INT6/T3
PE5/INT5/OC3C
PE4/INT4/OC3B
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
OC3C ENABLE
OC3C
0
OC3B ENABLE
OC3B
0
0
0
0
INT7 ENABLE
INT6 ENABLE
INT5 ENABLE
1
INT4 ENABLE
1
1
1
INT7 INPUT/ICP3
INPUT
INT7 INPUT/T3
INPUT
DI
INT5 INPUT
INT4 INPUT
AIO
–
–
–
–
Table 13-16. Overriding Signals for Alternate Functions in PE3:PE0
Signal
Name
PE1/PDO(1)/
TXD0
PE0/PDI(1)/
RXD0/PCINT8
PE3/AIN1/OC3A
PE2/AIN0/XCK0
PUOE
PUOV
0
0
0
0
TXEN0
RXEN0
0
PORTE0 • PUD
XCK0 OUTPUT
DDOE
DDOV
PVOE
0
TXEN0
1
RXEN0
ENABLE
0
1
0
0
XCK0 OUTPUT
OC3B ENABLE
TXEN0
ENABLE
PVOV
DIEOE
DIEOV
DI
OC3B
XCK0 OUTPUT
TXD0
0
0
0
0
0
–
0
–
PCINT8 • PCIE1
0
0
1
0
XCK0 INPUT
0
RXD0
PCINT8 INPUT
–
PE0
0
AIO
AIN1 INPUT
AIN0 INPUT
Note:
1. PDO/PDI only available at PE1/PE0 for ATmega1281/2561.
88
ATmega640/1280/1281/2560/2561
2549L–AVR–08/07
ATmega640/1280/1281/2560/2561
13.3.6
Alternate Functions of Port F
The Port F has an alternate function as analog input for the ADC as shown in Table 13-17. If
some Port F pins are configured as outputs, it is essential that these do not switch when a con-
version is in progress. This might corrupt the result of the conversion. If the JTAG interface is
enabled, the pull-up resistors on pins PF7(TDI), PF5(TMS), and PF4(TCK) will be activated even
if a Reset occurs.
Table 13-17. Port F Pins Alternate Functions
Port Pin
PF7
Alternate Function
ADC7/TDI (ADC input channel 7 or JTAG Test Data Input)
ADC6/TDO (ADC input channel 6 or JTAG Test Data Output)
ADC5/TMS (ADC input channel 5 or JTAG Test Mode Select)
ADC4/TCK (ADC input channel 4 or JTAG Test ClocK)
ADC3 (ADC input channel 3)
PF6
PF5
PF4
PF3
PF2
ADC2 (ADC input channel 2)
PF1
ADC1 (ADC input channel 1)
PF0
ADC0 (ADC input channel 0)
• TDI, ADC7 – Port F, Bit 7
ADC7, Analog to Digital Converter, Channel 7.
TDI, JTAG Test Data In: Serial input data to be shifted in to the Instruction Register or Data Reg-
ister (scan chains). When the JTAG interface is enabled, this pin can not be used as an I/O pin.
• TDO, ADC6 – Port F, Bit 6
ADC6, Analog to Digital Converter, Channel 6.
TDO, JTAG Test Data Out: Serial output data from Instruction Register or Data Register. When
the JTAG interface is enabled, this pin can not be used as an I/O pin.
The TDO pin is tri-stated unless TAP states that shift out data are entered.
• TMS, ADC5 – Port F, Bit 5
ADC5, Analog to Digital Converter, Channel 5.
TMS, JTAG Test Mode Select: This pin is used for navigating through the TAP-controller state
machine. When the JTAG interface is enabled, this pin can not be used as an I/O pin.
• TCK, ADC4 – Port F, Bit 4
ADC4, Analog to Digital Converter, Channel 4.
TCK, JTAG Test Clock: JTAG operation is synchronous to TCK. When the JTAG interface is
enabled, this pin can not be used as an I/O pin.
• ADC3 – ADC0 – Port F, Bit 3:0
89
2549L–AVR–08/07
Analog to Digital Converter, Channel 3:0.
Table 13-18. Overriding Signals for Alternate Functions in PF7:PF4
Signal
Name
PUOE
PUOV
DDOE
PF7/ADC7/TDI
JTAGEN
1
PF6/ADC6/TDO
JTAGEN
0
PF5/ADC5/TMS
JTAGEN
1
PF4/ADC4/TCK
JTAGEN
1
JTAGEN
JTAGEN
JTAGEN
JTAGEN
SHIFT_IR +
SHIFT_DR
DDOV
0
0
0
PVOE
PVOV
DIEOE
DIEOV
DI
0
JTAGEN
0
0
0
TDO
0
0
JTAGEN
JTAGEN
JTAGEN
JTAGEN
0
0
0
0
–
–
–
–
AIO
TDI/ADC7 INPUT
ADC6 INPUT
TMS/ADC5 INPUT
TCK/ADC4 INPUT
Table 13-19. Overriding Signals for Alternate Functions in PF3:PF0
Signal Name
PUOE
PUOV
DDOE
DDOV
PVOE
PVOV
DIEOE
DIEOV
DI
PF3/ADC3
PF2/ADC2
PF1/ADC1
PF0/ADC0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
–
–
–
–
AIO
ADC3 INPUT
ADC2 INPUT
ADC1 INPUT
ADC0 INPUT
13.3.7
Alternate Functions of Port G
The Port G alternate pin configuration is as follows:
Table 13-20. Port G Pins Alternate Functions
Port Pin
PG5
Alternate Function
OC0B (Output Compare and PWM Output B for Timer/Counter0)
TOSC1 (RTC Oscillator Timer/Counter2)
PG4
PG3
TOSC2 (RTC Oscillator Timer/Counter2)
PG2
ALE (Address Latch Enable to external memory)
RD (Read strobe to external memory)
PG1
PG0
WR (Write strobe to external memory)
90
ATmega640/1280/1281/2560/2561
2549L–AVR–08/07
ATmega640/1280/1281/2560/2561
• OC0B – Port G, Bit 5
OC0B, Output Compare match B output: The PG5 pin can serve as an external output for the
TImer/Counter0 Output Compare. The pin has to be configured as an output (DDG5 set) to
serve this function. The OC0B pin is also the output pin for the PWM mode timer function.
• TOSC1 – Port G, Bit 4
TOSC2, Timer Oscillator pin 1: When the AS2 bit in ASSR is set (one) to enable asynchronous
clocking of Timer/Counter2, pin PG4 is disconnected from the port, and becomes the input of the
inverting Oscillator amplifier. In this mode, a Crystal Oscillator is connected to this pin, and the
pin can not be used as an I/O pin.
• TOSC2 – Port G, Bit 3
TOSC2, Timer Oscillator pin 2: When the AS2 bit in ASSR is set (one) to enable asynchronous
clocking of Timer/Counter2, pin PG3 is disconnected from the port, and becomes the inverting
output of the Oscillator amplifier. In this mode, a Crystal Oscillator is connected to this pin, and
the pin can not be used as an I/O pin.
• ALE – Port G, Bit 2
ALE is the external data memory Address Latch Enable signal.
• RD – Port G, Bit 1
RD is the external data memory read control strobe.
• WR – Port G, Bit 0
WR is the external data memory write control strobe.
Table 13-21 and Table 13-22 relates the alternate functions of Port G to the overriding signals
shown in Figure 13-5 on page 76.
91
2549L–AVR–08/07
Table 13-21. Overriding Signals for Alternate Functions in PG5:PG4
Signal Name
PUOE
PUOV
DDOE
DDOV
PVOE
PVOV
PTOE
DIEOE
DIEOV
DI
—
–
–
–
–
–
–
–
–
–
–
–
—
–
–
–
–
–
–
–
–
–
–
–
PG5/OC0B
PG4/TOSC1
–
AS2
–
0
–
AS2
–
0
OC0B Enable
0
OC0B
0
–
–
–
–
–
–
AS2
EXCLK
–
AIO
T/C2 OSC INPUT
Table 13-22. Overriding Signals for Alternate Functions in PG3:PG0
Signal Name
PUOE
PUOV
DDOE
DDOV
PVOE
PVOV
PTOE
DIEOE
DIEOV
DI
PG3/TOSC2
PG2/ALE/A7
PG1/RD
PG0/WR
AS2 • EXCLK
SRE
0
SRE
0
SRE
0
0
AS2 • EXCLK
SRE
1
SRE
1
SRE
1
0
0
SRE
ALE
–
SRE
RD
–
SRE
WR
–
0
–
AS2 • EXCLK
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
–
–
–
–
AIO
T/C2 OSC OUTPUT
–
–
–
13.3.8
Alternate Functions of Port H
The Port H alternate pin configuration is as follows:
Table 13-23. Port H Pins Alternate Functions
Port Pin
PH7
Alternate Function
T4 (Timer/Counter4 Clock Input)
PH6
OC2B(Output Compare and PWM Output B for Timer/Counter2)
OC4C(Output Compare and PWM Output C for Timer/Counter4)
PH5
92
ATmega640/1280/1281/2560/2561
2549L–AVR–08/07
ATmega640/1280/1281/2560/2561
Table 13-23. Port H Pins Alternate Functions
Port Pin
PH4
Alternate Function
OC4B(Output Compare and PWM Output B for Timer/Counter4)
OC4A(Output Compare and PWM Output A for Timer/Counter4)
XCK2 (USART2 External Clock)
PH3
PH2
PH1
TXD2 (USART2 Transmit Pin)
PH0
RXD2 (USART2 Receive Pin)
• T4 – Port H, Bit 7
T4, Timer/Counter4 counter source.
• OC2B – Port H, Bit 6
OC2B, Output Compare Match B output: The PH6 pin can serve as an external output for the
Timer/Counter2 Output Compare B. The pin has to be configured as an output (DDH6 set) to
serve this function. The OC2B pin is also the output pin for the PWM mode timer function.
• OC4C – Port H, Bit 5
OC4C, Output Compare Match C output: The PH5 pin can serve as an external output for the
Timer/Counter4 Output Compare C. The pin has to be configured as an output (DDH5 set) to
serve this function. The OC4C pin is also the output pin for the PWM mode timer function.
• OC4B – Port H, Bit 4
OC4B, Output Compare Match B output: The PH4 pin can serve as an external output for the
Timer/Counter2 Output Compare B. The pin has to be configured as an output (DDH4 set) to
serve this function. The OC4B pin is also the output pin for the PWM mode timer function.
• OC4A – Port H, Bit 3
OC4C, Output Compare Match A output: The PH3 pin can serve as an external output for the
Timer/Counter4 Output Compare A. The pin has to be configured as an output (DDH3 set) to
serve this function. The OC4A pin is also the output pin for the PWM mode timer function.
• XCK2 – Port H, Bit 2
XCK2, USART2 External Clock: The Data Direction Register (DDH2) controls whether the clock
is output (DDH2 set) or input (DDH2 cleared). The XC2K pin is active only when the USART2
operates in synchronous mode.
• TXD2 – Port H, Bit 1
TXD2, USART2 Transmit Pin.
• RXD2 – Port H, Bit 0
RXD2, USART2 Receive pin: Receive Data (Data input pin for the USART2). When the
USART2 Receiver is enabled, this pin is configured as an input regardless of the value of DDH0.
93
2549L–AVR–08/07
When the USART2 forces this pin to be an input, a logical on in PORTH0 will turn on the internal
pull-up.
Table 13-24. Overriding Signals for Alternate Functions in PH7:PH4
Signal Name
PUOE
PUOV
DDOE
DDOV
PVOE
PVOV
PTOE
DIEOE
DIEOV
DI
PH7/T4
PH6/OC2B
PH5/OC4C
PH4/OC4B
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
OC2B ENABLE
OC4C ENABLE
OC4B ENABLE
0
OC2B
OC4C
OC4B
–
–
0
0
0
–
–
0
0
0
–
–
0
0
0
–
0
0
T4 INPUT
–
AIO
Table 13-25. Overriding Signals for Alternate Functions in PH3:PH0
Signal Name
PUOE
PH3/OC4A
PH2/XCK2
PH1/TXD2
TXEN2
0
PH0/RXD2
RXEN2
0
0
0
0
PUOV
PORTH0 • PUD
XCK2 OUTPUT
DDOE
DDOV
PVOE
0
TXEN2
1
RXEN2
ENABLE
0
1
0
0
XCK2 OUTPUT
OC4A ENABLE
TXEN2
ENABLE
PVOV
PTOE
DIEOE
DIEOV
DI
OC4A
XCK2
TXD2
0
–
0
0
0
–
–
–
0
0
0
–
–
0
0
0
0
XC2K INPUT
RXD2
–
AIO
–
94
ATmega640/1280/1281/2560/2561
2549L–AVR–08/07
ATmega640/1280/1281/2560/2561
13.3.9
Alternate Functions of Port J
The Port J alternate pin configuration is as follows:
Table 13-26. Port J Pins Alternate Functions
Port Pin
Alternate Function
PJ7
–
PJ6
PJ5
PJ4
PJ3
PJ2
PJ1
PJ0
PCINT15 (Pin Change Interrupt 15)
PCINT14 (Pin Change Interrupt 14)
PCINT13 (Pin Change Interrupt 13)
PCINT12 (Pin Change Interrupt 12)
XCK3/PCINT11 (USART3 External Clock or Pin Change Interrupt 11)
TXD3/PCINT10 (USART3 Transmit Pin or Pin Change Interrupt 10)
RXD3/PCINT9 (USART3 Receive Pin or Pin Change Interrupt 9)
• PCINT15:12 - Port J, Bit 6:3
PCINT15:12, Pin Change Interrupt Source 15:12. The PJ6:3 pins can serve as External Interrupt
Sources
• XCK2/PCINT11 - Port J, Bit 2
XCK2, USART 2 External Clock. The Data Direction Register (DDJ2) controls whether the clock
is output (DDJ2 set) or input (DDJ2 cleared). The XCK2 pin is active only when the USART2
operates in synchronous mode.
PCINT11, Pin Change Interrupt Source 11. The PJ2 pin can serve as External Interrupt Sources
• TXD3/PCINT10 - Port J, Bit 1
TXD3, USART3 Transmit pin
PCINT10, Pin Change Interrupt Source 10. The PJ1 pin can serve as External Interrupt Sources
• RXD3/PCINT9 - Port J, Bit 0
RXD3, USART3 Receive pin. Receive Data (Data input pin for the USART3). When the
USART3 Receiver is enabled, this pin is configured as an input regardless of the value of DDJ0.
When the USART3 forces this pin to be an input, a logical one in PORTJ0 will turn on the inter-
nal pull-up.
PCINT9, Pin Change Interrupt Source 9. The PJ0 pin can serve as External Interrupt Sources
Table 2 and Table 3 relates the alternate functions of Port J to the overriding signals shown in
Figure 13-5 on page 76.
95
2549L–AVR–08/07
Table 2. Overriding Signals for Alternate Functions in PJ7:PJ4
Signal Name
PUOE
PUOV
DDOE
DDOV
PVOE
PVOV
PTOE
DIEOE
DIEOV
DI
PJ7
0
PJ6/ PCINT15
PJ5/ PCINT14
PJ4/ PCINT13
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
-
-
-
-
0
PCINT15·PCIE1
PCINT14·PCIE1
PCINT13·PCIE1
0
1
1
1
0
PCINT15 INPUT
PCINT14 INPUT
PCINT13 INPUT
AIO
-
-
-
-
Table 3. Overriding Signals for Alternate Functions in PJ3:PJ0
PJ2/XCK3/PCINT
11
PJ1/TXD3/PCINT
10
PJ0/RXD3/PCINT
9
Signal Name
PUOE
PJ3/PCINT12
0
0
0
0
0
TXEN3
0
RXEN3
PUOV
PORTJ0·PUD
RXEN3
DDOE
XCK3 OUTPUT
TXEN3
ENABLE
DDOV
PVOE
0
0
1
1
0
0
XCK3 OUTPUT
TXEN3
ENABLE
PVOV
PTOE
DIEOE
DIEOV
DI
0
XCK3
TXD3
0
-
-
-
-
PCINT12·PCIE1
1
PCINT11·PCIE1
PCINT10·PCIE1
1
PCINT9·PCIE1
1
1
PCINT12 INPUT
PCINT11 INPUT
XCK3 INPUT
PCINT10 INPUT
PCINT9 INPUT
RXD3
AIO
-
-
-
-
13.3.10 Alternate Functions of Port K
The Port K alternate pin configuration is as follows:
Table 13-27. Port K Pins Alternate Functions
Port Pin
PK7
Alternate Function
ADC15/PCINT23 (ADC Input Channel 15 or Pin Change Interrupt 23)
ADC14/PCINT22 (ADC Input Channel 14 or Pin Change Interrupt 22)
ADC13/PCINT21 (ADC Input Channel 13 or Pin Change Interrupt 21)
PK6
PK5
96
ATmega640/1280/1281/2560/2561
2549L–AVR–08/07
ATmega640/1280/1281/2560/2561
Table 13-27. Port K Pins Alternate Functions
Port Pin
PK4
Alternate Function
ADC12/PCINT20 (ADC Input Channel 12 or Pin Change Interrupt 20)
ADC11/PCINT19 (ADC Input Channel 11 or Pin Change Interrupt 19)
ADC10/PCINT18 (ADC Input Channel 10 or Pin Change Interrupt 18)
ADC9/PCINT17 (ADC Input Channel 9 or Pin Change Interrupt 17)
ADC8 /PCINT16 (ADC Input Channel 8 or Pin Change Interrupt 16)
PK3
PK2
PK1
PK0
• ADC15:8/PCINT23:16 – Port K, Bit 7:0
ADC15:8, Analog to Digital Converter, Channel 15 - 8.
PCINT23:16, Pin Change Interrupt Source 23:16. The PK7:0 pins can serve as External Inter-
rupt Sources.
Table 13-28. Overriding Signals for Alternate Functions in PK7:PK4
PK7/ADC15/
PCINT23
PK6/ADC14/
PCINT22
PK5/ADC13/
PCINT21
PK4/ADC12/
PCINT20
Signal Name
PUOE
PUOV
DDOE
DDOV
PVOE
PVOV
PTOE
DIEOE
DIEOV
DI
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
–
–
–
–
PCINT23 • PCIE2
1
PCINT22 • PCIE2
1
PCINT21 • PCIE2
1
PCINT20 • PCIE2
1
PCINT23 INPUT
ADC15 INPUT
PCINT22 INPUT
ADC14 INPUT
PCINT21 INPUT
ADC13 INPUT
PCINT20 INPUT
ADC12 INPUT
AIO
97
2549L–AVR–08/07
Table 13-29. Overriding Signals for Alternate Functions in PK3:PK0
PK3/ADC11/
PCINT19
PK2/ADC10/
PCINT18
PK1/ADC9/
PCINT17
PK0/ADC8/
PCINT16
Signal Name
PUOE
0
0
0
0
0
0
–
0
0
0
0
0
0
–
0
0
0
0
0
0
–
0
0
0
0
0
0
–
PUOV
DDOE
DDOV
PVOE
PVOV
PTOE
PCINT17 •
PCIE2
PCINT16 •
PCIE2
DIEOE
PCINT19 • PCIE2
PCINT18 • PCIE2
DIEOV
DI
1
1
1
1
PCINT19 INPUT
ADC11 INPUT
PCINT18 INPUT
ADC10INPUT
PCINT17 INPUT PCINT16 INPUT
ADC9 INPUT ADC8 INPUT
AIO
13.3.11 Alternate Functions of Port L
The Port L alternate pin configuration is as follows:
Table 13-30. Port L Pins Alternate Functions
Port Pin
PL7
Alternate Function
–
–
PL6
PL5
OC5C (Output Compare and PWM Output C for Timer/Counter5)
OC5B (Output Compare and PWM Output B for Timer/Counter5)
OC5A (Output Compare and PWM Output A for Timer/Counter5)
T5 (Timer/Counter5 Clock Input)
PL4
PL3
PL2
PL1
ICP5 (Timer/Counter5 Input Capture Trigger)
PL0
ICP4 (Timer/Counter4 Input Capture Trigger)
• OC5C – Port L, Bit 5
OC5C, Output Compare Match C output: The PL5 pin can serve as an external output for the
Timer/Counter5 Output Compare C. The pin has to be configured as an output (DDL5 set) to
serve this function. The OC5C pin is also the output pin for the PWM mode timer function.
• OC5B – Port L, Bit 4
OC5B, Output Compare Match B output: The PL4 pin can serve as an external output for the
Timer/Counter 5 Output Compare B. The pin has to be configured as an output (DDL4 set) to
serve this function. The OC5B pin is also the output pin for the PWM mode timer function.
98
ATmega640/1280/1281/2560/2561
2549L–AVR–08/07
ATmega640/1280/1281/2560/2561
• OC5A – Port L, Bit 3
OC5A, Output Compare Match A output: The PL3 pin can serve as an external output for the
Timer/Counter 5 Output Compare A. The pin has to be configured as an output (DDL3 set) to
serve this function. The OC5A pin is also the output pin for the PWM mode timer function.
• T5 – Port L, Bit 2
T5, Timer/Counter5 counter source.
• ICP5 – Port L, Bit 1
ICP5, Input Capture Pin 5: The PL1 pin can serve as an Input Capture pin for Timer/Counter5.
• ICP4 – Port L, Bit 0
ICP4, Input Capture Pin 4: The PL0 pin can serve as an Input Capture pin for Timer/Counter4.
Table 13-31 and Table 13-32 relates the alternate functions of Port L to the overriding signals
shown in Figure 13-5 on page 76.
Table 13-31. Overriding Signals for Alternate Functions in PL7:PL4
Signal Name
PUOE
PUOV
DDOE
DDOV
PVOE
PVOV
PTOE
DIEOE
DIEOV
DI
PL7
0
PL6
0
PL5/OC5C
PL4/OC5B
0
0
0
0
0
0
–
–
0
0
–
–
0
0
–
–
OC5C ENABLE
OC5B ENABLE
–
–
OC5C
OC5B
–
–
–
0
0
0
–
–
0
0
0
–
0
0
0
0
0
0
AIO
–
–
99
2549L–AVR–08/07
Table 13-32. Overriding Signals for Alternate Functions in PL3:PL0
Signal Name
PUOE
PUOV
DDOE
DDOV
PVOE
PVOV
PTOE
DIEOE
DIEOV
DI
PL3/OC5A
PL2/T5
PL1/ICP5
PL0/ICP4
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
OC5A ENABLE
0
0
0
OC5A
0
0
0
–
0
0
0
–
–
–
–
0
0
0
0
T5 INPUT
–
0
0
ICP5 INPUT
ICP4 INPUT
AIO
–
–
13.4 Register Description for I/O-Ports
13.4.1
MCUCR – MCU Control Register
Bit
7
6
–
5
–
4
3
–
2
1
0
0x35 (0x55)
Read/Write
Initial Value
JTD
R/W
0
PUD
R/W
0
–
R
0
IVSEL
R/W
0
IVCE
R/W
0
MCUCR
R
0
R
0
R
0
• Bit 4 – PUD: Pull-up Disable
When this bit is written to one, the I/O ports pull-up resistors are disabled even if the DDxn and
PORTxn Registers are configured to enable the pull-up resistor ({DDxn, PORTxn} = 0b01). See
“Configuring the Pin” on page 71 for more details about this feature.
13.4.2
13.4.3
13.4.4
PORTA – Port A Data Register
Bit
7
6
PORTA6
R/W
0
5
PORTA5
R/W
0
4
PORTA4
R/W
0
3
PORTA3
R/W
0
2
PORTA2
R/W
0
1
PORTA1
R/W
0
0
PORTA0
R/W
0
PORTA7
R/W
0
0x02 (0x22)
Read/Write
Initial Value
PORTA
DDRA
PINA
DDRA – Port A Data Direction Register
Bit
7
DDA7
R/W
0
6
DDA6
R/W
0
5
DDA5
R/W
0
4
DDA4
R/W
0
3
DDA3
R/W
0
2
DDA2
R/W
0
1
DDA1
R/W
0
0
DDA0
R/W
0
0x01 (0x21)
Read/Write
Initial Value
PINA – Port A Input Pins Address
Bit
7
6
5
4
3
2
1
0
0x00 (0x20)
Read/Write
Initial Value
PINA7
R/W
N/A
PINA6
R/W
N/A
PINA5
R/W
N/A
PINA4
R/W
N/A
PINA3
R/W
N/A
PINA2
R/W
N/A
PINA1
R/W
N/A
PINA0
R/W
N/A
100
ATmega640/1280/1281/2560/2561
2549L–AVR–08/07
ATmega640/1280/1281/2560/2561
13.4.5
13.4.6
13.4.7
13.4.8
13.4.9
PORTB – Port B Data Register
Bit
7
6
PORTB6
R/W
0
5
PORTB5
R/W
0
4
PORTB4
R/W
0
3
PORTB3
R/W
0
2
PORTB2
R/W
0
1
PORTB1
R/W
0
0
PORTB0
R/W
0
PORTB7
R/W
0
PORTB
DDRB
PINB
0x05 (0x25)
Read/Write
Initial Value
DDRB – Port B Data Direction Register
Bit
7
DDB7
R/W
0
6
DDB6
R/W
0
5
DDB5
R/W
0
4
DDB4
R/W
0
3
DDB3
R/W
0
2
DDB2
R/W
0
1
DDB1
R/W
0
0
DDB0
R/W
0
0x04 (0x24)
Read/Write
Initial Value
PINB – Port B Input Pins Address
Bit
7
6
5
4
3
2
1
0
0x03 (0x23)
Read/Write
Initial Value
PINB7
R/W
N/A
PINB6
R/W
N/A
PINB5
R/W
N/A
PINB4
R/W
N/A
PINB3
R/W
N/A
PINB2
R/W
N/A
PINB1
R/W
N/A
PINB0
R/W
N/A
PORTC – Port C Data Register
Bit
7
6
PORTC6
R/W
0
5
PORTC5
R/W
0
4
PORTC4
R/W
0
3
PORTC3
R/W
0
2
PORTC2
R/W
0
1
PORTC1
R/W
0
0
PORTC0
R/W
0
PORTC7
R/W
0
PORTC
DDRC
PINC
0x08 (0x28)
Read/Write
Initial Value
DDRC – Port C Data Direction Register
Bit
7
DDC7
R/W
0
6
DDC6
R/W
0
5
DDC5
R/W
0
4
DDC4
R/W
0
3
DDC3
R/W
0
2
DDC2
R/W
0
1
DDC1
R/W
0
0
DDC0
R/W
0
0x07 (0x27)
Read/Write
Initial Value
13.4.10 PINC– Port C Input Pins Address
Bit
7
6
5
4
3
2
1
0
0x06 (0x26)
Read/Write
Initial Value
PINC7
R/W
N/A
PINC6
R/W
N/A
PINC5
R/W
N/A
PINC4
R/W
N/A
PINC3
R/W
N/A
PINC2
R/W
N/A
PINC1
R/W
N/A
PINC0
R/W
N/A
13.4.11 PORTD – Port D Data Register
Bit
7
6
PORTD6
R/W
0
5
PORTD5
R/W
0
4
PORTD4
R/W
0
3
PORTD3
R/W
0
2
PORTD2
R/W
0
1
PORTD1
R/W
0
0
PORTD0
R/W
0
PORTD7
R/W
0
PORTD
DDRD
PIND
0x0B (0x2B)
Read/Write
Initial Value
13.4.12 DDRD – Port D Data Direction Register
Bit
7
DDD7
R/W
0
6
DDD6
R/W
0
5
DDD5
R/W
0
4
DDD4
R/W
0
3
DDD3
R/W
0
2
DDD2
R/W
0
1
DDD1
R/W
0
0
DDD0
R/W
0
0x0A (0x2A)
Read/Write
Initial Value
13.4.13 PIND – Port D Input Pins Address
Bit
7
6
5
4
3
2
1
0
0x09 (0x29)
PIND7
PIND6
PIND5
PIND4
PIND3
PIND2
PIND1
PIND0
101
2549L–AVR–08/07
Read/Write
R/W
N/A
R/W
N/A
R/W
N/A
R/W
N/A
R/W
N/A
R/W
N/A
R/W
N/A
R/W
N/A
Initial Value
13.4.14 PORTE – Port E Data Register
Bit
7
6
PORTE6
R/W
0
5
PORTE5
R/W
0
4
PORTE4
R/W
0
3
PORTE3
R/W
0
2
PORTE2
R/W
0
1
PORTE1
R/W
0
0
PORTE0
R/W
0
PORTE7
R/W
0
PORTE
DDRE
PINE
0x0E (0x2E)
Read/Write
Initial Value
13.4.15 DDRE – Port E Data Direction Register
Bit
7
DDE7
R/W
0
6
DDE6
R/W
0
5
DDE5
R/W
0
4
DDE4
R/W
0
3
DDE3
R/W
0
2
DDE2
R/W
0
1
DDE1
R/W
0
0
DDE0
R/W
0
0x0D (0x2D)
Read/Write
Initial Value
13.4.16 PINE – Port E Input Pins Address
Bit
7
6
5
4
3
2
1
0
0x0C (0x2C)
Read/Write
Initial Value
PINE7
R/W
N/A
PINE6
R/W
N/A
PINE5
R/W
N/A
PINE4
R/W
N/A
PINE3
R/W
N/A
PINE2
R/W
N/A
PINE1
R/W
N/A
PINE0
R/W
N/A
13.4.17 PORTF – Port F Data Register
Bit
7
6
PORTF6
R/W
0
5
PORTF5
R/W
0
4
PORTF4
R/W
0
3
PORTF3
R/W
0
2
PORTF2
R/W
0
1
PORTF1
R/W
0
0
PORTF0
R/W
0
PORTF7
R/W
0
PORTF
DDRF
PINF
0x11 (0x31)
Read/Write
Initial Value
13.4.18 DDRF – Port F Data Direction Register
Bit
7
DDF7
R/W
0
6
DDF6
R/W
0
5
DDF5
R/W
0
4
DDF4
R/W
0
3
DDF3
R/W
0
2
DDF2
R/W
0
1
DDF1
R/W
0
0
DDF0
R/W
0
0x10 (0x30)
Read/Write
Initial Value
13.4.19 PINF – Port F Input Pins Address
Bit
7
6
5
4
3
2
1
0
0x0F (0x2F)
Read/Write
Initial Value
PINF7
R/W
N/A
PINF6
R/W
N/A
PINF5
R/W
N/A
PINF4
R/W
N/A
PINF3
R/W
N/A
PINF2
R/W
N/A
PINF1
R/W
N/A
PINF0
R/W
N/A
13.4.20 PORTG – Port G Data Register
Bit
7
6
–
5
PORTG5
R/W
0
4
PORTG4
R/W
0
3
PORTG3
R/W
0
2
PORTG2
R/W
0
1
PORTG1
R/W
0
0
PORTG0
R/W
0
PORTG
0x14 (0x34)
Read/Write
Initial Value
–
R
0
R
0
13.4.21 DDRG – Port G Data Direction Register
Bit
7
–
6
–
5
DDG5
R/W
0
4
DDG4
R/W
0
3
DDG3
R/W
0
2
DDG2
R/W
0
1
DDG1
R/W
0
0
DDG0
R/W
0
0x13 (0x33)
Read/Write
Initial Value
DDRG
R
0
R
0
102
ATmega640/1280/1281/2560/2561
2549L–AVR–08/07
ATmega640/1280/1281/2560/2561
13.4.22 PING – Port G Input Pins Address
Bit
7
–
6
–
5
4
3
2
1
0
0x12 (0x32)
Read/Write
Initial Value
PING5
R/W
N/A
PING4
R/W
N/A
PING3
R/W
N/A
PING2
R/W
N/A
PING1
R/W
N/A
PING0
R/W
N/A
PING
PORTH
DDRH
PINH
R
0
R
0
13.4.23 PORTH – Port H Data Register
Bit
7
6
PORTH6
R/W
0
5
PORTH5
R/W
0
4
PORTH4
R/W
0
3
PORTH3
R/W
0
2
PORTH2
R/W
0
1
PORTH1
R/W
0
0
PORTH0
R/W
0
PORTH7
R/W
0
(0x102)
Read/Write
Initial Value
13.4.24 DDRH – Port H Data Direction Register
Bit
7
DDH7
R/W
0
6
DDH6
R/W
0
5
DDH5
R/W
0
4
DDH4
R/W
0
3
DDH3
R/W
0
2
DDH2
R/W
0
1
DDH1
R/W
0
0
DDH0
R/W
0
(0x101)
Read/Write
Initial Value
13.4.25 PINH – Port H Input Pins Address
Bit
7
6
5
4
3
2
1
0
(0x100)
Read/Write
Initial Value
PINH5
R/W
N/A
PINH5
R/W
N/A
PINH5
R/W
N/A
PINH4
R/W
N/A
PINH3
R/W
N/A
PINGH
R/W
PINH1
R/W
N/A
PINH0
R/W
N/A
N/A
13.4.26 PORTJ – Port J Data Register
Bit
7
6
PORTJ6
R/W
0
5
PORTJ5
R/W
0
4
PORTJ4
R/W
0
3
PORTJ3
R/W
0
2
PORTJ2
R/W
0
1
PORTJ1
R/W
0
0
PORTJ0
R/W
0
PORTJ7
R/W
0
PORTJ
DDRJ
PINJ
(0x105)
Read/Write
Initial Value
13.4.27 DDRJ – Port J Data Direction Register
Bit
7
DDJ7
R/W
0
6
DDJ6
R/W
0
5
DDJ5
R/W
0
4
DDJ4
R/W
0
3
DDJ3
R/W
0
2
DDJ2
R/W
0
1
DDJ1
R/W
0
0
DDJ0
R/W
0
(0x104)
Read/Write
Initial Value
13.4.28 PINJ – Port J Input Pins Address
Bit
7
6
5
4
3
2
1
0
(0x103)
Read/Write
Initial Value
PINJ5
R/W
N/A
PINJ5
R/W
N/A
PINJ5
R/W
N/A
PINJ4
R/W
N/A
PINJ3
R/W
N/A
PINGJ
R/W
N/A
PINJ1
R/W
N/A
PINJ0
R/W
N/A
13.4.29 PORTK – Port K Data Register
Bit
7
6
PORTK6
R/W
0
5
PORTK5
R/W
0
4
PORTK4
R/W
0
3
PORTK3
R/W
0
2
PORTK2
R/W
0
1
PORTK1
R/W
0
0
PORTK0
R/W
0
PORTK7
R/W
0
PORTK
(0x108)
Read/Write
Initial Value
13.4.30 DDRK – Port K Data Direction Register
Bit
7
6
5
4
3
2
1
0
(0x107)
DDK7
DDK6
DDK5
DDK4
DDK3
DDK2
DDK1
DDK0
DDRK
103
2549L–AVR–08/07
Read/Write
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
Initial Value
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
13.4.31 PINK – Port K Input Pins Address
Bit
7
6
5
4
3
2
1
0
(0x106)
Read/Write
Initial Value
PINK5
R/W
N/A
PINK5
R/W
N/A
PINK5
R/W
N/A
PINK4
R/W
N/A
PINK3
R/W
N/A
PINGK
R/W
PINK1
R/W
N/A
PINK0
R/W
N/A
PINK
PORTL
DDRL
PINL
N/A
13.4.32 PORTL – Port L Data Register
Bit
7
6
PORTL6
R/W
0
5
PORTL5
R/W
0
4
PORTL4
R/W
0
3
PORTL3
R/W
0
2
PORTL2
R/W
0
1
PORTL1
R/W
0
0
PORTL0
R/W
0
PORTL7
R/W
0
(0x10B)
Read/Write
Initial Value
13.4.33 DDRL – Port L Data Direction Register
Bit
7
DDL7
R/W
0
6
DDL6
R/W
0
5
DDL5
R/W
0
4
DDL4
R/W
0
3
DDL3
R/W
0
2
DDL2
R/W
0
1
DDL1
R/W
0
0
DDL0
R/W
0
(0x10A)
Read/Write
Initial Value
13.4.34 PINL – Port L Input Pins Address
Bit
7
6
5
4
3
2
1
0
(0x109)
Read/Write
Initial Value
PINL5
R/W
N/A
PINL5
R/W
N/A
PINL5
R/W
N/A
PINL4
R/W
N/A
PINL3
R/W
N/A
PINGL
R/W
N/A
PINL1
R/W
N/A
PINL0
R/W
N/A
104
ATmega640/1280/1281/2560/2561
2549L–AVR–08/07
ATmega640/1280/1281/2560/2561
14. Interrupts
This section describes the specifics of the interrupt handling as performed in
ATmega640/1280/1281/2560/2561. For a general explanation of the AVR interrupt handling,
refer to “Reset and Interrupt Handling” on page 17.
14.1 Interrupt Vectors in ATmega640/1280/1281/2560/2561
Table 14-1. Reset and Interrupt Vectors
Vector
No.
Program
Address(2)
Source
Interrupt Definition
External Pin, Power-on Reset, Brown-out Reset,
1
$0000(1)
RESET
Watchdog Reset, and JTAG AVR Reset
2
$0002
$0004
$0006
$0008
$000A
$000C
$000E
$0010
$0012
$0014
$0016(3)
$0018
$001A
$001C
$001E
$0020
$0022
$0024
$0026
$0028
$002A
$002C
$002E
$0030
$0032
$0034
$0036
$0038
INT0
INT1
External Interrupt Request 0
External Interrupt Request 1
External Interrupt Request 2
External Interrupt Request 3
External Interrupt Request 4
External Interrupt Request 5
External Interrupt Request 6
External Interrupt Request 7
Pin Change Interrupt Request 0
Pin Change Interrupt Request 1
Pin Change Interrupt Request 2
Watchdog Time-out Interrupt
Timer/Counter2 Compare Match A
Timer/Counter2 Compare Match B
Timer/Counter2 Overflow
3
4
INT2
5
INT3
6
INT4
7
INT5
8
INT6
9
INT7
10
11
12
13
14
15
16
17
18
19
20
21
22
23
24
25
26
27
28
29
PCINT0
PCINT1
PCINT2
WDT
TIMER2 COMPA
TIMER2 COMPB
TIMER2 OVF
TIMER1 CAPT
TIMER1 COMPA
TIMER1 COMPB
TIMER1 COMPC
TIMER1 OVF
TIMER0 COMPA
TIMER0 COMPB
TIMER0 OVF
SPI, STC
Timer/Counter1 Capture Event
Timer/Counter1 Compare Match A
Timer/Counter1 Compare Match B
Timer/Counter1 Compare Match C
Timer/Counter1 Overflow
Timer/Counter0 Compare Match A
Timer/Counter0 Compare match B
Timer/Counter0 Overflow
SPI Serial Transfer Complete
USART0 Rx Complete
USART0 RX
USART0 UDRE
USART0 TX
ANALOG COMP
USART0 Data Register Empty
USART0 Tx Complete
Analog Comparator
105
2549L–AVR–08/07
Table 14-1. Reset and Interrupt Vectors (Continued)
Vector
No.
Program
Address(2)
Source
Interrupt Definition
ADC Conversion Complete
30
31
32
33
34
35
36
37
38
39
40
41
42
43
44
45
46
47
48
49
50
51
52
53
54
55
56
57
$003A
$003C
$003E
$0040
ADC
EE READY
EEPROM Ready
TIMER3 CAPT
TIMER3 COMPA
Timer/Counter3 Capture Event
Timer/Counter3 Compare Match A
$0042
TIMER3 COMPB Timer/Counter3 Compare Match B
TIMER3 COMPC Timer/Counter3 Compare Match C
$0044
$0046
TIMER3 OVF
USART1 RX
USART1 UDRE
USART1 TX
TWI
Timer/Counter3 Overflow
USART1 Rx Complete
$0048
$004A
$004C
$004E
$0050
USART1 Data Register Empty
USART1 Tx Complete
2-wire Serial Interface
SPM READY
TIMER4 CAPT
TIMER4 COMPA
Store Program Memory Ready
Timer/Counter4 Capture Event
Timer/Counter4 Compare Match A
$0052(3)
$0054
$0056
TIMER4 COMPB Timer/Counter4 Compare Match B
TIMER4 COMPC Timer/Counter4 Compare Match C
$0058
$005A
$005C(3)
$005E
$0060
TIMER4 OVF
Timer/Counter4 Overflow
TIMER5 CAPT
TIMER5 COMPA
Timer/Counter5 Capture Event
Timer/Counter5 Compare Match A
TIMER5 COMPB Timer/Counter5 Compare Match B
TIMER5 COMPC Timer/Counter5 Compare Match C
$0062
$0064
TIMER5 OVF
USART2 RX
USART2 UDRE
USART2 TX
USART3 RX
USART3 UDRE
USART3 TX
Timer/Counter5 Overflow
USART2 Rx Complete
$0066(3)
$0068(3)
$006A(3)
$006C(3)
$006E(3))
$0070(3)
USART2 Data Register Empty
USART2 Tx Complete
USART3 Rx Complete
USART3 Data Register Empty
USART3 Tx Complete
Notes: 1. When the BOOTRST Fuse is programmed, the device will jump to the Boot Loader address at
reset, see “Memory Programming” on page 337.
2. When the IVSEL bit in MCUCR is set, Interrupt Vectors will be moved to the start of the Boot
Flash Section. The address of each Interrupt Vector will then be the address in this table
added to the start address of the Boot Flash Section.
3. Only available in ATmega640/1280/2560
14.2 Reset and Interrupt Vector placement
Table 14-2 on page 107 shows Reset and Interrupt Vectors placement for the various combina-
tions of BOOTRST and IVSEL settings. If the program never enables an interrupt source, the
106
ATmega640/1280/1281/2560/2561
2549L–AVR–08/07
ATmega640/1280/1281/2560/2561
Interrupt Vectors are not used, and regular program code can be placed at these locations. This
is also the case if the Reset Vector is in the Application section while the Interrupt Vectors are in
the Boot section or vice versa.
Table 14-2. Reset and Interrupt Vectors Placement(1)
BOOTRST
IVSEL
Reset Address
0x0000
Interrupt Vectors Start Address
0x0002
1
1
0
0
0
1
0
1
0x0000
Boot Reset Address + 0x0002
0x0002
Boot Reset Address
Boot Reset Address
Boot Reset Address + 0x0002
Note:
1. The Boot Reset Address is shown in Table 29-7 on page 329 through Table 29-15 on page
334. For the BOOTRST Fuse “1” means unprogrammed while “0” means programmed.
The most typical and general program setup for the Reset and Interrupt Vector Addresses in
ATmega640/1280/1281/2560/2561 is:
Address Labels
0x0000
0x0002
0x0004
0x0006
0x0008
0x000A
0x000C
0x000E
0x0010
0x0012
0x0014
0x0016
0X0018
0x001A
0x001C
0x001E
0x0020
0x0022
0x0024
0x0026
0x0028
0x002A
0x002C
0x002E
0x0030
0x0032
0x0034
0x0036
0x0038
0x003A
0x003C
0x003E
0x0040
0x0042
0x0044
Code
jmp
jmp
jmp
jmp
jmp
jmp
jmp
jmp
jmp
jmp
jmp
jmp
jmp
jmp
jmp
jmp
jmp
jmp
jmp
jmp
jmp
jmp
jmp
jmp
jmp
jmp
jmp
jmp
jmp
jmp
jmp
jmp
jmp
jmp
jmp
Comments
RESET
; Reset Handler
INT0
; IRQ0 Handler
INT1
; IRQ1 Handler
INT2
; IRQ2 Handler
INT3
; IRQ3 Handler
INT4
; IRQ4 Handler
INT5
; IRQ5 Handler
INT6
; IRQ6 Handler
INT7
; IRQ7 Handler
PCINT0
; PCINT0 Handler
PCINT1
; PCINT1 Handler
PCINT2
; PCINT2 Handler
WDT
; Watchdog Timeout Handler
; Timer2 CompareA Handler
; Timer2 CompareB Handler
; Timer2 Overflow Handler
; Timer1 Capture Handler
; Timer1 CompareA Handler
; Timer1 CompareB Handler
; Timer1 CompareC Handler
; Timer1 Overflow Handler
; Timer0 CompareA Handler
; Timer0 CompareB Handler
; Timer0 Overflow Handler
; SPI Transfer Complete Handler
; USART0 RX Complete Handler
; USART0,UDR Empty Handler
; USART0 TX Complete Handler
; Analog Comparator Handler
; ADC Conversion Complete Handler
; EEPROM Ready Handler
; Timer3 Capture Handler
; Timer3 CompareA Handler
; Timer3 CompareB Handler
; Timer3 CompareC Handler
TIM2_COMPA
TIM2_COMPB
TIM2_OVF
TIM1_CAPT
TIM1_COMPA
TIM1_COMPB
TIM1_COMPC
TIM1_OVF
TIM0_COMPA
TIM0_COMPB
TIM0_OVF
SPI_STC
USART0_RXC
USART0_UDRE
USART0_TXC
ANA_COMP
ADC
EE_RDY
TIM3_CAPT
TIM3_COMPA
TIM3_COMPB
TIM3_COMPC
107
2549L–AVR–08/07
0x0046
0x0048
0x004A
0x004C
0x004E
0x0050
0x0052
0x0054
0x0056
0x0058
0x005A
0x005C
0x005E
0x0060
0x0062
0x0064
0x0066
0x0068
0x006A
0x006C
0x006E
0x0070
;
jmp
jmp
jmp
jmp
jmp
jmp
jmp
jmp
jmp
jmp
jmp
jmp
jmp
jmp
jmp
jmp
jmp
jmp
jmp
jmp
jmp
jmp
TIM3_OVF
; Timer3 Overflow Handler
; USART1 RX Complete Handler
; USART1,UDR Empty Handler
; USART1 TX Complete Handler
; 2-wire Serial Handler
USART1_RXC
USART1_UDRE
USART1_TXC
TWI
SPM_RDY
; SPM Ready Handler
TIM4_CAPT
TIM4_COMPA
TIM4_COMPB
TIM4_COMPC
TIM4_OVF
; Timer4 Capture Handler
; Timer4 CompareA Handler
; Timer4 CompareB Handler
; Timer4 CompareC Handler
; Timer4 Overflow Handler
; Timer5 Capture Handler
; Timer5 CompareA Handler
; Timer5 CompareB Handler
; Timer5 CompareC Handler
; Timer5 Overflow Handler
; USART2 RX Complete Handler
; USART2,UDR Empty Handler
; USART2 TX Complete Handler
; USART3 RX Complete Handler
; USART3,UDR Empty Handler
; USART3 TX Complete Handler
TIM5_CAPT
TIM5_COMPA
TIM5_COMPB
TIM5_COMPC
TIM5_OVF
USART2_RXC
USART2_UDRE
USART2_TXC
USART3_RXC
USART3_UDRE
USART3_TXC
0x0072
0x0073
0x0074
0x0075
0x0076
0x0077
...
RESET:
ldi
out
ldi
out
sei
r16, high(RAMEND)
SPH,r16
; Main program start
; Set Stack Pointer to top of RAM
r16, low(RAMEND)
SPL,r16
; Enable interrupts
<instr> xxx
... ...
...
When the BOOTRST Fuse is unprogrammed, the Boot section size set to 8K bytes and the
IVSEL bit in the MCUCR Register is set before any interrupts are enabled, the most typical and
general program setup for the Reset and Interrupt Vector Addresses is:
Address Labels Code
0x00000 RESET: ldi
Comments
r16,high(RAMEND); Main program start
0x00001
0x00002
out
ldi
SPH,r16
; Set Stack Pointer to top of RAM
r16,low(RAMEND)
SPL,r16
0x00003
0x00004
out
sei
; Enable interrupts
0x00005
;
<instr> xxx
.org 0x1F002
0x1F002
0x1F004
...
jmp
jmp
...
jmp
EXT_INT0
; IRQ0 Handler
EXT_INT1
...
; IRQ1 Handler
;
0x1FO70
USART3_TXC
; USART3 TX Complete Handler
When the BOOTRST Fuse is programmed and the Boot section size set to 8K bytes, the most
typical and general program setup for the Reset and Interrupt Vector Addresses is:
108
ATmega640/1280/1281/2560/2561
2549L–AVR–08/07
ATmega640/1280/1281/2560/2561
Address Labels Code
.org 0x0002
Comments
0x00002
0x00004
...
jmp
jmp
...
jmp
EXT_INT0
EXT_INT1
...
; IRQ0 Handler
; IRQ1 Handler
;
0x00070
;
USART3_TXC
; USART3 TX Complete Handler
.org 0x1F000
0x1F000 RESET: ldi
r16,high(RAMEND); Main program start
0x1F001
0x1F002
out
ldi
SPH,r16
; Set Stack Pointer to top of RAM
r16,low(RAMEND)
SPL,r16
0x1F003
0x1F004
out
sei
; Enable interrupts
0x1F005
<instr> xxx
When the BOOTRST Fuse is programmed, the Boot section size set to 8K bytes and the IVSEL
bit in the MCUCR Register is set before any interrupts are enabled, the most typical and general
program setup for the Reset and Interrupt Vector Addresses is:
Address Labels Code
Comments
;
.org 0x1F000
0x1F000
0x1F002
jmp
jmp
RESET
EXT_INT0
; Reset handler
; IRQ0 Handler
0x1F004
...
jmp
...
jmp
EXT_INT1
...
; IRQ1 Handler
;
0x1F070
;
USART3_TXC
; USART3 TX Complete Handler
0x1F072 RESET: ldi
r16,high(RAMEND) ; Main program start
0x1F073
0x1F074
out
ldi
SPH,r16
; Set Stack Pointer to top of RAM
r16,low(RAMEND)
SPL,r16
0x1F075
0x1F076
out
sei
; Enable interrupts
0x1FO77
<instr> xxx
14.3 Moving Interrupts Between Application and Boot Section
The MCU Control Register controls the placement of the Interrupt Vector table, see Code Exam-
ple below. For more details, see “Reset and Interrupt Handling” on page 17.
109
2549L–AVR–08/07
Assembly Code Example
Move_interrupts:
; Get MCUCR
in r16, MCUCR
mov r17, r16
; Enable change of Interrupt Vectors
ori r16, (1<<IVCE)
out MCUCR, r16
; Move interrupts to Boot Flash section
ori r16, (1<<IVSEL)
out MCUCR, r17
ret
C Code Example
void Move_interrupts(void)
{
uchar temp;
/* Get MCUCR*/
temp = MCUCR;
/* Enable change of Interrupt Vectors */
MCUCR = temp|(1<<IVCE);
/* Move interrupts to Boot Flash section */
MCUCR = temp|(1<<IVSEL);
}
14.4 Register Description
14.4.1
MCUCR – MCU Control Register
Bit
7
6
–
5
–
4
3
–
2
–
1
IVSEL
R/W
0
0
IVCE
R/W
0
0x35 (0x55)
Read/Write
Initial Value
JTD
R/W
0
PUD
R/W
0
MCUCR
R
0
R
0
R
0
R
0
• Bit 1 – IVSEL: Interrupt Vector Select
When the IVSEL bit is cleared (zero), the Interrupt Vectors are placed at the start of the Flash
memory. When this bit is set (one), the Interrupt Vectors are moved to the beginning of the Boot
Loader section of the Flash. The actual address of the start of the Boot Flash Section is deter-
mined by the BOOTSZ Fuses. Refer to the section “Memory Programming” on page 337 for
details. To avoid unintentional changes of Interrupt Vector tables, a special write procedure must
be followed to change the IVSEL bit (see “Moving Interrupts Between Application and Boot Sec-
tion” on page 109):
1. Write the Interrupt Vector Change Enable (IVCE) bit to one.
2. Within four cycles, write the desired value to IVSEL while writing a zero to IVCE.
110
ATmega640/1280/1281/2560/2561
2549L–AVR–08/07
ATmega640/1280/1281/2560/2561
Interrupts will automatically be disabled while this sequence is executed. Interrupts are disabled
in the cycle IVCE is set, and they remain disabled until after the instruction following the write to
IVSEL. If IVSEL is not written, interrupts remain disabled for four cycles. The I-bit in the Status
Register is unaffected by the automatic disabling.
Note:
If Interrupt Vectors are placed in the Boot Loader section and Boot Lock bit BLB02 is programmed,
interrupts are disabled while executing from the Application section. If Interrupt Vectors are placed
in the Application section and Boot Lock bit BLB12 is programed, interrupts are disabled while
executing from the Boot Loader section. Refer to the section “Memory Programming” on page 337
for details on Boot Lock bits.
• Bit 0 – IVCE: Interrupt Vector Change Enable
The IVCE bit must be written to logic one to enable change of the IVSEL bit. IVCE is cleared by
hardware four cycles after it is written or when IVSEL is written. Setting the IVCE bit will disable
interrupts, as explained in the IVSEL description.
111
2549L–AVR–08/07
15. External Interrupts
The External Interrupts are triggered by the INT7:0 pin or any of the PCINT23:0 pins. Observe
that, if enabled, the interrupts will trigger even if the INT7:0 or PCINT23:0 pins are configured as
outputs. This feature provides a way of generating a software interrupt.
The Pin change interrupt PCI2 will trigger if any enabled PCINT23:16 pin toggles, Pin change
interrupt PCI1 if any enabled PCINT15:8 toggles and Pin change interrupts PCI0 will trigger if
any enabled PCINT7:0 pin toggles. PCMSK2, PCMSK1 and PCMSK0 Registers control which
pins contribute to the pin change interrupts. Pin change interrupts on PCINT23 :0 are detected
asynchronously. This implies that these interrupts can be used for waking the part also from
sleep modes other than Idle mode.
The External Interrupts can be triggered by a falling or rising edge or a low level. This is set up
as indicated in the specification for the External Interrupt Control Registers – EICRA (INT3:0)
and EICRB (INT7:4). When the external interrupt is enabled and is configured as level triggered,
the interrupt will trigger as long as the pin is held low. Note that recognition of falling or rising
edge interrupts on INT7:4 requires the presence of an I/O clock, described in “Overview” on
page 39. Low level interrupts and the edge interrupt on INT3:0 are detected asynchronously.
This implies that these interrupts can be used for waking the part also from sleep modes other
than Idle mode. The I/O clock is halted in all sleep modes except Idle mode.
Note that if a level triggered interrupt is used for wake-up from Power-down, the required level
must be held long enough for the MCU to complete the wake-up to trigger the level interrupt. If
the level disappears before the end of the Start-up Time, the MCU will still wake up, but no inter-
rupt will be generated. The start-up time is defined by the SUT and CKSEL Fuses as described
in “System Clock and Clock Options” on page 39.
15.1 Pin Change Interrupt Timing
An example of timing of a pin change interrupt is shown in Figure 15-1.
112
ATmega640/1280/1281/2560/2561
2549L–AVR–08/07
ATmega640/1280/1281/2560/2561
Figure 15-1. Normal pin change interrupt.
pcint_in_(0)
pin_lat
pcint_setflag
0
x
pcint_syn
PCINT(0)
clk
D
Q
PCIF
LE
pin_sync
PCINT(0) in PCMSK(x)
clk
clk
PCINT(n)
pin_lat
pin_sync
pcint_in_(n)
pcint_syn
pcint_setflag
PCIF
15.2 Register Description
15.2.1
EICRA – External Interrupt Control Register A
The External Interrupt Control Register A contains control bits for interrupt sense control.
Bit
7
ISC31
R/W
0
6
ISC30
R/W
0
5
ISC21
R/W
0
4
ISC20
R/W
0
3
ISC11
R/W
0
2
ISC10
R/W
0
1
ISC01
R/W
0
0
ISC00
R/W
0
(0x69)
EICRA
Read/Write
Initial Value
• Bits 7:0 – ISC31, ISC30 – ISC00, ISC00: External Interrupt 3 - 0 Sense Control Bits
The External Interrupts 3 - 0 are activated by the external pins INT3:0 if the SREG I-flag and the
corresponding interrupt mask in the EIMSK is set. The level and edges on the external pins that
activate the interrupts are defined in Table 15-1. Edges on INT3:0 are registered asynchro-
nously. Pulses on INT3:0 pins wider than the minimum pulse width given in Table 15-2 will
generate an interrupt. Shorter pulses are not guaranteed to generate an interrupt. If low level
interrupt is selected, the low level must be held until the completion of the currently executing
instruction to generate an interrupt. If enabled, a level triggered interrupt will generate an inter-
rupt request as long as the pin is held low. When changing the ISCn bit, an interrupt can occur.
Therefore, it is recommended to first disable INTn by clearing its Interrupt Enable bit in the
EIMSK Register. Then, the ISCn bit can be changed. Finally, the INTn interrupt flag should be
cleared by writing a logical one to its Interrupt Flag bit (INTFn) in the EIFR Register before the
interrupt is re-enabled.
113
2549L–AVR–08/07
Table 15-1.
Interrupt Sense Control(1)
ISCn0
ISCn1
Description
0
0
1
1
0
1
0
1
The low level of INTn generates an interrupt request.
Any edge of INTn generates asynchronously an interrupt request.
The falling edge of INTn generates asynchronously an interrupt request.
The rising edge of INTn generates asynchronously an interrupt request.
Note:
1. n = 3, 2, 1or 0.
When changing the ISCn1/ISCn0 bits, the interrupt must be disabled by clearing its Interrupt
Enable bit in the EIMSK Register. Otherwise an interrupt can occur when the bits are changed.
Table 15-2. Asynchronous External Interrupt Characteristics
Symbol
Parameter
Condition
Min
Typ
Max
Units
Minimum pulse width for asynchronous
external interrupt
tINT
50
ns
15.2.2
EICRB – External Interrupt Control Register B
Bit
7
ISC71
R/W
0
6
ISC70
R/W
0
5
ISC61
R/W
0
4
ISC60
R/W
0
3
2
1
0
(0x6A)
ISC51
R/W
0
ISC50
R/W
0
ISC41
R/W
0
ISC40
R/W
0
EICRB
Read/Write
Initial Value
• Bits 7:0 – ISC71, ISC70 - ISC41, ISC40: External Interrupt 7 - 4 Sense Control Bits
The External Interrupts 7 - 4 are activated by the external pins INT7:4 if the SREG I-flag and the
corresponding interrupt mask in the EIMSK is set. The level and edges on the external pins that
activate the interrupts are defined in Table 15-3. The value on the INT7:4 pins are sampled
before detecting edges. If edge or toggle interrupt is selected, pulses that last longer than one
clock period will generate an interrupt. Shorter pulses are not guaranteed to generate an inter-
rupt. Observe that CPU clock frequency can be lower than the XTAL frequency if the XTAL
divider is enabled. If low level interrupt is selected, the low level must be held until the comple-
tion of the currently executing instruction to generate an interrupt. If enabled, a level triggered
interrupt will generate an interrupt request as long as the pin is held low.
Table 15-3.
Interrupt Sense Control(1)
ISCn0
ISCn1
Description
0
0
1
1
0
1
0
1
The low level of INTn generates an interrupt request.
Any logical change on INTn generates an interrupt request
The falling edge between two samples of INTn generates an interrupt request.
The rising edge between two samples of INTn generates an interrupt request.
Note:
1. n = 7, 6, 5 or 4.
When changing the ISCn1/ISCn0 bits, the interrupt must be disabled by clearing its Interrupt
Enable bit in the EIMSK Register. Otherwise an interrupt can occur when the bits are changed.
114
ATmega640/1280/1281/2560/2561
2549L–AVR–08/07
ATmega640/1280/1281/2560/2561
15.2.3
EIMSK – External Interrupt Mask Register
Bit
7
6
5
4
3
2
1
0
0x1D (0x3D)
Read/Write
Initial Value
INT7
R/W
0
INT6
R/W
0
INT5
R/W
0
INT4
R/W
0
INT3
R/W
0
INT2
R/W
0
INT1
R/W
0
INT0
R/W
0
EIMSK
• Bits 7:0 – INT7:0: External Interrupt Request 7 - 0 Enable
When an INT7:0 bit is written to one and the I-bit in the Status Register (SREG) is set (one), the
corresponding external pin interrupt is enabled. The Interrupt Sense Control bits in the External
Interrupt Control Registers – EICRA and EICRB – defines whether the external interrupt is acti-
vated on rising or falling edge or level sensed. Activity on any of these pins will trigger an
interrupt request even if the pin is enabled as an output. This provides a way of generating a
software interrupt.
15.2.4
EIFR – External Interrupt Flag Register
Bit
0x1C (0x3C)
7
6
5
INTF5
R/W
0
4
INTF4
R/W
0
3
INTF3
R/W
0
2
INTF2
R/W
0
1
INTF1
R/W
0
0
IINTF0
R/W
0
INTF7
INTF6
R/W
0
EIFR
Read/Write
R/W
Initial Value
0
• Bits 7:0 – INTF7:0: External Interrupt Flags 7 - 0
When an edge or logic change on the INT7:0 pin triggers an interrupt request, INTF7:0 becomes
set (one). If the I-bit in SREG and the corresponding interrupt enable bit, INT7:0 in EIMSK, are
set (one), the MCU will jump to the interrupt vector. The flag is cleared when the interrupt routine
is executed. Alternatively, the flag can be cleared by writing a logical one to it. These flags are
always cleared when INT7:0 are configured as level interrupt. Note that when entering sleep
mode with the INT3:0 interrupts disabled, the input buffers on these pins will be disabled. This
may cause a logic change in internal signals which will set the INTF3:0 flags. See “Digital Input
Enable and Sleep Modes” on page 74 for more information.
15.2.5
PCICR – Pin Change Interrupt Control Register
Bit
(0x68)
7
6
5
–
4
–
3
–
2
PCIE2
R/W
0
1
PCIE1
R/W
0
0
PCIE0
R/W
0
–
–
PCICR
Read/Write
R
0
R
0
R
0
R
0
R
0
Initial Value
• Bit 2 – PCIE2: Pin Change Interrupt Enable 1
When the PCIE2 bit is set (one) and the I-bit in the Status Register (SREG) is set (one), pin
change interrupt 2 is enabled. Any change on any enabled PCINT23:16 pin will cause an inter-
rupt. The corresponding interrupt of Pin Change Interrupt Request is executed from the PCI2
Interrupt Vector. PCINT23:16 pins are enabled individually by the PCMSK2 Register.
• Bit 1 – PCIE1: Pin Change Interrupt Enable 1
When the PCIE1 bit is set (one) and the I-bit in the Status Register (SREG) is set (one), pin
change interrupt 1 is enabled. Any change on any enabled PCINT15:8 pin will cause an inter-
rupt. The corresponding interrupt of Pin Change Interrupt Request is executed from the PCI1
Interrupt Vector. PCINT15:8 pins are enabled individually by the PCMSK1 Register.
• Bit 0 – PCIE0: Pin Change Interrupt Enable 0
115
2549L–AVR–08/07
When the PCIE0 bit is set (one) and the I-bit in the Status Register (SREG) is set (one), pin
change interrupt 0 is enabled. Any change on any enabled PCINT7:0 pin will cause an interrupt.
The corresponding interrupt of Pin Change Interrupt Request is executed from the PCI0 Interrupt
Vector. PCINT7:0 pins are enabled individually by the PCMSK0 Register.
15.2.6
PCIFR – Pin Change Interrupt Flag Register
Bit
0x1B (0x3B)
7
6
5
–
4
–
3
–
2
PCIF2
R/W
0
1
PCIF1
R/W
0
0
PCIF0
R/W
0
–
–
PCIFR
Read/Write
R
0
R
0
R
0
R
0
R
0
Initial Value
• Bit 2 – PCIF2: Pin Change Interrupt Flag 1
When a logic change on any PCINT23:16 pin triggers an interrupt request, PCIF2 becomes set
(one). If the I-bit in SREG and the PCIE2 bit in PCICR are set (one), the MCU will jump to the
corresponding Interrupt Vector. The flag is cleared when the interrupt routine is executed. Alter-
natively, the flag can be cleared by writing a logical one to it.
• Bit 1 – PCIF1: Pin Change Interrupt Flag 1
When a logic change on any PCINT15:8 pin triggers an interrupt request, PCIF1 becomes set
(one). If the I-bit in SREG and the PCIE1 bit in PCICR are set (one), the MCU will jump to the
corresponding Interrupt Vector. The flag is cleared when the interrupt routine is executed. Alter-
natively, the flag can be cleared by writing a logical one to it.
• Bit 0 – PCIF0: Pin Change Interrupt Flag 0
When a logic change on any PCINT7:0 pin triggers an interrupt request, PCIF0 becomes set
(one). If the I-bit in SREG and the PCIE0 bit in PCICR are set (one), the MCU will jump to the
corresponding Interrupt Vector. The flag is cleared when the interrupt routine is executed. Alter-
natively, the flag can be cleared by writing a logical one to it.
15.2.7
PCMSK2 – Pin Change Mask Register 2
Bit
7
6
5
PCINT21
R/W
0
4
PCINT20
R/W
0
3
PCINT19
R/W
0
2
PCINT18
R/W
0
1
PCINT17
R/W
0
0
PCINT16
R/W
0
PCINT23
R/W
0
PCINT22
R/W
0
PCMSK2
(0x6D)
Read/Write
Initial Value
• Bit 7:0 – PCINT23:16: Pin Change Enable Mask 23:16
Each PCINT23:16-bit selects whether pin change interrupt is enabled on the corresponding I/O
pin. If PCINT23:16 is set and the PCIE2 bit in PCICR is set, pin change interrupt is enabled on
the corresponding I/O pin. If PCINT23:16 is cleared, pin change interrupt on the corresponding
I/O pin is disabled.
15.2.8
PCMSK1 – Pin Change Mask Register 1
Bit
7
6
5
PCINT13
R/W
0
4
PCINT12
R/W
0
3
PCINT11
R/W
0
2
PCINT10
R/W
0
1
PCINT9
R/W
0
0
PCINT8
R/W
0
PCINT15
R/W
0
PCINT14
R/W
0
PCMSK1
(0x6C)
Read/Write
Initial Value
• Bit 7:0 – PCINT15:8: Pin Change Enable Mask 15:8
Each PCINT15:8-bit selects whether pin change interrupt is enabled on the corresponding I/O
pin. If PCINT15:8 is set and the PCIE1 bit in EIMSK is set, pin change interrupt is enabled on the
116
ATmega640/1280/1281/2560/2561
2549L–AVR–08/07
ATmega640/1280/1281/2560/2561
corresponding I/O pin. If PCINT15:8 is cleared, pin change interrupt on the corresponding I/O
pin is disabled.
15.2.9
PCMSK0 – Pin Change Mask Register 0
Bit
(0x6B)
7
6
5
4
3
2
1
0
PCINT7
PCINT6
PCINT5
R/W
0
PCINT4
R/W
0
PCINT3
R/W
0
PCINT2
R/W
0
PCINT1
R/W
0
PCINT0
R/W
0
PCMSK0
Read/Write
R/W
R/W
Initial Value
0
0
• Bit 7:0 – PCINT7:0: Pin Change Enable Mask 7:0
Each PCINT7:0 bit selects whether pin change interrupt is enabled on the corresponding I/O pin.
If PCINT7:0 is set and the PCIE0 bit in PCICR is set, pin change interrupt is enabled on the cor-
responding I/O pin. If PCINT7:0 is cleared, pin change interrupt on the corresponding I/O pin is
disabled.
117
2549L–AVR–08/07
16. 8-bit Timer/Counter0 with PWM
16.1 Features
• Two Independent Output Compare Units
• Double Buffered Output Compare Registers
• Clear Timer on Compare Match (Auto Reload)
• Glitch Free, Phase Correct Pulse Width Modulator (PWM)
• Variable PWM Period
• Frequency Generator
• Three Independent Interrupt Sources (TOV0, OCF0A, and OCF0B)
16.2 Overview
Timer/Counter0 is a general purpose 8-bit Timer/Counter module, with two independent Output
Compare Units, and with PWM support. It allows accurate program execution timing (event man-
agement) and wave generation.
A simplified block diagram of the 8-bit Timer/Counter is shown in Figure 16-1. For the actual
placement of I/O pins, refer to “TQFP-pinout ATmega640/1280/2560” on page 2. CPU accessi-
ble I/O Registers, including I/O bits and I/O pins, are shown in bold. The device-specific I/O
Register and bit locations are listed in the “Register Description” on page 129.
Figure 16-1. 8-bit Timer/Counter Block Diagram
Count
TOVn
(Int.Req.)
Clear
Control Logic
Clock Select
Direction
clkTn
Edge
Detector
Tn
TOP
BOTTOM
( From Prescaler )
Timer/Counter
TCNTn
=
=
0
OCnA
(Int.Req.)
Waveform
Generation
OCnA
OCnB
=
OCRnA
Fixed
TOP
Value
OCnB
(Int.Req.)
Waveform
Generation
=
OCRnB
TCCRnA
TCCRnB
16.2.1
Registers
The Timer/Counter (TCNT0) and Output Compare Registers (OCR0A and OCR0B) are 8-bit
registers. Interrupt request (abbreviated to Int.Req. in the figure) signals are all visible in the
Timer Interrupt Flag Register (TIFR0). All interrupts are individually masked with the Timer Inter-
rupt Mask Register (TIMSK0). TIFR0 and TIMSK0 are not shown in the figure.
The Timer/Counter can be clocked internally, via the prescaler, or by an external clock source on
the T0 pin. The Clock Select logic block controls which clock source and edge the Timer/Counter
118
ATmega640/1280/1281/2560/2561
2549L–AVR–08/07
ATmega640/1280/1281/2560/2561
uses to increment (or decrement) its value. The Timer/Counter is inactive when no clock source
is selected. The output from the Clock Select logic is referred to as the timer clock (clkT0).
The double buffered Output Compare Registers (OCR0A and OCR0B) are compared with the
Timer/Counter value at all times. The result of the compare can be used by the Waveform Gen-
erator to generate a PWM or variable frequency output on the Output Compare pins (OC0A and
OC0B). See “Output Compare Unit” on page 120. for details. The Compare Match event will also
set the Compare Flag (OCF0A or OCF0B) which can be used to generate an Output Compare
interrupt request.
16.2.2
Definitions
Many register and bit references in this section are written in general form. A lower case “n”
replaces the Timer/Counter number, in this case 0. A lower case “x” replaces the Output Com-
pare Unit, in this case Compare Unit A or Compare Unit B. However, when using the register or
bit defines in a program, the precise form must be used, i.e., TCNT0 for accessing
Timer/Counter0 counter value and so on.
The definitions in Table 16-1 are also used extensively throughout the document.
Table 16-1. Definitions
BOTTOM
MAX
The counter reaches the BOTTOM when it becomes 0x00.
The counter reaches its MAXimum when it becomes 0xFF (decimal 255).
TOP
The counter reaches the TOP when it becomes equal to the highest value in the
count sequence. The TOP value can be assigned to be the fixed value 0xFF
(MAX) or the value stored in the OCR0A Register. The assignment is depen-
dent on the mode of operation.
16.3 Timer/Counter Clock Sources
The Timer/Counter can be clocked by an internal or an external clock source. The clock source
is selected by the Clock Select logic which is controlled by the Clock Select (CS02:0) bits
located in the Timer/Counter Control Register (TCCR0B). For details on clock sources and pres-
caler, see “Timer/Counter 0, 1, 3, 4, and 5 Prescaler” on page 170.
16.4 Counter Unit
The main part of the 8-bit Timer/Counter is the programmable bi-directional counter unit. Figure
16-2 shows a block diagram of the counter and its surroundings.
Figure 16-2. Counter Unit Block Diagram
TOVn
(Int.Req.)
DATA BUS
Clock Select
count
clear
Edge
Detector
Tn
clkTn
TCNTn
Control Logic
direction
( From Prescaler )
bottom
top
119
2549L–AVR–08/07
Signal description (internal signals):
count
direction
clear
Increment or decrement TCNT0 by 1.
Select between increment and decrement.
Clear TCNT0 (set all bits to zero).
clkTn
Timer/Counter clock, referred to as clkT0 in the following.
Signalize that TCNT0 has reached maximum value.
Signalize that TCNT0 has reached minimum value (zero).
top
bottom
Depending of the mode of operation used, the counter is cleared, incremented, or decremented
at each timer clock (clkT0). clkT0 can be generated from an external or internal clock source,
selected by the Clock Select bits (CS02:0). When no clock source is selected (CS02:0 = 0) the
timer is stopped. However, the TCNT0 value can be accessed by the CPU, regardless of
whether clkT0 is present or not. A CPU write overrides (has priority over) all counter clear or
count operations.
The counting sequence is determined by the setting of the WGM01 and WGM00 bits located in
the Timer/Counter Control Register (TCCR0A) and the WGM02 bit located in the Timer/Counter
Control Register B (TCCR0B). There are close connections between how the counter behaves
(counts) and how waveforms are generated on the Output Compare outputs OC0A and OC0B.
For more details about advanced counting sequences and waveform generation, see “Modes of
Operation” on page 123.
The Timer/Counter Overflow Flag (TOV0) is set according to the mode of operation selected by
the WGM02:0 bits. TOV0 can be used for generating a CPU interrupt.
16.5 Output Compare Unit
The 8-bit comparator continuously compares TCNT0 with the Output Compare Registers
(OCR0A and OCR0B). Whenever TCNT0 equals OCR0A or OCR0B, the comparator signals a
match. A match will set the Output Compare Flag (OCF0A or OCF0B) at the next timer clock
cycle. If the corresponding interrupt is enabled, the Output Compare Flag generates an Output
Compare interrupt. The Output Compare Flag is automatically cleared when the interrupt is exe-
cuted. Alternatively, the flag can be cleared by software by writing a logical one to its I/O bit
location. The Waveform Generator uses the match signal to generate an output according to
operating mode set by the WGM02:0 bits and Compare Output mode (COM0x1:0) bits. The max
and bottom signals are used by the Waveform Generator for handling the special cases of the
extreme values in some modes of operation (“Modes of Operation” on page 123).
Figure 16-3 shows a block diagram of the Output Compare unit.
120
ATmega640/1280/1281/2560/2561
2549L–AVR–08/07
ATmega640/1280/1281/2560/2561
Figure 16-3. Output Compare Unit, Block Diagram
DATA BUS
OCRnx
TCNTn
= (8-bit Comparator )
OCFnx (Int.Req.)
top
bottom
FOCn
Waveform Generator
OCnx
WGMn1:0
COMnX1:0
The OCR0x Registers are double buffered when using any of the Pulse Width Modulation
(PWM) modes. For the normal and Clear Timer on Compare (CTC) modes of operation, the dou-
ble buffering is disabled. The double buffering synchronizes the update of the OCR0x Compare
Registers to either top or bottom of the counting sequence. The synchronization prevents the
occurrence of odd-length, non-symmetrical PWM pulses, thereby making the output glitch-free.
The OCR0x Register access may seem complex, but this is not case. When the double buffering
is enabled, the CPU has access to the OCR0x Buffer Register, and if double buffering is dis-
abled the CPU will access the OCR0x directly.
16.5.1
Force Output Compare
In non-PWM waveform generation modes, the match output of the comparator can be forced by
writing a one to the Force Output Compare (FOC0x) bit. Forcing Compare Match will not set the
OCF0x Flag or reload/clear the timer, but the OC0x pin will be updated as if a real Compare
Match had occurred (the COM0x1:0 bits settings define whether the OC0x pin is set, cleared or
toggled).
16.5.2
16.5.3
Compare Match Blocking by TCNT0 Write
All CPU write operations to the TCNT0 Register will block any Compare Match that occur in the
next timer clock cycle, even when the timer is stopped. This feature allows OCR0x to be initial-
ized to the same value as TCNT0 without triggering an interrupt when the Timer/Counter clock is
enabled.
Using the Output Compare Unit
Since writing TCNT0 in any mode of operation will block all Compare Matches for one timer
clock cycle, there are risks involved when changing TCNT0 when using the Output Compare
Unit, independently of whether the Timer/Counter is running or not. If the value written to TCNT0
equals the OCR0x value, the Compare Match will be missed, resulting in incorrect waveform
121
2549L–AVR–08/07
generation. Similarly, do not write the TCNT0 value equal to BOTTOM when the counter is
down-counting.
The setup of the OC0x should be performed before setting the Data Direction Register for the
port pin to output. The easiest way of setting the OC0x value is to use the Force Output Com-
pare (FOC0x) strobe bits in Normal mode. The OC0x Registers keep their values even when
changing between Waveform Generation modes.
Be aware that the COM0x1:0 bits are not double buffered together with the compare value.
Changing the COM0x1:0 bits will take effect immediately.
16.6 Compare Match Output Unit
The Compare Output mode (COM0x1:0) bits have two functions. The Waveform Generator uses
the COM0x1:0 bits for defining the Output Compare (OC0x) state at the next Compare Match.
Also, the COM0x1:0 bits control the OC0x pin output source. Figure 16-4 shows a simplified
schematic of the logic affected by the COM0x1:0 bit setting. The I/O Registers, I/O bits, and I/O
pins in the figure are shown in bold. Only the parts of the general I/O Port Control Registers
(DDR and PORT) that are affected by the COM0x1:0 bits are shown. When referring to the
OC0x state, the reference is for the internal OC0x Register, not the OC0x pin. If a system reset
occur, the OC0x Register is reset to “0”.
Figure 16-4. Compare Match Output Unit, Schematic
COMnx1
Waveform
Generator
COMnx0
FOCn
D
Q
1
0
OCnx
Pin
OCnx
D
Q
PORT
D
Q
DDR
clkI/O
The general I/O port function is overridden by the Output Compare (OC0x) from the Waveform
Generator if either of the COM0x1:0 bits are set. However, the OC0x pin direction (input or out-
put) is still controlled by the Data Direction Register (DDR) for the port pin. The Data Direction
Register bit for the OC0x pin (DDR_OC0x) must be set as output before the OC0x value is visi-
ble on the pin. The port override function is independent of the Waveform Generation mode.
The design of the Output Compare pin logic allows initialization of the OC0x state before the out-
put is enabled. Note that some COM0x1:0 bit settings are reserved for certain modes of
operation. “Register Description” on page 129.
122
ATmega640/1280/1281/2560/2561
2549L–AVR–08/07
ATmega640/1280/1281/2560/2561
16.6.1
Compare Output Mode and Waveform Generation
The Waveform Generator uses the COM0x1:0 bits differently in Normal, CTC, and PWM modes.
For all modes, setting the COM0x1:0 = 0 tells the Waveform Generator that no action on the
OC0x Register is to be performed on the next Compare Match. For compare output actions in
the non-PWM modes refer to Table 16-2 on page 129. For fast PWM mode, refer to Table 16-3
on page 129, and for phase correct PWM refer to Table 16-4 on page 130.
A change of the COM0x1:0 bits state will have effect at the first Compare Match after the bits are
written. For non-PWM modes, the action can be forced to have immediate effect by using the
FOC0x strobe bits.
16.7 Modes of Operation
The mode of operation, i.e., the behavior of the Timer/Counter and the Output Compare pins, is
defined by the combination of the Waveform Generation mode (WGM02:0) and Compare Output
mode (COM0x1:0) bits. The Compare Output mode bits do not affect the counting sequence,
while the Waveform Generation mode bits do. The COM0x1:0 bits control whether the PWM out-
put generated should be inverted or not (inverted or non-inverted PWM). For non-PWM modes
the COM0x1:0 bits control whether the output should be set, cleared, or toggled at a Compare
Match (See “Compare Match Output Unit” on page 147.).
For detailed timing information see “Timer/Counter Timing Diagrams” on page 127.
16.7.1
Normal Mode
The simplest mode of operation is the Normal mode (WGM02:0 = 0). In this mode the counting
direction is always up (incrementing), and no counter clear is performed. The counter simply
overruns when it passes its maximum 8-bit value (TOP = 0xFF) and then restarts from the bot-
tom (0x00). In normal operation the Timer/Counter Overflow Flag (TOV0) will be set in the same
timer clock cycle as the TCNT0 becomes zero. The TOV0 Flag in this case behaves like a ninth
bit, except that it is only set, not cleared. However, combined with the timer overflow interrupt
that automatically clears the TOV0 Flag, the timer resolution can be increased by software.
There are no special cases to consider in the Normal mode, a new counter value can be written
anytime.
The Output Compare Unit can be used to generate interrupts at some given time. Using the Out-
put Compare to generate waveforms in Normal mode is not recommended, since this will
occupy too much of the CPU time.
16.7.2
Clear Timer on Compare Match (CTC) Mode
In Clear Timer on Compare or CTC mode (WGM02:0 = 2), the OCR0A Register is used to
manipulate the counter resolution. In CTC mode the counter is cleared to zero when the counter
value (TCNT0) matches the OCR0A. The OCR0A defines the top value for the counter, hence
also its resolution. This mode allows greater control of the Compare Match output frequency. It
also simplifies the operation of counting external events.
The timing diagram for the CTC mode is shown in Figure 16-5. The counter value (TCNT0)
increases until a Compare Match occurs between TCNT0 and OCR0A, and then counter
(TCNT0) is cleared.
123
2549L–AVR–08/07
Figure 16-5. CTC Mode, Timing Diagram
OCnx Interrupt Flag Set
TCNTn
OCn
(Toggle)
(COMnx1:0 = 1)
1
2
3
4
Period
An interrupt can be generated each time the counter value reaches the TOP value by using the
OCF0A Flag. If the interrupt is enabled, the interrupt handler routine can be used for updating
the TOP value. However, changing TOP to a value close to BOTTOM when the counter is run-
ning with none or a low prescaler value must be done with care since the CTC mode does not
have the double buffering feature. If the new value written to OCR0A is lower than the current
value of TCNT0, the counter will miss the Compare Match. The counter will then have to count to
its maximum value (0xFF) and wrap around starting at 0x00 before the Compare Match can
occur.
For generating a waveform output in CTC mode, the OC0A output can be set to toggle its logical
level on each Compare Match by setting the Compare Output mode bits to toggle mode
(COM0A1:0 = 1). The OC0A value will not be visible on the port pin unless the data direction for
the pin is set to output. The waveform generated will have a maximum frequency of fOC0
clk_I/O/2 when OCR0A is set to zero (0x00). The waveform frequency is defined by the following
equation:
=
f
f
clk_I/O
f
= -------------------------------------------------
OCnx
2 ⋅ N ⋅ (1 + OCRnx)
The N variable represents the prescale factor (1, 8, 64, 256, or 1024).
As for the Normal mode of operation, the TOV0 Flag is set in the same timer clock cycle that the
counter counts from MAX to 0x00.
16.7.3
Fast PWM Mode
The fast Pulse Width Modulation or fast PWM mode (WGM02:0 = 3 or 7) provides a high fre-
quency PWM waveform generation option. The fast PWM differs from the other PWM option by
its single-slope operation. The counter counts from BOTTOM to TOP then restarts from BOT-
TOM. TOP is defined as 0xFF when WGM2:0 = 3, and OCR0A when WGM2:0 = 7. In non-
inverting Compare Output mode, the Output Compare (OC0x) is cleared on the Compare Match
between TCNT0 and OCR0x, and set at BOTTOM. In inverting Compare Output mode, the out-
put is set on Compare Match and cleared at BOTTOM. Due to the single-slope operation, the
operating frequency of the fast PWM mode can be twice as high as the phase correct PWM
mode that use dual-slope operation. This high frequency makes the fast PWM mode well suited
for power regulation, rectification, and DAC applications. High frequency allows physically small
sized external components (coils, capacitors), and therefore reduces total system cost.
In fast PWM mode, the counter is incremented until the counter value matches the TOP value.
The counter is then cleared at the following timer clock cycle. The timing diagram for the fast
124
ATmega640/1280/1281/2560/2561
2549L–AVR–08/07
ATmega640/1280/1281/2560/2561
PWM mode is shown in Figure 16-6. The TCNT0 value is in the timing diagram shown as a his-
togram for illustrating the single-slope operation. The diagram includes non-inverted and
inverted PWM outputs. The small horizontal line marks on the TCNT0 slopes represent Com-
pare Matches between OCR0x and TCNT0.
Figure 16-6. Fast PWM Mode, Timing Diagram
OCRnx Interrupt Flag Set
OCRnx Update and
TOVn Interrupt Flag Set
TCNTn
(COMnx1:0 = 2)
(COMnx1:0 = 3)
OCnx
OCnx
1
2
3
4
5
6
7
Period
The Timer/Counter Overflow Flag (TOV0) is set each time the counter reaches TOP. If the inter-
rupt is enabled, the interrupt handler routine can be used for updating the compare value.
In fast PWM mode, the compare unit allows generation of PWM waveforms on the OC0x pins.
Setting the COM0x1:0 bits to two will produce a non-inverted PWM and an inverted PWM output
can be generated by setting the COM0x1:0 to three: Setting the COM0A1:0 bits to one allows
the OC0A pin to toggle on Compare Matches if the WGM02 bit is set. This option is not available
for the OC0B pin (See Table 16-3 on page 129). The actual OC0x value will only be visible on
the port pin if the data direction for the port pin is set as output. The PWM waveform is gener-
ated by setting (or clearing) the OC0x Register at the Compare Match between OCR0x and
TCNT0, and clearing (or setting) the OC0x Register at the timer clock cycle the counter is
cleared (changes from TOP to BOTTOM).
The PWM frequency for the output can be calculated by the following equation:
f
clk_I/O
f
= -----------------
OCnxPWM
N ⋅ 256
The N variable represents the prescale factor (1, 8, 64, 256, or 1024).
The extreme values for the OCR0A Register represents special cases when generating a PWM
waveform output in the fast PWM mode. If the OCR0A is set equal to BOTTOM, the output will
be a narrow spike for each MAX+1 timer clock cycle. Setting the OCR0A equal to MAX will result
in a constantly high or low output (depending on the polarity of the output set by the COM0A1:0
bits.)
A frequency (with 50% duty cycle) waveform output in fast PWM mode can be achieved by set-
ting OC0x to toggle its logical level on each Compare Match (COM0x1:0 = 1). The waveform
generated will have a maximum frequency of fOC0 = fclk_I/O/2 when OCR0A is set to zero. This
125
2549L–AVR–08/07
feature is similar to the OC0A toggle in CTC mode, except the double buffer feature of the Out-
put Compare unit is enabled in the fast PWM mode.
16.7.4
Phase Correct PWM Mode
The phase correct PWM mode (WGM02:0 = 1 or 5) provides a high resolution phase correct
PWM waveform generation option. The phase correct PWM mode is based on a dual-slope
operation. The counter counts repeatedly from BOTTOM to TOP and then from TOP to BOT-
TOM. TOP is defined as 0xFF when WGM2:0 = 1, and OCR0A when WGM2:0 = 5. In non-
inverting Compare Output mode, the Output Compare (OC0x) is cleared on the Compare Match
between TCNT0 and OCR0x while upcounting, and set on the Compare Match while down-
counting. In inverting Output Compare mode, the operation is inverted. The dual-slope operation
has lower maximum operation frequency than single slope operation. However, due to the sym-
metric feature of the dual-slope PWM modes, these modes are preferred for motor control
applications.
In phase correct PWM mode the counter is incremented until the counter value matches TOP.
When the counter reaches TOP, it changes the count direction. The TCNT0 value will be equal
to TOP for one timer clock cycle. The timing diagram for the phase correct PWM mode is shown
on Figure 16-7. The TCNT0 value is in the timing diagram shown as a histogram for illustrating
the dual-slope operation. The diagram includes non-inverted and inverted PWM outputs. The
small horizontal line marks on the TCNT0 slopes represent Compare Matches between OCR0x
and TCNT0.
Figure 16-7. Phase Correct PWM Mode, Timing Diagram
OCnx Interrupt Flag Set
OCRnx Update
TOVn Interrupt Flag Set
TCNTn
(COMnx1:0 = 2)
OCnx
(COMnx1:0 = 3)
OCnx
1
2
3
Period
The Timer/Counter Overflow Flag (TOV0) is set each time the counter reaches BOTTOM. The
Interrupt Flag can be used to generate an interrupt each time the counter reaches the BOTTOM
value.
In phase correct PWM mode, the compare unit allows generation of PWM waveforms on the
OC0x pins. Setting the COM0x1:0 bits to two will produce a non-inverted PWM. An inverted
PWM output can be generated by setting the COM0x1:0 to three: Setting the COM0A0 bits to
126
ATmega640/1280/1281/2560/2561
2549L–AVR–08/07
ATmega640/1280/1281/2560/2561
one allows the OC0A pin to toggle on Compare Matches if the WGM02 bit is set. This option is
not available for the OC0B pin (See Table 16-4 on page 130). The actual OC0x value will only
be visible on the port pin if the data direction for the port pin is set as output. The PWM wave-
form is generated by clearing (or setting) the OC0x Register at the Compare Match between
OCR0x and TCNT0 when the counter increments, and setting (or clearing) the OC0x Register at
Compare Match between OCR0x and TCNT0 when the counter decrements. The PWM fre-
quency for the output when using phase correct PWM can be calculated by the following
equation:
f
clk_I/O
f
= -----------------
OCnxPCPWM
N ⋅ 510
The N variable represents the prescale factor (1, 8, 64, 256, or 1024).
The extreme values for the OCR0A Register represent special cases when generating a PWM
waveform output in the phase correct PWM mode. If the OCR0A is set equal to BOTTOM, the
output will be continuously low and if set equal to MAX the output will be continuously high for
non-inverted PWM mode. For inverted PWM the output will have the opposite logic values.
At the very start of period 2 in Figure 16-7 OCnx has a transition from high to low even though
there is no Compare Match. The point of this transition is to guarantee symmetry around BOT-
TOM. There are two cases that give a transition without Compare Match.
•
OCR0A changes its value from MAX, like in Figure 16-7. When the OCR0A value is MAX the
OCn pin value is the same as the result of a down-counting Compare Match. To ensure
symmetry around BOTTOM the OCn value at MAX must correspond to the result of an up-
counting Compare Match.
•
The timer starts counting from a value higher than the one in OCR0A, and for that reason
misses the Compare Match and hence the OCn change that would have happened on the
way up.
16.8 Timer/Counter Timing Diagrams
The Timer/Counter is a synchronous design and the timer clock (clkT0) is therefore shown as a
clock enable signal in the following figures. The figures include information on when Interrupt
Flags are set. Figure 16-8 contains timing data for basic Timer/Counter operation. The figure
shows the count sequence close to the MAX value in all modes other than phase correct PWM
mode.
Figure 16-8. Timer/Counter Timing Diagram, no Prescaling
clkI/O
clkTn
(clkI/O/1)
TCNTn
TOVn
MAX - 1
MAX
BOTTOM
BOTTOM + 1
Figure 16-9 shows the same timing data, but with the prescaler enabled.
127
2549L–AVR–08/07
Figure 16-9. Timer/Counter Timing Diagram, with Prescaler (fclk_I/O/8)
clkI/O
clkTn
(clkI/O/8)
TCNTn
TOVn
MAX - 1
MAX
BOTTOM
BOTTOM + 1
Figure 16-10 shows the setting of OCF0B in all modes and OCF0A in all modes except CTC
mode and PWM mode, where OCR0A is TOP.
Figure 16-10. Timer/Counter Timing Diagram, Setting of OCF0x, with Prescaler (fclk_I/O/8)
clkI/O
clkTn
(clkI/O/8)
TCNTn
OCRnx
OCFnx
OCRnx - 1
OCRnx
OCRnx + 1
OCRnx + 2
OCRnx Value
Figure 16-11 shows the setting of OCF0A and the clearing of TCNT0 in CTC mode and fast
PWM mode where OCR0A is TOP.
Figure 16-11. Timer/Counter Timing Diagram, Clear Timer on Compare Match mode, with Pres-
caler (fclk_I/O/8)
clkI/O
clkTn
(clkI/O/8)
TCNTn
(CTC)
TOP - 1
TOP
BOTTOM
BOTTOM + 1
OCRnx
TOP
OCFnx
128
ATmega640/1280/1281/2560/2561
2549L–AVR–08/07
ATmega640/1280/1281/2560/2561
16.9 Register Description
16.9.1
TCCR0A – Timer/Counter Control Register A
Bit
7
COM0A1
R/W
6
COM0A0
R/W
5
COM0B1
R/W
4
COM0B0
R/W
3
–
2
–
1
WGM01
R/W
0
0
WGM00
R/W
0
TCCR0A
0x24 (0x44)
Read/Write
Initial Value
R
0
R
0
0
0
0
0
• Bits 7:6 – COM0A1:0: Compare Match Output A Mode
These bits control the Output Compare pin (OC0A) behavior. If one or both of the COM0A1:0
bits are set, the OC0A output overrides the normal port functionality of the I/O pin it is connected
to. However, note that the Data Direction Register (DDR) bit corresponding to the OC0A pin
must be set in order to enable the output driver.
When OC0A is connected to the pin, the function of the COM0A1:0 bits depends on the
WGM02:0 bit setting. Table 16-2 shows the COM0A1:0 bit functionality when the WGM02:0 bits
are set to a normal or CTC mode (non-PWM).
Table 16-2. Compare Output Mode, non-PWM Mode
COM0A1
COM0A0
Description
0
0
1
1
0
1
0
1
Normal port operation, OC0A disconnected.
Toggle OC0A on Compare Match
Clear OC0A on Compare Match
Set OC0A on Compare Match
Table 16-3 shows the COM0A1:0 bit functionality when the WGM01:0 bits are set to fast PWM
mode.
Table 16-3. Compare Output Mode, Fast PWM Mode(1)
COM0A1
COM0A0
Description
0
0
Normal port operation, OC0A disconnected.
WGM02 = 0: Normal Port Operation, OC0A Disconnected.
WGM02 = 1: Toggle OC0A on Compare Match.
0
1
1
1
0
1
Clear OC0A on Compare Match, set OC0A at BOTTOM,
(non-inverting mode).
Set OC0A on Compare Match, clear OC0A at BOTTOM,
(inverting mode).
Note:
1. A special case occurs when OCR0A equals TOP and COM0A1 is set. In this case, the Com-
pare Match is ignored, but the set or clear is done at BOTTOM. See “Fast PWM Mode” on
page 124 for more details.
Table 16-4 on page 130 shows the COM0A1:0 bit functionality when the WGM02:0 bits are set
to phase correct PWM mode.
129
2549L–AVR–08/07
Table 16-4. Compare Output Mode, Phase Correct PWM Mode(1)
COM0A1
COM0A0
Description
0
0
Normal port operation, OC0A disconnected.
WGM02 = 0: Normal Port Operation, OC0A Disconnected.
WGM02 = 1: Toggle OC0A on Compare Match.
0
1
1
1
0
1
Clear OC0A on Compare Match when up-counting. Set OC0A on
Compare Match when down-counting.
Set OC0A on Compare Match when up-counting. Clear OC0A on
Compare Match when down-counting.
Note:
1. A special case occurs when OCR0A equals TOP and COM0A1 is set. In this case, the Com-
pare Match is ignored, but the set or clear is done at TOP. See “Phase Correct PWM Mode” on
page 126 for more details.
• Bits 5:4 – COM0B1:0: Compare Match Output B Mode
These bits control the Output Compare pin (OC0B) behavior. If one or both of the COM0B1:0
bits are set, the OC0B output overrides the normal port functionality of the I/O pin it is connected
to. However, note that the Data Direction Register (DDR) bit corresponding to the OC0B pin
must be set in order to enable the output driver.
When OC0B is connected to the pin, the function of the COM0B1:0 bits depends on the
WGM02:0 bit setting. Table 16-2 shows the COM0A1:0 bit functionality when the WGM02:0 bits
are set to a normal or CTC mode (non-PWM).
Table 16-5. Compare Output Mode, non-PWM Mode
COM0B1
COM0B0
Description
0
0
1
1
0
1
0
1
Normal port operation, OC0B disconnected.
Toggle OC0B on Compare Match
Clear OC0B on Compare Match
Set OC0B on Compare Match
Table 16-3 shows the COM0B1:0 bit functionality when the WGM02:0 bits are set to fast PWM
mode.
Table 16-6. Compare Output Mode, Fast PWM Mode(1)
COM0B1
COM0B0
Description
Normal port operation, OC0B disconnected.
Reserved
0
0
0
1
Clear OC0B on Compare Match, set OC0B at BOTTOM,
(non-inverting mode).
1
1
0
1
Set OC0B on Compare Match, clear OC0B at BOTTOM,
(inverting mode).
Note:
1. A special case occurs when OCR0B equals TOP and COM0B1 is set. In this case, the Com-
pare Match is ignored, but the set or clear is done at BOTTOM. See “Fast PWM Mode” on
page 124 for more details.
130
ATmega640/1280/1281/2560/2561
2549L–AVR–08/07
ATmega640/1280/1281/2560/2561
Table 16-4 shows the COM0B1:0 bit functionality when the WGM02:0 bits are set to phase cor-
rect PWM mode.
Table 16-7. Compare Output Mode, Phase Correct PWM Mode(1)
COM0B1
COM0B0
Description
Normal port operation, OC0B disconnected.
Reserved
0
0
0
1
Clear OC0B on Compare Match when up-counting. Set OC0B on
Compare Match when down-counting.
1
1
0
1
Set OC0B on Compare Match when up-counting. Clear OC0B on
Compare Match when down-counting.
Note:
1. A special case occurs when OCR0B equals TOP and COM0B1 is set. In this case, the Com-
pare Match is ignored, but the set or clear is done at TOP. See “Phase Correct PWM Mode” on
page 126 for more details.
• Bits 3, 2 – Res: Reserved Bits
These bits are reserved bits and will always read as zero.
• Bits 1:0 – WGM01:0: Waveform Generation Mode
Combined with the WGM02 bit found in the TCCR0B Register, these bits control the counting
sequence of the counter, the source for maximum (TOP) counter value, and what type of wave-
form generation to be used, see Table 16-8. Modes of operation supported by the Timer/Counter
unit are: Normal mode (counter), Clear Timer on Compare Match (CTC) mode, and two types of
Pulse Width Modulation (PWM) modes (see “Modes of Operation” on page 148).
Table 16-8. Waveform Generation Mode Bit Description
Timer/Counter
Mode of
Operation
Update of
OCRx at
TOV Flag
Mode
WGM2
WGM1
WGM0
TOP
Set on(1)(2)
0
0
0
0
Normal
0xFF
Immediate
TOP
MAX
PWM, Phase
1
0
0
1
0xFF
BOTTOM
Correct
2
3
4
0
0
1
1
1
0
0
1
0
CTC
OCRA
0xFF
–
Immediate
MAX
MAX
–
Fast PWM
Reserved
TOP
–
PWM, Phase
5
1
0
1
OCRA
TOP
BOTTOM
Correct
6
7
1
1
1
1
0
1
Reserved
–
–
–
Fast PWM
OCRA
BOTTOM
TOP
Note:
1. MAX
= 0xFF
2. BOTTOM = 0x00
131
2549L–AVR–08/07
16.9.2
TCCR0B – Timer/Counter Control Register B
Bit
7
FOC0A
W
6
FOC0B
W
5
–
4
–
3
WGM02
R/W
0
2
CS02
R/W
0
1
CS01
R/W
0
0
CS00
R/W
0
TCCR0B
0x25 (0x45)
Read/Write
Initial Value
R
0
R
0
0
0
• Bit 7 – FOC0A: Force Output Compare A
The FOC0A bit is only active when the WGM bits specify a non-PWM mode.
However, for ensuring compatibility with future devices, this bit must be set to zero when
TCCR0B is written when operating in PWM mode. When writing a logical one to the FOC0A bit,
an immediate Compare Match is forced on the Waveform Generation unit. The OC0A output is
changed according to its COM0A1:0 bits setting. Note that the FOC0A bit is implemented as a
strobe. Therefore it is the value present in the COM0A1:0 bits that determines the effect of the
forced compare.
A FOC0A strobe will not generate any interrupt, nor will it clear the timer in CTC mode using
OCR0A as TOP.
The FOC0A bit is always read as zero.
• Bit 6 – FOC0B: Force Output Compare B
The FOC0B bit is only active when the WGM bits specify a non-PWM mode.
However, for ensuring compatibility with future devices, this bit must be set to zero when
TCCR0B is written when operating in PWM mode. When writing a logical one to the FOC0B bit,
an immediate Compare Match is forced on the Waveform Generation unit. The OC0B output is
changed according to its COM0B1:0 bits setting. Note that the FOC0B bit is implemented as a
strobe. Therefore it is the value present in the COM0B1:0 bits that determines the effect of the
forced compare.
A FOC0B strobe will not generate any interrupt, nor will it clear the timer in CTC mode using
OCR0B as TOP.
The FOC0B bit is always read as zero.
• Bits 5:4 – Res: Reserved Bits
These bits are reserved bits and will always read as zero.
• Bit 3 – WGM02: Waveform Generation Mode
See the description in the “TCCR0A – Timer/Counter Control Register A” on page 129.
• Bits 2:0 – CS02:0: Clock Select
The three Clock Select bits select the clock source to be used by the Timer/Counter, see Table
16-9 on page 133.
132
ATmega640/1280/1281/2560/2561
2549L–AVR–08/07
ATmega640/1280/1281/2560/2561
Table 16-9. Clock Select Bit Description
CS02
CS01
CS00
Description
No clock source (Timer/Counter stopped)
clkI/O/(No prescaling)
0
0
0
0
1
1
1
1
0
0
1
1
0
0
1
1
0
1
0
1
0
1
0
1
clkI/O/8 (From prescaler)
clkI/O/64 (From prescaler)
clkI/O/256 (From prescaler)
clkI/O/1024 (From prescaler)
External clock source on T0 pin. Clock on falling edge.
External clock source on T0 pin. Clock on rising edge.
If external pin modes are used for the Timer/Counter0, transitions on the T0 pin will clock the
counter even if the pin is configured as an output. This feature allows software control of the
counting.
16.9.3
TCNT0 – Timer/Counter Register
Bit
7
6
5
4
3
2
1
0
0x26 (0x46)
Read/Write
Initial Value
TCNT0[7:0]
TCNT0
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
The Timer/Counter Register gives direct access, both for read and write operations, to the
Timer/Counter unit 8-bit counter. Writing to the TCNT0 Register blocks (removes) the Compare
Match on the following timer clock. Modifying the counter (TCNT0) while the counter is running,
introduces a risk of missing a Compare Match between TCNT0 and the OCR0x Registers.
16.9.4
OCR0A – Output Compare Register A
Bit
7
6
5
4
3
2
1
0
0x27 (0x47)
Read/Write
Initial Value
OCR0A[7:0]
OCR0A
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
The Output Compare Register A contains an 8-bit value that is continuously compared with the
counter value (TCNT0). A match can be used to generate an Output Compare interrupt, or to
generate a waveform output on the OC0A pin.
16.9.5
OCR0B – Output Compare Register B
Bit
7
6
5
4
3
2
1
0
0x28 (0x48)
Read/Write
Initial Value
OCR0B[7:0]
OCR0B
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
The Output Compare Register B contains an 8-bit value that is continuously compared with the
counter value (TCNT0). A match can be used to generate an Output Compare interrupt, or to
generate a waveform output on the OC0B pin.
133
2549L–AVR–08/07
16.9.6
TIMSK0 – Timer/Counter Interrupt Mask Register
Bit
7
–
6
–
5
–
4
–
3
–
2
OCIE0B
R/W
0
1
OCIE0A
R/W
0
0
TOIE0
R/W
0
(0x6E)
TIMSK0
Read/Write
Initial Value
R
0
R
0
R
0
R
0
R
0
• Bits 7:3, 0 – Res: Reserved Bits
These bits are reserved bits and will always read as zero.
• Bit 2 – OCIE0B: Timer/Counter Output Compare Match B Interrupt Enable
When the OCIE0B bit is written to one, and the I-bit in the Status Register is set, the
Timer/Counter Compare Match B interrupt is enabled. The corresponding interrupt is executed if
a Compare Match in Timer/Counter occurs, i.e., when the OCF0B bit is set in the Timer/Counter
Interrupt Flag Register – TIFR0.
• Bit 1 – OCIE0A: Timer/Counter0 Output Compare Match A Interrupt Enable
When the OCIE0A bit is written to one, and the I-bit in the Status Register is set, the
Timer/Counter0 Compare Match A interrupt is enabled. The corresponding interrupt is executed
if a Compare Match in Timer/Counter0 occurs, i.e., when the OCF0A bit is set in the
Timer/Counter 0 Interrupt Flag Register – TIFR0.
• Bit 0 – TOIE0: Timer/Counter0 Overflow Interrupt Enable
When the TOIE0 bit is written to one, and the I-bit in the Status Register is set, the
Timer/Counter0 Overflow interrupt is enabled. The corresponding interrupt is executed if an
overflow in Timer/Counter0 occurs, i.e., when the TOV0 bit is set in the Timer/Counter 0 Inter-
rupt Flag Register – TIFR0.
16.9.7
TIFR0 – Timer/Counter 0 Interrupt Flag Register
Bit
0x15 (0x35)
7
6
5
–
4
–
3
–
2
OCF0B
R/W
0
1
OCF0A
R/W
0
0
TOV0
R/W
0
–
–
TIFR0
Read/Write
R
0
R
0
R
0
R
0
R
0
Initial Value
• Bits 7:3, 0 – Res: Reserved Bits
These bits are reserved bits and will always read as zero.
• Bit 2 – OCF0B: Timer/Counter 0 Output Compare B Match Flag
The OCF0B bit is set when a Compare Match occurs between the Timer/Counter and the data in
OCR0B – Output Compare Register0 B. OCF0B is cleared by hardware when executing the cor-
responding interrupt handling vector. Alternatively, OCF0B is cleared by writing a logic one to
the flag. When the I-bit in SREG, OCIE0B (Timer/Counter Compare B Match Interrupt Enable),
and OCF0B are set, the Timer/Counter Compare Match Interrupt is executed.
• Bit 1 – OCF0A: Timer/Counter 0 Output Compare A Match Flag
The OCF0A bit is set when a Compare Match occurs between the Timer/Counter0 and the data
in OCR0A – Output Compare Register0. OCF0A is cleared by hardware when executing the cor-
responding interrupt handling vector. Alternatively, OCF0A is cleared by writing a logic one to
the flag. When the I-bit in SREG, OCIE0A (Timer/Counter0 Compare Match Interrupt Enable),
and OCF0A are set, the Timer/Counter0 Compare Match Interrupt is executed.
134
ATmega640/1280/1281/2560/2561
2549L–AVR–08/07
ATmega640/1280/1281/2560/2561
• Bit 0 – TOV0: Timer/Counter0 Overflow Flag
The bit TOV0 is set when an overflow occurs in Timer/Counter0. TOV0 is cleared by hardware
when executing the corresponding interrupt handling vector. Alternatively, TOV0 is cleared by
writing a logic one to the flag. When the SREG I-bit, TOIE0 (Timer/Counter0 Overflow Interrupt
Enable), and TOV0 are set, the Timer/Counter0 Overflow interrupt is executed.
The setting of this flag is dependent of the WGM02:0 bit setting. Refer to Table 16-8, “Waveform
Generation Mode Bit Description” on page 131.
135
2549L–AVR–08/07
17. 16-bit Timer/Counter (Timer/Counter 1, 3, 4, and 5)
17.1 Features
• True 16-bit Design (i.e., Allows 16-bit PWM)
• Three independent Output Compare Units
• Double Buffered Output Compare Registers
• One Input Capture Unit
• Input Capture Noise Canceler
• Clear Timer on Compare Match (Auto Reload)
• Glitch-free, Phase Correct Pulse Width Modulator (PWM)
• Variable PWM Period
• Frequency Generator
• External Event Counter
• Twenty independent interrupt sources (TOV1, OCF1A, OCF1B, OCF1C, ICF1, TOV3, OCF3A,
OCF3B, OCF3C, ICF3, TOV4, OCF4A, OCF4B, OCF4C, ICF4, TOV5, OCF5A, OCF5B, OCF5C and
ICF5)
17.2 Overview
The 16-bit Timer/Counter unit allows accurate program execution timing (event management),
wave generation, and signal timing measurement.
Most register and bit references in this section are written in general form. A lower case “n”
replaces the Timer/Counter number, and a lower case “x” replaces the Output Compare unit
channel. However, when using the register or bit defines in a program, the precise form must be
used, i.e., TCNT1 for accessing Timer/Counter1 counter value and so on.
A simplified block diagram of the 16-bit Timer/Counter is shown in Figure 17-1. For the actual
placement of I/O pins, see “TQFP-pinout ATmega640/1280/2560” on page 2 and “Pinout
ATmega1281/2561” on page 4. CPU accessible I/O Registers, including I/O bits and I/O pins,
are shown in bold. The device-specific I/O Register and bit locations are listed in the “Register
Description” on page 158.
The Power Reduction Timer/Counter1 bit, PRTIM1, in “PRR0 – Power Reduction Register 0” on
page 56 must be written to zero to enable Timer/Counter1 module.
The Power Reduction Timer/Counter3 bit, PRTIM3, in “PRR1 – Power Reduction Register 1” on
page 57 must be written to zero to enable Timer/Counter3 module.
The Power Reduction Timer/Counter4 bit, PRTIM4, in “PRR1 – Power Reduction Register 1” on
page 57 must be written to zero to enable Timer/Counter4 module.
The Power Reduction Timer/Counter5 bit, PRTIM5, in “PRR1 – Power Reduction Register 1” on
page 57 must be written to zero to enable Timer/Counter5 module.
Timer/Counter4 and Timer/Counter5 only have full functionality in the ATmega640/1280/2560.
Input capture and output compare are not available in the ATmega1281/2561.
136
ATmega640/1280/1281/2560/2561
2549L–AVR–08/07
ATmega640/1280/1281/2560/2561
Figure 17-1. 16-bit Timer/Counter Block Diagram(1)
Count
TOVn
(Int.Req.)
Clear
Control Logic
Clock Select
Direction
TCLK
Edge
Detector
Tn
TOP BOTTOM
( From Prescaler )
Timer/Counter
TCNTn
=
= 0
OCFnA
(Int.Req.)
Waveform
Generation
OCnA
OCnB
OCnC
=
OCRnA
OCFnB
Fixed
TOP
Values
(Int.Req.)
Waveform
Generation
=
OCRnB
OCFnC
(Int.Req.)
Waveform
Generation
=
OCRnC
( From Analog
Comparator Ouput )
ICFn (Int.Req.)
Edge
Detector
Noise
Canceler
ICRn
ICPn
TCCRnA
TCCRnB
TCCRnC
Note:
1. Refer to Figure 1-1 on page 2, Table 13-5 on page 79, and Table 13-11 on page 83 for
Timer/Counter1 and 3 and 3 pin placement and description.
17.2.1
Registers
The Timer/Counter (TCNTn), Output Compare Registers (OCRnA/B/C), and Input Capture Reg-
ister (ICRn) are all 16-bit registers. Special procedures must be followed when accessing the 16-
bit registers. These procedures are described in the section “Accessing 16-bit Registers” on
page 138. The Timer/Counter Control Registers (TCCRnA/B/C) are 8-bit registers and have no
CPU access restrictions. Interrupt requests (shorten as Int.Req.) signals are all visible in the
Timer Interrupt Flag Register (TIFRn). All interrupts are individually masked with the Timer Inter-
rupt Mask Register (TIMSKn). TIFRn and TIMSKn are not shown in the figure since these
registers are shared by other timer units.
The Timer/Counter can be clocked internally, via the prescaler, or by an external clock source on
the Tn pin. The Clock Select logic block controls which clock source and edge the Timer/Counter
uses to increment (or decrement) its value. The Timer/Counter is inactive when no clock source
is selected. The output from the clock select logic is referred to as the timer clock (clk ).
n
T
The double buffered Output Compare Registers (OCRnA/B/C) are compared with the
Timer/Counter value at all time. The result of the compare can be used by the Waveform Gener-
ator to generate a PWM or variable frequency output on the Output Compare pin (OCnA/B/C).
137
2549L–AVR–08/07
See “Output Compare Units” on page 145.. The compare match event will also set the Compare
Match Flag (OCFnA/B/C) which can be used to generate an Output Compare interrupt request.
The Input Capture Register can capture the Timer/Counter value at a given external (edge trig-
gered) event on either the Input Capture pin (ICPn) or on the Analog Comparator pins (See “AC
– Analog Comparator” on page 271.) The Input Capture unit includes a digital filtering unit
(Noise Canceler) for reducing the chance of capturing noise spikes.
The TOP value, or maximum Timer/Counter value, can in some modes of operation be defined
by either the OCRnA Register, the ICRn Register, or by a set of fixed values. When using
OCRnA as TOP value in a PWM mode, the OCRnA Register can not be used for generating a
PWM output. However, the TOP value will in this case be double buffered allowing the TOP
value to be changed in run time. If a fixed TOP value is required, the ICRn Register can be used
as an alternative, freeing the OCRnA to be used as PWM output.
17.2.2
Definitions
The following definitions are used extensively throughout the document:
Table 17-1. Definitions
BOTTOM
MAX
The counter reaches the BOTTOM when it becomes 0x0000.
The counter reaches its MAXimum when it becomes 0xFFFF (decimal 65535).
TOP
The counter reaches the TOP when it becomes equal to the highest value in the
count sequence. The TOP value can be assigned to be one of the fixed values:
0x00FF, 0x01FF, or 0x03FF, or to the value stored in the OCRnA or ICRn Reg-
ister. The assignment is dependent of the mode of operation.
17.3 Accessing 16-bit Registers
The TCNTn, OCRnA/B/C, and ICRn are 16-bit registers that can be accessed by the AVR CPU
via the 8-bit data bus. The 16-bit register must be byte accessed using two read or write opera-
tions. Each 16-bit timer has a single 8-bit register for temporary storing of the high byte of the 16-
bit access. The same Temporary Register is shared between all 16-bit registers within each 16-
bit timer. Accessing the low byte triggers the 16-bit read or write operation. When the low byte of
a 16-bit register is written by the CPU, the high byte stored in the Temporary Register, and the
low byte written are both copied into the 16-bit register in the same clock cycle. When the low
byte of a 16-bit register is read by the CPU, the high byte of the 16-bit register is copied into the
Temporary Register in the same clock cycle as the low byte is read.
Not all 16-bit accesses uses the Temporary Register for the high byte. Reading the OCRnA/B/C
16-bit registers does not involve using the Temporary Register.
To do a 16-bit write, the high byte must be written before the low byte. For a 16-bit read, the low
byte must be read before the high byte.
The following code examples show how to access the 16-bit timer registers assuming that no
interrupts updates the temporary register. The same principle can be used directly for accessing
the OCRnA/B/C and ICRn Registers. Note that when using “C”, the compiler handles the 16-bit
access.
138
ATmega640/1280/1281/2560/2561
2549L–AVR–08/07
ATmega640/1280/1281/2560/2561
Assembly Code Examples(1)
...
; Set TCNTn to 0x01FF
ldir17,0x01
ldir16,0xFF
outTCNTnH,r17
outTCNTnL,r16
; Read TCNTn into r17:r16
in r16,TCNTnL
in r17,TCNTnH
...
C Code Examples(1)
unsigned int i;
...
/* Set TCNTn to 0x01FF */
TCNTn = 0x1FF;
/* Read TCNTn into i */
i = TCNTn;
...
Note:
1. See “About Code Examples” on page 10.
The assembly code example returns the TCNTn value in the r17:r16 register pair.
It is important to notice that accessing 16-bit registers are atomic operations. If an interrupt
occurs between the two instructions accessing the 16-bit register, and the interrupt code
updates the temporary register by accessing the same or any other of the 16-bit Timer Regis-
ters, then the result of the access outside the interrupt will be corrupted. Therefore, when both
the main code and the interrupt code update the temporary register, the main code must disable
the interrupts during the 16-bit access.
The following code examples show how to do an atomic read of the TCNTn Register contents.
Reading any of the OCRnA/B/C or ICRn Registers can be done by using the same principle
139
2549L–AVR–08/07
.
Assembly Code Example(1)
TIM16_ReadTCNTn:
; Save global interrupt flag
in r18,SREG
; Disable interrupts
cli
; Read TCNTn into r17:r16
in r16,TCNTnL
in r17,TCNTnH
; Restore global interrupt flag
outSREG,r18
ret
C Code Example(1)
unsigned int TIM16_ReadTCNTn( void )
{
unsigned char sreg;
unsigned int i;
/* Save global interrupt flag */
sreg = SREG;
/* Disable interrupts */
__disable_interrupt();
/* Read TCNTn into i */
i = TCNTn;
/* Restore global interrupt flag */
SREG = sreg;
return i;
}
Note:
1. See “About Code Examples” on page 10.
The assembly code example returns the TCNTn value in the r17:r16 register pair.
140
ATmega640/1280/1281/2560/2561
2549L–AVR–08/07
ATmega640/1280/1281/2560/2561
The following code examples show how to do an atomic write of the TCNTn Register contents.
Writing any of the OCRnA/B/C or ICRn Registers can be done by using the same principle.
Assembly Code Example(1)
TIM16_WriteTCNTn:
; Save global interrupt flag
in r18,SREG
; Disable interrupts
cli
; Set TCNTn to r17:r16
outTCNTnH,r17
outTCNTnL,r16
; Restore global interrupt flag
outSREG,r18
ret
C Code Example(1)
void TIM16_WriteTCNTn( unsigned int i )
{
unsigned char sreg;
unsigned int i;
/* Save global interrupt flag */
sreg = SREG;
/* Disable interrupts */
__disable_interrupt();
/* Set TCNTn to i */
TCNTn = i;
/* Restore global interrupt flag */
SREG = sreg;
}
Note:
1. See “About Code Examples” on page 10.
The assembly code example requires that the r17:r16 register pair contains the value to be writ-
ten to TCNTn.
17.3.1
Reusing the Temporary High Byte Register
If writing to more than one 16-bit register where the high byte is the same for all registers written,
then the high byte only needs to be written once. However, note that the same rule of atomic
operation described previously also applies in this case.
17.4 Timer/Counter Clock Sources
The Timer/Counter can be clocked by an internal or an external clock source. The clock source
is selected by the Clock Select logic which is controlled by the Clock Select (CSn2:0) bits
located in the Timer/Counter control Register B (TCCRnB). For details on clock sources and
prescaler, see “Timer/Counter 0, 1, 3, 4, and 5 Prescaler” on page 170.
141
2549L–AVR–08/07
17.5 Counter Unit
The main part of the 16-bit Timer/Counter is the programmable 16-bit bi-directional counter unit.
Figure 17-2 shows a block diagram of the counter and its surroundings.
Figure 17-2. Counter Unit Block Diagram
DATA BUS (8-bit)
TOVn
(Int.Req.)
TEMP (8-bit)
Clock Select
Count
Clear
Edge
Detector
Tn
TCNTnH (8-bit)
TCNTnL (8-bit)
clkTn
Control Logic
Direction
TCNTn (16-bit Counter)
( From Prescaler )
TOP
BOTTOM
Signal description (internal signals):
Count
Increment or decrement TCNTn by 1.
Direction
Clear
Select between increment and decrement.
Clear TCNTn (set all bits to zero).
clkT
Timer/Counter clock.
n
TOP
Signalize that TCNTn has reached maximum value.
BOTTOM
Signalize that TCNTn has reached minimum value (zero).
The 16-bit counter is mapped into two 8-bit I/O memory locations: Counter High (TCNTnH) con-
taining the upper eight bits of the counter, and Counter Low (TCNTnL) containing the lower eight
bits. The TCNTnH Register can only be indirectly accessed by the CPU. When the CPU does an
access to the TCNTnH I/O location, the CPU accesses the high byte temporary register (TEMP).
The temporary register is updated with the TCNTnH value when the TCNTnL is read, and
TCNTnH is updated with the temporary register value when TCNTnL is written. This allows the
CPU to read or write the entire 16-bit counter value within one clock cycle via the 8-bit data bus.
It is important to notice that there are special cases of writing to the TCNTn Register when the
counter is counting that will give unpredictable results. The special cases are described in the
sections where they are of importance.
Depending on the mode of operation used, the counter is cleared, incremented, or decremented
at each timer clock (clk ). The clk n can be generated from an external or internal clock source,
n
T
T
selected by the Clock Select bits (CSn2:0). When no clock source is selected (CSn2:0 = 0) the
timer is stopped. However, the TCNTn value can be accessed by the CPU, independent of
whether clkT is present or not. A CPU write overrides (has priority over) all counter clear or
n
count operations.
The counting sequence is determined by the setting of the Waveform Generation mode bits
(WGMn3:0) located in the Timer/Counter Control Registers A and B (TCCRnA and TCCRnB).
There are close connections between how the counter behaves (counts) and how waveforms
are generated on the Output Compare outputs OCnx. For more details about advanced counting
sequences and waveform generation, see “Modes of Operation” on page 148.
142
ATmega640/1280/1281/2560/2561
2549L–AVR–08/07
ATmega640/1280/1281/2560/2561
The Timer/Counter Overflow Flag (TOVn) is set according to the mode of operation selected by
the WGMn3:0 bits. TOVn can be used for generating a CPU interrupt.
17.6 Input Capture Unit
The Timer/Counter incorporates an input capture unit that can capture external events and give
them a time-stamp indicating time of occurrence. The external signal indicating an event, or mul-
tiple events, can be applied via the ICPn pin or alternatively, for the Timer/Counter1 only, via the
Analog Comparator unit. The time-stamps can then be used to calculate frequency, duty-cycle,
and other features of the signal applied. Alternatively the time-stamps can be used for creating a
log of the events.
The Input Capture unit is illustrated by the block diagram shown in Figure 17-3. The elements of
the block diagram that are not directly a part of the input capture unit are gray shaded. The small
“n” in register and bit names indicates the Timer/Counter number.
Figure 17-3. Input Capture Unit Block Diagram
DATA BUS (8-bit)
TEMP (8-bit)
ICRnH (8-bit)
ICRnL (8-bit)
TCNTnH (8-bit)
TCNTnL (8-bit)
ICRn (16-bit Register)
TCNTn (16-bit Counter)
WRITE
ACO*
ACIC*
ICNC
ICES
Analog
Comparator
Noise
Canceler
Edge
Detector
ICFn (Int.Req.)
ICPn
Note:
The Analog Comparator Output (ACO) can only trigger the Timer/Counter1 ICP – not
Timer/Counter3, 4 or 5.
When a change of the logic level (an event) occurs on the Input Capture Pin (ICPn), alternatively
on the analog Comparator output (ACO), and this change confirms to the setting of the edge
detector, a capture will be triggered. When a capture is triggered, the 16-bit value of the counter
(TCNTn) is written to the Input Capture Register (ICRn). The Input Capture Flag (ICFn) is set at
the same system clock as the TCNTn value is copied into ICRn Register. If enabled (TICIEn =
1), the input capture flag generates an input capture interrupt. The ICFn flag is automatically
cleared when the interrupt is executed. Alternatively the ICFn flag can be cleared by software by
writing a logical one to its I/O bit location.
Reading the 16-bit value in the Input Capture Register (ICRn) is done by first reading the low
byte (ICRnL) and then the high byte (ICRnH). When the low byte is read the high byte is copied
143
2549L–AVR–08/07
into the high byte Temporary Register (TEMP). When the CPU reads the ICRnH I/O location it
will access the TEMP Register.
The ICRn Register can only be written when using a Waveform Generation mode that utilizes
the ICRn Register for defining the counter’s TOP value. In these cases the Waveform Genera-
tion mode (WGMn3:0) bits must be set before the TOP value can be written to the ICRn
Register. When writing the ICRn Register the high byte must be written to the ICRnH I/O location
before the low byte is written to ICRnL.
For more information on how to access the 16-bit registers refer to “Accessing 16-bit Registers”
on page 138.
17.6.1
Input Capture Trigger Source
The main trigger source for the input capture unit is the Input Capture Pin (ICPn).
Timer/Counter1 can alternatively use the analog comparator output as trigger source for the
input capture unit. The Analog Comparator is selected as trigger source by setting the analog
Comparator Input Capture (ACIC) bit in the Analog Comparator Control and Status Register
(ACSR). Be aware that changing trigger source can trigger a capture. The input capture flag
must therefore be cleared after the change.
Both the Input Capture Pin (ICPn) and the Analog Comparator output (ACO) inputs are sampled
using the same technique as for the Tn pin (Figure 18-1 on page 170). The edge detector is also
identical. However, when the noise canceler is enabled, additional logic is inserted before the
edge detector, which increases the delay by four system clock cycles. Note that the input of the
noise canceler and edge detector is always enabled unless the Timer/Counter is set in a Wave-
form Generation mode that uses ICRn to define TOP.
An input capture can be triggered by software by controlling the port of the ICPn pin.
17.6.2
Noise Canceler
The noise canceler improves noise immunity by using a simple digital filtering scheme. The
noise canceler input is monitored over four samples, and all four must be equal for changing the
output that in turn is used by the edge detector.
The noise canceler is enabled by setting the Input Capture Noise Canceler (ICNCn) bit in
Timer/Counter Control Register B (TCCRnB). When enabled the noise canceler introduces addi-
tional four system clock cycles of delay from a change applied to the input, to the update of the
ICRn Register. The noise canceler uses the system clock and is therefore not affected by the
prescaler.
17.6.3
Using the Input Capture Unit
The main challenge when using the Input Capture unit is to assign enough processor capacity
for handling the incoming events. The time between two events is critical. If the processor has
not read the captured value in the ICRn Register before the next event occurs, the ICRn will be
overwritten with a new value. In this case the result of the capture will be incorrect.
When using the Input Capture interrupt, the ICRn Register should be read as early in the inter-
rupt handler routine as possible. Even though the Input Capture interrupt has relatively high
priority, the maximum interrupt response time is dependent on the maximum number of clock
cycles it takes to handle any of the other interrupt requests.
Using the Input Capture unit in any mode of operation when the TOP value (resolution) is
actively changed during operation, is not recommended.
144
ATmega640/1280/1281/2560/2561
2549L–AVR–08/07
ATmega640/1280/1281/2560/2561
Measurement of an external signal’s duty cycle requires that the trigger edge is changed after
each capture. Changing the edge sensing must be done as early as possible after the ICRn
Register has been read. After a change of the edge, the Input Capture Flag (ICFn) must be
cleared by software (writing a logical one to the I/O bit location). For measuring frequency only,
the clearing of the ICFn Flag is not required (if an interrupt handler is used).
17.7 Output Compare Units
The 16-bit comparator continuously compares TCNTn with the Output Compare Register
(OCRnx). If TCNT equals OCRnx the comparator signals a match. A match will set the Output
Compare Flag (OCFnx) at the next timer clock cycle. If enabled (OCIEnx = 1), the Output Com-
pare Flag generates an Output Compare interrupt. The OCFnx Flag is automatically cleared
when the interrupt is executed. Alternatively the OCFnx Flag can be cleared by software by writ-
ing a logical one to its I/O bit location. The Waveform Generator uses the match signal to
generate an output according to operating mode set by the Waveform Generation mode
(WGMn3:0) bits and Compare Output mode (COMnx1:0) bits. The TOP and BOTTOM signals
are used by the Waveform Generator for handling the special cases of the extreme values in
some modes of operation (See “Modes of Operation” on page 148.)
A special feature of Output Compare unit A allows it to define the Timer/Counter TOP value (i.e.,
counter resolution). In addition to the counter resolution, the TOP value defines the period time
for waveforms generated by the Waveform Generator.
Figure 17-4 shows a block diagram of the Output Compare unit. The small “n” in the register and
bit names indicates the device number (n = n for Timer/Counter n), and the “x” indicates Output
Compare unit (A/B/C). The elements of the block diagram that are not directly a part of the Out-
put Compare unit are gray shaded.
Figure 17-4. Output Compare Unit, Block Diagram
DATA BUS (8-bit)
TEMP (8-bit)
OCRnxH Buf. (8-bit)
OCRnxL Buf. (8-bit)
TCNTnH (8-bit)
TCNTnL (8-bit)
OCRnx Buffer (16-bit Register)
TCNTn (16-bit Counter)
OCRnxH (8-bit)
OCRnxL (8-bit)
OCRnx (16-bit Register)
=
(16-bit Comparator )
OCFnx (Int.Req.)
TOP
OCnx
Waveform Generator
BOTTOM
WGMn3:0
COMnx1:0
The OCRnx Register is double buffered when using any of the twelve Pulse Width Modulation
(PWM) modes. For the Normal and Clear Timer on Compare (CTC) modes of operation, the
145
2549L–AVR–08/07
double buffering is disabled. The double buffering synchronizes the update of the OCRnx Com-
pare Register to either TOP or BOTTOM of the counting sequence. The synchronization
prevents the occurrence of odd-length, non-symmetrical PWM pulses, thereby making the out-
put glitch-free.
The OCRnx Register access may seem complex, but this is not case. When the double buffering
is enabled, the CPU has access to the OCRnx Buffer Register, and if double buffering is dis-
abled the CPU will access the OCRnx directly. The content of the OCR1x (Buffer or Compare)
Register is only changed by a write operation (the Timer/Counter does not update this register
automatically as the TCNT1 and ICR1 Register). Therefore OCR1x is not read via the high byte
temporary register (TEMP). However, it is a good practice to read the low byte first as when
accessing other 16-bit registers. Writing the OCRnx Registers must be done via the TEMP Reg-
ister since the compare of all 16 bits is done continuously. The high byte (OCRnxH) has to be
written first. When the high byte I/O location is written by the CPU, the TEMP Register will be
updated by the value written. Then when the low byte (OCRnxL) is written to the lower eight bits,
the high byte will be copied into the upper 8-bits of either the OCRnx buffer or OCRnx Compare
Register in the same system clock cycle.
For more information of how to access the 16-bit registers refer to “Accessing 16-bit Registers”
on page 138.
17.7.1
Force Output Compare
In non-PWM Waveform Generation modes, the match output of the comparator can be forced by
writing a one to the Force Output Compare (FOCnx) bit. Forcing compare match will not set the
OCFnx Flag or reload/clear the timer, but the OCnx pin will be updated as if a real compare
match had occurred (the COMn1:0 bits settings define whether the OCnx pin is set, cleared or
toggled).
17.7.2
17.7.3
Compare Match Blocking by TCNTn Write
All CPU writes to the TCNTn Register will block any compare match that occurs in the next timer
clock cycle, even when the timer is stopped. This feature allows OCRnx to be initialized to the
same value as TCNTn without triggering an interrupt when the Timer/Counter clock is enabled.
Using the Output Compare Unit
Since writing TCNTn in any mode of operation will block all compare matches for one timer clock
cycle, there are risks involved when changing TCNTn when using any of the Output Compare
channels, independent of whether the Timer/Counter is running or not. If the value written to
TCNTn equals the OCRnx value, the compare match will be missed, resulting in incorrect wave-
form generation. Do not write the TCNTn equal to TOP in PWM modes with variable TOP
values. The compare match for the TOP will be ignored and the counter will continue to 0xFFFF.
Similarly, do not write the TCNTn value equal to BOTTOM when the counter is downcounting.
The setup of the OCnx should be performed before setting the Data Direction Register for the
port pin to output. The easiest way of setting the OCnx value is to use the Force Output Com-
pare (FOCnx) strobe bits in Normal mode. The OCnx Register keeps its value even when
changing between Waveform Generation modes.
Be aware that the COMnx1:0 bits are not double buffered together with the compare value.
Changing the COMnx1:0 bits will take effect immediately.
146
ATmega640/1280/1281/2560/2561
2549L–AVR–08/07
ATmega640/1280/1281/2560/2561
17.8 Compare Match Output Unit
The Compare Output mode (COMnx1:0) bits have two functions. The Waveform Generator uses
the COMnx1:0 bits for defining the Output Compare (OCnx) state at the next compare match.
Secondly the COMnx1:0 bits control the OCnx pin output source. Figure 17-5 shows a simplified
schematic of the logic affected by the COMnx1:0 bit setting. The I/O Registers, I/O bits, and I/O
pins in the figure are shown in bold. Only the parts of the general I/O Port Control Registers
(DDR and PORT) that are affected by the COMnx1:0 bits are shown. When referring to the
OCnx state, the reference is for the internal OCnx Register, not the OCnx pin. If a system reset
occur, the OCnx Register is reset to “0”.
Figure 17-5. Compare Match Output Unit, Schematic
COMnx1
Waveform
Generator
COMnx0
FOCnx
D
Q
1
0
OCnx
Pin
OCnx
D
Q
PORT
D
Q
DDR
clkI/O
The general I/O port function is overridden by the Output Compare (OCnx) from the Waveform
Generator if either of the COMnx1:0 bits are set. However, the OCnx pin direction (input or out-
put) is still controlled by the Data Direction Register (DDR) for the port pin. The Data Direction
Register bit for the OCnx pin (DDR_OCnx) must be set as output before the OCnx value is visi-
ble on the pin. The port override function is generally independent of the Waveform Generation
mode, but there are some exceptions. Refer to Table 17-3, Table 17-4 and Table 17-5 for
details.
The design of the Output Compare pin logic allows initialization of the OCnx state before the out-
put is enabled. Note that some COMnx1:0 bit settings are reserved for certain modes of
operation. See “Register Description” on page 158.
The COMnx1:0 bits have no effect on the Input Capture unit.
147
2549L–AVR–08/07
17.8.1
Compare Output Mode and Waveform Generation
The Waveform Generator uses the COMnx1:0 bits differently in normal, CTC, and PWM modes.
For all modes, setting the COMnx1:0 = 0 tells the Waveform Generator that no action on the
OCnx Register is to be performed on the next compare match. For compare output actions in the
non-PWM modes refer to Table 17-3 on page 160. For fast PWM mode refer to Table 17-4 on
page 160, and for phase correct and phase and frequency correct PWM refer to Table 17-5 on
page 160.
A change of the COMnx1:0 bits state will have effect at the first compare match after the bits are
written. For non-PWM modes, the action can be forced to have immediate effect by using the
FOCnx strobe bits.
17.9 Modes of Operation
The mode of operation, i.e., the behavior of the Timer/Counter and the Output Compare pins, is
defined by the combination of the Waveform Generation mode (WGMn3:0) and Compare Output
mode (COMnx1:0) bits. The Compare Output mode bits do not affect the counting sequence,
while the Waveform Generation mode bits do. The COMnx1:0 bits control whether the PWM out-
put generated should be inverted or not (inverted or non-inverted PWM). For non-PWM modes
the COMnx1:0 bits control whether the output should be set, cleared or toggle at a compare
match (See “Compare Match Output Unit” on page 147.)
Table 17-2. Waveform Generation Mode Bit Description(1)
WGMn2
(CTCn)
WGMn1
(PWMn1) (PWMn0)
WGMn0
Timer/Counter
Mode of Operation
Update of
OCRnx at
TOVn Flag
Set on
Mode
WGMn3
TOP
0
1
2
3
4
5
6
7
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
1
1
1
1
0
0
1
1
0
0
1
1
0
1
0
1
0
1
0
1
Normal
PWM, Phase Correct, 8-bit
PWM, Phase Correct, 9-bit
PWM, Phase Correct, 10-bit
CTC
0xFFFF
0x00FF
0x01FF
0x03FF
OCRnA
0x00FF
0x01FF
0x03FF
Immediate
TOP
MAX
BOTTOM
BOTTOM
BOTTOM
MAX
TOP
TOP
Immediate
BOTTOM
BOTTOM
BOTTOM
Fast PWM, 8-bit
TOP
Fast PWM, 9-bit
TOP
Fast PWM, 10-bit
TOP
PWM, Phase and Frequency
8
9
1
1
0
0
0
0
0
1
ICRn
BOTTOM
BOTTOM
BOTTOM
BOTTOM
Correct
PWM,Phase and Frequency
OCRnA
Correct
10
11
12
13
14
15
1
1
1
1
1
1
0
0
1
1
1
1
1
1
0
0
1
1
0
1
0
1
0
1
PWM, Phase Correct
PWM, Phase Correct
CTC
ICRn
OCRnA
ICRn
–
TOP
TOP
BOTTOM
BOTTOM
MAX
Immediate
–
(Reserved)
–
Fast PWM
ICRn
OCRnA
BOTTOM
BOTTOM
TOP
Fast PWM
TOP
148
ATmega640/1280/1281/2560/2561
2549L–AVR–08/07
ATmega640/1280/1281/2560/2561
Note:
1. The CTCn and PWMn1:0 bit definition names are obsolete. Use the WGMn2:0 definitions.
However, the functionality and location of these bits are compatible with previous versions of
the timer.
For detailed timing information refer to “Timer/Counter Timing Diagrams” on page 156.
17.9.1
Normal Mode
The simplest mode of operation is the Normal mode (WGMn3:0 = 0). In this mode the counting
direction is always up (incrementing), and no counter clear is performed. The counter simply
overruns when it passes its maximum 16-bit value (MAX = 0xFFFF) and then restarts from the
BOTTOM (0x0000). In normal operation the Timer/Counter Overflow Flag (TOVn) will be set in
the same timer clock cycle as the TCNTn becomes zero. The TOVn Flag in this case behaves
like a 17th bit, except that it is only set, not cleared. However, combined with the timer overflow
interrupt that automatically clears the TOVn Flag, the timer resolution can be increased by soft-
ware. There are no special cases to consider in the Normal mode, a new counter value can be
written anytime.
The Input Capture unit is easy to use in Normal mode. However, observe that the maximum
interval between the external events must not exceed the resolution of the counter. If the interval
between events are too long, the timer overflow interrupt or the prescaler must be used to
extend the resolution for the capture unit.
The Output Compare units can be used to generate interrupts at some given time. Using the
Output Compare to generate waveforms in Normal mode is not recommended, since this will
occupy too much of the CPU time.
17.9.2
Clear Timer on Compare Match (CTC) Mode
In Clear Timer on Compare or CTC mode (WGMn3:0 = 4 or 12), the OCRnA or ICRn Register
are used to manipulate the counter resolution. In CTC mode the counter is cleared to zero when
the counter value (TCNTn) matches either the OCRnA (WGMn3:0 = 4) or the ICRn (WGMn3:0 =
12). The OCRnA or ICRn define the top value for the counter, hence also its resolution. This
mode allows greater control of the compare match output frequency. It also simplifies the opera-
tion of counting external events.
The timing diagram for the CTC mode is shown in Figure 17-6. The counter value (TCNTn)
increases until a compare match occurs with either OCRnA or ICRn, and then counter (TCNTn)
is cleared.
Figure 17-6. CTC Mode, Timing Diagram
OCnA Interrupt Flag Set
or ICFn Interrupt Flag Set
(Interrupt on TOP)
TCNTn
OCnA
(Toggle)
(COMnA1:0 = 1)
1
2
3
4
Period
149
2549L–AVR–08/07
An interrupt can be generated at each time the counter value reaches the TOP value by either
using the OCFnA or ICFn Flag according to the register used to define the TOP value. If the
interrupt is enabled, the interrupt handler routine can be used for updating the TOP value. How-
ever, changing the TOP to a value close to BOTTOM when the counter is running with none or a
low prescaler value must be done with care since the CTC mode does not have the double buff-
ering feature. If the new value written to OCRnA or ICRn is lower than the current value of
TCNTn, the counter will miss the compare match. The counter will then have to count to its max-
imum value (0xFFFF) and wrap around starting at 0x0000 before the compare match can occur.
In many cases this feature is not desirable. An alternative will then be to use the fast PWM mode
using OCRnA for defining TOP (WGMn3:0 = 15) since the OCRnA then will be double buffered.
For generating a waveform output in CTC mode, the OCnA output can be set to toggle its logical
level on each compare match by setting the Compare Output mode bits to toggle mode
(COMnA1:0 = 1). The OCnA value will not be visible on the port pin unless the data direction for
the pin is set to output (DDR_OCnA = 1). The waveform generated will have a maximum fre-
quency of fOC A = fclk_I/O/2 when OCRnA is set to zero (0x0000). The waveform frequency is
n
defined by the following equation:
f
clk_I/O
f
= --------------------------------------------------
OCnA
2 ⋅ N ⋅ (1 + OCRnA)
The N variable represents the prescaler factor (1, 8, 64, 256, or 1024).
As for the Normal mode of operation, the TOVn Flag is set in the same timer clock cycle that the
counter counts from MAX to 0x0000.
17.9.3
Fast PWM Mode
The fast Pulse Width Modulation or fast PWM mode (WGMn3:0 = 5, 6, 7, 14, or 15) provides a
high frequency PWM waveform generation option. The fast PWM differs from the other PWM
options by its single-slope operation. The counter counts from BOTTOM to TOP then restarts
from BOTTOM. In non-inverting Compare Output mode, the Output Compare (OCnx) is cleared
on the compare match between TCNTn and OCRnx, and set at BOTTOM. In inverting Compare
Output mode output is set on compare match and cleared at BOTTOM. Due to the single-slope
operation, the operating frequency of the fast PWM mode can be twice as high as the phase cor-
rect and phase and frequency correct PWM modes that use dual-slope operation. This high
frequency makes the fast PWM mode well suited for power regulation, rectification, and DAC
applications. High frequency allows physically small sized external components (coils, capaci-
tors), hence reduces total system cost.
The PWM resolution for fast PWM can be fixed to 8-, 9-, or 10-bit, or defined by either ICRn or
OCRnA. The minimum resolution allowed is 2-bit (ICRn or OCRnA set to 0x0003), and the max-
imum resolution is 16-bit (ICRn or OCRnA set to MAX). The PWM resolution in bits can be
calculated by using the following equation:
log(TOP + 1)
R
= ----------------------------------
FPWM
log(2)
In fast PWM mode the counter is incremented until the counter value matches either one of the
fixed values 0x00FF, 0x01FF, or 0x03FF (WGMn3:0 = 5, 6, or 7), the value in ICRn (WGMn3:0 =
14), or the value in OCRnA (WGMn3:0 = 15). The counter is then cleared at the following timer
clock cycle. The timing diagram for the fast PWM mode is shown in Figure 17-7. The figure
shows fast PWM mode when OCRnA or ICRn is used to define TOP. The TCNTn value is in the
timing diagram shown as a histogram for illustrating the single-slope operation. The diagram
150
ATmega640/1280/1281/2560/2561
2549L–AVR–08/07
ATmega640/1280/1281/2560/2561
includes non-inverted and inverted PWM outputs. The small horizontal line marks on the TCNTn
slopes represent compare matches between OCRnx and TCNTn. The OCnx Interrupt Flag will
be set when a compare match occurs.
Figure 17-7. Fast PWM Mode, Timing Diagram
OCRnx / TOP Update
and TOVn Interrupt Flag
Set and OCnA Interrupt
Flag Set or ICFn
Interrupt Flag Set
(Interrupt on TOP)
TCNTn
(COMnx1:0 = 2)
OCnx
(COMnx1:0 = 3)
OCnx
1
2
3
4
5
6
7
8
Period
The Timer/Counter Overflow Flag (TOVn) is set each time the counter reaches TOP. In addition
the OCnA or ICFn Flag is set at the same timer clock cycle as TOVn is set when either OCRnA
or ICRn is used for defining the TOP value. If one of the interrupts are enabled, the interrupt han-
dler routine can be used for updating the TOP and compare values.
When changing the TOP value the program must ensure that the new TOP value is higher or
equal to the value of all of the Compare Registers. If the TOP value is lower than any of the
Compare Registers, a compare match will never occur between the TCNTn and the OCRnx.
Note that when using fixed TOP values the unused bits are masked to zero when any of the
OCRnx Registers are written.
The procedure for updating ICRn differs from updating OCRnA when used for defining the TOP
value. The ICRn Register is not double buffered. This means that if ICRn is changed to a low
value when the counter is running with none or a low prescaler value, there is a risk that the new
ICRn value written is lower than the current value of TCNTn. The result will then be that the
counter will miss the compare match at the TOP value. The counter will then have to count to the
MAX value (0xFFFF) and wrap around starting at 0x0000 before the compare match can occur.
The OCRnA Register however, is double buffered. This feature allows the OCRnA I/O location
to be written anytime. When the OCRnA I/O location is written the value written will be put into
the OCRnA Buffer Register. The OCRnA Compare Register will then be updated with the value
in the Buffer Register at the next timer clock cycle the TCNTn matches TOP. The update is done
at the same timer clock cycle as the TCNTn is cleared and the TOVn Flag is set.
Using the ICRn Register for defining TOP works well when using fixed TOP values. By using
ICRn, the OCRnA Register is free to be used for generating a PWM output on OCnA. However,
if the base PWM frequency is actively changed (by changing the TOP value), using the OCRnA
as TOP is clearly a better choice due to its double buffer feature.
In fast PWM mode, the compare units allow generation of PWM waveforms on the OCnx pins.
Setting the COMnx1:0 bits to two will produce a non-inverted PWM and an inverted PWM output
can be generated by setting the COMnx1:0 to three (see Table on page 160). The actual OCnx
value will only be visible on the port pin if the data direction for the port pin is set as output
151
2549L–AVR–08/07
(DDR_OCnx). The PWM waveform is generated by setting (or clearing) the OCnx Register at
the compare match between OCRnx and TCNTn, and clearing (or setting) the OCnx Register at
the timer clock cycle the counter is cleared (changes from TOP to BOTTOM).
The PWM frequency for the output can be calculated by the following equation:
f
clk_I/O
f
= ----------------------------------
OCnxPWM
N ⋅ (1 + TOP)
The N variable represents the prescaler divider (1, 8, 64, 256, or 1024).
The extreme values for the OCRnx Register represents special cases when generating a PWM
waveform output in the fast PWM mode. If the OCRnx is set equal to BOTTOM (0x0000) the out-
put will be a narrow spike for each TOP+1 timer clock cycle. Setting the OCRnx equal to TOP
will result in a constant high or low output (depending on the polarity of the output set by the
COMnx1:0 bits.)
A frequency (with 50% duty cycle) waveform output in fast PWM mode can be achieved by set-
ting OCnA to toggle its logical level on each compare match (COMnA1:0 = 1). This applies only
if OCR1A is used to define the TOP value (WGM13:0 = 15). The waveform generated will have
a maximum frequency of fOC A = fclk_I/O/2 when OCRnA is set to zero (0x0000). This feature is
n
similar to the OCnA toggle in CTC mode, except the double buffer feature of the Output Com-
pare unit is enabled in the fast PWM mode.
17.9.4
Phase Correct PWM Mode
The phase correct Pulse Width Modulation or phase correct PWM mode (WGMn3:0 = 1, 2, 3,
10, or 11) provides a high resolution phase correct PWM waveform generation option. The
phase correct PWM mode is, like the phase and frequency correct PWM mode, based on a dual-
slope operation. The counter counts repeatedly from BOTTOM (0x0000) to TOP and then from
TOP to BOTTOM. In non-inverting Compare Output mode, the Output Compare (OCnx) is
cleared on the compare match between TCNTn and OCRnx while upcounting, and set on the
compare match while downcounting. In inverting Output Compare mode, the operation is
inverted. The dual-slope operation has lower maximum operation frequency than single slope
operation. However, due to the symmetric feature of the dual-slope PWM modes, these modes
are preferred for motor control applications.
The PWM resolution for the phase correct PWM mode can be fixed to 8-, 9-, or 10-bit, or defined
by either ICRn or OCRnA. The minimum resolution allowed is 2-bit (ICRn or OCRnA set to
0x0003), and the maximum resolution is 16-bit (ICRn or OCRnA set to MAX). The PWM resolu-
tion in bits can be calculated by using the following equation:
log(TOP + 1)
R
= ----------------------------------
PCPWM
log(2)
In phase correct PWM mode the counter is incremented until the counter value matches either
one of the fixed values 0x00FF, 0x01FF, or 0x03FF (WGMn3:0 = 1, 2, or 3), the value in ICRn
(WGMn3:0 = 10), or the value in OCRnA (WGMn3:0 = 11). The counter has then reached the
TOP and changes the count direction. The TCNTn value will be equal to TOP for one timer clock
cycle. The timing diagram for the phase correct PWM mode is shown on Figure 17-8. The figure
shows phase correct PWM mode when OCRnA or ICRn is used to define TOP. The TCNTn
value is in the timing diagram shown as a histogram for illustrating the dual-slope operation. The
152
ATmega640/1280/1281/2560/2561
2549L–AVR–08/07
ATmega640/1280/1281/2560/2561
diagram includes non-inverted and inverted PWM outputs. The small horizontal line marks on
the TCNTn slopes represent compare matches between OCRnx and TCNTn. The OCnx Inter-
rupt Flag will be set when a compare match occurs.
Figure 17-8. Phase Correct PWM Mode, Timing Diagram
OCRnx/TOP Update and
OCnA Interrupt Flag Set
or ICFn Interrupt Flag Set
(Interrupt on TOP)
TOVn Interrupt Flag Set
(Interrupt on Bottom)
TCNTn
(COMnx1:0 = 2)
OCnx
(COMnx1:0 = 3)
OCnx
1
2
3
4
Period
The Timer/Counter Overflow Flag (TOVn) is set each time the counter reaches BOTTOM. When
either OCRnA or ICRn is used for defining the TOP value, the OCnA or ICFn Flag is set accord-
ingly at the same timer clock cycle as the OCRnx Registers are updated with the double buffer
value (at TOP). The Interrupt Flags can be used to generate an interrupt each time the counter
reaches the TOP or BOTTOM value.
When changing the TOP value the program must ensure that the new TOP value is higher or
equal to the value of all of the Compare Registers. If the TOP value is lower than any of the
Compare Registers, a compare match will never occur between the TCNTn and the OCRnx.
Note that when using fixed TOP values, the unused bits are masked to zero when any of the
OCRnx Registers are written. As the third period shown in Figure 17-8 illustrates, changing the
TOP actively while the Timer/Counter is running in the phase correct mode can result in an
unsymmetrical output. The reason for this can be found in the time of update of the OCRnx Reg-
ister. Since the OCRnx update occurs at TOP, the PWM period starts and ends at TOP. This
implies that the length of the falling slope is determined by the previous TOP value, while the
length of the rising slope is determined by the new TOP value. When these two values differ the
two slopes of the period will differ in length. The difference in length gives the unsymmetrical
result on the output.
It is recommended to use the phase and frequency correct mode instead of the phase correct
mode when changing the TOP value while the Timer/Counter is running. When using a static
TOP value there are practically no differences between the two modes of operation.
In phase correct PWM mode, the compare units allow generation of PWM waveforms on the
OCnx pins. Setting the COMnx1:0 bits to two will produce a non-inverted PWM and an inverted
PWM output can be generated by setting the COMnx1:0 to three (See Table 17-5 on page 160).
The actual OCnx value will only be visible on the port pin if the data direction for the port pin is
set as output (DDR_OCnx). The PWM waveform is generated by setting (or clearing) the OCnx
153
2549L–AVR–08/07
Register at the compare match between OCRnx and TCNTn when the counter increments, and
clearing (or setting) the OCnx Register at compare match between OCRnx and TCNTn when
the counter decrements. The PWM frequency for the output when using phase correct PWM can
be calculated by the following equation:
f
clk_I/O
f
= ---------------------------
OCnxPCPWM
2 ⋅ N ⋅ TOP
The N variable represents the prescaler divider (1, 8, 64, 256, or 1024).
The extreme values for the OCRnx Register represent special cases when generating a PWM
waveform output in the phase correct PWM mode. If the OCRnx is set equal to BOTTOM the
output will be continuously low and if set equal to TOP the output will be continuously high for
non-inverted PWM mode. For inverted PWM the output will have the opposite logic values. If
OCR1A is used to define the TOP value (WGM13:0 = 11) and COM1A1:0 = 1, the OC1A output
will toggle with a 50% duty cycle.
17.9.5
Phase and Frequency Correct PWM Mode
The phase and frequency correct Pulse Width Modulation, or phase and frequency correct PWM
mode (WGMn3:0 = 8 or 9) provides a high resolution phase and frequency correct PWM wave-
form generation option. The phase and frequency correct PWM mode is, like the phase correct
PWM mode, based on a dual-slope operation. The counter counts repeatedly from BOTTOM
(0x0000) to TOP and then from TOP to BOTTOM. In non-inverting Compare Output mode, the
Output Compare (OCnx) is cleared on the compare match between TCNTn and OCRnx while
upcounting, and set on the compare match while downcounting. In inverting Compare Output
mode, the operation is inverted. The dual-slope operation gives a lower maximum operation fre-
quency compared to the single-slope operation. However, due to the symmetric feature of the
dual-slope PWM modes, these modes are preferred for motor control applications.
The main difference between the phase correct, and the phase and frequency correct PWM
mode is the time the OCRnx Register is updated by the OCRnx Buffer Register, (see Figure 17-
8 and Figure ).
The PWM resolution for the phase and frequency correct PWM mode can be defined by either
ICRn or OCRnA. The minimum resolution allowed is 2-bit (ICRn or OCRnA set to 0x0003), and
the maximum resolution is 16-bit (ICRn or OCRnA set to MAX). The PWM resolution in bits can
be calculated using the following equation:
log(TOP + 1)
R
= ----------------------------------
PFCPWM
log(2)
In phase and frequency correct PWM mode the counter is incremented until the counter value
matches either the value in ICRn (WGMn3:0 = 8), or the value in OCRnA (WGMn3:0 = 9). The
counter has then reached the TOP and changes the count direction. The TCNTn value will be
equal to TOP for one timer clock cycle. The timing diagram for the phase correct and frequency
correct PWM mode is shown on Figure . The figure shows phase and frequency correct PWM
mode when OCRnA or ICRn is used to define TOP. The TCNTn value is in the timing diagram
shown as a histogram for illustrating the dual-slope operation. The diagram includes non-
inverted and inverted PWM outputs. The small horizontal line marks on the TCNTn slopes repre-
sent compare matches between OCRnx and TCNTn. The OCnx Interrupt Flag will be set when a
compare match occurs.
154
ATmega640/1280/1281/2560/2561
2549L–AVR–08/07
ATmega640/1280/1281/2560/2561
Phase and Frequency Correct PWM Mode, Timing Diagram
OCnA Interrupt Flag Set
or ICFn Interrupt Flag Set
(Interrupt on TOP)
OCRnx/TOP Updateand
TOVn Interrupt Flag Set
(Interrupt on Bottom)
TCNTn
(COMnx1:0 = 2)
(COMnx1:0 = 3)
OCnx
OCnx
1
2
3
4
Period
The Timer/Counter Overflow Flag (TOVn) is set at the same timer clock cycle as the OCRnx
Registers are updated with the double buffer value (at BOTTOM). When either OCRnA or ICRn
is used for defining the TOP value, the OCnA or ICFn Flag set when TCNTn has reached TOP.
The Interrupt Flags can then be used to generate an interrupt each time the counter reaches the
TOP or BOTTOM value.
When changing the TOP value the program must ensure that the new TOP value is higher or
equal to the value of all of the Compare Registers. If the TOP value is lower than any of the
Compare Registers, a compare match will never occur between the TCNTn and the OCRnx.
As Figure shows the output generated is, in contrast to the phase correct mode, symmetrical in
all periods. Since the OCRnx Registers are updated at BOTTOM, the length of the rising and the
falling slopes will always be equal. This gives symmetrical output pulses and is therefore fre-
quency correct.
Using the ICRn Register for defining TOP works well when using fixed TOP values. By using
ICRn, the OCRnA Register is free to be used for generating a PWM output on OCnA. However,
if the base PWM frequency is actively changed by changing the TOP value, using the OCRnA as
TOP is clearly a better choice due to its double buffer feature.
In phase and frequency correct PWM mode, the compare units allow generation of PWM wave-
forms on the OCnx pins. Setting the COMnx1:0 bits to two will produce a non-inverted PWM and
an inverted PWM output can be generated by setting the COMnx1:0 to three (See Table 17-5 on
page 160). The actual OCnx value will only be visible on the port pin if the data direction for the
port pin is set as output (DDR_OCnx). The PWM waveform is generated by setting (or clearing)
the OCnx Register at the compare match between OCRnx and TCNTn when the counter incre-
ments, and clearing (or setting) the OCnx Register at compare match between OCRnx and
TCNTn when the counter decrements. The PWM frequency for the output when using phase
and frequency correct PWM can be calculated by the following equation:
f
clk_I/O
f
= ---------------------------
OCnxPFCPWM
2 ⋅ N ⋅ TOP
The N variable represents the prescaler divider (1, 8, 64, 256, or 1024).
155
2549L–AVR–08/07
The extreme values for the OCRnx Register represents special cases when generating a PWM
waveform output in the phase correct PWM mode. If the OCRnx is set equal to BOTTOM the
output will be continuously low and if set equal to TOP the output will be set to high for non-
inverted PWM mode. For inverted PWM the output will have the opposite logic values. If OCR1A
is used to define the TOP value (WGM13:0 = 9) and COM1A1:0 = 1, the OC1A output will toggle
with a 50% duty cycle.
17.10 Timer/Counter Timing Diagrams
The Timer/Counter is a synchronous design and the timer clock (clkTn) is therefore shown as a
clock enable signal in the following figures. The figures include information on when Interrupt
Flags are set, and when the OCRnx Register is updated with the OCRnx buffer value (only for
modes utilizing double buffering). Figure 17-9 shows a timing diagram for the setting of OCFnx.
Figure 17-9. Timer/Counter Timing Diagram, Setting of OCFnx, no Prescaling
clkI/O
clkTn
(clkI/O/1)
TCNTn
OCRnx
OCFnx
OCRnx - 1
OCRnx
OCRnx + 1
OCRnx + 2
OCRnx Value
Figure 17-10 shows the same timing data, but with the prescaler enabled.
Figure 17-10. Timer/Counter Timing Diagram, Setting of OCFnx, with Prescaler (fclk_I/O/8)
clkI/O
clkTn
(clkI/O/8)
TCNTn
OCRnx
OCFnx
OCRnx - 1
OCRnx
OCRnx + 1
OCRnx + 2
OCRnx Value
Figure 17-11 shows the count sequence close to TOP in various modes. When using phase and
frequency correct PWM mode the OCRnx Register is updated at BOTTOM. The timing diagrams
156
ATmega640/1280/1281/2560/2561
2549L–AVR–08/07
ATmega640/1280/1281/2560/2561
will be the same, but TOP should be replaced by BOTTOM, TOP-1 by BOTTOM+1 and so on.
The same renaming applies for modes that set the TOVn Flag at BOTTOM.
Figure 17-11. Timer/Counter Timing Diagram, no Prescaling
clkI/O
clkTn
(clkI/O/1)
TCNTn
TOP - 1
TOP - 1
TOP
TOP
BOTTOM
TOP - 1
BOTTOM + 1
TOP - 2
(CTC and FPWM)
TCNTn
(PC and PFC PWM)
TOVn (FPWM)
and ICFn (if used
as TOP)
OCRnx
(Update at TOP)
New OCRnx Value
Old OCRnx Value
Figure 17-12 shows the same timing data, but with the prescaler enabled.
157
2549L–AVR–08/07
Figure 17-12. Timer/Counter Timing Diagram, with Prescaler (fclk_I/O/8)
clk
I/O
clk
(clkT/n8)
I/O
TCNTn
TOP - 1
TOP - 1
TOP
TOP
BOTTOM
TOP - 1
BOTTOM + 1
TOP - 2
(CTC and FPWM)
TCNTn
(PC and PFC PWM)
TOVn(FPWM)
and ICFn(if used
as TOP)
OCRnx
(Update at TOP)
Old OCRnx Value
New OCRnx Value
17.11 Register Description
17.11.1 TCCR1A – Timer/Counter 1 Control Register A
Bit
7
COM1A1
R/W
6
COM1A0
R/W
5
COM1B1
R/W
4
COM1B0
R/W
3
COM1C1
R/W
2
COM1C0
R/W
1
WGM11
R/W
0
0
WGM10
R/W
0
TCCR1A
TCCR3A
TCCR4A
(0x80)
Read/Write
Initial Value
0
0
0
0
0
0
17.11.2 TCCR3A – Timer/Counter 3 Control Register A
Bit
7
COM3A1
R/W
6
COM3A0
R/W
5
COM3B1
R/W
4
COM3B0
R/W
3
COM3C1
R/W
2
COM3C0
R/W
1
WGM31
R/W
0
0
WGM30
R/W
0
(0x90)
Read/Write
Initial Value
0
0
0
0
0
0
17.11.3 TCCR4A – Timer/Counter 4 Control Register A
Bit
7
COM4A1
R/W
6
COM4A0
R/W
5
COM4B1
R/W
4
COM4B0
R/W
3
COM4C1
R/W
2
COM4C0
R/W
1
WGM41
R/W
0
0
WGM40
R/W
0
(0xA0)
Read/Write
Initial Value
0
0
0
0
0
0
17.11.4 TCCR5A – Timer/Counter 5 Control Register A
Bit
7
6
5
4
3
2
1
0
158
ATmega640/1280/1281/2560/2561
2549L–AVR–08/07
ATmega640/1280/1281/2560/2561
COM5A1
R/W
0
COM5A0
R/W
0
COM5B1
R/W
0
COM5B0
R/W
0
COM5C1
R/W
0
COM5C0
R/W
0
WGM51
R/W
0
WGM50
R/W
0
TCCR5A
(0x120)
Read/Write
Initial Value
• Bit 7:6 – COMnA1:0: Compare Output Mode for Channel A
• Bit 5:4 – COMnB1:0: Compare Output Mode for Channel B
• Bit 3:2 – COMnC1:0: Compare Output Mode for Channel C
The COMnA1:0, COMnB1:0, and COMnC1:0 control the output compare pins (OCnA, OCnB,
and OCnC respectively) behavior. If one or both of the COMnA1:0 bits are written to one, the
OCnA output overrides the normal port functionality of the I/O pin it is connected to. If one or
both of the COMnB1:0 bits are written to one, the OCnB output overrides the normal port func-
tionality of the I/O pin it is connected to. If one or both of the COMnC1:0 bits are written to one,
the OCnC output overrides the normal port functionality of the I/O pin it is connected to. How-
ever, note that the Data Direction Register (DDR) bit corresponding to the OCnA, OCnB or
OCnC pin must be set in order to enable the output driver.
When the OCnA, OCnB or OCnC is connected to the pin, the function of the COMnx1:0 bits is
dependent of the WGMn3:0 bits setting. Table 17-3 shows the COMnx1:0 bit functionality when
the WGMn3:0 bits are set to a normal or a CTC mode (non-PWM).
• Bit 1:0 – WGMn1:0: Waveform Generation Mode
Combined with the WGMn3:2 bits found in the TCCRnB Register, these bits control the counting
sequence of the counter, the source for maximum (TOP) counter value, and what type of wave-
form generation to be used, see Table 17-2. Modes of operation supported by the Timer/Counter
unit are: Normal mode (counter), Clear Timer on Compare match (CTC) mode, and three types
of Pulse Width Modulation (PWM) modes. For more information on the different modes, see
“Modes of Operation” on page 148.
159
2549L–AVR–08/07
.
Table 17-3. Compare Output Mode, non-PWM
COMnA1
COMnB1
COMnC1
COMnA0
COMnB0
COMnC0
Description
0
0
1
1
0
1
0
1
Normal port operation, OCnA/OCnB/OCnC disconnected.
Toggle OCnA/OCnB/OCnC on compare match.
Clear OCnA/OCnB/OCnC on compare match (set output to low level).
Set OCnA/OCnB/OCnC on compare match (set output to high level).
Table 17-4 shows the COMnx1:0 bit functionality when the WGMn3:0 bits are set to the fast
PWM mode.
Table 17-4. Compare Output Mode, Fast PWM
COMnA1
COMnB1
COMnC1
COMnA0
COMnB0
COMnC0
Description
0
0
Normal port operation, OCnA/OCnB/OCnC disconnected.
WGM13:0 = 14 or 15: Toggle OC1A on Compare Match, OC1B and OC1C
disconnected (normal port operation). For all other WGM1 settings, normal
port operation, OC1A/OC1B/OC1C disconnected.
0
1
Clear OCnA/OCnB/OCnC on compare match, set OCnA/OCnB/OCnC at
BOTTOM (non-inverting mode).
1
1
0
1
Set OCnA/OCnB/OCnC on compare match, clear OCnA/OCnB/OCnC at
BOTTOM (inverting mode).
Note:
A special case occurs when OCRnA/OCRnB/OCRnC equals TOP and
COMnA1/COMnB1/COMnC1 is set. In this case the compare match is ignored, but the set or clear
is done at BOTTOM. See “Fast PWM Mode” on page 150. for more details.
Table 17-5 shows the COMnx1:0 bit functionality when the WGMn3:0 bits are set to the phase
correct and frequency correct PWM mode.
Table 17-5. Compare Output Mode, Phase Correct and Phase and Frequency Correct PWM
COMnA1
COMnB1
COMnC1
COMnA0
COMnB0
COMnC0
Description
0
0
Normal port operation, OCnA/OCnB/OCnC disconnected.
WGM13:0 =9 or 11: Toggle OC1A on Compare Match, OC1B and OC1C
disconnected (normal port operation). For all other WGM1 settings, normal
port operation, OC1A/OC1B/OC1C disconnected.
0
1
Clear OCnA/OCnB/OCnC on compare match when up-counting. Set
OCnA/OCnB/OCnC on compare match when downcounting.
1
1
0
1
Set OCnA/OCnB/OCnC on compare match when up-counting. Clear
OCnA/OCnB/OCnC on compare match when downcounting.
Note:
A special case occurs when OCRnA/OCRnB/OCRnC equals TOP and
COMnA1/COMnB1//COMnC1 is set. See “Phase Correct PWM Mode” on page 152. for more
details.
160
ATmega640/1280/1281/2560/2561
2549L–AVR–08/07
ATmega640/1280/1281/2560/2561
17.11.5 TCCR1B – Timer/Counter 1 Control Register B
Bit
7
ICNC1
R/W
0
6
ICES1
R/W
0
5
–
4
WGM13
R/W
0
3
WGM12
R/W
0
2
CS12
R/W
0
1
CS11
R/W
0
0
CS10
R/W
0
(0x81)
TCCR1B
TCCR3B
TCCR4B
TCCR5B
Read/Write
Initial Value
R
0
17.11.6 TCCR3B – Timer/Counter 3 Control Register B
Bit
7
ICNC3
R/W
0
6
ICES3
R/W
0
5
–
4
WGM33
R/W
0
3
WGM32
R/W
0
2
CS32
R/W
0
1
CS31
R/W
0
0
CS30
R/W
0
(0x91)
Read/Write
Initial Value
R
0
17.11.7 TCCR4B – Timer/Counter 4 Control Register B
Bit
7
ICNC4
R/W
0
6
ICES4
R/W
0
5
–
4
WGM43
R/W
0
3
WGM42
R/W
0
2
CS42
R/W
0
1
CS41
R/W
0
0
CS40
R/W
0
(0xA1)
Read/Write
Initial Value
R
0
17.11.8 TCCR5B – Timer/Counter 5 Control Register B
Bit
7
ICNC5
R/W
0
6
ICES5
R/W
0
5
–
4
WGM53
R/W
0
3
WGM52
R/W
0
2
CS52
R/W
0
1
CS51
R/W
0
0
CS50
R/W
0
(0x121)
Read/Write
Initial Value
R
0
• Bit 7 – ICNCn: Input Capture Noise Canceler
Setting this bit (to one) activates the Input Capture Noise Canceler. When the Noise Canceler is
activated, the input from the Input Capture Pin (ICPn) is filtered. The filter function requires four
successive equal valued samples of the ICPn pin for changing its output. The input capture is
therefore delayed by four Oscillator cycles when the noise canceler is enabled.
• Bit 6 – ICESn: Input Capture Edge Select
This bit selects which edge on the Input Capture Pin (ICPn) that is used to trigger a capture
event. When the ICESn bit is written to zero, a falling (negative) edge is used as trigger, and
when the ICESn bit is written to one, a rising (positive) edge will trigger the capture.
When a capture is triggered according to the ICESn setting, the counter value is copied into the
Input Capture Register (ICRn). The event will also set the Input Capture Flag (ICFn), and this
can be used to cause an Input Capture Interrupt, if this interrupt is enabled.
When the ICRn is used as TOP value (see description of the WGMn3:0 bits located in the
TCCRnA and the TCCRnB Register), the ICPn is disconnected and consequently the input cap-
ture function is disabled.
• Bit 5 – Reserved Bit
This bit is reserved for future use. For ensuring compatibility with future devices, this bit must be
written to zero when TCCRnB is written.
• Bit 4:3 – WGMn3:2: Waveform Generation Mode
See TCCRnA Register description.
161
2549L–AVR–08/07
• Bit 2:0 – CSn2:0: Clock Select
The three clock select bits select the clock source to be used by the Timer/Counter, see Figure
17-9 and Figure 17-10.
Table 17-6. Clock Select Bit Description
CSn2
CSn1
CSn0
Description
No clock source. (Timer/Counter stopped)
clkI/O/1 (No prescaling
0
0
0
0
1
1
1
1
0
0
1
1
0
0
1
1
0
1
0
1
0
1
0
1
clkI/O/8 (From prescaler)
clkI/O/64 (From prescaler)
clkI/O/256 (From prescaler)
clkI/O/1024 (From prescaler)
External clock source on Tn pin. Clock on falling edge
External clock source on Tn pin. Clock on rising edge
If external pin modes are used for the Timer/Countern, transitions on the Tn pin will clock the
counter even if the pin is configured as an output. This feature allows software control of the
counting.
17.11.9 TCCR1C – Timer/Counter 1 Control Register C
Bit
(0x82)
7
6
5
4
–
3
–
2
–
1
–
0
–
FOC1A
FOC1B
FOC1C
TCCR1C
TCCR3C
TCCR4C
TCCR5C
Read/Write
W
W
W
R
0
R
0
R
0
R
0
R
0
Initial Value
0
0
0
17.11.10 TCCR3C – Timer/Counter 3 Control Register C
Bit
7
FOC3A
W
6
FOC3B
W
5
FOC3C
W
4
–
3
–
2
–
1
–
0
–
(0x92)
Read/Write
Initial Value
R
0
R
0
R
0
R
0
R
0
0
0
0
17.11.11 TCCR4C – Timer/Counter 4 Control Register C
Bit
7
FOC4A
W
6
FOC4B
W
5
FOC4C
W
4
–
3
–
2
–
1
–
0
–
(0xA2)
Read/Write
Initial Value
R
0
R
0
R
0
R
0
R
0
0
0
0
17.11.12 TCCR5C – Timer/Counter 5 Control Register C
Bit
7
FOC5A
W
6
FOC5B
W
5
FOC3C
W
4
–
3
–
2
–
1
–
0
–
(0x122)
Read/Write
Initial Value
R
0
R
0
R
0
R
0
R
0
0
0
0
162
ATmega640/1280/1281/2560/2561
2549L–AVR–08/07
ATmega640/1280/1281/2560/2561
• Bit 7 – FOCnA: Force Output Compare for Channel A
• Bit 6 – FOCnB: Force Output Compare for Channel B
• Bit 5 – FOCnC: Force Output Compare for Channel C
The FOCnA/FOCnB/FOCnC bits are only active when the WGMn3:0 bits specifies a non-PWM
mode. When writing a logical one to the FOCnA/FOCnB/FOCnC bit, an immediate compare
match is forced on the waveform generation unit. The OCnA/OCnB/OCnC output is changed
according to its COMnx1:0 bits setting. Note that the FOCnA/FOCnB/FOCnC bits are imple-
mented as strobes. Therefore it is the value present in the COMnx1:0 bits that determine the
effect of the forced compare.
A FOCnA/FOCnB/FOCnC strobe will not generate any interrupt nor will it clear the timer in Clear
Timer on Compare Match (CTC) mode using OCRnA as TOP.
The FOCnA/FOCnB/FOCnB bits are always read as zero.
• Bit 4:0 – Reserved Bits
These bits are reserved for future use. For ensuring compatibility with future devices, these bits
must be written to zero when TCCRnC is written.
17.11.13 TCNT1H and TCNT1L – Timer/Counter 1
Bit
7
6
5
4
3
2
1
0
(0x85)
TCNT1[15:8]
TCNT1[7:0]
TCNT1H
TCNT1L
(0x84)
Read/Write
Initial Value
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
17.11.14 TCNT3H and TCNT3L – Timer/Counter 3
Bit
7
6
5
4
3
2
1
0
(0x95)
TCNT3[15:8]
TCNT3[7:0]
TCNT3H
TCNT3L
(0x94)
Read/Write
Initial Value
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
17.11.15 TCNT4H and TCNT4L –Timer/Counter 4
Bit
7
6
5
4
3
2
1
0
(0xA5)
TCNT4[15:8]
TCNT4[7:0]
TCNT4H
TCNT4L
(0xA4)
Read/Write
Initial Value
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
17.11.16 TCNT5H and TCNT5L –Timer/Counter 5
Bit
7
6
5
4
3
2
1
0
(0x125)
(0x124)
Read/Write
Initial Value
TCNT5[15:8]
TCNT5[7:0]
TCNT5H
TCNT5L
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
The two Timer/Counter I/O locations (TCNTnH and TCNTnL, combined TCNTn) give direct
access, both for read and for write operations, to the Timer/Counter unit 16-bit counter. To
ensure that both the high and low bytes are read and written simultaneously when the CPU
accesses these registers, the access is performed using an 8-bit temporary High Byte Register
163
2549L–AVR–08/07
(TEMP). This temporary register is shared by all the other 16-bit registers. See “Accessing 16-bit
Registers” on page 138.
Modifying the counter (TCNTn) while the counter is running introduces a risk of missing a com-
pare match between TCNTn and one of the OCRnx Registers.
Writing to the TCNTn Register blocks (removes) the compare match on the following timer clock
for all compare units.
17.11.17 OCR1AH and OCR1AL – Output Compare Register 1 A
Bit
7
6
5
4
3
2
1
0
(0x89)
OCR1A[15:8]
OCR1A[7:0]
OCR1AH
OCR1AL
(0x88)
Read/Write
Initial Value
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
17.11.18 OCR1BH and OCR1BL – Output Compare Register 1 B
Bit
7
6
5
4
3
2
1
0
(0x8B)
OCR1B[15:8]
OCR1B[7:0]
OCR1BH
OCR1BL
(0x8A)
Read/Write
Initial Value
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
17.11.19 OCR1CH and OCR1CL – Output Compare Register 1 C
Bit
7
6
5
4
3
2
1
0
(0x8D)
OCR1C[15:8]
OCR1C[7:0]
OCR1CH
OCR1CL
(0x8C)
Read/Write
Initial Value
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
17.11.20 OCR3AH and OCR3AL – Output Compare Register 3 A
Bit
7
6
5
4
3
2
1
0
(0x99)
OCR3A[15:8]
OCR3A[7:0]
OCR3AH
OCR3AL
(0x98)
Read/Write
Initial Value
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
17.11.21 OCR3BH and OCR3BL – Output Compare Register 3 B
Bit
7
6
5
4
3
2
1
0
(0x9B)
OCR3B[15:8]
OCR3B[7:0]
OCR3BH
OCR3BL
(0x9A)
Read/Write
Initial Value
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
17.11.22 OCR3CH and OCR3CL – Output Compare Register 3 C
Bit
7
6
5
4
3
2
1
0
(0x9D)
OCR3C[15:8]
OCR3C[7:0]
OCR3CH
OCR3CL
(0x9C)
Read/Write
Initial Value
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
164
ATmega640/1280/1281/2560/2561
2549L–AVR–08/07
ATmega640/1280/1281/2560/2561
17.11.23 OCR4AH and OCR4AL – Output Compare Register 4 A
Bit
7
6
5
4
3
2
1
0
(0xA9)
OCR4A[15:8]
OCR4A[7:0]
OCR4AH
OCR4AL
(0xA8)
Read/Write
Initial Value
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
165
2549L–AVR–08/07
17.11.24 OCR4BH and OCR4BL – Output Compare Register 4 B
Bit
7
6
5
4
3
2
1
0
(0xAA)
OCR4B[15:8]
OCR4B[7:0]
OCR4BH
OCR4BL
(0xAB)
Read/Write
Initial Value
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
17.11.25 OCR4CH and OCR4CL –Output Compare Register 4 C
Bit
7
6
5
4
3
2
1
0
(0xAD)
OCR4C[15:8]
OCR4C[7:0]
OCR4CH
OCR4CL
(0xAC)
Read/Write
Initial Value
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
17.11.26 OCR5AH and OCR5AL – Output Compare Register 5 A
Bit
7
6
5
4
3
2
1
0
(0x129)
(0x128)
Read/Write
Initial Value
OCR5A[15:8]
OCR5A[7:0]
OCR5AH
OCR5AL
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
17.11.27 OCR5BH and OCR5BL – Output Compare Register 5 B
Bit
7
6
5
4
3
2
1
0
(0x12B)
(0x12A)
Read/Write
Initial Value
OCR5B[15:8]
OCR5B[7:0]
OCR5BH
OCR5BL
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
17.11.28 OCR5CH and OCR5CL –Output Compare Register 5 C
Bit
7
6
5
4
3
2
1
0
(0x12D)
(0x12C)
Read/Write
Initial Value
OCR5C[15:8]
OCR5C[7:0]
OCR5CH
OCR5CL
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
The Output Compare Registers contain a 16-bit value that is continuously compared with the
counter value (TCNTn). A match can be used to generate an Output Compare interrupt, or to
generate a waveform output on the OCnx pin.
The Output Compare Registers are 16-bit in size. To ensure that both the high and low bytes are
written simultaneously when the CPU writes to these registers, the access is performed using an
8-bit temporary High Byte Register (TEMP). This temporary register is shared by all the other
16-bit registers. See “Accessing 16-bit Registers” on page 138.
17.11.29 ICR1H and ICR1L – Input Capture Register 1
Bit
7
6
5
4
3
2
1
0
(0x87)
ICR1[15:8]
ICR1[7:0]
ICR1H
ICR1L
(0x86)
Read/Write
Initial Value
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
166
ATmega640/1280/1281/2560/2561
2549L–AVR–08/07
ATmega640/1280/1281/2560/2561
17.11.30 ICR3H and ICR3L – Input Capture Register 3 –
Bit
7
6
5
4
3
2
1
0
(0x97)
ICR3[15:8]
ICR3[7:0]
ICR3H
ICR3L
(0x96)
Read/Write
Initial Value
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
17.11.31 ICR4H and ICR4L – Input Capture Register 4
Bit
7
6
5
4
3
2
1
0
(0xA7)
ICR4[15:8]
ICR4[7:0]
ICR4H
ICR4L
(0xA6)
Read/Write
Initial Value
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
17.11.32 ICR5H and ICR5L – Input Capture Register 5
Bit
7
6
5
4
3
2
1
0
(0x127)
(0x126)
Read/Write
Initial Value
ICR5[15:8]
ICR5[7:0]
ICR5H
ICR5L
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
The Input Capture is updated with the counter (TCNTn) value each time an event occurs on the
ICPn pin (or optionally on the Analog Comparator output for Timer/Counter1). The Input Capture
can be used for defining the counter TOP value.
The Input Capture Register is 16-bit in size. To ensure that both the high and low bytes are read
simultaneously when the CPU accesses these registers, the access is performed using an 8-bit
temporary High Byte Register (TEMP). This temporary register is shared by all the other 16-bit
registers. See “Accessing 16-bit Registers” on page 138.
17.11.33 TIMSK1 – Timer/Counter 1 Interrupt Mask Register
Bit
(0x6F)
7
6
5
4
–
3
OCIE1C
R/W
0
2
OCIE1B
R/W
0
1
OCIE1A
R/W
0
0
TOIE1
R/W
0
–
–
ICIE1
TIMSK1
TIMSK3
TIMSK4
Read/Write
R
0
R
0
R/W
R
0
Initial Value
0
17.11.34 TIMSK3 – Timer/Counter 3 Interrupt Mask Register
Bit
7
–
6
–
5
ICIE3
R/W
0
4
–
3
OCIE3C
R/W
0
2
OCIE3B
R/W
0
1
OCIE3A
R/W
0
0
TOIE3
R/W
0
(0x71)
Read/Write
Initial Value
R
0
R
0
R
0
17.11.35 TIMSK4 – Timer/Counter 4 Interrupt Mask Register
Bit
7
–
6
–
5
ICIE4
R/W
0
4
–
3
OCIE4C
R/W
0
2
OCIE4B
R/W
0
1
OCIE4A
R/W
0
0
TOIE4
R/W
0
(0x72)
Read/Write
Initial Value
R
0
R
0
R
0
167
2549L–AVR–08/07
17.11.36 TIMSK5 – Timer/Counter 5 Interrupt Mask Register
Bit
7
–
6
–
5
ICIE5
R/W
0
4
–
3
OCIE5C
R/W
0
2
OCIE5B
R/W
0
1
OCIE5A
R/W
0
0
TOIE5
R/W
0
(0x73)
TIMSK5
Read/Write
Initial Value
R
0
R
0
R
0
• Bit 5 – ICIEn: Timer/Countern, Input Capture Interrupt Enable
When this bit is written to one, and the I-flag in the Status Register is set (interrupts globally
enabled), the Timer/Countern Input Capture interrupt is enabled. The corresponding Interrupt
Vector (See “Interrupts” on page 105.) is executed when the ICFn Flag, located in TIFRn, is set.
• Bit 3 – OCIEnC: Timer/Countern, Output Compare C Match Interrupt Enable
When this bit is written to one, and the I-flag in the Status Register is set (interrupts globally
enabled), the Timer/Countern Output Compare C Match interrupt is enabled. The corresponding
Interrupt Vector (See “Interrupts” on page 105.) is executed when the OCFnC Flag, located in
TIFRn, is set.
• Bit 2 – OCIEnB: Timer/Countern, Output Compare B Match Interrupt Enable
When this bit is written to one, and the I-flag in the Status Register is set (interrupts globally
enabled), the Timer/Countern Output Compare B Match interrupt is enabled. The corresponding
Interrupt Vector (See “Interrupts” on page 105.) is executed when the OCFnB Flag, located in
TIFRn, is set.
• Bit 1 – OCIEnA: Timer/Countern, Output Compare A Match Interrupt Enable
When this bit is written to one, and the I-flag in the Status Register is set (interrupts globally
enabled), the Timer/Countern Output Compare A Match interrupt is enabled. The corresponding
Interrupt Vector (See “Interrupts” on page 105.) is executed when the OCFnA Flag, located in
TIFRn, is set.
• Bit 0 – TOIEn: Timer/Countern, Overflow Interrupt Enable
When this bit is written to one, and the I-flag in the Status Register is set (interrupts globally
enabled), the Timer/Countern Overflow interrupt is enabled. The corresponding Interrupt Vector
(See “Interrupts” on page 105.) is executed when the TOVn Flag, located in TIFRn, is set.
17.11.37 TIFR1 – Timer/Counter1 Interrupt Flag Register
Bit
0x16 (0x36)
7
6
5
4
–
3
OCF1C
R/W
0
2
OCF1B
R/W
0
1
OCF1A
R/W
0
0
TOV1
R/W
0
–
–
ICF1
R/W
0
TIFR1
Read/Write
R
0
R
0
R
0
Initial Value
17.11.38 TIFR3 – Timer/Counter3 Interrupt Flag Register
Bit
7
–
6
–
5
4
–
3
OCF3C
R/W
0
2
OCF3B
R/W
0
1
OCF3A
R/W
0
0
TOV3
R/W
0
0x18 (0x38)
Read/Write
Initial Value
ICF3
R/W
0
TIFR3
R
0
R
0
R
0
168
ATmega640/1280/1281/2560/2561
2549L–AVR–08/07
ATmega640/1280/1281/2560/2561
17.11.39 TIFR4 – Timer/Counter4 Interrupt Flag Register
Bit
7
–
6
–
5
4
–
3
OCF4C
R/W
0
2
OCF4B
R/W
0
1
OCF4A
R/W
0
0
TOV4
R/W
0
0x19 (0x39)
Read/Write
Initial Value
ICF4
R/W
0
TIFR4
R
0
R
0
R
0
17.11.40 TIFR5 – Timer/Counter5 Interrupt Flag Register
Bit
7
–
6
–
5
4
–
3
OCF5C
R/W
0
2
OCF5B
R/W
0
1
OCF5A
R/W
0
0
TOV5
R/W
0
0x1A (0x3A)
Read/Write
Initial Value
ICF5
R/W
0
TIFR5
R
0
R
0
R
0
• Bit 5 – ICFn: Timer/Countern, Input Capture Flag
This flag is set when a capture event occurs on the ICPn pin. When the Input Capture Register
(ICRn) is set by the WGMn3:0 to be used as the TOP value, the ICFn Flag is set when the
counter reaches the TOP value.
ICFn is automatically cleared when the Input Capture Interrupt Vector is executed. Alternatively,
ICFn can be cleared by writing a logic one to its bit location.
• Bit 3– OCFnC: Timer/Countern, Output Compare C Match Flag
This flag is set in the timer clock cycle after the counter (TCNTn) value matches the Output
Compare Register C (OCRnC).
Note that a Forced Output Compare (FOCnC) strobe will not set the OCFnC Flag.
OCFnC is automatically cleared when the Output Compare Match C Interrupt Vector is exe-
cuted. Alternatively, OCFnC can be cleared by writing a logic one to its bit location.
• Bit 2 – OCFnB: Timer/Counter1, Output Compare B Match Flag
This flag is set in the timer clock cycle after the counter (TCNTn) value matches the Output
Compare Register B (OCRnB).
Note that a Forced Output Compare (FOCnB) strobe will not set the OCFnB Flag.
OCFnB is automatically cleared when the Output Compare Match B Interrupt Vector is exe-
cuted. Alternatively, OCFnB can be cleared by writing a logic one to its bit location.
• Bit 1 – OCF1A: Timer/Counter1, Output Compare A Match Flag
This flag is set in the timer clock cycle after the counter (TCNTn value matches the Output Com-
pare Register A (OCRnA).
Note that a Forced Output Compare (FOCnA) strobe will not set the OCFnA Flag.
OCFnA is automatically cleared when the Output Compare Match A Interrupt Vector is exe-
cuted. Alternatively, OCFnA can be cleared by writing a logic one to its bit location.
• Bit 0 – TOVn: Timer/Countern, Overflow Flag
The setting of this flag is dependent of the WGMn3:0 bits setting. In Normal and CTC modes,
the TOVn Flag is set when the timer overflows. Refer to Table 17-2 on page 148 for the TOVn
Flag behavior when using another WGMn3:0 bit setting.
TOVn is automatically cleared when the Timer/Countern Overflow Interrupt Vector is executed.
Alternatively, TOVn can be cleared by writing a logic one to its bit location.
169
2549L–AVR–08/07
18. Timer/Counter 0, 1, 3, 4, and 5 Prescaler
Timer/Counter 0, 1, 3, 4, and 5 share the same prescaler module, but the Timer/Counters can
have different prescaler settings. The description below applies to all Timer/Counters. Tn is used
as a general name, n = 0, 1, 3, 4, or 5.
18.1 Internal Clock Source
The Timer/Counter can be clocked directly by the system clock (by setting the CSn2:0 = 1). This
provides the fastest operation, with a maximum Timer/Counter clock frequency equal to system
clock frequency (fCLK_I/O). Alternatively, one of four taps from the prescaler can be used as a
clock source. The prescaled clock has a frequency of either fCLK_I/O/8, fCLK_I/O/64, fCLK_I/O/256, or
fCLK_I/O/1024.
18.2 Prescaler Reset
The prescaler is free running, i.e., operates independently of the Clock Select logic of the
Timer/Counter, and it is shared by the Timer/Counter Tn. Since the prescaler is not affected by
the Timer/Counter’s clock select, the state of the prescaler will have implications for situations
where a prescaled clock is used. One example of prescaling artifacts occurs when the timer is
enabled and clocked by the prescaler (6 > CSn2:0 > 1). The number of system clock cycles from
when the timer is enabled to the first count occurs can be from 1 to N+1 system clock cycles,
where N equals the prescaler divisor (8, 64, 256, or 1024).
It is possible to use the prescaler reset for synchronizing the Timer/Counter to program execu-
tion. However, care must be taken if the other Timer/Counter that shares the same prescaler
also uses prescaling. A prescaler reset will affect the prescaler period for all Timer/Counters it is
connected to.
18.3 External Clock Source
An external clock source applied to the Tn pin can be used as Timer/Counter clock (clkTn). The
Tn pin is sampled once every system clock cycle by the pin synchronization logic. The synchro-
nized (sampled) signal is then passed through the edge detector. Figure 18-1 shows a functional
equivalent block diagram of the Tn synchronization and edge detector logic. The registers are
clocked at the positive edge of the internal system clock (clkI/O). The latch is transparent in the
high period of the internal system clock.
The edge detector generates one clkTn pulse for each positive (CSn2:0 = 7) or negative (CSn2:0
= 6) edge it detects.
Figure 18-1. Tn/T0 Pin Sampling
Tn_sync
(To Clock
Tn
D
Q
D
Q
D
Q
Select Logic)
LE
clkI/O
Synchronization
Edge Detector
The synchronization and edge detector logic introduces a delay of 2.5 to 3.5 system clock cycles
from an edge has been applied to the Tn pin to the counter is updated.
170
ATmega640/1280/1281/2560/2561
2549L–AVR–08/07
ATmega640/1280/1281/2560/2561
Enabling and disabling of the clock input must be done when Tn has been stable for at least one
system clock cycle, otherwise it is a risk that a false Timer/Counter clock pulse is generated.
Each half period of the external clock applied must be longer than one system clock cycle to
ensure correct sampling. The external clock must be guaranteed to have less than half the sys-
tem clock frequency (fExtClk < fclk_I/O/2) given a 50/50% duty cycle. Since the edge detector uses
sampling, the maximum frequency of an external clock it can detect is half the sampling fre-
quency (Nyquist sampling theorem). However, due to variation of the system clock frequency
and duty cycle caused by Oscillator source (crystal, resonator, and capacitors) tolerances, it is
recommended that maximum frequency of an external clock source is less than fclk_I/O/2.5.
An external clock source can not be prescaled.
Figure 18-2. Prescaler for synchronous Timer/Counters
clkI/O
Clear
PSR10
Tn
Synchronization
Tn
Synchronization
CSn0
CSn1
CSn2
CSn0
CSn1
CSn2
TIMER/COUNTERn CLOCK SOURCE
clkTn
TIMER/COUNTERn CLOCK SOURCE
clkTn
18.4 Register Description
18.4.1
GTCCR – General Timer/Counter Control Register
Bit
7
6
–
5
–
4
–
3
–
2
–
1
0
0x23 (0x43)
Read/Write
Initial Value
TSM
R/W
0
PSRASY PSRSYNC
GTCCR
R
0
R
0
R
0
R
0
R
0
R/W
R/W
0
0
• Bit 7 – TSM: Timer/Counter Synchronization Mode
Writing the TSM bit to one activates the Timer/Counter Synchronization mode. In this mode, the
value that is written to the PSRASY and PSRSYNC bits is kept, hence keeping the correspond-
ing prescaler reset signals asserted. This ensures that the corresponding Timer/Counters are
halted and can be configured to the same value without the risk of one of them advancing during
configuration. When the TSM bit is written to zero, the PSRASY and PSRSYNC bits are cleared
by hardware, and the Timer/Counters start counting simultaneously.
• Bit 0 – PSRSYNC: Prescaler Reset for Synchronous Timer/Counters
When this bit is one, Timer/Counter0, Timer/Counter1, Timer/Counter3, Timer/Counter4 and
Timer/Counter5 prescaler will be Reset. This bit is normally cleared immediately by hardware,
171
2549L–AVR–08/07
except if the TSM bit is set. Note that Timer/Counter0, Timer/Counter1, Timer/Counter3,
Timer/Counter4 and Timer/Counter5 share the same prescaler and a reset of this prescaler will
affect all timers.
172
ATmega640/1280/1281/2560/2561
2549L–AVR–08/07
ATmega640/1280/1281/2560/2561
19. Output Compare Modulator (OCM1C0A)
19.1 Overview
The Output Compare Modulator (OCM) allows generation of waveforms modulated with a carrier
frequency. The modulator uses the outputs from the Output Compare Unit C of the 16-bit
Timer/Counter1 and the Output Compare Unit of the 8-bit Timer/Counter0. For more details
about these Timer/Counters see “Timer/Counter 0, 1, 3, 4, and 5 Prescaler” on page 170 and “8-
bit Timer/Counter2 with PWM and Asynchronous Operation” on page 175.
Figure 19-1. Output Compare Modulator, Block Diagram
OC1C
Timer/Counter 1
Pin
OC1C /
OC0A / PB7
OC0A
Timer/Counter 0
When the modulator is enabled, the two output compare channels are modulated together as
shown in the block diagram (Figure 19-1).
19.2 Description
The Output Compare unit 1C and Output Compare unit 2 shares the PB7 port pin for output. The
outputs of the Output Compare units (OC1C and OC0A) overrides the normal PORTB7 Register
when one of them is enabled (i.e., when COMnx1:0 is not equal to zero). When both OC1C and
OC0A are enabled at the same time, the modulator is automatically enabled.
The functional equivalent schematic of the modulator is shown on Figure 19-2. The schematic
includes part of the Timer/Counter units and the port B pin 7 output driver circuit.
Figure 19-2. Output Compare Modulator, Schematic
COMA01
COMA00
Vcc
COM1C1
COM1C0
Modulator
0
1
( From Waveform Generator )
D
Q
1
0
OC1C
Pin
OC1C /
( From Waveform Generator )
D
Q
OC0A/ PB7
OC0A
D
Q
D
Q
PORTB7
DDRB7
DATABUS
173
2549L–AVR–08/07
When the modulator is enabled the type of modulation (logical AND or OR) can be selected by
the PORTB7 Register. Note that the DDRB7 controls the direction of the port independent of the
COMnx1:0 bit setting.
19.2.1
Timing Example
Figure 19-3 illustrates the modulator in action. In this example the Timer/Counter1 is set to oper-
ate in fast PWM mode (non-inverted) and Timer/Counter0 uses CTC waveform mode with toggle
Compare Output mode (COMnx1:0 = 1).
Figure 19-3. Output Compare Modulator, Timing Diagram
clkI/O
OC1C
(FPWM Mode)
OC0A
(CTC Mode)
PB7
(PORTB7 = 0)
PB7
(PORTB7 = 1)
1
2
3
(Period)
In this example, Timer/Counter2 provides the carrier, while the modulating signal is generated
by the Output Compare unit C of the Timer/Counter1.
The resolution of the PWM signal (OC1C) is reduced by the modulation. The reduction factor is
equal to the number of system clock cycles of one period of the carrier (OC0A). In this example
the resolution is reduced by a factor of two. The reason for the reduction is illustrated in Figure
19-3 at the second and third period of the PB7 output when PORTB7 equals zero. The period 2
high time is one cycle longer than the period 3 high time, but the result on the PB7 output is
equal in both periods.
174
ATmega640/1280/1281/2560/2561
2549L–AVR–08/07
ATmega640/1280/1281/2560/2561
20. 8-bit Timer/Counter2 with PWM and Asynchronous Operation
Timer/Counter2 is a general purpose, single channel, 8-bit Timer/Counter module. The main
features are:
• Single Channel Counter
• Clear Timer on Compare Match (Auto Reload)
• Glitch-free, Phase Correct Pulse Width Modulator (PWM)
• Frequency Generator
• 10-bit Clock Prescaler
• Overflow and Compare Match Interrupt Sources (TOV2, OCF2A and OCF2B)
• Allows Clocking from External 32 kHz Watch Crystal Independent of the I/O Clock
20.1 Overview
A simplified block diagram of the 8-bit Timer/Counter is shown in Figure 17-11.. For the actual
placement of I/O pins, see “Pin Configurations” on page 2. CPU accessible I/O Registers, includ-
ing I/O bits and I/O pins, are shown in bold. The device-specific I/O Register and bit locations
are listed in the “Register Description” on page 188.
The Power Reduction Timer/Counter2 bit, PRTIM2, in “PRR0 – Power Reduction Register 0” on
page 56 must be written to zero to enable Timer/Counter2 module.
Figure 20-1. 8-bit Timer/Counter Block Diagram
Count
TOVn
(Int.Req.)
Clear
Control Logic
Direction
clkTn
TOSC1
TOSC2
T/C
Oscillator
Prescaler
TOP
BOTTOM
clkI/O
Timer/Counter
TCNTn
=
=
0
OCnA
(Int.Req.)
Waveform
Generation
OCnA
OCnB
=
OCRnA
Fixed
TOP
Value
OCnB
(Int.Req.)
Waveform
Generation
=
OCRnB
clkI/O
Synchronized Status flags
Synchronization Unit
clkASY
asynchronous mode
select (ASn)
Status flags
ASSRn
TCCRnA
TCCRnB
175
2549L–AVR–08/07
20.1.1
Registers
The Timer/Counter (TCNT2) and Output Compare Register (OCR2A and OCR2B) are 8-bit reg-
isters. Interrupt request (abbreviated to Int.Req.) signals are all visible in the Timer Interrupt Flag
Register (TIFR2). All interrupts are individually masked with the Timer Interrupt Mask Register
(TIMSK2). TIFR2 and TIMSK2 are not shown in the figure.
The Timer/Counter can be clocked internally, via the prescaler, or asynchronously clocked from
the TOSC1/2 pins, as detailed later in this section. The asynchronous operation is controlled by
the Asynchronous Status Register (ASSR). The Clock Select logic block controls which clock
source the Timer/Counter uses to increment (or decrement) its value. The Timer/Counter is inac-
tive when no clock source is selected. The output from the Clock Select logic is referred to as the
timer clock (clkT2).
The double buffered Output Compare Register (OCR2A and OCR2B) are compared with the
Timer/Counter value at all times. The result of the compare can be used by the Waveform Gen-
erator to generate a PWM or variable frequency output on the Output Compare pins (OC2A and
OC2B). See “Output Compare Unit” on page 181. for details. The compare match event will also
set the Compare Flag (OCF2A or OCF2B) which can be used to generate an Output Compare
interrupt request.
20.1.2
Definitions
Many register and bit references in this document are written in general form. A lower case “n”
replaces the Timer/Counter number, in this case 2. However, when using the register or bit
defines in a program, the precise form must be used, i.e., TCNT2 for accessing Timer/Counter2
counter value and so on.
The definitions in Table 20-1 are also used extensively throughout the section.
Table 20-1. Definitions
BOTTOM
MAX
The counter reaches the BOTTOM when it becomes zero (0x00).
The counter reaches its MAXimum when it becomes 0xFF (decimal 255).
TOP
The counter reaches the TOP when it becomes equal to the highest value in the
count sequence. The TOP value can be assigned to be the fixed value 0xFF
(MAX) or the value stored in the OCR2A Register. The assignment is dependent
on the mode of operation.
20.2 Timer/Counter Clock Sources
The Timer/Counter can be clocked by an internal synchronous or an external asynchronous
clock source. The clock source clkT2 is by default equal to the MCU clock, clkI/O. When the AS2
bit in the ASSR Register is written to logic one, the clock source is taken from the Timer/Counter
Oscillator connected to TOSC1 and TOSC2. For details on asynchronous operation, see “Asyn-
chronous Operation of Timer/Counter2” on page 185. For details on clock sources and
prescaler, see “Timer/Counter Prescaler” on page 187.
20.3 Counter Unit
The main part of the 8-bit Timer/Counter is the programmable bi-directional counter unit. Figure
20-2 shows a block diagram of the counter and its surrounding environment.
176
ATmega640/1280/1281/2560/2561
2549L–AVR–08/07
ATmega640/1280/1281/2560/2561
Figure 20-2. Counter Unit Block Diagram
TOVn
(Int.Req.)
DATA BUS
TOSC1
TOSC2
count
clear
T/C
Oscillator
clk Tn
TCNTn
Control Logic
Prescaler
direction
clk
bottom
top
I/O
Signal description (internal signals):
count
direction
clear
Increment or decrement TCNT2 by 1.
Selects between increment and decrement.
Clear TCNT2 (set all bits to zero).
clkTn
Timer/Counter clock, referred to as clkT2 in the following.
Signalizes that TCNT2 has reached maximum value.
Signalizes that TCNT2 has reached minimum value (zero).
top
bottom
Depending on the mode of operation used, the counter is cleared, incremented, or decremented
at each timer clock (clkT2). clkT2 can be generated from an external or internal clock source,
selected by the Clock Select bits (CS22:0). When no clock source is selected (CS22:0 = 0) the
timer is stopped. However, the TCNT2 value can be accessed by the CPU, regardless of
whether clkT2 is present or not. A CPU write overrides (has priority over) all counter clear or
count operations.
The counting sequence is determined by the setting of the WGM21 and WGM20 bits located in
the Timer/Counter Control Register (TCCR2A) and the WGM22 located in the Timer/Counter
Control Register B (TCCR2B). There are close connections between how the counter behaves
(counts) and how waveforms are generated on the Output Compare outputs OC2A and OC2B.
For more details about advanced counting sequences and waveform generation, see “Modes of
Operation” on page 177.
The Timer/Counter Overflow Flag (TOV2) is set according to the mode of operation selected by
the WGM22:0 bits. TOV2 can be used for generating a CPU interrupt.
20.4 Modes of Operation
The mode of operation, i.e., the behavior of the Timer/Counter and the Output Compare pins, is
defined by the combination of the Waveform Generation mode (WGM22:0) and Compare Output
mode (COM2x1:0) bits. The Compare Output mode bits do not affect the counting sequence,
while the Waveform Generation mode bits do. The COM2x1:0 bits control whether the PWM out-
put generated should be inverted or not (inverted or non-inverted PWM). For non-PWM modes
the COM2x1:0 bits control whether the output should be set, cleared, or toggled at a compare
match (See “Compare Match Output Unit” on page 183.).
For detailed timing information refer to “Timer/Counter Timing Diagrams” on page 184.
177
2549L–AVR–08/07
20.4.1
Normal Mode
The simplest mode of operation is the Normal mode (WGM22:0 = 0). In this mode the counting
direction is always up (incrementing), and no counter clear is performed. The counter simply
overruns when it passes its maximum 8-bit value (TOP = 0xFF) and then restarts from the bot-
tom (0x00). In normal operation the Timer/Counter Overflow Flag (TOV2) will be set in the same
timer clock cycle as the TCNT2 becomes zero. The TOV2 Flag in this case behaves like a ninth
bit, except that it is only set, not cleared. However, combined with the timer overflow interrupt
that automatically clears the TOV2 Flag, the timer resolution can be increased by software.
There are no special cases to consider in the Normal mode, a new counter value can be written
anytime.
The Output Compare unit can be used to generate interrupts at some given time. Using the Out-
put Compare to generate waveforms in Normal mode is not recommended, since this will
occupy too much of the CPU time.
20.4.2
Clear Timer on Compare Match (CTC) Mode
In Clear Timer on Compare or CTC mode (WGM22:0 = 2), the OCR2A Register is used to
manipulate the counter resolution. In CTC mode the counter is cleared to zero when the counter
value (TCNT2) matches the OCR2A. The OCR2A defines the top value for the counter, hence
also its resolution. This mode allows greater control of the compare match output frequency. It
also simplifies the operation of counting external events.
The timing diagram for the CTC mode is shown in Table 20-3. The counter value (TCNT2)
increases until a compare match occurs between TCNT2 and OCR2A, and then counter
(TCNT2) is cleared.
Figure 20-3. CTC Mode, Timing Diagram
OCnx Interrupt Flag Set
TCNTn
OCnx
(Toggle)
(COMnx1:0 = 1)
1
2
3
4
Period
An interrupt can be generated each time the counter value reaches the TOP value by using the
OCF2A Flag. If the interrupt is enabled, the interrupt handler routine can be used for updating
the TOP value. However, changing TOP to a value close to BOTTOM when the counter is run-
ning with none or a low prescaler value must be done with care since the CTC mode does not
have the double buffering feature. If the new value written to OCR2A is lower than the current
value of TCNT2, the counter will miss the compare match. The counter will then have to count to
its maximum value (0xFF) and wrap around starting at 0x00 before the compare match can
occur.
For generating a waveform output in CTC mode, the OC2A output can be set to toggle its logical
level on each compare match by setting the Compare Output mode bits to toggle mode
(COM2A1:0 = 1). The OC2A value will not be visible on the port pin unless the data direction for
178
ATmega640/1280/1281/2560/2561
2549L–AVR–08/07
ATmega640/1280/1281/2560/2561
the pin is set to output. The waveform generated will have a maximum frequency of fOC2A
clk_I/O/2 when OCR2A is set to zero (0x00). The waveform frequency is defined by the following
equation:
=
f
f
clk_I/O
f
= -------------------------------------------------
OCnx
2 ⋅ N ⋅ (1 + OCRnx)
The N variable represents the prescale factor (1, 8, 32, 64, 128, 256, or 1024).
As for the Normal mode of operation, the TOV2 Flag is set in the same timer clock cycle that the
counter counts from MAX to 0x00.
20.4.3
Fast PWM Mode
Figure 20-4. Fast PWM Mode, Timing Diagram
OCRnx Interrupt Flag Set
OCRnx Update and
TOVn Interrupt Flag Set
TCNTn
(COMnx1:0 = 2)
(COMnx1:0 = 3)
OCnx
OCnx
1
2
3
4
5
6
7
Period
The Timer/Counter Overflow Flag (TOV2) is set each time the counter reaches TOP. If the inter-
rupt is enabled, the interrupt handler routine can be used for updating the compare value.
In fast PWM mode, the compare unit allows generation of PWM waveforms on the OC2x pin.
Setting the COM2x1:0 bits to two will produce a non-inverted PWM and an inverted PWM output
can be generated by setting the COM2x1:0 to three. TOP is defined as 0xFF when WGM2:0 = 3,
and OCR2A when WGM2:0 = 7 (See Table 20-3 on page 188). The actual OC2x value will only
be visible on the port pin if the data direction for the port pin is set as output. The PWM wave-
form is generated by setting (or clearing) the OC2x Register at the compare match between
OCR2x and TCNT2, and clearing (or setting) the OC2x Register at the timer clock cycle the
counter is cleared (changes from TOP to BOTTOM).
The PWM frequency for the output can be calculated by the following equation:
f
clk_I/O
f
= -----------------
OCnxPWM
N ⋅ 256
The N variable represents the prescale factor (1, 8, 32, 64, 128, 256, or 1024).
The extreme values for the OCR2A Register represent special cases when generating a PWM
waveform output in the fast PWM mode. If the OCR2A is set equal to BOTTOM, the output will
179
2549L–AVR–08/07
be a narrow spike for each MAX+1 timer clock cycle. Setting the OCR2A equal to MAX will result
in a constantly high or low output (depending on the polarity of the output set by the COM2A1:0
bits.)
A frequency (with 50% duty cycle) waveform output in fast PWM mode can be achieved by set-
ting OC2x to toggle its logical level on each compare match (COM2x1:0 = 1). The waveform
generated will have a maximum frequency of foc2 = fclk_I/O/2 when OCR2A is set to zero. This fea-
ture is similar to the OC2A toggle in CTC mode, except the double buffer feature of the Output
Compare unit is enabled in the fast PWM mode.
20.4.4
Phase Correct PWM Mode
The phase correct PWM mode (WGM22:0 = 1 or 5) provides a high resolution phase correct
PWM waveform generation option. The phase correct PWM mode is based on a dual-slope
operation. The counter counts repeatedly from BOTTOM to TOP and then from TOP to BOT-
TOM. TOP is defined as 0xFF when WGM22:0 = 1, and OCR2A when MGM22:0 = 5. In non-
inverting Compare Output mode, the Output Compare (OC2x) is cleared on the compare match
between TCNT2 and OCR2x while upcounting, and set on the compare match while downcount-
ing. In inverting Output Compare mode, the operation is inverted. The dual-slope operation has
lower maximum operation frequency than single slope operation. However, due to the symmet-
ric feature of the dual-slope PWM modes, these modes are preferred for motor control
applications.
In phase correct PWM mode the counter is incremented until the counter value matches TOP.
When the counter reaches TOP, it changes the count direction. The TCNT2 value will be equal
to TOP for one timer clock cycle. The timing diagram for the phase correct PWM mode is shown
on Figure 20-5. The TCNT2 value is in the timing diagram shown as a histogram for illustrating
the dual-slope operation. The diagram includes non-inverted and inverted PWM outputs. The
small horizontal line marks on the TCNT2 slopes represent compare matches between OCR2x
and TCNT2.
Figure 20-5. Phase Correct PWM Mode, Timing Diagram
OCnx Interrupt Flag Set
OCRnx Update
TOVn Interrupt Flag Set
TCNTn
(COMnx1:0 = 2)
OCnx
(COMnx1:0 = 3)
OCnx
1
2
3
Period
180
ATmega640/1280/1281/2560/2561
2549L–AVR–08/07
ATmega640/1280/1281/2560/2561
The Timer/Counter Overflow Flag (TOV2) is set each time the counter reaches BOTTOM. The
Interrupt Flag can be used to generate an interrupt each time the counter reaches the BOTTOM
value.
In phase correct PWM mode, the compare unit allows generation of PWM waveforms on the
OC2x pin. Setting the COM2x1:0 bits to two will produce a non-inverted PWM. An inverted PWM
output can be generated by setting the COM2x1:0 to three. TOP is defined as 0xFF when
WGM2:0 = 3, and OCR2A when MGM2:0 = 7 (See Table 20-4 on page 189). The actual OC2x
value will only be visible on the port pin if the data direction for the port pin is set as output. The
PWM waveform is generated by clearing (or setting) the OC2x Register at the compare match
between OCR2x and TCNT2 when the counter increments, and setting (or clearing) the OC2x
Register at compare match between OCR2x and TCNT2 when the counter decrements. The
PWM frequency for the output when using phase correct PWM can be calculated by the follow-
ing equation:
f
clk_I/O
f
= -----------------
OCnxPCPWM
N ⋅ 510
The N variable represents the prescale factor (1, 8, 32, 64, 128, 256, or 1024).
The extreme values for the OCR2A Register represent special cases when generating a PWM
waveform output in the phase correct PWM mode. If the OCR2A is set equal to BOTTOM, the
output will be continuously low and if set equal to MAX the output will be continuously high for
non-inverted PWM mode. For inverted PWM the output will have the opposite logic values.
At the very start of period 2 in Figure 20-5 OCnx has a transition from high to low even though
there is no Compare Match. The point of this transition is to guarantee symmetry around BOT-
TOM. There are two cases that give a transition without Compare Match.
•
OCR2A changes its value from MAX, like in Figure 20-5. When the OCR2A value is MAX the
OCn pin value is the same as the result of a down-counting compare match. To ensure
symmetry around BOTTOM the OCn value at MAX must correspond to the result of an up-
counting Compare Match.
•
The timer starts counting from a value higher than the one in OCR2A, and for that reason
misses the Compare Match and hence the OCn change that would have happened on the
way up.
20.5 Output Compare Unit
The 8-bit comparator continuously compares TCNT2 with the Output Compare Register
(OCR2A and OCR2B). Whenever TCNT2 equals OCR2A or OCR2B, the comparator signals a
match. A match will set the Output Compare Flag (OCF2A or OCF2B) at the next timer clock
cycle. If the corresponding interrupt is enabled, the Output Compare Flag generates an Output
Compare interrupt. The Output Compare Flag is automatically cleared when the interrupt is exe-
cuted. Alternatively, the Output Compare Flag can be cleared by software by writing a logical
one to its I/O bit location. The Waveform Generator uses the match signal to generate an output
according to operating mode set by the WGM22:0 bits and Compare Output mode (COM2x1:0)
bits. The max and bottom signals are used by the Waveform Generator for handling the special
cases of the extreme values in some modes of operation (“Modes of Operation” on page 177).
Figure 17-9 on page 156 shows a block diagram of the Output Compare unit.
181
2549L–AVR–08/07
Figure 20-6. Output Compare Unit, Block Diagram
DATA BUS
OCRnx
TCNTn
=
(8-bit Comparator )
OCFnx (Int.Req.)
top
bottom
FOCn
Waveform Generator
OCnx
WGMn1:0
COMnX1:0
The OCR2x Register is double buffered when using any of the Pulse Width Modulation (PWM)
modes. For the Normal and Clear Timer on Compare (CTC) modes of operation, the double
buffering is disabled. The double buffering synchronizes the update of the OCR2x Compare
Register to either top or bottom of the counting sequence. The synchronization prevents the
occurrence of odd-length, non-symmetrical PWM pulses, thereby making the output glitch-free.
The OCR2x Register access may seem complex, but this is not case. When the double buffering
is enabled, the CPU has access to the OCR2x Buffer Register, and if double buffering is dis-
abled the CPU will access the OCR2x directly.
20.5.1
Force Output Compare
In non-PWM waveform generation modes, the match output of the comparator can be forced by
writing a one to the Force Output Compare (FOC2x) bit. Forcing compare match will not set the
OCF2x Flag or reload/clear the timer, but the OC2x pin will be updated as if a real compare
match had occurred (the COM2x1:0 bits settings define whether the OC2x pin is set, cleared or
toggled).
20.5.2
20.5.3
Compare Match Blocking by TCNT2 Write
All CPU write operations to the TCNT2 Register will block any compare match that occurs in the
next timer clock cycle, even when the timer is stopped. This feature allows OCR2x to be initial-
ized to the same value as TCNT2 without triggering an interrupt when the Timer/Counter clock is
enabled.
Using the Output Compare Unit
Since writing TCNT2 in any mode of operation will block all compare matches for one timer clock
cycle, there are risks involved when changing TCNT2 when using the Output Compare channel,
independently of whether the Timer/Counter is running or not. If the value written to TCNT2
equals the OCR2x value, the compare match will be missed, resulting in incorrect waveform
generation. Similarly, do not write the TCNT2 value equal to BOTTOM when the counter is
downcounting.
182
ATmega640/1280/1281/2560/2561
2549L–AVR–08/07
ATmega640/1280/1281/2560/2561
The setup of the OC2x should be performed before setting the Data Direction Register for the
port pin to output. The easiest way of setting the OC2x value is to use the Force Output Com-
pare (FOC2x) strobe bit in Normal mode. The OC2x Register keeps its value even when
changing between Waveform Generation modes.
Be aware that the COM2x1:0 bits are not double buffered together with the compare value.
Changing the COM2x1:0 bits will take effect immediately.
20.6 Compare Match Output Unit
The Compare Output mode (COM2x1:0) bits have two functions. The Waveform Generator uses
the COM2x1:0 bits for defining the Output Compare (OC2x) state at the next compare match.
Also, the COM2x1:0 bits control the OC2x pin output source. Figure 20-7 shows a simplified
schematic of the logic affected by the COM2x1:0 bit setting. The I/O Registers, I/O bits, and I/O
pins in the figure are shown in bold. Only the parts of the general I/O Port Control Registers
(DDR and PORT) that are affected by the COM2x1:0 bits are shown. When referring to the
OC2x state, the reference is for the internal OC2x Register, not the OC2x pin.
Figure 20-7. Compare Match Output Unit, Schematic
COMnx1
Waveform
Generator
COMnx0
FOCnx
D
Q
1
0
OCnx
Pin
OCnx
D
Q
PORT
D
Q
DDR
clkI/O
The general I/O port function is overridden by the Output Compare (OC2x) from the Waveform
Generator if either of the COM2x1:0 bits are set. However, the OC2x pin direction (input or out-
put) is still controlled by the Data Direction Register (DDR) for the port pin. The Data Direction
Register bit for the OC2x pin (DDR_OC2x) must be set as output before the OC2x value is visi-
ble on the pin. The port override function is independent of the Waveform Generation mode.
The design of the Output Compare pin logic allows initialization of the OC2x state before the out-
put is enabled. Note that some COM2x1:0 bit settings are reserved for certain modes of
operation. See “Register Description” on page 188.
183
2549L–AVR–08/07
20.6.1
Compare Output Mode and Waveform Generation
The Waveform Generator uses the COM2x1:0 bits differently in normal, CTC, and PWM modes.
For all modes, setting the COM2x1:0 = 0 tells the Waveform Generator that no action on the
OC2x Register is to be performed on the next compare match. For compare output actions in the
non-PWM modes refer to Table 20-5 on page 189. For fast PWM mode, refer to Table 20-6 on
page 189, and for phase correct PWM refer to Table 20-7 on page 190.
A change of the COM2x1:0 bits state will have effect at the first compare match after the bits are
written. For non-PWM modes, the action can be forced to have immediate effect by using the
FOC2x strobe bits.
20.7 Timer/Counter Timing Diagrams
The following figures show the Timer/Counter in synchronous mode, and the timer clock (clkT2)
is therefore shown as a clock enable signal. In asynchronous mode, clkI/O should be replaced by
the Timer/Counter Oscillator clock. The figures include information on when Interrupt Flags are
set. Figure 20-8 contains timing data for basic Timer/Counter operation. The figure shows the
count sequence close to the MAX value in all modes other than phase correct PWM mode.
Figure 20-8. Timer/Counter Timing Diagram, no Prescaling
clkI/O
clkTn
(clkI/O/1)
TCNTn
TOVn
MAX - 1
MAX
BOTTOM
BOTTOM + 1
Figure 20-9 shows the same timing data, but with the prescaler enabled.
Figure 20-9. Timer/Counter Timing Diagram, with Prescaler (fclk_I/O/8)
clkI/O
clkTn
(clkI/O/8)
TCNTn
TOVn
MAX - 1
MAX
BOTTOM
BOTTOM + 1
Figure 20-10 shows the setting of OCF2A in all modes except CTC mode.
184
ATmega640/1280/1281/2560/2561
2549L–AVR–08/07
ATmega640/1280/1281/2560/2561
Figure 20-10. Timer/Counter Timing Diagram, Setting of OCF2A, with Prescaler (fclk_I/O/8)
clkI/O
clkTn
(clkI/O/8)
TCNTn
OCRnx
OCFnx
OCRnx - 1
OCRnx
OCRnx + 1
OCRnx + 2
OCRnx Value
Figure 20-11 shows the setting of OCF2A and the clearing of TCNT2 in CTC mode.
Figure 20-11. Timer/Counter Timing Diagram, Clear Timer on Compare Match mode, with Pres-
caler (fclk_I/O/8)
clkI/O
clkTn
(clkI/O/8)
TCNTn
(CTC)
TOP - 1
TOP
BOTTOM
BOTTOM + 1
OCRnx
TOP
OCFnx
20.8 Asynchronous Operation of Timer/Counter2
When Timer/Counter2 operates asynchronously, some considerations must be taken.
•
Warning: When switching between asynchronous and synchronous clocking of
Timer/Counter2, the Timer Registers TCNT2, OCR2x, and TCCR2x might be corrupted. A
safe procedure for switching clock source is:
1. Disable the Timer/Counter2 interrupts by clearing OCIE2x and TOIE2.
2. Select clock source by setting AS2 as appropriate.
3. Write new values to TCNT2, OCR2x, and TCCR2x.
4. To switch to asynchronous operation: Wait for TCN2UB, OCR2xUB, and TCR2xUB.
5. Clear the Timer/Counter2 Interrupt Flags.
6. Enable interrupts, if needed.
•
•
The CPU main clock frequency must be more than four times the Oscillator frequency.
When writing to one of the registers TCNT2, OCR2x, or TCCR2x, the value is transferred to
a temporary register, and latched after two positive edges on TOSC1. The user should not
185
2549L–AVR–08/07
write a new value before the contents of the temporary register have been transferred to its
destination. Each of the five mentioned registers have their individual temporary register,
which means that e.g. writing to TCNT2 does not disturb an OCR2x write in progress. To
detect that a transfer to the destination register has taken place, the Asynchronous Status
Register – ASSR has been implemented.
•
•
When entering Power-save or ADC Noise Reduction mode after having written to TCNT2,
OCR2x, or TCCR2x, the user must wait until the written register has been updated if
Timer/Counter2 is used to wake up the device. Otherwise, the MCU will enter sleep mode
before the changes are effective. This is particularly important if any of the Output
Compare2 interrupt is used to wake up the device, since the Output Compare function is
disabled during writing to OCR2x or TCNT2. If the write cycle is not finished, and the MCU
enters sleep mode before the corresponding OCR2xUB bit returns to zero, the device will
never receive a compare match interrupt, and the MCU will not wake up.
If Timer/Counter2 is used to wake the device up from Power-save or ADC Noise Reduction
mode, precautions must be taken if the user wants to re-enter one of these modes: The
interrupt logic needs one TOSC1 cycle to be reset. If the time between wake-up and re-
entering sleep mode is less than one TOSC1 cycle, the interrupt will not occur, and the
device will fail to wake up. If the user is in doubt whether the time before re-entering Power-
save or ADC Noise Reduction mode is sufficient, the following algorithm can be used to
ensure that one TOSC1 cycle has elapsed:
1. Write a value to TCCR2x, TCNT2, or OCR2x.
2. Wait until the corresponding Update Busy Flag in ASSR returns to zero.
3. Enter Power-save or ADC Noise Reduction mode.
•
When the asynchronous operation is selected, the 32.768 kHz Oscillator for Timer/Counter2
is always running, except in Power-down and Standby modes. After a Power-up Reset or
wake-up from Power-down or Standby mode, the user should be aware of the fact that this
Oscillator might take as long as one second to stabilize. The user is advised to wait for at
least one second before using Timer/Counter2 after power-up or wake-up from Power-down
or Standby mode. The contents of all Timer/Counter2 Registers must be considered lost
after a wake-up from Power-down or Standby mode due to unstable clock signal upon start-
up, no matter whether the Oscillator is in use or a clock signal is applied to the TOSC1 pin.
•
•
Description of wake up from Power-save or ADC Noise Reduction mode when the timer is
clocked asynchronously: When the interrupt condition is met, the wake up process is started
on the following cycle of the timer clock, that is, the timer is always advanced by at least one
before the processor can read the counter value. After wake-up, the MCU is halted for four
cycles, it executes the interrupt routine, and resumes execution from the instruction
following SLEEP.
Reading of the TCNT2 Register shortly after wake-up from Power-save may give an
incorrect result. Since TCNT2 is clocked on the asynchronous TOSC clock, reading TCNT2
must be done through a register synchronized to the internal I/O clock domain.
Synchronization takes place for every rising TOSC1 edge. When waking up from Power-
save mode, and the I/O clock (clkI/O) again becomes active, TCNT2 will read as the previous
value (before entering sleep) until the next rising TOSC1 edge. The phase of the TOSC
clock after waking up from Power-save mode is essentially unpredictable, as it depends on
the wake-up time. The recommended procedure for reading TCNT2 is thus as follows:
1. Write any value to either of the registers OCR2x or TCCR2x.
2. Wait for the corresponding Update Busy Flag to be cleared.
3. Read TCNT2.
•
During asynchronous operation, the synchronization of the Interrupt Flags for the
asynchronous timer takes 3 processor cycles plus one timer cycle. The timer is therefore
advanced by at least one before the processor can read the timer value causing the setting
186
ATmega640/1280/1281/2560/2561
2549L–AVR–08/07
ATmega640/1280/1281/2560/2561
of the Interrupt Flag. The Output Compare pin is changed on the timer clock and is not
synchronized to the processor clock.
20.9 Timer/Counter Prescaler
Figure 20-12. Prescaler for Timer/Counter2
clkI/O
clkT2S
10-BIT T/C PRESCALER
Clear
TOSC1
AS2
PSRASY
0
CS20
CS21
CS22
TIMER/COUNTER2 CLOCK SOURCE
clkT2
The clock source for Timer/Counter2 is named clkT2S. clkT2S is by default connected to the main
system I/O clock clkIO. By setting the AS2 bit in ASSR, Timer/Counter2 is asynchronously
clocked from the TOSC1 pin. This enables use of Timer/Counter2 as a Real Time Counter
(RTC). When AS2 is set, pins TOSC1 and TOSC2 are disconnected from Port C. A crystal can
then be connected between the TOSC1 and TOSC2 pins to serve as an independent clock
source for Timer/Counter2. The Oscillator is optimized for use with a 32.768 kHz crystal. By set-
ting the EXCLK bit in the ASSR, a 32 KHz external clock can be applied. See “ASSR –
Asynchronous Status Register” on page 193 for details.
For Timer/Counter2, the possible prescaled selections are: clkT2S/8, clkT2S/32, clkT2S/64,
clkT2S/128, clkT2S/256, and clkT2S/1024. Additionally, clkT2S as well as 0 (stop) may be selected.
Setting the PSRASY bit in GTCCR resets the prescaler. This allows the user to operate with a
predictable prescaler.
187
2549L–AVR–08/07
20.10 Register Description
20.10.1 TCCR2A –Timer/Counter Control Register A
Bit
7
COM2A1
R/W
6
COM2A0
R/W
5
COM2B1
R/W
4
COM2B0
R/W
3
–
2
–
1
WGM21
R/W
0
0
WGM20
R/W
0
TCCR2A
(0xB0)
Read/Write
Initial Value
R
0
R
0
0
0
0
0
• Bits 7:6 – COM2A1:0: Compare Match Output A Mode
These bits control the Output Compare pin (OC2A) behavior. If one or both of the COM2A1:0
bits are set, the OC2A output overrides the normal port functionality of the I/O pin it is connected
to. However, note that the Data Direction Register (DDR) bit corresponding to the OC2A pin
must be set in order to enable the output driver.
When OC2A is connected to the pin, the function of the COM2A1:0 bits depends on the
WGM22:0 bit setting. Table 20-2 shows the COM2A1:0 bit functionality when the WGM22:0 bits
are set to a normal or CTC mode (non-PWM).
Table 20-2. Compare Output Mode, non-PWM Mode
COM2A1
COM2A0
Description
0
0
1
1
0
1
0
1
Normal port operation, OC2A disconnected.
Toggle OC2A on Compare Match
Clear OC2A on Compare Match
Set OC2A on Compare Match
Table 20-3 shows the COM2A1:0 bit functionality when the WGM21:0 bits are set to fast PWM
mode.
Table 20-3. Compare Output Mode, Fast PWM Mode(1)
COM2A1
COM2A0
Description
0
0
Normal port operation, OC2A disconnected.
WGM22 = 0: Normal Port Operation, OC2A Disconnected.
WGM22 = 1: Toggle OC2A on Compare Match.
0
1
1
1
0
1
Clear OC2A on Compare Match, set OC2A at BOTTOM,
(non-inverting mode).
Set OC2A on Compare Match, clear OC2A at BOTTOM,
(inverting mode).
Note:
1. A special case occurs when OCR2A equals TOP and COM2A1 is set. In this case, the Com-
pare Match is ignored, but the set or clear is done at BOTTOM. See “Fast PWM Mode” on
page 179 for more details.
Table 20-4 shows the COM2A1:0 bit functionality when the WGM22:0 bits are set to phase cor-
rect PWM mode.
188
ATmega640/1280/1281/2560/2561
2549L–AVR–08/07
ATmega640/1280/1281/2560/2561
Table 20-4. Compare Output Mode, Phase Correct PWM Mode(1)
COM2A1
COM2A0
Description
0
0
Normal port operation, OC2A disconnected.
WGM22 = 0: Normal Port Operation, OC2A Disconnected.
WGM22 = 1: Toggle OC2A on Compare Match.
0
1
1
1
0
1
Clear OC2A on Compare Match when up-counting. Set OC2A on
Compare Match when down-counting.
Set OC2A on Compare Match when up-counting. Clear OC2A on
Compare Match when down-counting.
Note:
1. A special case occurs when OCR2A equals TOP and COM2A1 is set. In this case, the Com-
pare Match is ignored, but the set or clear is done at TOP. See “Phase Correct PWM Mode” on
page 180 for more details.
• Bits 5:4 – COM2B1:0: Compare Match Output B Mode
These bits control the Output Compare pin (OC2B) behavior. If one or both of the COM2B1:0
bits are set, the OC2B output overrides the normal port functionality of the I/O pin it is connected
to. However, note that the Data Direction Register (DDR) bit corresponding to the OC2B pin
must be set in order to enable the output driver.
When OC2B is connected to the pin, the function of the COM2B1:0 bits depends on the
WGM22:0 bit setting. Table 20-5 shows the COM2B1:0 bit functionality when the WGM22:0 bits
are set to a normal or CTC mode (non-PWM).
Table 20-5. Compare Output Mode, non-PWM Mode
COM2B1
COM2B0
Description
0
0
1
1
0
1
0
1
Normal port operation, OC2B disconnected.
Toggle OC2B on Compare Match
Clear OC2B on Compare Match
Set OC2B on Compare Match
Table 20-6 shows the COM2B1:0 bit functionality when the WGM22:0 bits are set to fast PWM
mode.
Table 20-6. Compare Output Mode, Fast PWM Mode(1)
COM2B1
COM2B0
Description
Normal port operation, OC2B disconnected.
Reserved
0
0
0
1
Clear OC2B on Compare Match, set OC2B at BOTTOM,
(non-inverting mode).
1
1
0
1
Set OC2B on Compare Match, clear OC2B at BOTTOM,
(inverting mode).
Note:
1. A special case occurs when OCR2B equals TOP and COM2B1 is set. In this case, the Com-
pare Match is ignored, but the set or clear is done at BOTTOM. See “Fast PWM Mode” on
page 179 for more details.
189
2549L–AVR–08/07
Table 20-7 shows the COM2B1:0 bit functionality when the WGM22:0 bits are set to phase cor-
rect PWM mode.
Table 20-7. Compare Output Mode, Phase Correct PWM Mode(1)
COM2B1
COM2B0
Description
Normal port operation, OC2B disconnected.
Reserved
0
0
0
1
Clear OC2B on Compare Match when up-counting. Set OC2B on
Compare Match when down-counting.
1
1
0
1
Set OC2B on Compare Match when up-counting. Clear OC2B on
Compare Match when down-counting.
Note:
1. A special case occurs when OCR2B equals TOP and COM2B1 is set. In this case, the Com-
pare Match is ignored, but the set or clear is done at TOP. See “Phase Correct PWM Mode” on
page 180 for more details.
• Bits 3, 2 – Res: Reserved Bits
These bits are reserved bits and will always read as zero.
• Bits 1:0 – WGM21:0: Waveform Generation Mode
Combined with the WGM22 bit found in the TCCR2B Register, these bits control the counting
sequence of the counter, the source for maximum (TOP) counter value, and what type of wave-
form generation to be used, see Table 20-8. Modes of operation supported by the Timer/Counter
unit are: Normal mode (counter), Clear Timer on Compare Match (CTC) mode, and two types of
Pulse Width Modulation (PWM) modes (see “Modes of Operation” on page 177).
Table 20-8. Waveform Generation Mode Bit Description
Timer/Counter
Mode of
Operation
Update of
OCRx at
TOV Flag
Mode
WGM2
WGM1
WGM0
TOP
Set on(1)(2)
0
0
0
0
Normal
0xFF
Immediate
TOP
MAX
PWM, Phase
1
0
0
1
0xFF
BOTTOM
Correct
2
3
4
0
0
1
1
1
0
0
1
0
CTC
OCRA
0xFF
–
Immediate
BOTTOM
–
MAX
MAX
–
Fast PWM
Reserved
PWM, Phase
5
1
0
1
OCRA
TOP
BOTTOM
Correct
6
7
1
1
1
1
0
1
Reserved
–
–
–
Fast PWM
OCRA
BOTTOM
TOP
Notes: 1. MAX= 0xFF
2. BOTTOM= 0x00
190
ATmega640/1280/1281/2560/2561
2549L–AVR–08/07
ATmega640/1280/1281/2560/2561
20.10.2 TCCR2B – Timer/Counter Control Register B
Bit
7
FOC2A
W
6
FOC2B
W
5
–
4
–
3
WGM22
R/W
0
2
CS22
R/W
0
1
CS21
R/W
0
0
CS20
R/W
0
TCCR2B
(0xB1)
Read/Write
Initial Value
R
0
R
0
0
0
• Bit 7 – FOC2A: Force Output Compare A
The FOC2A bit is only active when the WGM bits specify a non-PWM mode.
However, for ensuring compatibility with future devices, this bit must be set to zero when
TCCR2B is written when operating in PWM mode. When writing a logical one to the FOC2A bit,
an immediate Compare Match is forced on the Waveform Generation unit. The OC2A output is
changed according to its COM2A1:0 bits setting. Note that the FOC2A bit is implemented as a
strobe. Therefore it is the value present in the COM2A1:0 bits that determines the effect of the
forced compare.
A FOC2A strobe will not generate any interrupt, nor will it clear the timer in CTC mode using
OCR2A as TOP.
The FOC2A bit is always read as zero.
• Bit 6 – FOC2B: Force Output Compare B
The FOC2B bit is only active when the WGM bits specify a non-PWM mode.
However, for ensuring compatibility with future devices, this bit must be set to zero when
TCCR2B is written when operating in PWM mode. When writing a logical one to the FOC2B bit,
an immediate Compare Match is forced on the Waveform Generation unit. The OC2B output is
changed according to its COM2B1:0 bits setting. Note that the FOC2B bit is implemented as a
strobe. Therefore it is the value present in the COM2B1:0 bits that determines the effect of the
forced compare.
A FOC2B strobe will not generate any interrupt, nor will it clear the timer in CTC mode using
OCR2B as TOP.
The FOC2B bit is always read as zero.
• Bits 5:4 – Res: Reserved Bits
These bits are reserved bits and will always read as zero.
• Bit 3 – WGM22: Waveform Generation Mode
See the description in the “TCCR2A –Timer/Counter Control Register A” on page 188.
• Bit 2:0 – CS22:0: Clock Select
The three Clock Select bits select the clock source to be used by the Timer/Counter, see Table
20-9.
191
2549L–AVR–08/07
Table 20-9. Clock Select Bit Description
CS22
CS21
CS20
Description
No clock source (Timer/Counter stopped).
clkT2S/(No prescaling)
0
0
0
0
1
1
1
1
0
0
1
1
0
0
1
1
0
1
0
1
0
1
0
1
clkT2S/8 (From prescaler)
clkT2S/32 (From prescaler)
clkT2S/64 (From prescaler)
clkT2S/128 (From prescaler)
clkT S/256 (From prescaler)
2
clkT S/1024 (From prescaler)
2
If external pin modes are used for the Timer/Counter0, transitions on the T0 pin will clock the
counter even if the pin is configured as an output. This feature allows software control of the
counting.
20.10.3 TCNT2 – Timer/Counter Register
Bit
7
6
5
4
3
2
1
0
(0xB2)
TCNT2[7:0]
TCNT2
Read/Write
Initial Value
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
The Timer/Counter Register gives direct access, both for read and write operations, to the
Timer/Counter unit 8-bit counter. Writing to the TCNT2 Register blocks (removes) the Compare
Match on the following timer clock. Modifying the counter (TCNT2) while the counter is running,
introduces a risk of missing a Compare Match between TCNT2 and the OCR2x Registers.
20.10.4 OCR2A – Output Compare Register A
Bit
7
6
5
4
3
2
1
0
(0xB3)
OCR2A[7:0]
OCR2A
Read/Write
Initial Value
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
The Output Compare Register A contains an 8-bit value that is continuously compared with the
counter value (TCNT2). A match can be used to generate an Output Compare interrupt, or to
generate a waveform output on the OC2A pin.
20.10.5 OCR2B – Output Compare Register B
Bit
7
6
5
4
3
2
1
0
(0xB4)
OCR2B[7:0]
OCR2B
Read/Write
Initial Value
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
The Output Compare Register B contains an 8-bit value that is continuously compared with the
counter value (TCNT2). A match can be used to generate an Output Compare interrupt, or to
generate a waveform output on the OC2B pin.
192
ATmega640/1280/1281/2560/2561
2549L–AVR–08/07
ATmega640/1280/1281/2560/2561
20.10.6 ASSR – Asynchronous Status Register
Bit
7
–
6
EXCLK
R/W
0
5
4
3
2
1
0
(0xB6)
AS2
R/W
0
TCN2UB
OCR2AUB
OCR2BUB
TCR2AUB
TCR2BUB
ASSR
Read/Write
Initial Value
R
0
R
0
R
0
R
0
R
0
R
0
• Bit 6 – EXCLK: Enable External Clock Input
When EXCLK is written to one, and asynchronous clock is selected, the external clock input
buffer is enabled and an external clock can be input on Timer Oscillator 1 (TOSC1) pin instead
of a 32 kHz crystal. Writing to EXCLK should be done before asynchronous operation is
selected. Note that the crystal Oscillator will only run when this bit is zero.
• Bit 5 – AS2: Asynchronous Timer/Counter2
When AS2 is written to zero, Timer/Counter2 is clocked from the I/O clock, clkI/O. When AS2 is
written to one, Timer/Counter2 is clocked from a crystal Oscillator connected to the Timer Oscil-
lator 1 (TOSC1) pin. When the value of AS2 is changed, the contents of TCNT2, OCR2A,
OCR2B, TCCR2A and TCCR2B might be corrupted.
• Bit 4 – TCN2UB: Timer/Counter2 Update Busy
When Timer/Counter2 operates asynchronously and TCNT2 is written, this bit becomes set.
When TCNT2 has been updated from the temporary storage register, this bit is cleared by hard-
ware. A logical zero in this bit indicates that TCNT2 is ready to be updated with a new value.
• Bit 3 – OCR2AUB: Output Compare Register2 Update Busy
When Timer/Counter2 operates asynchronously and OCR2A is written, this bit becomes set.
When OCR2A has been updated from the temporary storage register, this bit is cleared by hard-
ware. A logical zero in this bit indicates that OCR2A is ready to be updated with a new value.
• Bit 2 – OCR2BUB: Output Compare Register2 Update Busy
When Timer/Counter2 operates asynchronously and OCR2B is written, this bit becomes set.
When OCR2B has been updated from the temporary storage register, this bit is cleared by hard-
ware. A logical zero in this bit indicates that OCR2B is ready to be updated with a new value.
• Bit 1 – TCR2AUB: Timer/Counter Control Register2 Update Busy
When Timer/Counter2 operates asynchronously and TCCR2A is written, this bit becomes set.
When TCCR2A has been updated from the temporary storage register, this bit is cleared by
hardware. A logical zero in this bit indicates that TCCR2A is ready to be updated with a new
value.
• Bit 0 – TCR2BUB: Timer/Counter Control Register2 Update Busy
When Timer/Counter2 operates asynchronously and TCCR2B is written, this bit becomes set.
When TCCR2B has been updated from the temporary storage register, this bit is cleared by
hardware. A logical zero in this bit indicates that TCCR2B is ready to be updated with a new
value.
If a write is performed to any of the five Timer/Counter2 Registers while its update busy flag is
set, the updated value might get corrupted and cause an unintentional interrupt to occur.
193
2549L–AVR–08/07
The mechanisms for reading TCNT2, OCR2A, OCR2B, TCCR2A and TCCR2B are different.
When reading TCNT2, the actual timer value is read. When reading OCR2A, OCR2B, TCCR2A
and TCCR2B the value in the temporary storage register is read.
20.10.7 TIMSK2 – Timer/Counter2 Interrupt Mask Register
Bit
(0x70)
7
6
5
4
–
3
–
2
OCIE2B
R/W
0
1
OCIE2A
R/W
0
0
TOIE2
R/W
0
–
–
–
TIMSK2
Read/Write
R
0
R
0
R
0
R
0
R
0
Initial Value
• Bit 2 – OCIE2B: Timer/Counter2 Output Compare Match B Interrupt Enable
When the OCIE2B bit is written to one and the I-bit in the Status Register is set (one), the
Timer/Counter2 Compare Match B interrupt is enabled. The corresponding interrupt is executed
if a compare match in Timer/Counter2 occurs, i.e., when the OCF2B bit is set in the
Timer/Counter 2 Interrupt Flag Register – TIFR2.
• Bit 1 – OCIE2A: Timer/Counter2 Output Compare Match A Interrupt Enable
When the OCIE2A bit is written to one and the I-bit in the Status Register is set (one), the
Timer/Counter2 Compare Match A interrupt is enabled. The corresponding interrupt is executed
if a compare match in Timer/Counter2 occurs, i.e., when the OCF2A bit is set in the
Timer/Counter 2 Interrupt Flag Register – TIFR2.
• Bit 0 – TOIE2: Timer/Counter2 Overflow Interrupt Enable
When the TOIE2 bit is written to one and the I-bit in the Status Register is set (one), the
Timer/Counter2 Overflow interrupt is enabled. The corresponding interrupt is executed if an
overflow in Timer/Counter2 occurs, i.e., when the TOV2 bit is set in the Timer/Counter2 Interrupt
Flag Register – TIFR2.
20.10.8 TIFR2 – Timer/Counter2 Interrupt Flag Register
Bit
0x17 (0x37)
7
6
5
–
4
–
3
–
2
OCF2B
R/W
0
1
OCF2A
R/W
0
0
TOV2
R/W
0
–
–
TIFR2
Read/Write
R
0
R
0
R
0
R
0
R
0
Initial Value
• Bit 2 – OCF2B: Output Compare Flag 2 B
The OCF2B bit is set (one) when a compare match occurs between the Timer/Counter2 and the
data in OCR2B – Output Compare Register2. OCF2B is cleared by hardware when executing
the corresponding interrupt handling vector. Alternatively, OCF2B is cleared by writing a logic
one to the flag. When the I-bit in SREG, OCIE2B (Timer/Counter2 Compare match Interrupt
Enable), and OCF2B are set (one), the Timer/Counter2 Compare match Interrupt is executed.
• Bit 1 – OCF2A: Output Compare Flag 2 A
The OCF2A bit is set (one) when a compare match occurs between the Timer/Counter2 and the
data in OCR2A – Output Compare Register2. OCF2A is cleared by hardware when executing
the corresponding interrupt handling vector. Alternatively, OCF2A is cleared by writing a logic
one to the flag. When the I-bit in SREG, OCIE2A (Timer/Counter2 Compare match Interrupt
Enable), and OCF2A are set (one), the Timer/Counter2 Compare match Interrupt is executed.
194
ATmega640/1280/1281/2560/2561
2549L–AVR–08/07
ATmega640/1280/1281/2560/2561
• Bit 0 – TOV2: Timer/Counter2 Overflow Flag
The TOV2 bit is set (one) when an overflow occurs in Timer/Counter2. TOV2 is cleared by hard-
ware when executing the corresponding interrupt handling vector. Alternatively, TOV2 is cleared
by writing a logic one to the flag. When the SREG I-bit, TOIE2A (Timer/Counter2 Overflow Inter-
rupt Enable), and TOV2 are set (one), the Timer/Counter2 Overflow interrupt is executed. In
PWM mode, this bit is set when Timer/Counter2 changes counting direction at 0x00.
20.10.9 GTCCR – General Timer/Counter Control Register
Bit
0x23 (0x43)
7
6
5
4
–
3
–
2
–
1
0
TSM
–
–
PSRASY PSRSYNC
GTCCR
Read/Write
R/W
R
0
R
0
R
0
R
0
R
0
R/W
R/W
Initial Value
0
0
0
• Bit 1 – PSRASY: Prescaler Reset Timer/Counter2
When this bit is one, the Timer/Counter2 prescaler will be reset. This bit is normally cleared
immediately by hardware. If the bit is written when Timer/Counter2 is operating in asynchronous
mode, the bit will remain one until the prescaler has been reset. The bit will not be cleared by
hardware if the TSM bit is set. Refer to the description of the “Bit 7 – TSM: Timer/Counter Syn-
chronization Mode” on page 171 for a description of the Timer/Counter Synchronization mode.
195
2549L–AVR–08/07
21. SPI – Serial Peripheral Interface
The Serial Peripheral Interface (SPI) allows high-speed synchronous data transfer between the
ATmega640/1280/1281/2560/2561 and peripheral devices or between several AVR devices.
The ATmega640/1280/1281/2560/2561 SPI includes the following features:
• Full-duplex, Three-wire Synchronous Data Transfer
• Master or Slave Operation
• LSB First or MSB First Data Transfer
• Seven Programmable Bit Rates
• End of Transmission Interrupt Flag
• Write Collision Flag Protection
• Wake-up from Idle Mode
• Double Speed (CK/2) Master SPI Mode
USART can also be used in Master SPI mode, see “USART in SPI Mode” on page 232.
The Power Reduction SPI bit, PRSPI, in “PRR0 – Power Reduction Register 0” on page 56 on
page 50 must be written to zero to enable SPI module.
Figure 21-1. SPI Block Diagram(1)
DIVIDER
/2/4/8/16/32/64/128
Note:
1. Refer to Figure 1-1 on page 2, and Table 13-6 on page 79 for SPI pin placement.
The interconnection between Master and Slave CPUs with SPI is shown in Figure 21-2. The sys-
tem consists of two shift Registers, and a Master clock generator. The SPI Master initiates the
communication cycle when pulling low the Slave Select SS pin of the desired Slave. Master and
196
ATmega640/1280/1281/2560/2561
2549L–AVR–08/07
ATmega640/1280/1281/2560/2561
Slave prepare the data to be sent in their respective shift Registers, and the Master generates
the required clock pulses on the SCK line to interchange data. Data is always shifted from Mas-
ter to Slave on the Master Out – Slave In, MOSI, line, and from Slave to Master on the Master In
– Slave Out, MISO, line. After each data packet, the Master will synchronize the Slave by pulling
high the Slave Select, SS, line.
When configured as a Master, the SPI interface has no automatic control of the SS line. This
must be handled by user software before communication can start. When this is done, writing a
byte to the SPI Data Register starts the SPI clock generator, and the hardware shifts the eight
bits into the Slave. After shifting one byte, the SPI clock generator stops, setting the end of
Transmission Flag (SPIF). If the SPI Interrupt Enable bit (SPIE) in the SPCR Register is set, an
interrupt is requested. The Master may continue to shift the next byte by writing it into SPDR, or
signal the end of packet by pulling high the Slave Select, SS line. The last incoming byte will be
kept in the Buffer Register for later use.
When configured as a Slave, the SPI interface will remain sleeping with MISO tri-stated as long
as the SS pin is driven high. In this state, software may update the contents of the SPI Data
Register, SPDR, but the data will not be shifted out by incoming clock pulses on the SCK pin
until the SS pin is driven low. As one byte has been completely shifted, the end of Transmission
Flag, SPIF is set. If the SPI Interrupt Enable bit, SPIE, in the SPCR Register is set, an interrupt
is requested. The Slave may continue to place new data to be sent into SPDR before reading
the incoming data. The last incoming byte will be kept in the Buffer Register for later use.
Figure 21-2. SPI Master-slave Interconnection
SHIFT
ENABLE
The system is single buffered in the transmit direction and double buffered in the receive direc-
tion. This means that bytes to be transmitted cannot be written to the SPI Data Register before
the entire shift cycle is completed. When receiving data, however, a received character must be
read from the SPI Data Register before the next character has been completely shifted in. Oth-
erwise, the first byte is lost.
In SPI Slave mode, the control logic will sample the incoming signal of the SCK pin. To ensure
correct sampling of the clock signal, the minimum low and high periods should be:
Low period: longer than 2 CPU clock cycles
High period: longer than 2 CPU clock cycles
197
2549L–AVR–08/07
When the SPI is enabled, the data direction of the MOSI, MISO, SCK, and SS pins is overridden
according to Table 21-1. For more details on automatic port overrides, refer to “Alternate Port
Functions” on page 75.
Table 21-1. SPI Pin Overrides(1)
Pin
MOSI
MISO
SCK
SS
Direction, Master SPI
User Defined
Input
Direction, Slave SPI
Input
User Defined
Input
User Defined
User Defined
Input
Note:
1. See “Alternate Functions of Port B” on page 79 for a detailed description of how to define the
direction of the user defined SPI pins.
The following code examples show how to initialize the SPI as a Master and how to perform a
simple transmission. DDR_SPI in the examples must be replaced by the actual Data Direction
Register controlling the SPI pins. DD_MOSI, DD_MISO and DD_SCK must be replaced by the
actual data direction bits for these pins. E.g. if MOSI is placed on pin PB5, replace DD_MOSI
with DDB5 and DDR_SPI with DDRB.
198
ATmega640/1280/1281/2560/2561
2549L–AVR–08/07
ATmega640/1280/1281/2560/2561
Assembly Code Example(1)
SPI_MasterInit:
; Set MOSI and SCK output, all others input
ldi r17,(1<<DD_MOSI)|(1<<DD_SCK)
out DDR_SPI,r17
; Enable SPI, Master, set clock rate fck/16
ldi r17,(1<<SPE)|(1<<MSTR)|(1<<SPR0)
out SPCR,r17
ret
SPI_MasterTransmit:
; Start transmission of data (r16)
out SPDR,r16
Wait_Transmit:
; Wait for transmission complete
sbis SPSR,SPIF
rjmp Wait_Transmit
ret
C Code Example(1)
void SPI_MasterInit(void)
{
/* Set MOSI and SCK output, all others input */
DDR_SPI = (1<<DD_MOSI)|(1<<DD_SCK);
/* Enable SPI, Master, set clock rate fck/16 */
SPCR = (1<<SPE)|(1<<MSTR)|(1<<SPR0);
}
void SPI_MasterTransmit(char cData)
{
/* Start transmission */
SPDR = cData;
/* Wait for transmission complete */
while(!(SPSR & (1<<SPIF)))
;
}
Note:
1. See “About Code Examples” on page 10.
199
2549L–AVR–08/07
The following code examples show how to initialize the SPI as a Slave and how to perform a
simple reception.
Assembly Code Example(1)
SPI_SlaveInit:
; Set MISO output, all others input
ldi r17,(1<<DD_MISO)
out DDR_SPI,r17
; Enable SPI
ldi r17,(1<<SPE)
out SPCR,r17
ret
SPI_SlaveReceive:
; Wait for reception complete
sbis SPSR,SPIF
rjmp SPI_SlaveReceive
; Read received data and return
in
r16,SPDR
ret
C Code Example(1)
void SPI_SlaveInit(void)
{
/* Set MISO output, all others input */
DDR_SPI = (1<<DD_MISO);
/* Enable SPI */
SPCR = (1<<SPE);
}
char SPI_SlaveReceive(void)
{
/* Wait for reception complete */
while(!(SPSR & (1<<SPIF)))
;
/* Return Data Register */
return SPDR;
}
Note:
1. See “About Code Examples” on page 10.
200
ATmega640/1280/1281/2560/2561
2549L–AVR–08/07
ATmega640/1280/1281/2560/2561
21.1 SS Pin Functionality
21.1.1
Slave Mode
When the SPI is configured as a Slave, the Slave Select (SS) pin is always input. When SS is
held low, the SPI is activated, and MISO becomes an output if configured so by the user. All
other pins are inputs. When SS is driven high, all pins are inputs, and the SPI is passive, which
means that it will not receive incoming data. Note that the SPI logic will be reset once the SS pin
is driven high.
The SS pin is useful for packet/byte synchronization to keep the slave bit counter synchronous
with the master clock generator. When the SS pin is driven high, the SPI slave will immediately
reset the send and receive logic, and drop any partially received data in the Shift Register.
21.1.2
Master Mode
When the SPI is configured as a Master (MSTR in SPCR is set), the user can determine the
direction of the SS pin.
If SS is configured as an output, the pin is a general output pin which does not affect the SPI
system. Typically, the pin will be driving the SS pin of the SPI Slave.
If SS is configured as an input, it must be held high to ensure Master SPI operation. If the SS pin
is driven low by peripheral circuitry when the SPI is configured as a Master with the SS pin
defined as an input, the SPI system interprets this as another master selecting the SPI as a
slave and starting to send data to it. To avoid bus contention, the SPI system takes the following
actions:
1. The MSTR bit in SPCR is cleared and the SPI system becomes a Slave. As a result of
the SPI becoming a Slave, the MOSI and SCK pins become inputs.
2. The SPIF Flag in SPSR is set, and if the SPI interrupt is enabled, and the I-bit in SREG is
set, the interrupt routine will be executed.
Thus, when interrupt-driven SPI transmission is used in Master mode, and there exists a possi-
bility that SS is driven low, the interrupt should always check that the MSTR bit is still set. If the
MSTR bit has been cleared by a slave select, it must be set by the user to re-enable SPI Master
mode.
21.1.3
Data Modes
There are four combinations of SCK phase and polarity with respect to serial data, which are
determined by control bits CPHA and CPOL. The SPI data transfer formats are shown in Figure
21-3 and Figure 21-4. Data bits are shifted out and latched in on opposite edges of the SCK sig-
nal, ensuring sufficient time for data signals to stabilize. This is clearly seen by summarizing
Table 21-3 and Table 21-4, as done below:
201
2549L–AVR–08/07
Table 21-2. CPOL Functionality
Leading Edge
Sample (Rising)
Setup (Rising)
Sample (Falling)
Setup (Falling)
Trailing eDge
Setup (Falling)
Sample (Falling)
Setup (Rising)
Sample (Rising)
SPI Mode
CPOL=0, CPHA=0
CPOL=0, CPHA=1
CPOL=1, CPHA=0
CPOL=1, CPHA=1
0
1
2
3
Figure 21-3. SPI Transfer Format with CPHA = 0
SCK (CPOL = 0)
mode 0
SCK (CPOL = 1)
mode 2
SAMPLE I
MOSI/MISO
CHANGE 0
MOSI PIN
CHANGE 0
MISO PIN
SS
MSB first (DORD = 0) MSB
LSB first (DORD = 1) LSB
Bit 6
Bit 1
Bit 5
Bit 2
Bit 4
Bit 3
Bit 3
Bit 4
Bit 2
Bit 5
Bit 1
Bit 6
LSB
MSB
Figure 21-4. SPI Transfer Format with CPHA = 1
SCK (CPOL = 0)
mode 1
SCK (CPOL = 1)
mode 3
SAMPLE I
MOSI/MISO
CHANGE 0
MOSI PIN
CHANGE 0
MISO PIN
SS
MSB first (DORD = 0)
LSB first (DORD = 1)
MSB
LSB
Bit 6
Bit 1
Bit 5
Bit 2
Bit 4
Bit 3
Bit 3
Bit 4
Bit 2
Bit 5
Bit 1
Bit 6
LSB
MSB
202
ATmega640/1280/1281/2560/2561
2549L–AVR–08/07
ATmega640/1280/1281/2560/2561
21.2 Register Description
21.2.1
SPCR – SPI Control Register
Bit
7
SPIE
R/W
0
6
5
DORD
R/W
0
4
MSTR
R/W
0
3
CPOL
R/W
0
2
CPHA
R/W
0
1
SPR1
R/W
0
0
SPR0
R/W
0
0x2C (0x4C)
Read/Write
Initial Value
SPE
R/W
0
SPCR
• Bit 7 – SPIE: SPI Interrupt Enable
This bit causes the SPI interrupt to be executed if SPIF bit in the SPSR Register is set and the if
the Global Interrupt Enable bit in SREG is set.
• Bit 6 – SPE: SPI Enable
When the SPE bit is written to one, the SPI is enabled. This bit must be set to enable any SPI
operations.
• Bit 5 – DORD: Data Order
When the DORD bit is written to one, the LSB of the data word is transmitted first.
When the DORD bit is written to zero, the MSB of the data word is transmitted first.
• Bit 4 – MSTR: Master/Slave Select
This bit selects Master SPI mode when written to one, and Slave SPI mode when written logic
zero. If SS is configured as an input and is driven low while MSTR is set, MSTR will be cleared,
and SPIF in SPSR will become set. The user will then have to set MSTR to re-enable SPI Mas-
ter mode.
• Bit 3 – CPOL: Clock Polarity
When this bit is written to one, SCK is high when idle. When CPOL is written to zero, SCK is low
when idle. Refer to Figure 21-3 and Figure 21-4 for an example. The CPOL functionality is sum-
marized below:
Table 21-3. CPOL Functionality
CPOL
Leading Edge
Rising
Trailing Edge
Falling
0
1
Falling
Rising
• Bit 2 – CPHA: Clock Phase
The settings of the Clock Phase bit (CPHA) determine if data is sampled on the leading (first) or
trailing (last) edge of SCK. Refer to Figure 21-3 and Figure 21-4 for an example. The CPOL
functionality is summarized below:
Table 21-4. CPHA Functionality
CPHA
Leading Edge
Sample
Trailing Edge
Setup
0
1
Setup
Sample
203
2549L–AVR–08/07
• Bits 1, 0 – SPR1, SPR0: SPI Clock Rate Select 1 and 0
These two bits control the SCK rate of the device configured as a Master. SPR1 and SPR0 have
no effect on the Slave. The relationship between SCK and the Oscillator Clock frequency fosc is
shown in the following table:
Table 21-5. Relationship Between SCK and the Oscillator Frequency
SPI2X
SPR1
SPR0
SCK Frequency
fosc/4
0
0
0
0
1
1
1
1
0
0
1
1
0
0
1
1
0
1
0
1
0
1
0
1
fosc/16
fosc/64
fosc/128
fosc/2
fosc/8
fosc/32
fosc/64
21.2.2
SPSR – SPI Status Register
Bit
7
SPIF
R
6
5
–
4
–
3
–
2
–
1
–
0
SPI2X
R/W
0
0x2D (0x4D)
Read/Write
Initial Value
WCOL
SPSR
R
0
R
0
R
0
R
0
R
0
R
0
0
• Bit 7 – SPIF: SPI Interrupt Flag
When a serial transfer is complete, the SPIF Flag is set. An interrupt is generated if SPIE in
SPCR is set and global interrupts are enabled. If SS is an input and is driven low when the SPI is
in Master mode, this will also set the SPIF Flag. SPIF is cleared by hardware when executing the
corresponding interrupt handling vector. Alternatively, the SPIF bit is cleared by first reading the
SPI Status Register with SPIF set, then accessing the SPI Data Register (SPDR).
• Bit 6 – WCOL: Write COLlision Flag
The WCOL bit is set if the SPI Data Register (SPDR) is written during a data transfer. The
WCOL bit (and the SPIF bit) are cleared by first reading the SPI Status Register with WCOL set,
and then accessing the SPI Data Register.
• Bit 5:1 – Res: Reserved Bits
These bits are reserved bits and will always read as zero.
• Bit 0 – SPI2X: Double SPI Speed Bit
When this bit is written logic one the SPI speed (SCK Frequency) will be doubled when the SPI
is in Master mode (see Table 21-5). This means that the minimum SCK period will be two CPU
clock periods. When the SPI is configured as Slave, the SPI is only guaranteed to work at fosc/4
or lower.
The SPI interface on the ATmega640/1280/1281/2560/2561 is also used for program memory
and EEPROM downloading or uploading. See “Serial Downloading” on page 351 for serial pro-
gramming and verification.
204
ATmega640/1280/1281/2560/2561
2549L–AVR–08/07
ATmega640/1280/1281/2560/2561
21.2.3
SPDR – SPI Data Register
Bit
7
6
5
4
3
2
1
0
0x2E (0x4E)
Read/Write
Initial Value
MSB
R/W
X
LSB
R/W
X
SPDR
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
X
X
X
X
X
X
Undefined
The SPI Data Register is a read/write register used for data transfer between the Register File
and the SPI Shift Register. Writing to the register initiates data transmission. Reading the regis-
ter causes the Shift Register Receive buffer to be read.
205
2549L–AVR–08/07
22. USART
22.1 Features
• Full Duplex Operation (Independent Serial Receive and Transmit Registers)
• Asynchronous or Synchronous Operation
• Master or Slave Clocked Synchronous Operation
• High Resolution Baud Rate Generator
• Supports Serial Frames with 5, 6, 7, 8, or 9 Data Bits and 1 or 2 Stop Bits
• Odd or Even Parity Generation and Parity Check Supported by Hardware
• Data OverRun Detection
• Framing Error Detection
• Noise Filtering Includes False Start Bit Detection and Digital Low Pass Filter
• Three Separate Interrupts on TX Complete, TX Data Register Empty and RX Complete
• Multi-processor Communication Mode
• Double Speed Asynchronous Communication Mode
Overview
The Universal Synchronous and Asynchronous serial Receiver and Transmitter (USART) is a
highly flexible serial communication device.
The ATmega640/1280/2560 has four USART’s, USART0, USART1, USART2, and USART3.
The functionality for all four USART’s is described below. USART0, USART1, USART2, and
USART3 have different I/O registers as shown in “Register Summary” on page 414.
A simplified block diagram of the USART Transmitter is shown in Figure 22-1 on page 207. CPU
accessible I/O Registers and I/O pins are shown in bold.
The Power Reducion USART0 bit, PRUSART0, in “PRR0 – Power Reduction Register 0” on
page 56 must be disabled by writing a logical zero to it.
The Power Reducion USART1 bit, PRUSART1, in “PRR1 – Power Reduction Register 1” on
page 57 must be disabled by writing a logical zero to it.
The Power Reducion USART2 bit, PRUSART2, in “PRR1 – Power Reduction Register 1” on
page 57 must be disabled by writing a logical zero to it.
The Power Reducion USART3 bit, PRUSART3, in “PRR1 – Power Reduction Register 1” on
page 57 must be disabled by writing a logical zero to it.
206
ATmega640/1280/1281/2560/2561
2549L–AVR–08/07
ATmega640/1280/1281/2560/2561
Figure 22-1. USART Block Diagram(1)
Clock Generator
UBRR[H:L]
OSC
BAUD RATE GENERATOR
SYNC LOGIC
PIN
CONTROL
XCK
TxD
RxD
Transmitter
TX
CONTROL
UDR (Transmit)
PARITY
GENERATOR
PIN
CONTROL
TRANSMIT SHIFT REGISTER
Receiver
CLOCK
RECOVERY
RX
CONTROL
DATA
RECOVERY
PIN
CONTROL
RECEIVE SHIFT REGISTER
PARITY
CHECKER
UDR (Receive)
UCSRA
UCSRB
UCSRC
Note:
1. See Figure 1-1 on page 2, Figure 1-3 on page 4, Table 1 on page 83, Table 13-14 on page 86,
Table 13-23 on page 92 and Table 13-26 on page 95 for USART pin placement.
The dashed boxes in the block diagram separate the three main parts of the USART (listed from
the top): Clock Generator, Transmitter and Receiver. Control Registers are shared by all units.
The Clock Generation logic consists of synchronization logic for external clock input used by
synchronous slave operation, and the baud rate generator. The XCKn (Transfer Clock) pin is
only used by synchronous transfer mode. The Transmitter consists of a single write buffer, a
serial Shift Register, Parity Generator and Control logic for handling different serial frame for-
mats. The write buffer allows a continuous transfer of data without any delay between frames.
The Receiver is the most complex part of the USART module due to its clock and data recovery
units. The recovery units are used for asynchronous data reception. In addition to the recovery
units, the Receiver includes a Parity Checker, Control logic, a Shift Register and a two level
receive buffer (UDRn). The Receiver supports the same frame formats as the Transmitter, and
can detect Frame Error, Data OverRun and Parity Errors.
22.2 Clock Generation
The Clock Generation logic generates the base clock for the Transmitter and Receiver. The
USARTn supports four modes of clock operation: Normal asynchronous, Double Speed asyn-
chronous, Master synchronous and Slave synchronous mode. The UMSELn bit in USART
Control and Status Register C (UCSRnC) selects between asynchronous and synchronous
operation. Double Speed (asynchronous mode only) is controlled by the U2Xn found in the
207
2549L–AVR–08/07
UCSRnA Register. When using synchronous mode (UMSELn = 1), the Data Direction Register
for the XCKn pin (DDR_XCKn) controls whether the clock source is internal (Master mode) or
external (Slave mode). The XCKn pin is only active when using synchronous mode.
Figure 22-2 shows a block diagram of the clock generation logic.
Figure 22-2. Clock Generation Logic, Block Diagram
UBRR
U2X
fosc
UBRR+1
Prescaling
Down-Counter
/2
/4
/2
0
1
0
1
OSC
txclk
UMSEL
rxclk
DDR_XCK
Sync
Register
Edge
Detector
xcki
0
1
XCK
Pin
xcko
DDR_XCK
UCPOL
1
0
Signal description:
txclk
Transmitter clock (Internal Signal).
Receiver base clock (Internal Signal).
rxclk
xcki
Input from XCK pin (internal Signal). Used for synchronous slave
operation.
xcko
fOSC
Clock output to XCK pin (Internal Signal). Used for synchronous master
operation.
XTAL pin frequency (System Clock).
22.2.1
Internal Clock Generation – The Baud Rate Generator
Internal clock generation is used for the asynchronous and the synchronous master modes of
operation. The description in this section refers to Figure 22-2.
The USART Baud Rate Register (UBRRn) and the down-counter connected to it function as a
programmable prescaler or baud rate generator. The down-counter, running at system clock
(fosc), is loaded with the UBRRn value each time the counter has counted down to zero or when
the UBRRLn Register is written. A clock is generated each time the counter reaches zero. This
clock is the baud rate generator clock output (= fosc/(UBRRn+1)). The Transmitter divides the
baud rate generator clock output by 2, 8 or 16 depending on mode. The baud rate generator out-
put is used directly by the Receiver’s clock and data recovery units. However, the recovery units
use a state machine that uses 2, 8 or 16 states depending on mode set by the state of the
UMSELn, U2Xn and DDR_XCKn bits.
Table 22-1 contains equations for calculating the baud rate (in bits per second) and for calculat-
ing the UBRRn value for each mode of operation using an internally generated clock source.
Note:
1. The baud rate is defined to be the transfer rate in bit per second (bps)
BAUD
fOSC
Baud rate (in bits per second, bps)
System Oscillator clock frequency
208
ATmega640/1280/1281/2560/2561
2549L–AVR–08/07
ATmega640/1280/1281/2560/2561
Table 22-1. Equations for Calculating Baud Rate Register Setting
Equation for Calculating Equation for Calculating
Operating Mode
Baud Rate(1)
UBRR Value
f
OSC
UBRRn = ----------------------- – 1
16BAUD
f
Asynchronous Normal
mode (U2Xn = 0)
OSC
BAUD = -----------------------------------------
16(UBRRn + 1)
f
OSC
UBRRn = -------------------- – 1
8BAUD
Asynchronous Double
Speed mode (U2Xn =
1)
f
OSC
BAUD = --------------------------------------
8(UBRRn + 1)
f
OSC
UBRRn = -------------------- – 1
2BAUD
f
OSC
Synchronous Master
mode
BAUD = --------------------------------------
2(UBRRn + 1)
UBRRn
Contents of the UBRRHn and UBRRLn Registers, (0-4095)
Some examples of UBRRn values for some system clock frequencies are found in Table 22-9 on
page 228.
22.2.2
Double Speed Operation (U2Xn)
The transfer rate can be doubled by setting the U2Xn bit in UCSRnA. Setting this bit only has
effect for the asynchronous operation. Set this bit to zero when using synchronous operation.
Setting this bit will reduce the divisor of the baud rate divider from 16 to 8, effectively doubling
the transfer rate for asynchronous communication. Note however that the Receiver will in this
case only use half the number of samples (reduced from 16 to 8) for data sampling and clock
recovery, and therefore a more accurate baud rate setting and system clock are required when
this mode is used. For the Transmitter, there are no downsides.
22.2.3
External Clock
External clocking is used by the synchronous slave modes of operation. The description in this
section refers to Figure 22-2 for details.
External clock input from the XCKn pin is sampled by a synchronization register to minimize the
chance of meta-stability. The output from the synchronization register must then pass through
an edge detector before it can be used by the Transmitter and Receiver. This process intro-
209
2549L–AVR–08/07
duces a two CPU clock period delay and therefore the maximum external XCKn clock frequency
is limited by the following equation:
f
OSC
-----------
f
<
XCK
4
Note that fosc depends on the stability of the system clock source. It is therefore recommended to
add some margin to avoid possible loss of data due to frequency variations.
22.2.4
Synchronous Clock Operation
When synchronous mode is used (UMSELn = 1), the XCKn pin will be used as either clock input
(Slave) or clock output (Master). The dependency between the clock edges and data sampling
or data change is the same. The basic principle is that data input (on RxDn) is sampled at the
opposite XCKn clock edge of the edge the data output (TxDn) is changed.
Figure 22-3. Synchronous Mode XCKn Timing.
UCPOL = 1
XCK
RxD / TxD
Sample
Sample
UCPOL = 0
XCK
RxD / TxD
The UCPOLn bit UCRSC selects which XCKn clock edge is used for data sampling and which is
used for data change. As Figure 22-3 shows, when UCPOLn is zero the data will be changed at
rising XCKn edge and sampled at falling XCKn edge. If UCPOLn is set, the data will be changed
at falling XCKn edge and sampled at rising XCKn edge.
22.3 Frame Formats
A serial frame is defined to be one character of data bits with synchronization bits (start and stop
bits), and optionally a parity bit for error checking. The USART accepts all 30 combinations of
the following as valid frame formats:
•
•
•
•
1 start bit
5, 6, 7, 8, or 9 data bits
no, even or odd parity bit
1 or 2 stop bits
A frame starts with the start bit followed by the least significant data bit. Then the next data bits,
up to a total of nine, are succeeding, ending with the most significant bit. If enabled, the parity bit
is inserted after the data bits, before the stop bits. When a complete frame is transmitted, it can
be directly followed by a new frame, or the communication line can be set to an idle (high) state.
Figure 22-4 illustrates the possible combinations of the frame formats. Bits inside brackets are
optional.
210
ATmega640/1280/1281/2560/2561
2549L–AVR–08/07
ATmega640/1280/1281/2560/2561
Figure 22-4. Frame Formats
FRAME
(IDLE)
St
0
1
2
3
4
[5]
[6]
[7]
[8]
[P] Sp1 [Sp2] (St / IDLE)
St
Start bit, always low.
Data bits (0 to 8).
(n)
P
Parity bit. Can be odd or even.
Stop bit, always high.
Sp
IDLE
No transfers on the communication line (RxDn or TxDn). An IDLE line
must be
high.
The frame format used by the USART is set by the UCSZn2:0, UPMn1:0 and USBSn bits in
UCSRnB and UCSRnC. The Receiver and Transmitter use the same setting. Note that changing
the setting of any of these bits will corrupt all ongoing communication for both the Receiver and
Transmitter.
The USART Character SiZe (UCSZn2:0) bits select the number of data bits in the frame. The
USART Parity mode (UPMn1:0) bits enable and set the type of parity bit. The selection between
one or two stop bits is done by the USART Stop Bit Select (USBSn) bit. The Receiver ignores
the second stop bit. An FE (Frame Error) will therefore only be detected in the cases where the
first stop bit is zero.
22.3.1
Parity Bit Calculation
The parity bit is calculated by doing an exclusive-or of all the data bits. If odd parity is used, the
result of the exclusive or is inverted. The parity bit is located between the last data bit and first
stop bit of a serial frame. The relation between the parity bit and data bits is as follows::
P
P
= d
= d
⊕ … ⊕ d ⊕ d ⊕ d ⊕ d ⊕ 0
3 2 1 0
even
n – 1
n – 1
⊕ … ⊕ d ⊕ d ⊕ d ⊕ d ⊕ 1
odd
3 2 1 0
Peven
Podd
dn
Parity bit using even parity
Parity bit using odd parity
Data bit n of the character
22.4 USART Initialization
The USART has to be initialized before any communication can take place. The initialization pro-
cess normally consists of setting the baud rate, setting frame format and enabling the
Transmitter or the Receiver depending on the usage. For interrupt driven USART operation, the
Global Interrupt Flag should be cleared (and interrupts globally disabled) when doing the
initialization.
Before doing a re-initialization with changed baud rate or frame format, be sure that there are no
ongoing transmissions during the period the registers are changed. The TXCn Flag can be used
to check that the Transmitter has completed all transfers, and the RXC Flag can be used to
211
2549L–AVR–08/07
check that there are no unread data in the receive buffer. Note that the TXCn Flag must be
cleared before each transmission (before UDRn is written) if it is used for this purpose.
The following simple USART initialization code examples show one assembly and one C func-
tion that are equal in functionality. The examples assume asynchronous operation using polling
(no interrupts enabled) and a fixed frame format. The baud rate is given as a function parameter.
For the assembly code, the baud rate parameter is assumed to be stored in the r17:r16
Registers.
Assembly Code Example(1)
USART_Init:
; Set baud rate
out
out
UBRRnH, r17
UBRRnL, r16
; Enable receiver and transmitter
ldi
out
r16, (1<<RXENn)|(1<<TXENn)
UCSRnB,r16
; Set frame format: 8data, 2stop bit
ldi
out
ret
r16, (1<<USBSn)|(3<<UCSZn0)
UCSRnC,r16
C Code Example(1)
#define FOSC 1843200// Clock Speed
#define BAUD 9600
#define (MYUBRR FOSC/16/BAUD-1)
void main( void )
{...
USART_Init ( MYUBRR );
...} // main
void USART_Init( unsigned int ubrr){
/* Set baud rate */
UBRRH = (unsigned char)(ubrr>>8);
UBRRL = (unsigned char)ubrr;
/* Enable receiver and transmitter */
UCSRB = (1<<RXEN)|(1<<TXEN);
/* Set frame format: 8data, 2stop bit */
UCSRC = (1<<USBS)|(3<<UCSZ0);
} // USART_Init
Note:
1. See “About Code Examples” on page 10.
More advanced initialization routines can be made that include frame format as parameters, dis-
able interrupts and so on. However, many applications use a fixed setting of the baud and
control registers, and for these types of applications the initialization code can be placed directly
in the main routine, or be combined with initialization code for other I/O modules.
212
ATmega640/1280/1281/2560/2561
2549L–AVR–08/07
ATmega640/1280/1281/2560/2561
22.5 Data Transmission – The USART Transmitter
The USART Transmitter is enabled by setting the Transmit Enable (TXEN) bit in the UCSRnB
Register. When the Transmitter is enabled, the normal port operation of the TxDn pin is overrid-
den by the USART and given the function as the Transmitter’s serial output. The baud rate,
mode of operation and frame format must be set up once before doing any transmissions. If syn-
chronous operation is used, the clock on the XCKn pin will be overridden and used as
transmission clock.
22.5.1
Sending Frames with 5 to 8 Data Bit
A data transmission is initiated by loading the transmit buffer with the data to be transmitted. The
CPU can load the transmit buffer by writing to the UDRn I/O location. The buffered data in the
transmit buffer will be moved to the Shift Register when the Shift Register is ready to send a new
frame. The Shift Register is loaded with new data if it is in idle state (no ongoing transmission) or
immediately after the last stop bit of the previous frame is transmitted. When the Shift Register is
loaded with new data, it will transfer one complete frame at the rate given by the Baud Register,
U2Xn bit or by XCKn depending on mode of operation.
The following code examples show a simple USART transmit function based on polling of the
Data Register Empty (UDREn) Flag. When using frames with less than eight bits, the most sig-
nificant bits written to the UDRn are ignored. The USART has to be initialized before the function
can be used. For the assembly code, the data to be sent is assumed to be stored in Register
R16
Assembly Code Example(1)
USART_Transmit:
; Wait for empty transmit buffer
sbis UCSRnA,UDREn
rjmp USART_Transmit
; Put data (r16) into buffer, sends the data
out
ret
UDRn,r16
C Code Example(1)
void USART_Transmit( unsigned char data )
{
/* Wait for empty transmit buffer */
while ( !( UCSRnA & (1<<UDREn)) )
;
/* Put data into buffer, sends the data */
UDRn = data;
}
Note:
1. See “About Code Examples” on page 10.
The function simply waits for the transmit buffer to be empty by checking the UDREn Flag,
before loading it with new data to be transmitted. If the Data Register Empty interrupt is utilized,
the interrupt routine writes the data into the buffer.
213
2549L–AVR–08/07
22.5.2
Sending Frames with 9 Data Bit
If 9-bit characters are used (UCSZn = 7), the ninth bit must be written to the TXB8 bit in UCS-
RnB before the low byte of the character is written to UDRn. The following code examples show
a transmit function that handles 9-bit characters. For the assembly code, the data to be sent is
assumed to be stored in registers R17:R16.
Assembly Code Example(1)(2)
USART_Transmit:
; Wait for empty transmit buffer
sbis UCSRnA,UDREn
rjmp USART_Transmit
; Copy 9th bit from r17 to TXB8
cbi
UCSRnB,TXB8
sbrc r17,0
sbi
UCSRnB,TXB8
; Put LSB data (r16) into buffer, sends the data
out
ret
UDRn,r16
C Code Example(1)(2)
void USART_Transmit( unsigned int data )
{
/* Wait for empty transmit buffer */
while ( !( UCSRnA & (1<<UDREn))) )
;
/* Copy 9th bit to TXB8 */
UCSRnB &= ~(1<<TXB8);
if ( data & 0x0100 )
UCSRnB |= (1<<TXB8);
/* Put data into buffer, sends the data */
UDRn = data;
}
Notes: 1. These transmit functions are written to be general functions. They can be optimized if the con-
tents of the UCSRnB is static. For example, only the TXB8 bit of the UCSRnB Register is used
after initialization.
2. See “About Code Examples” on page 10.
The ninth bit can be used for indicating an address frame when using multi processor communi-
cation mode or for other protocol handling as for example synchronization.
22.5.3
Transmitter Flags and Interrupts
The USART Transmitter has two flags that indicate its state: USART Data Register Empty
(UDREn) and Transmit Complete (TXCn). Both flags can be used for generating interrupts.
The Data Register Empty (UDREn) Flag indicates whether the transmit buffer is ready to receive
new data. This bit is set when the transmit buffer is empty, and cleared when the transmit buffer
contains data to be transmitted that has not yet been moved into the Shift Register. For compat-
ibility with future devices, always write this bit to zero when writing the UCSRnA Register.
214
ATmega640/1280/1281/2560/2561
2549L–AVR–08/07
ATmega640/1280/1281/2560/2561
When the Data Register Empty Interrupt Enable (UDRIEn) bit in UCSRnB is written to one, the
USART Data Register Empty Interrupt will be executed as long as UDREn is set (provided that
global interrupts are enabled). UDREn is cleared by writing UDRn. When interrupt-driven data
transmission is used, the Data Register Empty interrupt routine must either write new data to
UDRn in order to clear UDREn or disable the Data Register Empty interrupt, otherwise a new
interrupt will occur once the interrupt routine terminates.
The Transmit Complete (TXCn) Flag bit is set one when the entire frame in the Transmit Shift
Register has been shifted out and there are no new data currently present in the transmit buffer.
The TXCn Flag bit is automatically cleared when a transmit complete interrupt is executed, or it
can be cleared by writing a one to its bit location. The TXCn Flag is useful in half-duplex commu-
nication interfaces (like the RS-485 standard), where a transmitting application must enter
receive mode and free the communication bus immediately after completing the transmission.
When the Transmit Compete Interrupt Enable (TXCIEn) bit in UCSRnB is set, the USART
Transmit Complete Interrupt will be executed when the TXCn Flag becomes set (provided that
global interrupts are enabled). When the transmit complete interrupt is used, the interrupt han-
dling routine does not have to clear the TXCn Flag, this is done automatically when the interrupt
is executed.
22.5.4
22.5.5
Parity Generator
The Parity Generator calculates the parity bit for the serial frame data. When parity bit is enabled
(UPMn1 = 1), the transmitter control logic inserts the parity bit between the last data bit and the
first stop bit of the frame that is sent.
Disabling the Transmitter
The disabling of the Transmitter (setting the TXEN to zero) will not become effective until ongo-
ing and pending transmissions are completed, i.e., when the Transmit Shift Register and
Transmit Buffer Register do not contain data to be transmitted. When disabled, the Transmitter
will no longer override the TxDn pin.
22.6 Data Reception – The USART Receiver
The USART Receiver is enabled by writing the Receive Enable (RXENn) bit in the
UCSRnB Register to one. When the Receiver is enabled, the normal pin operation of the RxDn
pin is overridden by the USART and given the function as the Receiver’s serial input. The baud
rate, mode of operation and frame format must be set up once before any serial reception can
be done. If synchronous operation is used, the clock on the XCKn pin will be used as transfer
clock.
22.6.1
Receiving Frames with 5 to 8 Data Bits
The Receiver starts data reception when it detects a valid start bit. Each bit that follows the start
bit will be sampled at the baud rate or XCKn clock, and shifted into the Receive Shift Register
until the first stop bit of a frame is received. A second stop bit will be ignored by the Receiver.
When the first stop bit is received, i.e., a complete serial frame is present in the Receive Shift
Register, the contents of the Shift Register will be moved into the receive buffer. The receive
buffer can then be read by reading the UDRn I/O location.
The following code example shows a simple USART receive function based on polling of the
Receive Complete (RXCn) Flag. When using frames with less than eight bits the most significant
215
2549L–AVR–08/07
bits of the data read from the UDRn will be masked to zero. The USART has to be initialized
before the function can be used.
Assembly Code Example(1)
USART_Receive:
; Wait for data to be received
sbis UCSRnA, RXCn
rjmp USART_Receive
; Get and return received data from buffer
in
r16, UDRn
ret
C Code Example(1)
unsigned char USART_Receive( void )
{
/* Wait for data to be received */
while ( !(UCSRnA & (1<<RXCn)) )
;
/* Get and return received data from buffer */
return UDRn;
}
Note:
1. See “About Code Examples” on page 10.
The function simply waits for data to be present in the receive buffer by checking the RXCn Flag,
before reading the buffer and returning the value.
22.6.2
Receiving Frames with 9 Data Bits
If 9-bit characters are used (UCSZn=7) the ninth bit must be read from the RXB8n bit in UCS-
RnB before reading the low bits from the UDRn. This rule applies to the FEn, DORn and UPEn
Status Flags as well. Read status from UCSRnA, then data from UDRn. Reading the UDRn I/O
location will change the state of the receive buffer FIFO and consequently the TXB8n, FEn,
DORn and UPEn bits, which all are stored in the FIFO, will change.
The following code example shows a simple USART receive function that handles both nine bit
characters and the status bits.
216
ATmega640/1280/1281/2560/2561
2549L–AVR–08/07
ATmega640/1280/1281/2560/2561
Assembly Code Example(1)
USART_Receive:
; Wait for data to be received
sbis UCSRnA, RXCn
rjmp USART_Receive
; Get status and 9th bit, then data from buffer
in
in
in
r18, UCSRnA
r17, UCSRnB
r16, UDRn
; If error, return -1
andi r18,(1<<FEn)|(1<<DORn)|(1<<UPEn)
breq USART_ReceiveNoError
ldi
ldi
r17, HIGH(-1)
r16, LOW(-1)
USART_ReceiveNoError:
; Filter the 9th bit, then return
lsr
r17
andi r17, 0x01
ret
C Code Example(1)
unsigned int USART_Receive( void )
{
unsigned char status, resh, resl;
/* Wait for data to be received */
while ( !(UCSRnA & (1<<RXCn)) )
;
/* Get status and 9th bit, then data */
/* from buffer */
status = UCSRnA;
resh = UCSRnB;
resl = UDRn;
/* If error, return -1 */
if ( status & (1<<FEn)|(1<<DORn)|(1<<UPEn) )
return -1;
/* Filter the 9th bit, then return */
resh = (resh >> 1) & 0x01;
return ((resh << 8) | resl);
}
Note:
1. See “About Code Examples” on page 10.
The receive function example reads all the I/O Registers into the Register File before any com-
putation is done. This gives an optimal receive buffer utilization since the buffer location read will
be free to accept new data as early as possible.
217
2549L–AVR–08/07
22.6.3
Receive Compete Flag and Interrupt
The USART Receiver has one flag that indicates the Receiver state.
The Receive Complete (RXCn) Flag indicates if there are unread data present in the receive
buffer. This flag is one when unread data exist in the receive buffer, and zero when the receive
buffer is empty (i.e., does not contain any unread data). If the Receiver is disabled (RXENn = 0),
the receive buffer will be flushed and consequently the RXCn bit will become zero.
When the Receive Complete Interrupt Enable (RXCIEn) in UCSRnB is set, the USART Receive
Complete interrupt will be executed as long as the RXCn Flag is set (provided that global inter-
rupts are enabled). When interrupt-driven data reception is used, the receive complete routine
must read the received data from UDRn in order to clear the RXCn Flag, otherwise a new inter-
rupt will occur once the interrupt routine terminates.
22.6.4
Receiver Error Flags
The USART Receiver has three Error Flags: Frame Error (FEn), Data OverRun (DORn) and
Parity Error (UPEn). All can be accessed by reading UCSRnA. Common for the Error Flags is
that they are located in the receive buffer together with the frame for which they indicate the
error status. Due to the buffering of the Error Flags, the UCSRnA must be read before the
receive buffer (UDRn), since reading the UDRn I/O location changes the buffer read location.
Another equality for the Error Flags is that they can not be altered by software doing a write to
the flag location. However, all flags must be set to zero when the UCSRnA is written for upward
compatibility of future USART implementations. None of the Error Flags can generate interrupts.
The Frame Error (FEn) Flag indicates the state of the first stop bit of the next readable frame
stored in the receive buffer. The FEn Flag is zero when the stop bit was correctly read (as one),
and the FEn Flag will be one when the stop bit was incorrect (zero). This flag can be used for
detecting out-of-sync conditions, detecting break conditions and protocol handling. The FEn
Flag is not affected by the setting of the USBSn bit in UCSRnC since the Receiver ignores all,
except for the first, stop bits. For compatibility with future devices, always set this bit to zero
when writing to UCSRnA.
The Data OverRun (DORn) Flag indicates data loss due to a receiver buffer full condition. A
Data OverRun occurs when the receive buffer is full (two characters), it is a new character wait-
ing in the Receive Shift Register, and a new start bit is detected. If the DORn Flag is set there
was one or more serial frame lost between the frame last read from UDRn, and the next frame
read from UDRn. For compatibility with future devices, always write this bit to zero when writing
to UCSRnA. The DORn Flag is cleared when the frame received was successfully moved from
the Shift Register to the receive buffer.
The Parity Error (UPEn) Flag indicates that the next frame in the receive buffer had a Parity
Error when received. If Parity Check is not enabled the UPEn bit will always be read zero. For
compatibility with future devices, always set this bit to zero when writing to UCSRnA. For more
details see “Parity Bit Calculation” on page 211 and “Parity Checker” on page 218.
22.6.5
Parity Checker
The Parity Checker is active when the high USART Parity mode (UPMn1) bit is set. Type of Par-
ity Check to be performed (odd or even) is selected by the UPMn0 bit. When enabled, the Parity
Checker calculates the parity of the data bits in incoming frames and compares the result with
the parity bit from the serial frame. The result of the check is stored in the receive buffer together
with the received data and stop bits. The Parity Error (UPEn) Flag can then be read by software
to check if the frame had a Parity Error.
218
ATmega640/1280/1281/2560/2561
2549L–AVR–08/07
ATmega640/1280/1281/2560/2561
The UPEn bit is set if the next character that can be read from the receive buffer had a Parity
Error when received and the Parity Checking was enabled at that point (UPMn1 = 1). This bit is
valid until the receive buffer (UDRn) is read.
22.6.6
22.6.7
Disabling the Receiver
In contrast to the Transmitter, disabling of the Receiver will be immediate. Data from ongoing
receptions will therefore be lost. When disabled (i.e., the RXENn is set to zero) the Receiver will
no longer override the normal function of the RxDn port pin. The Receiver buffer FIFO will be
flushed when the Receiver is disabled. Remaining data in the buffer will be lost
Flushing the Receive Buffer
The receiver buffer FIFO will be flushed when the Receiver is disabled, i.e., the buffer will be
emptied of its contents. Unread data will be lost. If the buffer has to be flushed during normal
operation, due to for instance an error condition, read the UDRn I/O location until the RXCn Flag
is cleared. The following code example shows how to flush the receive buffer.
Assembly Code Example(1)
USART_Flush:
sbis UCSRnA, RXCn
ret
in
r16, UDRn
rjmp USART_Flush
C Code Example(1)
void USART_Flush( void )
{
unsigned char dummy;
while ( UCSRnA & (1<<RXCn) ) dummy = UDRn;
}
Note:
1. See “About Code Examples” on page 10.
22.7 Asynchronous Data Reception
The USART includes a clock recovery and a data recovery unit for handling asynchronous data
reception. The clock recovery logic is used for synchronizing the internally generated baud rate
clock to the incoming asynchronous serial frames at the RxDn pin. The data recovery logic sam-
ples and low pass filters each incoming bit, thereby improving the noise immunity of the
Receiver. The asynchronous reception operational range depends on the accuracy of the inter-
nal baud rate clock, the rate of the incoming frames, and the frame size in number of bits.
22.7.1
Asynchronous Clock Recovery
The clock recovery logic synchronizes internal clock to the incoming serial frames. Figure 22-5
illustrates the sampling process of the start bit of an incoming frame. The sample rate is 16 times
the baud rate for Normal mode, and eight times the baud rate for Double Speed mode. The hor-
izontal arrows illustrate the synchronization variation due to the sampling process. Note the
larger time variation when using the Double Speed mode (U2Xn = 1) of operation. Samples
denoted zero are samples done when the RxDn line is idle (i.e., no communication activity).
219
2549L–AVR–08/07
Figure 22-5. Start Bit Sampling
RxD
IDLE
START
BIT 0
Sample
(U2X = 0)
0
0
1
1
2
3
2
4
5
3
6
7
4
8
9
5
10
11
6
12
13
7
14
15
8
16
1
1
2
3
Sample
(U2X = 1)
0
2
When the clock recovery logic detects a high (idle) to low (start) transition on the RxDn line, the
start bit detection sequence is initiated. Let sample 1 denote the first zero-sample as shown in
the figure. The clock recovery logic then uses samples 8, 9, and 10 for Normal mode, and sam-
ples 4, 5, and 6 for Double Speed mode (indicated with sample numbers inside boxes on the
figure), to decide if a valid start bit is received. If two or more of these three samples have logical
high levels (the majority wins), the start bit is rejected as a noise spike and the Receiver starts
looking for the next high to low-transition. If however, a valid start bit is detected, the clock recov-
ery logic is synchronized and the data recovery can begin. The synchronization process is
repeated for each start bit.
22.7.2
Asynchronous Data Recovery
When the receiver clock is synchronized to the start bit, the data recovery can begin. The data
recovery unit uses a state machine that has 16 states for each bit in Normal mode and eight
states for each bit in Double Speed mode. Figure 22-6 shows the sampling of the data bits and
the parity bit. Each of the samples is given a number that is equal to the state of the recovery
unit.
Figure 22-6. Sampling of Data and Parity Bit
RxD
BIT n
Sample
(U2X = 0)
1
1
2
3
2
4
5
3
6
7
4
8
9
5
10
11
6
12
13
7
14
15
8
16
1
1
Sample
(U2X = 1)
The decision of the logic level of the received bit is taken by doing a majority voting of the logic
value to the three samples in the center of the received bit. The center samples are emphasized
on the figure by having the sample number inside boxes. The majority voting process is done as
follows: If two or all three samples have high levels, the received bit is registered to be a logic 1.
If two or all three samples have low levels, the received bit is registered to be a logic 0. This
majority voting process acts as a low pass filter for the incoming signal on the RxDn pin. The
recovery process is then repeated until a complete frame is received. Including the first stop bit.
Note that the Receiver only uses the first stop bit of a frame.
Figure 22-7 shows the sampling of the stop bit and the earliest possible beginning of the start bit
of the next frame.
220
ATmega640/1280/1281/2560/2561
2549L–AVR–08/07
ATmega640/1280/1281/2560/2561
Figure 22-7. Stop Bit Sampling and Next Start Bit Sampling
(A)
(B)
(C)
RxD
STOP 1
Sample
(U2X = 0)
1
1
2
3
2
4
5
3
6
7
4
8
9
5
10
0/1 0/1 0/1
Sample
(U2X = 1)
6
0/1
The same majority voting is done to the stop bit as done for the other bits in the frame. If the stop
bit is registered to have a logic 0 value, the Frame Error (FEn) Flag will be set.
A new high to low transition indicating the start bit of a new frame can come right after the last of
the bits used for majority voting. For Normal Speed mode, the first low level sample can be at
point marked (A) in Figure 22-7. For Double Speed mode the first low level must be delayed to
(B). (C) marks a stop bit of full length. The early start bit detection influences the operational
range of the Receiver.
22.7.3
Asynchronous Operational Range
The operational range of the Receiver is dependent on the mismatch between the received bit
rate and the internally generated baud rate. If the Transmitter is sending frames at too fast or too
slow bit rates, or the internally generated baud rate of the Receiver does not have a similar (see
Table 22-2) base frequency, the Receiver will not be able to synchronize the frames to the start
bit.
The following equations can be used to calculate the ratio of the incoming data rate and internal
receiver baud rate.
(D + 1)S
S – 1 + D ⋅ S + S
(D + 2)S
(D + 1)S + S
R
= ------------------------------------------
R
= -----------------------------------
slow
fast
F
M
D
S
Sum of character size and parity size (D = 5 to 10 bit)
Samples per bit. S = 16 for Normal Speed mode and S = 8 for Double Speed
mode.
SF
First sample number used for majority voting. SF = 8 for normal speed and SF = 4
for Double Speed mode.
SM
Middle sample number used for majority voting. SM = 9 for normal speed and
SM = 5 for Double Speed mode.
Rslow
is the ratio of the slowest incoming data rate that can be accepted in relation to the
receiver baud rate. Rfast is the ratio of the fastest incoming data rate that can be
accepted in relation to the receiver baud rate.
Table 22-2 and Table 22-3 list the maximum receiver baud rate error that can be tolerated. Note
that Normal Speed mode has higher toleration of baud rate variations.
221
2549L–AVR–08/07
Table 22-2. Recommended Maximum Receiver Baud Rate Error for Normal Speed Mode
(U2Xn = 0)
D
Recommended Max
Receiver Error (%)
# (Data+Parity Bit)
Rslow (%)
93.20
94.12
94.81
95.36
95.81
96.17
Rfast (%)
106.67
105.79
105.11
104.58
104.14
103.78
Max Total Error (%)
+6.67/-6.8
5
6
3.0
2.5
2.0
2.0
1.5
1.5
+5.79/-5.88
+5.11/-5.19
+4.58/-4.54
+4.14/-4.19
+3.78/-3.83
7
8
9
10
Table 22-3. Recommended Maximum Receiver Baud Rate Error for Double Speed Mode
(U2Xn = 1)
D
Recommended Max
Receiver Error (%)
# (Data+Parity Bit)
Rslow (%)
94.12
94.92
95.52
96.00
96.39
96.70
Rfast (%)
105.66
104.92
104,35
103.90
103.53
103.23
Max Total Error (%)
+5.66/-5.88
5
6
2.5
2.0
1.5
1.5
1.5
1.0
+4.92/-5.08
7
+4.35/-4.48
8
+3.90/-4.00
9
+3.53/-3.61
10
+3.23/-3.30
The recommendations of the maximum receiver baud rate error was made under the assump-
tion that the Receiver and Transmitter equally divides the maximum total error.
There are two possible sources for the receivers baud rate error. The Receiver’s system clock
(XTAL) will always have some minor instability over the supply voltage range and the tempera-
ture range. When using a crystal to generate the system clock, this is rarely a problem, but for a
resonator the system clock may differ more than 2% depending of the resonators tolerance. The
second source for the error is more controllable. The baud rate generator can not always do an
exact division of the system frequency to get the baud rate wanted. In this case an UBRR value
that gives an acceptable low error can be used if possible.
22.8 Multi-processor Communication Mode
Setting the Multi-processor Communication mode (MPCMn) bit in UCSRnA enables a filtering
function of incoming frames received by the USART Receiver. Frames that do not contain
address information will be ignored and not put into the receive buffer. This effectively reduces
the number of incoming frames that has to be handled by the CPU, in a system with multiple
MCUs that communicate via the same serial bus. The Transmitter is unaffected by the MPCMn
setting, but has to be used differently when it is a part of a system utilizing the Multi-processor
Communication mode.
If the Receiver is set up to receive frames that contain 5 to 8 data bits, then the first stop bit indi-
cates if the frame contains data or address information. If the Receiver is set up for frames with
nine data bits, then the ninth bit (RXB8n) is used for identifying address and data frames. When
222
ATmega640/1280/1281/2560/2561
2549L–AVR–08/07
ATmega640/1280/1281/2560/2561
the frame type bit (the first stop or the ninth bit) is one, the frame contains an address. When the
frame type bit is zero the frame is a data frame.
The Multi-processor Communication mode enables several slave MCUs to receive data from a
master MCU. This is done by first decoding an address frame to find out which MCU has been
addressed. If a particular slave MCU has been addressed, it will receive the following data
frames as normal, while the other slave MCUs will ignore the received frames until another
address frame is received.
22.8.1
Using MPCMn
For an MCU to act as a master MCU, it can use a 9-bit character frame format (UCSZn = 7). The
ninth bit (TXB8n) must be set when an address frame (TXB8n = 1) or cleared when a data frame
(TXB = 0) is being transmitted. The slave MCUs must in this case be set to use a 9-bit character
frame format.
The following procedure should be used to exchange data in Multi-processor Communication
mode:
1. All Slave MCUs are in Multi-processor Communication mode (MPCMn in UCSRnA is
set).
2. The Master MCU sends an address frame, and all slaves receive and read this frame. In
the Slave MCUs, the RXCn Flag in UCSRnA will be set as normal.
3. Each Slave MCU reads the UDRn Register and determines if it has been selected. If so,
it clears the MPCMn bit in UCSRnA, otherwise it waits for the next address byte and
keeps the MPCMn setting.
4. The addressed MCU will receive all data frames until a new address frame is received.
The other Slave MCUs, which still have the MPCMn bit set, will ignore the data frames.
5. When the last data frame is received by the addressed MCU, the addressed MCU sets
the MPCMn bit and waits for a new address frame from master. The process then
repeats from 2.
Using any of the 5- to 8-bit character frame formats is possible, but impractical since the
Receiver must change between using n and n+1 character frame formats. This makes full-
duplex operation difficult since the Transmitter and Receiver uses the same character size set-
ting. If 5- to 8-bit character frames are used, the Transmitter must be set to use two stop bit
(USBSn = 1) since the first stop bit is used for indicating the frame type.
Do not use Read-Modify-Write instructions (SBI and CBI) to set or clear the MPCMn bit. The
MPCMn bit shares the same I/O location as the TXCn Flag and this might accidentally be
cleared when using SBI or CBI instructions.
22.9 Register Description
The following section describes the USART’s registers.
22.9.1
UDRn – USART I/O Data Register n
Bit
7
6
5
4
3
2
1
0
RXB[7:0]
TXB[7:0]
UDRn (Read)
UDRn (Write)
Read/Write
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
Initial Value
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
The USART Transmit Data Buffer Register and USART Receive Data Buffer Registers share the
same I/O address referred to as USART Data Register or UDRn. The Transmit Data Buffer Reg-
223
2549L–AVR–08/07
ister (TXB) will be the destination for data written to the UDRn Register location. Reading the
UDRn Register location will return the contents of the Receive Data Buffer Register (RXB).
For 5-, 6-, or 7-bit characters the upper unused bits will be ignored by the Transmitter and set to
zero by the Receiver.
The transmit buffer can only be written when the UDREn Flag in the UCSRnA Register is set.
Data written to UDRn when the UDREn Flag is not set, will be ignored by the USART Transmit-
ter. When data is written to the transmit buffer, and the Transmitter is enabled, the Transmitter
will load the data into the Transmit Shift Register when the Shift Register is empty. Then the
data will be serially transmitted on the TxDn pin.
The receive buffer consists of a two level FIFO. The FIFO will change its state whenever the
receive buffer is accessed. Due to this behavior of the receive buffer, do not use Read-Modify-
Write instructions (SBI and CBI) on this location. Be careful when using bit test instructions
(SBIC and SBIS), since these also will change the state of the FIFO.
22.9.2
UCSRnA – USART Control and Status Register A
Bit
7
6
5
4
FEn
R
3
DORn
R
2
UPEn
R
1
U2Xn
R/W
0
0
MPCMn
R/W
0
RXCn
TXCn
UDREn
UCSRnA
Read/Write
R
0
R/W
R
1
Initial Value
0
0
0
0
• Bit 7 – RXCn: USART Receive Complete
This flag bit is set when there are unread data in the receive buffer and cleared when the receive
buffer is empty (i.e., does not contain any unread data). If the Receiver is disabled, the receive
buffer will be flushed and consequently the RXCn bit will become zero. The RXCn Flag can be
used to generate a Receive Complete interrupt (see description of the RXCIEn bit).
• Bit 6 – TXCn: USART Transmit Complete
This flag bit is set when the entire frame in the Transmit Shift Register has been shifted out and
there are no new data currently present in the transmit buffer (UDRn). The TXCn Flag bit is auto-
matically cleared when a transmit complete interrupt is executed, or it can be cleared by writing
a one to its bit location. The TXCn Flag can generate a Transmit Complete interrupt (see
description of the TXCIEn bit).
• Bit 5 – UDREn: USART Data Register Empty
The UDREn Flag indicates if the transmit buffer (UDRn) is ready to receive new data. If UDREn
is one, the buffer is empty, and therefore ready to be written. The UDREn Flag can generate a
Data Register Empty interrupt (see description of the UDRIEn bit).
UDREn is set after a reset to indicate that the Transmitter is ready.
• Bit 4 – FEn: Frame Error
This bit is set if the next character in the receive buffer had a Frame Error when received. I.e.,
when the first stop bit of the next character in the receive buffer is zero. This bit is valid until the
receive buffer (UDRn) is read. The FEn bit is zero when the stop bit of received data is one.
Always set this bit to zero when writing to UCSRnA.
• Bit 3 – DORn: Data OverRun
This bit is set if a Data OverRun condition is detected. A Data OverRun occurs when the receive
buffer is full (two characters), it is a new character waiting in the Receive Shift Register, and a
224
ATmega640/1280/1281/2560/2561
2549L–AVR–08/07
ATmega640/1280/1281/2560/2561
new start bit is detected. This bit is valid until the receive buffer (UDRn) is read. Always set this
bit to zero when writing to UCSRnA.
• Bit 2 – UPEn: USART Parity Error
This bit is set if the next character in the receive buffer had a Parity Error when received and the
Parity Checking was enabled at that point (UPMn1 = 1). This bit is valid until the receive buffer
(UDRn) is read. Always set this bit to zero when writing to UCSRnA.
• Bit 1 – U2Xn: Double the USART Transmission Speed
This bit only has effect for the asynchronous operation. Write this bit to zero when using syn-
chronous operation.
Writing this bit to one will reduce the divisor of the baud rate divider from 16 to 8 effectively dou-
bling the transfer rate for asynchronous communication.
• Bit 0 – MPCMn: Multi-processor Communication Mode
This bit enables the Multi-processor Communication mode. When the MPCMn bit is written to
one, all the incoming frames received by the USART Receiver that do not contain address infor-
mation will be ignored. The Transmitter is unaffected by the MPCMn setting. For more detailed
information see “Multi-processor Communication Mode” on page 222.
22.9.3
UCSRnB – USART Control and Status Register n B
Bit
7
6
5
4
RXENn
R/W
0
3
TXENn
R/W
0
2
UCSZn2
R/W
1
0
TXB8n
R/W
0
RXCIEn
TXCIEn
UDRIEn
RXB8n
UCSRnB
Read/Write
R/W
R/W
R/W
R
0
Initial Value
0
0
0
0
• Bit 7 – RXCIEn: RX Complete Interrupt Enable n
Writing this bit to one enables interrupt on the RXCn Flag. A USART Receive Complete interrupt
will be generated only if the RXCIEn bit is written to one, the Global Interrupt Flag in SREG is
written to one and the RXCn bit in UCSRnA is set.
• Bit 6 – TXCIEn: TX Complete Interrupt Enable n
Writing this bit to one enables interrupt on the TXCn Flag. A USART Transmit Complete interrupt
will be generated only if the TXCIEn bit is written to one, the Global Interrupt Flag in SREG is
written to one and the TXCn bit in UCSRnA is set.
• Bit 5 – UDRIEn: USART Data Register Empty Interrupt Enable n
Writing this bit to one enables interrupt on the UDREn Flag. A Data Register Empty interrupt will
be generated only if the UDRIEn bit is written to one, the Global Interrupt Flag in SREG is written
to one and the UDREn bit in UCSRnA is set.
• Bit 4 – RXENn: Receiver Enable n
Writing this bit to one enables the USART Receiver. The Receiver will override normal port oper-
ation for the RxDn pin when enabled. Disabling the Receiver will flush the receive buffer
invalidating the FEn, DORn, and UPEn Flags.
• Bit 3 – TXENn: Transmitter Enable n
Writing this bit to one enables the USART Transmitter. The Transmitter will override normal port
operation for the TxDn pin when enabled. The disabling of the Transmitter (writing TXENn to
225
2549L–AVR–08/07
zero) will not become effective until ongoing and pending transmissions are completed, i.e.,
when the Transmit Shift Register and Transmit Buffer Register do not contain data to be trans-
mitted. When disabled, the Transmitter will no longer override the TxDn port.
• Bit 2 – UCSZn2: Character Size n
The UCSZn2 bits combined with the UCSZn1:0 bit in UCSRnC sets the number of data bits
(Character SiZe) in a frame the Receiver and Transmitter use.
• Bit 1 – RXB8n: Receive Data Bit 8 n
RXB8n is the ninth data bit of the received character when operating with serial frames with nine
data bits. Must be read before reading the low bits from UDRn.
• Bit 0 – TXB8n: Transmit Data Bit 8 n
TXB8n is the ninth data bit in the character to be transmitted when operating with serial frames
with nine data bits. Must be written before writing the low bits to UDRn.
22.9.4
UCSRnC – USART Control and Status Register n C
Bit
7
6
5
4
3
2
1
0
UMSELn1
UMSELn0
UPMn1
UPMn0
USBSn
UCSZn1
UCSZn0
UCPOLn
UCSRnC
Read/Write
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
Initial Value
0
0
0
0
0
1
1
0
• Bits 7:6 – UMSELn1:0 USART Mode Select
These bits select the mode of operation of the USARTn as shown in Table 22-4.
Table 22-4. UMSELn Bits Settings
UMSELn1
UMSELn0
Mode
0
0
1
1
0
1
0
1
Asynchronous USART
Synchronous USART
(Reserved)
Master SPI (MSPIM)(1)
Note:
1. See “USART in SPI Mode” on page 232 for full description of the Master SPI Mode (MSPIM)
operation
• Bits 5:4 – UPMn1:0: Parity Mode
These bits enable and set type of parity generation and check. If enabled, the Transmitter will
automatically generate and send the parity of the transmitted data bits within each frame. The
Receiver will generate a parity value for the incoming data and compare it to the UPMn setting.
If a mismatch is detected, the UPEn Flag in UCSRnA will be set.
Table 22-5. UPMn Bits Settings
UPMn1
UPMn0
Parity Mode
Disabled
0
0
1
1
0
1
0
1
Reserved
Enabled, Even Parity
Enabled, Odd Parity
226
ATmega640/1280/1281/2560/2561
2549L–AVR–08/07
ATmega640/1280/1281/2560/2561
• Bit 3 – USBSn: Stop Bit Select
This bit selects the number of stop bits to be inserted by the Transmitter. The Receiver ignores
this setting.
Table 22-6. USBS Bit Settings
USBSn
Stop Bit(s)
1-bit
0
1
2-bit
• Bit 2:1 – UCSZn1:0: Character Size
The UCSZn1:0 bits combined with the UCSZn2 bit in UCSRnB sets the number of data bits
(Character SiZe) in a frame the Receiver and Transmitter use.
Table 22-7. UCSZn Bits Settings
UCSZn2
UCSZn1
UCSZn0
Character Size
5-bit
0
0
0
0
1
1
1
1
0
0
1
1
0
0
1
1
0
1
0
1
0
1
0
1
6-bit
7-bit
8-bit
Reserved
Reserved
Reserved
9-bit
• Bit 0 – UCPOLn: Clock Polarity
This bit is used for synchronous mode only. Write this bit to zero when asynchronous mode is
used. The UCPOLn bit sets the relationship between data output change and data input sample,
and the synchronous clock (XCKn).
Table 22-8. UCPOLn Bit Settings
Transmitted Data Changed (Output of
TxDn Pin)
Received Data Sampled (Input on RxDn
Pin)
UCPOLn
0
1
Rising XCKn Edge
Falling XCKn Edge
Falling XCKn Edge
Rising XCKn Edge
22.9.5
UBRRnL and UBRRnH – USART Baud Rate Registers
Bit
15
14
13
12
11
10
9
8
–
–
–
–
UBRR[11:8]
UBRRHn
UBRRLn
UBRR[7:0]
7
R
6
R
5
R
4
R
3
R/W
R/W
0
2
R/W
R/W
0
1
R/W
R/W
0
0
R/W
R/W
0
Read/Write
R/W
0
R/W
0
R/W
0
R/W
0
Initial Value
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
• Bit 15:12 – Reserved Bits
227
2549L–AVR–08/07
These bits are reserved for future use. For compatibility with future devices, these bit must be
written to zero when UBRRH is written.
• Bit 11:0 – UBRR11:0: USART Baud Rate Register
This is a 12-bit register which contains the USART baud rate. The UBRRH contains the four
most significant bits, and the UBRRL contains the eight least significant bits of the USART baud
rate. Ongoing transmissions by the Transmitter and Receiver will be corrupted if the baud rate is
changed. Writing UBRRL will trigger an immediate update of the baud rate prescaler.
22.10 Examples of Baud Rate Setting
For standard crystal and resonator frequencies, the most commonly used baud rates for asyn-
chronous operation can be generated by using the UBRR settings in Table 22-9 to Table 22-12.
UBRR values which yield an actual baud rate differing less than 0.5% from the target baud rate,
are bold in the table. Higher error ratings are acceptable, but the Receiver will have less noise
resistance when the error ratings are high, especially for large serial frames (see “Asynchronous
Operational Range” on page 221). The error values are calculated using the following equation:
BaudRateClosest Match
⎛
⎞
Error[%] = ------------------------------------------------------- – 1 • 100%
⎝
⎠
BaudRate
Table 22-9. Examples of UBRRn Settings for Commonly Used Oscillator Frequencies
fosc = 1.0000 MHz fosc = 1.8432 MHz
U2Xn = 0 U2Xn = 1 U2Xn = 0 U2Xn = 1
UBRR UBRR UBRR UBRR
fosc = 2.0000 MHz
U2Xn = 0 U2Xn = 1
UBRR UBRR
Baud
Rate
(bps)
Error
0.2%
0.2%
-7.0%
8.5%
8.5%
8.5%
-18.6%
8.5%
–
Error
0.2%
0.2%
0.2%
-3.5%
-7.0%
8.5%
8.5%
8.5%
-18.6%
8.5%
–
Error
0.0%
0.0%
0.0%
0.0%
0.0%
0.0%
0.0%
0.0%
-25.0%
0.0%
–
Error
0.0%
0.0%
0.0%
0.0%
0.0%
0.0%
0.0%
0.0%
0.0%
0.0%
0.0%
–
Error
0.2%
0.2%
0.2%
-3.5%
-7.0%
8.5%
8.5%
8.5%
-18.6%
8.5%
–
Error
0.2%
0.2%
0.2%
2.1%
0.2%
-3.5%
-7.0%
8.5%
8.5%
8.5%
–
2400
4800
25
12
6
51
25
12
8
47
23
11
7
95
47
23
15
11
7
51
25
12
8
103
51
25
16
12
8
9600
14.4k
19.2k
28.8k
38.4k
57.6k
76.8k
115.2k
230.4k
250k
3
2
6
5
6
1
3
3
3
1
2
2
5
2
6
0
1
1
3
1
3
–
1
1
2
1
2
–
–
0
0
1
0
1
–
–
–
–
0
–
–
–
–
–
–
–
–
–
–
–
0
0.0%
Max. (1)
62.5 kbps
UBRR = 0, Error = 0.0%
125 kbps
115.2 kbps
230.4 kbps
125 kbps
250 kbps
1.
228
ATmega640/1280/1281/2560/2561
2549L–AVR–08/07
ATmega640/1280/1281/2560/2561
Table 22-10. Examples of UBRRn Settings for Commonly Used Oscillator Frequencies (Continued)
fosc = 3.6864 MHz fosc = 4.0000 MHz fosc = 7.3728 MHz
U2Xn = 0 U2Xn = 1 U2Xn = 0 U2Xn = 1 U2Xn = 0 U2Xn = 1
UBRR UBRR UBRR UBRR UBRR UBRR
Baud
Rate
(bps)
Error
0.0%
0.0%
0.0%
0.0%
0.0%
0.0%
0.0%
0.0%
0.0%
0.0%
0.0%
-7.8%
–
Error
0.0%
0.0%
0.0%
0.0%
0.0%
0.0%
0.0%
0.0%
0.0%
0.0%
0.0%
-7.8%
-7.8%
–
Error
0.2%
0.2%
0.2%
2.1%
0.2%
-3.5%
-7.0%
8.5%
8.5%
8.5%
8.5%
0.0%
–
Error
0.2%
0.2%
0.2%
-0.8%
0.2%
2.1%
0.2%
-3.5%
-7.0%
8.5%
8.5%
0.0%
0.0%
–
Error
0.0%
0.0%
0.0%
0.0%
0.0%
0.0%
0.0%
0.0%
0.0%
0.0%
0.0%
-7.8%
-7.8%
–
Error
0.0%
0.0%
0.0%
0.0%
0.0%
0.0%
0.0%
0.0%
0.0%
0.0%
0.0%
-7.8%
-7.8%
-7.8%
2400
4800
95
47
23
15
11
7
191
95
47
31
23
15
11
7
103
51
25
16
12
8
207
103
51
34
25
16
12
8
191
95
47
31
23
15
11
7
383
191
95
63
47
31
23
15
11
7
9600
14.4k
19.2k
28.8k
38.4k
57.6k
76.8k
115.2k
230.4k
250k
5
6
3
3
2
5
2
6
5
1
3
1
3
3
0
1
0
1
1
3
0
1
0
1
1
3
0.5M
–
0
–
0
0
1
1M
–
–
–
–
–
–
–
0
Max. (1)
230.4 kbps
UBRR = 0, Error = 0.0%
460.8 kbps
250 kbps
0.5 Mbps
460.8 kbps
921.6 kbps
1.
229
2549L–AVR–08/07
Table 22-11. Examples of UBRRn Settings for Commonly Used Oscillator Frequencies (Continued)
fosc = 8.0000 MHz fosc = 11.0592 MHz fosc = 14.7456 MHz
U2Xn = 0 U2Xn = 1 U2Xn = 0 U2Xn = 1 U2Xn = 0 U2Xn = 1
UBRR UBRR UBRR UBRR UBRR UBRR
Baud
Rate
(bps)
Error
0.2%
0.2%
0.2%
-0.8%
0.2%
2.1%
0.2%
-3.5%
-7.0%
8.5%
8.5%
0.0%
0.0%
–
Error
-0.1%
0.2%
0.2%
0.6%
0.2%
-0.8%
0.2%
2.1%
0.2%
-3.5%
8.5%
0.0%
0.0%
0.0%
Error
0.0%
0.0%
0.0%
0.0%
0.0%
0.0%
0.0%
0.0%
0.0%
0.0%
0.0%
-7.8%
–
Error
0.0%
0.0%
0.0%
0.0%
0.0%
0.0%
0.0%
0.0%
0.0%
0.0%
0.0%
-7.8%
-7.8%
–
Error
0.0%
0.0%
0.0%
0.0%
0.0%
0.0%
0.0%
0.0%
0.0%
0.0%
0.0%
-7.8%
-7.8%
-7.8%
Error
0.0%
0.0%
0.0%
0.0%
0.0%
0.0%
0.0%
0.0%
0.0%
0.0%
0.0%
5.3%
-7.8%
-7.8%
2400
4800
207
103
51
34
25
16
12
8
416
207
103
68
51
34
25
16
12
8
287
143
71
47
35
23
17
11
8
575
287
143
95
71
47
35
23
17
11
5
383
191
95
63
47
31
23
15
11
7
767
383
191
127
95
63
47
31
23
15
7
9600
14.4k
19.2k
28.8k
38.4k
57.6k
76.8k
115.2k
230.4k
250k
6
3
5
1
3
2
3
1
3
2
5
3
6
0.5M
0
1
–
2
1
3
1M
–
0
–
–
–
0
1
Max. (1)
0.5 Mbps
UBRR = 0, Error = 0.0%
1 Mbps
691.2 kbps
1.3824 Mbps
921.6 kbps
1.8432 Mbps
1.
230
ATmega640/1280/1281/2560/2561
2549L–AVR–08/07
ATmega640/1280/1281/2560/2561
Table 22-12. Examples of UBRRn Settings for Commonly Used Oscillator Frequencies (Continued)
fosc = 16.0000 MHz fosc = 18.4320 MHz fosc = 20.0000 MHz
U2Xn = 0 U2Xn = 1 U2Xn = 0 U2Xn = 1 U2Xn = 0 U2Xn = 1
UBRR UBRR UBRR UBRR UBRR UBRR
Baud
Rate
(bps)
Error
-0.1%
0.2%
0.2%
0.6%
0.2%
-0.8%
0.2%
2.1%
0.2%
-3.5%
8.5%
0.0%
0.0%
0.0%
Error
0.0%
-0.1%
0.2%
-0.1%
0.2%
0.6%
0.2%
-0.8%
0.2%
2.1%
-3.5%
0.0%
0.0%
0.0%
Error
0.0%
0.0%
0.0%
0.0%
0.0%
0.0%
0.0%
0.0%
0.0%
0.0%
0.0%
-7.8%
–
Error
0.0%
0.0%
0.0%
0.0%
0.0%
0.0%
0.0%
0.0%
0.0%
0.0%
0.0%
2.4%
-7.8%
–
Error
0.0%
0.2%
0.2%
-0.2%
0.2%
0.9%
-1.4%
-1.4%
1.7%
-1.4%
8.5%
0.0%
–
Error
0.0%
0.0%
0.2%
-0.2%
0.2%
-0.2%
0.2%
0.9%
-1.4%
-1.4%
-1.4%
0.0%
0.0%
–
2400
4800
416
207
103
68
51
34
25
16
12
8
832
416
207
138
103
68
51
34
25
16
8
479
239
119
79
59
39
29
19
14
9
959
479
239
159
119
79
59
39
29
19
9
520
259
129
86
64
42
32
21
15
10
4
1041
520
259
173
129
86
9600
14.4k
19.2k
28.8k
38.4k
57.6k
76.8k
115.2k
230.4k
250k
64
42
32
21
3
4
10
3
7
4
8
4
9
0.5M
1
3
–
4
–
4
1M
0
1
–
–
–
–
–
–
Max. (1)
1 Mbps
UBRR = 0, Error = 0.0%
2 Mbps
1.152 Mbps
2.304 Mbps
1.25 Mbps
2.5 Mbps
1.
231
2549L–AVR–08/07
23. USART in SPI Mode
The Universal Synchronous and Asynchronous serial Receiver and Transmitter (USART) can be
set to a master SPI compliant mode of operation. The Master SPI Mode (MSPIM) has the follow-
ing features:
• Full Duplex, Three-wire Synchronous Data Transfer
• Master Operation
• Supports all four SPI Modes of Operation (Mode 0, 1, 2, and 3)
• LSB First or MSB First Data Transfer (Configurable Data Order)
• Queued Operation (Double Buffered)
• High Resolution Baud Rate Generator
• High Speed Operation (fXCKmax = fCK/2)
• Flexible Interrupt Generation
23.1 Overview
Setting both UMSELn1:0 bits to one enables the USART in MSPIM logic. In this mode of opera-
tion the SPI master control logic takes direct control over the USART resources. These
resources include the transmitter and receiver shift register and buffers, and the baud rate gen-
erator. The parity generator and checker, the data and clock recovery logic, and the RX and TX
control logic is disabled. The USART RX and TX control logic is replaced by a common SPI
transfer control logic. However, the pin control logic and interrupt generation logic is identical in
both modes of operation.
The I/O register locations are the same in both modes. However, some of the functionality of the
control registers changes when using MSPIM.
23.2 USART MSPIM vs. SPI
The AVR USART in MSPIM mode is fully compatible with the AVR SPI regarding:
•
•
•
•
Master mode timing diagram.
The UCPOLn bit functionality is identical to the SPI CPOL bit.
The UCPHAn bit functionality is identical to the SPI CPHA bit.
The UDORDn bit functionality is identical to the SPI DORD bit.
However, since the USART in MSPIM mode reuses the USART resources, the use of the
USART in MSPIM mode is somewhat different compared to the SPI. In addition to differences of
the control register bits, and that only master operation is supported by the USART in MSPIM
mode, the following features differ between the two modules:
•
The USART in MSPIM mode includes (double) buffering of the transmitter. The SPI has no
buffer.
•
•
•
The USART in MSPIM mode receiver includes an additional buffer level.
The SPI WCOL (Write Collision) bit is not included in USART in MSPIM mode.
The SPI double speed mode (SPI2X) bit is not included. However, the same effect is
achieved by setting UBRRn accordingly.
•
•
Interrupt timing is not compatible.
Pin control differs due to the master only operation of the USART in MSPIM mode.
232
ATmega640/1280/1281/2560/2561
2549L–AVR–08/07
ATmega640/1280/1281/2560/2561
A comparison of the USART in MSPIM mode and the SPI pins is shown in Table 23-4 on page
240
23.2.1
Clock Generation
The Clock Generation logic generates the base clock for the Transmitter and Receiver. For
USART MSPIM mode of operation only internal clock generation (i.e. master operation) is sup-
ported. The Data Direction Register for the XCKn pin (DDR_XCKn) must therefore be set to one
(i.e. as output) for the USART in MSPIM to operate correctly. Preferably the DDR_XCKn should
be set up before the USART in MSPIM is enabled (i.e. TXENn and RXENn bit set to one).
The internal clock generation used in MSPIM mode is identical to the USART synchronous mas-
ter mode. The baud rate or UBRRn setting can therefore be calculated using the same
equations, see Table 23-1:
Table 23-1. Equations for Calculating Baud Rate Register Setting
Equation for Calculating Baud
Rate(1)
Equation for Calculating
UBRRn Value
Operating Mode
Synchronous Master
mode
f
OSC
f
OSC
BAUD = --------------------------------------
UBRRn = -------------------- – 1
2(UBRRn + 1)
2BAUD
Note:
1. The baud rate is defined to be the transfer rate in bit per second (bps)
BAUD
Baud rate (in bits per second, bps)
fOSC
System Oscillator clock frequency
UBRRn
Contents of the UBRRnH and UBRRnL Registers, (0-4095)
23.3 SPI Data Modes and Timing
There are four combinations of XCKn (SCK) phase and polarity with respect to serial data, which
are determined by control bits UCPHAn and UCPOLn. The data transfer timing diagrams are
shown in Figure 23-1. Data bits are shifted out and latched in on opposite edges of the XCKn
signal, ensuring sufficient time for data signals to stabilize. The UCPOLn and UCPHAn function-
ality is summarized in Table 23-2. Note that changing the setting of any of these bits will corrupt
all ongoing communication for both the Receiver and Transmitter.
Table 23-2. UCPOLn and UCPHAn Functionality-
UCPOLn
UCPHAn
SPI Mode
Leading Edge
Sample (Rising)
Setup (Rising)
Sample (Falling)
Setup (Falling)
Trailing Edge
Setup (Falling)
Sample (Falling)
Setup (Rising)
Sample (Rising)
0
0
1
1
0
1
0
1
0
1
2
3
233
2549L–AVR–08/07
Figure 23-1. UCPHAn and UCPOLn data transfer timing diagrams.
UCPOL=0
UCPOL=1
XCK
XCK
Data setup (TXD)
Data sample (RXD)
Data setup (TXD)
Data sample (RXD)
XCK
XCK
Data setup (TXD)
Data sample (RXD)
Data setup (TXD)
Data sample (RXD)
23.4 Frame Formats
A serial frame for the MSPIM is defined to be one character of 8 data bits. The USART in MSPIM
mode has two valid frame formats:
•
•
8-bit data with MSB first
8-bit data with LSB first
A frame starts with the least or most significant data bit. Then the next data bits, up to a total of
eight, are succeeding, ending with the most or least significant bit accordingly. When a complete
frame is transmitted, a new frame can directly follow it, or the communication line can be set to
an idle (high) state.
The UDORDn bit in UCSRnC sets the frame format used by the USART in MSPIM mode. The
Receiver and Transmitter use the same setting. Note that changing the setting of any of these
bits will corrupt all ongoing communication for both the Receiver and Transmitter.
16-bit data transfer can be achieved by writing two data bytes to UDRn. A UART transmit com-
plete interrupt will then signal that the 16-bit value has been shifted out.
23.4.1
USART MSPIM Initialization
The USART in MSPIM mode has to be initialized before any communication can take place. The
initialization process normally consists of setting the baud rate, setting master mode of operation
(by setting DDR_XCKn to one), setting frame format and enabling the Transmitter and the
Receiver. Only the transmitter can operate independently. For interrupt driven USART opera-
tion, the Global Interrupt Flag should be cleared (and thus interrupts globally disabled) when
doing the initialization.
Note:
To ensure immediate initialization of the XCKn output the baud-rate register (UBRRn) must be
zero at the time the transmitter is enabled. Contrary to the normal mode USART operation the
UBRRn must then be written to the desired value after the transmitter is enabled, but before the
first transmission is started. Setting UBRRn to zero before enabling the transmitter is not neces-
sary if the initialization is done immediately after a reset since UBRRn is reset to zero.
Before doing a re-initialization with changed baud rate, data mode, or frame format, be sure that
there is no ongoing transmissions during the period the registers are changed. The TXCn Flag
can be used to check that the Transmitter has completed all transfers, and the RXCn Flag can
be used to check that there are no unread data in the receive buffer. Note that the TXCn Flag
must be cleared before each transmission (before UDRn is written) if it is used for this purpose.
234
ATmega640/1280/1281/2560/2561
2549L–AVR–08/07
ATmega640/1280/1281/2560/2561
The following simple USART initialization code examples show one assembly and one C func-
tion that are equal in functionality. The examples assume polling (no interrupts enabled). The
baud rate is given as a function parameter. For the assembly code, the baud rate parameter is
assumed to be stored in the r17:r16 registers.
Assembly Code Example(1)
USART_Init:
clr r18
out UBRRnH,r18
out UBRRnL,r18
; Setting the XCKn port pin as output, enables master mode.
sbi XCKn_DDR, XCKn
; Set MSPI mode of operation and SPI data mode 0.
ldi r18, (1<<UMSELn1)|(1<<UMSELn0)|(0<<UCPHAn)|(0<<UCPOLn)
out UCSRnC,r18
; Enable receiver and transmitter.
ldi r18, (1<<RXENn)|(1<<TXENn)
out UCSRnB,r18
; Set baud rate.
; IMPORTANT: The Baud Rate must be set after the transmitter is enabled!
out UBRRnH, r17
out UBRRnL, r18
ret
C Code Example(1)
void USART_Init( unsigned int baud )
{
UBRRn = 0;
/* Setting the XCKn port pin as output, enables master mode. */
XCKn_DDR |= (1<<XCKn);
/* Set MSPI mode of operation and SPI data mode 0. */
UCSRnC = (1<<UMSELn1)|(1<<UMSELn0)|(0<<UCPHAn)|(0<<UCPOLn);
/* Enable receiver and transmitter. */
UCSRnB = (1<<RXENn)|(1<<TXENn);
/* Set baud rate. */
/* IMPORTANT: The Baud Rate must be set after the transmitter is enabled
*/
UBRRn = baud;
}
Note:
1. See “About Code Examples” on page 10.
235
2549L–AVR–08/07
23.5 Data Transfer
Using the USART in MSPI mode requires the Transmitter to be enabled, i.e. the TXENn bit in
the UCSRnB register is set to one. When the Transmitter is enabled, the normal port operation
of the TxDn pin is overridden and given the function as the Transmitter's serial output. Enabling
the receiver is optional and is done by setting the RXENn bit in the UCSRnB register to one.
When the receiver is enabled, the normal pin operation of the RxDn pin is overridden and given
the function as the Receiver's serial input. The XCKn will in both cases be used as the transfer
clock.
After initialization the USART is ready for doing data transfers. A data transfer is initiated by writ-
ing to the UDRn I/O location. This is the case for both sending and receiving data since the
transmitter controls the transfer clock. The data written to UDRn is moved from the transmit
buffer to the shift register when the shift register is ready to send a new frame.
Note:
To keep the input buffer in sync with the number of data bytes transmitted, the UDRn register must
be read once for each byte transmitted. The input buffer operation is identical to normal USART
mode, i.e. if an overflow occurs the character last received will be lost, not the first data in the
buffer. This means that if four bytes are transferred, byte 1 first, then byte 2, 3, and 4, and the
UDRn is not read before all transfers are completed, then byte 3 to be received will be lost, and not
byte 1.
The following code examples show a simple USART in MSPIM mode transfer function based on
polling of the Data Register Empty (UDREn) Flag and the Receive Complete (RXCn) Flag. The
USART has to be initialized before the function can be used. For the assembly code, the data to
be sent is assumed to be stored in Register R16 and the data received will be available in the
same register (R16) after the function returns.
The function simply waits for the transmit buffer to be empty by checking the UDREn Flag,
before loading it with new data to be transmitted. The function then waits for data to be present
in the receive buffer by checking the RXCn Flag, before reading the buffer and returning the
value.
236
ATmega640/1280/1281/2560/2561
2549L–AVR–08/07
ATmega640/1280/1281/2560/2561
Assembly Code Example(1)
USART_MSPIM_Transfer:
; Wait for empty transmit buffer
sbis UCSRnA, UDREn
rjmp USART_MSPIM_Transfer
; Put data (r16) into buffer, sends the data
out UDRn,r16
; Wait for data to be received
USART_MSPIM_Wait_RXCn:
sbis UCSRnA, RXCn
rjmp USART_MSPIM_Wait_RXCn
; Get and return received data from buffer
in r16, UDRn
ret
C Code Example(1)
unsigned char USART_Receive( void )
{
/* Wait for empty transmit buffer */
while ( !( UCSRnA & (1<<UDREn)) );
/* Put data into buffer, sends the data */
UDRn = data;
/* Wait for data to be received */
while ( !(UCSRnA & (1<<RXCn)) );
/* Get and return received data from buffer */
return UDRn;
}
Note:
1. See “About Code Examples” on page 10.
23.5.1
23.5.2
Transmitter and Receiver Flags and Interrupts
The RXCn, TXCn, and UDREn flags and corresponding interrupts in USART in MSPIM mode
are identical in function to the normal USART operation. However, the receiver error status flags
(FE, DOR, and PE) are not in use and is always read as zero.
Disabling the Transmitter or Receiver
The disabling of the transmitter or receiver in USART in MSPIM mode is identical in function to
the normal USART operation.
23.6 USART MSPIM Register Description
The following section describes the registers used for SPI operation using the USART.
23.6.1
UDRn – USART MSPIM I/O Data Register
The function and bit description of the USART data register (UDRn) in MSPI mode is identical to
normal USART operation. See “UDRn – USART I/O Data Register n” on page 223.
237
2549L–AVR–08/07
23.6.2
UCSRnA – USART MSPIM Control and Status Register n A
•
Bit
7
RXCn
R/W
0
6
TXCn
R/W
0
5
UDREn
R/W
0
4
-
3
-
2
-
1
-
0
-
UCSRnA
Read/Write
R
0
R
0
R
1
R
1
R
0
Initial Value
• Bit 7 - RXCn: USART Receive Complete
This flag bit is set when there are unread data in the receive buffer and cleared when the receive
buffer is empty (i.e., does not contain any unread data). If the Receiver is disabled, the receive
buffer will be flushed and consequently the RXCn bit will become zero. The RXCn Flag can be
used to generate a Receive Complete interrupt (see description of the RXCIEn bit).
• Bit 6 - TXCn: USART Transmit Complete
This flag bit is set when the entire frame in the Transmit Shift Register has been shifted out and
there are no new data currently present in the transmit buffer (UDRn). The TXCn Flag bit is auto-
matically cleared when a transmit complete interrupt is executed, or it can be cleared by writing
a one to its bit location. The TXCn Flag can generate a Transmit Complete interrupt (see
description of the TXCIEn bit).
• Bit 5 - UDREn: USART Data Register Empty
The UDREn Flag indicates if the transmit buffer (UDRn) is ready to receive new data. If UDREn
is one, the buffer is empty, and therefore ready to be written. The UDREn Flag can generate a
Data Register Empty interrupt (see description of the UDRIE bit). UDREn is set after a reset to
indicate that the Transmitter is ready.
• Bit 4:0 - Reserved Bits in MSPI mode
When in MSPI mode, these bits are reserved for future use. For compatibility with future devices,
these bits must be written to zero when UCSRnA is written.
23.6.3
UCSRnB – USART MSPIM Control and Status Register n B
Bit
7
6
5
4
3
TXENn
R/W
0
2
-
1
-
0
-
RXCIEn
TXCIEn
UDRIE
RXENn
R/W
0
UCSRnB
Read/Write
R/W
R/W
R/W
R
1
R
1
R
0
Initial Value
0
0
0
• Bit 7 - RXCIEn: RX Complete Interrupt Enable
Writing this bit to one enables interrupt on the RXCn Flag. A USART Receive Complete interrupt
will be generated only if the RXCIEn bit is written to one, the Global Interrupt Flag in SREG is
written to one and the RXCn bit in UCSRnA is set.
• Bit 6 - TXCIEn: TX Complete Interrupt Enable
Writing this bit to one enables interrupt on the TXCn Flag. A USART Transmit Complete interrupt
will be generated only if the TXCIEn bit is written to one, the Global Interrupt Flag in SREG is
written to one and the TXCn bit in UCSRnA is set.
• Bit 5 - UDRIE: USART Data Register Empty Interrupt Enable
238
ATmega640/1280/1281/2560/2561
2549L–AVR–08/07
ATmega640/1280/1281/2560/2561
Writing this bit to one enables interrupt on the UDREn Flag. A Data Register Empty interrupt will
be generated only if the UDRIE bit is written to one, the Global Interrupt Flag in SREG is written
to one and the UDREn bit in UCSRnA is set.
• Bit 4 - RXENn: Receiver Enable
Writing this bit to one enables the USART Receiver in MSPIM mode. The Receiver will override
normal port operation for the RxDn pin when enabled. Disabling the Receiver will flush the
receive buffer. Only enabling the receiver in MSPI mode (i.e. setting RXENn=1 and TXENn=0)
has no meaning since it is the transmitter that controls the transfer clock and since only master
mode is supported.
• Bit 3 - TXENn: Transmitter Enable
Writing this bit to one enables the USART Transmitter. The Transmitter will override normal port
operation for the TxDn pin when enabled. The disabling of the Transmitter (writing TXENn to
zero) will not become effective until ongoing and pending transmissions are completed, i.e.,
when the Transmit Shift Register and Transmit Buffer Register do not contain data to be trans-
mitted. When disabled, the Transmitter will no longer override the TxDn port.
• Bit 2:0 - Reserved Bits in MSPI mode
When in MSPI mode, these bits are reserved for future use. For compatibility with future devices,
these bits must be written to zero when UCSRnB is written.
23.6.4
UCSRnC – USART MSPIM Control and Status Register n C
Bit
7
6
5
4
3
-
2
UDORDn
R/W
1
UCPHAn
R/W
0
UCPOLn
R/W
UMSELn1
UMSELn0
-
-
UCSRnC
Read/Write
R/W
R/W
R
0
R
0
R
0
Initial Value
0
0
1
1
0
• Bit 7:6 - UMSELn1:0: USART Mode Select
These bits select the mode of operation of the USART as shown in Table 23-3. See “UCSRnC –
USART Control and Status Register n C” on page 226 for full description of the normal USART
operation. The MSPIM is enabled when both UMSELn bits are set to one. The UDORDn,
UCPHAn, and UCPOLn can be set in the same write operation where the MSPIM is enabled.
Table 23-3. UMSELn Bits Settings
UMSELn1
UMSELn0
Mode
0
0
1
1
0
1
0
1
Asynchronous USART
Synchronous USART
(Reserved)
Master SPI (MSPIM)
• Bit 5:3 - Reserved Bits in MSPI mode
When in MSPI mode, these bits are reserved for future use. For compatibility with future devices,
these bits must be written to zero when UCSRnC is written.
239
2549L–AVR–08/07
• Bit 2 - UDORDn: Data Order
When set to one the LSB of the data word is transmitted first. When set to zero the MSB of the
data word is transmitted first. Refer to the Frame Formats section page 4 for details.
• Bit 1 - UCPHAn: Clock Phase
The UCPHAn bit setting determine if data is sampled on the leasing edge (first) or tailing (last)
edge of XCKn. Refer to the SPI Data Modes and Timing section page 4 for details.
• Bit 0 - UCPOLn: Clock Polarity
The UCPOLn bit sets the polarity of the XCKn clock. The combination of the UCPOLn and
UCPHAn bit settings determine the timing of the data transfer. Refer to the SPI Data Modes and
Timing section page 4 for details.
23.6.5
UBRRnL and UBRRnH – USART MSPIM Baud Rate Registers
The function and bit description of the baud rate registers in MSPI mode is identical to normal
USART operation. See “UBRRnL and UBRRnH – USART Baud Rate Registers” on page 227.
Table 23-4. Comparison of USART in MSPIM mode and SPI pins.
USART_MSPIM
TxDn
SPI
MOSI
MISO
SCK
SS
Comment
Master Out only
RxDn
Master In only
XCKn
(Functionally identical)
Not supported by USART in MSPIM
(N/A)
240
ATmega640/1280/1281/2560/2561
2549L–AVR–08/07
ATmega640/1280/1281/2560/2561
24. 2-wire Serial Interface
24.1 Features
• Simple yet Powerful and Flexible Communication Interface, only two Bus Lines needed
• Both Master and Slave Operation Supported
• Device can Operate as Transmitter or Receiver
• 7-bit Address Space Allows up to 128 Different Slave Addresses
• Multi-master Arbitration Support
• Up to 400 kHz Data Transfer Speed
• Slew-rate Limited Output Drivers
• Noise Suppression Circuitry Rejects Spikes on Bus Lines
• Fully Programmable Slave Address with General Call Support
• Address Recognition Causes Wake-up When AVR is in Sleep Mode
24.2 2-wire Serial Interface Bus Definition
The 2-wire Serial Interface (TWI) is ideally suited for typical microcontroller applications. The
TWI protocol allows the systems designer to interconnect up to 128 different devices using only
two bi-directional bus lines, one for clock (SCL) and one for data (SDA). The only external hard-
ware needed to implement the bus is a single pull-up resistor for each of the TWI bus lines. All
devices connected to the bus have individual addresses, and mechanisms for resolving bus
contention are inherent in the TWI protocol.
Figure 2. TWI Bus Interconnection
VCC
Device 1
Device 3
R1
R2
Device 2
Device n
........
SDA
SCL
24.2.1
TWI Terminology
The following definitions are frequently encountered in this section.
Table 4. TWI Terminology
Term
Description
The device that initiates and terminates a transmission. The Master also generates the
SCL clock.
Master
Slave
The device addressed by a Master.
The device placing data on the bus.
The device reading data from the bus.
Transmitter
Receiver
241
2549L–AVR–08/07
The Power Reduction TWI bit, PRTWI bit in “PRR0 – Power Reduction Register 0” on page 56
must be written to zero to enable the 2-wire Serial Interface.
24.2.2
Electrical Interconnection
As depicted in Figure 2, both bus lines are connected to the positive supply voltage through pull-
up resistors. The bus drivers of all TWI-compliant devices are open-drain or open-collector. This
implements a wired-AND function which is essential to the operation of the interface. A low level
on a TWI bus line is generated when one or more TWI devices output a zero. A high level is out-
put when all TWI devices trim-state their outputs, allowing the pull-up resistors to pull the line
high. Note that all AVR devices connected to the TWI bus must be powered in order to allow any
bus operation.
The number of devices that can be connected to the bus is only limited by the bus capacitance
limit of 400 pF and the 7-bit slave address space. A detailed specification of the electrical char-
acteristics of the TWI is given in “SPI Timing Characteristics” on page 377. Two different sets of
specifications are presented there, one relevant for bus speeds below 100 kHz, and one valid for
bus speeds up to 400 kHz.
24.3 Data Transfer and Frame Format
24.3.1
Transferring Bits
Each data bit transferred on the TWI bus is accompanied by a pulse on the clock line. The level
of the data line must be stable when the clock line is high. The only exception to this rule is for
generating start and stop conditions.
Figure 24-1. Data Validity
SDA
SCL
Data Stable
Data Stable
Data Change
24.3.2
START and STOP Conditions
The Master initiates and terminates a data transmission. The transmission is initiated when the
Master issues a START condition on the bus, and it is terminated when the Master issues a
STOP condition. Between a START and a STOP condition, the bus is considered busy, and no
other master should try to seize control of the bus. A special case occurs when a new START
condition is issued between a START and STOP condition. This is referred to as a REPEATED
START condition, and is used when the Master wishes to initiate a new transfer without relin-
quishing control of the bus. After a REPEATED START, the bus is considered busy until the next
STOP. This is identical to the START behavior, and therefore START is used to describe both
START and REPEATED START for the remainder of this datasheet, unless otherwise noted. As
242
ATmega640/1280/1281/2560/2561
2549L–AVR–08/07
ATmega640/1280/1281/2560/2561
depicted below, START and STOP conditions are signalled by changing the level of the SDA
line when the SCL line is high.
Figure 24-2. START, REPEATED START and STOP conditions
SDA
SCL
START
STOP START
REPEATED START
STOP
24.3.3
Address Packet Format
All address packets transmitted on the TWI bus are 9 bits long, consisting of 7 address bits, one
READ/WRITE control bit and an acknowledge bit. If the READ/WRITE bit is set, a read opera-
tion is to be performed, otherwise a write operation should be performed. When a Slave
recognizes that it is being addressed, it should acknowledge by pulling SDA low in the ninth SCL
(ACK) cycle. If the addressed Slave is busy, or for some other reason can not service the Mas-
ter’s request, the SDA line should be left high in the ACK clock cycle. The Master can then
transmit a STOP condition, or a REPEATED START condition to initiate a new transmission. An
address packet consisting of a slave address and a READ or a WRITE bit is called SLA+R or
SLA+W, respectively.
The MSB of the address byte is transmitted first. Slave addresses can freely be allocated by the
designer, but the address 0000 000 is reserved for a general call.
When a general call is issued, all slaves should respond by pulling the SDA line low in the ACK
cycle. A general call is used when a Master wishes to transmit the same message to several
slaves in the system. When the general call address followed by a Write bit is transmitted on the
bus, all slaves set up to acknowledge the general call will pull the SDA line low in the ack cycle.
The following data packets will then be received by all the slaves that acknowledged the general
call. Note that transmitting the general call address followed by a Read bit is meaningless, as
this would cause contention if several slaves started transmitting different data.
All addresses of the format 1111 xxx should be reserved for future purposes.
Figure 24-3. Address Packet Format
Addr MSB
Addr LSB
R/W
ACK
SDA
SCL
1
2
7
8
9
START
243
2549L–AVR–08/07
24.3.4
Data Packet Format
All data packets transmitted on the TWI bus are nine bits long, consisting of one data byte and
an acknowledge bit. During a data transfer, the Master generates the clock and the START and
STOP conditions, while the Receiver is responsible for acknowledging the reception. An
Acknowledge (ACK) is signalled by the Receiver pulling the SDA line low during the ninth SCL
cycle. If the Receiver leaves the SDA line high, a NACK is signalled. When the Receiver has
received the last byte, or for some reason cannot receive any more bytes, it should inform the
Transmitter by sending a NACK after the final byte. The MSB of the data byte is transmitted first.
Figure 24-4. Data Packet Format
Data MSB
Data LSB
ACK
Aggregate
SDA
SDA from
Transmitter
SDA from
Receiver
SCL from
Master
1
2
7
8
9
STOP, REPEATED
START or Next
Data Byte
SLA+R/W
Data Byte
24.3.5
Combining Address and Data Packets into a Transmission
A transmission basically consists of a START condition, a SLA+R/W, one or more data packets
and a STOP condition. An empty message, consisting of a START followed by a STOP condi-
tion, is illegal. Note that the Wired-ANDing of the SCL line can be used to implement
handshaking between the Master and the Slave. The Slave can extend the SCL low period by
pulling the SCL line low. This is useful if the clock speed set up by the Master is too fast for the
Slave, or the Slave needs extra time for processing between the data transmissions. The Slave
extending the SCL low period will not affect the SCL high period, which is determined by the
Master. As a consequence, the Slave can reduce the TWI data transfer speed by prolonging the
SCL duty cycle.
Figure 24-5 shows a typical data transmission. Note that several data bytes can be transmitted
between the SLA+R/W and the STOP condition, depending on the software protocol imple-
mented by the application software.
Figure 24-5. Typical Data Transmission
Addr MSB
Addr LSB R/W
ACK
Data MSB
Data LSB ACK
SDA
SCL
1
2
7
8
9
1
2
7
8
9
START
SLA+R/W
Data Byte
STOP
244
ATmega640/1280/1281/2560/2561
2549L–AVR–08/07
ATmega640/1280/1281/2560/2561
24.4 Multi-master Bus Systems, Arbitration and Synchronization
The TWI protocol allows bus systems with several masters. Special concerns have been taken
in order to ensure that transmissions will proceed as normal, even if two or more masters initiate
a transmission at the same time. Two problems arise in multi-master systems:
•
An algorithm must be implemented allowing only one of the masters to complete the
transmission. All other masters should cease transmission when they discover that they
have lost the selection process. This selection process is called arbitration. When a
contending master discovers that it has lost the arbitration process, it should immediately
switch to Slave mode to check whether it is being addressed by the winning master. The fact
that multiple masters have started transmission at the same time should not be detectable to
the slaves, i.e. the data being transferred on the bus must not be corrupted.
•
Different masters may use different SCL frequencies. A scheme must be devised to
synchronize the serial clocks from all masters, in order to let the transmission proceed in a
lockstep fashion. This will facilitate the arbitration process.
The wired-ANDing of the bus lines is used to solve both these problems. The serial clocks from
all masters will be wired-ANDed, yielding a combined clock with a high period equal to the one
from the Master with the shortest high period. The low period of the combined clock is equal to
the low period of the Master with the longest low period. Note that all masters listen to the SCL
line, effectively starting to count their SCL high and low time-out periods when the combined
SCL line goes high or low, respectively.
Figure 24-6. SCL Synchronization Between Multiple Masters
TA low
TA high
SCL from
Master A
SCL from
Master B
SCL Bus
Line
TBlow
TBhigh
Masters Start
Masters Start
Counting Low Period
Counting High Period
Arbitration is carried out by all masters continuously monitoring the SDA line after outputting
data. If the value read from the SDA line does not match the value the Master had output, it has
lost the arbitration. Note that a Master can only lose arbitration when it outputs a high SDA value
while another Master outputs a low value. The losing Master should immediately go to Slave
mode, checking if it is being addressed by the winning Master. The SDA line should be left high,
but losing masters are allowed to generate a clock signal until the end of the current data or
address packet. Arbitration will continue until only one Master remains, and this may take many
bits. If several masters are trying to address the same Slave, arbitration will continue into the
data packet.
245
2549L–AVR–08/07
Figure 24-7. Arbitration Between Two Masters
START
Master A Loses
Arbitration, SDAA SDA
SDA from
Master A
SDA from
Master B
SDA Line
Synchronized
SCL Line
Note that arbitration is not allowed between:
•
•
•
A REPEATED START condition and a data bit.
A STOP condition and a data bit.
A REPEATED START and a STOP condition.
It is the user software’s responsibility to ensure that these illegal arbitration conditions never
occur. This implies that in multi-master systems, all data transfers must use the same composi-
tion of SLA+R/W and data packets. In other words: All transmissions must contain the same
number of data packets, otherwise the result of the arbitration is undefined.
24.5 Overview of the TWI Module
The TWI module is comprised of several submodules, as shown in Figure 24-8. All registers
drawn in a thick line are accessible through the AVR data bus.
246
ATmega640/1280/1281/2560/2561
2549L–AVR–08/07
ATmega640/1280/1281/2560/2561
Figure 24-8. Overview of the TWI Module
SCL
SDA
Spike
Filter
Spike
Filter
Slew-rate
Control
Slew-rate
Control
Bus Interface Unit
Bit Rate Generator
START / STOP
Spike Suppression
Prescaler
Control
Address/Data Shift
Register (TWDR)
Bit Rate Register
(TWBR)
Arbitration detection
Ack
Address Match Unit
Control Unit
Address Register
(TWAR)
Status Register
(TWSR)
Control Register
(TWCR)
State Machine and
Status control
Address Comparator
24.5.1
24.5.2
SCL and SDA Pins
These pins interface the AVR TWI with the rest of the MCU system. The output drivers contain a
slew-rate limiter in order to conform to the TWI specification. The input stages contain a spike
suppression unit removing spikes shorter than 50 ns. Note that the internal pull-ups in the AVR
pads can be enabled by setting the PORT bits corresponding to the SCL and SDA pins, as
explained in the I/O Port section. The internal pull-ups can in some systems eliminate the need
for external ones.
Bit Rate Generator Unit
This unit controls the period of SCL when operating in a Master mode. The SCL period is con-
trolled by settings in the TWI Bit Rate Register (TWBR) and the Prescaler bits in the TWI Status
Register (TWSR). Slave operation does not depend on Bit Rate or Prescaler settings, but the
CPU clock frequency in the Slave must be at least 16 times higher than the SCL frequency. Note
that slaves may prolong the SCL low period, thereby reducing the average TWI bus clock
period. The SCL frequency is generated according to the following equation:
247
2549L–AVR–08/07
CPU Clock frequency
SCL frequency = -----------------------------------------------------------
TWPS
16 + 2(TWBR) ⋅ 4
•
•
TWBR = Value of the TWI Bit Rate Register.
TWPS = Value of the prescaler bits in the TWI Status Register.
Note:
Pull-up resistor values should be selected according to the SCL frequency and the capacitive bus
line load. See “2-wire Serial Interface Characteristics” on page 375 for value of pull-up resistor.
24.5.3
Bus Interface Unit
This unit contains the Data and Address Shift Register (TWDR), a START/STOP Controller and
Arbitration detection hardware. The TWDR contains the address or data bytes to be transmitted,
or the address or data bytes received. In addition to the 8-bit TWDR, the Bus Interface Unit also
contains a register containing the (N)ACK bit to be transmitted or received. This (N)ACK Regis-
ter is not directly accessible by the application software. However, when receiving, it can be set
or cleared by manipulating the TWI Control Register (TWCR). When in Transmitter mode, the
value of the received (N)ACK bit can be determined by the value in the TWSR.
The START/STOP Controller is responsible for generation and detection of START, REPEATED
START, and STOP conditions. The START/STOP controller is able to detect START and STOP
conditions even when the AVR MCU is in one of the sleep modes, enabling the MCU to wake up
if addressed by a Master.
If the TWI has initiated a transmission as Master, the Arbitration Detection hardware continu-
ously monitors the transmission trying to determine if arbitration is in process. If the TWI has lost
an arbitration, the Control Unit is informed. Correct action can then be taken and appropriate
status codes generated.
24.5.4
Address Match Unit
The Address Match unit checks if received address bytes match the seven-bit address in the
TWI Address Register (TWAR). If the TWI General Call Recognition Enable (TWGCE) bit in the
TWAR is written to one, all incoming address bits will also be compared against the General Call
address. Upon an address match, the Control Unit is informed, allowing correct action to be
taken. The TWI may or may not acknowledge its address, depending on settings in the TWCR.
The Address Match unit is able to compare addresses even when the AVR MCU is in sleep
mode, enabling the MCU to wake up if addressed by a Master. If another interrupt (e.g., INT0)
occurs during TWI Power-down address match and wakes up the CPU, the TWI aborts opera-
tion and return to it’s idle state. If this cause any problems, ensure that TWI Address Match is the
only enabled interrupt when entering Power-down.
24.5.5
Control Unit
The Control unit monitors the TWI bus and generates responses corresponding to settings in the
TWI Control Register (TWCR). When an event requiring the attention of the application occurs
on the TWI bus, the TWI Interrupt Flag (TWINT) is asserted. In the next clock cycle, the TWI Sta-
tus Register (TWSR) is updated with a status code identifying the event. The TWSR only
contains relevant status information when the TWI Interrupt Flag is asserted. At all other times,
the TWSR contains a special status code indicating that no relevant status information is avail-
able. As long as the TWINT Flag is set, the SCL line is held low. This allows the application
software to complete its tasks before allowing the TWI transmission to continue.
The TWINT Flag is set in the following situations:
248
ATmega640/1280/1281/2560/2561
2549L–AVR–08/07
ATmega640/1280/1281/2560/2561
•
•
•
•
•
•
•
•
After the TWI has transmitted a START/REPEATED START condition.
After the TWI has transmitted SLA+R/W.
After the TWI has transmitted an address byte.
After the TWI has lost arbitration.
After the TWI has been addressed by own slave address or general call.
After the TWI has received a data byte.
After a STOP or REPEATED START has been received while still addressed as a Slave.
When a bus error has occurred due to an illegal START or STOP condition.
24.6 Using the TWI
The AVR TWI is byte-oriented and interrupt based. Interrupts are issued after all bus events, like
reception of a byte or transmission of a START condition. Because the TWI is interrupt-based,
the application software is free to carry on other operations during a TWI byte transfer. Note that
the TWI Interrupt Enable (TWIE) bit in TWCR together with the Global Interrupt Enable bit in
SREG allow the application to decide whether or not assertion of the TWINT Flag should gener-
ate an interrupt request. If the TWIE bit is cleared, the application must poll the TWINT Flag in
order to detect actions on the TWI bus.
When the TWINT Flag is asserted, the TWI has finished an operation and awaits application
response. In this case, the TWI Status Register (TWSR) contains a value indicating the current
state of the TWI bus. The application software can then decide how the TWI should behave in
the next TWI bus cycle by manipulating the TWCR and TWDR Registers.
Figure 24-9 is a simple example of how the application can interface to the TWI hardware. In this
example, a Master wishes to transmit a single data byte to a Slave. This description is quite
abstract, a more detailed explanation follows later in this section. A simple code example imple-
menting the desired behavior is also presented.
Figure 24-9. Interfacing the Application to the TWI in a Typical Transmission
3. Check TWSR to see if START was
sent. Application loads SLA+W into
TWDR, and loads appropriate control
signals into TWCR, makin sure that
TWINT is written to one,
5. Check TWSR to see if SLA+W was
sent and ACK received.
Application loads data into TWDR, and
loads appropriate control signals into
TWCR, making sure that TWINT is
written to one
1. Application
writes to TWCR to
initiate
transmission of
START
7. Check TWSR to see if data was sent
and ACK received.
Application loads appropriate control
signals to send STOP into TWCR,
making sure that TWINT is written to one
and TWSTA is written to zero.
TWI bus START
SLA+W
A
Data
A
STOP
Indicates
TWINT set
4. TWINT set.
Status code indicates
SLA+W sent, ACK
received
2. TWINT set.
Status code indicates
START condition sent
6. TWINT set.
Status code indicates
data sent, ACK received
1. The first step in a TWI transmission is to transmit a START condition. This is done by
writing a specific value into TWCR, instructing the TWI hardware to transmit a START
condition. Which value to write is described later on. However, it is important that the
TWINT bit is set in the value written. Writing a one to TWINT clears the flag. The TWI will
249
2549L–AVR–08/07
not start any operation as long as the TWINT bit in TWCR is set. Immediately after the
application has cleared TWINT, the TWI will initiate transmission of the START condition.
2. When the START condition has been transmitted, the TWINT Flag in TWCR is set, and
TWSR is updated with a status code indicating that the START condition has success-
fully been sent.
3. The application software should now examine the value of TWSR, to make sure that the
START condition was successfully transmitted. If TWSR indicates otherwise, the applica-
tion software might take some special action, like calling an error routine. Assuming that
the status code is as expected, the application must load SLA+W into TWDR. Remember
that TWDR is used both for address and data. After TWDR has been loaded with the
desired SLA+W, a specific value must be written to TWCR, instructing the TWI hardware
to transmit the SLA+W present in TWDR. Which value to write is described later on.
However, it is important that the TWINT bit is set in the value written. Writing a one to
TWINT clears the flag. The TWI will not start any operation as long as the TWINT bit in
TWCR is set. Immediately after the application has cleared TWINT, the TWI will initiate
transmission of the address packet.
4. When the address packet has been transmitted, the TWINT Flag in TWCR is set, and
TWSR is updated with a status code indicating that the address packet has successfully
been sent. The status code will also reflect whether a Slave acknowledged the packet or
not.
5. The application software should now examine the value of TWSR, to make sure that the
address packet was successfully transmitted, and that the value of the ACK bit was as
expected. If TWSR indicates otherwise, the application software might take some special
action, like calling an error routine. Assuming that the status code is as expected, the
application must load a data packet into TWDR. Subsequently, a specific value must be
written to TWCR, instructing the TWI hardware to transmit the data packet present in
TWDR. Which value to write is described later on. However, it is important that the
TWINT bit is set in the value written. Writing a one to TWINT clears the flag. The TWI will
not start any operation as long as the TWINT bit in TWCR is set. Immediately after the
application has cleared TWINT, the TWI will initiate transmission of the data packet.
6. When the data packet has been transmitted, the TWINT Flag in TWCR is set, and TWSR
is updated with a status code indicating that the data packet has successfully been sent.
The status code will also reflect whether a Slave acknowledged the packet or not.
7. The application software should now examine the value of TWSR, to make sure that the
data packet was successfully transmitted, and that the value of the ACK bit was as
expected. If TWSR indicates otherwise, the application software might take some special
action, like calling an error routine. Assuming that the status code is as expected, the
application must write a specific value to TWCR, instructing the TWI hardware to transmit
a STOP condition. Which value to write is described later on. However, it is important that
the TWINT bit is set in the value written. Writing a one to TWINT clears the flag. The TWI
will not start any operation as long as the TWINT bit in TWCR is set. Immediately after
the application has cleared TWINT, the TWI will initiate transmission of the STOP condi-
tion. Note that TWINT is NOT set after a STOP condition has been sent.
Even though this example is simple, it shows the principles involved in all TWI transmissions.
These can be summarized as follows:
•
When the TWI has finished an operation and expects application response, the TWINT Flag
is set. The SCL line is pulled low until TWINT is cleared.
•
When the TWINT Flag is set, the user must update all TWI Registers with the value relevant
for the next TWI bus cycle. As an example, TWDR must be loaded with the value to be
transmitted in the next bus cycle.
250
ATmega640/1280/1281/2560/2561
2549L–AVR–08/07
ATmega640/1280/1281/2560/2561
•
After all TWI Register updates and other pending application software tasks have been
completed, TWCR is written. When writing TWCR, the TWINT bit should be set. Writing a
one to TWINT clears the flag. The TWI will then commence executing whatever operation
was specified by the TWCR setting.
In the following an assembly and C implementation of the example is given. Note that the code
below assumes that several definitions have been made, for example by using include-files.
Assembly Code Example
C Example
TWCR = (1<<TWINT)|(1<<TWSTA)|
(1<<TWEN)
Comments
ldi r16, (1<<TWINT)|(1<<TWSTA)|
1
2
(1<<TWEN)
out TWCR, r16
wait1:
Send START condition
while (!(TWCR & (1<<TWINT)))
Wait for TWINT Flag set. This
indicates that the START condition
has been transmitted
in
r16,TWCR
;
sbrs r16,TWINT
rjmp wait1
in
r16,TWSR
if ((TWSR & 0xF8) != START)
3
Check value of TWI Status
Register. Mask prescaler bits. If
status different from START go to
ERROR
andi r16, 0xF8
cpi r16, START
brne ERROR
ERROR();
ldi r16, SLA_W
out TWDR, r16
ldi r16, (1<<TWINT) | (1<<TWEN)
out TWCR, r16
wait2:
TWDR = SLA_W;
Load SLA_W into TWDR Register.
Clear TWINT bit in TWCR to start
transmission of address
TWCR = (1<<TWINT) | (1<<TWEN);
while (!(TWCR & (1<<TWINT)))
4
5
Wait for TWINT Flag set. This
indicates that the SLA+W has been
transmitted, and ACK/NACK has
been received.
in
r16,TWCR
;
sbrs r16,TWINT
rjmp wait2
in
r16,TWSR
if ((TWSR & 0xF8) !=
MT_SLA_ACK)
Check value of TWI Status
Register. Mask prescaler bits. If
status different from MT_SLA_ACK
go to ERROR
andi r16, 0xF8
ERROR();
cpi r16, MT_SLA_ACK
brne ERROR
ldi r16, DATA
TWDR = DATA;
Load DATA into TWDR Register.
Clear TWINT bit in TWCR to start
transmission of data
out TWDR, r16
TWCR = (1<<TWINT) | (1<<TWEN);
ldi r16, (1<<TWINT) | (1<<TWEN)
out TWCR, r16
wait3:
while (!(TWCR & (1<<TWINT)))
6
7
Wait for TWINT Flag set. This
indicates that the DATA has been
transmitted, and ACK/NACK has
been received.
in
r16,TWCR
;
sbrs r16,TWINT
rjmp wait3
in
r16,TWSR
if ((TWSR & 0xF8) !=
MT_DATA_ACK)
Check value of TWI Status
Register. Mask prescaler bits. If
status different from
andi r16, 0xF8
ERROR();
cpi r16, MT_DATA_ACK
brne ERROR
MT_DATA_ACK go to ERROR
ldi r16, (1<<TWINT)|(1<<TWEN)|
(1<<TWSTO)
TWCR = (1<<TWINT)|(1<<TWEN)|
(1<<TWSTO);
Transmit STOP condition
out TWCR, r16
251
2549L–AVR–08/07
24.7 Transmission Modes
The TWI can operate in one of four major modes. These are named Master Transmitter (MT),
Master Receiver (MR), Slave Transmitter (ST) and Slave Receiver (SR). Several of these
modes can be used in the same application. As an example, the TWI can use MT mode to write
data into a TWI EEPROM, MR mode to read the data back from the EEPROM. If other masters
are present in the system, some of these might transmit data to the TWI, and then SR mode
would be used. It is the application software that decides which modes are legal.
The following sections describe each of these modes. Possible status codes are described
along with figures detailing data transmission in each of the modes. These figures contain the
following abbreviations:
S: START condition
Rs: REPEATED START condition
R: Read bit (high level at SDA)
W: Write bit (low level at SDA)
A: Acknowledge bit (low level at SDA)
A: Not acknowledge bit (high level at SDA)
Data: 8-bit data byte
P: STOP condition
SLA: Slave Address
In Figure 24-11 to Figure 24-17, circles are used to indicate that the TWINT Flag is set. The
numbers in the circles show the status code held in TWSR, with the prescaler bits masked to
zero. At these points, actions must be taken by the application to continue or complete the TWI
transfer. The TWI transfer is suspended until the TWINT Flag is cleared by software.
When the TWINT Flag is set, the status code in TWSR is used to determine the appropriate soft-
ware action. For each status code, the required software action and details of the following serial
transfer are given in Table 24-1 to Table 24-4. Note that the prescaler bits are masked to zero in
these tables.
24.7.1
Master Transmitter Mode
In the Master Transmitter mode, a number of data bytes are transmitted to a Slave Receiver
(see Figure 24-10). In order to enter a Master mode, a START condition must be transmitted.
The format of the following address packet determines whether Master Transmitter or Master
Receiver mode is to be entered. If SLA+W is transmitted, MT mode is entered, if SLA+R is trans-
mitted, MR mode is entered. All the status codes mentioned in this section assume that the
prescaler bits are zero or are masked to zero.
252
ATmega640/1280/1281/2560/2561
2549L–AVR–08/07
ATmega640/1280/1281/2560/2561
Figure 24-10. Data Transfer in Master Transmitter Mode
VCC
Device 1
MASTER
TRANSMITTER
Device 2
SLAVE
RECEIVER
Device 3
Device n
R1
R2
........
SDA
SCL
A START condition is sent by writing the following value to TWCR:
TWCR
TWINT
TWEA
TWSTA
TWSTO
TWWC
TWEN
–
TWIE
value
1
X
1
0
X
1
0
X
TWEN must be set to enable the 2-wire Serial Interface, TWSTA must be written to one to trans-
mit a START condition and TWINT must be written to one to clear the TWINT Flag. The TWI will
then test the 2-wire Serial Bus and generate a START condition as soon as the bus becomes
free. After a START condition has been transmitted, the TWINT Flag is set by hardware, and the
status code in TWSR will be 0x08 (see Table 24-1). In order to enter MT mode, SLA+W must be
transmitted. This is done by writing SLA+W to TWDR. Thereafter the TWINT bit should be
cleared (by writing it to one) to continue the transfer. This is accomplished by writing the follow-
ing value to TWCR:
TWCR
TWINT
TWEA
TWSTA
TWSTO
TWWC
TWEN
–
TWIE
value
1
X
0
0
X
1
0
X
When SLA+W have been transmitted and an acknowledgement bit has been received, TWINT is
set again and a number of status codes in TWSR are possible. Possible status codes in Master
mode are 0x18, 0x20, or 0x38. The appropriate action to be taken for each of these status codes
is detailed in Table 24-1.
When SLA+W has been successfully transmitted, a data packet should be transmitted. This is
done by writing the data byte to TWDR. TWDR must only be written when TWINT is high. If not,
the access will be discarded, and the Write Collision bit (TWWC) will be set in the TWCR Regis-
ter. After updating TWDR, the TWINT bit should be cleared (by writing it to one) to continue the
transfer. This is accomplished by writing the following value to TWCR:
TWCR
TWINT
TWEA
TWSTA
TWSTO
TWWC
TWEN
–
TWIE
value
1
X
0
0
X
1
0
X
This scheme is repeated until the last byte has been sent and the transfer is ended by generat-
ing a STOP condition or a repeated START condition. A STOP condition is generated by writing
the following value to TWCR:
TWCR
TWINT
TWEA
TWSTA
TWSTO
TWWC
TWEN
–
TWIE
value
1
X
0
1
X
1
0
X
A REPEATED START condition is generated by writing the following value to TWCR:
TWCR
TWINT
TWEA
TWSTA
TWSTO
TWWC
TWEN
–
TWIE
value
1
X
1
0
X
1
0
X
253
2549L–AVR–08/07
After a repeated START condition (state 0x10) the 2-wire Serial Interface can access the same
Slave again, or a new Slave without transmitting a STOP condition. Repeated START enables
the Master to switch between Slaves, Master Transmitter mode and Master Receiver mode with-
out losing control of the bus.
Table 24-1. Status codes for Master Transmitter Mode
Status Code
(TWSR)
Prescaler Bits
are 0
Application Software Response
To/from TWDR To TWCR
STO TWINT
Status of the 2-wire Serial Bus
and 2-wire Serial Interface Hard-
ware
STA
0
TWEA
X
Next Action Taken by TWI Hardware
0x08
A START condition has been Load SLA+W
transmitted
0
1
SLA+W will be transmitted;
ACK or NOT ACK will be received
0x10
A
repeated START condition Load SLA+W or
0
0
0
0
1
1
X
X
SLA+W will be transmitted;
ACK or NOT ACK will be received
SLA+R will be transmitted;
has been transmitted
Load SLA+R
Logic will switch to Master Receiver mode
0x18
0x20
0x28
0x30
0x38
SLA+W has been transmitted;
ACK has been received
Load data byte or
0
0
1
X
Data byte will be transmitted and ACK or NOT ACK will
be received
Repeated START will be transmitted
STOP condition will be transmitted and
TWSTO Flag will be reset
No TWDR action or
No TWDR action or
1
0
0
1
1
1
X
X
No TWDR action
Load data byte or
1
0
1
0
1
1
X
X
STOP condition followed by a START condition will be
transmitted and TWSTO Flag will be reset
SLA+W has been transmitted;
NOT ACK has been received
Data byte will be transmitted and ACK or NOT ACK will
be received
Repeated START will be transmitted
STOP condition will be transmitted and
TWSTO Flag will be reset
No TWDR action or
No TWDR action or
1
0
0
1
1
1
X
X
No TWDR action
1
0
1
0
1
1
X
X
STOP condition followed by a START condition will be
transmitted and TWSTO Flag will be reset
Data byte has been transmitted; Load data byte or
ACK has been received
Data byte will be transmitted and ACK or NOT ACK will
be received
Repeated START will be transmitted
STOP condition will be transmitted and
TWSTO Flag will be reset
No TWDR action or
No TWDR action or
1
0
0
1
1
1
X
X
No TWDR action
1
0
1
0
1
1
X
X
STOP condition followed by a START condition will be
transmitted and TWSTO Flag will be reset
Data byte has been transmitted; Load data byte or
NOT ACK has been received
No TWDR action or
Data byte will be transmitted and ACK or NOT ACK will
be received
Repeated START will be transmitted
STOP condition will be transmitted and
TWSTO Flag will be reset
1
0
0
1
1
1
X
X
No TWDR action or
No TWDR action
1
1
1
X
STOP condition followed by a START condition will be
transmitted and TWSTO Flag will be reset
Arbitration lost in SLA+W or data No TWDR action or
bytes
0
1
0
0
1
1
X
X
2-wire Serial Bus will be released and not addressed
Slave mode entered
A START condition will be transmitted when the bus be-
comes free
No TWDR action
254
ATmega640/1280/1281/2560/2561
2549L–AVR–08/07
ATmega640/1280/1281/2560/2561
Figure 24-11. Formats and States in the Master Transmitter Mode
MT
Successfull
transmission
to a slave
receiver
S
SLA
W
A
DATA
A
P
$08
$18
$28
Next transfer
started with a
repeated start
condition
RS
SLA
W
R
$10
Not acknowledge
received after the
slave address
A
P
$20
MR
Not acknowledge
received after a data
byte
A
P
$30
Arbitration lost in slave
address or data byte
Other master
continues
Other master
continues
A or A
A or A
$38
A
$38
Arbitration lost and
addressed as slave
Other master
continues
To corresponding
states in slave mode
$68 $78 $B0
Any number of data bytes
and their associated acknowledge bits
From master to slave
From slave to master
DATA
A
This number (contained in TWSR) corresponds
to a defined state of the Two-Wire Serial Bus. The
prescaler bits are zero or masked to zero
n
24.7.2
Master Receiver Mode
In the Master Receiver mode, a number of data bytes are received from a Slave Transmitter
(Slave see Figure 24-12). In order to enter a Master mode, a START condition must be transmit-
ted. The format of the following address packet determines whether Master Transmitter or
Master Receiver mode is to be entered. If SLA+W is transmitted, MT mode is entered, if SLA+R
is transmitted, MR mode is entered. All the status codes mentioned in this section assume that
the prescaler bits are zero or are masked to zero.
255
2549L–AVR–08/07
Figure 24-12. Data Transfer in Master Receiver Mode
VCC
Device 1
MASTER
RECEIVER
Device 2
SLAVE
TRANSMITTER
Device 3
Device n
R1
R2
........
SDA
SCL
A START condition is sent by writing the following value to TWCR:
TWCR
TWINT
TWEA
TWSTA
TWSTO
TWWC
TWEN
–
TWIE
value
1
X
1
0
X
1
0
X
TWEN must be written to one to enable the 2-wire Serial Interface, TWSTA must be written to
one to transmit a START condition and TWINT must be set to clear the TWINT Flag. The TWI
will then test the 2-wire Serial Bus and generate a START condition as soon as the bus
becomes free. After a START condition has been transmitted, the TWINT Flag is set by hard-
ware, and the status code in TWSR will be 0x08 (See Table 24-1). In order to enter MR mode,
SLA+R must be transmitted. This is done by writing SLA+R to TWDR. Thereafter the TWINT bit
should be cleared (by writing it to one) to continue the transfer. This is accomplished by writing
the following value to TWCR:
TWCR
TWINT
TWEA
TWSTA
TWSTO
TWWC
TWEN
–
TWIE
value
1
X
0
0
X
1
0
X
When SLA+R have been transmitted and an acknowledgement bit has been received, TWINT is
set again and a number of status codes in TWSR are possible. Possible status codes in Master
mode are 0x38, 0x40, or 0x48. The appropriate action to be taken for each of these status codes
is detailed in Table 24-2. Received data can be read from the TWDR Register when the TWINT
Flag is set high by hardware. This scheme is repeated until the last byte has been received.
After the last byte has been received, the MR should inform the ST by sending a NACK after the
last received data byte. The transfer is ended by generating a STOP condition or a repeated
START condition. A STOP condition is generated by writing the following value to TWCR:
TWCR
TWINT
TWEA
TWSTA
TWSTO
TWWC
TWEN
–
TWIE
value
1
X
0
1
X
1
0
X
A REPEATED START condition is generated by writing the following value to TWCR:
TWCR
TWINT
TWEA
TWSTA
TWSTO
TWWC
TWEN
–
TWIE
value
1
X
1
0
X
1
0
X
After a repeated START condition (state 0x10) the 2-wire Serial Interface can access the same
Slave again, or a new Slave without transmitting a STOP condition. Repeated START enables
256
ATmega640/1280/1281/2560/2561
2549L–AVR–08/07
ATmega640/1280/1281/2560/2561
the Master to switch between Slaves, Master Transmitter mode and Master Receiver mode with-
out losing control over the bus.
Table 24-2. Status codes for Master Receiver Mode
Status Code
(TWSR)
Prescaler Bits
are 0
Application Software Response
To TWCR
Status of the 2-wire Serial Bus
and 2-wire Serial Interface Hard-
ware
To/from TWDR
STA
0
STO
0
TWINT
1
TWEA
X
Next Action Taken by TWI Hardware
0x08
A START condition has been Load SLA+R
transmitted
SLA+R will be transmitted
ACK or NOT ACK will be received
0x10
A
repeated START condition Load SLA+R or
0
0
0
0
1
1
X
X
SLA+R will be transmitted
ACK or NOT ACK will be received
SLA+W will be transmitted
has been transmitted
Load SLA+W
Logic will switch to Master Transmitter mode
0x38
0x40
0x48
Arbitration lost in SLA+R or NOT No TWDR action or
ACK bit
0
1
0
0
1
1
X
X
2-wire Serial Bus will be released and not addressed
Slave mode will be entered
A START condition will be transmitted when the bus
becomes free
No TWDR action
SLA+R has been transmitted;
ACK has been received
No TWDR action or
No TWDR action
0
0
0
0
1
1
0
1
Data byte will be received and NOT ACK will be
returned
Data byte will be received and ACK will be returned
SLA+R has been transmitted;
NOT ACK has been received
No TWDR action or
No TWDR action or
1
0
0
1
1
1
X
X
Repeated START will be transmitted
STOP condition will be transmitted and TWSTO Flag will
be reset
No TWDR action
1
1
1
X
STOP condition followed by a START condition will be
transmitted and TWSTO Flag will be reset
0x50
0x58
Data byte has been received;
ACK has been returned
Read data byte or
Read data byte
0
0
0
0
1
1
0
1
Data byte will be received and NOT ACK will be
returned
Data byte will be received and ACK will be returned
Data byte has been received;
NOT ACK has been returned
Read data byte or
Read data byte or
1
0
0
1
1
1
X
X
Repeated START will be transmitted
STOP condition will be transmitted and TWSTO Flag will
be reset
Read data byte
1
1
1
X
STOP condition followed by a START condition will be
transmitted and TWSTO Flag will be reset
257
2549L–AVR–08/07
Figure 24-13. Formats and States in the Master Receiver Mode
MR
Successfull
S
SLA
R
A
DATA
A
DATA
A
P
reception
from a slave
receiver
$08
$40
$50
$58
Next transfer
started with a
repeated start
condition
RS
SLA
R
$10
Not acknowledge
received after the
slave address
W
A
P
$48
MT
Arbitration lost in slave
address or data byte
Other master
continues
Other master
continues
A or A
A
$38
A
$38
Arbitration lost and
addressed as slave
Other master
continues
To corresponding
states in slave mode
$68 $78 $B0
Any number of data bytes
and their associated acknowledge bits
From master to slave
From slave to master
DATA
A
This number (contained in TWSR) corresponds
to a defined state of the Two-Wire Serial Bus. The
prescaler bits are zero or masked to zero
n
24.7.3
Slave Receiver Mode
In the Slave Receiver mode, a number of data bytes are received from a Master Transmitter
(see Figure 24-14). All the status codes mentioned in this section assume that the prescaler bits
are zero or are masked to zero.
Figure 24-14. Data transfer in Slave Receiver mode
VCC
Device 1
SLAVE
RECEIVER
Device 2
MASTER
TRANSMITTER
Device 3
Device n
R1
R2
........
SDA
SCL
To initiate the Slave Receiver mode, TWAR and TWCR must be initialized as follows:
TWAR
TWA6
TWA5
TWA4
TWA3
TWA2
TWA1
TWA0
TWGCE
value
Device’s Own Slave Address
258
ATmega640/1280/1281/2560/2561
2549L–AVR–08/07
ATmega640/1280/1281/2560/2561
The upper 7 bits are the address to which the 2-wire Serial Interface will respond when
addressed by a Master. If the LSB is set, the TWI will respond to the general call address (0x00),
otherwise it will ignore the general call address.
TWCR
TWINT
TWEA
TWSTA
TWSTO
TWWC
TWEN
–
TWIE
value
0
1
0
0
0
1
0
X
TWEN must be written to one to enable the TWI. The TWEA bit must be written to one to enable
the acknowledgement of the device’s own slave address or the general call address. TWSTA
and TWSTO must be written to zero.
When TWAR and TWCR have been initialized, the TWI waits until it is addressed by its own
slave address (or the general call address if enabled) followed by the data direction bit. If the
direction bit is “0” (write), the TWI will operate in SR mode, otherwise ST mode is entered. After
its own slave address and the write bit have been received, the TWINT Flag is set and a valid
status code can be read from TWSR. The status code is used to determine the appropriate soft-
ware action. The appropriate action to be taken for each status code is detailed in Table 24-3.
The Slave Receiver mode may also be entered if arbitration is lost while the TWI is in the Master
mode (see states 0x68 and 0x78).
If the TWEA bit is reset during a transfer, the TWI will return a “Not Acknowledge” (“1”) to SDA
after the next received data byte. This can be used to indicate that the Slave is not able to
receive any more bytes. While TWEA is zero, the TWI does not acknowledge its own slave
address. However, the 2-wire Serial Bus is still monitored and address recognition may resume
at any time by setting TWEA. This implies that the TWEA bit may be used to temporarily isolate
the TWI from the 2-wire Serial Bus.
In all sleep modes other than Idle mode, the clock system to the TWI is turned off. If the TWEA
bit is set, the interface can still acknowledge its own slave address or the general call address by
using the 2-wire Serial Bus clock as a clock source. The part will then wake up from sleep and
the TWI will hold the SCL clock low during the wake up and until the TWINT Flag is cleared (by
writing it to one). Further data reception will be carried out as normal, with the AVR clocks run-
ning as normal. Observe that if the AVR is set up with a long start-up time, the SCL line may be
held low for a long time, blocking other data transmissions.
Note that the 2-wire Serial Interface Data Register – TWDR does not reflect the last byte present
on the bus when waking up from these Sleep modes.
259
2549L–AVR–08/07
Table 24-3. Status Codes for Slave Receiver Mode
Status Code
(TWSR)
Prescaler Bits
are 0
Application Software Response
To TWCR
STO TWINT
Status of the 2-wire Serial Bus and
2-wire Serial Interface Hardware
To/from TWDR
STA
X
TWEA
0
Next Action Taken by TWI Hardware
0x60
0x68
0x70
0x78
Own SLA+W has been received;
ACK has been returned
No TWDR action or
0
1
Data byte will be received and NOT ACK will be
returned
No TWDR action
X
X
0
0
1
1
1
0
Data byte will be received and ACK will be returned
Arbitration lost in SLA+R/W as No TWDR action or
Master; own SLA+W has been
Data byte will be received and NOT ACK will be
returned
received; ACK has been returned
No TWDR action
X
X
0
0
1
1
1
0
Data byte will be received and ACK will be returned
General call address has been
received; ACK has been returned
No TWDR action or
Data byte will be received and NOT ACK will be
returned
No TWDR action
X
X
0
0
1
1
1
0
Data byte will be received and ACK will be returned
Arbitration lost in SLA+R/W as No TWDR action or
Master; General call address has
Data byte will be received and NOT ACK will be
returned
been received; ACK has been
returned
No TWDR action
X
X
0
0
1
1
1
0
Data byte will be received and ACK will be returned
0x80
0x88
Previously addressed with own Read data byte or
SLA+W; data has been received;
Data byte will be received and NOT ACK will be
returned
ACK has been returned
Read data byte
X
0
0
0
1
1
1
0
Data byte will be received and ACK will be returned
Previously addressed with own Read data byte or
SLA+W; data has been received;
NOT ACK has been returned
Switched to the not addressed Slave mode;
no recognition of own SLA or GCA
Switched to the not addressed Slave mode;
own SLA will be recognized;
GCA will be recognized if TWGCE = “1”
Switched to the not addressed Slave mode;
no recognition of own SLA or GCA;
a START condition will be transmitted when the bus
becomes free
Read data byte or
0
1
0
0
1
1
1
0
Read data byte or
Read data byte
1
0
0
1
1
1
0
Switched to the not addressed Slave mode;
own SLA will be recognized;
GCA will be recognized if TWGCE = “1”;
a START condition will be transmitted when the bus
becomes free
0x90
0x98
Previously addressed with
general call; data has been re-
ceived; ACK has been returned
Read data byte or
X
Data byte will be received and NOT ACK will be
returned
Read data byte
X
0
0
0
1
1
1
0
Data byte will be received and ACK will be returned
Previously addressed with
general call; data has been
received; NOT ACK has been
returned
Read data byte or
Switched to the not addressed Slave mode;
no recognition of own SLA or GCA
Switched to the not addressed Slave mode;
own SLA will be recognized;
GCA will be recognized if TWGCE = “1”
Switched to the not addressed Slave mode;
no recognition of own SLA or GCA;
a START condition will be transmitted when the bus
becomes free
Read data byte or
Read data byte or
0
1
0
0
1
1
1
0
Read data byte
1
0
1
1
Switched to the not addressed Slave mode;
own SLA will be recognized;
GCA will be recognized if TWGCE = “1”;
a START condition will be transmitted when the bus
becomes free
0xA0
A
STOP condition or repeated No action
0
0
0
0
1
1
0
1
Switched to the not addressed Slave mode;
no recognition of own SLA or GCA
Switched to the not addressed Slave mode;
own SLA will be recognized;
START condition has been
received while still addressed as
Slave
GCA will be recognized if TWGCE = “1”
Switched to the not addressed Slave mode;
no recognition of own SLA or GCA;
a START condition will be transmitted when the bus
becomes free
1
1
0
0
1
1
0
1
Switched to the not addressed Slave mode;
own SLA will be recognized;
GCA will be recognized if TWGCE = “1”;
a START condition will be transmitted when the bus
becomes free
260
ATmega640/1280/1281/2560/2561
2549L–AVR–08/07
ATmega640/1280/1281/2560/2561
Figure 24-15. Formats and States in the Slave Receiver Mode
Reception of the own
slave address and one or
more data bytes. All are
acknowledged
S
SLA
W
A
DATA
A
DATA
A
P or S
$60
$80
$80
A
$A0
Last data byte received
is not acknowledged
P or S
$88
Arbitration lost as master
and addressed as slave
A
$68
A
Reception of the general call
address and one or more data
bytes
General Call
DATA
A
DATA
A
P or S
$70
$90
$90
A
$A0
Last data byte received is
not acknowledged
P or S
$98
Arbitration lost as master and
addressed as slave by general call
A
$78
Any number of data bytes
and their associated acknowledge bits
From master to slave
From slave to master
DATA
A
This number (contained in TWSR) corresponds
to a defined state of the Two-Wire Serial Bus. The
prescaler bits are zero or masked to zero
n
24.7.4
Slave Transmitter Mode
In the Slave Transmitter mode, a number of data bytes are transmitted to a Master Receiver
(see Figure 24-16). All the status codes mentioned in this section assume that the prescaler bits
are zero or are masked to zero.
Figure 24-16. Data Transfer in Slave Transmitter Mode
VCC
Device 1
SLAVE
TRANSMITTER
Device 2
MASTER
RECEIVER
Device 3
Device n
R1
R2
........
SDA
SCL
261
2549L–AVR–08/07
To initiate the Slave Transmitter mode, TWAR and TWCR must be initialized as follows:
TWAR
TWA6
TWA5
TWA4
TWA3
TWA2
TWA1
TWA0
TWGCE
value
Device’s Own Slave Address
The upper seven bits are the address to which the 2-wire Serial Interface will respond when
addressed by a Master. If the LSB is set, the TWI will respond to the general call address (0x00),
otherwise it will ignore the general call address.
TWCR
TWINT
TWEA
TWSTA
TWSTO
TWWC
TWEN
–
TWIE
value
0
1
0
0
0
1
0
X
TWEN must be written to one to enable the TWI. The TWEA bit must be written to one to enable
the acknowledgement of the device’s own slave address or the general call address. TWSTA
and TWSTO must be written to zero.
When TWAR and TWCR have been initialized, the TWI waits until it is addressed by its own
slave address (or the general call address if enabled) followed by the data direction bit. If the
direction bit is “1” (read), the TWI will operate in ST mode, otherwise SR mode is entered. After
its own slave address and the write bit have been received, the TWINT Flag is set and a valid
status code can be read from TWSR. The status code is used to determine the appropriate soft-
ware action. The appropriate action to be taken for each status code is detailed in Table 24-4.
The Slave Transmitter mode may also be entered if arbitration is lost while the TWI is in the
Master mode (see state 0xB0).
If the TWEA bit is written to zero during a transfer, the TWI will transmit the last byte of the trans-
fer. State 0xC0 or state 0xC8 will be entered, depending on whether the Master Receiver
transmits a NACK or ACK after the final byte. The TWI is switched to the not addressed Slave
mode, and will ignore the Master if it continues the transfer. Thus the Master Receiver receives
all “1” as serial data. State 0xC8 is entered if the Master demands additional data bytes (by
transmitting ACK), even though the Slave has transmitted the last byte (TWEA zero and expect-
ing NACK from the Master).
While TWEA is zero, the TWI does not respond to its own slave address. However, the 2-wire
Serial Bus is still monitored and address recognition may resume at any time by setting TWEA.
This implies that the TWEA bit may be used to temporarily isolate the TWI from the 2-wire Serial
Bus.
In all sleep modes other than Idle mode, the clock system to the TWI is turned off. If the TWEA
bit is set, the interface can still acknowledge its own slave address or the general call address by
using the 2-wire Serial Bus clock as a clock source. The part will then wake up from sleep and
the TWI will hold the SCL clock will low during the wake up and until the TWINT Flag is cleared
(by writing it to one). Further data transmission will be carried out as normal, with the AVR clocks
running as normal. Observe that if the AVR is set up with a long start-up time, the SCL line may
be held low for a long time, blocking other data transmissions.
Note that the 2-wire Serial Interface Data Register – TWDR does not reflect the last byte present
on the bus when waking up from these sleep modes.
262
ATmega640/1280/1281/2560/2561
2549L–AVR–08/07
ATmega640/1280/1281/2560/2561
Table 24-4. Status Codes for Slave Transmitter Mode
Status Code
(TWSR)
Prescaler Bits
are 0
Application Software Response
Status of the 2-wire Serial Bus and
2-wire Serial Interface Hardware
To TWCR
To/from TWDR
Load data byte or
Load data byte
STA
X
STO
0
TWINT
1
TWEA
0
Next Action Taken by TWI Hardware
0xA8
0xB0
0xB8
0xC0
Own SLA+R has been received;
ACK has been returned
Last data byte will be transmitted and NOT ACK should
be received
X
0
1
1
Data byte will be transmitted and ACK should be re-
ceived
Arbitration lost in SLA+R/W as Load data byte or
Master; own SLA+R has been
X
X
0
0
1
1
0
1
Last data byte will be transmitted and NOT ACK should
be received
Data byte will be transmitted and ACK should be re-
ceived
received; ACK has been returned
Load data byte
Data byte in TWDR has been
transmitted; ACK has been
received
Load data byte or
Load data byte
X
X
0
0
1
1
0
1
Last data byte will be transmitted and NOT ACK should
be received
Data byte will be transmitted and ACK should be re-
ceived
Data byte in TWDR has been
transmitted; NOT ACK has been
received
No TWDR action or
No TWDR action or
0
0
0
0
1
1
0
1
Switched to the not addressed Slave mode;
no recognition of own SLA or GCA
Switched to the not addressed Slave mode;
own SLA will be recognized;
GCA will be recognized if TWGCE = “1”
Switched to the not addressed Slave mode;
no recognition of own SLA or GCA;
a START condition will be transmitted when the bus
becomes free
No TWDR action or
No TWDR action
1
1
0
0
1
1
0
1
Switched to the not addressed Slave mode;
own SLA will be recognized;
GCA will be recognized if TWGCE = “1”;
a START condition will be transmitted when the bus
becomes free
0xC8
Last data byte in TWDR has been No TWDR action or
0
0
0
0
1
1
0
1
Switched to the not addressed Slave mode;
no recognition of own SLA or GCA
Switched to the not addressed Slave mode;
own SLA will be recognized;
GCA will be recognized if TWGCE = “1”
Switched to the not addressed Slave mode;
no recognition of own SLA or GCA;
a START condition will be transmitted when the bus
becomes free
transmitted (TWEA
has been received
= “0”); ACK
No TWDR action or
No TWDR action or
1
1
0
0
1
1
0
1
No TWDR action
Switched to the not addressed Slave mode;
own SLA will be recognized;
GCA will be recognized if TWGCE = “1”;
a START condition will be transmitted when the bus
becomes free
263
2549L–AVR–08/07
Figure 24-17. Formats and States in the Slave Transmitter Mode
Reception of the own
slave address and one or
more data bytes
S
SLA
R
A
DATA
A
DATA
A
P or S
$A8
A
$B8
$C0
Arbitration lost as master
and addressed as slave
$B0
Last data byte transmitted.
Switched to not addressed
slave (TWEA = '0')
A
All 1's
P or S
$C8
Any number of data bytes
and their associated acknowledge bits
From master to slave
From slave to master
DATA
A
This number (contained in TWSR) corresponds
to a defined state of the Two-Wire Serial Bus. The
prescaler bits are zero or masked to zero
n
24.7.5
Miscellaneous States
There are two status codes that do not correspond to a defined TWI state, see Table 24-5.
Status 0xF8 indicates that no relevant information is available because the TWINT Flag is not
set. This occurs between other states, and when the TWI is not involved in a serial transfer.
Status 0x00 indicates that a bus error has occurred during a 2-wire Serial Bus transfer. A bus
error occurs when a START or STOP condition occurs at an illegal position in the format frame.
Examples of such illegal positions are during the serial transfer of an address byte, a data byte,
or an acknowledge bit. When a bus error occurs, TWINT is set. To recover from a bus error, the
TWSTO Flag must set and TWINT must be cleared by writing a logic one to it. This causes the
TWI to enter the not addressed Slave mode and to clear the TWSTO Flag (no other bits in
TWCR are affected). The SDA and SCL lines are released, and no STOP condition is
transmitted.
Table 24-5. Miscellaneous States
Status Code
(TWSR)
Prescaler Bits
are 0
Application Software Response
To TWCR
Status of the 2-wire Serial Bus
and 2-wire Serial Interface Hard-
ware
To/from TWDR
STA
STO
TWINT
TWEA
X
Next Action Taken by TWI Hardware
Wait or proceed current transfer
0xF8
No relevant state information No TWDR action
available; TWINT = “0”
No TWCR action
0x00
Bus error due to an illegal No TWDR action
START or STOP condition
0
1
1
Only the internal hardware is affected, no STOP condi-
tion is sent on the bus. In all cases, the bus is released
and TWSTO is cleared.
24.7.6
Combining Several TWI Modes
In some cases, several TWI modes must be combined in order to complete the desired action.
Consider for example reading data from a serial EEPROM. Typically, such a transfer involves
the following steps:
1. The transfer must be initiated.
2. The EEPROM must be instructed what location should be read.
3. The reading must be performed.
4. The transfer must be finished.
264
ATmega640/1280/1281/2560/2561
2549L–AVR–08/07
ATmega640/1280/1281/2560/2561
Note that data is transmitted both from Master to Slave and vice versa. The Master must instruct
the Slave what location it wants to read, requiring the use of the MT mode. Subsequently, data
must be read from the Slave, implying the use of the MR mode. Thus, the transfer direction must
be changed. The Master must keep control of the bus during all these steps, and the steps
should be carried out as an atomical operation. If this principle is violated in a multimaster sys-
tem, another Master can alter the data pointer in the EEPROM between steps 2 and 3, and the
Master will read the wrong data location. Such a change in transfer direction is accomplished by
transmitting a REPEATED START between the transmission of the address byte and reception
of the data. After a REPEATED START, the Master keeps ownership of the bus. The following
figure shows the flow in this transfer.
Figure 24-18. Combining Several TWI Modes to Access a Serial EEPROM
Master Transmitter
Master Receiver
S
SLA+W
A
ADDRESS
A
Rs
SLA+R
A
DATA
A
P
S = START
Transmitted from master to slave
Rs = REPEATED START
Transmitted from slave to master
P = STOP
24.8 Multi-master Systems and Arbitration
If multiple masters are connected to the same bus, transmissions may be initiated simulta-
neously by one or more of them. The TWI standard ensures that such situations are handled in
such a way that one of the masters will be allowed to proceed with the transfer, and that no data
will be lost in the process. An example of an arbitration situation is depicted below, where two
masters are trying to transmit data to a Slave Receiver.
Figure 24-19. An Arbitration Example
VCC
Device 1
MASTER
TRANSMITTER
Device 3
SLAVE
RECEIVER
Device 2
MASTER
TRANSMITTER
Device n
R1
R2
........
SDA
SCL
Several different scenarios may arise during arbitration, as described below:
•
Two or more masters are performing identical communication with the same Slave. In this
case, neither the Slave nor any of the masters will know about the bus contention.
•
Two or more masters are accessing the same Slave with different data or direction bit. In this
case, arbitration will occur, either in the READ/WRITE bit or in the data bits. The masters
trying to output a one on SDA while another Master outputs a zero will lose the arbitration.
Losing masters will switch to not addressed Slave mode or wait until the bus is free and
transmit a new START condition, depending on application software action.
265
2549L–AVR–08/07
•
Two or more masters are accessing different slaves. In this case, arbitration will occur in the
SLA bits. Masters trying to output a one on SDA while another Master outputs a zero will
lose the arbitration. Masters losing arbitration in SLA will switch to Slave mode to check if
they are being addressed by the winning Master. If addressed, they will switch to SR or ST
mode, depending on the value of the READ/WRITE bit. If they are not being addressed, they
will switch to not addressed Slave mode or wait until the bus is free and transmit a new
START condition, depending on application software action.
This is summarized in Figure 24-20. Possible status values are given in circles.
Figure 24-20. Possible Status Codes Caused by Arbitration
START
SLA
Data
STOP
Arbitration lost in SLA
Arbitration lost in Data
Own
No
38
TWI bus will be released and not addressed slave mode will be entered
A START condition will be transmitted when the bus becomes free
Address / General Call
received
Yes
Write
68/78
B0
Data byte will be received and NOT ACK will be returned
Data byte will be received and ACK will be returned
Direction
Read
Last data byte will be transmitted and NOT ACK should be received
Data byte will be transmitted and ACK should be received
24.9 Register Description
24.9.1
TWBR – TWI Bit Rate Register
Bit
7
6
5
4
3
TWBR3
R/W
0
2
TWBR2
R/W
0
1
TWBR1
R/W
0
0
TWBR0
R/W
0
(0xB8)
TWBR7
R/W
0
TWBR6
TWBR5
R/W
0
TWBR4
R/W
0
TWBR
Read/Write
Initial Value
R/W
0
• Bits 7:0 – TWI Bit Rate Register
TWBR selects the division factor for the bit rate generator. The bit rate generator is a frequency
divider which generates the SCL clock frequency in the Master modes. See “Bit Rate Generator
Unit” on page 247 for calculating bit rates.
24.9.2
TWCR – TWI Control Register
Bit
7
TWINT
R/W
0
6
TWEA
R/W
0
5
TWSTA
R/W
0
4
TWSTO
R/W
0
3
2
TWEN
R/W
0
1
–
0
TWIE
R/W
0
(0xBC)
TWWC
TWCR
Read/Write
Initial Value
R
0
R
0
The TWCR is used to control the operation of the TWI. It is used to enable the TWI, to initiate a
Master access by applying a START condition to the bus, to generate a Receiver acknowledge,
to generate a stop condition, and to control halting of the bus while the data to be written to the
bus are written to the TWDR. It also indicates a write collision if data is attempted written to
TWDR while the register is inaccessible.
266
ATmega640/1280/1281/2560/2561
2549L–AVR–08/07
ATmega640/1280/1281/2560/2561
• Bit 7 – TWINT: TWI Interrupt Flag
This bit is set by hardware when the TWI has finished its current job and expects application
software response. If the I-bit in SREG and TWIE in TWCR are set, the MCU will jump to the
TWI Interrupt Vector. While the TWINT Flag is set, the SCL low period is stretched. The TWINT
Flag must be cleared by software by writing a logic one to it. Note that this flag is not automati-
cally cleared by hardware when executing the interrupt routine. Also note that clearing this flag
starts the operation of the TWI, so all accesses to the TWI Address Register (TWAR), TWI Sta-
tus Register (TWSR), and TWI Data Register (TWDR) must be complete before clearing this
flag.
• Bit 6 – TWEA: TWI Enable Acknowledge Bit
The TWEA bit controls the generation of the acknowledge pulse. If the TWEA bit is written to
one, the ACK pulse is generated on the TWI bus if the following conditions are met:
1. The device’s own slave address has been received.
2. A general call has been received, while the TWGCE bit in the TWAR is set.
3. A data byte has been received in Master Receiver or Slave Receiver mode.
By writing the TWEA bit to zero, the device can be virtually disconnected from the 2-wire Serial
Bus temporarily. Address recognition can then be resumed by writing the TWEA bit to one
again.
• Bit 5 – TWSTA: TWI START Condition Bit
The application writes the TWSTA bit to one when it desires to become a Master on the 2-wire
Serial Bus. The TWI hardware checks if the bus is available, and generates a START condition
on the bus if it is free. However, if the bus is not free, the TWI waits until a STOP condition is
detected, and then generates a new START condition to claim the bus Master status. TWSTA
must be cleared by software when the START condition has been transmitted.
• Bit 4 – TWSTO: TWI STOP Condition Bit
Writing the TWSTO bit to one in Master mode will generate a STOP condition on the 2-wire
Serial Bus. When the STOP condition is executed on the bus, the TWSTO bit is cleared auto-
matically. In Slave mode, setting the TWSTO bit can be used to recover from an error condition.
This will not generate a STOP condition, but the TWI returns to a well-defined unaddressed
Slave mode and releases the SCL and SDA lines to a high impedance state.
• Bit 3 – TWWC: TWI Write Collision Flag
The TWWC bit is set when attempting to write to the TWI Data Register – TWDR when TWINT is
low. This flag is cleared by writing the TWDR Register when TWINT is high.
• Bit 2 – TWEN: TWI Enable Bit
The TWEN bit enables TWI operation and activates the TWI interface. When TWEN is written to
one, the TWI takes control over the I/O pins connected to the SCL and SDA pins, enabling the
slew-rate limiters and spike filters. If this bit is written to zero, the TWI is switched off and all TWI
transmissions are terminated, regardless of any ongoing operation.
• Bit 1 – Res: Reserved Bit
This bit is a reserved bit and will always read as zero.
267
2549L–AVR–08/07
• Bit 0 – TWIE: TWI Interrupt Enable
When this bit is written to one, and the I-bit in SREG is set, the TWI interrupt request will be acti-
vated for as long as the TWINT Flag is high.
24.9.3
TWSR – TWI Status Register
Bit
7
TWS7
R
6
TWS6
R
5
TWS5
R
4
TWS4
R
3
TWS3
R
2
–
1
TWPS1
R/W
0
0
TWPS0
R/W
0
(0xB9)
TWSR
Read/Write
Initial Value
R
0
1
1
1
1
1
• Bits 7:3 – TWS: TWI Status
These 5 bits reflect the status of the TWI logic and the 2-wire Serial Bus. The different status
codes are described later in this section. Note that the value read from TWSR contains both the
5-bit status value and the 2-bit prescaler value. The application designer should mask the pres-
caler bits to zero when checking the Status bits. This makes status checking independent of
prescaler setting. This approach is used in this datasheet, unless otherwise noted.
• Bit 2 – Res: Reserved Bit
This bit is reserved and will always read as zero.
• Bits 1:0 – TWPS: TWI Prescaler Bits
These bits can be read and written, and control the bit rate prescaler.
Table 24-6. TWI Bit Rate Prescaler
TWPS1
TWPS0
Prescaler Value
0
0
1
1
0
1
0
1
1
4
16
64
To calculate bit rates, see “Bit Rate Generator Unit” on page 247. The value of TWPS1:0 is used
in the equation.
24.9.4
TWDR – TWI Data Register
Bit
7
TWD7
R/W
1
6
TWD6
R/W
1
5
TWD5
R/W
1
4
TWD4
R/W
1
3
TWD3
R/W
1
2
TWD2
R/W
1
1
TWD1
R/W
1
0
TWD0
R/W
1
(0xBB)
TWDR
Read/Write
Initial Value
In Transmit mode, TWDR contains the next byte to be transmitted. In Receive mode, the TWDR
contains the last byte received. It is writable while the TWI is not in the process of shifting a byte.
This occurs when the TWI Interrupt Flag (TWINT) is set by hardware. Note that the Data Regis-
ter cannot be initialized by the user before the first interrupt occurs. The data in TWDR remains
stable as long as TWINT is set. While data is shifted out, data on the bus is simultaneously
shifted in. TWDR always contains the last byte present on the bus, except after a wake up from
a sleep mode by the TWI interrupt. In this case, the contents of TWDR is undefined. In the case
of a lost bus arbitration, no data is lost in the transition from Master to Slave. Handling of the
ACK bit is controlled automatically by the TWI logic, the CPU cannot access the ACK bit directly.
268
ATmega640/1280/1281/2560/2561
2549L–AVR–08/07
ATmega640/1280/1281/2560/2561
• Bits 7:0 – TWD: TWI Data Register
These eight bits constitute the next data byte to be transmitted, or the latest data byte received
on the 2-wire Serial Bus.
24.9.5
TWAR – TWI (Slave) Address Register
Bit
7
6
TWA5
R/W
1
5
TWA4
R/W
1
4
TWA3
R/W
1
3
TWA2
R/W
1
2
TWA1
R/W
1
1
TWA0
R/W
1
0
TWGCE
R/W
0
TWA6
R/W
1
TWAR
(0xBA)
Read/Write
Initial Value
The TWAR should be loaded with the 7-bit Slave address (in the seven most significant bits of
TWAR) to which the TWI will respond when programmed as a Slave Transmitter or Receiver,
and not needed in the Master modes. In multimaster systems, TWAR must be set in masters
which can be addressed as Slaves by other Masters.
The LSB of TWAR is used to enable recognition of the general call address (0x00). There is an
associated address comparator that looks for the slave address (or general call address if
enabled) in the received serial address. If a match is found, an interrupt request is generated.
• Bits 7:1 – TWA: TWI (Slave) Address Register
These seven bits constitute the slave address of the TWI unit.
• Bit 0 – TWGCE: TWI General Call Recognition Enable Bit
If set, this bit enables the recognition of a General Call given over the 2-wire Serial Bus.
24.9.6
TWAMR – TWI (Slave) Address Mask Register
Bit
7
6
5
4
TWAM[6:0]
R/W
3
2
1
0
–
TWAMR
(0xBD)
Read/Write
Initial Value
R/W
0
R/W
0
R/W
0
R/W
0
R/W
0
R/W
0
R
0
0
• Bits 7:1 – TWAM: TWI Address Mask
The TWAMR can be loaded with a 7-bit Slave Address mask. Each of the bits in TWAMR can
mask (disable) the corresponding address bit in the TWI Address Register (TWAR). If the mask
bit is set to one then the address match logic ignores the compare between the incoming
address bit and the corresponding bit in TWAR. Figure 24-21 shows the address match logic in
detail.
Figure 24-21. TWI Address Match Logic, Block Diagram
TWAR0
Address
Match
Address
Bit 0
TWAMR0
Address Bit Comparator 0
Address Bit Comparator 6..1
269
2549L–AVR–08/07
• Bit 0 – Res: Reserved Bit
This bit is reserved and will always read as zero.
270
ATmega640/1280/1281/2560/2561
2549L–AVR–08/07
ATmega640/1280/1281/2560/2561
25. AC – Analog Comparator
The Analog Comparator compares the input values on the positive pin AIN0 and negative pin
AIN1. When the voltage on the positive pin AIN0 is higher than the voltage on the negative pin
AIN1, the Analog Comparator output, ACO, is set. The comparator’s output can be set to trigger
the Timer/Counter1 Input Capture function. In addition, the comparator can trigger a separate
interrupt, exclusive to the Analog Comparator. The user can select Interrupt triggering on com-
parator output rise, fall or toggle. A block diagram of the comparator and its surrounding logic is
shown in Figure 25-1.
The Power Reduction ADC bit, PRADC, in “PRR0 – Power Reduction Register 0” on page 56
must be disabled by writing a logical zero to be able to use the ADC input MUX.
Figure 25-1. Analog Comparator Block Diagram(2)
BANDGAP
REFERENCE
ACBG
ACME
ADEN
ADC MULTIPLEXER
OUTPUT(1)
Note:
1. See Table 25-1 on page 271.
2. Refer to Figure 1-1 on page 2 and Table 13-5 on page 79 for Analog Comparator pin
placement.
25.1 Analog Comparator Multiplexed Input
It is possible to select any of the ADC15:0 pins to replace the negative input to the Analog Com-
parator. The ADC multiplexer is used to select this input, and consequently, the ADC must be
switched off to utilize this feature. If the Analog Comparator Multiplexer Enable bit (ACME in
ADCSRB) is set and the ADC is switched off (ADEN in ADCSRA is zero), MUX5 and MUX2:0 in
ADMUX select the input pin to replace the negative input to the Analog Comparator, as shown in
Table 25-1. If ACME is cleared or ADEN is set, AIN1 is applied to the negative input to the Ana-
log Comparator.
Table 25-1. Analog Comparator Mulitiplexed Input
ACME
ADEN
MUX5
MUX2:0
xxx
Analog Comparator Negative Input
0
1
1
1
1
1
x
1
0
0
0
0
x
x
0
0
0
0
AIN1
AIN1
xxx
000
ADC0
ADC1
ADC2
ADC3
001
010
011
271
2549L–AVR–08/07
Table 25-1. Analog Comparator Mulitiplexed Input
ACME
ADEN
MUX5
MUX2:0
100
101
110
111
000
001
010
011
100
101
110
111
Analog Comparator Negative Input
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
ADC4
ADC5
ADC6
ADC7
ADC8
ADC9
ADC10
ADC11
ADC12
ADC13
ADC14
ADC15
25.2 Register Description
25.2.1
ADCSRB – ADC Control and Status Register B
Bit
7
–
6
ACME
R/W
0
5
–
4
–
3
2
ADTS2
R/W
0
1
ADTS1
R/W
0
0
ADTS0
R/W
0
(0x7B)
MUX5
R/W
0
ADCSRB
Read/Write
Initial Value
R
0
R
0
R
0
• Bit 6 – ACME: Analog Comparator Multiplexer Enable
When this bit is written logic one and the ADC is switched off (ADEN in ADCSRA is zero), the
ADC multiplexer selects the negative input to the Analog Comparator. When this bit is written
logic zero, AIN1 is applied to the negative input of the Analog Comparator. For a detailed
description of this bit, see “Analog Comparator Multiplexed Input” on page 271.
25.2.2
ACSR – Analog Comparator Control and Status Register
Bit
0x30 (0x50)
7
6
5
4
3
ACIE
R/W
0
2
ACIC
R/W
0
1
ACIS1
R/W
0
0
ACIS0
R/W
0
ACD
ACBG
ACO
ACI
ACSR
Read/Write
R/W
R/W
R
R/W
Initial Value
0
0
N/A
0
• Bit 7 – ACD: Analog Comparator Disable
When this bit is written logic one, the power to the Analog Comparator is switched off. This bit
can be set at any time to turn off the Analog Comparator. This will reduce power consumption in
Active and Idle mode. When changing the ACD bit, the Analog Comparator Interrupt must be
disabled by clearing the ACIE bit in ACSR. Otherwise an interrupt can occur when the bit is
changed.
• Bit 6 – ACBG: Analog Comparator Bandgap Select
272
ATmega640/1280/1281/2560/2561
2549L–AVR–08/07
ATmega640/1280/1281/2560/2561
When this bit is set, a fixed bandgap reference voltage replaces the positive input to the Analog
Comparator. When this bit is cleared, AIN0 is applied to the positive input of the Analog Compar-
ator. When the bandgap reference is used as input to the Analog Comparator, it will take a
certain time for the voltage to stabilize. If not stabilized, the first conversion may give a wrong
value. See “Internal Voltage Reference” on page 62.
• Bit 5 – ACO: Analog Comparator Output
The output of the Analog Comparator is synchronized and then directly connected to ACO. The
synchronization introduces a delay of 1 - 2 clock cycles.
• Bit 4 – ACI: Analog Comparator Interrupt Flag
This bit is set by hardware when a comparator output event triggers the interrupt mode defined
by ACIS1 and ACIS0. The Analog Comparator interrupt routine is executed if the ACIE bit is set
and the I-bit in SREG is set. ACI is cleared by hardware when executing the corresponding inter-
rupt handling vector. Alternatively, ACI is cleared by writing a logic one to the flag.
• Bit 3 – ACIE: Analog Comparator Interrupt Enable
When the ACIE bit is written logic one and the I-bit in the Status Register is set, the Analog Com-
parator interrupt is activated. When written logic zero, the interrupt is disabled.
• Bit 2 – ACIC: Analog Comparator Input Capture Enable
When written logic one, this bit enables the input capture function in Timer/Counter1 to be trig-
gered by the Analog Comparator. The comparator output is in this case directly connected to the
input capture front-end logic, making the comparator utilize the noise canceler and edge select
features of the Timer/Counter1 Input Capture interrupt. When written logic zero, no connection
between the Analog Comparator and the input capture function exists. To make the comparator
trigger the Timer/Counter1 Input Capture interrupt, the ICIE1 bit in the Timer Interrupt Mask
Register (TIMSK1) must be set.
• Bits 1, 0 – ACIS1, ACIS0: Analog Comparator Interrupt Mode Select
These bits determine which comparator events that trigger the Analog Comparator interrupt. The
different settings are shown in Table 25-2.
Table 25-2. ACIS1/ACIS0 Settings
Interrupt Mode
ACIS1
ACIS0
0
0
1
1
0
1
0
1
Comparator Interrupt on Output Toggle.
Reserved
Comparator Interrupt on Falling Output Edge.
Comparator Interrupt on Rising Output Edge.
When changing the ACIS1/ACIS0 bits, the Analog Comparator Interrupt must be disabled by
clearing its Interrupt Enable bit in the ACSR Register. Otherwise an interrupt can occur when the
bits are changed.
25.2.3
DIDR1 – Digital Input Disable Register 1
Bit
(0x7F)
7
6
5
–
4
–
3
–
2
–
1
AIN1D
R/W
0
0
AIN0D
R/W
0
–
–
DIDR1
Read/Write
R
0
R
0
R
0
R
0
R
0
R
0
Initial Value
273
2549L–AVR–08/07
• Bit 1, 0 – AIN1D, AIN0D: AIN1, AIN0 Digital Input Disable
When this bit is written logic one, the digital input buffer on the AIN1/0 pin is disabled. The corre-
sponding PIN Register bit will always read as zero when this bit is set. When an analog signal is
applied to the AIN1/0 pin and the digital input from this pin is not needed, this bit should be writ-
ten logic one to reduce power consumption in the digital input buffer.
274
ATmega640/1280/1281/2560/2561
2549L–AVR–08/07
ATmega640/1280/1281/2560/2561
26. ADC – Analog to Digital Converter
26.1 Features
• 10-bit Resolution
• 1 LSB Integral Non-linearity
•
2 LSB Absolute Accuracy
• 13 - 260 µs Conversion Time
• Up to 76.9 kSPS (Up to 15 kSPS at Maximum Resolution)
• 16 Multiplexed Single Ended Input Channels
• 14 Differential input channels
• 4 Differential Input Channels with Optional Gain of 10x and 200x
• Optional Left Adjustment for ADC Result Readout
• 0 - VCC ADC Input Voltage Range
• 2.7 - VCC Differential ADC Voltage Range
• Selectable 2.56V or 1.1V ADC Reference Voltage
• Free Running or Single Conversion Mode
• Interrupt on ADC Conversion Complete
• Sleep Mode Noise Canceler
The ATmega640/1280/1281/2560/2561 features a 10-bit successive approximation ADC. The
ADC is connected to an 8/16-channel Analog Multiplexer which allows eight/sixteen single-
ended voltage inputs constructed from the pins of Port A and Port F. The single-ended voltage
inputs refer to 0V (GND).
The device also supports 16/32 differential voltage input combinations. Four of the differential
inputs (ADC1 & ADC0, ADC3 & ADC2, ADC9 & ADC8 and ADC11 & ADC10) are equipped with
a programmable gain stage, providing amplification steps of 0 dB (1x), 20 dB (10x) or 46 dB
(200x) on the differential input voltage before the ADC conversion. The 16 channels are split in
two sections of 8 channels where in each section seven differential analog input channels share
a common negative terminal (ADC1/ADC9), while any other ADC input in that section can be
selected as the positive input terminal. If 1x or 10x gain is used, 8 bit resolution can be expected.
If 200x gain is used, 7 bit resolution can be expected.
The ADC contains a Sample and Hold circuit which ensures that the input voltage to the ADC is
held at a constant level during conversion. A block diagram of the ADC is shown in Figure 26-1.
The ADC has a separate analog supply voltage pin, AVCC. AVCC must not differ more than
0.3V from VCC. See the paragraph “ADC Noise Canceler” on page 283 on how to connect this
pin.
Internal reference voltages of nominally 1.1V, 2.56V or AVCC are provided On-chip. The volt-
age reference may be externally decoupled at the AREF pin by a capacitor for better noise
performance.
The Power Reduction ADC bit, PRADC, in “PRR0 – Power Reduction Register 0” on page 56
must be disabled by writing a logical zero to enable the ADC.
275
2549L–AVR–08/07
Figure 26-1. Analog to Digital Converter Block Schematic
ADC CONVERSION
COMPLETE IRQ
INTERRUPT
FLAGS
ADTS[2:0]
8-BIT DATABUS
15
ADC DATA REGISTER
(ADCH/ADCL)
0
ADC MULTIPLEXER
SELECT (ADMUX)
ADC CTRL & STATUS
REGISTER B (ADCSRB)
ADC CTRL & STATUS
REGISTER A (ADCSRA)
TRIGGER
SELECT
START
PRESCALER
MUX DECODER
CONVERSION LOGIC
AVCC
INTERNAL
REFERENCE
(1.1V/2.56V)
-
AREF
10-bit DAC
+
SAMPLE & HOLD
COMPARATOR
ADC[2:0]
-
ADC[10:8]
+
GAIN
R
AMPLIFIE
ADC[15:0]
ADC
MULTIPLEXER
OUTPUT
BANDGAP (1.1V)
REFERENCE
GND
26.2 Operation
The ADC converts an analog input voltage to a 10-bit digital value through successive approxi-
mation. The minimum value represents GND and the maximum value represents the voltage on
the AREF pin minus 1 LSB. Optionally, AVCC or an internal 1.1V or 2.56V reference voltage
may be connected to the AREF pin by writing to the REFSn bits in the ADMUX Register. The
internal voltage reference may thus be decoupled by an external capacitor at the AREF pin to
improve noise immunity.
The analog input channel is selected by writing to the MUX bits in ADMUX and ADCSRB. Any of
the ADC input pins, as well as GND and a fixed bandgap voltage reference, can be selected as
276
ATmega640/1280/1281/2560/2561
2549L–AVR–08/07
ATmega640/1280/1281/2560/2561
single ended inputs to the ADC. A selection of ADC input pins can be selected as positive and
negative inputs to the differential amplifier.
If differential channels are selected, the voltage difference between the selected input channel
pair then becomes the analog input to the ADC. If single ended channels are used, the amplifier
is bypassed altogether.
The ADC is enabled by setting the ADC Enable bit, ADEN in ADCSRA. Voltage reference and
input channel selections will not go into effect until ADEN is set. The ADC does not consume
power when ADEN is cleared, so it is recommended to switch off the ADC before entering power
saving sleep modes.
The ADC generates a 10-bit result which is presented in the ADC Data Registers, ADCH and
ADCL. By default, the result is presented right adjusted, but can optionally be presented left
adjusted by setting the ADLAR bit in ADMUX.
If the result is left adjusted and no more than 8-bit precision is required, it is sufficient to read
ADCH. Otherwise, ADCL must be read first, then ADCH, to ensure that the content of the Data
Registers belongs to the same conversion. Once ADCL is read, ADC access to Data Registers
is blocked. This means that if ADCL has been read, and a conversion completes before ADCH is
read, neither register is updated and the result from the conversion is lost. When ADCH is read,
ADC access to the ADCH and ADCL Registers is re-enabled.
The ADC has its own interrupt which can be triggered when a conversion completes. When ADC
access to the Data Registers is prohibited between reading of ADCH and ADCL, the interrupt
will trigger even if the result is lost.
26.3 Starting a Conversion
A single conversion is started by writing a logical one to the ADC Start Conversion bit, ADSC.
This bit stays high as long as the conversion is in progress and will be cleared by hardware
when the conversion is completed. If a different data channel is selected while a conversion is in
progress, the ADC will finish the current conversion before performing the channel change.
Alternatively, a conversion can be triggered automatically by various sources. Auto Triggering is
enabled by setting the ADC Auto Trigger Enable bit, ADATE in ADCSRA. The trigger source is
selected by setting the ADC Trigger Select bits, ADTS in ADCSRB (See description of the ADTS
bits for a list of the trigger sources). When a positive edge occurs on the selected trigger signal,
the ADC prescaler is reset and a conversion is started. This provides a method of starting con-
versions at fixed intervals. If the trigger signal still is set when the conversion completes, a new
conversion will not be started. If another positive edge occurs on the trigger signal during con-
version, the edge will be ignored. Note that an Interrupt Flag will be set even if the specific
interrupt is disabled or the Global Interrupt Enable bit in SREG is cleared. A conversion can thus
be triggered without causing an interrupt. However, the Interrupt Flag must be cleared in order to
trigger a new conversion at the next interrupt event.
277
2549L–AVR–08/07
Figure 26-2. ADC Auto Trigger Logic
ADTS[2:0]
PRESCALER
CLKADC
START
ADIF
ADATE
SOURCE 1
.
.
.
CONVERSION
LOGIC
.
EDGE
DETECTOR
SOURCE n
ADSC
Using the ADC Interrupt Flag as a trigger source makes the ADC start a new conversion as soon
as the ongoing conversion has finished. The ADC then operates in Free Running mode, con-
stantly sampling and updating the ADC Data Register. The first conversion must be started by
writing a logical one to the ADSC bit in ADCSRA. In this mode the ADC will perform successive
conversions independently of whether the ADC Interrupt Flag, ADIF is cleared or not.
If Auto Triggering is enabled, single conversions can be started by writing ADSC in ADCSRA to
one. ADSC can also be used to determine if a conversion is in progress. The ADSC bit will be
read as one during a conversion, independently of how the conversion was started.
26.4 Prescaling and Conversion Timing
Figure 26-3. ADC Prescaler
ADEN
START
Reset
7-BIT ADC PRESCALER
CK
ADPS0
ADPS1
ADPS2
ADC CLOCK SOURCE
By default, the successive approximation circuitry requires an input clock frequency between 50
kHz and 200 kHz. If a lower resolution than 10 bits is needed, the input clock frequency to the
ADC can be as high as 1000 kHz to get a higher sample rate.
The ADC module contains a prescaler, which generates an acceptable ADC clock frequency
from any CPU frequency above 100 kHz. The prescaling is set by the ADPS bits in ADCSRA.
278
ATmega640/1280/1281/2560/2561
2549L–AVR–08/07
ATmega640/1280/1281/2560/2561
The prescaler starts counting from the moment the ADC is switched on by setting the ADEN bit
in ADCSRA. The prescaler keeps running for as long as the ADEN bit is set, and is continuously
reset when ADEN is low.
When initiating a single ended conversion by setting the ADSC bit in ADCSRA, the conversion
starts at the following rising edge of the ADC clock cycle.
A normal conversion takes 13 ADC clock cycles. The first conversion after the ADC is switched
on (ADEN in ADCSRA is set) takes 25 ADC clock cycles in order to initialize the analog circuitry.
When the bandgap reference voltage is used as input to the ADC, it will take a certain time for
the voltage to stabilize. If not stabilized, the first value read after the first conversion may be
wrong.
The actual sample-and-hold takes place 1.5 ADC clock cycles after the start of a normal conver-
sion and 13.5 ADC clock cycles after the start of an first conversion. When a conversion is
complete, the result is written to the ADC Data Registers, and ADIF is set. In Single Conversion
mode, ADSC is cleared simultaneously. The software may then set ADSC again, and a new
conversion will be initiated on the first rising ADC clock edge.
When Auto Triggering is used, the prescaler is reset when the trigger event occurs. This assures
a fixed delay from the trigger event to the start of conversion. In this mode, the sample-and-hold
takes place two ADC clock cycles after the rising edge on the trigger source signal. Three addi-
tional CPU clock cycles are used for synchronization logic.
In Free Running mode, a new conversion will be started immediately after the conversion com-
pletes, while ADSC remains high. For a summary of conversion times, see Table 26-1.
Figure 26-4. ADC Timing Diagram, First Conversion (Single Conversion Mode)
Next
First Conversion
Conversion
Cycle Number
1
2
12
13
14
15
16
17
18
19
20
21
22
23
24
25
1
2
3
ADC Clock
ADEN
ADSC
ADIF
Sign and MSB of Result
LSB of Result
ADCH
ADCL
MUX and REFS
Update
Conversion
Complete
MUX and REFS
Update
Sample & Hold
279
2549L–AVR–08/07
Figure 26-5. ADC Timing Diagram, Single Conversion
One Conversion
Next Conversion
1
2
3
4
5
6
7
8
9
10
11
12
13
1
2
3
Cycle Number
ADC Clock
ADSC
ADIF
ADCH
Sign and MSB of Result
LSB of Result
ADCL
Sample & Hold
Conversion
Complete
MUX and REFS
Update
MUX and REFS
Update
Figure 26-6. ADC Timing Diagram, Auto Triggered Conversion
One Conversion
Next Conversion
1
2
3
4
5
6
7
8
9
10
11
12
13
1
2
Cycle Number
ADC Clock
Trigger
Source
ADATE
ADIF
ADCH
ADCL
Sign and MSB of Result
LSB of Result
Sample &
Hold
Prescaler
Reset
Conversion
Complete
Prescaler
Reset
MUX and REFS
Update
Figure 26-7. ADC Timing Diagram, Free Running Conversion
One Conversion
Next Conversion
11
12
13
1
2
3
4
Cycle Number
ADC Clock
ADSC
ADIF
ADCH
ADCL
Sign and MSB of Result
LSB of Result
Sample & Hold
MUX and REFS
Update
Conversion
Complete
280
ATmega640/1280/1281/2560/2561
2549L–AVR–08/07
ATmega640/1280/1281/2560/2561
Table 26-1. ADC Conversion Time
Sample & Hold (Cycles from
Start of Conversion)
Condition
Conversion Time (Cycles)
First conversion
13.5
1.5
25
13
Normal conversions, single ended
Auto Triggered conversions
Normal conversions, differential
2
13.5
13/14
1.5/2.5
26.4.1
Differential Channels
When using differential channels, certain aspects of the conversion need to be taken into
consideration.
Differential conversions are synchronized to the internal clock CKADC2 equal to half the ADC
clock. This synchronization is done automatically by the ADC interface in such a way that the
sample-and-hold occurs at a specific phase of CKADC2. A conversion initiated by the user (i.e., all
single conversions, and the first free running conversion) when CKADC2 is low will take the same
amount of time as a single ended conversion (13 ADC clock cycles from the next prescaled
clock cycle). A conversion initiated by the user when CKADC2 is high will take 14 ADC clock
cycles due to the synchronization mechanism. In Free Running mode, a new conversion is initi-
ated immediately after the previous conversion completes, and since CKADC2 is high at this time,
all automatically started (i.e., all but the first) Free Running conversions will take 14 ADC clock
cycles.
If differential channels are used and conversions are started by Auto Triggering, the ADC must
be switched off between conversions. When Auto Triggering is used, the ADC prescaler is reset
before the conversion is started. Since the stage is dependent of a stable ADC clock prior to the
conversion, this conversion will not be valid. By disabling and then re-enabling the ADC between
each conversion (writing ADEN in ADCSRA to “0” then to “1”), only extended conversions are
performed. The result from the extended conversions will be valid. See “Prescaling and Conver-
sion Timing” on page 278 for timing details.
281
2549L–AVR–08/07
26.5 Changing Channel or Reference Selection
The MUXn and REFS1:0 bits in the ADMUX Register are single buffered through a temporary
register to which the CPU has random access. This ensures that the channels and reference
selection only takes place at a safe point during the conversion. The channel and reference
selection is continuously updated until a conversion is started. Once the conversion starts, the
channel and reference selection is locked to ensure a sufficient sampling time for the ADC. Con-
tinuous updating resumes in the last ADC clock cycle before the conversion completes (ADIF in
ADCSRA is set). Note that the conversion starts on the following rising ADC clock edge after
ADSC is written. The user is thus advised not to write new channel or reference selection values
to ADMUX until one ADC clock cycle after ADSC is written.
If Auto Triggering is used, the exact time of the triggering event can be indeterministic. Special
care must be taken when updating the ADMUX Register, in order to control which conversion
will be affected by the new settings.
If both ADATE and ADEN is written to one, an interrupt event can occur at any time. If the
ADMUX Register is changed in this period, the user cannot tell if the next conversion is based
on the old or the new settings. ADMUX can be safely updated in the following ways:
1. When ADATE or ADEN is cleared.
2. During conversion, minimum one ADC clock cycle after the trigger event.
3. After a conversion, before the Interrupt Flag used as trigger source is cleared.
When updating ADMUX in one of these conditions, the new settings will affect the next ADC
conversion.
Special care should be taken when changing differential channels. Once a differential channel
has been selected, the stage may take as much as 125 µs to stabilize to the new value. Thus
conversions should not be started within the first 125 µs after selecting a new differential chan-
nel. Alternatively, conversion results obtained within this period should be discarded.
The same settling time should be observed for the first differential conversion after changing
ADC reference (by changing the REFS1:0 bits in ADMUX).
26.5.1
ADC Input Channels
When changing channel selections, the user should observe the following guidelines to ensure
that the correct channel is selected:
In Single Conversion mode, always select the channel before starting the conversion. The chan-
nel selection may be changed one ADC clock cycle after writing one to ADSC. However, the
simplest method is to wait for the conversion to complete before changing the channel selection.
In Free Running mode, always select the channel before starting the first conversion. The chan-
nel selection may be changed one ADC clock cycle after writing one to ADSC. However, the
simplest method is to wait for the first conversion to complete, and then change the channel
selection. Since the next conversion has already started automatically, the next result will reflect
the previous channel selection. Subsequent conversions will reflect the new channel selection.
When switching to a differential gain channel, the first conversion result may have a poor accu-
racy due to the required settling time for the automatic offset cancellation circuitry. The user
should preferably disregard the first conversion result.
282
ATmega640/1280/1281/2560/2561
2549L–AVR–08/07
ATmega640/1280/1281/2560/2561
26.5.2
ADC Voltage Reference
The reference voltage for the ADC (VREF) indicates the conversion range for the ADC. Single
ended channels that exceed VREF will result in codes close to 0x3FF. VREF can be selected as
either AVCC, internal 1.1V reference, internal 2.56V reference or external AREF pin.
AVCC is connected to the ADC through a passive switch. The internal 1.1V reference is gener-
ated from the internal bandgap reference (VBG) through an internal amplifier. In either case, the
external AREF pin is directly connected to the ADC, and the reference voltage can be made
more immune to noise by connecting a capacitor between the AREF pin and ground. VREF can
also be measured at the AREF pin with a high impedant voltmeter. Note that VREF is a high
impedant source, and only a capacitive load should be connected in a system. The Internal
2.56V reference is generated from the 1.1V reference.
If the user has a fixed voltage source connected to the AREF pin, the user may not use the other
reference voltage options in the application, as they will be shorted to the external voltage. If no
external voltage is applied to the AREF pin, the user may switch between AVCC, 1.1V and
2.56V as reference selection. The first ADC conversion result after switching reference voltage
source may be inaccurate, and the user is advised to discard this result.
If differential channels are used, the selected reference should not be closer to AVCC than
indicated in “ADC Characteristics – Preliminary Data” on page 379.
26.6 ADC Noise Canceler
The ADC features a noise canceler that enables conversion during sleep mode to reduce noise
induced from the CPU core and other I/O peripherals. The noise canceler can be used with ADC
Noise Reduction and Idle mode. To make use of this feature, the following procedure should be
used:
1. Make sure that the ADC is enabled and is not busy converting. Single Conversion
mode must be selected and the ADC conversion complete interrupt must be
enabled.
2. Enter ADC Noise Reduction mode (or Idle mode). The ADC will start a conversion
once the CPU has been halted.
3. If no other interrupts occur before the ADC conversion completes, the ADC interrupt
will wake up the CPU and execute the ADC Conversion Complete interrupt routine. If
another interrupt wakes up the CPU before the ADC conversion is complete, that
interrupt will be executed, and an ADC Conversion Complete interrupt request will be
generated when the ADC conversion completes. The CPU will remain in active mode
until a new sleep command is executed.
Note that the ADC will not be automatically turned off when entering other sleep modes than Idle
mode and ADC Noise Reduction mode. The user is advised to write zero to ADEN before enter-
ing such sleep modes to avoid excessive power consumption.
If the ADC is enabled in such sleep modes and the user wants to perform differential conver-
sions, the user is advised to switch the ADC off and on after waking up from sleep to prompt an
extended conversion to get a valid result.
26.6.1
Analog Input Circuitry
The analog input circuitry for single ended channels is illustrated in Figure 26-8. An analog
source applied to ADCn is subjected to the pin capacitance and input leakage of that pin, regard-
less of whether that channel is selected as input for the ADC. When the channel is selected, the
283
2549L–AVR–08/07
source must drive the S/H capacitor through the series resistance (combined resistance in the
input path).
The ADC is optimized for analog signals with an output impedance of approximately 10 kΩ or
less. If such a source is used, the sampling time will be negligible. If a source with higher imped-
ance is used, the sampling time will depend on how long time the source needs to charge the
S/H capacitor, which can vary widely. The user is recommended to only use low impedant
sources with slowly varying signals, since this minimizes the required charge transfer to the S/H
capacitor.
Signal components higher than the Nyquist frequency (fADC/2) should not be present for either
kind of channels, to avoid distortion from unpredictable signal convolution. The user is advised
to remove high frequency components with a low-pass filter before applying the signals as
inputs to the ADC.
Figure 26-8. Analog Input Circuitry
IIH
ADCn
1..100 kΩ
CS/H= 14 pF
IIL
VCC/2
26.6.2
Analog Noise Canceling Techniques
Digital circuitry inside and outside the device generates EMI which might affect the accuracy of
analog measurements. If conversion accuracy is critical, the noise level can be reduced by
applying the following techniques:
1. Keep analog signal paths as short as possible. Make sure analog tracks run over the
ground plane, and keep them well away from high-speed switching digital tracks.
2. The AVCC pin on the device should be connected to the digital VCC supply voltage
via an LC network as shown in Figure 26-9.
3. Use the ADC noise canceler function to reduce induced noise from the CPU.
4. If any ADC port pins are used as digital outputs, it is essential that these do not
switch while a conversion is in progress.
284
ATmega640/1280/1281/2560/2561
2549L–AVR–08/07
ATmega640/1280/1281/2560/2561
Figure 26-9. ADC Power Connections, ATmega1281/2561.
PA0 51
VCC
52
GND 53
(ADC7) PF7 54
(ADC6) PF6 55
(ADC5) PF5 56
(ADC4) PF4 57
(ADC3) PF3 58
(ADC2) PF2 59
(ADC1) PF1
(ADC0) PF0
60
61
10υΗ
62
63
64
AREF
GND
AVCC
100nF
1
Ground Plane
Figure 26-10. ADC Power Connections, ATmega640/1280/2560
PJ7 79
VCC 80
GND 81
(ADC15/PCINT23) PK7 82
(ADC14/PCINT22) PK6 83
(ADC13/PCINT21) PK5 84
(ADC12/PCINT20) PK4 85
(ADC11/PCINT19) PK3 86
(ADC10/PCINT18) PK2 87
(ADC9/PCINT17) PK1 88
(ADC8/PCINT16) PK0 89
(ADC7/TDI) PF7 90
(ADC6/TDO) PF6 91
(ADC5/TMS) PF5 92
(ADC4/TCK) PF4 93
(ADC3) PF3 94
(ADC2) PF2 95
(ADC1) PF1 96
(ADC0) PF0 97
10υΗ
AREF 98
GND 99
100
AVCC
100nF
Ground Plane
285
2549L–AVR–08/07
26.6.3
26.6.4
Offset Compensation Schemes
The stage has a built-in offset cancellation circuitry that nulls the offset of differential measure-
ments as much as possible. The remaining offset in the analog path can be measured directly by
selecting the same channel for both differential inputs. This offset residue can be then sub-
tracted in software from the measurement results. Using this kind of software based offset
correction, offset on any channel can be reduced below one LSB.
ADC Accuracy Definitions
An n-bit single-ended ADC converts a voltage linearly between GND and VREF in 2n steps
(LSBs). The lowest code is read as 0, and the highest code is read as 2n-1.
Several parameters describe the deviation from the ideal behavior:
•
Offset: The deviation of the first transition (0x000 to 0x001) compared to the ideal transition
(at 0.5 LSB). Ideal value: 0 LSB.
Figure 26-11. Offset Error
Output Code
Ideal ADC
Actual ADC
Offset
Error
VREF
Input Voltage
•
Gain Error: After adjusting for offset, the Gain Error is found as the deviation of the last
transition (0x3FE to 0x3FF) compared to the ideal transition (at 1.5 LSB below maximum).
Ideal value: 0 LSB
Figure 26-12. Gain Error
Gain
Error
Output Code
Ideal ADC
Actual ADC
VREF
Input Voltage
286
ATmega640/1280/1281/2560/2561
2549L–AVR–08/07
ATmega640/1280/1281/2560/2561
•
Integral Non-linearity (INL): After adjusting for offset and gain error, the INL is the maximum
deviation of an actual transition compared to an ideal transition for any code. Ideal value: 0
LSB.
Figure 26-13. Integral Non-linearity (INL)
Output Code
Ideal ADC
Actual ADC
V
Input Voltage
REF
•
Differential Non-linearity (DNL): The maximum deviation of the actual code width (the
interval between two adjacent transitions) from the ideal code width (1 LSB). Ideal value: 0
LSB.
Figure 26-14. Differential Non-linearity (DNL)
Output Code
0x3FF
1 LSB
DNL
0x000
0
VREF Input Voltage
•
•
Quantization Error: Due to the quantization of the input voltage into a finite number of codes,
a range of input voltages (1 LSB wide) will code to the same value. Always 0.5 LSB.
Absolute Accuracy: The maximum deviation of an actual (unadjusted) transition compared
to an ideal transition for any code. This is the compound effect of offset, gain error,
differential error, non-linearity, and quantization error. Ideal value: 0.5 LSB.
287
2549L–AVR–08/07
26.7 ADC Conversion Result
After the conversion is complete (ADIF is high), the conversion result can be found in the ADC
Result Registers (ADCL, ADCH).
For single ended conversion, the result is
V
⋅ 1024
IN
ADC = --------------------------
V
REF
where VIN is the voltage on the selected input pin and VREF the selected voltage reference (see
Table 26-3 on page 290 and Table 26-4 on page 291). 0x000 represents analog ground, and
0x3FF represents the selected reference voltage minus one LSB.
If differential channels are used, the result is
(V
– V
) ⋅ 512
NEG
POS
ADC = ----------------------------------------------------
V
REF
where VPOS is the voltage on the positive input pin, VNEG the voltage on the negative input pin,
and VREF the selected voltage reference. The result is presented in two’s complement form, from
0x200 (-512d) through 0x1FF (+511d). Note that if the user wants to perform a quick polarity
check of the result, it is sufficient to read the MSB of the result (ADC9 in ADCH). If the bit is one,
the result is negative, and if this bit is zero, the result is positive. Figure 26-15 shows the decod-
ing of the differential input range.
Table 26-2 shows the resulting output codes if the differential input channel pair (ADCn - ADCm)
is selected with a gain of GAIN and a reference voltage of VREF
.
288
ATmega640/1280/1281/2560/2561
2549L–AVR–08/07
ATmega640/1280/1281/2560/2561
Figure 26-15. Differential Measurement Range
Output Code
0x1FF
0x000
0
Differential Input
Voltage (Volts)
- VREF
VREF
0x3FF
0x200
289
2549L–AVR–08/07
Table 26-2. Correlation Between Input Voltage and Output Codes
VADCn
Read Code
0x1FF
0x1FF
0x1FE
...
Corresponding Decimal Value
VADCm + VREF / GAIN
511
511
510
...
VADCm + 0.999 VREF / GAIN
VADCm + 0.998 VREF / GAIN
...
V
ADCm + 0.001 VREF / GAIN
VADCm
ADCm - 0.001 VREF / GAIN
0x001
0x000
0x3FF
...
1
0
V
-1
...
...
VADCm - 0.999 VREF / GAIN
0x201
0x200
-511
-512
VADCm - VREF / GAIN
Example:
ADMUX = 0xFB (ADC3 - ADC2, 10x gain, 2.56V reference, left adjusted result)
Voltage on ADC3 is 300 mV, voltage on ADC2 is 500 mV.
ADCR = 512 * 10 * (300 - 500) / 2560 = -400 = 0x270.
ADCL will thus read 0x00, and ADCH will read 0x9C. Writing zero to ADLAR right adjusts the
result: ADCL = 0x70, ADCH = 0x02.
26.8 Register Description
26.8.1
ADMUX – ADC Multiplexer Selection Register
Bit
7
REFS1
R/W
0
6
REFS0
R/W
0
5
ADLAR
R/W
0
4
MUX4
R/W
0
3
MUX3
R/W
0
2
MUX2
R/W
0
1
MUX1
R/W
0
0
MUX0
R/W
0
(0x7C)
ADMUX
Read/Write
Initial Value
• Bit 7:6 – REFS1:0: Reference Selection Bits
These bits select the voltage reference for the ADC, as shown in Table 26-3. If these bits are
changed during a conversion, the change will not go in effect until this conversion is complete
(ADIF in ADCSRA is set). The internal voltage reference options may not be used if an external
reference voltage is being applied to the AREF pin.
Table 26-3. Voltage Reference Selections for ADC
REFS1
REFS0
Voltage Reference Selection(1)
0
0
1
1
0
1
0
1
AREF, Internal VREF turned off
AVCC with external capacitor at AREF pin
Internal 1.1V Voltage Reference with external capacitor at AREF pin
Internal 2.56V Voltage Reference with external capacitor at AREF pin
Note:
1. If 10x or 200x gain is selected, only 2.56 V should be used as Internal Voltage Reference. For
differential conversion, only 1.1V cannot be used as internal voltage reference.
290
ATmega640/1280/1281/2560/2561
2549L–AVR–08/07
ATmega640/1280/1281/2560/2561
• Bit 5 – ADLAR: ADC Left Adjust Result
The ADLAR bit affects the presentation of the ADC conversion result in the ADC Data Register.
Write one to ADLAR to left adjust the result. Otherwise, the result is right adjusted. Changing the
ADLAR bit will affect the ADC Data Register immediately, regardless of any ongoing conver-
sions. For a complete description of this bit, see “ADCL and ADCH – The ADC Data Register” on
page 295.
• Bits 4:0 – MUX4:0: Analog Channel and Gain Selection Bits
The value of these bits selects which combination of analog inputs are connected to the ADC.
See Table 26-4 for details. If these bits are changed during a conversion, the change will not go
in effect until this conversion is complete (ADIF in ADCSRA is set)
26.8.2
ADCSRB – ADC Control and Status Register B
Bit
(0x7B)
7
6
5
–
4
–
3
MUX5
R/W
0
2
ADTS2
R/W
0
1
ADTS1
R/W
0
0
ADTS0
R/W
0
–
ACME
ADCSRB
Read/Write
R
0
R/W
R
0
R
0
Initial Value
0
• Bit 3 – MUX5: Analog Channel and Gain Selection Bit
This bit is used together with MUX4:0 in ADMUX to select which combination in of analog inputs
are connected to the ADC. See Table 26-4 for details. If this bit is changed during a conversion,
the change will not go in effect until this conversion is complete.
This bit is not valid for ATmega1281/2561.
Table 26-4. Input Channel Selections
Single Ended
Input
Positive Differential
Input
Negative Differential
Input
MUX5:0
000000
000001
000010
000011
000100
000101
000110
000111
Gain
ADC0
ADC1
ADC2
ADC3
ADC4
ADC5
ADC6
ADC7
N/A
291
2549L–AVR–08/07
Table 26-4. Input Channel Selections (Continued)
Single Ended
Input
Positive Differential
Input
Negative Differential
Input
MUX5:0
001000(1)
001001(1)
001010(1)
001011(1)
001100(1)
001101(1)
001110(1)
001111(1)
010000
010001
010010
010011
010100
010101
010110
010111
011000
011001
011010
011011
011100
011101
011110
011111
100000
100001
100010
100011
100100
100101
100110
100111
Gain
10x
ADC0
ADC0
ADC1
ADC0
ADC1
ADC2
ADC3
ADC2
ADC3
ADC0
ADC1
ADC2
ADC3
ADC4
ADC5
ADC6
ADC7
ADC0
ADC1
ADC2
ADC3
ADC4
ADC5
ADC0
ADC0
ADC0
ADC2
ADC2
ADC2
ADC2
ADC1
ADC1
ADC1
ADC1
ADC1
ADC1
ADC1
ADC1
ADC2
ADC2
ADC2
ADC2
ADC2
ADC2
10x
200x
200x
10x
10x
200x
200x
1x
N/A
1x
1x
1x
1x
1x
1x
1x
1x
1x
1x
1x
N/A
1x
1x
1.1V (VBG
)
N/A
0V (GND)
ADC8
ADC9
ADC10
ADC11
ADC12
ADC13
ADC14
ADC15
N/A
292
ATmega640/1280/1281/2560/2561
2549L–AVR–08/07
ATmega640/1280/1281/2560/2561
Table 26-4. Input Channel Selections (Continued)
Single Ended
Input
Positive Differential
Input
Negative Differential
Input
MUX5:0
101000(1)
101001(1)
101010(1)
101011(1)
101100(1)
101101(1)
101110(1)
101111(1)
110000
110001
110010
110011
110100
110101
110110
110111
111000
111001
111010
111011
111100
111101
111110
111111
Gain
10x
ADC8
ADC8
ADC9
ADC8
ADC8
ADC8
ADC10
ADC10
ADC10
ADC10
ADC9
ADC9
ADC9
ADC9
ADC9
ADC9
ADC9
ADC9
ADC10
ADC10
ADC10
ADC10
ADC10
ADC10
N/A
10x
200x
200x
10x
10x
200x
200x
1x
ADC8
ADC9
ADC10
ADC11
ADC10
ADC11
ADC8
ADC9
1x
N/A
ADC10
ADC11
ADC12
ADC13
ADC14
ADC15
ADC8
1x
1x
1x
1x
1x
1x
1x
ADC9
1x
ADC10
ADC11
ADC12
ADC13
1x
1x
1x
N/A
Reserved
Reserved
1x
N/A
Note:
1. To reach the given accuracy, 10x or 200x Gain should not be used for operating voltage below
2.7V
26.8.3
ADCSRA – ADC Control and Status Register A
Bit
7
ADEN
R/W
0
6
ADSC
R/W
0
5
ADATE
R/W
0
4
ADIF
R/W
0
3
ADIE
R/W
0
2
ADPS2
R/W
0
1
ADPS1
R/W
0
0
ADPS0
R/W
0
(0x7A)
ADCSRA
Read/Write
Initial Value
• Bit 7 – ADEN: ADC Enable
Writing this bit to one enables the ADC. By writing it to zero, the ADC is turned off. Turning the
ADC off while a conversion is in progress, will terminate this conversion.
293
2549L–AVR–08/07
• Bit 6 – ADSC: ADC Start Conversion
In Single Conversion mode, write this bit to one to start each conversion. In Free Running mode,
write this bit to one to start the first conversion. The first conversion after ADSC has been written
after the ADC has been enabled, or if ADSC is written at the same time as the ADC is enabled,
will take 25 ADC clock cycles instead of the normal 13. This first conversion performs initializa-
tion of the ADC.
ADSC will read as one as long as a conversion is in progress. When the conversion is complete,
it returns to zero. Writing zero to this bit has no effect.
• Bit 5 – ADATE: ADC Auto Trigger Enable
When this bit is written to one, Auto Triggering of the ADC is enabled. The ADC will start a con-
version on a positive edge of the selected trigger signal. The trigger source is selected by setting
the ADC Trigger Select bits, ADTS in ADCSRB.
• Bit 4 – ADIF: ADC Interrupt Flag
This bit is set when an ADC conversion completes and the Data Registers are updated. The
ADC Conversion Complete Interrupt is executed if the ADIE bit and the I-bit in SREG are set.
ADIF is cleared by hardware when executing the corresponding interrupt handling vector. Alter-
natively, ADIF is cleared by writing a logical one to the flag. Beware that if doing a Read-Modify-
Write on ADCSRA, a pending interrupt can be disabled. This also applies if the SBI and CBI
instructions are used.
• Bit 3 – ADIE: ADC Interrupt Enable
When this bit is written to one and the I-bit in SREG is set, the ADC Conversion Complete Inter-
rupt is activated.
• Bits 2:0 – ADPS2:0: ADC Prescaler Select Bits
These bits determine the division factor between the XTAL frequency and the input clock to the
ADC.
Table 26-5. ADC Prescaler Selections
ADPS2
ADPS1
ADPS0
Division Factor
0
0
0
0
1
1
1
1
0
0
1
1
0
0
1
1
0
1
0
1
0
1
0
1
2
2
4
8
16
32
64
128
294
ATmega640/1280/1281/2560/2561
2549L–AVR–08/07
ATmega640/1280/1281/2560/2561
26.8.4
ADCL and ADCH – The ADC Data Register
26.8.4.1
ADLAR = 0
Bit
15
14
13
12
11
10
9
8
(0x79)
(0x78)
–
–
–
–
–
–
ADC9
ADC8
ADCH
ADCL
ADC7
ADC6
ADC5
ADC4
ADC3
ADC2
ADC1
ADC0
7
R
R
0
6
R
R
0
5
R
R
0
4
R
R
0
3
R
R
0
2
R
R
0
1
R
R
0
0
R
R
0
Read/Write
Initial Value
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
26.8.4.2
ADLAR = 1
Bit
15
14
13
12
11
10
9
8
(0x79)
(0x78)
ADC9
ADC8
ADC7
ADC6
ADC5
ADC4
ADC3
ADC2
ADCH
ADCL
ADC1
ADC0
–
5
–
4
–
3
–
2
–
1
–
0
7
R
R
0
6
R
R
0
Read/Write
R
R
0
R
R
0
R
R
0
R
R
0
R
R
0
R
R
0
Initial Value
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
When an ADC conversion is complete, the result is found in these two registers. If differential
channels are used, the result is presented in two’s complement form.
When ADCL is read, the ADC Data Register is not updated until ADCH is read. Consequently, if
the result is left adjusted and no more than 8-bit precision (7 bit + sign bit for differential input
channels) is required, it is sufficient to read ADCH. Otherwise, ADCL must be read first, then
ADCH.
The ADLAR bit in ADMUX, and the MUXn bits in ADMUX affect the way the result is read from
the registers. If ADLAR is set, the result is left adjusted. If ADLAR is cleared (default), the result
is right adjusted.
• ADC9:0: ADC Conversion Result
These bits represent the result from the conversion, as detailed in “ADC Conversion Result” on
page 288.
26.8.5
ADCSRB – ADC Control and Status Register B
Bit
7
–
6
ACME
R/W
0
5
–
4
–
3
MUX5
R/W
0
2
ADTS2
R/W
0
1
ADTS1
R/W
0
0
ADTS0
R/W
0
(0x7B)
ADCSRB
Read/Write
Initial Value
R
0
R
0
R
0
• Bit 7 – Res: Reserved Bit
This bit is reserved for future use. To ensure compatibility with future devices, this bit must be
written to zero when ADCSRB is written.
• Bit 2:0 – ADTS2:0: ADC Auto Trigger Source
If ADATE in ADCSRA is written to one, the value of these bits selects which source will trigger
an ADC conversion. If ADATE is cleared, the ADTS2:0 settings will have no effect. A conversion
will be triggered by the rising edge of the selected Interrupt Flag. Note that switching from a trig-
295
2549L–AVR–08/07
ger source that is cleared to a trigger source that is set, will generate a positive edge on the
trigger signal. If ADEN in ADCSRA is set, this will start a conversion. Switching to Free Running
mode (ADTS[2:0]=0) will not cause a trigger event, even if the ADC Interrupt Flag is set.
Table 26-6. ADC Auto Trigger Source Selections
ADTS2
ADTS1
ADTS0
Trigger Source
0
0
0
0
1
1
1
1
0
0
1
1
0
0
1
1
0
1
0
1
0
1
0
1
Free Running mode
Analog Comparator
External Interrupt Request 0
Timer/Counter0 Compare Match A
Timer/Counter0 Overflow
Timer/Counter1 Compare Match B
Timer/Counter1 Overflow
Timer/Counter1 Capture Event
Note:
Free running mode cannot be used for differential channels. (See chapter “Differential Channels”
on page 28126.4.1)
26.8.6
DIDR0 – Digital Input Disable Register 0
Bit
7
ADC7D
R/W
0
6
ADC6D
R/W
0
5
ADC5D
R/W
0
4
ADC4D
R/W
0
3
ADC3D
R/W
0
2
ADC2D
R/W
0
1
ADC1D
R/W
0
0
ADC0D
R/W
0
(0x7E)
DIDR0
Read/Write
Initial Value
• Bit 7:0 – ADC7D:ADC0D: ADC7:0 Digital Input Disable
When this bit is written logic one, the digital input buffer on the corresponding ADC pin is dis-
abled. The corresponding PIN Register bit will always read as zero when this bit is set. When an
analog signal is applied to the ADC7:0 pin and the digital input from this pin is not needed, this
bit should be written logic one to reduce power consumption in the digital input buffer.
26.8.7
DIDR2 – Digital Input Disable Register 2
Bit
(0x7D)
7
6
5
ADC13D
R/W
4
ADC12D
R/W
3
ADC11D
R/W
2
ADC10D
R/W
1
ADC9D
R/W
0
0
ADC8D
R/W
0
ADC15D
ADC14D
DIDR2
Read/Write
R/W
R/W
Initial Value
0
0
0
0
0
0
• Bit 7:0 – ADC15D:ADC8D: ADC15:8 Digital Input Disable
When this bit is written logic one, the digital input buffer on the corresponding ADC pin is dis-
abled. The corresponding PIN Register bit will always read as zero when this bit is set. When an
analog signal is applied to the ADC15:8 pin and the digital input from this pin is not needed, this
bit should be written logic one to reduce power consumption in the digital input buffer.
296
ATmega640/1280/1281/2560/2561
2549L–AVR–08/07
ATmega640/1280/1281/2560/2561
27. JTAG Interface and On-chip Debug System
27.1 Features
• JTAG (IEEE std. 1149.1 Compliant) Interface
• Boundary-scan Capabilities According to the IEEE std. 1149.1 (JTAG) Standard
• Debugger Access to:
– All Internal Peripheral Units
– Internal and External RAM
– The Internal Register File
– Program Counter
– EEPROM and Flash Memories
• Extensive On-chip Debug Support for Break Conditions, Including
– AVR Break Instruction
– Break on Change of Program Memory Flow
– Single Step Break
– Program Memory Break Points on Single Address or Address Range
– Data Memory Break Points on Single Address or Address Range
• Programming of Flash, EEPROM, Fuses, and Lock Bits through the JTAG Interface
• On-chip Debugging Supported by AVR Studio®
27.2 Overview
The AVR IEEE std. 1149.1 compliant JTAG interface can be used for
•
•
•
Testing PCBs by using the JTAG Boundary-scan capability
Programming the non-volatile memories, Fuses and Lock bits
On-chip debugging
A brief description is given in the following sections. Detailed descriptions for Programming via
the JTAG interface, and using the Boundary-scan Chain can be found in the sections “Program-
ming via the JTAG Interface” on page 357 and “IEEE 1149.1 (JTAG) Boundary-scan” on page
303, respectively. The On-chip Debug support is considered being private JTAG instructions,
and distributed within ATMEL and to selected third party vendors only.
Figure 27-1 shows a block diagram of the JTAG interface and the On-chip Debug system. The
TAP Controller is a state machine controlled by the TCK and TMS signals. The TAP Controller
selects either the JTAG Instruction Register or one of several Data Registers as the scan chain
(Shift Register) between the TDI – input and TDO – output. The Instruction Register holds JTAG
instructions controlling the behavior of a Data Register.
The ID-Register, Bypass Register, and the Boundary-scan Chain are the Data Registers used
for board-level testing. The JTAG Programming Interface (actually consisting of several physical
and virtual Data Registers) is used for serial programming via the JTAG interface. The Internal
Scan Chain and Break Point Scan Chain are used for On-chip debugging only.
297
2549L–AVR–08/07
Figure 27-1. Block Diagram
I/O PORT 0
DEVICE BOUNDARY
BOUNDARY SCAN CHAIN
TDI
TDO
TCK
TMS
JTAG PROGRAMMING
INTERFACE
TAP
CONTROLLER
AVR CPU
INTERNAL
SCAN
CHAIN
FLASH
MEMORY
Address
Data
PC
Instruction
INSTRUCTION
REGISTER
ID
REGISTER
BREAKPOINT
UNIT
M
U
X
FLOW CONTROL
UNIT
BYPASS
REGISTER
DIGITAL
PERIPHERAL
UNITS
ANALOG
PERIPHERIAL
UNITS
Analog inputs
BREAKPOINT
SCAN CHAIN
JTAG / AVR CORE
COMMUNICATION
INTERFACE
ADDRESS
DECODER
OCD STATUS
AND CONTROL
Control & Clock lines
I/O PORT n
27.3 TAP - Test Access Port
The JTAG interface is accessed through four of the AVR’s pins. In JTAG terminology, these pins
constitute the Test Access Port – TAP. These pins are:
•
TMS: Test mode select. This pin is used for navigating through the TAP-controller state
machine.
•
•
TCK: Test Clock. JTAG operation is synchronous to TCK.
TDI: Test Data In. Serial input data to be shifted in to the Instruction Register or Data
Register (Scan Chains).
•
TDO: Test Data Out. Serial output data from Instruction Register or Data Register.
The IEEE std. 1149.1 also specifies an optional TAP signal; TRST – Test ReSeT – which is not
provided.
When the JTAGEN Fuse is unprogrammed, these four TAP pins are normal port pins, and the
TAP controller is in reset. When programmed, the input TAP signals are internally pulled high
and the JTAG is enabled for Boundary-scan and programming. The device is shipped with this
fuse programmed.
For the On-chip Debug system, in addition to the JTAG interface pins, the RESET pin is moni-
tored by the debugger to be able to detect external reset sources. The debugger can also pull
the RESET pin low to reset the whole system, assuming only open collectors on the reset line
are used in the application.
298
ATmega640/1280/1281/2560/2561
2549L–AVR–08/07
ATmega640/1280/1281/2560/2561
Figure 27-2. TAP Controller State Diagram
1
Test-Logic-Reset
0
1
1
1
0
Run-Test/Idle
Select-DR Scan
Select-IR Scan
0
0
1
1
Capture-DR
Capture-IR
0
0
Shift-IR
1
Shift-DR
0
0
1
Exit1-DR
0
1
1
Exit1-IR
0
Pause-DR
1
0
Pause-IR
1
0
0
0
Exit2-DR
1
Exit2-IR
1
Update-DR
Update-IR
1
1
0
0
27.3.1
TAP Controller
The TAP controller is a 16-state finite state machine that controls the operation of the Boundary-
scan circuitry, JTAG programming circuitry, or On-chip Debug system. The state transitions
depicted in Figure 27-2 depend on the signal present on TMS (shown adjacent to each state
transition) at the time of the rising edge at TCK. The initial state after a Power-on Reset is Test-
Logic-Reset.
As a definition in this document, the LSB is shifted in and out first for all Shift Registers.
Assuming Run-Test/Idle is the present state, a typical scenario for using the JTAG interface is:
•
At the TMS input, apply the sequence 1, 1, 0, 0 at the rising edges of TCK to enter the Shift
Instruction Register – Shift-IR state. While in this state, shift the four bits of the JTAG
instructions into the JTAG Instruction Register from the TDI input at the rising edge of TCK.
The TMS input must be held low during input of the 3 LSBs in order to remain in the Shift-IR
state. The MSB of the instruction is shifted in when this state is left by setting TMS high.
While the instruction is shifted in from the TDI pin, the captured IR-state 0x01 is shifted out
on the TDO pin. The JTAG Instruction selects a particular Data Register as path between
TDI and TDO and controls the circuitry surrounding the selected Data Register.
299
2549L–AVR–08/07
•
•
Apply the TMS sequence 1, 1, 0 to re-enter the Run-Test/Idle state. The instruction is
latched onto the parallel output from the Shift Register path in the Update-IR state. The Exit-
IR, Pause-IR, and Exit2-IR states are only used for navigating the state machine.
At the TMS input, apply the sequence 1, 0, 0 at the rising edges of TCK to enter the Shift
Data Register – Shift-DR state. While in this state, upload the selected Data Register
(selected by the present JTAG instruction in the JTAG Instruction Register) from the TDI
input at the rising edge of TCK. In order to remain in the Shift-DR state, the TMS input must
be held low during input of all bits except the MSB. The MSB of the data is shifted in when
this state is left by setting TMS high. While the Data Register is shifted in from the TDI pin,
the parallel inputs to the Data Register captured in the Capture-DR state is shifted out on the
TDO pin.
•
Apply the TMS sequence 1, 1, 0 to re-enter the Run-Test/Idle state. If the selected Data
Register has a latched parallel-output, the latching takes place in the Update-DR state. The
Exit-DR, Pause-DR, and Exit2-DR states are only used for navigating the state machine.
As shown in the state diagram, the Run-Test/Idle state need not be entered between selecting
JTAG instruction and using Data Registers, and some JTAG instructions may select certain
functions to be performed in the Run-Test/Idle, making it unsuitable as an Idle state.
Note:
Independent of the initial state of the TAP Controller, the Test-Logic-Reset state can always be
entered by holding TMS high for five TCK clock periods.
For detailed information on the JTAG specification, refer to the literature listed in “Bibliography”
on page 302.
27.4 Using the Boundary-scan Chain
A complete description of the Boundary-scan capabilities are given in the section “IEEE 1149.1
(JTAG) Boundary-scan” on page 303.
27.5 Using the On-chip Debug System
As shown in Figure 27-1, the hardware support for On-chip Debugging consists mainly of
•
A scan chain on the interface between the internal AVR CPU and the internal peripheral
units.
•
•
Break Point unit.
Communication interface between the CPU and JTAG system.
All read or modify/write operations needed for implementing the Debugger are done by applying
AVR instructions via the internal AVR CPU Scan Chain. The CPU sends the result to an I/O
memory mapped location which is part of the communication interface between the CPU and the
JTAG system.
The Break Point Unit implements Break on Change of Program Flow, Single Step Break, two
Program Memory Break Points, and two combined Break Points. Together, the four Break
Points can be configured as either:
•
•
•
•
4 single Program Memory Break Points.
3 Single Program Memory Break Point + 1 single Data Memory Break Point.
2 single Program Memory Break Points + 2 single Data Memory Break Points.
2 single Program Memory Break Points + 1 Program Memory Break Point with mask (“range
Break Point”).
•
2 single Program Memory Break Points + 1 Data Memory Break Point with mask (“range
Break Point”).
300
ATmega640/1280/1281/2560/2561
2549L–AVR–08/07
ATmega640/1280/1281/2560/2561
A debugger, like the AVR Studio, may however use one or more of these resources for its inter-
nal purpose, leaving less flexibility to the end-user.
A list of the On-chip Debug specific JTAG instructions is given in “On-chip Debug Specific JTAG
Instructions” on page 301.
The JTAGEN Fuse must be programmed to enable the JTAG Test Access Port. In addition, the
OCDEN Fuse must be programmed and no Lock bits must be set for the On-chip debug system
to work. As a security feature, the On-chip debug system is disabled when either of the LB1 or
LB2 Lock bits are set. Otherwise, the On-chip debug system would have provided a back-door
into a secured device.
The AVR Studio enables the user to fully control execution of programs on an AVR device with
On-chip Debug capability, AVR In-Circuit Emulator, or the built-in AVR Instruction Set Simulator.
AVR Studio® supports source level execution of Assembly programs assembled with Atmel Cor-
poration’s AVR Assembler and C programs compiled with third party vendors’ compilers.
AVR Studio runs under Microsoft® Windows® 95/98/2000 and Microsoft Windows NT®.
For a full description of the AVR Studio, please refer to the AVR Studio User Guide. Only high-
lights are presented in this document.
All necessary execution commands are available in AVR Studio, both on source level and on
disassembly level. The user can execute the program, single step through the code either by
tracing into or stepping over functions, step out of functions, place the cursor on a statement and
execute until the statement is reached, stop the execution, and reset the execution target. In
addition, the user can have an unlimited number of code Break Points (using the BREAK
instruction) and up to two data memory Break Points, alternatively combined as a mask (range)
Break Point.
27.6 On-chip Debug Specific JTAG Instructions
The On-chip debug support is considered being private JTAG instructions, and distributed within
ATMEL and to selected third party vendors only. Instruction opcodes are listed for reference.
27.6.1
27.6.2
27.6.3
27.6.4
PRIVATE0; 0x8
PRIVATE1; 0x9
PRIVATE2; 0xA
PRIVATE3; 0xB
Private JTAG instruction for accessing On-chip debug system.
Private JTAG instruction for accessing On-chip debug system.
Private JTAG instruction for accessing On-chip debug system.
Private JTAG instruction for accessing On-chip debug system.
301
2549L–AVR–08/07
27.7 Using the JTAG Programming Capabilities
Programming of AVR parts via JTAG is performed via the 4-pin JTAG port, TCK, TMS, TDI, and
TDO. These are the only pins that need to be controlled/observed to perform JTAG program-
ming (in addition to power pins). It is not required to apply 12V externally. The JTAGEN Fuse
must be programmed and the JTD bit in the MCUCR Register must be cleared to enable the
JTAG Test Access Port.
The JTAG programming capability supports:
•
•
•
•
Flash programming and verifying.
EEPROM programming and verifying.
Fuse programming and verifying.
Lock bit programming and verifying.
The Lock bit security is exactly as in parallel programming mode. If the Lock bits LB1 or LB2 are
programmed, the OCDEN Fuse cannot be programmed unless first doing a chip erase. This is a
security feature that ensures no back-door exists for reading out the content of a secured
device.
The details on programming through the JTAG interface and programming specific JTAG
instructions are given in the section “Programming via the JTAG Interface” on page 357.
27.8 Bibliography
For more information about general Boundary-scan, the following literature can be consulted:
•
IEEE: IEEE Std. 1149.1-1990. IEEE Standard Test Access Port and Boundary-scan
Architecture, IEEE, 1993.
•
Colin Maunder: The Board Designers Guide to Testable Logic Circuits, Addison-Wesley,
1992.
27.9 On-chip Debug Related Register in I/O Memory
27.9.1
OCDR – On-chip Debug Register
Bit
7
6
5
4
3
2
1
0
0x31 (0x51)
Read/Write
Initial Value
MSB/IDRD
LSB
R/W
0
OCDR
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
R/W
0
0
0
0
0
0
0
The OCDR Register provides a communication channel from the running program in the micro-
controller to the debugger. The CPU can transfer a byte to the debugger by writing to this
location. At the same time, an internal flag; I/O Debug Register Dirty – IDRD – is set to indicate
to the debugger that the register has been written. When the CPU reads the OCDR Register the
7 LSB will be from the OCDR Register, while the MSB is the IDRD bit. The debugger clears the
IDRD bit when it has read the information.
In some AVR devices, this register is shared with a standard I/O location. In this case, the OCDR
Register can only be accessed if the OCDEN Fuse is programmed, and the debugger enables
access to the OCDR Register. In all other cases, the standard I/O location is accessed.
Refer to the debugger documentation for further information on how to use this register.
302
ATmega640/1280/1281/2560/2561
2549L–AVR–08/07
ATmega640/1280/1281/2560/2561
28. IEEE 1149.1 (JTAG) Boundary-scan
28.1 Features
• JTAG (IEEE std. 1149.1 compliant) Interface
• Boundary-scan Capabilities According to the JTAG Standard
• Full Scan of all Port Functions as well as Analog Circuitry having Off-chip Connections
• Supports the Optional IDCODE Instruction
• Additional Public AVR_RESET Instruction to Reset the AVR
28.2 System Overview
The Boundary-scan chain has the capability of driving and observing the logic levels on the digi-
tal I/O pins, as well as the boundary between digital and analog logic for analog circuitry having
off-chip connections. At system level, all ICs having JTAG capabilities are connected serially by
the TDI/TDO signals to form a long Shift Register. An external controller sets up the devices to
drive values at their output pins, and observe the input values received from other devices. The
controller compares the received data with the expected result. In this way, Boundary-scan pro-
vides a mechanism for testing interconnections and integrity of components on Printed Circuits
Boards by using the four TAP signals only.
The four IEEE 1149.1 defined mandatory JTAG instructions IDCODE, BYPASS, SAMPLE/PRE-
LOAD, and EXTEST, as well as the AVR specific public JTAG instruction AVR_RESET can be
used for testing the Printed Circuit Board. Initial scanning of the Data Register path will show the
ID-Code of the device, since IDCODE is the default JTAG instruction. It may be desirable to
have the AVR device in reset during test mode. If not reset, inputs to the device may be deter-
mined by the scan operations, and the internal software may be in an undetermined state when
exiting the test mode. Entering reset, the outputs of any port pin will instantly enter the high
impedance state, making the HIGHZ instruction redundant. If needed, the BYPASS instruction
can be issued to make the shortest possible scan chain through the device. The device can be
set in the reset state either by pulling the external RESET pin low, or issuing the AVR_RESET
instruction with appropriate setting of the Reset Data Register.
The EXTEST instruction is used for sampling external pins and loading output pins with data.
The data from the output latch will be driven out on the pins as soon as the EXTEST instruction
is loaded into the JTAG IR-Register. Therefore, the SAMPLE/PRELOAD should also be used for
setting initial values to the scan ring, to avoid damaging the board when issuing the EXTEST
instruction for the first time. SAMPLE/PRELOAD can also be used for taking a snapshot of the
external pins during normal operation of the part.
The JTAGEN Fuse must be programmed and the JTD bit in the I/O Register MCUCR must be
cleared to enable the JTAG Test Access Port.
When using the JTAG interface for Boundary-scan, using a JTAG TCK clock frequency higher
than the internal chip frequency is possible. The chip clock is not required to run.
28.3 Data Registers
The Data Registers relevant for Boundary-scan operations are:
•
Bypass Register
•
•
•
Device Identification Register
Reset Register
Boundary-scan Chain
303
2549L–AVR–08/07
28.3.1
28.3.2
Bypass Register
The Bypass Register consists of a single Shift Register stage. When the Bypass Register is
selected as path between TDI and TDO, the register is reset to 0 when leaving the Capture-DR
controller state. The Bypass Register can be used to shorten the scan chain on a system when
the other devices are to be tested.
Device Identification Register
Figure 3 shows the structure of the Device Identification Register.
Figure 3. The Format of the Device Identification Register
LSB
MSB
Bit
31
28
27
12
11
1
0
Device ID
Version
Part Number
Manufacturer ID
1
4 bits
16 bits
11 bits
1-bit
28.3.2.1
28.3.2.2
28.3.2.3
28.3.3
Version
Version is a 4-bit number identifying the revision of the component. The JTAG version number
follows the revision of the device. Revision A is 0x0, revision B is 0x1 and so on.
Part Number
The part number is a 16-bit code identifying the component. The JTAG Part Number for
ATmega640/1280/1281/2560/2561 is listed in Table 30-6 on page 340.
Manufacturer ID
The Manufacturer ID is a 11-bit code identifying the manufacturer. The JTAG manufacturer ID
for ATMEL is listed in Table 30-6 on page 340.
Reset Register
The Reset Register is a test Data Register used to reset the part. Since the AVR tri-states Port
Pins when reset, the Reset Register can also replace the function of the unimplemented optional
JTAG instruction HIGHZ.
A high value in the Reset Register corresponds to pulling the external Reset low. The part is
reset as long as there is a high value present in the Reset Register. Depending on the fuse set-
tings for the clock options, the part will remain reset for a reset time-out period (see “Clock
Sources” on page 40) after releasing the Reset Register. The output from this Data Register is
not latched, so the reset will take place immediately, as shown in Figure 28-1.
304
ATmega640/1280/1281/2560/2561
2549L–AVR–08/07
ATmega640/1280/1281/2560/2561
Figure 28-1. Reset Register
To
TDO
From Other Internal and
External Reset Sources
From
TDI
Internal reset
D
Q
ClockDR · AVR_RESET
28.3.4
Boundary-scan Chain
The Boundary-scan Chain has the capability of driving and observing the logic levels on the dig-
ital I/O pins, as well as the boundary between digital and analog logic for analog circuitry having
off-chip connections.
See “Boundary-scan Chain” on page 306 for a complete description.
28.4 Boundary-scan Specific JTAG Instructions
The Instruction Register is 4-bit wide, supporting up to 16 instructions. Listed below are the
JTAG instructions useful for Boundary-scan operation. Note that the optional HIGHZ instruction
is not implemented, but all outputs with tri-state capability can be set in high-impedant state by
using the AVR_RESET instruction, since the initial state for all port pins is tri-state.
As a definition in this datasheet, the LSB is shifted in and out first for all Shift Registers.
The OPCODE for each instruction is shown behind the instruction name in hex format. The text
describes which Data Register is selected as path between TDI and TDO for each instruction.
28.4.1
EXTEST; 0x0
Mandatory JTAG instruction for selecting the Boundary-scan Chain as Data Register for testing
circuitry external to the AVR package. For port-pins, Pull-up Disable, Output Control, Output
Data, and Input Data are all accessible in the scan chain. For Analog circuits having off-chip
connections, the interface between the analog and the digital logic is in the scan chain. The con-
tents of the latched outputs of the Boundary-scan chain is driven out as soon as the JTAG IR-
Register is loaded with the EXTEST instruction.
The active states are:
•
•
•
Capture-DR: Data on the external pins are sampled into the Boundary-scan Chain.
Shift-DR: The Internal Scan Chain is shifted by the TCK input.
Update-DR: Data from the scan chain is applied to output pins.
28.4.2
IDCODE; 0x1
Optional JTAG instruction selecting the 32 bit ID-Register as Data Register. The ID-Register
consists of a version number, a device number and the manufacturer code chosen by JEDEC.
This is the default instruction after power-up.
305
2549L–AVR–08/07
The active states are:
•
•
Capture-DR: Data in the IDCODE Register is sampled into the Boundary-scan Chain.
Shift-DR: The IDCODE scan chain is shifted by the TCK input.
28.4.3
SAMPLE_PRELOAD; 0x2
Mandatory JTAG instruction for pre-loading the output latches and taking a snap-shot of the
input/output pins without affecting the system operation. However, the output latches are not
connected to the pins. The Boundary-scan Chain is selected as Data Register.
The active states are:
•
•
•
Capture-DR: Data on the external pins are sampled into the Boundary-scan Chain.
Shift-DR: The Boundary-scan Chain is shifted by the TCK input.
Update-DR: Data from the Boundary-scan chain is applied to the output latches. However,
the output latches are not connected to the pins.
28.4.4
AVR_RESET; 0xC
The AVR specific public JTAG instruction for forcing the AVR device into the Reset mode or
releasing the JTAG reset source. The TAP controller is not reset by this instruction. The one bit
Reset Register is selected as Data Register. Note that the reset will be active as long as there is
a logic “one” in the Reset Chain. The output from this chain is not latched.
The active states are:
•
Shift-DR: The Reset Register is shifted by the TCK input.
28.4.5
BYPASS; 0xF
Mandatory JTAG instruction selecting the Bypass Register for Data Register.
The active states are:
•
•
Capture-DR: Loads a logic “0” into the Bypass Register.
Shift-DR: The Bypass Register cell between TDI and TDO is shifted.
28.5 Boundary-scan Chain
The Boundary-scan chain has the capability of driving and observing the logic levels on the digi-
tal I/O pins, as well as the boundary between digital and analog logic for analog circuitry having
off-chip connection.
28.5.1
Scanning the Digital Port Pins
Figure 28-2 shows the Boundary-scan Cell for a bi-directional port pin. The pull-up function is
disabled during Boundary-scan when the JTAG IC contains EXTEST or SAMPLE_PRELOAD.
The cell consists of a bi-directional pin cell that combines the three signals Output Control -
OCxn, Output Data - ODxn, and Input Data - IDxn, into only a two-stage Shift Register. The port
and pin indexes are not used in the following description
The Boundary-scan logic is not included in the figures in the datasheet. Figure 28-3 shows a
simple digital port pin as described in the section “I/O-Ports” on page 70. The Boundary-scan
details from Figure 28-2 replaces the dashed box in Figure 28-3.
When no alternate port function is present, the Input Data - ID - corresponds to the PINxn Regis-
ter value (but ID has no synchronizer), Output Data corresponds to the PORT Register, Output
306
ATmega640/1280/1281/2560/2561
2549L–AVR–08/07
ATmega640/1280/1281/2560/2561
Control corresponds to the Data Direction - DD Register, and the Pull-up Enable - PUExn - cor-
responds to logic expression PUD · DDxn · PORTxn.
Digital alternate port functions are connected outside the dotted box in Figure 28-3 to make the
scan chain read the actual pin value. For analog function, there is a direct connection from the
external pin to the analog circuit. There is no scan chain on the interface between the digital and
the analog circuitry, but some digital control signal to analog circuitry are turned off to avoid driv-
ing contention on the pads.
When JTAG IR contains EXTEST or SAMPLE_PRELOAD the clock is not sent out on the port
pins even if the CKOUT fuse is programmed. Even though the clock is output when the JTAG IR
contains SAMPLE_PRELOAD, the clock is not sampled by the boundary scan.
Figure 28-2. Boundary-scan Cell for Bi-directional Port Pin with Pull-up Function.
To Next Cell
ShiftDR
EXTEST
Vcc
Pull-up Enable (PUE)
0
1
Output Control (OC)
FF1
Q
LD1
0
1
0
1
D
D
Q
G
Output Data (OD)
0
1
FF0
Q
LD0
0
1
0
1
D
D
G
Q
Input Data (ID)
From Last Cell
ClockDR
UpdateDR
307
2549L–AVR–08/07
Figure 28-3. General Port Pin Schematic Diagram
See Boundary-scan
Description for Details!
PUExn
PUD
Q
D
DDxn
Q CLR
WDx
RDx
RESET
OCxn
Q
D
Pxn
PORTxn
ODxn
Q CLR
WRx
RRx
IDxn
RESET
SLEEP
SYNCHRONIZER
RPx
D
Q
D
L
Q
Q
PINxn
Q
CLK I/O
PUD:
PULLUP DISABLE
WDx:
RDx:
WRITE DDRx
PUExn:
OCxn:
ODxn:
IDxn:
PULLUP ENABLE for pin Pxn
OUTPUT CONTROL for pin Pxn
OUTPUT DATA to pin Pxn
INPUT DATA from pin Pxn
SLEEP CONTROL
READ DDRx
WRx:
RRx:
WRITE PORTx
READ PORTx REGISTER
READ PORTx PIN
I/O CLOCK
RPx:
SLEEP:
CLK I/O :
28.5.2
Scanning the RESET Pin
The RESET pin accepts 5V active low logic for standard reset operation, and 12V active high
logic for High Voltage Parallel programming. An observe-only cell as shown in Figure 28-4 is
inserted for the 5V reset signal.
Figure 28-4. Observe-only Cell
To
Next
ShiftDR
Cell
From System Pin
To System Logic
FF1
0
1
D
Q
From
ClockDR
Previous
Cell
308
ATmega640/1280/1281/2560/2561
2549L–AVR–08/07
ATmega640/1280/1281/2560/2561
28.6 Boundary-scan Related Register in I/O Memory
28.6.1
MCUCR – MCU Control Register
The MCU Control Register contains control bits for general MCU functions.
Bit
7
6
–
5
–
4
3
–
2
–
1
IVSEL
R/W
0
0
IVCE
R/W
0
0x35 (0x55)
Read/Write
Initial Value
JTD
R/W
0
PUD
R/W
0
MCUCR
R
0
R
0
R
0
R
0
• Bits 7 – JTD: JTAG Interface Disable
When this bit is zero, the JTAG interface is enabled if the JTAGEN Fuse is programmed. If this
bit is one, the JTAG interface is disabled. In order to avoid unintentional disabling or enabling of
the JTAG interface, a timed sequence must be followed when changing this bit: The application
software must write this bit to the desired value twice within four cycles to change its value. Note
that this bit must not be altered when using the On-chip Debug system.
28.6.2
MCUSR – MCU Status Register
The MCU Status Register provides information on which reset source caused an MCU reset.
Bit
7
–
6
–
5
–
4
3
2
BORF
1
0
0x34 (0x54)
Read/Write
Initial Value
JTRF
R/W
WDRF
R/W
EXTRF
R/W
PORF
R/W
MCUSR
R
0
R
0
R
0
R/W
See Bit Description
• Bit 4 – JTRF: JTAG Reset Flag
This bit is set if a reset is being caused by a logic one in the JTAG Reset Register selected by
the JTAG instruction AVR_RESET. This bit is reset by a Power-on Reset, or by writing a logic
zero to the flag.
28.7 ATmega640/1280/1281/2560/2561 Boundary-scan Order
Table 28-1 shows the Scan order between TDI and TDO when the Boundary-scan chain is
selected as data path. Bit 0 is the LSB; the first bit scanned in, and the first bit scanned out. The
scan order follows the pin-out order as far as possible. Therefore, the bits of Port A and Port K is
scanned in the opposite bit order of the other ports. Exceptions from the rules are the Scan
chains for the analog circuits, which constitute the most significant bits of the scan chain regard-
less of which physical pin they are connected to. In Figure 28-2, PXn. Data corresponds to FF0,
PXn. Control corresponds to FF1, PXn. Bit 4, 5, 6 and 7 of Port F is not in the scan chain, since
these pins constitute the TAP pins when the JTAG is enabled.
28.8 Boundary-scan Description Language Files
Boundary-scan Description Language (BSDL) files describe Boundary-scan capable devices in
a standard format used by automated test-generation software. The order and function of bits in
the Boundary-scan Data Register are included in this description. BSDL files are available for
ATmega1281/2561 and ATmega640/1280/2560.
309
2549L–AVR–08/07
Table 28-1. ATmega640/1280/2560 Boundary-scan Order
Bit Number
164
163
162
161
160
159
158
157
156
155
154
153
152
151
150
149
148
147
146
145
144
143
142
141
140
139
138
137
136
135
134
133
Signal Name
PG5.Data
Module
Port G
PG5.Control
PE0.Data
PE0.Control
PE1.Data
PE1.Control
PE2.Data
PE2.Control
PE3.Data
PE3.Control
PE4.Data
Port E
PE4.Control
PE5.Data
PE5.Control
PE6.Data
PE6.Control
PE7.Data
PE7.Control
PH0.Data
PH0.Control
PH1.Data
Port H
PH1.Control
PH2.Data
PH2.Control
PH3.Data
PH3.Control
PH4.Data
PH4.Control
PH5.Data
PH5.Control
PH6.Data
PH6.Control
310
ATmega640/1280/1281/2560/2561
2549L–AVR–08/07
ATmega640/1280/1281/2560/2561
Table 28-1. ATmega640/1280/2560 Boundary-scan Order (Continued)
Bit Number
132
131
130
129
128
127
126
125
124
123
122
121
120
119
118
117
116
115
114
113
112
111
110
109
108
107
106
105
Signal Name
PB0.Data
Module
PB0.Control
PB1.Data
PB1.Control
PB2.Data
PB2.Control
PB3.Data
PB3.Control
PB4.Data
Port B
PB4.Control
PB5.Data
PB5.Control
PB6.Data
PB6.Control
PB7.Data
PB7.Control
PH7.Data
Port H
PH7.Control
PG3.Data
PG3.Control
PG4.Data
PG4.Control
RSTT
Port G
Reset Logic (Observe Only)
PL0.Data
PL0.Control
PL1.Data
Port L
PL1.Control
PL2.Data
311
2549L–AVR–08/07
Table 28-1. ATmega640/1280/2560 Boundary-scan Order (Continued)
Bit Number
104
103
102
101
100
99
Signal Name
PL2.Control
PL3.Data
Module
PL3.Control
PL4.Data
PL4.Control
PL5.Data
98
PL5.Control
PL6.Data
97
96
PL6.Control
PL7.Data
95
94
PL7.Control
PD0.Data
93
92
PD0.Control
PD1.Data
91
90
PD1.Control
PD2.Data
89
88
PD2.Control
PD3.Data
87
86
PD3.Control
PD4.Data
Port D
85
84
PD4.Control
PD5.Data
83
82
PD5.Control
PD6.Data
81
80
PD6.Control
PD7.Data
79
78
PD7.Control
PG0.Data
77
76
PG0.Control
PG1.Data
Port G
Port C
75
74
PG1.Control
PC0.Data
73
72
PC0.Control
PC1.Data
71
70
PC1.Control
PC2.Data
69
312
ATmega640/1280/1281/2560/2561
2549L–AVR–08/07
ATmega640/1280/1281/2560/2561
Table 28-1. ATmega640/1280/2560 Boundary-scan Order (Continued)
Bit Number
68
Signal Name
PC2.Control
PC3.Data
Module
67
66
PC3.Control
PC4.Data
65
64
PC4.Control
PC5.Data
63
62
PC5.Control
PC6.Data
61
60
PC6.Control
PC7.Data
59
58
PC7.Control
PJ0.Data
57
56
PJ0.Control
PJ1.Data
55
54
PJ1.Control
PJ2.Data
53
52
PJ2.Control
PJ3.Data
51
Port J
50
PJ3.Control
PJ4.Data
49
48
PJ4.Control
PJ5.Data
47
46
PJ5.Control
PJ6.Data
45
44
PJ6.Control
PG2.Data
PG2.Control
PA7.Data
43
Port G
42
41
40
PA7.Control
PA6.Data
39
38
PA6.Control
PA5.Data
37
Port A
36
PA5.Control
PA4.Data
35
34
PA4.Control
PA3.Data
33
313
2549L–AVR–08/07
Table 28-1. ATmega640/1280/2560 Boundary-scan Order (Continued)
Bit Number
Signal Name
PA3.Control
PA2.Data
Module
32
31
30
29
28
27
26
25
24
23
22
21
20
19
18
17
16
15
14
13
12
11
10
9
PA2.Control
PA1.Data
PA1.Control
PA0.Data
PA0.Control
PJ7.Data
Port J
PJ7.Control
PK7.Data
PK7.Control
PK6.Data
PK6.Control
PK5.Data
PK5.Control
PK4.Data
PK4.Control
PK3.Data
Port K
PK3.Control
PK2.Data
PK2.Control
PK1.Data
PK1.Control
PK0.Data
8
PK0.Control
PF3.Data
7
6
PF3.Control
PF2.Data
5
4
PF2.Control
PF1.Data
Port F
3
2
PF1.Control
PF0.Data
1
0
PF0.Control
314
ATmega640/1280/1281/2560/2561
2549L–AVR–08/07
ATmega640/1280/1281/2560/2561
Table 28-2. ATmega1281/2561 Boundary-scan Order
Bit Number
100
99
Signal Name
PG5.Data
Module
Port G
PG5.Control
PE0.Data
98
97
PE0.Control
PE1.Data
96
95
PE1.Control
PE2.Data
94
93
PE2.Control
PE3.Data
92
91
PE3.Control
PE4.Data
Port E
90
89
PE4.Control
PE5.Data
88
87
PE5.Control
PE6.Data
86
85
PE6.Control
PE7.Data
84
83
PE7.Control
PB0.Data
82
81
PB0.Control
PB1.Data
80
79
PB1.Control
PB2.Data
78
77
PB2.Control
PB3.Data
76
75
PB3.Control
PB4.Data
Port B
74
73
PB4.Control
PB5.Data
72
71
PB5.Control
PB6.Data
70
69
PB6.Control
PB7.Data
68
67
PB7.Control
PG3.Data
66
Port G
315
2549L–AVR–08/07
Table 28-2. ATmega1281/2561 Boundary-scan Order (Continued)
Bit Number
65
Signal Name
PG3.Control
PG4.Data
Module
64
63
PG4.Control
RSTT
62
Reset Logic (Observe Only)
61
PD0.Data
60
PD0.Control
PD1.Data
59
58
PD1.Control
PD2.Data
57
56
PD2.Control
PD3.Data
55
54
PD3.Control
PD4.Data
Port D
53
52
PD4.Control
PD5.Data
51
50
PD5.Control
PD6.Data
49
48
PD6.Control
PD7.Data
47
46
PD7.Control
PG0.Data
45
44
PG0.Control
PG1.Data
Port G
43
42
PG1.Control
PC0.Data
41
40
PC0.Control
PC1.Data
39
38
PC1.Control
PC2.Data
37
36
PC2.Control
PC3.Data
Port C
35
34
PC3.Control
PC4.Data
33
32
PC4.Control
PC5.Data
31
30
PC5.Control
316
ATmega640/1280/1281/2560/2561
2549L–AVR–08/07
ATmega640/1280/1281/2560/2561
Table 28-2. ATmega1281/2561 Boundary-scan Order (Continued)
Bit Number
Signal Name
PC6.Data
Module
29
28
27
26
25
24
23
22
21
20
19
18
17
16
15
14
13
12
11
10
9
PC6.Control
PC7.Data
PC7.Control
PG2.Data
PG2.Control
PA7.Data
Port G
PA7.Control
PA6.Data
PA6.Control
PA5.Data
PA5.Control
PA4.Data
PA4.Control
PA3.Data
Port A
PA3.Control
PA2.Data
PA2.Control
PA1.Data
PA1.Control
PA0.Data
8
PA0.Control
PF3.Data
7
6
PF3.Control
PF2.Data
5
4
PF2.Control
PF1.Data
Port F
3
2
PF1.Control
PF0.Data
1
0
PF0.Control
317
2549L–AVR–08/07
29. Boot Loader Support – Read-While-Write Self-Programming
The Boot Loader Support provides a real Read-While-Write Self-Programming mechanism for
downloading and uploading program code by the MCU itself. This feature allows flexible applica-
tion software updates controlled by the MCU using a Flash-resident Boot Loader program. The
Boot Loader program can use any available data interface and associated protocol to read code
and write (program) that code into the Flash memory, or read the code from the program mem-
ory. The program code within the Boot Loader section has the capability to write into the entire
Flash, including the Boot Loader memory. The Boot Loader can thus even modify itself, and it
can also erase itself from the code if the feature is not needed anymore. The size of the Boot
Loader memory is configurable with fuses and the Boot Loader has two separate sets of Boot
Lock bits which can be set independently. This gives the user a unique flexibility to select differ-
ent levels of protection.
29.1 Features
• Read-While-Write Self-Programming
• Flexible Boot Memory Size
• High Security (Separate Boot Lock Bits for a Flexible Protection)
• Separate Fuse to Select Reset Vector
• Optimized Page(1) Size
• Code Efficient Algorithm
• Efficient Read-Modify-Write Support
Note:
1. A page is a section in the Flash consisting of several bytes (see Table 30-7 on page 340) used
during programming. The page organization does not affect normal operation.
29.2 Application and Boot Loader Flash Sections
The Flash memory is organized in two main sections, the Application section and the Boot
Loader section (see Figure 29-2). The size of the different sections is configured by the
BOOTSZ Fuses as shown in Table 29-7 on page 329 and Figure 29-2. These two sections can
have different level of protection since they have different sets of Lock bits.
29.2.1
29.2.2
Application Section
The Application section is the section of the Flash that is used for storing the application code.
The protection level for the Application section can be selected by the application Boot Lock bits
(Boot Lock bits 0), see Table 29-2 on page 322. The Application section can never store any
Boot Loader code since the SPM instruction is disabled when executed from the Application
section.
BLS – Boot Loader Section
While the Application section is used for storing the application code, the The Boot Loader soft-
ware must be located in the BLS since the SPM instruction can initiate a programming when
executing from the BLS only. The SPM instruction can access the entire Flash, including the
BLS itself. The protection level for the Boot Loader section can be selected by the Boot Loader
Lock bits (Boot Lock bits 1), see Table 29-3 on page 322.
29.3 Read-While-Write and No Read-While-Write Flash Sections
Whether the CPU supports Read-While-Write or if the CPU is halted during a Boot Loader soft-
ware update is dependent on which address that is being programmed. In addition to the two
sections that are configurable by the BOOTSZ Fuses as described above, the Flash is also
318
ATmega640/1280/1281/2560/2561
2549L–AVR–08/07
ATmega640/1280/1281/2560/2561
divided into two fixed sections, the Read-While-Write (RWW) section and the No Read-While-
Write (NRWW) section. The limit between the RWW- and NRWW sections is given in Table 29-
1 and Figure 29-1 on page 320. The main difference between the two sections is:
•
When erasing or writing a page located inside the RWW section, the NRWW section can be
read during the operation.
•
When erasing or writing a page located inside the NRWW section, the CPU is halted during
the entire operation.
Note that the user software can never read any code that is located inside the RWW section dur-
ing a Boot Loader software operation. The syntax “Read-While-Write section” refers to which
section that is being programmed (erased or written), not which section that actually is being
read during a Boot Loader software update.
29.3.1
RWW – Read-While-Write Section
If a Boot Loader software update is programming a page inside the RWW section, it is possible
to read code from the Flash, but only code that is located in the NRWW section. During an on-
going programming, the software must ensure that the RWW section never is being read. If the
user software is trying to read code that is located inside the RWW section (i.e., by load program
memory, call, or jump instructions or an interrupt) during programming, the software might end
up in an unknown state. To avoid this, the interrupts should either be disabled or moved to the
Boot Loader section. The Boot Loader section is always located in the NRWW section. The
RWW Section Busy bit (RWWSB) in the Store Program Memory Control and Status Register
(SPMCSR) will be read as logical one as long as the RWW section is blocked for reading. After
a programming is completed, the RWWSB must be cleared by software before reading code
located in the RWW section. See “SPMCSR – Store Program Memory Control and Status Reg-
ister” on page 334. for details on how to clear RWWSB.
29.3.2
NRWW – No Read-While-Write Section
The code located in the NRWW section can be read when the Boot Loader software is updating
a page in the RWW section. When the Boot Loader code updates the NRWW section, the CPU
is halted during the entire Page Erase or Page Write operation.
Table 29-1. Read-While-Write Features
Which Section does the Z-pointer
Address during the Programming?
Which Section can be
Read-While-Write
Supported?
Read during Programming?
NRWW Section
None
CPU Halted?
RWW Section
No
Yes
NRWW Section
Yes
No
319
2549L–AVR–08/07
Figure 29-1. Read-While-Write vs. No Read-While-Write
Read-While-Write
(RWW) Section
Z-pointer
Addresses NRWW
Section
Z-pointer
No Read-While-Write
(NRWW) Section
Addresses RWW
Section
CPU is Halted
During the Operation
Code Located in
NRWW Section
Can be Read During
the Operation
320
ATmega640/1280/1281/2560/2561
2549L–AVR–08/07
ATmega640/1280/1281/2560/2561
Figure 29-2. Memory Sections
Program Memory
BOOTSZ = '10'
Program Memory
BOOTSZ = '11'
0x0000
0x0000
Application Flash Section
Application Flash Section
End RWW
End RWW
Start NRWW
Start NRWW
Application Flash Section
Boot Loader Flash Section
Application Flash Section
Boot Loader Flash Section
End Application
End Application
Start Boot Loader
Flashend
Start Boot Loader
Flashend
0x0000
Program Memory
BOOTSZ = '01'
Program Memory
BOOTSZ = '00'
0x0000
Application Flash Section
Application Flash Section
End RWW, End Application
End RWW
Start NRWW, Start Boot Loader
Start NRWW
Application Flash Section
Boot Loader Flash Section
End Application
Boot Loader Flash Section
Start Boot Loader
Flashend
Flashend
Note:
1. The parameters in the figure above are given in Table 29-7 on page 329.
29.4 Boot Loader Lock Bits
If no Boot Loader capability is needed, the entire Flash is available for application code. The
Boot Loader has two separate sets of Boot Lock bits which can be set independently. This gives
the user a unique flexibility to select different levels of protection.
The user can select:
•
•
•
•
To protect the entire Flash from a software update by the MCU.
To protect only the Boot Loader Flash section from a software update by the MCU.
To protect only the Application Flash section from a software update by the MCU.
Allow software update in the entire Flash.
See Table 29-2 and Table 29-3 for further details. The Boot Lock bits can be set in software and
in Serial or Parallel Programming mode, but they can be cleared by a Chip Erase command
only. The general Write Lock (Lock Bit mode 2) does not control the programming of the Flash
memory by SPM instruction. Similarly, the general Read/Write Lock (Lock Bit mode 1) does not
control reading nor writing by (E)LPM/SPM, if it is attempted.
321
2549L–AVR–08/07
Table 29-2. Boot Lock Bit0 Protection Modes (Application Section)(Note:)
BLB0 Mode
BLB02
BLB01
Protection
No restrictions for SPM or (E)LPM accessing the Application
section.
1
2
1
1
1
0
SPM is not allowed to write to the Application section.
SPM is not allowed to write to the Application section, and
(E)LPM executing from the Boot Loader section is not allowed to
read from the Application section. If Interrupt Vectors are placed
in the Boot Loader section, interrupts are disabled while
executing from the Application section.
3
4
0
0
0
1
(E)LPM executing from the Boot Loader section is not allowed to
read from the Application section. If Interrupt Vectors are placed
in the Boot Loader section, interrupts are disabled while
executing from the Application section.
Note:
“1” means unprogrammed, “0” means programmed
Table 29-3. Boot Lock Bit1 Protection Modes (Boot Loader Section)(Note:)
BLB1 Mode
BLB12
BLB11
Protection
No restrictions for SPM or (E)LPM accessing the Boot Loader
section.
1
2
1
1
1
0
SPM is not allowed to write to the Boot Loader section.
SPM is not allowed to write to the Boot Loader section, and
(E)LPM executing from the Application section is not allowed to
read from the Boot Loader section. If Interrupt Vectors are
placed in the Application section, interrupts are disabled while
executing from the Boot Loader section.
3
4
0
0
0
1
(E)LPM executing from the Application section is not allowed to
read from the Boot Loader section. If Interrupt Vectors are
placed in the Application section, interrupts are disabled while
executing from the Boot Loader section.
Note:
“1” means unprogrammed, “0” means programmed
29.4.1
Entering the Boot Loader Program
Entering the Boot Loader takes place by a jump or call from the application program. This may
be initiated by a trigger such as a command received via USART, or SPI interface. Alternatively,
the Boot Reset Fuse can be programmed so that the Reset Vector is pointing to the Boot Flash
start address after a reset. In this case, the Boot Loader is started after a reset. After the applica-
tion code is loaded, the program can start executing the application code. Note that the fuses
cannot be changed by the MCU itself. This means that once the Boot Reset Fuse is pro-
grammed, the Reset Vector will always point to the Boot Loader Reset and the fuse can only be
changed through the serial or parallel programming interface.
Table 29-4. Boot Reset Fuse(Note:)
BOOTRST
Reset Address
1
0
Reset Vector = Application Reset (address 0x0000)
Reset Vector = Boot Loader Reset (see Table 29-7 on page 329)
Note:
“1” means unprogrammed, “0” means programmed
322
ATmega640/1280/1281/2560/2561
2549L–AVR–08/07
ATmega640/1280/1281/2560/2561
29.5 Addressing the Flash During Self-Programming
The Z-pointer is used to address the SPM commands. The Z pointer consists of the Z-registers
ZL and ZH in the register file, and RAMPZ in the I/O space. The number of bits actually used is
implementation dependent. Note that the RAMPZ register is only implemented when the pro-
gram space is larger than 64K bytes.
Bit
23
15
22
14
21
13
20
12
19
11
18
10
17
16
9
8
RAMPZ
ZH (R31)
ZL (R30)
RAMPZ7
Z15
Z7
RAMPZ6
Z14
Z6
RAMPZ5
Z13
Z5
RAMPZ4
Z12
Z4
RAMPZ3
Z11
Z3
RAMPZ2
Z10
Z2
RAMPZ1
RAMPZ0
Z9
Z1
1
Z8
Z0
0
7
6
5
4
3
2
Since the Flash is organized in pages (see Table 30-7 on page 340), the Program Counter can
be treated as having two different sections. One section, consisting of the least significant bits, is
addressing the words within a page, while the most significant bits are addressing the pages.
This is shown in Figure 29-3. Note that the Page Erase and Page Write operations are
addressed independently. Therefore it is of major importance that the Boot Loader software
addresses the same page in both the Page Erase and Page Write operation. Once a program-
ming operation is initiated, the address is latched and the Z-pointer can be used for other
operations.
The (E)LPM instruction use the Z-pointer to store the address. Since this instruction addresses
the Flash byte-by-byte, also bit Z0 of the Z-pointer is used.
Figure 29-3. Addressing the Flash During SPM(Note:)
BIT 15
ZPCMSB
ZPAGEMSB
1
0
Z - REGISTER
0
PCMSB
PAGEMSB
PCWORD
PROGRAM
COUNTER
PCPAGE
PAGE ADDRESS
WITHIN THE FLASH
WORD ADDRESS
WITHIN A PAGE
PROGRAM MEMORY
PAGE
PAGE
INSTRUCTION WORD
PCWORD[PAGEMSB:0]:
00
01
02
PAGEEND
Note:
The different variables used in Figure 29-3 are listed in Table 29-9 on page 330.
323
2549L–AVR–08/07
29.6 Self-Programming the Flash
The program memory is updated in a page by page fashion. Before programming a page with
the data stored in the temporary page buffer, the page must be erased. The temporary page
buffer is filled one word at a time using SPM and the buffer can be filled either before the Page
Erase command or between a Page Erase and a Page Write operation:
Alternative 1, fill the buffer before a Page Erase
•
•
•
Fill temporary page buffer
Perform a Page Erase
Perform a Page Write
Alternative 2, fill the buffer after Page Erase
•
•
•
Perform a Page Erase
Fill temporary page buffer
Perform a Page Write
If only a part of the page needs to be changed, the rest of the page must be stored (for example
in the temporary page buffer) before the erase, and then be rewritten. When using alternative 1,
the Boot Loader provides an effective Read-Modify-Write feature which allows the user software
to first read the page, do the necessary changes, and then write back the modified data. If alter-
native 2 is used, it is not possible to read the old data while loading since the page is already
erased. The temporary page buffer can be accessed in a random sequence. It is essential that
the page address used in both the Page Erase and Page Write operation is addressing the same
page. See “Simple Assembly Code Example for a Boot Loader” on page 328 for an assembly
code example.
29.6.1
Performing Page Erase by SPM
To execute Page Erase, set up the address in the Z-pointer, write “X0000011” to SPMCSR and
execute SPM within four clock cycles after writing SPMCSR. The data in R1 and R0 is ignored.
The page address must be written to PCPAGE in the Z-register. Other bits in the Z-pointer will
be ignored during this operation.
•
•
Page Erase to the RWW section: The NRWW section can be read during the Page Erase.
Page Erase to the NRWW section: The CPU is halted during the operation.
29.6.2
Filling the Temporary Buffer (Page Loading)
To write an instruction word, set up the address in the Z-pointer and data in R1:R0, write
“00000001” to SPMCSR and execute SPM within four clock cycles after writing SPMCSR. The
content of PCWORD in the Z-register is used to address the data in the temporary buffer. The
temporary buffer will auto-erase after a Page Write operation or by writing the RWWSRE bit in
SPMCSR. It is also erased after a system reset. Note that it is not possible to write more than
one time to each address without erasing the temporary buffer.
If the EEPROM is written in the middle of an SPM Page Load operation, all data loaded is still
buffered.
324
ATmega640/1280/1281/2560/2561
2549L–AVR–08/07
ATmega640/1280/1281/2560/2561
29.6.3
Performing a Page Write
To execute Page Write, set up the address in the Z-pointer, write “X0000101” to SPMCSR and
execute SPM within four clock cycles after writing SPMCSR. The data in R1 and R0 is ignored.
The page address must be written to PCPAGE. Other bits in the Z-pointer must be written to
zero during this operation.
•
•
Page Write to the RWW section: The NRWW section can be read during the Page Write.
Page Write to the NRWW section: The CPU is halted during the operation.
29.6.4
29.6.5
29.6.6
Using the SPM Interrupt
If the SPM interrupt is enabled, the SPM interrupt will generate a constant interrupt when the
SPMEN bit in SPMCSR is cleared. This means that the interrupt can be used instead of polling
the SPMCSR Register in software. When using the SPM interrupt, the Interrupt Vectors should
be moved to the BLS section to avoid that an interrupt is accessing the RWW section when it is
blocked for reading. How to move the interrupts is described in “Interrupts” on page 105.
Consideration While Updating BLS
Special care must be taken if the user allows the Boot Loader section to be updated by leaving
Boot Lock bit11 unprogrammed. An accidental write to the Boot Loader itself can corrupt the
entire Boot Loader, and further software updates might be impossible. If it is not necessary to
change the Boot Loader software itself, it is recommended to program the Boot Lock bit11 to
protect the Boot Loader software from any internal software changes.
Prevent Reading the RWW Section During Self-Programming
During Self-Programming (either Page Erase or Page Write), the RWW section is always
blocked for reading. The user software itself must prevent that this section is addressed during
the self programming operation. The RWWSB in the SPMCSR will be set as long as the RWW
section is busy. During Self-Programming the Interrupt Vector table should be moved to the BLS
as described in “Interrupts” on page 105, or the interrupts must be disabled. Before addressing
the RWW section after the programming is completed, the user software must clear the
RWWSB by writing the RWWSRE. See “Simple Assembly Code Example for a Boot Loader” on
page 328 for an example.
29.6.7
Setting the Boot Loader Lock Bits by SPM
To set the Boot Loader Lock bits and general Lock bits, write the desired data to R0, write
“X0001001” to SPMCSR and execute SPM within four clock cycles after writing SPMCSR.
Bit
R0
7
6
5
4
3
2
1
0
1
1
BLB12
BLB11
BLB02
BLB01
LB2
LB1
See Table 29-2 and Table 29-3 for how the different settings of the Boot Loader bits affect the
Flash access.
If bits 5:0 in R0 are cleared (zero), the corresponding Lock bit will be programmed if an SPM
instruction is executed within four cycles after BLBSET and SPMEN are set in SPMCSR. The Z-
pointer is don’t care during this operation, but for future compatibility it is recommended to load
the Z-pointer with 0x0001 (same as used for reading the lOck bits). For future compatibility it is
also recommended to set bits 7 and 6 in R0 to “1” when writing the Lock bits. When program-
ming the Lock bits the entire Flash can be read during the operation.
325
2549L–AVR–08/07
29.6.8
29.6.9
EEPROM Write Prevents Writing to SPMCSR
Note that an EEPROM write operation will block all software programming to Flash. Reading the
Fuses and Lock bits from software will also be prevented during the EEPROM write operation. It
is recommended that the user checks the status bit (EEPE) in the EECR Register and verifies
that the bit is cleared before writing to the SPMCSR Register.
Reading the Fuse and Lock Bits from Software
It is possible to read both the Fuse and Lock bits from software. To read the Lock bits, load the
Z-pointer with 0x0001 and set the BLBSET and SPMEN bits in SPMCSR. When an (E)LPM
instruction is executed within three CPU cycles after the BLBSET and SPMEN bits are set in
SPMCSR, the value of the Lock bits will be loaded in the destination register. The BLBSET and
SPMEN bits will auto-clear upon completion of reading the Lock bits or if no (E)LPM instruction
is executed within three CPU cycles or no SPM instruction is executed within four CPU cycles.
When BLBSET and SPMEN are cleared, (E)LPM will work as described in the Instruction set
Manual.
Bit
Rd
7
6
5
4
3
2
1
0
–
–
BLB12
BLB11
BLB02
BLB01
LB2
LB1
The algorithm for reading the Fuse Low byte is similar to the one described above for reading
the Lock bits. To read the Fuse Low byte, load the Z-pointer with 0x0000 and set the BLBSET
and SPMEN bits in SPMCSR. When an (E)LPM instruction is executed within three cycles after
the BLBSET and SPMEN bits are set in the SPMCSR, the value of the Fuse Low byte (FLB) will
be loaded in the destination register as shown below. Refer to Table 30-5 on page 339 for a
detailed description and mapping of the Fuse Low byte.
Bit
Rd
7
6
5
4
3
2
1
0
FLB7
FLB6
FLB5
FLB4
FLB3
FLB2
FLB1
FLB0
Similarly, when reading the Fuse High byte, load 0x0003 in the Z-pointer. When an (E)LPM
instruction is executed within three cycles after the BLBSET and SPMEN bits are set in the
SPMCSR, the value of the Fuse High byte (FHB) will be loaded in the destination register as
shown below. Refer to Table 30-4 on page 339 for detailed description and mapping of the Fuse
High byte.
Bit
Rd
7
6
5
4
3
2
1
0
FHB7
FHB6
FHB5
FHB4
FHB3
FHB2
FHB1
FHB0
When reading the Extended Fuse byte, load 0x0002 in the Z-pointer. When an (E)LPM instruc-
tion is executed within three cycles after the BLBSET and SPMEN bits are set in the SPMCSR,
the value of the Extended Fuse byte (EFB) will be loaded in the destination register as shown
below. Refer to Table 30-3 on page 338 for detailed description and mapping of the Extended
Fuse byte.
Bit
Rd
7
6
5
4
3
2
1
0
–
–
–
–
–
EFB2
EFB1
EFB0
Fuse and Lock bits that are programmed, will be read as zero. Fuse and Lock bits that are
unprogrammed, will be read as one.
29.6.10 Reading the Signature Row from Software
To read the Signature Row from software, load the Z-pointer with the signature byte address
given in Table 29-5 on page 327 and set the SIGRD and SPMEN bits in SPMCSR. When an
LPM instruction is executed within three CPU cycles after the SIGRD and SPMEN bits are set in
326
ATmega640/1280/1281/2560/2561
2549L–AVR–08/07
ATmega640/1280/1281/2560/2561
SPMCSR, the signature byte value will be loaded in the destination register. The SIGRD and
SPMEN bits will auto-clear upon completion of reading the Signature Row Lock bits or if no LPM
instruction is executed within three CPU cycles. When SIGRD and SPMEN are cleared, LPM will
work as described in the Instruction set Manual.
Table 29-5. Signature Row Addressing
Signature Byte
Z-Pointer Address
0x0000
Device Signature Byte 1
Device Signature Byte 2
Device Signature Byte 3
RC Oscillator Calibration Byte
0x0002
0x0004
0x0001
Note:
All other addresses are reserved for future use.
29.6.11 Preventing Flash Corruption
During periods of low VCC, the Flash program can be corrupted because the supply voltage is
too low for the CPU and the Flash to operate properly. These issues are the same as for board
level systems using the Flash, and the same design solutions should be applied.
A Flash program corruption can be caused by two situations when the voltage is too low. First, a
regular write sequence to the Flash requires a minimum voltage to operate correctly. Secondly,
the CPU itself can execute instructions incorrectly, if the supply voltage for executing instructions
is too low.
Flash corruption can easily be avoided by following these design recommendations (one is
sufficient):
1. If there is no need for a Boot Loader update in the system, program the Boot Loader Lock
bits to prevent any Boot Loader software updates.
2. Keep the AVR RESET active (low) during periods of insufficient power supply voltage.
This can be done by enabling the internal Brown-out Detector (BOD) if the operating volt-
age matches the detection level. If not, an external low VCC reset protection circuit can be
used. If a reset occurs while a write operation is in progress, the write operation will be
completed provided that the power supply voltage is sufficient.
3. Keep the AVR core in Power-down sleep mode during periods of low VCC. This will pre-
vent the CPU from attempting to decode and execute instructions, effectively protecting
the SPMCSR Register and thus the Flash from unintentional writes.
29.6.12 Programming Time for Flash when Using SPM
The calibrated RC Oscillator is used to time Flash accesses. Table 29-6 shows the typical pro-
gramming time for Flash accesses from the CPU.
Table 29-6. SPM Programming Time
Symbol
Min Programming Time
Max Programming Time
Flash write (Page Erase, Page Write, and
write Lock bits by SPM)
3.7 ms
4.5 ms
327
2549L–AVR–08/07
29.6.13 Simple Assembly Code Example for a Boot Loader
;-the routine writes one page of data from RAM to Flash
; the first data location in RAM is pointed to by the Y pointer
; the first data location in Flash is pointed to by the Z-pointer
;-error handling is not included
;-the routine must be placed inside the Boot space
; (at least the Do_spm sub routine). Only code inside NRWW section can
; be read during Self-Programming (Page Erase and Page Write).
;-registers used: r0, r1, temp1 (r16), temp2 (r17), looplo (r24),
; loophi (r25), spmcrval (r20)
; storing and restoring of registers is not included in the routine
; register usage can be optimized at the expense of code size
;-It is assumed that either the interrupt table is moved to the Boot
; loader section or that the interrupts are disabled.
.equ PAGESIZEB = PAGESIZE*2
.org SMALLBOOTSTART
Write_page:
;PAGESIZEB is page size in BYTES, not words
; Page Erase
ldi spmcrval, (1<<PGERS) | (1<<SPMEN)
call Do_spm
; re-enable the RWW section
ldi spmcrval, (1<<RWWSRE) | (1<<SPMEN)
call Do_spm
; transfer data from RAM to Flash page buffer
ldi looplo, low(PAGESIZEB)
;init loop variable
ldi loophi, high(PAGESIZEB) ;not required for PAGESIZEB<=256
Wrloop:
ld
ld
r0, Y+
r1, Y+
ldi spmcrval, (1<<SPMEN)
call Do_spm
adiw ZH:ZL, 2
sbiw loophi:looplo, 2
brne Wrloop
;use subi for PAGESIZEB<=256
; execute Page Write
subi ZL, low(PAGESIZEB)
sbci ZH, high(PAGESIZEB)
;restore pointer
;not required for PAGESIZEB<=256
ldi spmcrval, (1<<PGWRT) | (1<<SPMEN)
call Do_spm
; re-enable the RWW section
ldi spmcrval, (1<<RWWSRE) | (1<<SPMEN)
call Do_spm
; read back and check, optional
ldi looplo, low(PAGESIZEB)
;init loop variable
ldi loophi, high(PAGESIZEB) ;not required for PAGESIZEB<=256
subi YL, low(PAGESIZEB)
sbci YH, high(PAGESIZEB)
Rdloop:
;restore pointer
elpm r0, Z+
ld
r1, Y+
cpse r0, r1
jmp Error
sbiw loophi:looplo, 1
brne Rdloop
;use subi for PAGESIZEB<=256
328
ATmega640/1280/1281/2560/2561
2549L–AVR–08/07
ATmega640/1280/1281/2560/2561
; return to RWW section
; verify that RWW section is safe to read
Return:
in
temp1, SPMCSR
sbrs temp1, RWWSB
ret
; If RWWSB is set, the RWW section is not ready yet
; re-enable the RWW section
ldi spmcrval, (1<<RWWSRE) | (1<<SPMEN)
call Do_spm
rjmp Return
Do_spm:
; check for previous SPM complete
Wait_spm:
in
temp1, SPMCSR
sbrc temp1, SPMEN
rjmp Wait_spm
; input: spmcrval determines SPM action
; disable interrupts if enabled, store status
in
temp2, SREG
cli
; check that no EEPROM write access is present
Wait_ee:
sbic EECR, EEPE
rjmp Wait_ee
; SPM timed sequence
out SPMCSR, spmcrval
spm
; restore SREG (to enable interrupts if originally enabled)
out SREG, temp2
ret
29.6.14 ATmega640 Boot Loader Parameters
In Table 29-7 through Table 29-9, the parameters used in the description of the Self-Program-
ming are given.
Table 29-7. Boot Size Configuration, ATmega640(Note:)
512
words
0x0000 -
0x7DFF
0x7E00 -
0x7FFF
1
1
0
0
1
0
1
0
4
8
0x7DFF
0x7BFF
0x77FF
0x6FFF
0x7E00
0x7C00
0x7800
0x7000
1024
words
0x0000 -
0x7BFF
0x7C00 -
0x7FFF
2048
words
0x0000 -
0x77FF
0x7800 -
0x7FFF
16
32
4096
words
0x0000 -
0x6FFF
0x7000 -
0x7FFF
329
2549L–AVR–08/07
Note:
The different BOOTSZ Fuse configurations are shown in Figure 29-2.
Table 29-8. Read-While-Write Limit, ATmega640
Section(1)
Pages
224
Address
Read-While-Write section (RWW)
No Read-While-Write section (NRWW)
0x0000 - 0x6FFF
0x7000 - 0x7FFF
32
Note:
1. For details about these two section, see “NRWW – No Read-While-Write Section” on page
319 and “RWW – Read-While-Write Section” on page 319.
Table 29-9. Explanation of different variables used in Figure 29-3 and the mapping to the Z-
pointer, ATmega640
Corresponding
Variable
Z-value(2)
Description(1)
Most significant bit in the Program Counter.
(The Program Counter is 15 bits PC[14:0])
PCMSB
14
6
Most significant bit which is used to address
the words within one page (128 words in a
page requires seven bits PC [6:0]).
PAGEMSB
ZPCMSB
Bit in Z-pointer that is mapped to PCMSB.
Because Z0 is not used, the ZPCMSB equals
PCMSB + 1.
Z15
Bit in Z-pointer that is mapped to PCMSB.
Because Z0 is not used, the ZPAGEMSB
equals PAGEMSB + 1.
ZPAGEMSB
PCPAGE
Z7
Program Counter page address: Page select,
for Page Erase and Page Write
PC[14:7]
PC[6:0]
Z15:Z8
Z7:Z1
Program Counter word address: Word select,
for filling temporary buffer (must be zero
during Page Write operation)
PCWORD
Note:
1. Z0: should be zero for all SPM commands, byte select for the (E)LPM instruction.
2. See “Addressing the Flash During Self-Programming” on page 323 for details about the use of
Z-pointer during Self-Programming.
330
ATmega640/1280/1281/2560/2561
2549L–AVR–08/07
ATmega640/1280/1281/2560/2561
29.6.15 ATmega1280/1281 Boot Loader Parameters
In Table 29-10 through Table 29-11, the parameters used in the description of the Self-Program-
ming are given.
Table 29-10. Boot Size Configuration, ATmega1280/1281(1)
512
words
0x0000 -
0xFDFF
0xFE00 -
0xFFFF
1
1
0
0
1
0
1
0
4
8
0xFDFF
0xFBFF
0xF7FF
0xEFFF
0xFE00
0xFC00
0xF800
0xF000
1024
words
0x0000 -
0xFBFF
0xFC00 -
0xFFFF
2048
words
0x0000 -
0xF7FF
0xF800 -
0xFFFF
16
32
4096
words
0x0000 -
0xEFFF
0xF000 -
0xFFFF
Note:
1. The different BOOTSZ Fuse configurations are shown in Figure 29-2.
Table 29-11. Read-While-Write Limit, ATmega1280/1281
Section(1)
Pages
Address
Read-While-Write section (RWW)
No Read-While-Write section (NRWW)
480
32
0x0000 - 0xEFFF
0xF000 - 0xFFFF
Note:
1. For details about these two section, see “NRWW – No Read-While-Write Section” on page
319 and “RWW – Read-While-Write Section” on page 319.
Table 29-12. Explanation of different variables used in Figure 29-3 and the mapping to the Z-
pointer, ATmega1280/1281
Corresponding
Variable
Z-value(2)
Description(1)
Most significant bit in the Program Counter. (The
Program Counter is 16 bits PC[15:0])
PCMSB
15
331
2549L–AVR–08/07
Table 29-12. Explanation of different variables used in Figure 29-3 and the mapping to the Z-
pointer, ATmega1280/1281
Corresponding
Variable
Z-value(2)
Description(1)
Most significant bit which is used to address the
words within one page (128 words in a page
requires seven bits PC [6:0]).
PAGEMSB
6
Bit in Z-pointer that is mapped to PCMSB. Because
Z0 is not used, the ZPCMSB equals PCMSB + 1.
ZPCMSB
ZPAGEMSB
PCPAGE
Z16(3)
Z7
Bit in Z-pointer that is mapped to PCMSB. Because
Z0 is not used, the ZPAGEMSB equals PAGEMSB +
1.
Program Counter page address: Page select, for
Page Erase and Page Write
PC[15:7]
PC[6:0]
Z16(3):Z8
Z7:Z1
Program Counter word address: Word select, for
filling temporary buffer (must be zero during Page
Write operation)
PCWORD
Notes: 1. Z0: should be zero for all SPM commands, byte select for the (E)LPM instruction.
2. See “Addressing the Flash During Self-Programming” on page 323 for details about the use of
Z-pointer during Self-Programming.
3. The Z-register is only 16 bits wide. Bit 16 is located in the RAMPZ register in the I/O map.
29.6.16 ATmega2560/2561 Boot Loader Parameters
In Table 29-13 through Table 29-15, the parameters used in the description of the Self-Program-
ming are given.
Table 29-13. Boot Size Configuration, ATmega2560/2561(1)
512
words
0x00000 -
0x1FDFF
0x1FE00 -
0x1FFFF
1
1
0
0
1
0
1
0
4
8
0x1FDFF
0x1FBFF
0x1F7FF
0x1EFFF
0x1FE00
0x1FC00
0x1F800
0x1F000
1024
words
0x00000 -
0x1FBFF
0x1FC00 -
0x1FFFF
2048
words
0x00000 -
0x1F7FF
0x1F800 -
0x1FFFF
16
32
4096
words
0x00000 -
0x1EFFF
0x1F000 -
0x1FFFF
Note:
1. The different BOOTSZ Fuse configurations are shown in Figure 29-2.
332
ATmega640/1280/1281/2560/2561
2549L–AVR–08/07
ATmega640/1280/1281/2560/2561
Table 29-14. Read-While-Write Limit, ATmega2560/2561
Section(1)
Pages
992
Address
Read-While-Write section (RWW)
No Read-While-Write section (NRWW)
0x00000 - 0x1EFFF
0x1F000 - 0x1FFFF
32
Note:
1. For details about these two section, see “NRWW – No Read-While-Write Section” on page
319 and “RWW – Read-While-Write Section” on page 319.
333
2549L–AVR–08/07
Table 29-15. Explanation of different variables used in Figure 29-3 and the mapping to the Z-
pointer, ATmega2560/2561
Corresponding
Variable
Z-value(2)
Description(1)
Most significant bit in the Program Counter. (The
Program Counter is 17 bits PC[16:0])
PCMSB
16
6
Most significant bit which is used to address the
words within one page (128 words in a page
requires seven bits PC [6:0]).
PAGEMSB
ZPCMSB
Bit in Z-pointer that is mapped to PCMSB. Because
Z0 is not used, the ZPCMSB equals PCMSB + 1.
Z17:Z16(3)
Z7
Bit in Z-pointer that is mapped to PCMSB. Because
Z0 is not used, the ZPAGEMSB equals PAGEMSB +
1.
ZPAGEMSB
PCPAGE
Program Counter page address: Page select, for
Page Erase and Page Write
PC[16:7]
PC[6:0]
Z17(3):Z8
Z7:Z1
Program Counter word address: Word select, for
filling temporary buffer (must be zero during Page
Write operation)
PCWORD
Notes: 1. Z0: should be zero for all SPM commands, byte select for the (E)LPM instruction.
2. See “Addressing the Flash During Self-Programming” on page 323 for details about the use of
Z-pointer during Self-Programming.
3. The Z-register is only 16 bits wide. Bit 16 is located in the RAMPZ register in the I/O map.
29.7 Register Description
29.7.1
SPMCSR – Store Program Memory Control and Status Register
The Store Program Memory Control and Status Register contains the control bits needed to con-
trol the Boot Loader operations.
Bit
7
SPMIE
R/W
0
6
5
SIGRD
R/W
0
4
RWWSRE
R/W
3
BLBSET
R/W
0
2
PGWRT
R/W
0
1
PGERS
R/W
0
0
SPMEN
R/W
0
RWWSB
SPMCSR
0x37 (0x57)
Read/Write
Initial Value
R
0
0
• Bit 7 – SPMIE: SPM Interrupt Enable
When the SPMIE bit is written to one, and the I-bit in the Status Register is set (one), the SPM
ready interrupt will be enabled. The SPM ready Interrupt will be executed as long as the SPMEN
bit in the SPMCSR Register is cleared.
• Bit 6 – RWWSB: Read-While-Write Section Busy
When a Self-Programming (Page Erase or Page Write) operation to the RWW section is initi-
ated, the RWWSB will be set (one) by hardware. When the RWWSB bit is set, the RWW section
cannot be accessed. The RWWSB bit will be cleared if the RWWSRE bit is written to one after a
Self-Programming operation is completed. Alternatively the RWWSB bit will automatically be
cleared if a page load operation is initiated.
• Bit 5 – SIGRD: Signature Row Read
334
ATmega640/1280/1281/2560/2561
2549L–AVR–08/07
ATmega640/1280/1281/2560/2561
If this bit is written to one at the same time as SPMEN, the next LPM instruction within three
clock cycles will read a byte from the signature row into the destination register. see “Reading
the Signature Row from Software” on page 326 for details. An SPM instruction within four cycles
after SIGRD and SPMEN are set will have no effect. This operation is reserved for future use
and should not be used.
• Bit 4 – RWWSRE: Read-While-Write Section Read Enable
When programming (Page Erase or Page Write) to the RWW section, the RWW section is
blocked for reading (the RWWSB will be set by hardware). To re-enable the RWW section, the
user software must wait until the programming is completed (SPMEN will be cleared). Then, if
the RWWSRE bit is written to one at the same time as SPMEN, the next SPM instruction within
four clock cycles re-enables the RWW section. The RWW section cannot be re-enabled while
the Flash is busy with a Page Erase or a Page Write (SPMEN is set). If the RWWSRE bit is writ-
ten while the Flash is being loaded, the Flash load operation will abort and the data loaded will
be lost.
• Bit 3 – BLBSET: Boot Lock Bit Set
If this bit is written to one at the same time as SPMEN, the next SPM instruction within four clock
cycles sets Boot Lock bits, according to the data in R0. The data in R1 and the address in the Z-
pointer are ignored. The BLBSET bit will automatically be cleared upon completion of the Lock
bit set, or if no SPM instruction is executed within four clock cycles.
An (E)LPM instruction within three cycles after BLBSET and SPMEN are set in the SPMCSR
Register, will read either the Lock bits or the Fuse bits (depending on Z0 in the Z-pointer) into the
destination register. See “Reading the Fuse and Lock Bits from Software” on page 326 for
details.
• Bit 2 – PGWRT: Page Write
If this bit is written to one at the same time as SPMEN, the next SPM instruction within four clock
cycles executes Page Write, with the data stored in the temporary buffer. The page address is
taken from the high part of the Z-pointer. The data in R1 and R0 are ignored. The PGWRT bit
will auto-clear upon completion of a Page Write, or if no SPM instruction is executed within four
clock cycles. The CPU is halted during the entire Page Write operation if the NRWW section is
addressed.
• Bit 1 – PGERS: Page Erase
If this bit is written to one at the same time as SPMEN, the next SPM instruction within four clock
cycles executes Page Erase. The page address is taken from the high part of the Z-pointer. The
data in R1 and R0 are ignored. The PGERS bit will auto-clear upon completion of a Page Erase,
or if no SPM instruction is executed within four clock cycles. The CPU is halted during the entire
Page Write operation if the NRWW section is addressed.
• Bit 0 – SPMEN: Store Program Memory Enable
This bit enables the SPM instruction for the next four clock cycles. If written to one together with
either RWWSRE, BLBSET, PGWRT’ or PGERS, the following SPM instruction will have a spe-
cial meaning, see description above. If only SPMEN is written, the following SPM instruction will
store the value in R1:R0 in the temporary page buffer addressed by the Z-pointer. The LSB of
the Z-pointer is ignored. The SPMEN bit will auto-clear upon completion of an SPM instruction,
or if no SPM instruction is executed within four clock cycles. During Page Erase and Page Write,
the SPMEN bit remains high until the operation is completed.
335
2549L–AVR–08/07
Writing any other combination than “10001”, “01001”, “00101”, “00011” or “00001” in the lower
five bits will have no effect.
Note:
Only one SPM instruction should be active at any time.
336
ATmega640/1280/1281/2560/2561
2549L–AVR–08/07
ATmega640/1280/1281/2560/2561
30. Memory Programming
30.1 Program And Data Memory Lock Bits
The ATmega640/1280/1281/2560/2561 provides six Lock bits which can be left unprogrammed
(“1”) or can be programmed (“0”) to obtain the additional features listed in Table 30-2. The Lock
bits can only be erased to “1” with the Chip Erase command.
Table 30-1. Lock Bit Byte(1)
Lock Bit Byte
Bit No
Description
–
Default Value
7
6
5
4
3
2
1
0
1 (unprogrammed)
1 (unprogrammed)
1 (unprogrammed)
1 (unprogrammed)
1 (unprogrammed)
1 (unprogrammed)
1 (unprogrammed)
1 (unprogrammed)
–
BLB12
Boot Lock bit
Boot Lock bit
Boot Lock bit
Boot Lock bit
Lock bit
BLB11
BLB02
BLB01
LB2
LB1
Lock bit
Note:
Table 30-2. Lock Bit Protection Modes(1)(2)
Memory Lock Bits Protection Type
1. “1” means unprogrammed, “0” means programmed
LB Mode
LB2
LB1
1
1
1
No memory lock features enabled.
Further programming of the Flash and EEPROM is disabled in
Parallel and Serial Programming mode. The Fuse bits are
locked in both Serial and Parallel Programming mode.(1)
2
1
0
0
0
Further programming and verification of the Flash and EEPROM
is disabled in Parallel and Serial Programming mode. The Boot
Lock bits and Fuse bits are locked in both Serial and Parallel
Programming mode.(1)
3
BLB0 Mode
BLB02
BLB01
No restrictions for SPM or (E)LPM accessing the Application
section.
1
2
1
1
1
0
SPM is not allowed to write to the Application section.
SPM is not allowed to write to the Application section, and
(E)LPM executing from the Boot Loader section is not allowed to
read from the Application section. If Interrupt Vectors are placed
in the Boot Loader section, interrupts are disabled while
executing from the Application section.
3
4
0
0
0
1
(E)LPM executing from the Boot Loader section is not allowed to
read from the Application section. If Interrupt Vectors are placed
in the Boot Loader section, interrupts are disabled while
executing from the Application section.
337
2549L–AVR–08/07
Table 30-2. Lock Bit Protection Modes(1)(2) (Continued)
Memory Lock Bits
Protection Type
BLB1 Mode
BLB12
BLB11
No restrictions for SPM or (E)LPM accessing the Boot Loader
section.
1
2
1
1
1
0
SPM is not allowed to write to the Boot Loader section.
SPM is not allowed to write to the Boot Loader section, and
(E)LPM executing from the Application section is not allowed to
read from the Boot Loader section. If Interrupt Vectors are
placed in the Application section, interrupts are disabled while
executing from the Boot Loader section.
3
4
0
0
0
1
(E)LPM executing from the Application section is not allowed to
read from the Boot Loader section. If Interrupt Vectors are
placed in the Application section, interrupts are disabled while
executing from the Boot Loader section.
Notes: 1. Program the Fuse bits and Boot Lock bits before programming the LB1 and LB2.
2. “1” means unprogrammed, “0” means programmed
30.2 Fuse Bits
The ATmega640/1280/1281/2560/2561 has three Fuse bytes. Table 30-3 - Table 30-5 describe
briefly the functionality of all the fuses and how they are mapped into the Fuse bytes. Note that
the fuses are read as logical zero, “0”, if they are programmed.
Table 30-3. Extended Fuse Byte
Fuse Low Byte
Bit No
Description
Default Value
–
7
6
5
4
3
2
1
0
–
1
–
–
1
–
–
1
–
–
1
–
–
1
BODLEVEL2(Note:)
BODLEVEL1(Note:)
BODLEVEL0(Note:)
Brown-out Detector trigger level
Brown-out Detector trigger level
Brown-out Detector trigger level
1 (unprogrammed)
1 (unprogrammed)
1 (unprogrammed)
Note:
See “System and Reset Characteristics” on page 375 for BODLEVEL Fuse decoding.
338
ATmega640/1280/1281/2560/2561
2549L–AVR–08/07
ATmega640/1280/1281/2560/2561
Table 30-4. Fuse High Byte
Fuse High Byte
OCDEN(4)
JTAGEN
Bit No
Description
Enable OCD
Enable JTAG
Default Value
1 (unprogrammed, OCD
disabled)
7
6
5
4
3
0 (programmed, JTAG enabled)
Enable Serial Program and Data
Downloading
0 (programmed, SPI prog.
enabled)
SPIEN(1)
WDTON(3)
EESAVE
Watchdog Timer always on
1 (unprogrammed)
EEPROM memory is preserved
through the Chip Erase
1 (unprogrammed, EEPROM
not preserved)
Select Boot Size (see Table 30-9 for
details)
BOOTSZ1
2
0 (programmed)(2)
Select Boot Size (see Table 30-9 for
details)
BOOTSZ0
BOOTRST
1
0
0 (programmed)(2)
1 (unprogrammed)
Select Reset Vector
Notes: 1. The SPIEN Fuse is not accessible in serial programming mode.
2. The default value of BOOTSZ1:0 results in maximum Boot Size. See Table 29-7 on page 329
for details.
3. See “WDTCSR – Watchdog Timer Control Register” on page 67 for details.
4. Never ship a product with the OCDEN Fuse programmed regardless of the setting of Lock bits
and JTAGEN Fuse. A programmed OCDEN Fuse enables some parts of the clock system to
be running in all sleep modes. This may increase the power consumption.
Table 30-5. Fuse Low Byte
Fuse Low Byte
CKDIV8(4)
CKOUT(3)
SUT1
Bit No
Description
Default Value
7
6
5
4
3
2
1
0
Divide clock by 8
Clock output
0 (programmed)
1 (unprogrammed)
1 (unprogrammed)(1)
0 (programmed)(1)
0 (programmed)(2)
0 (programmed)(2)
1 (unprogrammed)(2)
0 (programmed)(2)
Select start-up time
Select start-up time
Select Clock source
Select Clock source
Select Clock source
Select Clock source
SUT0
CKSEL3
CKSEL2
CKSEL1
CKSEL0
Notes: 1. The default value of SUT1:0 results in maximum start-up time for the default clock source. See
“System and Reset Characteristics” on page 375 for details.
2. The default setting of CKSEL3:0 results in internal RC Oscillator @ 8 MHz. See Table 10-1 on
page 40 for details.
3. The CKOUT Fuse allow the system clock to be output on PORTE7. See “Clock Output Buffer”
on page 48 for details.
4. See “System Clock Prescaler” on page 49 for details.
The status of the Fuse bits is not affected by Chip Erase. Note that the Fuse bits are locked if
Lock bit1 (LB1) is programmed. Program the Fuse bits before programming the Lock bits.
339
2549L–AVR–08/07
30.2.1
Latching of Fuses
The fuse values are latched when the device enters programming mode and changes of the
fuse values will have no effect until the part leaves Programming mode. This does not apply to
the EESAVE Fuse which will take effect once it is programmed. The fuses are also latched on
Power-up in Normal mode.
30.3 Signature Bytes
All Atmel microcontrollers have a three-byte signature code which identifies the device. This
code can be read in both serial and parallel mode, also when the device is locked. The three
bytes reside in a separate address space. For the ATmega640/1280/1281/2560/2561 the signa-
ture bytes are given in Table 30-6.
Table 30-6. Device and JTAG ID
Signature Bytes Address
JTAG
Part
0x000
0x001
0x96
0x97
0x97
0x98
0x98
0x002
Part Number
9608
Manufacture ID
0x1F
ATmega640
ATmega1280
ATmega1281
ATmega2560
ATmega2561
0x1E
0x1E
0x1E
0x1E
0x1E
0x08
0x03
0x04
0x01
0x02
9703
0x1F
9704
0x1F
9801
0x1F
9802
0x1F
30.4 Calibration Byte
The ATmega640/1280/1281/2560/2561 has a byte calibration value for the internal RC Oscilla-
tor. This byte resides in the high byte of address 0x000 in the signature address space. During
reset, this byte is automatically written into the OSCCAL Register to ensure correct frequency of
the calibrated RC Oscillator.
30.5 Page Size
Table 30-7. No. of Words in a Page and No. of Pages in the Flash
No. of
Flash Size
Page Size
PCWORD
Pages
PCPAGE
PCMSB
128K words (256K bytes)
128 words
PC[6:0]
1024
PC[16:7]
16
Table 30-8. No. of Words in a Page and No. of Pages in the EEPROM
No. of
EEPROM Size
Page Size
PCWORD
Pages
PCPAGE
EEAMSB
4K bytes
8 bytes
EEA[2:0]
512
EEA[11:3]
11
30.6 Parallel Programming Parameters, Pin Mapping, and Commands
This section describes how to parallel program and verify Flash Program memory, EEPROM
Data memory, Memory Lock bits, and Fuse bits in the ATmega640/1280/1281/2560/2561.
Pulses are assumed to be at least 250 ns unless otherwise noted.
340
ATmega640/1280/1281/2560/2561
2549L–AVR–08/07
ATmega640/1280/1281/2560/2561
30.6.1
Signal Names
In this section, some pins of the ATmega640/1280/1281/2560/2561 are referenced by signal
names describing their functionality during parallel programming, see Figure 30-1 and Table 30-
9. Pins not described in the following table are referenced by pin names.
The XA1/XA0 pins determine the action executed when the XTAL1 pin is given a positive pulse.
The bit coding is shown in Table 30-12.
When pulsing WR or OE, the command loaded determines the action executed. The different
commands are shown in Table 30-13.
Figure 30-1. Parallel Programming(Note:)
+5V
RDY/BSY
OE
PD1
PD2
PD3
PD4
PD5
PD6
PD7
VCC
+5V
WR
AVCC
BS1
PB7 - PB0
DATA
XA0
XA1
PAGEL
+12 V
BS2
RESET
PA0
XTAL1
GND
Note:
Unused Pins should be left floating.
Table 30-9. Pin Name Mapping
Signal Name in
Programming Mode
Pin Name
I/O
Function
0: Device is busy programming, 1: Device is ready for
new command.
RDY/BSY
PD1
O
OE
WR
PD2
PD3
PD4
PD5
PD6
PD7
PA0
I
Output Enable (Active low).
Write Pulse (Active low).
Byte Select 1.
I
BS1
I
XA0
I
XTAL Action Bit 0
XA1
I
I
XTAL Action Bit 1
PAGEL
BS2
Program Memory and EEPROM data Page Load.
Byte Select 2.
I
DATA
PB7-0
I/O
Bi-directional Data bus (Output when OE is low).
341
2549L–AVR–08/07
Table 30-10. BS2 and BS1 Encoding
Flash Data
Loading /
Reading
Flash / EEPROM
Fuse
Programming
Reading Fuse
and Lock Bits
BS2
0
BS1
0
Address
Low Byte
High Byte
Low Byte
High Byte
Low Byte
High Byte
Fuse Low Byte
Lockbits
0
1
Extended High
Byte
Extended Fuse
Byte
1
1
0
1
Reserved
Reserved
Extended Byte
Reserved
Reserved
Fuse High Byte
,
Table 30-11. Pin Values Used to Enter Programming Mode
Pin
PAGEL
XA1
Symbol
Value
Prog_enable[3]
Prog_enable[2]
Prog_enable[1]
Prog_enable[0]
0
0
0
0
XA0
BS1
Table 30-12. XA1 and XA0 Enoding
XA1
XA0
Action when XTAL1 is Pulsed
0
0
Load Flash or EEPROM Address (High or low address byte determined
by BS2 and BS1).
0
1
1
1
0
1
Load Data (High or Low data byte for Flash determined by BS1).
Load Command
No Action, Idle
Table 30-13. Command Byte Bit Encoding
Command Byte
1000 0000
0100 0000
0010 0000
0001 0000
0001 0001
0000 1000
0000 0100
0000 0010
0000 0011
Command Executed
Chip Erase
Write Fuse bits
Write Lock bits
Write Flash
Write EEPROM
Read Signature Bytes and Calibration byte
Read Fuse and Lock bits
Read Flash
Read EEPROM
342
ATmega640/1280/1281/2560/2561
2549L–AVR–08/07
ATmega640/1280/1281/2560/2561
30.7 Parallel Programming
30.7.1
Enter Programming Mode
The following algorithm puts the device in parallel programming mode:
1. Apply 4.5 - 5.5V between VCC and GND.
2. Set RESET to “0” and toggle XTAL1 at least six times.
3. Set the Prog_enable pins listed in Table 30-11 on page 342 to “0000” and wait at least
100 ns.
4. Apply 11.5 - 12.5V to RESET. Any activity on Prog_enable pins within 100 ns after +12V
has been applied to RESET, will cause the device to fail entering programming mode.
5. Wait at least 50 µs before sending a new command.
30.7.2
Considerations for Efficient Programming
The loaded command and address are retained in the device during programming. For efficient
programming, the following should be considered.
•
•
•
The command needs only be loaded once when writing or reading multiple memory
locations.
Skip writing the data value 0xFF, that is the contents of the entire EEPROM (unless the
EESAVE Fuse is programmed) and Flash after a Chip Erase.
Address high byte needs only be loaded before programming or reading a new 256 word
window in Flash or 256 byte EEPROM. This consideration also applies to Signature bytes
reading.
30.7.3
Chip Erase
The Chip Erase will erase the Flash and EEPROM(1) memories plus Lock bits. The Lock bits are
not reset until the program memory has been completely erased. The Fuse bits are not
changed. A Chip Erase must be performed before the Flash and/or EEPROM are
reprogrammed.
Note:
1. The EEPRPOM memory is preserved during Chip Erase if the EESAVE Fuse is programmed.
Load Command “Chip Erase”
1. Set XA1, XA0 to “10”. This enables command loading.
2. Set BS1 to “0”.
3. Set DATA to “1000 0000”. This is the command for Chip Erase.
4. Give XTAL1 a positive pulse. This loads the command.
5. Give WR a negative pulse. This starts the Chip Erase. RDY/BSY goes low.
6. Wait until RDY/BSY goes high before loading a new command.
30.7.4
Programming the Flash
The Flash is organized in pages, see Table 30-7 on page 340. When programming the Flash,
the program data is latched into a page buffer. This allows one page of program data to be pro-
grammed simultaneously. The following procedure describes how to program the entire Flash
memory:
A. Load Command “Write Flash”
1. Set XA1, XA0 to “10”. This enables command loading.
2. Set BS1 to “0”.
343
2549L–AVR–08/07
3. Set DATA to “0001 0000”. This is the command for Write Flash.
4. Give XTAL1 a positive pulse. This loads the command.
B. Load Address Low byte (Address bits 7:0)
1. Set XA1, XA0 to “00”. This enables address loading.
2. Set BS2, BS1 to “00”. This selects the address low byte.
3. Set DATA = Address low byte (0x00 - 0xFF).
4. Give XTAL1 a positive pulse. This loads the address low byte.
C. Load Data Low Byte
1. Set XA1, XA0 to “01”. This enables data loading.
2. Set DATA = Data low byte (0x00 - 0xFF).
3. Give XTAL1 a positive pulse. This loads the data byte.
D. Load Data High Byte
1. Set BS1 to “1”. This selects high data byte.
2. Set XA1, XA0 to “01”. This enables data loading.
3. Set DATA = Data high byte (0x00 - 0xFF).
4. Give XTAL1 a positive pulse. This loads the data byte.
E. Latch Data
1. Set BS1 to “1”. This selects high data byte.
2. Give PAGEL a positive pulse. This latches the data bytes. (See Figure 30-2 for signal
waveforms)
F. Repeat B through E until the entire buffer is filled or until all data within the page is loaded.
While the lower bits in the address are mapped to words within the page, the higher bits address
the pages within the FLASH. This is illustrated in Figure 4 on page 345. Note that if less than
eight bits are required to address words in the page (pagesize < 256), the most significant bit(s)
in the address low byte are used to address the page when performing a Page Write.
G. Load Address High byte (Address bits15:8)
1. Set XA1, XA0 to “00”. This enables address loading.
2. Set BS2, BS1 to “01”. This selects the address high byte.
3. Set DATA = Address high byte (0x00 - 0xFF).
4. Give XTAL1 a positive pulse. This loads the address high byte.
H. Load Address Extended High byte (Address bits 23:16)
1. Set XA1, XA0 to “00”. This enables address loading.
2. Set BS2, BS1 to “10”. This selects the address extended high byte.
3. Set DATA = Address extended high byte (0x00 - 0xFF).
4. Give XTAL1 a positive pulse. This loads the address high byte.
I. Program Page
1. Set BS2, BS1 to “00”
2. Give WR a negative pulse. This starts programming of the entire page of data. RDY/BSY
goes low.
3. Wait until RDY/BSY goes high (See Figure 30-2 for signal waveforms).
J. Repeat B through I until the entire Flash is programmed or until all data has been
programmed.
344
ATmega640/1280/1281/2560/2561
2549L–AVR–08/07
ATmega640/1280/1281/2560/2561
K. End Page Programming
1. 1. Set XA1, XA0 to “10”. This enables command loading.
2. Set DATA to “0000 0000”. This is the command for No Operation.
3. Give XTAL1 a positive pulse. This loads the command, and the internal write signals are
reset.
Figure 4. Addressing the Flash Which is Organized in Pages(Note:)
PCMSB
PAGEMSB
PROGRAM
COUNTER
PCPAGE
PCWORD
PAGE ADDRESS
WITHIN THE FLASH
WORD ADDRESS
WITHIN A PAGE
PROGRAM MEMORY
PAGE
PAGE
INSTRUCTION WORD
PCWORD[PAGEMSB:0]:
00
01
02
PAGEEND
Note:
PCPAGE and PCWORD are listed in Table 30-7 on page 340.
Figure 30-2. Programming the Flash Waveforms(1)
F
A
B
C
D
E
B
C
D
E
G
I
H
0x10
ADDR. LOW
DATA LOW
DATA HIGH
ADDR. LOW DATA LOW
DATA HIGH
ADDR. HIGH
ADDR. EXT.H
XX
XX
XX
DATA
XA1
XA0
BS1
BS2
XTAL1
WR
RDY/BSY
RESET +12V
OE
PAGEL
Note:
1. “XX” is don’t care. The letters refer to the programming description above.
30.7.5
Programming the EEPROM
The EEPROM is organized in pages, see Table 30-8 on page 340. When programming the
EEPROM, the program data is latched into a page buffer. This allows one page of data to be
programmed simultaneously. The programming algorithm for the EEPROM data memory is as
345
2549L–AVR–08/07
follows (refer to “Programming the Flash” on page 343 for details on Command, Address and
Data loading):
1. A: Load Command “0001 0001”.
2. G: Load Address High Byte (0x00 - 0xFF).
3. B: Load Address Low Byte (0x00 - 0xFF).
4. C: Load Data (0x00 - 0xFF).
5. E: Latch data (give PAGEL a positive pulse).
K: Repeat 3 through 5 until the entire buffer is filled.
L: Program EEPROM page
1. Set BS2, BS1 to “00”.
2. Give WR a negative pulse. This starts programming of the EEPROM page. RDY/BSY
goes low.
3. Wait until to RDY/BSY goes high before programming the next page (See Figure 30-3 for
signal waveforms).
Figure 30-3. Programming the EEPROM Waveforms
K
A
G
B
C
E
B
C
E
L
0x11
ADDR. HIGH
ADDR. LOW
DATA
ADDR. LOW
DATA
XX
XX
DATA
XA1
XA0
BS1
XTAL1
WR
RDY/BSY
RESET +12V
OE
PAGEL
BS2
30.7.6
Reading the Flash
The algorithm for reading the Flash memory is as follows (refer to “Programming the Flash” on
page 343 for details on Command and Address loading):
1. A: Load Command “0000 0010”.
2. H: Load Address Extended Byte (0x00- 0xFF).
3. G: Load Address High Byte (0x00 - 0xFF).
4. B: Load Address Low Byte (0x00 - 0xFF).
5. Set OE to “0”, and BS1 to “0”. The Flash word low byte can now be read at DATA.
6. Set BS to “1”. The Flash word high byte can now be read at DATA.
7. Set OE to “1”.
30.7.7
346
Reading the EEPROM
The algorithm for reading the EEPROM memory is as follows (refer to “Programming the Flash”
on page 343 for details on Command and Address loading):
ATmega640/1280/1281/2560/2561
2549L–AVR–08/07
ATmega640/1280/1281/2560/2561
1. A: Load Command “0000 0011”.
2. G: Load Address High Byte (0x00 - 0xFF).
3. B: Load Address Low Byte (0x00 - 0xFF).
4. Set OE to “0”, and BS1 to “0”. The EEPROM Data byte can now be read at DATA.
5. Set OE to “1”.
30.7.8
30.7.9
Programming the Fuse Low Bits
The algorithm for programming the Fuse Low bits is as follows (refer to “Programming the Flash”
on page 343 for details on Command and Data loading):
1. A: Load Command “0100 0000”.
2. C: Load Data Low Byte. Bit n = “0” programs and bit n = “1” erases the Fuse bit.
3. Give WR a negative pulse and wait for RDY/BSY to go high.
Programming the Fuse High Bits
The algorithm for programming the Fuse High bits is as follows (refer to “Programming the
Flash” on page 343 for details on Command and Data loading):
1. A: Load Command “0100 0000”.
2. C: Load Data Low Byte. Bit n = “0” programs and bit n = “1” erases the Fuse bit.
3. Set BS2, BS1 to “01”. This selects high data byte.
4. Give WR a negative pulse and wait for RDY/BSY to go high.
5. Set BS2, BS1 to “00”. This selects low data byte.
30.7.10 Programming the Extended Fuse Bits
The algorithm for programming the Extended Fuse bits is as follows (refer to “Programming the
Flash” on page 343 for details on Command and Data loading):
1. 1. A: Load Command “0100 0000”.
2. 2. C: Load Data Low Byte. Bit n = “0” programs and bit n = “1” erases the Fuse bit.
3. 3. Set BS2, BS1 to “10”. This selects extended data byte.
4. 4. Give WR a negative pulse and wait for RDY/BSY to go high.
5. 5. Set BS2, BS1 to “00”. This selects low data byte.
347
2549L–AVR–08/07
Figure 30-4. Programming the FUSES Waveforms
Write Fuse Low byte
Write Fuse high byte
Write Extended Fuse byte
A
C
A
C
A
C
0x40
DATA
XX
0x40
DATA
XX
0x40
DATA
XX
DATA
XA1
XA0
BS1
BS2
XTAL1
WR
RDY/BSY
RESET +12V
OE
PAGEL
30.7.11 Programming the Lock Bits
The algorithm for programming the Lock bits is as follows (refer to “Programming the Flash” on
page 343 for details on Command and Data loading):
1. A: Load Command “0010 0000”.
2. C: Load Data Low Byte. Bit n = “0” programs the Lock bit. If LB mode 3 is programmed
(LB1 and LB2 is programmed), it is not possible to program the Boot Lock bits by any
External Programming mode.
3. Give WR a negative pulse and wait for RDY/BSY to go high.
The Lock bits can only be cleared by executing Chip Erase.
30.7.12 Reading the Fuse and Lock Bits
The algorithm for reading the Fuse and Lock bits is as follows (refer to “Programming the Flash”
on page 343 for details on Command loading):
1. A: Load Command “0000 0100”.
2. Set OE to “0”, and BS2, BS1 to “00”. The status of the Fuse Low bits can now be read at
DATA (“0” means programmed).
3. Set OE to “0”, and BS2, BS1 to “11”. The status of the Fuse High bits can now be read at
DATA (“0” means programmed).
4. Set OE to “0”, and BS2, BS1 to “10”. The status of the Extended Fuse bits can now be
read at DATA (“0” means programmed).
5. Set OE to “0”, and BS2, BS1 to “01”. The status of the Lock bits can now be read at DATA
(“0” means programmed).
6. Set OE to “1”.
348
ATmega640/1280/1281/2560/2561
2549L–AVR–08/07
ATmega640/1280/1281/2560/2561
Figure 30-5. Mapping Between BS1, BS2 and the Fuse and Lock Bits During Read
0
Fuse Low Byte
Extended Fuse Byte
Lock Bits
0
1
1
0
DATA
BS2
BS1
Fuse High Byte
1
BS2
30.7.13 Reading the Signature Bytes
The algorithm for reading the Signature bytes is as follows (refer to “Programming the Flash” on
page 343 for details on Command and Address loading):
1. A: Load Command “0000 1000”.
2. B: Load Address Low Byte (0x00 - 0x02).
3. Set OE to “0”, and BS to “0”. The selected Signature byte can now be read at DATA.
4. Set OE to “1”.
30.7.14 Reading the Calibration Byte
The algorithm for reading the Calibration byte is as follows (refer to “Programming the Flash” on
page 343 for details on Command and Address loading):
1. A: Load Command “0000 1000”.
2. B: Load Address Low Byte, 0x00.
3. Set OE to “0”, and BS1 to “1”. The Calibration byte can now be read at DATA.
4. Set OE to “1”.
30.7.15 Parallel Programming Characteristics
Figure 30-6. Parallel Programming Timing, Including some General Timing Requirements
tXLWL
tXHXL
XTAL1
tDVXH
tXLDX
Data & Contol
(DATA, XA0/1, BS1, BS2)
tBVPH
tPLBX tBVWL
tWLBX
PAGEL
tPHPL
tWLWH
WR
tPLWL
WLRL
RDY/BSY
tWLRH
349
2549L–AVR–08/07
Figure 30-7. Parallel Programming Timing, Loading Sequence with Timing Requirements(Note:)
LOAD DATA
LOAD ADDRESS
(LOW BYTE)
LOAD DATA
(LOW BYTE)
LOAD DATA
(HIGH BYTE)
LOAD ADDRESS
(LOW BYTE)
tXLPH
tXLXH
tPLXH
XTAL1
BS1
PAGEL
DATA
ADDR0 (Low Byte)
DATA (Low Byte)
DATA (High Byte)
ADDR1 (Low Byte)
XA0
XA1
Note:
The timing requirements shown in Figure 30-6 (i.e., tDVXH, tXHXL, and tXLDX) also apply to loading
operation.
Figure 30-8. Parallel Programming Timing, Reading Sequence (within the Same Page) with
Timing Requirements(1)
LOAD ADDRESS
(LOW BYTE)
READ DATA
(LOW BYTE)
READ DATA
(HIGH BYTE)
LOAD ADDRESS
(LOW BYTE)
tXLOL
XTAL1
BS1
tBVDV
tOLDV
OE
tOHDZ
ADDR1 (Low Byte)
DATA (High Byte)
DATA
ADDR0 (Low Byte)
DATA (Low Byte)
XA0
XA1
Note:
1. The timing requirements shown in Figure 30-6 (i.e., tDVXH, tXHXL, and tXLDX) also apply to read-
ing operation.
Table 30-14. Parallel Programming Characteristics, VCC = 5V 10%
Symbol
VPP
Parameter
Min
Typ
Max
12.5
250
Units
V
Programming Enable Voltage
Programming Enable Current
Data and Control Valid before XTAL1 High
XTAL1 Low to XTAL1 High
XTAL1 Pulse Width High
11.5
IPP
μA
ns
tDVXH
tXLXH
tXHXL
tXLDX
67
200
150
67
ns
ns
Data and Control Hold after XTAL1 Low
ns
350
ATmega640/1280/1281/2560/2561
2549L–AVR–08/07
ATmega640/1280/1281/2560/2561
Table 30-14. Parallel Programming Characteristics, VCC = 5V 10% (Continued)
Symbol
tXLWL
tXLPH
Parameter
Min
0
Typ
Max
Units
ns
XTAL1 Low to WR Low
XTAL1 Low to PAGEL high
PAGEL low to XTAL1 high
BS1 Valid before PAGEL High
PAGEL Pulse Width High
BS1 Hold after PAGEL Low
BS2/1 Hold after WR Low
PAGEL Low to WR Low
BS2/1 Valid to WR Low
WR Pulse Width Low
0
ns
tPLXH
150
67
150
67
67
67
67
150
0
ns
tBVPH
tPHPL
ns
ns
tPLBX
ns
tWLBX
tPLWL
tBVWL
tWLWH
tWLRL
tWLRH
tWLRH_CE
tXLOL
ns
ns
ns
ns
WR Low to RDY/BSY Low
WR Low to RDY/BSY High(1)
WR Low to RDY/BSY High for Chip Erase(2)
XTAL1 Low to OE Low
1
4.5
9
μs
ms
ms
ns
3.7
7.5
0
tBVDV
tOLDV
tOHDZ
BS1 Valid to DATA valid
OE Low to DATA Valid
0
250
250
250
ns
ns
OE High to DATA Tri-stated
ns
Notes: 1. tWLRH is valid for the Write Flash, Write EEPROM, Write Fuse bits and Write Lock bits
commands.
2.
tWLRH_CE is valid for the Chip Erase command.
30.8 Serial Downloading
Both the Flash and EEPROM memory arrays can be programmed using a serial programming
bus while RESET is pulled to GND. The serial programming interface consists of pins SCK, PDI
(input) and PDO (output). After RESET is set low, the Programming Enable instruction needs to
be executed first before program/erase operations can be executed. NOTE, in Table 30-15 on
page 351, the pin mapping for serial programming is listed. Not all packages use the SPI pins
dedicated for the internal Serial Peripheral Interface - SPI.
30.8.1
Serial Programming Pin Mapping
Table 30-15. Pin Mapping Serial Programming
Pins
Pins
Symbol
PDI
(TQFP-100)
(TQFP-64)
I/O
Description
Serial Data in
Serial Data out
Serial Clock
PB2
PB3
PB1
PE0
I
O
I
PDO
SCK
PE1
PB1
Figure 30-9. Serial Programming and Verify(1)
351
2549L–AVR–08/07
+1.8 - 5.5V
VCC
+1.8 - 5.5V(2)
PDI
AVCC
PDO
SCK
XTAL1
RESET
GND
Notes: 1. If the device is clocked by the internal Oscillator, it is no need to connect a clock source to the
XTAL1 pin.
2. VCC - 0.3V < AVCC < VCC + 0.3V, however, AVCC should always be within 1.8 - 5.5V
352
ATmega640/1280/1281/2560/2561
2549L–AVR–08/07
ATmega640/1280/1281/2560/2561
When programming the EEPROM, an auto-erase cycle is built into the self-timed programming
operation (in the Serial mode ONLY) and there is no need to first execute the Chip Erase
instruction. The Chip Erase operation turns the content of every memory location in both the
Program and EEPROM arrays into 0xFF.
Depending on CKSEL Fuses, a valid clock must be present. The minimum low and high periods
for the serial clock (SCK) input are defined as follows:
Low: > 2 CPU clock cycles for fck < 12 MHz, 3 CPU clock cycles for fck >= 12 MHz
High: > 2 CPU clock cycles for fck < 12 MHz, 3 CPU clock cycles for fck >= 12 MHz
30.8.2
Serial Programming Algorithm
When writing serial data to the ATmega640/1280/1281/2560/2561, data is clocked on the rising
edge of SCK.
When reading data from the ATmega640/1280/1281/2560/2561, data is clocked on the falling
edge of SCK. See Figure 30-11 for timing details.
To program and verify the ATmega640/1280/1281/2560/2561 in the serial programming mode,
the following sequence is recommended (See four byte instruction formats in Table 30-17 on
page 354):
1. Power-up sequence:
Apply power between VCC and GND while RESET and SCK are set to “0”. In some sys-
tems, the programmer can not guarantee that SCK is held low during power-up. In this
case, RESET must be given a positive pulse of at least two CPU clock cycles duration
after SCK has been set to “0”.
2. Wait for at least 20 ms and enable serial programming by sending the Programming
Enable serial instruction to pin PDI.
3. The serial programming instructions will not work if the communication is out of synchro-
nization. When in sync. the second byte (0x53), will echo back when issuing the third
byte of the Programming Enable instruction. Whether the echo is correct or not, all four
bytes of the instruction must be transmitted. If the 0x53 did not echo back, give RESET a
positive pulse and issue a new Programming Enable command.
4. The Flash is programmed one page at a time. The memory page is loaded one byte at a
time by supplying the 7 LSB of the address and data together with the Load Program
Memory Page instruction. To ensure correct loading of the page, the data low byte must
be loaded before data high byte is applied for a given address. The Program Memory
Page is stored by loading the Write Program Memory Page instruction with the address
lines 15:8. Before issuing this command, make sure the instruction Load Extended
Address Byte has been used to define the MSB of the address. The extended address
byte is stored until the command is re-issued, i.e., the command needs only be issued for
the first page, and when crossing the 64KWord boundary. If polling (RDY/BSY) is not
used, the user must wait at least tWD_FLASH before issuing the next page. (See Table 30-
16.) Accessing the serial programming interface before the Flash write operation com-
pletes can result in incorrect programming.
5. The EEPROM array is programmed one byte at a time by supplying the address and data
together with the appropriate Write instruction. An EEPROM memory location is first
automatically erased before new data is written. If polling is not used, the user must wait
at least tWD_EEPROM before issuing the next byte. (See Table 30-16.) In a chip erased
device, no 0xFFs in the data file(s) need to be programmed.
6. Any memory location can be verified by using the Read instruction which returns the con-
tent at the selected address at serial output PDO. When reading the Flash memory, use
the instruction Load Extended Address Byte to define the upper address byte, which is
353
2549L–AVR–08/07
not included in the Read Program Memory instruction. The extended address byte is
stored until the command is re-issued, i.e., the command needs only be issued for the
first page, and when crossing the 64KWord boundary.
7. At the end of the programming session, RESET can be set high to commence normal
operation.
8. Power-off sequence (if needed):
Set RESET to “1”.
Turn VCC power off.
Table 30-16. Minimum Wait Delay Before Writing the Next Flash or EEPROM Location
Symbol
Minimum Wait Delay
4.5 ms
tWD_FLASH
tWD_EEPROM
tWD_ERASE
9.0 ms
9.0 ms
30.8.3
Serial Programming Instruction set
Table 30-17 on page 354 and Figure 30-10 on page 356 describes the Instruction set.
Table 30-17. Serial Programming Instruction Set
Instruction Format
Instruction/Operation
Byte 1
$AC
Byte 2
Byte 3
$00
Byte4
$00
Programming Enable
$53
$80
$00
Chip Erase (Program Memory/EEPROM)
Poll RDY/BSY
$AC
$00
$00
$F0
$00
data byte out
Load Instructions
Load Extended Address byte(1)
Load Program Memory Page, High byte
Load Program Memory Page, Low byte
Load EEPROM Memory Page (page access)
Read Instructions
$4D
$48
$40
$C1
$00
$00
$00
$00
Extended adr
adr LSB
$00
high data byte in
low data byte in
data byte in
adr LSB
0000 000aa
Read Program Memory, High byte
Read Program Memory, Low byte
Read EEPROM Memory
Read Lock bits
$28
$20
$A0
$58
$30
$50
$58
$50
$38
adr MSB
adr MSB
0000 aaaa
$00
adr LSB
adr LSB
aaaa aaaa
$00
high data byte out
low data byte out
data byte out
data byte out
data byte out
data byte out
data byte out
data byte out
data byte out
Read Signature Byte
$00
0000 000aa
$00
Read Fuse bits
$00
Read Fuse High bits
$08
$00
Read Extended Fuse Bits
Read Calibration Byte
$08
$00
$00
$00
Write Instructions
354
ATmega640/1280/1281/2560/2561
2549L–AVR–08/07
ATmega640/1280/1281/2560/2561
Table 30-17. Serial Programming Instruction Set (Continued)
Instruction Format
Instruction/Operation
Write Program Memory Page
Write EEPROM Memory
Write EEPROM Memory Page (page access)
Write Lock bits
Byte 1
$4C
Byte 2
Byte 3
adr LSB
aaaa aaaa
aaaa 00
$00
Byte4
$00
adr MSB
0000 aaaa
0000 aaaa
$E0
$C0
data byte in
$00
$C2
$AC
$AC
$AC
$AC
data byte in
data byte in
data byte in
data byte in
Write Fuse bits
$A0
$00
Write Fuse High bits
$A8
$00
Write Extended Fuse Bits
$A4
$00
Notes: 1. Not all instructions are applicable for all parts.
2. a = address.
3. Bits are programmed ‘0’, unprogrammed ‘1’.
4. To ensure future compatibility, unused Fuses and Lock bits should be unprogrammed (‘1’) .
5. Refer to the correspondig section for Fuse and Lock bits, Calibration and Signature bytes and
Page size.
6. See htt://www.atmel.com/avr for Application Notes regarding programming and programmers.
If the LSB in RDY/BSY data byte out is ‘1’, a programming operation is still pending. Wait until
this bit returns ‘0’ before the next instruction is carried out.
Within the same page, the low data byte must be loaded prior to the high data byte.
After data is loaded to the page buffer, program the EEPROM page, see Figure 30-10 on page
356.
355
2549L–AVR–08/07
Figure 30-10. Serial Programming Instruction example
Serial Programming Instruction
Load Program Memory Page (High/Low Byte)/
Load EEPROM Memory Page (page access)
Write Program Memory Page/
Write EEPROM Memory Page
Byte 1
Byte 2
Byte 3
Byte 4
Byte 1
Byte 2
Byte 3
Byte 4
Adr MSB
Adr LSB
Adr MSB
Adr LSB
Bit 15 B
0
Bit 15 B
0
Page Buffer
Page Offset
Page 0
Page 1
Page 2
Page Number
Page N-1
Program Memory/
EEPROM Memory
30.8.4
Serial Programming Characteristics
For characteristics of the Serial Programming module see “SPI Timing Characteristics” on page
377.
Figure 30-11. Serial Programming Waveforms
SERIAL DATA INPUT
(MOSI)
MSB
LSB
LSB
SERIAL DATA OUTPUT
(MISO)
MSB
SERIAL CLOCK INPUT
(SCK)
SAMPLE
356
ATmega640/1280/1281/2560/2561
2549L–AVR–08/07
ATmega640/1280/1281/2560/2561
30.9 Programming via the JTAG Interface
Programming through the JTAG interface requires control of the four JTAG specific pins: TCK,
TMS, TDI, and TDO. Control of the reset and clock pins is not required.
To be able to use the JTAG interface, the JTAGEN Fuse must be programmed. The device is
default shipped with the fuse programmed. In addition, the JTD bit in MCUCR must be cleared.
Alternatively, if the JTD bit is set, the external reset can be forced low. Then, the JTD bit will be
cleared after two chip clocks, and the JTAG pins are available for programming. This provides a
means of using the JTAG pins as normal port pins in Running mode while still allowing In-Sys-
tem Programming via the JTAG interface. Note that this technique can not be used when using
the JTAG pins for Boundary-scan or On-chip Debug. In these cases the JTAG pins must be ded-
icated for this purpose.
During programming the clock frequency of the TCK Input must be less than the maximum fre-
quency of the chip. The System Clock Prescaler can not be used to divide the TCK Clock Input
into a sufficiently low frequency.
As a definition in this datasheet, the LSB is shifted in and out first of all Shift Registers.
30.9.1
Programming Specific JTAG Instructions
The Instruction Register is 4-bit wide, supporting up to 16 instructions. The JTAG instructions
useful for programming are listed below.
The OPCODE for each instruction is shown behind the instruction name in hex format. The text
describes which Data Register is selected as path between TDI and TDO for each instruction.
The Run-Test/Idle state of the TAP controller is used to generate internal clocks. It can also be
used as an idle state between JTAG sequences. The state machine sequence for changing the
instruction word is shown in Figure 30-12.
357
2549L–AVR–08/07
Figure 30-12. State Machine Sequence for Changing the Instruction Word
1
Test-Logic-Reset
0
1
1
1
0
Run-Test/Idle
Select-DR Scan
Select-IR Scan
0
0
1
1
Capture-DR
Capture-IR
0
0
Shift-DR
0
Shift-IR
0
1
Exit1-DR
0
1
Exit1-IR
0
1
1
Pause-DR
1
0
Pause-IR
1
0
0
0
Exit2-DR
1
Exit2-IR
1
Update-DR
Update-IR
1
1
0
0
30.9.2
AVR_RESET (0xC)
The AVR specific public JTAG instruction for setting the AVR device in the Reset mode or taking
the device out from the Reset mode. The TAP controller is not reset by this instruction. The one
bit Reset Register is selected as Data Register. Note that the reset will be active as long as there
is a logic “one” in the Reset Chain. The output from this chain is not latched.
The active states are:
•
Shift-DR: The Reset Register is shifted by the TCK input.
30.9.3
PROG_ENABLE (0x4)
The AVR specific public JTAG instruction for enabling programming via the JTAG port. The 16-
bit Programming Enable Register is selected as Data Register. The active states are the
following:
•
•
Shift-DR: The programming enable signature is shifted into the Data Register.
Update-DR: The programming enable signature is compared to the correct value, and
Programming mode is entered if the signature is valid.
358
ATmega640/1280/1281/2560/2561
2549L–AVR–08/07
ATmega640/1280/1281/2560/2561
30.9.4
PROG_COMMANDS (0x5)
The AVR specific public JTAG instruction for entering programming commands via the JTAG
port. The 15-bit Programming Command Register is selected as Data Register. The active
states are the following:
•
•
Capture-DR: The result of the previous command is loaded into the Data Register.
Shift-DR: The Data Register is shifted by the TCK input, shifting out the result of the
previous command and shifting in the new command.
•
•
Update-DR: The programming command is applied to the Flash inputs
Run-Test/Idle: One clock cycle is generated, executing the applied command
30.9.5
PROG_PAGELOAD (0x6)
The AVR specific public JTAG instruction to directly load the Flash data page via the JTAG port.
An 8-bit Flash Data Byte Register is selected as the Data Register. This is physically the 8 LSBs
of the Programming Command Register. The active states are the following:
•
•
Shift-DR: The Flash Data Byte Register is shifted by the TCK input.
Update-DR: The content of the Flash Data Byte Register is copied into a temporary register.
A write sequence is initiated that within 11 TCK cycles loads the content of the temporary
register into the Flash page buffer. The AVR automatically alternates between writing the low
and the high byte for each new Update-DR state, starting with the low byte for the first
Update-DR encountered after entering the PROG_PAGELOAD command. The Program
Counter is pre-incremented before writing the low byte, except for the first written byte. This
ensures that the first data is written to the address set up by PROG_COMMANDS, and
loading the last location in the page buffer does not make the program counter increment
into the next page.
30.9.6
PROG_PAGEREAD (0x7)
The AVR specific public JTAG instruction to directly capture the Flash content via the JTAG port.
An 8-bit Flash Data Byte Register is selected as the Data Register. This is physically the 8 LSBs
of the Programming Command Register. The active states are the following:
•
Capture-DR: The content of the selected Flash byte is captured into the Flash Data Byte
Register. The AVR automatically alternates between reading the low and the high byte for
each new Capture-DR state, starting with the low byte for the first Capture-DR encountered
after entering the PROG_PAGEREAD command. The Program Counter is post-incremented
after reading each high byte, including the first read byte. This ensures that the first data is
captured from the first address set up by PROG_COMMANDS, and reading the last location
in the page makes the program counter increment into the next page.
•
Shift-DR: The Flash Data Byte Register is shifted by the TCK input.
30.9.7
Data Registers
The Data Registers are selected by the JTAG instruction registers described in section “Pro-
gramming Specific JTAG Instructions” on page 357. The Data Registers relevant for
programming operations are:
•
•
•
•
Reset Register
Programming Enable Register
Programming Command Register
Flash Data Byte Register
359
2549L–AVR–08/07
30.9.8
Reset Register
The Reset Register is a Test Data Register used to reset the part during programming. It is
required to reset the part before entering Programming mode.
A high value in the Reset Register corresponds to pulling the external reset low. The part is reset
as long as there is a high value present in the Reset Register. Depending on the Fuse settings
for the clock options, the part will remain reset for a Reset Time-out period (refer to “Clock
Sources” on page 40) after releasing the Reset Register. The output from this Data Register is
not latched, so the reset will take place immediately, as shown in Figure 28-1 on page 305.
30.9.9
Programming Enable Register
The Programming Enable Register is a 16-bit register. The contents of this register is compared
to the programming enable signature, binary code 0b1010_0011_0111_0000. When the con-
tents of the register is equal to the programming enable signature, programming via the JTAG
port is enabled. The register is reset to 0 on Power-on Reset, and should always be reset when
leaving Programming mode.
Figure 30-13. Programming Enable Register
TDI
0xA370
D
D
Q
A
T
A
Programming Enable
=
ClockDR & PROG_ENABLE
TDO
30.9.10 Programming Command Register
The Programming Command Register is a 15-bit register. This register is used to serially shift in
programming commands, and to serially shift out the result of the previous command, if any. The
JTAG Programming Instruction Set is shown in Table 30-18. The state sequence when shifting
in the programming commands is illustrated in Figure 30-15.
360
ATmega640/1280/1281/2560/2561
2549L–AVR–08/07
ATmega640/1280/1281/2560/2561
Figure 30-14. Programming Command Register
TDI
S
T
R
O
B
E
S
Flash
EEPROM
Fuses
A
D
D
R
E
S
S
/
Lock Bits
D
A
T
A
TDO
361
2549L–AVR–08/07
Table 30-18. JTAG Programming Instruction
Set a = address high bits, b = address low bits, c = address extended bits, H = 0 - Low byte, 1 - High Byte, o = data out,
i = data in, x = don’t care
Instruction
TDI Sequence
TDO Sequence
Notes
0100011_10000000
0110001_10000000
0110011_10000000
0110011_10000000
xxxxxxx_xxxxxxxx
xxxxxxx_xxxxxxxx
xxxxxxx_xxxxxxxx
xxxxxxx_xxxxxxxx
1a. Chip Erase
1b. Poll for Chip Erase Complete
2a. Enter Flash Write
0110011_10000000
0100011_00010000
0001011_cccccccc
0000111_aaaaaaaa
0000011_bbbbbbbb
0010011_iiiiiiii
xxxxxox_xxxxxxxx
xxxxxxx_xxxxxxxx
xxxxxxx_xxxxxxxx
xxxxxxx_xxxxxxxx
xxxxxxx_xxxxxxxx
xxxxxxx_xxxxxxxx
xxxxxxx_xxxxxxxx
(2)
2b. Load Address Extended High Byte
2c. Load Address High Byte
2d. Load Address Low Byte
2e. Load Data Low Byte
(10)
2f. Load Data High Byte
0010111_iiiiiiii
0110111_00000000
1110111_00000000
0110111_00000000
xxxxxxx_xxxxxxxx
xxxxxxx_xxxxxxxx
xxxxxxx_xxxxxxxx
2g. Latch Data
(1)
(1)
0110111_00000000
0110101_00000000
0110111_00000000
0110111_00000000
xxxxxxx_xxxxxxxx
xxxxxxx_xxxxxxxx
xxxxxxx_xxxxxxxx
xxxxxxx_xxxxxxxx
2h. Write Flash Page
2i. Poll for Page Write Complete
3a. Enter Flash Read
0110111_00000000
0100011_00000010
0001011_cccccccc
0000111_aaaaaaaa
0000011_bbbbbbbb
xxxxxox_xxxxxxxx
xxxxxxx_xxxxxxxx
xxxxxxx_xxxxxxxx
xxxxxxx_xxxxxxxx
xxxxxxx_xxxxxxxx
(2)
3b. Load Address Extended High Byte
3c. Load Address High Byte
3d. Load Address Low Byte
(10)
0110010_00000000
0110110_00000000
0110111_00000000
xxxxxxx_xxxxxxxx
xxxxxxx_oooooooo
xxxxxxx_oooooooo
3e. Read Data Low and High Byte
Low byte
High byte
4a. Enter EEPROM Write
4b. Load Address High Byte
4c. Load Address Low Byte
4d. Load Data Byte
0100011_00010001
0000111_aaaaaaaa
0000011_bbbbbbbb
0010011_iiiiiiii
xxxxxxx_xxxxxxxx
xxxxxxx_xxxxxxxx
xxxxxxx_xxxxxxxx
xxxxxxx_xxxxxxxx
(10)
0110111_00000000
1110111_00000000
0110111_00000000
xxxxxxx_xxxxxxxx
xxxxxxx_xxxxxxxx
xxxxxxx_xxxxxxxx
4e. Latch Data
(1)
(1)
0110011_00000000
0110001_00000000
0110011_00000000
0110011_00000000
xxxxxxx_xxxxxxxx
xxxxxxx_xxxxxxxx
xxxxxxx_xxxxxxxx
xxxxxxx_xxxxxxxx
4f. Write EEPROM Page
362
ATmega640/1280/1281/2560/2561
2549L–AVR–08/07
ATmega640/1280/1281/2560/2561
Table 30-18. JTAG Programming Instruction (Continued)
Set (Continued) a = address high bits, b = address low bits, c = address extended bits, H = 0 - Low byte, 1 - High Byte,
o = data out, i = data in, x = don’t care
Instruction
TDI Sequence
TDO Sequence
Notes
4g. Poll for Page Write Complete
5a. Enter EEPROM Read
5b. Load Address High Byte
5c. Load Address Low Byte
0110011_00000000
0100011_00000011
0000111_aaaaaaaa
0000011_bbbbbbbb
xxxxxox_xxxxxxxx
xxxxxxx_xxxxxxxx
xxxxxxx_xxxxxxxx
xxxxxxx_xxxxxxxx
(2)
(10)
0110011_bbbbbbbb
0110010_00000000
0110011_00000000
xxxxxxx_xxxxxxxx
xxxxxxx_xxxxxxxx
xxxxxxx_oooooooo
5d. Read Data Byte
6a. Enter Fuse Write
0100011_01000000
xxxxxxx_xxxxxxxx
xxxxxxx_xxxxxxxx
6b. Load Data Low Byte(6)
0010011_iiiiiiii
(3)
(1)
0111011_00000000
0111001_00000000
0111011_00000000
0111011_00000000
xxxxxxx_xxxxxxxx
xxxxxxx_xxxxxxxx
xxxxxxx_xxxxxxxx
xxxxxxx_xxxxxxxx
6c. Write Fuse Extended Byte
6d. Poll for Fuse Write Complete
0110111_00000000
xxxxxox_xxxxxxxx
(2)
(3)
6e. Load Data Low Byte(7)
0010011_iiiiiiii
xxxxxxx_xxxxxxxx
0110111_00000000
0110101_00000000
0110111_00000000
0110111_00000000
xxxxxxx_xxxxxxxx
xxxxxxx_xxxxxxxx
xxxxxxx_xxxxxxxx
xxxxxxx_xxxxxxxx
6f. Write Fuse High Byte
(1)
6g. Poll for Fuse Write Complete
0110111_00000000
xxxxxox_xxxxxxxx
(2)
(3)
6h. Load Data Low Byte(7)
0010011_iiiiiiii
xxxxxxx_xxxxxxxx
0110011_00000000
0110001_00000000
0110011_00000000
0110011_00000000
xxxxxxx_xxxxxxxx
xxxxxxx_xxxxxxxx
xxxxxxx_xxxxxxxx
xxxxxxx_xxxxxxxx
6i. Write Fuse Low Byte
(1)
6j. Poll for Fuse Write Complete
7a. Enter Lock Bit Write
7b. Load Data Byte(9)
0110011_00000000
0100011_00100000
0010011_11iiiiii
xxxxxox_xxxxxxxx
xxxxxxx_xxxxxxxx
xxxxxxx_xxxxxxxx
(2)
(4)
0110011_00000000
0110001_00000000
0110011_00000000
0110011_00000000
xxxxxxx_xxxxxxxx
xxxxxxx_xxxxxxxx
xxxxxxx_xxxxxxxx
xxxxxxx_xxxxxxxx
7c. Write Lock Bits
(1)
(2)
7d. Poll for Lock Bit Write complete
0110011_00000000
0100011_00000100
xxxxxox_xxxxxxxx
8a. Enter Fuse/Lock Bit Read
xxxxxxx_xxxxxxxx
0111010_00000000
0111011_00000000
xxxxxxx_xxxxxxxx
8b. Read Extended Fuse Byte(6)
8c. Read Fuse High Byte(7)
xxxxxxx_oooooooo
0111110_00000000
0111111_00000000
xxxxxxx_xxxxxxxx
xxxxxxx_oooooooo
363
2549L–AVR–08/07
Table 30-18. JTAG Programming Instruction (Continued)
Set (Continued) a = address high bits, b = address low bits, c = address extended bits, H = 0 - Low byte, 1 - High Byte,
o = data out, i = data in, x = don’t care
Instruction
TDI Sequence
TDO Sequence
Notes
0110010_00000000
0110011_00000000
xxxxxxx_xxxxxxxx
8d. Read Fuse Low Byte(8)
xxxxxxx_oooooooo
0110110_00000000
0110111_00000000
xxxxxxx_xxxxxxxx
8e. Read Lock Bits(9)
(5)
xxxxxxx_xxoooooo
0111010_00000000
0111110_00000000
0110010_00000000
0110110_00000000
0110111_00000000
xxxxxxx_xxxxxxxx
xxxxxxx_oooooooo
xxxxxxx_oooooooo
xxxxxxx_oooooooo
xxxxxxx_oooooooo
(5)
Fuse Ext. byte
Fuse High byte
Fuse Low byte
Lock bits
8f. Read Fuses and Lock Bits
9a. Enter Signature Byte Read
9b. Load Address Byte
0100011_00001000
xxxxxxx_xxxxxxxx
xxxxxxx_xxxxxxxx
0000011_bbbbbbbb
0110010_00000000
0110011_00000000
xxxxxxx_xxxxxxxx
9c. Read Signature Byte
xxxxxxx_oooooooo
10a. Enter Calibration Byte Read
10b. Load Address Byte
0100011_00001000
xxxxxxx_xxxxxxxx
xxxxxxx_xxxxxxxx
0000011_bbbbbbbb
0110110_00000000
0110111_00000000
xxxxxxx_xxxxxxxx
10c. Read Calibration Byte
xxxxxxx_oooooooo
0100011_00000000
0110011_00000000
xxxxxxx_xxxxxxxx
xxxxxxx_xxxxxxxx
11a. Load No Operation Command
Notes: 1. This command sequence is not required if the seven MSB are correctly set by the previous command sequence (which is
normally the case).
2. Repeat until o = “1”.
3. Set bits to “0” to program the corresponding Fuse, “1” to unprogram the Fuse.
4. Set bits to “0” to program the corresponding Lock bit, “1” to leave the Lock bit unchanged.
5. “0” = programmed, “1” = unprogrammed.
6. The bit mapping for Fuses Extended byte is listed in Table 30-3 on page 338
7. The bit mapping for Fuses High byte is listed in Table 30-4 on page 339
8. The bit mapping for Fuses Low byte is listed in Table 30-5 on page 339
9. The bit mapping for Lock bits byte is listed in Table 30-1 on page 337
10. Address bits exceeding PCMSB and EEAMSB (Table 30-7 and Table 30-8) are don’t care
11. All TDI and TDO sequences are represented by binary digits (0b...).
364
ATmega640/1280/1281/2560/2561
2549L–AVR–08/07
ATmega640/1280/1281/2560/2561
Figure 30-15. State Machine Sequence for Changing/Reading the Data Word
1
Test-Logic-Reset
0
1
1
1
0
Run-Test/Idle
Select-DR Scan
Select-IR Scan
0
0
1
1
Capture-DR
Capture-IR
0
0
Shift-IR
1
Shift-DR
0
0
1
Exit1-DR
0
1
1
Exit1-IR
0
Pause-DR
1
0
Pause-IR
1
0
0
0
Exit2-DR
1
Exit2-IR
1
Update-DR
Update-IR
1
1
0
0
30.9.11 Flash Data Byte Register
The Flash Data Byte Register provides an efficient way to load the entire Flash page buffer
before executing Page Write, or to read out/verify the content of the Flash. A state machine sets
up the control signals to the Flash and senses the strobe signals from the Flash, thus only the
data words need to be shifted in/out.
The Flash Data Byte Register actually consists of the 8-bit scan chain and a 8-bit temporary reg-
ister. During page load, the Update-DR state copies the content of the scan chain over to the
temporary register and initiates a write sequence that within 11 TCK cycles loads the content of
the temporary register into the Flash page buffer. The AVR automatically alternates between
writing the low and the high byte for each new Update-DR state, starting with the low byte for the
first Update-DR encountered after entering the PROG_PAGELOAD command. The Program
Counter is pre-incremented before writing the low byte, except for the first written byte. This
ensures that the first data is written to the address set up by PROG_COMMANDS, and loading
the last location in the page buffer does not make the Program Counter increment into the next
page.
During Page Read, the content of the selected Flash byte is captured into the Flash Data Byte
Register during the Capture-DR state. The AVR automatically alternates between reading the
low and the high byte for each new Capture-DR state, starting with the low byte for the first Cap-
365
2549L–AVR–08/07
ture-DR encountered after entering the PROG_PAGEREAD command. The Program Counter is
post-incremented after reading each high byte, including the first read byte. This ensures that
the first data is captured from the first address set up by PROG_COMMANDS, and reading the
last location in the page makes the program counter increment into the next page.
Figure 30-16. Flash Data Byte Register
STROBES
State
Machine
TDI
ADDRESS
Flash
EEPROM
Fuses
Lock Bits
D
A
T
A
TDO
The state machine controlling the Flash Data Byte Register is clocked by TCK. During normal
operation in which eight bits are shifted for each Flash byte, the clock cycles needed to navigate
through the TAP controller automatically feeds the state machine for the Flash Data Byte Regis-
ter with sufficient number of clock pulses to complete its operation transparently for the user.
However, if too few bits are shifted between each Update-DR state during page load, the TAP
controller should stay in the Run-Test/Idle state for some TCK cycles to ensure that there are at
least 11 TCK cycles between each Update-DR state.
30.9.12 Programming Algorithm
All references below of type “1a”, “1b”, and so on, refer to Table 30-18.
30.9.13 Entering Programming Mode
1. Enter JTAG instruction AVR_RESET and shift 1 in the Reset Register.
2. Enter instruction PROG_ENABLE and shift 0b1010_0011_0111_0000 in the Program-
ming Enable Register.
30.9.14 Leaving Programming Mode
1. Enter JTAG instruction PROG_COMMANDS.
2. Disable all programming instructions by using no operation instruction 11a.
3. Enter instruction PROG_ENABLE and shift 0b0000_0000_0000_0000 in the program-
ming Enable Register.
4. Enter JTAG instruction AVR_RESET and shift 0 in the Reset Register.
366
ATmega640/1280/1281/2560/2561
2549L–AVR–08/07
ATmega640/1280/1281/2560/2561
30.9.15 Performing Chip Erase
1. Enter JTAG instruction PROG_COMMANDS.
2. Start Chip Erase using programming instruction 1a.
3. Poll for Chip Erase complete using programming instruction 1b, or wait for tWLRH_CE (refer
to Table 30-14 on page 350).
30.9.16 Programming the Flash
Before programming the Flash a Chip Erase must be performed, see “Performing Chip Erase”
on page 367.
1. Enter JTAG instruction PROG_COMMANDS.
2. Enable Flash write using programming instruction 2a.
3. Load address Extended High byte using programming instruction 2b.
4. Load address High byte using programming instruction 2c.
5. Load address Low byte using programming instruction 2d.
6. Load data using programming instructions 2e, 2f and 2g.
7. Repeat steps 5 and 6 for all instruction words in the page.
8. Write the page using programming instruction 2h.
9. Poll for Flash write complete using programming instruction 2i, or wait for tWLRH (refer to
Table 30-14 on page 350).
10. Repeat steps 3 to 9 until all data have been programmed.
A more efficient data transfer can be achieved using the PROG_PAGELOAD instruction:
1. Enter JTAG instruction PROG_COMMANDS.
2. Enable Flash write using programming instruction 2a.
3. Load the page address using programming instructions 2b, 2c and 2d. PCWORD (refer
to Table 30-7 on page 340) is used to address within one page and must be written as 0.
4. Enter JTAG instruction PROG_PAGELOAD.
5. Load the entire page by shifting in all instruction words in the page byte-by-byte, starting
with the LSB of the first instruction in the page and ending with the MSB of the last
instruction in the page. Use Update-DR to copy the contents of the Flash Data Byte Reg-
ister into the Flash page location and to auto-increment the Program Counter before
each new word.
6. Enter JTAG instruction PROG_COMMANDS.
7. Write the page using programming instruction 2h.
8. Poll for Flash write complete using programming instruction 2i, or wait for tWLRH (refer to
Table 30-14 on page 350).
9. Repeat steps 3 to 8 until all data have been programmed.
30.9.17 Reading the Flash
1. Enter JTAG instruction PROG_COMMANDS.
2. Enable Flash read using programming instruction 3a.
3. Load address using programming instructions 3b, 3c and 3d.
4. Read data using programming instruction 3e.
5. Repeat steps 3 and 4 until all data have been read.
A more efficient data transfer can be achieved using the PROG_PAGEREAD instruction:
367
2549L–AVR–08/07
1. Enter JTAG instruction PROG_COMMANDS.
2. Enable Flash read using programming instruction 3a.
3. Load the page address using programming instructions 3b, 3c and 3d. PCWORD (refer
to Table 30-7 on page 340) is used to address within one page and must be written as 0.
4. Enter JTAG instruction PROG_PAGEREAD.
5. Read the entire page (or Flash) by shifting out all instruction words in the page (or Flash),
starting with the LSB of the first instruction in the page (Flash) and ending with the MSB
of the last instruction in the page (Flash). The Capture-DR state both captures the data
from the Flash, and also auto-increments the program counter after each word is read.
Note that Capture-DR comes before the shift-DR state. Hence, the first byte which is
shifted out contains valid data.
6. Enter JTAG instruction PROG_COMMANDS.
7. Repeat steps 3 to 6 until all data have been read.
30.9.18 Programming the EEPROM
Before programming the EEPROM a Chip Erase must be performed, see “Performing Chip
Erase” on page 367.
1. Enter JTAG instruction PROG_COMMANDS.
2. Enable EEPROM write using programming instruction 4a.
3. Load address High byte using programming instruction 4b.
4. Load address Low byte using programming instruction 4c.
5. Load data using programming instructions 4d and 4e.
6. Repeat steps 4 and 5 for all data bytes in the page.
7. Write the data using programming instruction 4f.
8. Poll for EEPROM write complete using programming instruction 4g, or wait for tWLRH
(refer to Table 30-14 on page 350).
9. Repeat steps 3 to 8 until all data have been programmed.
Note that the PROG_PAGELOAD instruction can not be used when programming the EEPROM.
30.9.19 Reading the EEPROM
1. Enter JTAG instruction PROG_COMMANDS.
2. Enable EEPROM read using programming instruction 5a.
3. Load address using programming instructions 5b and 5c.
4. Read data using programming instruction 5d.
5. Repeat steps 3 and 4 until all data have been read.
Note that the PROG_PAGEREAD instruction can not be used when reading the EEPROM.
30.9.20 Programming the Fuses
1. Enter JTAG instruction PROG_COMMANDS.
2. Enable Fuse write using programming instruction 6a.
3. Load data high byte using programming instructions 6b. A bit value of “0” will program the
corresponding fuse, a “1” will unprogram the fuse.
4. Write Fuse High byte using programming instruction 6c.
5. Poll for Fuse write complete using programming instruction 6d, or wait for tWLRH (refer to
Table 30-14 on page 350).
368
ATmega640/1280/1281/2560/2561
2549L–AVR–08/07
ATmega640/1280/1281/2560/2561
6. Load data low byte using programming instructions 6e. A “0” will program the fuse, a “1”
will unprogram the fuse.
7. Write Fuse low byte using programming instruction 6f.
8. Poll for Fuse write complete using programming instruction 6g, or wait for tWLRH (refer to
Table 30-14 on page 350).
30.9.21 Programming the Lock Bits
1. Enter JTAG instruction PROG_COMMANDS.
2. Enable Lock bit write using programming instruction 7a.
3. Load data using programming instructions 7b. A bit value of “0” will program the corre-
sponding lock bit, a “1” will leave the lock bit unchanged.
4. Write Lock bits using programming instruction 7c.
5. Poll for Lock bit write complete using programming instruction 7d, or wait for tWLRH (refer
to Table 30-14 on page 350).
30.9.22 Reading the Fuses and Lock Bits
1. Enter JTAG instruction PROG_COMMANDS.
2. Enable Fuse/Lock bit read using programming instruction 8a.
3. To read all Fuses and Lock bits, use programming instruction 8e.
To only read Fuse High byte, use programming instruction 8b.
To only read Fuse Low byte, use programming instruction 8c.
To only read Lock bits, use programming instruction 8d.
30.9.23 Reading the Signature Bytes
1. Enter JTAG instruction PROG_COMMANDS.
2. Enable Signature byte read using programming instruction 9a.
3. Load address 0x00 using programming instruction 9b.
4. Read first signature byte using programming instruction 9c.
5. Repeat steps 3 and 4 with address 0x01 and address 0x02 to read the second and third
signature bytes, respectively.
30.9.24 Reading the Calibration Byte
1. Enter JTAG instruction PROG_COMMANDS.
2. Enable Calibration byte read using programming instruction 10a.
3. Load address 0x00 using programming instruction 10b.
4. Read the calibration byte using programming instruction 10c.
369
2549L–AVR–08/07
31. Electrical Characteristics
Absolute Maximum Ratings*
Operating Temperature.................................. -55°C to +125°C
*NOTICE:
Stresses beyond those listed under “Absolute
Maximum Ratings” may cause permanent dam-
age to the device. This is a stress rating only and
functional operation of the device at these or
other conditions beyond those indicated in the
operational sections of this specification is not
implied. Exposure to absolute maximum rating
conditions for extended periods may affect
device reliability.
Storage Temperature..................................... -65°C to +150°C
Voltage on any Pin except RESET
with respect to Ground ................................-0.5V to VCC+0.5V
Voltage on RESET with respect to Ground......-0.5V to +13.0V
Maximum Operating Voltage ............................................ 6.0V
DC Current per I/O Pin ............................................... 40.0 mA
DC Current VCC and GND Pins................................ 200.0 mA
31.1 DC Characteristics
TA = -40°C to 85°C, VCC = 1.8V to 5.5V (unless otherwise noted)
Symbol
Parameter
Condition
Min.
Typ.
Max.
Units
(1)
(1)
Input Low Voltage,Except
XTAL1 and Reset pin
VCC = 1.8V - 2.4V
VCC = 2.4V - 5.5V
-0.5
-0.5
0.2VCC
0.3VCC
VIL
V
Input Low Voltage,
XTAL1 pin
(1)
(1)
VIL1
VIL2
VCC = 1.8V - 5.5V
VCC = 1.8V - 5.5V
-0.5
-0.5
0.1VCC
0.1VCC
V
V
Input Low Voltage,
RESET pin
Input High Voltage,
Except XTAL1 and
RESET pins
(2)
(2)
VCC = 1.8V - 2.4V
VCC = 2.4V - 5.5V
0.7VCC
0.6VCC
VCC + 0.5
VCC + 0.5
VIH
V
(2)
(2)
Input High Voltage,
XTAL1 pin
VCC = 1.8V - 2.4V
VCC = 2.4V - 5.5V
0.8VCC
0.7VCC
VCC + 0.5
VCC + 0.5
VIH1
VIH2
VOL
V
V
V
Input High Voltage,
RESET pin
(2)
VCC = 1.8V - 5.5V
0.9VCC
VCC + 0.5
Output Low Voltage(3),
Except RESET pin
IOL = 20 mA, VCC = 5V
IOL = 10 mA, VCC = 3V
0.9
0.6
Output High Voltage(4),
Except RESET pin
IOH = -20 mA, VCC = 5V
IOH = -10 mA, VCC = 3V
4.2
2.3
VOH
V
Input Leakage
Current I/O Pin
VCC = 5.5V, pin low
(absolute value)
IIL
1
1
µA
µA
Input Leakage
Current I/O Pin
VCC = 5.5V, pin high
(absolute value)
IIH
RRST
RPU
Reset Pull-up Resistor
I/O Pin Pull-up Resistor
30
20
60
50
kΩ
kΩ
370
ATmega640/1280/1281/2560/2561
2549L–AVR–08/07
ATmega640/1280/1281/2560/2561
TA = -40°C to 85°C, VCC = 1.8V to 5.5V (unless otherwise noted) (Continued)
Symbol
Parameter
Condition
Min.
Typ.
Max.
Units
Active 1MHz, VCC = 2V
0.5
0.8
mA
(ATmega640/1280/2560/1V)
Active 4MHz, VCC = 3V
3.2
10
5
14
mA
mA
mA
mA
mA
(ATmega640/1280/2560/1L)
Active 8MHz, VCC = 5V
(ATmega640/1280/1281/2560/2561)
Power Supply Current(5)
Idle 1MHz, VCC = 2V
0.14
0.7
2.7
0.22
1.1
4
ICC
(ATmega640/1280/2560/1V)
Idle 4MHz, VCC = 3V
(ATmega640/1280/2560/1L)
Idle 8MHz, VCC = 5V
(ATmega640/1280/1281/2560/2561)
WDT enabled, VCC = 3V
WDT disabled, VCC = 3V
<5
<1
15
µA
µA
Power-down mode
7.5
VCC = 5V
Analog Comparator
Input Offset Voltage
VACIO
IACLK
tACID
<10
40
50
mV
nA
ns
Vin = VCC/2
Analog Comparator
Input Leakage Current
VCC = 5V
Vin = VCC/2
-50
Analog Comparator
Propagation Delay
VCC = 2.7V
VCC = 4.0V
750
500
Notes: 1. "Max" means the highest value where the pin is guaranteed to be read as low
2. "Min" means the lowest value where the pin is guaranteed to be read as high
3. Although each I/O port can sink more than the test conditions (20mA at VCC = 5V, 10mA at VCC = 3V) under steady state
conditions (non-transient), the following must be observed:
ATmega1281/2561:
1.)The sum of all IOL, for ports A0-A7, G2, C4-C7 should not exceed 100 mA.
2.)The sum of all IOL, for ports C0-C3, G0-G1, D0-D7 should not exceed 100 mA.
3.)The sum of all IOL, for ports G3-G5, B0-B7, E0-E7 should not exceed 100 mA.
4.)The sum of all IOL, for ports F0-F7 should not exceed 100 mA.
ATmega640/1280/2560:
1.)The sum of all IOL, for ports J0-J7, A0-A7, G2 should not exceed 200 mA.
2.)The sum of all IOL, for ports C0-C7, G0-G1, D0-D7, L0-L7 should not exceed 200 mA.
3.)The sum of all IOL, for ports G3-G4, B0-B7, H0-B7 should not exceed 200 mA.
4.)The sum of all IOL, for ports E0-E7, G5 should not exceed 100 mA.
5.)The sum of all IOL, for ports F0-F7, K0-K7 should not exceed 100 mA.
If IOL exceeds the test condition, VOL may exceed the related specification. Pins are not guaranteed to sink current greater
than the listed test condition.
4. Although each I/O port can source more than the test conditions (20mA at VCC = 5V, 10mA at VCC = 3V) under steady
state conditions (non-transient), the following must be observed:
ATmega1281/2561:
1)The sum of all IOH, for ports A0-A7, G2, C4-C7 should not exceed 100 mA.
2)The sum of all IOH, for ports C0-C3, G0-G1, D0-D7 should not exceed 100 mA.
3)The sum of all IOH, for ports G3-G5, B0-B7, E0-E7 should not exceed 100 mA.
4)The sum of all IOH, for ports F0-F7 should not exceed 100 mA.
ATmega640/1280/2560:
1)The sum of all IOH, for ports J0-J7, G2, A0-A7 should not exceed 200 mA.
2)The sum of all IOH, for ports C0-C7, G0-G1, D0-D7, L0-L7 should not exceed 200 mA.
371
2549L–AVR–08/07
3)The sum of all IOH, for ports G3-G4, B0-B7, H0-H7 should not exceed 200 mA.
4)The sum of all IOH, for ports E0-E7, G5 should not exceed 100 mA.
5)The sum of all IOH, for ports F0-F7, K0-K7 should not exceed 100 mA.
If IOH exceeds the test condition, VOH may exceed the related specification. Pins are not guaranteed to source current
greater than the listed test condition.
5. Values with “PRR1 – Power Reduction Register 1” enabled (0xFF).
31.2 Speed Grades
Maximum frequency is depending on VCC. As shown in Figure 31-1 trough Figure 31-4, the Max-
imum Frequency vs. VCC curve is linear between 1.8V < VCC < 2.7V and between 2.7V < VCC
4.5V.
<
31.2.1
8 MHz
Figure 31-1. Maximum Frequency vs. VCC, ATmega640V/1280V/1281V/2560V/2561V
8 MHz
4 MHz
Safe Operating Area
1.8V
2.7V
5.5V
Figure 31-2. Maximum Frequency vs. VCC when only using No-Read-While-Write Section(1),
ATmega2560V/ATmega2561V
8 MHz
Safe Operating Area
2 MHz
1.8V
2.7V
5.5V
Note:
1. When only using the Read-While-Write Section of the program memory, a higher speed can
be achieved at low voltage, see “Read-While-Write and No Read-While-Write Flash Sections”
on page 318 for addresses.
372
ATmega640/1280/1281/2560/2561
2549L–AVR–08/07
ATmega640/1280/1281/2560/2561
31.2.2
16 MHz
Figure 31-3. Maximum Frequency vs. VCC, ATmega640/ATmega1280/ATmega1281
16 MHz
8 MHz
Safe Operating Area
2.7V
4.5V
5.5V
Figure 31-4. Maximum Frequency vs. VCC, ATmega2560/ATmega2561
16 MHz
Safe Operating Area
4.5V
5.5V
373
2549L–AVR–08/07
31.3 Clock Characteristics
31.3.1
Calibrated Internal RC Oscillator Accuracy
Table 31-1. Calibration Accuracy of Internal RC Oscillator
Frequency
VCC
Temperature
Calibration Accuracy
Factory Calibration
User Calibration
8.0 MHz
3V
25°C
10%
1.8V - 5.5V(1)
2.7V - 5.5V(2)
7.3 - 8.1 MHz
-40°C - 85°C
1%
Notes: 1. Voltage range for ATmega640V/1281V/1280V/2561V/2560V.
2. Voltage range for ATmega640/1281/1280/2561/2560.
31.3.2
External Clock Drive Waveforms
Figure 31-5. External Clock Drive Waveforms
VIH1
VIL1
31.4 External Clock Drive
Table 31-2. External Clock Drive
VCC=1.8-5.5V
VCC=2.7-5.5V
VCC=4.5-5.5V
Symbol
Parameter
Min.
Max.
Min.
Max.
Min.
Max.
Units
Oscillator
Frequency
1/tCLCL
0
2
0
8
0
16
MHz
tCLCL
tCHCX
tCLCX
tCLCH
tCHCL
Clock Period
High Time
Low Time
Rise Time
Fall Time
500
200
200
125
50
62.5
25
ns
ns
ns
μs
μs
50
25
2.0
2.0
1.6
1.6
0.5
0.5
Change in period
from one clock
cycle to the next
ΔtCLCL
2
2
2
%
374
ATmega640/1280/1281/2560/2561
2549L–AVR–08/07
ATmega640/1280/1281/2560/2561
31.5 System and Reset Characteristics
Table 31-3. Reset, Brown-out and Internal voltage CharacteristicsCharacteristics
Symbol
Parameter
Condition
Min
Typ
Max
Units
Power-on Reset Threshold Voltage
(rising)
0.7
1.0
1.4
V
VPOT
Power-on Reset Threshold Voltage
(falling)(1)
0.05
0.9
1.3
V
VPSR
VRST
tRST
VHYST
tBOD
VBG
tBG
Power-on slope rate
0.01
4.5
0.9VCC
2.5
V/ms
V
RESET Pin Threshold Voltage
Minimum pulse width on RESET Pin
Brown-out Detector Hysteresis
Min Pulse Width on Brown-out Reset
Bandgap reference voltage
0.2VCC
ns
50
2
mV
ns
VCC=2.7V,TA= 25°C
VCC=2.7V,TA= 25°C
VCC=2.7V,TA= 25°C
1.0
1.1
40
10
1.2
70
V
Bandgap reference start-up time
Bandgap reference current consumption
µs
IBG
µA
Note:
1. The Power-on Reset will not work unless the supply voltage has been below VPOT (falling).
Table 31-4. BODLEVEL Fuse Coding(1)
BODLEVEL 2:0 Fuses
Min VBOT
Typ VBOT
Max VBOT
Units
111
110
101
100
011
010
001
000
BOD Disabled
1.7
2.5
4.1
1.8
2.7
4.3
2.0
2.9
4.5
V
Reserved
Note:
1. VBOT may be below nominal minimum operating voltage for some devices. For devices where this is the case, the device is
tested down to VCC = VBOT during the production test. This guarantees that a Brown-Out Reset will occur before VCC drops to
a voltage where correct operation of the microcontroller is no longer guaranteed. The test is performed using
BODLEVEL = 110 for 4 MHz operation of ATmega640V/1280V/1281V/2560V/2561V, BODLEVEL = 101 for 8 MHz operation
of ATmega640V/1280V/1281V/2560V/2561V and ATmega640/1280/1281, and BODLEVEL = 100 for 16 MHz operation of
ATmega640/1280/1281/2560/2561
31.6 2-wire Serial Interface Characteristics
Table 31-5 describes the requirements for devices connected to the 2-wire Serial Bus. The
ATmega640/1280/1281/2560/2561 2-wire Serial Interface meets or exceeds these requirements under the noted
conditions.
375
2549L–AVR–08/07
Timing symbols refer to Figure 31-6.
Table 31-5. 2-wire Serial Bus Requirements
Symbol Parameter
Condition
Min
-0.5
Max
0.3 VCC
VCC + 0.5
–
Units
VIL
Input Low-voltage
V
V
V
V
VIH
Vhys
Input High-voltage
0.7 VCC
(1)
(1)
(2)
Hysteresis of Schmitt Trigger Inputs
Output Low-voltage
0.05 VCC
0
VOL
tr(1)
3 mA sink current
0.4
20 +
Rise Time for both SDA and SCL
300
ns
ns
(3)(2)
0.1Cb
20 +
tof
Output Fall Time from VIHmin to VILmax
10 pF < Cb < 400 pF(3)
0.1VCC < Vi < 0.9VCC
250
(1)
(3)(2)
0.1Cb
0
tSP
Ii
Ci(1)
Spikes Suppressed by Input Filter
Input Current each I/O Pin
50(2)
10
ns
µA
pF
(1)
-10
–
Capacitance for each I/O Pin
10
fCK(4) > max(16fSCL
250kHz)(5)
,
fSCL
SCL Clock Frequency
Value of Pull-up resistor
0
400
kHz
Ω
VCC – 0,4V
----------------------------
3mA
fSCL ≤ 100 kHz
1000ns
-------------------
Cb
Rp
VCC – 0,4V
----------------------------
3mA
f
SCL > 100 kHz
300ns
---------------
Ω
Cb
fSCL ≤ 100 kHz
SCL > 100 kHz
4.0
0.6
4.7
1.3
4.0
0.6
4.7
0.6
0
–
µs
µs
µs
µs
µs
µs
µs
µs
µs
µs
ns
ns
µs
µs
µs
µs
tHD;STA
Hold Time (repeated) START Condition
Low Period of the SCL Clock
High period of the SCL clock
Set-up time for a repeated START condition
Data hold time
f
–
fSCL ≤ 100 kHz(6)
fSCL > 100 kHz(7)
fSCL ≤ 100 kHz
fSCL > 100 kHz
fSCL ≤ 100 kHz
–
tLOW
–
–
tHIGH
–
–
tSU;STA
tHD;DAT
tSU;DAT
tSU;STO
tBUF
f
SCL > 100 kHz
–
fSCL ≤ 100 kHz
fSCL > 100 kHz
fSCL ≤ 100 kHz
fSCL > 100 kHz
fSCL ≤ 100 kHz
3.45
0.9
–
0
250
100
4.0
0.6
4.7
1.3
Data setup time
–
–
Setup time for STOP condition
f
SCL > 100 kHz
fSCL ≤ 100 kHz
SCL > 100 kHz
–
–
Bus free time between a STOP and START
condition
f
–
Notes: 1. In ATmega640/1280/1281/2560/2561, this parameter is characterized and not 100% tested.
2. Required only for fSCL > 100 kHz.
3. Cb = capacitance of one bus line in pF.
4. fCK = CPU clock frequency
376
ATmega640/1280/1281/2560/2561
2549L–AVR–08/07
ATmega640/1280/1281/2560/2561
5. This requirement applies to all ATmega640/1280/1281/2560/2561 2-wire Serial Interface operation. Other devices con-
nected to the 2-wire Serial Bus need only obey the general fSCL requirement.
6. The actual low period generated by the ATmega640/1280/1281/2560/2561 2-wire Serial Interface is (1/fSCL - 2/fCK), thus
fCK must be greater than 6 MHz for the low time requirement to be strictly met at fSCL = 100 kHz.
7. The actual low period generated by the ATmega640/1280/1281/2560/2561 2-wire Serial Interface is (1/fSCL - 2/fCK), thus
the low time requirement will not be strictly met for fSCL > 308 kHz when fCK = 8 MHz. Still,
ATmega640/1280/1281/2560/2561 devices connected to the bus may communicate at full speed (400 kHz) with other
ATmega640/1280/1281/2560/2561 devices, as well as any other device with a proper tLOW acceptance margin.
Figure 31-6. 2-wire Serial Bus Timing
t
HIGH
t
t
r
of
t
t
LOW
LOW
SCL
SDA
t
t
t
HD;DAT
SU;STA
HD;STA
t
SU;DAT
t
SU;STO
t
BUF
31.7 SPI Timing Characteristics
See Figure 31-7 and Figure 31-8 for details.
Table 31-6. SPI Timing Parameters
Description
SCK period
SCK high/low
Rise/Fall time
Setup
Mode
Master
Master
Master
Master
Master
Master
Master
Master
Slave
Min
Typ
Max
1
2
See Table 21-5
50% duty cycle
3
3.6
10
4
5
Hold
10
6
Out to SCK
SCK to out
SCK to out high
SS low to out
SCK period
SCK high/low(1)
Rise/Fall time
Setup
0.5 • tsck
10
7
8
10
9
15
ns
10
11
12
13
14
15
16
17
18
Slave
4 • tck
2 • tck
Slave
Slave
1600
Slave
10
tck
Hold
Slave
SCK to out
SCK to SS high
SS high to tri-state
SS low to SCK
Slave
15
10
Slave
20
20
Slave
Slave
377
2549L–AVR–08/07
Note:
1. In SPI Programming mode the minimum SCK high/low period is:
- 2 tCLCL for fCK < 12 MHz
- 3 tCLCL for fCK > 12 MHz
Figure 31-7. SPI Interface Timing Requirements (Master Mode)
SS
6
1
SCK
(CPOL = 0)
2
2
SCK
(CPOL = 1)
4
5
3
MISO
(Data Input)
MSB
...
LSB
7
8
MOSI
(Data Output)
MSB
...
LSB
Figure 31-8. SPI Interface Timing Requirements (Slave Mode)
SS
10
16
9
SCK
(CPOL = 0)
11
11
SCK
(CPOL = 1)
13
14
12
MOSI
(Data Input)
MSB
...
LSB
15
17
MISO
(Data Output)
MSB
...
LSB
X
378
ATmega640/1280/1281/2560/2561
2549L–AVR–08/07
ATmega640/1280/1281/2560/2561
31.8 ADC Characteristics – Preliminary Data
Table 31-7. ADC Characteristics, Singel Ended Channels
Symbol
Parameter
Condition
Min(1)
Typ(1)
Max(1)
Units
Resolution
Single Ended Conversion
10
Bits
Single Ended Conversion
VREF = 4V, VCC = 4V,
CLKADC= 200 kHz
2.25
3
2.5
LSB
LSB
Single Ended Conversion
VREF = 4V, VCC = 4V,
CLKADC = 1 MHz
Absolute accuracy (Including
INL, DNL, quantization error,
gain and offset error)
Single Ended Conversion
VREF = 4V, VCC = 4V,
2
3
LSB
LSB
CLKADC = 200 kHz
Noise Reduction Mode
Single Ended Conversion
VREF = 4V, VCC = 4V,
CLKADC = 1 MHz
Noise Reduction Mode
Single Ended Conversion
VREF = 4V, VCC = 4V,
CLKADC = 200 kHz
Integral Non-Linearity (INL)
Differential Non-Linearity (DNL)
Gain Error
1.25
0.5
2
LSB
LSB
LSB
LSB
Single Ended Conversion
VREF = 4V, VCC = 4V,
CLKADC = 200 kHz
Single Ended Conversion
VREF = 4V, VCC = 4V,
CLKADC= 200 kHz
Single Ended Conversion
Offset Error
VREF = 4V, VCC = 4V,
-2
CLKADC = 200 kHz
Conversion Time
Free Running Conversion
Single Ended Conversion
13
50
260
1000
µs
kHz
V
Clock Frequency
AVCC
VREF
VIN
Analog Supply Voltage
Reference Voltage
VCC - 0.3
1.0
VCC + 0.3
AVCC
VREF
V
Input Voltage
GND
V
Input Bandwidth
38,5
1.1
kHz
V
VINT1
VINT2
RREF
RAIN
Internal Voltage Reference
Internal Voltage Reference
Reference Input Resistance
Analog Input Resistance
1.1V
1.0
2.4
1.2
2.8
2.56V
2.56
32
V
kΩ
MΩ
100
Note:
1. Values are guidelines only.
379
2549L–AVR–08/07
Table 31-8. ADC Characteristics, Differential Channels
Symbol Parameter
Condition
Gain = 1x
Gain = 10x
Gain = 200x
Min(1)
Typ(1)
Max(1)
Units
Bits
8
8
7
Resolution
Bits
Bits
Gain = 1x
V
REF = 4V, VCC = 5V
18
17
9
LSB
LSB
LSB
LSB
LSB
LSB
LSB
LSB
LSB
CLKADC = 50 - 200 kHz
Gain = 10x
VREF = 4V, VCC = 5V
CLKADC = 50 - 200 kHz
Absolute Accuracy(Including INL, DNL,
Quantization Error, Gain and Offset Error)
Gain = 200x
VREF = 4V, VCC = 5V
CLKADC = 50 - 200 kHz
Gain = 1x
VREF = 4V, VCC = 5V
CLKADC = 50 - 200 kHz
2.5
5
Gain = 10x
VREF = 4V, VCC = 5V
CLKADC = 50 - 200 kHz
Integral Non-Linearity (INL)
Gain = 200x
VREF = 4V, VCC = 5V
CLKADC = 50 - 200 kHz
9
Gain = 1x
VREF = 4V, VCC = 5V
CLKADC = 50 - 200 kHz
0.75
1.5
Gain = 10x
VREF = 4V, VCC = 5V
CLKADC = 50 - 200 kHz
Differential Non-Linearity (DNL)
Gain = 200x
VREF = 4V, VCC = 5V
CLKADC = 50 - 200 kHz
10
Gain = 1x
Gain = 10x
Gain = 200x
1.7
1.7
0.5
%
%
%
Gain Error
Gain = 1x
VREF = 4V, VCC = 5V
CLKADC = 50 - 200 kHz
2
2
3
LSB
LSB
LSB
Gain = 10x
VREF = 4V, VCC = 5V
CLKADC = 50 - 200 kHz
Offset Error
Gain = 200x
VREF = 4V, VCC = 5V
CLKADC = 50 - 200 kHz
Clock Frequency
Conversion Time
50
65
200
260
kHz
µs
380
ATmega640/1280/1281/2560/2561
2549L–AVR–08/07
ATmega640/1280/1281/2560/2561
Table 31-8. ADC Characteristics, Differential Channels (Continued)
Symbol Parameter Condition
Min(1)
CC - 0.3
2.7
Typ(1)
Max(1)
VCC + 0.3
AVCC - 0.5
VCC
Units
V
AVCC
VREF
VIN
Analog Supply Voltage
V
Reference Voltage
Input Voltage
V
GND
V
VDIFF
Input Differential Voltage
ADC Conversion Output
Input Bandwidth
-VREF/Gain
-511
VREF/Gain
511
V
LSB
kHz
V
4
VINT
RREF
RAIN
Internal Voltage Reference
Reference Input Resistance
Analog Input Resistance
Values are guidelines only.
2.3
2.56
32
2.8
kΩ
MΩ
100
Note:
31.9 External Data Memory Timing
Table 31-9. External Data Memory Characteristics, 4.5 - 5.5 Volts, No Wait-state
8 MHz Oscillator
Variable Oscillator
Symbol
1/tCLCL
tLHLL
Parameter
Min
Max
Min
Max
Unit
MHz
ns
0
1
2
Oscillator Frequency
ALE Pulse Width
0.0
16
115
1.0tCLCL-10
0.5tCLCL-5(1)
tAVLL
Address Valid A to ALE Low
57.5
ns
Address Hold After ALE Low,
write access
3a
3b
tLLAX_ST
tLLAX_LD
5
5
5
ns
ns
Address Hold after ALE Low,
read access
5
4
tAVLLC
tAVRL
tAVWL
tLLWL
tLLRL
Address Valid C to ALE Low
Address Valid to RD Low
Address Valid to WR Low
ALE Low to WR Low
ALE Low to RD Low
57.5
115
115
47.5
47.5
40
0.5tCLCL-5(1)
1.0tCLCL-10
1.0tCLCL-10
0.5tCLCL-15(2)
0.5tCLCL-15(2)
40
ns
ns
ns
ns
ns
ns
ns
ns
ns
ns
ns
ns
ns
5
6
7
67.5
67.5
0.5tCLCL+5(2)
0.5tCLCL+5(2)
8
9
tDVRH
tRLDV
tRHDX
tRLRH
tDVWL
tWHDX
tDVWH
tWLWH
Data Setup to RD High
Read Low to Data Valid
Data Hold After RD High
RD Pulse Width
10
11
12
13
14
15
16
75
1.0tCLCL-50
0
0
115
42.5
115
125
115
1.0tCLCL-10
0.5tCLCL-20(1)
1.0tCLCL-10
1.0tCLCL
Data Setup to WR Low
Data Hold After WR High
Data Valid to WR High
WR Pulse Width
1.0tCLCL-10
Notes: 1. This assumes 50% clock duty cycle. The half period is actually the high time of the external clock, XTAL1.
381
2549L–AVR–08/07
2. This assumes 50% clock duty cycle. The half period is actually the low time of the external clock, XTAL1.
Table 31-10. External Data Memory Characteristics, 4.5 - 5.5 Volts, 1 Cycle Wait-state
8 MHz Oscillator
Variable Oscillator
Min Max
Symbol
Parameter
Min
Max
Unit
MHz
ns
0
1/tCLCL
Oscillator Frequency
Read Low to Data Valid
RD Pulse Width
0.0
16
10 tRLDV
12 tRLRH
15 tDVWH
16 tWLWH
200
2.0tCLCL-50
240
240
240
2.0tCLCL-10
2.0tCLCL
ns
Data Valid to WR High
WR Pulse Width
ns
2.0tCLCL-10
ns
Table 31-11. External Data Memory Characteristics, 4.5 - 5.5 Volts, SRWn1 = 1, SRWn0 = 0
4 MHz Oscillator Variable Oscillator
Symbol
Parameter
Min
Max
Min
Max
16
Unit
MHz
ns
0
1/tCLCL
Oscillator Frequency
Read Low to Data Valid
RD Pulse Width
0.0
10 tRLDV
12 tRLRH
15 tDVWH
16 tWLWH
325
3.0tCLCL-50
365
375
365
3.0tCLCL-10
3.0tCLCL
ns
Data Valid to WR High
WR Pulse Width
ns
3.0tCLCL-10
ns
Table 31-12. External Data Memory Characteristics, 4.5 - 5.5 Volts, SRWn1 = 1, SRWn0 = 1
4 MHz Oscillator Variable Oscillator
Symbol
Parameter
Min
Max
Min
Max
16
Unit
MHz
ns
0
1/tCLCL
Oscillator Frequency
Read Low to Data Valid
RD Pulse Width
0.0
10 tRLDV
12 tRLRH
14 tWHDX
15 tDVWH
16 tWLWH
325
3.0tCLCL-50
365
240
375
365
3.0tCLCL-10
2.0tCLCL-10
3.0tCLCL
ns
Data Hold After WR High
Data Valid to WR High
WR Pulse Width
ns
ns
3.0tCLCL-10
ns
Table 31-13. External Data Memory Characteristics, 2.7 - 5.5 Volts, No Wait-state
4 MHz Oscillator
Variable Oscillator
Symbol
1/tCLCL
tLHLL
Parameter
Min
Max
Min
0.0
Max
Unit
MHz
ns
0
1
2
Oscillator Frequency
ALE Pulse Width
8
235
115
tCLCL-15
0.5tCLCL-10(1)
tAVLL
Address Valid A to ALE Low
ns
Address Hold After ALE Low,
write access
3a tLLAX_ST
5
5
ns
382
ATmega640/1280/1281/2560/2561
2549L–AVR–08/07
ATmega640/1280/1281/2560/2561
Table 31-13. External Data Memory Characteristics, 2.7 - 5.5 Volts, No Wait-state (Continued)
4 MHz Oscillator Variable Oscillator
Min Max
Symbol
Parameter
Min
Max
Unit
Address Hold after ALE Low,
read access
3b tLLAX_LD
5
5
ns
4
5
6
7
8
9
tAVLLC
tAVRL
tAVWL
tLLWL
tLLRL
Address Valid C to ALE Low
Address Valid to RD Low
Address Valid to WR Low
ALE Low to WR Low
ALE Low to RD Low
115
235
235
115
115
45
0.5tCLCL-10(1)
1.0tCLCL-15
1.0tCLCL-15
0.5tCLCL-10(2)
0.5tCLCL-10(2)
45
ns
ns
ns
ns
ns
ns
ns
ns
ns
ns
ns
ns
ns
130
130
0.5tCLCL+5(2)
0.5tCLCL+5(2)
tDVRH
Data Setup to RD High
Read Low to Data Valid
Data Hold After RD High
RD Pulse Width
10 tRLDV
11 tRHDX
12 tRLRH
13 tDVWL
14 tWHDX
15 tDVWH
16 tWLWH
190
1.0tCLCL-60
0
0
235
105
235
250
235
1.0tCLCL-15
0.5tCLCL-20(1)
1.0tCLCL-15
1.0tCLCL
Data Setup to WR Low
Data Hold After WR High
Data Valid to WR High
WR Pulse Width
1.0tCLCL-15
Notes: 1. This assumes 50% clock duty cycle. The half period is actually the high time of the external clock, XTAL1.
2. This assumes 50% clock duty cycle. The half period is actually the low time of the external clock, XTAL1.
Table 31-14. External Data Memory Characteristics, 2.7 - 5.5 Volts, SRWn1 = 0, SRWn0 = 1
4 MHz Oscillator
Variable Oscillator
Min Max
Symbol
Parameter
Min
Max
Unit
MHz
ns
0
1/tCLCL
Oscillator Frequency
Read Low to Data Valid
RD Pulse Width
0.0
8
10 tRLDV
12 tRLRH
15 tDVWH
16 tWLWH
440
2.0tCLCL-60
485
500
485
2.0tCLCL-15
2.0tCLCL
ns
Data Valid to WR High
WR Pulse Width
ns
2.0tCLCL-15
ns
Table 31-15. External Data Memory Characteristics, 2.7 - 5.5 Volts, SRWn1 = 1, SRWn0 = 0
4 MHz Oscillator Variable Oscillator
Symbol
Parameter
Min
Max
Min
Max
8
Unit
MHz
ns
0
1/tCLCL
Oscillator Frequency
Read Low to Data Valid
RD Pulse Width
0.0
10 tRLDV
12 tRLRH
15 tDVWH
16 tWLWH
690
3.0tCLCL-60
735
750
735
3.0tCLCL-15
3.0tCLCL
ns
Data Valid to WR High
WR Pulse Width
ns
3.0tCLCL-15
ns
383
2549L–AVR–08/07
Table 31-16. External Data Memory Characteristics, 2.7 - 5.5 Volts, SRWn1 = 1, SRWn0 = 1
4 MHz Oscillator Variable Oscillator
Symbol
Parameter
Min
Max
Min
Max
8
Unit
MHz
ns
0
1/tCLCL
Oscillator Frequency
Read Low to Data Valid
RD Pulse Width
0.0
10 tRLDV
12 tRLRH
14 tWHDX
15 tDVWH
16 tWLWH
690
3.0tCLCL-60
735
485
750
735
3.0tCLCL-15
2.0tCLCL-15
3.0tCLCL
ns
Data Hold After WR High
Data Valid to WR High
WR Pulse Width
ns
ns
3.0tCLCL-15
ns
Figure 31-9. External Memory Timing (SRWn1 = 0, SRWn0 = 0
T1
T2
T3
T4
System Clock (CLKCPU
)
1
ALE
4
2
7
A15:8 Prev. addr.
Address
15
3a
3b
13
DA7:0 Prev. data
Address
6
XX
Data
16
14
WR
9
11
DA7:0 (XMBK = 0)
Address
5
Data
10
8
12
RD
384
ATmega640/1280/1281/2560/2561
2549L–AVR–08/07
ATmega640/1280/1281/2560/2561
Figure 31-10. External Memory Timing (SRWn1 = 0, SRWn0 = 1)
T1
T2
T3
T4
T5
System Clock (CLKCPU
)
1
ALE
4
2
7
A15:8 Prev. addr.
Address
15
3a
3b
13
Data
16
DA7:0 Prev. data
Address
6
XX
14
WR
9
11
DA7:0 (XMBK = 0)
Address
5
Data
10
8
12
RD
Figure 31-11. External Memory Timing (SRWn1 = 1, SRWn0 = 0)
T1
T2
T3
T4
T5
T6
System Clock (CLKCPU
)
1
ALE
4
2
7
Address
15
A15:8 Prev. addr.
3a
3b
13
DA7:0 Prev. data
Address
6
XX
Data
16
14
WR
9
11
DA7:0 (XMBK = 0)
Address
5
Data
10
8
12
RD
385
2549L–AVR–08/07
Figure 31-12. External Memory Timing (SRWn1 = 1, SRWn0 = 1)()
T6
T1
T2
T3
T4
T5
T7
System Clock (CLKCPU
)
1
ALE
4
2
7
Address
15
A15:8 Prev. addr.
3a
3b
13
DA7:0 Prev. data
Address
6
XX
Data
16
14
WR
9
11
DA7:0 (XMBK = 0)
Address
5
Data
10
8
12
RD
The ALE pulse in the last period (T4-T7) is only present if the next instruction accesses the RAM
(internal or external).
386
ATmega640/1280/1281/2560/2561
2549L–AVR–08/07
ATmega640/1280/1281/2560/2561
32. Typical Characteristics
The following charts show typical behavior. These figures are not tested during manufacturing.
All current consumption measurements are performed with all I/O pins configured as inputs and
with internal pull-ups enabled. A sine wave generator with rail-to-rail output is used as clock
source.
All Active- and Idle current consumption measurements are done with all bits in the PRR regis-
ters set and thus, the corresponding I/O modules are turned off. Also the Analog Comparator is
disabled during these measurements. Table 32-1 on page 393 and Table 32-2 on page 393
show the additional current consumption compared to ICC Active and ICC Idle for every I/O mod-
ule controlled by the Power Reduction Register. See “When the SM2:0 bits are 111 and an
external crystal/resonator clock option is selected, the SLEEP instruction makes the MCU enter
Extended Standby mode. This mode is identical to Power-save mode with the exception that the
Oscillator is kept running. From Extended Standby mode, the device wakes up in six clock
cycles.Power Reduction Register” on page 54 for details.
The power consumption in Power-down mode is independent of clock selection.
The current consumption is a function of several factors such as: operating voltage, operating
frequency, loading of I/O pins, switching rate of I/O pins, code executed and ambient tempera-
ture. The dominating factors are operating voltage and frequency.
The current drawn from capacitive loaded pins may be estimated (for one pin) as CL*VCC*f where
CL = load capacitance, VCC = operating voltage and f = average switching frequency of I/O pin.
The parts are characterized at frequencies higher than test limits. Parts are not guaranteed to
function properly at frequencies higher than the ordering code indicates.
The difference between current consumption in Power-down mode with Watchdog Timer
enabled and Power-down mode with Watchdog Timer disabled represents the differential cur-
rent drawn by the Watchdog Timer.
387
2549L–AVR–08/07
32.1 Active Supply Current
Figure 32-1. Active Supply Current vs. frequency (0.1 - 1.0 MHz)
ACTIVE SUPPLY CURRENT vs. FREQUENCY
0.1 - 1.0 MHz
2,5
2
5.5V
5.0V
1,5
1
4.5V
4.0V
3.3V
2.7V
1.8V
0,5
0
0
0,1
0,2
0,3
0,4
0,5
0,6
0,7
0,8
0,9
1
Frequency (MHz)
Figure 32-2. Active Supply Current vs. Frequency (1 - 16 MHz)
ACTIVE SUPPLY CURRENT vs. FREQUENCY
1 - 16 MHz
25
5.5V
5.0V
4.5V
20
15
4.0V
10
3.3V
2.7V
5
1.8V
0
0
2
4
6
8
10
12
14
16
Frequency (MHz)
388
ATmega640/1280/1281/2560/2561
2549L–AVR–08/07
ATmega640/1280/1281/2560/2561
Figure 32-3. Active Supply Current vs. VCC (Internal RC Oscillator, 8 MHz)
ACTIVE SUPPLY CURRENT vs. VCC
INTERNAL RC OSCILLATOR, 8 MHz
14
12
10
8
85˚C
25˚C
-40˚C
6
4
2
0
1,5
2
2,5
3
3,5
4
4,5
5
5,5
VCC (V)
Figure 32-4. Active Supply Current vs. VCC (Internal RC Oscillator, 1 MHz)
ACTIVE SUPPLY CURRENT vs. VCC
INTERNAL RC OSCILLATOR, 1 MHz
2,5
-40˚C
85˚C
25˚C
2
1,5
1
0,5
0
1,5
2
2,5
3
3,5
4
4,5
5
5,5
VCC (V)
389
2549L–AVR–08/07
Figure 32-5. Active Supply Current vs. VCC (Internal RC Oscillator, 128 kHz)
ACTIVE SUPPLY CURRENT vs. VCC
INTERNAL RC OSCILLATOR, 128 kHz
0,7
0,6
0,5
0,4
0,3
0,2
0,1
0
-40˚C
85˚C
1,5
2
2,5
3
3,5
4
4,5
5
5,5
VCC (V)
32.2 Idle Supply Current
Figure 32-6. Idle Supply Current vs. Low Frequency (0.1 - 1.0 MHz)
IDLE SUPPLY CURRENT vs. LOW FREQUENCY
0.1 - 1.0 MHz
0,6
0,5
0,4
0,3
0,2
0,1
0
5.5V
5.0V
4.5V
4.0V
3.3V
2.7V
1.8V
0
0,1
0,2
0,3
0,4
0,5
0,6
0,7
0,8
0,9
1
Frequency (MHz)
390
ATmega640/1280/1281/2560/2561
2549L–AVR–08/07
ATmega640/1280/1281/2560/2561
Figure 32-7. Idle Supply Current vs. Frequency (1 - 16 MHz)
IDLE SUPPLY CURRENT vs. FREQUENCY
1 - 16 MHz
8
7
6
5
4
3
2
1
0
5.5V
5.0V
4.5V
4.0V
3.3V
2.7V
1.8V
0
2
4
6
8
10
12
14
16
Frequency (MHz)
Figure 32-8. Idle Supply Current vs. VCC (Internal RC Oscillator, 8 MHz)
IDLE SUPPLY CURRENT vs. VCC
INTERNAL RC OSCILLATOR, 8 MHz
3,5
85˚C
25˚C
3
2,5
2
-40˚C
1,5
1
0,5
0
1,5
2
2,5
3
3,5
4
4,5
5
5,5
VCC (V)
391
2549L–AVR–08/07
Figure 32-9. Idle Supply Current vs. VCC (Internal RC Oscillator, 1 MHz)
IDLE SUPPLY CURRENT vs. VCC
INTERNAL RC OSCILLATOR, 1 MHz
0,9
-40˚C
0,8
0,7
0,6
0,5
0,4
0,3
0,2
0,1
0
85˚C
25˚C
1,5
2
2,5
3
3,5
4
4,5
5
5,5
VCC (V)
Figure 32-10. Idle Supply Current vs. VCC (Internal RC Oscillator, 128 KHz)I
IDLE SUPPLY CURRENT vs. VCC
INTERNAL RC OSCILLATOR, 128 kHz
0,3
-40˚C
0,25
0,2
0,15
0,1
25˚C
85˚C
0,05
0
1,5
2
2,5
3
3,5
4
4,5
5
5,5
VCC (V)
32.2.1
Supply Current of IO modules
The tables and formulas below can be used to calculate the additional current consumption for
the different I/O modules in Active and Idle mode. The enabling or disabling of the I/O modules
are controlled by the Power Reduction Register. See “When the SM2:0 bits are 111 and an
external crystal/resonator clock option is selected, the SLEEP instruction makes the MCU enter
Extended Standby mode. This mode is identical to Power-save mode with the exception that the
392
ATmega640/1280/1281/2560/2561
2549L–AVR–08/07
ATmega640/1280/1281/2560/2561
Oscillator is kept running. From Extended Standby mode, the device wakes up in six clock
cycles.Power Reduction Register” on page 54 for details.
Table 32-1.
Additional Current Consumption for the different I/O modules (absolute values)
PRR bit
Typical numbers
VCC = 2V, F = 1MHz
VCC = 3V, F = 4MHz
VCC = 5V, F = 8MHz
220 uA
PRUSART3
PRUSART2
PRUSART1
PRUSART0
PRTWI
8.0 uA
8.0 uA
8.0 uA
8.0 uA
12 uA
6.0 uA
6.0 uA
6.0 uA
11 uA
6.0 uA
4.0 uA
15 uA
12 uA
51 uA
51 uA
51 uA
51 uA
75 uA
39 uA
39 uA
39 uA
72 uA
39 uA
24 uA
95 uA
75 uA
220 uA
220 uA
220 uA
315 uA
150 uA
150 uA
150 uA
300 uA
150 uA
100 uA
400 uA
315 uA
PRTIM5
PRTIM4
PRTIM3
PRTIM2
PRTIM1
PRTIM0
PRSPI
PRADC
Table 32-2.
Additional Current Consumption (percentage) in Active and Idle mode
Additional Current consumption
compared to Active with external
clock
Additional Current consumption
compared to Idle with external clock
PRR bit
PRUSART3
PRUSART2
PRUSART1
PRUSART0
PRTWI
3.0%
3.0%
3.0%
3.0%
4.4%
1.8%
1.8%
1.8%
4.3%
1.8%
1.5%
3.3%
4.5%
17%
17%
17%
17%
24%
10%
10%
10%
23%
10%
8.0%
18%
24%
PRTIM5
PRTIM4
PRTIM3
PRTIM2
PRTIM1
PRTIM0
PRSPI
PRADC
It is possible to calculate the typical current consumption based on the numbers from Table 32-1
for other VCC and frequency settings than listed in Table 32-2.
393
2549L–AVR–08/07
32.2.1.1
Example 1
Calculate the expected current consumption in idle mode with USART0, TIMER1, and TWI
enabled at VCC = 2.0V and F = 1MHz. From Table 32-2 on page 393, third column, we see that
we need to add 17% for the USART0, 24% for the TWI, and 10% for the TIMER1 module. Read-
ing from Figure 32-6 on page 390, we find that the idle current consumption is ~0,15mA at VCC
=
2.0V and F = 1MHz. The total current consumption in idle mode with USART0, TIMER1, and
TWI enabled, gives:
ICCtotal ≈ 0,15mA • (1 + 0,17 + 0,24 + 0,10) ≈ 0,227mA
32.3 Power-down Supply Current
Figure 32-11. Power-down Supply Current vs. VCC (Watchdog Timer Disabled)
POWER-DOWN SUPPLY CURRENT vs. VCC
WATCHDOG TIMER DISABLED
4
3,5
3
85˚C
2,5
2
1,5
1
-40˚C
25˚C
0,5
0
1,5
2
2,5
3
3,5
4
4,5
5
5,5
VCC (V)
394
ATmega640/1280/1281/2560/2561
2549L–AVR–08/07
ATmega640/1280/1281/2560/2561
Figure 32-12. Power-down Supply Current vs. VCC (Watchdog Timer Enabled)
POWER-DOWN SUPPLY CURRENT vs. VCC
WATCHDOG TIMER ENABLED
12
10
8
85˚C
-40˚C
25˚C
6
4
2
0
1,5
2
2,5
3
3,5
4
4,5
5
5,5
VCC (V)
32.4 Power-save Supply Current
Figure 32-13. Power-save Supply Current vs. VCC (Watchdog Timer Disabled)
POWER-SAVE SUPPLY CURRENT vs. VCC
WATCHDOG TIMER DISABLED
4
3,5
3
25 ˚C
2,5
2
1,5
1
0,5
0
1,5
2
2,5
3
3,5
4
4,5
5
5,5
VCC(V)
395
2549L–AVR–08/07
Figure 32-14. Power-save Supply Current vs. VCC (Watchdog Timer Enabled)
POWER-SAVE SUPPLY CURRENT vs. VCC
WATCHDOG TIMER ENABLED
9
8
7
6
5
4
3
2
1
0
25 ˚C
1,5
2
2,5
3
3,5
4
4,5
5
5,5
VCC (V)
32.5 Standby Supply Current
Figure 32-15. Standby Supply Current vs. VCC (Watchdog Timer Disabled)
STANDBY SUPPLY CURRENT vs. VCC
WATCHDOG TIMER DISABLED
0,2
6 MHz xtal
6 MHz res
0,18
0,16
0,14
0,12
0,1
4 MHz res
4 MHz xtal
2 MHz res
2 MHz xtal
0,08
0,06
0,04
0,02
0
1 MHz res
455 kHz res
32 kHz xtal
1,5
2
2,5
3
3,5
4
4,5
5
5,5
VCC (V)
396
ATmega640/1280/1281/2560/2561
2549L–AVR–08/07
ATmega640/1280/1281/2560/2561
32.6 Pin Pull-up
Figure 32-16. I/O Pin Pull-up Resistor Current vs. Input Voltage (VCC = 1.8 V)
I/O PIN PULL-UP RESISTOR CURRENT vs. INPUT VOLTAGE
VCC = 1.8V
60
50
40
30
20
10
0
25˚C
85˚C
-40˚C
0
0,2
0,4
0,6
0,8
1
1,2
1,4
1,6
1,8
2
VOP (V)
Figure 32-17. I/O Pin Pull-up Resistor Current vs. Input Voltage (VCC = 2.7 V)
I/O PIN PULL-UP RESISTOR CURRENT vs. INPUT VOLTAGE
VCC= 2.7V
90
80
70
60
50
40
30
20
10
0
85˚C
25˚C
-40˚C
0
0,5
1
1,5
2
2,5
3
VOP (V)
397
2549L–AVR–08/07
Figure 32-18. I/O Pin Pull-up Resistor Current vs. Input Voltage (VCC = 5V)
I/O PIN PULL-UP RESISTOR CURRENT vs. INPUT VOLTAGE
= 5V
VCC
160
140
120
100
80
60
40
25˚C
20
85˚C
-40˚C
0
0
1
2
3
OP (V)
4
5
6
V
Figure 32-19. Reset Pull-up Resistor Current vs. Reset Pin Voltage (VCC = 1.8 V)
RESET PULL-UP RESISTOR CURRENT vs. RESET PIN VOLTAGE
= 1.8V
VCC
40
35
30
25
20
15
10
5
25˚C
-40˚C
85˚C
0
0
0,2
0,4
0,6
0,8
1
1,2
1,4
1,6
1,8
2
VRESET(V)
398
ATmega640/1280/1281/2560/2561
2549L–AVR–08/07
ATmega640/1280/1281/2560/2561
Figure 32-20. Reset pull-up Resistor Current vs. Reset Pin Voltage (VCC = 2.7 V)
RESET PULL-UP RESISTOR CURRENT vs. RESET PIN VOLTAGE
Vcc= 2.7V
70
60
50
40
30
20
10
25˚C
-40˚C
85˚C
0
0
0,5
1
1,5
2
2,5
3
VRESET(V)
Figure 32-21. Reset Pull-up Resistor Current vs. Reset Pin Voltage (VCC = 5 V)
RESET PULL-UP RESISTOR CURRENT vs. RESET PIN VOLTAGE
VCC = 5V
120
100
80
60
40
20
25˚C
-40˚C
85˚C
0
0
1
2
3
4
5
6
VRESET(V)
399
2549L–AVR–08/07
32.7 Pin Driver Strength
Figure 32-22. I/O Pin output Voltage vs.Sink Current (VCC = 3 V)
I/O PIN OUTPUT VOLTAGE vs. SINK CURRENT
VCC = 3V
1
0,9
0,8
0,7
0,6
0,5
0,4
0,3
0,2
0,1
0
85˚C
25˚C
-40˚C
0
5
10
15
20
25
IOL (mA)
Figure 32-23. I/O Pin Output Voltage vs. Sink Current (VCC = 5 V)
I/O PIN OUTPUT VOLTAGE vs. SINK CURRENT
VCC = 5V
0,6
0,5
0,4
0,3
0,2
0,1
0
85˚C
25˚C
-40˚C
0
5
10
15
20
25
IOL (mA)
400
ATmega640/1280/1281/2560/2561
2549L–AVR–08/07
ATmega640/1280/1281/2560/2561
Figure 32-24. I/O Pin Output Voltage vs. Source Current (VCC = 3 V)
I/O PIN OUTPUT VOLTAGE vs. SOURCE CURRENT
VCC = 3V
3,5
3
2,5
2
-40˚C
25˚C
85˚C
1,5
1
0,5
0
0
5
10
15
20
25
IOH (mA)
Figure 32-25. I/O Pin Output Voltage vs. Source Current (VCC = 5 V)
I/O PIN OUTPUT VOLTAGE vs. SOURCE CURRENT
VCC = 5V
5,1
5
4,9
4,8
4,7
4,6
4,5
4,4
4,3
-40˚C
25˚C
85˚C
0
5
10
15
20
25
IOH (mA)
401
2549L–AVR–08/07
32.8 Pin Threshold and Hysteresis
Figure 32-26. I/O Pin Input Threshold Voltage vs. VCC (VIH, IO Pin Read as “1“)
I/O PIN INPUT THRESHOLD VOLTAGE vs. VCC
VIH, IO PIN READ AS '1'
3,5
3
-40˚C
25˚C
85˚C
2,5
2
1,5
1
0,5
0
1,5
2
2,5
3
3,5
4
4,5
5
5,5
VCC (V)
Figure 32-27. I/O Pin Input Threshold Voltage vs. VCC (VIL, IO Pin Read as “0“)
I/O PIN INPUT THRESHOLD VOLTAGE vs. VCC
VIL, IO PIN READ AS '0'
2,5
85˚C
25˚C
-40˚C
2
1,5
1
0,5
0
1,5
2
2,5
3
3,5
CC (V)
4
4,5
5
5,5
V
402
ATmega640/1280/1281/2560/2561
2549L–AVR–08/07
ATmega640/1280/1281/2560/2561
Figure 32-28. I/O Pin Input Hysteresis
I/O PIN INPUT HYSTERESIS vs. VCC
0,8
0,7
0,6
0,5
0,4
0,3
0,2
0,1
0
-40˚C
25˚C
85˚C
1,5
2
2,5
3
3,5
4
4,5
5
5,5
VCC (V)
Figure 32-29. Reset Input Threshold Voltage vs. VCC (VIH, IO Pin Read as “1“)
RESET INPUT THRESHOLD VOLTAGE vs. VCC
VIH, IO PIN READ AS '1'
2,5
-40˚C
25˚C
85˚C
2
1,5
1
0,5
0
1,5
2
2,5
3
3,5
CC (V)
4
4,5
5
5,5
V
403
2549L–AVR–08/07
Figure 32-30. Reset Input Threshold Voltage vs. VCC (VIL, IO Pin Read as “0“)
RESET INPUT THRESHOLD VOLTAGE vs. VCC
VIL, IO PIN READ AS '0'
2,5
85 ˚C
25 ˚C
-40 ˚C
2
1,5
1
0,5
0
1,5
2
2,5
3
3,5
4
4,5
5
5,5
VCC (V)
Figure 32-31. Reset Pin Input Hysteresis vs. VCC
RESET PIN INPUT HYSTERESIS vs. VCC
0,7
0,6
0,5
0,4
0,3
0,2
0,1
0
-40˚C
25˚C
85˚C
1,5
2
2,5
3
3,5
4
4,5
5
5,5
VCC (V)
404
ATmega640/1280/1281/2560/2561
2549L–AVR–08/07
ATmega640/1280/1281/2560/2561
32.9 BOD Threshold and Analog Comparator Offset
Figure 32-32. BOD Threshold vs. Temperature (BOD Level is 4.3 V)
BOD THRESHOLDS vs. TEMPERATURE
BODLEVELS IS 4.3V
4.4
4.35
4.3
Rising Vcc
Falling Vcc
4.25
4.2
-60
-40
-20
0
20
40
60
80
100
Temperature (C)
Figure 32-33. BOD Threshold vs. Temperature (BOD Level is 2.7 V)
BOD THRESHOLDS vs. TEMPERATURE
BODLEVEL IS 2.7V
2.8
Rising Vcc
2.75
2.7
Falling Vcc
2.65
2.6
-60
-40
-20
0
20
40
60
80
100
Temperature (C)
405
2549L–AVR–08/07
Figure 32-34. BOD Threshold vs. Temperature (BOD Level is 1.8 V)
BOD THRESHOLDS vs. TEMPERATURE
BODLEVEL IS 1.8V
1.9
1.85
Rising Vcc
1.8
Fallling Vcc
1.75
1.7
-60
-40
-20
0
20
40
60
80
100
Temperature (C)
32.10 Internal Oscillator Speed
Figure 32-35. Watchdog Oscillator Frequency vs. VCC
WATCHDOG OSCILLATOR FREQUENCY vs. V
CC
128
126
124
122
120
118
116
114
-40˚C
25 ˚C
85˚C
2
2,5
3
3,5
4
4,5
5
5,5
VCC (V)
406
ATmega640/1280/1281/2560/2561
2549L–AVR–08/07
ATmega640/1280/1281/2560/2561
Figure 32-36. Watchdog Oscillator Frequency vs. Temperature
WATCHDOG OSCILLATOR FREQUENCY vs. TEMPERATURE
128
126
124
122
120
118
116
114
2.1V
2.7V
3.3V
4.0V
5.5V
-60
-40
-20
0
20
40
60
80
100
Temperature
Figure 32-37. Calibrated 8 MHz RC Oscillator Frequency vs. VCC
CALIBRATED 8 MHz RC OSCILLATOR FREQUENCY vs. VCC
8,3
8,2
8,1
8
85˚C
25˚C
7,9
7,8
7,7
7,6
-40˚C
1,5
2
2,5
3
3,5
4
4,5
5
5,5
VCC (V)
407
2549L–AVR–08/07
Figure 32-38. Calibrated 8 MHz RC Oscillator Frequency vs. Temperature
CALIBRATED 8 MHz RC OSCILLATOR FREQUENCY vs. TEMPERATURE
8,5
5.0V
8,4
3.0V
8,3
8,2
8,1
8
7,9
-60
-40
-20
0
20
40
60
80
100
Temperature
Figure 32-39. Calibrated 8 MHz RC Oscillator Frequency vs. Osccal Value
CALIBRATED 8 MHz RC OSCILLATOR FREQUENCY vs. OSCCAL VALUE
16
14
12
10
8
85˚C
25˚C
-40˚C
6
4
2
0
0
16
32
48
64
80
96 112 128 144 160 176 192 208 224 240 256
OSCCAL (X1)
408
ATmega640/1280/1281/2560/2561
2549L–AVR–08/07
ATmega640/1280/1281/2560/2561
32.11 Current Consumption of Peripheral Units
Figure 32-40. Brownout Detector Current vs. VCC
BROWNOUT DETECTOR CURRENT vs. VCC
30
25
20
15
10
5
85˚C
25˚C
-40˚C
0
1,5
2
2,5
3
3,5
4
4,5
5
5,5
VCC (V)
Figure 32-41. ADC Current vs. VCC (AREF = AVCC
)
ADC CURRENT vs. VCC
AREF = AVCC
350
300
250
200
150
100
50
-40˚C
25˚C
85˚C
0
1,5
2
2,5
3
3,5
4
4,5
5
5,5
VCC (V)
409
2549L–AVR–08/07
Figure 32-42. AREF External Reference Current vs. VCC
AREF EXTERNAL REFERENCE CURRENT vs. VCC
250
200
150
100
50
-40˚C
25˚C
85˚C
0
1,5
2
2,5
3
3,5
4
4,5
5
5,5
VCC (V)
Figure 32-43. Watchdog Timer Current vs. VCC
WATCHDOG TIMER CURRENT vs. VCC
9
8
7
6
5
4
3
2
1
0
-40˚C
25˚C
85˚C
1,5
2
2,5
3
3,5
CC (V)
4
4,5
5
5,5
V
410
ATmega640/1280/1281/2560/2561
2549L–AVR–08/07
ATmega640/1280/1281/2560/2561
Figure 32-44. Analog Comparator Current vs. VCC
ANALOG COMPARATOR CURRENT vs. VCC
100
90
80
70
60
50
40
30
20
10
0
-40˚C
25˚C
85˚C
1,5
2
2,5
3
3,5
4
4,5
5
5,5
VCC (V)
Figure 32-45. Programming Current vs. VCC
PROGRAMMING CURRENT vs. Vcc
16
14
12
10
8
-40 ˚C
25 ˚C
85 ˚C
6
4
2
0
1,5
2
2,5
3
3,5
4
4,5
5
5,5
VCC (V)
411
2549L–AVR–08/07
32.12 Current Consumption in Reset and Reset Pulsewidth
Figure 32-46. Reset Supply Current vs VCC (0.1 - 1.0 MHz, Excluding Current Through The
Reset Pull-up)
RESET SUPPLY CURRENT vs. VCC
0.1 - 1.0 MHz, EXCLUDING CURRENT THROUGH THE RESET PULLUP
0,35
0,3
5.5V
5.0V
0,25
0,2
4.5V
4.0V
0,15
0,1
3.3V
2.7V
1.8V
0,05
0
0
0,1
0,2
0,3
0,4
0,5
0,6
0,7
0,8
0,9
1
Frequency (MHz)
Figure 32-47. Reset Supply Current vs. VCC (1 - 16 MHz, Excluding Current Through The Reset
Pull-up)
RESET SUPPLY CURRENT vs. VCC
1 - 16 MHz, EXCLUDING CURRENT THROUGH THE RESET PULLUP
4
5.5V
3,5
5.0V
3
4.5V
2,5
2
4.0V
1,5
1
3.3V
2.7V
0,5
1.8V
0
0
2
4
6
8
10
12
14
16
Frequency (MHz)
412
ATmega640/1280/1281/2560/2561
2549L–AVR–08/07
ATmega640/1280/1281/2560/2561
Figure 32-48. Minimum Reset Pulse Width vs. VCC
MINIMUM RESET PULSE WIDTH vs. VCC
2500
2000
1500
1000
500
85˚C
25˚C
-40˚C
0
1,5
2
2,5
3
3,5
4
4,5
5
5,5
VCC (V)
413
2549L–AVR–08/07
33. Register Summary
Address
Name
Bit 7
Bit 6
Bit 5
Bit 4
Bit 3
Bit 2
Bit 1
Bit 0
Page
(0x1FF)
...
Reserved
Reserved
Reserved
Reserved
Reserved
Reserved
Reserved
Reserved
Reserved
Reserved
Reserved
UDR3
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
(0x13F)
(0x13E)
(0x13D)
(0x13C)
(0x13B)
(0x13A)
(0x139)
(0x138)
(0x137)
(0x136)
(0x135)
(0x134)
(0x133)
(0x132)
(0x131)
(0x130)
(0x12F)
(0x12E)
(0x12D)
(0x12C)
(0x12B)
(0x12A)
(0x129)
(0x128)
(0x127)
(0x126)
(0x125)
(0x124)
(0x123)
(0x122)
(0x121)
(0x120)
(0x11F)
(0x11E)
(0x11D)
(0x11C)
(0x11B)
(0x11A)
(0x119)
(0x118)
(0x117)
(0x116)
(0x115)
(0x114)
(0x113)
(0x112)
(0x111)
(0x110)
(0x10F)
(0x10E)
(0x10D)
(0x10C)
(0x10B)
(0x10A)
(0x109)
(0x108)
(0x107)
(0x106)
(0x105)
(0x104)
(0x103)
(0x102)
(0x101)
USART3 I/O Data Register
- USART3 Baud Rate Register High Byte
page 223
page 227
page 227
UBRR3H
UBRR3L
Reserved
UCSR3C
UCSR3B
UCSR3A
Reserved
Reserved
OCR5CH
OCR5CL
OCR5BH
OCR5BL
OCR5AH
OCR5AL
ICR5H
-
-
-
USART3 Baud Rate Register Low Byte
-
-
-
UPM31
UDRIE3
UDRE3
-
-
-
USBS3
TXEN3
DOR3
-
-
-
UCSZ30
RXB83
U2X3
-
-
UMSEL31
UMSEL30
UPM30
UCSZ31
UCPOL3
page 239
page 238
page 238
RXCIE3
TXCIE3
RXEN3
UCSZ32
TXB83
RXC3
TXC3
FE3
UPE3
MPCM3
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
Timer/Counter5 - Output Compare Register C High Byte
Timer/Counter5 - Output Compare Register C Low Byte
Timer/Counter5 - Output Compare Register B High Byte
Timer/Counter5 - Output Compare Register B Low Byte
Timer/Counter5 - Output Compare Register A High Byte
Timer/Counter5 - Output Compare Register A Low Byte
Timer/Counter5 - Input Capture Register High Byte
Timer/Counter5 - Input Capture Register Low Byte
Timer/Counter5 - Counter Register High Byte
page 166
page 166
page 166
page 166
page 166
page 166
page 167
page 167
page 163
page 163
ICR5L
TCNT5H
TCNT5L
Reserved
TCCR5C
TCCR5B
TCCR5A
Reserved
Reserved
Reserved
Reserved
Reserved
Reserved
Reserved
Reserved
Reserved
Reserved
Reserved
Reserved
Reserved
Reserved
Reserved
Reserved
Reserved
Reserved
Reserved
Reserved
PORTL
Timer/Counter5 - Counter Register Low Byte
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
FOC5A
FOC5B
FOC5C
-
-
-
-
-
page 162
page 161
page 158
ICNC5
ICES5
-
WGM53
WGM52
CS52
CS51
CS50
COM5A1
COM5A0
COM5B1
COM5B0
COM5C1
COM5C0
WGM51
WGM50
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
PORTL7
DDL7
PINL7
PORTK7
DDK7
PINK7
PORTJ7
DDJ7
PINJ7
PORTH7
DDH7
PORTL6
DDL6
PINL6
PORTK6
DDK6
PINK6
PORTJ6
DDJ6
PINJ6
PORTH6
DDH6
PORTL5
DDL5
PINL5
PORTK5
DDK5
PINK5
PORTJ5
DDJ5
PINJ5
PORTH5
DDH5
PORTL4
DDL4
PINL4
PORTK4
DDK4
PINK4
PORTJ4
DDJ4
PINJ4
PORTH4
DDH4
PORTL3
DDL3
PINL3
PORTK3
DDK3
PINK3
PORTJ3
DDJ3
PINJ3
PORTH3
DDH3
PORTL2
DDL2
PINL2
PORTK2
DDK2
PINK2
PORTJ2
DDJ2
PINJ2
PORTH2
DDH2
PORTL1
DDL1
PINL1
PORTK1
DDK1
PINK1
PORTJ1
DDJ1
PINJ1
PORTH1
DDH1
PORTL0
DDL0
PINL0
PORTK0
DDK0
PINK0
PORTJ0
DDJ0
PINJ0
PORTH0
DDH0
page 104
page 104
page 104
page 103
page 103
page 104
page 103
page 103
page 103
page 103
page 103
DDRL
PINL
PORTK
DDRK
PINK
PORTJ
DDRJ
PINJ
PORTH
DDRH
414
ATmega640/1280/1281/2560/2561
2549L–AVR–08/07
ATmega640/1280/1281/2560/2561
Address
Name
Bit 7
Bit 6
Bit 5
Bit 4
Bit 3
Bit 2
Bit 1
Bit 0
Page
(0x100)
(0xFF)
(0xFE)
(0xFD)
(0xFC)
(0xFB)
(0xFA)
(0xF9)
(0xF8)
(0xF7)
(0xF6)
(0xF5)
(0xF4)
(0xF3)
(0xF2)
(0xF1)
(0xF0)
(0xEF)
(0xEE)
(0xED)
(0xEC)
(0xEB)
(0xEA)
(0xE9)
(0xE8)
(0xE7)
(0xE6)
(0xE5)
(0xE4)
(0xE3)
(0xE2)
(0xE1)
(0xE0)
(0xDF)
(0xDE)
(0xDD)
(0xDC)
(0xDB)
(0xDA)
(0xD9)
(0xD8)
(0xD7)
(0xD6)
(0xD5)
(0xD4)
(0xD3)
(0xD2)
(0xD1)
(0xD0)
(0xCF)
(0xCE)
(0xCD)
(0xCC)
(0xCB)
(0xCA)
(0xC9)
(0xC8)
(0xC7)
(0xC6)
(0xC5)
(0xC4)
(0xC3)
(0xC2)
(0xC1)
(0xC0)
(0xBF)
PINH
PINH7
PINH6
PINH5
PINH4
PINH3
PINH2
PINH1
PINH0
page 103
Reserved
Reserved
Reserved
Reserved
Reserved
Reserved
Reserved
Reserved
Reserved
Reserved
Reserved
Reserved
Reserved
Reserved
Reserved
Reserved
Reserved
Reserved
Reserved
Reserved
Reserved
Reserved
Reserved
Reserved
Reserved
Reserved
Reserved
Reserved
Reserved
Reserved
Reserved
Reserved
Reserved
Reserved
Reserved
Reserved
Reserved
Reserved
Reserved
Reserved
Reserved
UDR2
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
USART2 I/O Data Register
- USART2 Baud Rate Register High Byte
page 223
page 227
page 227
UBRR2H
UBRR2L
Reserved
UCSR2C
UCSR2B
UCSR2A
Reserved
UDR1
-
-
-
USART2 Baud Rate Register Low Byte
-
-
UMSEL20
TXCIE2
TXC2
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
UMSEL21
RXCIE2
RXC2
-
UPM21
UDRIE2
UDRE2
-
UPM20
RXEN2
FE2
USBS2
TXEN2
DOR2
-
UCSZ21
UCSZ22
UPE2
-
UCSZ20
RXB82
U2X2
-
UCPOL2
TXB82
MPCM2
-
page 239
page 238
page 238
-
USART1 I/O Data Register
- USART1 Baud Rate Register High Byte
page 223
page 227
page 227
UBRR1H
UBRR1L
Reserved
UCSR1C
UCSR1B
UCSR1A
Reserved
UDR0
-
-
-
USART1 Baud Rate Register Low Byte
-
-
UMSEL10
TXCIE1
TXC1
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
UMSEL11
RXCIE1
RXC1
-
UPM11
UDRIE1
UDRE1
-
UPM10
RXEN1
FE1
USBS1
TXEN1
DOR1
-
UCSZ11
UCSZ12
UPE1
-
UCSZ10
RXB81
U2X1
-
UCPOL1
TXB81
MPCM1
-
page 239
page 238
page 238
-
USART0 I/O Data Register
- USART0 Baud Rate Register High Byte
page 223
page 227
page 227
UBRR0H
UBRR0L
Reserved
UCSR0C
UCSR0B
UCSR0A
Reserved
-
-
-
USART0 Baud Rate Register Low Byte
-
-
UMSEL00
TXCIE0
TXC0
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
UMSEL01
RXCIE0
RXC0
-
UPM01
UDRIE0
UDRE0
-
UPM00
RXEN0
FE0
USBS0
TXEN0
DOR0
-
UCSZ01
UCSZ02
UPE0
-
UCSZ00
RXB80
U2X0
-
UCPOL0
TXB80
MPCM0
-
page 239
page 238
page 238
-
415
2549L–AVR–08/07
Address
Name
Bit 7
Bit 6
Bit 5
Bit 4
Bit 3
Bit 2
Bit 1
Bit 0
Page
(0xBE)
(0xBD)
(0xBC)
(0xBB)
(0xBA)
(0xB9)
(0xB8)
(0xB7)
(0xB6)
(0xB5)
(0xB4)
(0xB3)
(0xB2)
(0xB1)
(0xB0)
(0xAF)
(0xAE)
(0xAD)
(0xAC)
(0xAB)
(0xAA)
(0xA9)
(0xA8)
(0xA7)
(0xA6)
(0xA5)
(0xA4)
(0xA3)
(0xA2)
(0xA1)
(0xA0)
(0x9F)
(0x9E)
(0x9D)
(0x9C)
(0x9B)
(0x9A)
(0x99)
(0x98)
(0x97)
(0x96)
(0x95)
(0x94)
(0x93)
(0x92)
(0x91)
(0x90)
(0x8F)
(0x8E)
(0x8D)
(0x8C)
(0x8B)
(0x8A)
(0x89)
(0x88)
(0x87)
(0x86)
(0x85)
(0x84)
(0x83)
(0x82)
(0x81)
(0x80)
(0x7F)
(0x7E)
(0x7D)
Reserved
TWAMR
TWCR
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
TWAM6
TWINT
TWAM5
TWEA
TWAM4
TWSTA
TWAM3
TWSTO
TWAM2
TWWC
TWAM1
TWEN
TWAM0
page 269
page 266
page 268
page 269
page 268
page 266
-
TWIE
TWDR
2-wire Serial Interface Data Register
TWAR
TWA6
TWS7
TWA5
TWS6
TWA4
TWS5
TWA3
TWS4
TWA2
TWS3
TWA1
TWA0
TWGCE
TWPS0
TWSR
-
TWPS1
TWBR
2-wire Serial Interface Bit Rate Register
Reserved
ASSR
-
-
-
-
-
AS2
-
-
-
-
-
-
EXCLK
-
TCN2UB
OCR2AUB
-
OCR2BUB
-
TCR2AUB
-
TCR2BUB
-
page 185
Reserved
OCR2B
-
Timer/Counter2 Output Compare Register B
Timer/Counter2 Output Compare Register A
Timer/Counter2 (8 Bit)
page 192
page 192
page 192
page 191
page 192
OCR2A
TCNT2
TCCR2B
TCCR2A
Reserved
Reserved
OCR4CH
OCR4CL
OCR4BH
OCR4BL
OCR4AH
OCR4AL
ICR4H
FOC2A
FOC2B
-
-
WGM22
CS22
CS21
CS20
COM2A1
COM2A0
COM2B1
COM2B0
-
-
-
-
-
-
WGM21
WGM20
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
Timer/Counter4 - Output Compare Register C High Byte
Timer/Counter4 - Output Compare Register C Low Byte
Timer/Counter4 - Output Compare Register B High Byte
Timer/Counter4 - Output Compare Register B Low Byte
Timer/Counter4 - Output Compare Register A High Byte
Timer/Counter4 - Output Compare Register A Low Byte
Timer/Counter4 - Input Capture Register High Byte
Timer/Counter4 - Input Capture Register Low Byte
Timer/Counter4 - Counter Register High Byte
page 166
page 166
page 166
page 166
page 165
page 165
page 167
page 167
page 163
page 163
ICR4L
TCNT4H
TCNT4L
Reserved
TCCR4C
TCCR4B
TCCR4A
Reserved
Reserved
OCR3CH
OCR3CL
OCR3BH
OCR3BL
OCR3AH
OCR3AL
ICR3H
Timer/Counter4 - Counter Register Low Byte
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
FOC4A
FOC4B
FOC4C
-
-
-
-
-
page 162
page 161
page 158
ICNC4
ICES4
-
WGM43
WGM42
CS42
CS41
CS40
COM4A1
COM4A0
COM4B1
COM4B0
COM4C1
COM4C0
WGM41
WGM40
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
Timer/Counter3 - Output Compare Register C High Byte
Timer/Counter3 - Output Compare Register C Low Byte
Timer/Counter3 - Output Compare Register B High Byte
Timer/Counter3 - Output Compare Register B Low Byte
Timer/Counter3 - Output Compare Register A High Byte
Timer/Counter3 - Output Compare Register A Low Byte
Timer/Counter3 - Input Capture Register High Byte
Timer/Counter3 - Input Capture Register Low Byte
Timer/Counter3 - Counter Register High Byte
page 164
page 164
page 164
page 164
page 164
page 164
page 167
page 167
page 163
page 163
ICR3L
TCNT3H
TCNT3L
Reserved
TCCR3C
TCCR3B
TCCR3A
Reserved
Reserved
OCR1CH
OCR1CL
OCR1BH
OCR1BL
OCR1AH
OCR1AL
ICR1H
Timer/Counter3 - Counter Register Low Byte
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
FOC3A
FOC3B
FOC3C
-
-
-
-
-
page 162
page 161
page 158
ICNC3
ICES3
-
WGM33
WGM32
CS32
CS31
CS30
COM3A1
COM3A0
COM3B1
COM3B0
COM3C1
COM3C0
WGM31
WGM30
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
Timer/Counter1 - Output Compare Register C High Byte
Timer/Counter1 - Output Compare Register C Low Byte
Timer/Counter1 - Output Compare Register B High Byte
Timer/Counter1 - Output Compare Register B Low Byte
Timer/Counter1 - Output Compare Register A High Byte
Timer/Counter1 - Output Compare Register A Low Byte
Timer/Counter1 - Input Capture Register High Byte
Timer/Counter1 - Input Capture Register Low Byte
Timer/Counter1 - Counter Register High Byte
page 164
page 164
page 164
page 164
page 164
page 164
page 166
page 166
page 163
page 163
ICR1L
TCNT1H
TCNT1L
Reserved
TCCR1C
TCCR1B
TCCR1A
DIDR1
Timer/Counter1 - Counter Register Low Byte
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
FOC1A
ICNC1
COM1A1
-
FOC1B
ICES1
COM1A0
-
FOC1C
-
-
-
-
-
page 162
page 161
page 158
page 273
page 296
page 296
WGM13
COM1B0
-
WGM12
COM1C1
-
CS12
COM1C0
-
CS11
WGM11
AIN1D
ADC1D
ADC9D
CS10
WGM10
AIN0D
ADC0D
ADC8D
COM1B1
-
DIDR0
ADC7D
ADC15D
ADC6D
ADC14D
ADC5D
ADC13D
ADC4D
ADC12D
ADC3D
ADC11D
ADC2D
ADC10D
DIDR2
416
ATmega640/1280/1281/2560/2561
2549L–AVR–08/07
ATmega640/1280/1281/2560/2561
Address
Name
Bit 7
Bit 6
Bit 5
Bit 4
Bit 3
Bit 2
Bit 1
Bit 0
Page
(0x7C)
(0x7B)
ADMUX
ADCSRB
ADCSRA
ADCH
REFS1
-
REFS0
ACME
ADSC
ADLAR
-
MUX4
-
MUX3
MUX5
ADIE
MUX2
ADTS2
ADPS2
MUX1
ADTS1
ADPS1
MUX0
ADTS0
ADPS0
page 290
page 272,291,,295
page 293
(0x7A)
ADEN
ADATE
ADIF
(0x79)
ADC Data Register High byte
ADC Data Register Low byte
page 295
(0x78)
ADCL
page 295
(0x77)
Reserved
Reserved
XMCRB
XMCRA
TIMSK5
TIMSK4
TIMSK3
TIMSK2
TIMSK1
TIMSK0
PCMSK2
PCMSK1
PCMSK0
EICRB
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
(0x76)
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
(0x75)
XMBK
-
-
-
XMM2
SRW10
OCIE5B
OCIE4B
OCIE3B
OCIE2B
OCIE1B
OCIE0B
PCINT18
PCINT10
PCINT2
ISC50
ISC10
PCIE2
-
XMM1
SRW01
OCIE5A
OCIE4A
OCIE3A
OCIE2A
OCIE1A
OCIE0A
PCINT17
PCINT9
PCINT1
ISC41
ISC01
PCIE1
-
XMM0
SRW00
TOIE5
TOIE4
TOIE3
TOIE2
TOIE1
TOIE0
PCINT16
PCINT8
PCINT0
ISC40
ISC00
PCIE0
-
page 37
page 36
(0x74)
SRE
SRL2
SRL1
ICIE5
ICIE4
ICIE3
-
SRL0
SRW11
OCIE5C
OCIE4C
OCIE3C
-
(0x73)
-
-
-
page 168
page 167
page 167
page 194
page 167
page 134
page 116
page 116
page 117
page 114
page 113
page 115
(0x72)
-
-
-
(0x71)
-
-
-
(0x70)
-
-
-
(0x6F)
-
-
ICIE1
-
-
OCIE1C
-
(0x6E)
-
-
-
(0x6D)
PCINT23
PCINT15
PCINT7
ISC71
ISC31
-
PCINT22
PCINT14
PCINT6
ISC70
ISC30
-
PCINT21
PCINT13
PCINT5
ISC61
ISC21
-
PCINT20
PCINT12
PCINT4
ISC60
ISC20
-
PCINT19
PCINT11
PCINT3
ISC51
ISC11
-
(0x6C)
(0x6B)
(0x6A)
(0x69)
EICRA
(0x68)
PCICR
(0x67)
Reserved
OSCCAL
PRR1
-
-
-
-
-
(0x66)
Oscillator Calibration Register
page 50
page 57
page 56
(0x65)
-
-
PRTIM5
PRTIM4
PRTIM3
PRUSART3
PRUSART2
PRUSART1
(0x64)
PRR0
PRTWI
PRTIM2
PRTIM0
-
PRTIM1
PRSPI
PRUSART0
PRADC
(0x63)
Reserved
Reserved
CLKPR
WDTCSR
SREG
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
(0x62)
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
(0x61)
CLKPCE
-
-
-
CLKPS3
CLKPS2
CLKPS1
CLKPS0
page 50
page 67
page 13
page 15
page 15
page 16
page 16
(0x60)
WDIF
WDIE
WDP3
WDCE
WDE
WDP2
WDP1
WDP0
0x3F (0x5F)
0x3E (0x5E)
0x3D (0x5D)
0x3C (0x5C)
0x3B (0x5B)
0x3A (0x5A)
0x39 (0x59)
0x38 (0x58)
0x37 (0x57)
0x36 (0x56)
0x35 (0x55)
0x34 (0x54)
0x33 (0x53)
0x32 (0x52)
0x31 (0x51)
0x30 (0x50)
0x2F (0x4F)
0x2E (0x4E)
0x2D (0x4D)
0x2C (0x4C)
0x2B (0x4B)
0x2A (0x4A)
0x29 (0x49)
0x28 (0x48)
0x27 (0x47)
0x26 (0x46)
0x25 (0x45)
0x24 (0x44)
0x23 (0x43)
0x22 (0x42)
0x21 (0x41)
0x20 (0x40)
0x1F (0x3F)
0x1E (0x3E)
0x1D (0x3D)
0x1C (0x3C)
0x1B (0x3B)
I
T
H
S
V
N
Z
C
SPH
SP15
SP14
SP13
SP12
SP11
SP10
SP9
SP8
SPL
SP7
SP6
SP5
SP4
SP3
SP2
SP1
SP0
EIND
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
EIND0
RAMPZ
Reserved
Reserved
Reserved
SPMCSR
Reserved
MCUCR
MCUSR
SMCR
-
-
-
-
-
-
RAMPZ1
RAMPZ0
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
PGERS
-
-
SPMEN
-
SPMIE
RWWSB
SIGRD
RWWSRE
BLBSET
PGWRT
page 334
-
-
-
-
-
-
JTD
-
-
PUD
-
WDRF
SM2
-
-
BORF
SM1
-
IVSEL
EXTRF
SM0
-
IVCE
PORF
SE
page 67,110,100,309
page 309
-
-
-
JTRF
-
-
-
-
page 52
Reserved
OCDR
-
OCDR7
ACD
-
-
-
OCDR5
ACO
-
-
OCDR4
ACI
-
OCDR6
ACBG
-
OCDR3
ACIE
-
OCDR2
ACIC
-
OCDR1
ACIS1
-
OCDR0
ACIS0
-
page 302
page 272
ACSR
Reserved
SPDR
-
SPI Data Register
page 205
page 204
page 203
page 36
page 36
SPSR
SPIF
SPIE
WCOL
-
-
-
-
-
SPI2X
SPR0
SPCR
SPE
DORD
MSTR
CPOL
CPHA
SPR1
GPIOR2
GPIOR1
Reserved
OCR0B
OCR0A
TCNT0
TCCR0B
TCCR0A
GTCCR
EEARH
EEARL
EEDR
General Purpose I/O Register 2
General Purpose I/O Register 1
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
Timer/Counter0 Output Compare Register B
Timer/Counter0 Output Compare Register A
Timer/Counter0 (8 Bit)
page 133
page 133
page 133
page 132
page 129
page 171, 195
page 34
FOC0A
COM0A1
TSM
FOC0B
-
-
WGM02
CS02
CS01
CS00
COM0A0
COM0B1
COM0B0
-
-
-
-
WGM01
PSRASY
WGM00
-
-
-
-
-
-
PSRSYNC
-
EEPROM Address Register High Byte
EEPROM Address Register Low Byte
EEPROM Data Register
page 34
page 34
EECR
-
-
EEPM1
EEPM0
EERIE
EEMPE
EEPE
EERE
page 34
GPIOR0
EIMSK
General Purpose I/O Register 0
page 36
INT7
INTF7
-
INT6
INTF6
-
INT5
INTF5
-
INT4
INTF4
-
INT3
INTF3
-
INT2
INTF2
PCIF2
INT1
INTF1
PCIF1
INT0
INTF0
PCIF0
page 115
page 115
page 116
EIFR
PCIFR
417
2549L–AVR–08/07
Address
Name
Bit 7
Bit 6
Bit 5
Bit 4
Bit 3
Bit 2
Bit 1
Bit 0
Page
0x1A (0x3A)
0x19 (0x39)
0x18 (0x38)
0x17 (0x37)
0x16 (0x36)
0x15 (0x35)
0x14 (0x34)
0x13 (0x33)
0x12 (0x32)
0x11 (0x31)
0x10 (0x30)
0x0F (0x2F)
0x0E (0x2E)
0x0D (0x2D)
0x0C (0x2C)
0x0B (0x2B)
0x0A (0x2A)
0x09 (0x29)
0x08 (0x28)
0x07 (0x27)
0x06 (0x26)
0x05 (0x25)
0x04 (0x24)
0x03 (0x23)
0x02 (0x22)
0x01 (0x21)
0x00 (0x20)
TIFR5
TIFR4
TIFR3
TIFR2
TIFR1
TIFR0
PORTG
DDRG
PING
-
-
-
-
ICF5
ICF4
-
OCF5C
OCF4C
OCF3C
-
OCF5B
OCF4B
OCF3B
OCF2B
OCF1B
OCF0B
PORTG2
DDG2
OCF5A
OCF4A
OCF3A
OCF2A
OCF1A
OCF0A
PORTG1
DDG1
TOV5
TOV4
page 168
page 169
page 168
page 194
page 168
page 134
page 102
page 102
page 103
page 101
page 102
page 102
page 102
page 102
page 102
page 101
page 101
page 101
page 101
page 101
page 101
page 101
page 101
page 101
page 100
page 100
page 100
-
-
-
ICF3
-
TOV3
-
-
-
-
TOV2
-
-
ICF1
-
OCF1C
-
TOV1
-
-
-
-
TOV0
-
-
PORTG5
DDG5
PING5
PORTF5
DDF5
PORTG4
DDG4
PING4
PORTF4
DDF4
PINF4
PORTE4
DDE4
PINE4
PORTD4
DDD4
PIND4
PORTC4
DDC4
PINC4
PORTB4
DDB4
PINB4
PORTA4
DDA4
PINA4
PORTG3
DDG3
PING3
PORTF3
DDF3
PORTG0
DDG0
-
-
-
-
PING2
PORTF2
DDF2
PING1
PORTF1
DDF1
PING0
PORTF0
DDF0
PORTF
DDRF
PINF
PORTF7
DDF7
PINF7
PORTE7
DDE7
PINE7
PORTD7
DDD7
PIND7
PORTC7
DDC7
PINC7
PORTB7
DDB7
PINB7
PORTA7
DDA7
PINA7
PORTF6
DDF6
PINF6
PORTE6
DDE6
PINE6
PORTD6
DDD6
PIND6
PORTC6
DDC6
PINC6
PORTB6
DDB6
PINB6
PORTA6
DDA6
PINA6
PINF5
PORTE5
DDE5
PINE5
PORTD5
DDD5
PIND5
PORTC5
DDC5
PINC5
PORTB5
DDB5
PINB5
PORTA5
DDA5
PINA5
PINF3
PORTE3
DDE3
PINF2
PINF1
PINF0
PORTE0
DDE0
PORTE
DDRE
PINE
PORTE2
DDE2
PORTE1
DDE1
PINE3
PORTD3
DDD3
PINE2
PINE1
PINE0
PORTD0
DDD0
PORTD
DDRD
PIND
PORTD2
DDD2
PORTD1
DDD1
PIND3
PORTC3
DDC3
PIND2
PIND1
PIND0
PORTC0
DDC0
PORTC
DDRC
PINC
PORTC2
DDC2
PORTC1
DDC1
PINC3
PORTB3
DDB3
PINC2
PINC1
PINC0
PORTB0
DDB0
PORTB
DDRB
PINB
PORTB2
DDB2
PORTB1
DDB1
PINB3
PORTA3
DDA3
PINB2
PINB1
PINB0
PORTA0
DDA0
PORTA
DDRA
PINA
PORTA2
DDA2
PORTA1
DDA1
PINA3
PINA2
PINA1
PINA0
Notes: 1. For compatibility with future devices, reserved bits should be written to zero if accessed. Reserved I/O memory addresses
should never be written.
2. I/O registers within the address range $00 - $1F are directly bit-accessible using the SBI and CBI instructions. In these reg-
isters, the value of single bits can be checked by using the SBIS and SBIC instructions.
3. Some of the status flags are cleared by writing a logical one to them. Note that the CBI and SBI instructions will operate on
all bits in the I/O register, writing a one back into any flag read as set, thus clearing the flag. The CBI and SBI instructions
work with registers 0x00 to 0x1F only.
4. When using the I/O specific commands IN and OUT, the I/O addresses $00 - $3F must be used. When addressing I/O regis-
ters as data space using LD and ST instructions, $20 must be added to these addresses. The
ATmega640/1280/1281/2560/2561 is a complex microcontroller with more peripheral units than can be supported within
the 64 location reserved in Opcode for the IN and OUT instructions. For the Extended I/O space from $60 - $1FF in SRAM,
only the ST/STS/STD and LD/LDS/LDD instructions can be used.
418
ATmega640/1280/1281/2560/2561
2549L–AVR–08/07
ATmega640/1280/1281/2560/2561
34. Instruction Set Summary
Mnemonics
Operands
Description
Operation
Flags
#Clocks
ARITHMETIC AND LOGIC INSTRUCTIONS
ADD
Rd, Rr
Rd, Rr
Rdl,K
Rd, Rr
Rd, K
Rd, Rr
Rd, K
Rdl,K
Rd, Rr
Rd, K
Rd, Rr
Rd, K
Rd, Rr
Rd
Add two Registers
Rd ← Rd + Rr
Z,C,N,V,H
Z,C,N,V,H
Z,C,N,V,S
Z,C,N,V,H
Z,C,N,V,H
Z,C,N,V,H
Z,C,N,V,H
Z,C,N,V,S
Z,N,V
1
1
2
1
1
1
1
2
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
2
2
2
2
2
2
ADC
Add with Carry two Registers
Add Immediate to Word
Subtract two Registers
Subtract Constant from Register
Subtract with Carry two Registers
Subtract with Carry Constant from Reg.
Subtract Immediate from Word
Logical AND Registers
Logical AND Register and Constant
Logical OR Registers
Rd ← Rd + Rr + C
Rdh:Rdl ← Rdh:Rdl + K
Rd ← Rd - Rr
ADIW
SUB
SUBI
SBC
Rd ← Rd - K
Rd ← Rd - Rr - C
Rd ← Rd - K - C
Rdh:Rdl ← Rdh:Rdl - K
Rd ← Rd • Rr
SBCI
SBIW
AND
ANDI
OR
Rd ← Rd • K
Z,N,V
Rd ← Rd v Rr
Z,N,V
ORI
Logical OR Register and Constant
Exclusive OR Registers
One’s Complement
Rd ← Rd v K
Z,N,V
EOR
COM
NEG
SBR
Rd ← Rd ⊕ Rr
Z,N,V
Rd ← 0xFF − Rd
Rd ← 0x00 − Rd
Rd ← Rd v K
Z,C,N,V
Z,C,N,V,H
Z,N,V
Rd
Two’s Complement
Rd,K
Rd,K
Rd
Set Bit(s) in Register
CBR
Clear Bit(s) in Register
Increment
Rd ← Rd • (0xFF - K)
Rd ← Rd + 1
Z,N,V
INC
Z,N,V
DEC
Rd
Decrement
Rd ← Rd − 1
Z,N,V
TST
Rd
Test for Zero or Minus
Clear Register
Rd ← Rd • Rd
Z,N,V
CLR
Rd
Rd ← Rd ⊕ Rd
Rd ← 0xFF
Z,N,V
SER
Rd
Set Register
None
MUL
Rd, Rr
Rd, Rr
Rd, Rr
Rd, Rr
Rd, Rr
Rd, Rr
Multiply Unsigned
R1:R0 ← Rd x Rr
R1:R0 ← Rd x Rr
R1:R0 ← Rd x Rr
R1:R0 ← (Rd x Rr) << 1
R1:R0 ← (Rd x Rr) << 1
R1:R0 ← (Rd x Rr) << 1
Z,C
MULS
MULSU
FMUL
FMULS
FMULSU
Multiply Signed
Z,C
Multiply Signed with Unsigned
Fractional Multiply Unsigned
Fractional Multiply Signed
Fractional Multiply Signed with Unsigned
Z,C
Z,C
Z,C
Z,C
BRANCH INSTRUCTIONS
RJMP
IJMP
k
Relative Jump
PC ← PC + k + 1
PC ← Z
None
None
None
None
None
None
None
None
None
I
2
2
Indirect Jump to (Z)
PC ←(EIND:Z)
EIJMP
JMP
Extended Indirect Jump to (Z)
Direct Jump
2
k
k
PC ← k
3
RCALL
ICALL
EICALL
CALL
RET
Relative Subroutine Call
Indirect Call to (Z)
PC ← PC + k + 1
PC ← Z
4
4
PC ←(EIND:Z)
Extended Indirect Call to (Z)
Direct Subroutine Call
Subroutine Return
4
k
PC ← k
5
PC ← STACK
5
RETI
Interrupt Return
PC ← STACK
5
CPSE
CP
Rd,Rr
Compare, Skip if Equal
Compare
if (Rd = Rr) PC ← PC + 2 or 3
Rd − Rr
None
Z, N,V,C,H
Z, N,V,C,H
Z, N,V,C,H
None
None
None
None
None
None
None
None
None
None
None
None
None
None
None
None
None
None
None
None
1/2/3
1
Rd,Rr
CPC
Rd,Rr
Compare with Carry
Rd − Rr − C
1
CPI
Rd,K
Compare Register with Immediate
Skip if Bit in Register Cleared
Skip if Bit in Register is Set
Skip if Bit in I/O Register Cleared
Skip if Bit in I/O Register is Set
Branch if Status Flag Set
Branch if Status Flag Cleared
Branch if Equal
Rd − K
1
SBRC
SBRS
SBIC
Rr, b
if (Rr(b)=0) PC ← PC + 2 or 3
if (Rr(b)=1) PC ← PC + 2 or 3
if (P(b)=0) PC ← PC + 2 or 3
if (P(b)=1) PC ← PC + 2 or 3
if (SREG(s) = 1) then PC←PC+k + 1
if (SREG(s) = 0) then PC←PC+k + 1
if (Z = 1) then PC ← PC + k + 1
if (Z = 0) then PC ← PC + k + 1
if (C = 1) then PC ← PC + k + 1
if (C = 0) then PC ← PC + k + 1
if (C = 0) then PC ← PC + k + 1
if (C = 1) then PC ← PC + k + 1
if (N = 1) then PC ← PC + k + 1
if (N = 0) then PC ← PC + k + 1
if (N ⊕ V= 0) then PC ← PC + k + 1
if (N ⊕ V= 1) then PC ← PC + k + 1
if (H = 1) then PC ← PC + k + 1
if (H = 0) then PC ← PC + k + 1
if (T = 1) then PC ← PC + k + 1
if (T = 0) then PC ← PC + k + 1
1/2/3
1/2/3
1/2/3
1/2/3
1/2
1/2
1/2
1/2
1/2
1/2
1/2
1/2
1/2
1/2
1/2
1/2
1/2
1/2
1/2
1/2
Rr, b
P, b
P, b
s, k
s, k
k
SBIS
BRBS
BRBC
BREQ
BRNE
BRCS
BRCC
BRSH
BRLO
BRMI
BRPL
BRGE
BRLT
BRHS
BRHC
BRTS
BRTC
k
Branch if Not Equal
k
Branch if Carry Set
k
Branch if Carry Cleared
Branch if Same or Higher
Branch if Lower
k
k
k
Branch if Minus
k
Branch if Plus
k
Branch if Greater or Equal, Signed
Branch if Less Than Zero, Signed
Branch if Half Carry Flag Set
Branch if Half Carry Flag Cleared
Branch if T Flag Set
k
k
k
k
k
Branch if T Flag Cleared
419
2549L–AVR–08/07
Mnemonics
Operands
Description
Operation
Flags
#Clocks
BRVS
BRVC
BRIE
BRID
k
k
k
k
Branch if Overflow Flag is Set
if (V = 1) then PC ← PC + k + 1
if (V = 0) then PC ← PC + k + 1
if ( I = 1) then PC ← PC + k + 1
if ( I = 0) then PC ← PC + k + 1
None
1/2
1/2
1/2
1/2
Branch if Overflow Flag is Cleared
Branch if Interrupt Enabled
Branch if Interrupt Disabled
None
None
None
BIT AND BIT-TEST INSTRUCTIONS
SBI
P,b
P,b
Rd
Rd
Rd
Rd
Rd
Rd
s
Set Bit in I/O Register
Clear Bit in I/O Register
Logical Shift Left
I/O(P,b) ← 1
None
2
2
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
CBI
I/O(P,b) ← 0
None
LSL
Rd(n+1) ← Rd(n), Rd(0) ← 0
Z,C,N,V
LSR
ROL
ROR
ASR
SWAP
BSET
BCLR
BST
BLD
SEC
CLC
SEN
CLN
SEZ
CLZ
SEI
Logical Shift Right
Rd(n) ← Rd(n+1), Rd(7) ← 0
Z,C,N,V
Rotate Left Through Carry
Rotate Right Through Carry
Arithmetic Shift Right
Swap Nibbles
Rd(0)←C,Rd(n+1)← Rd(n),C←Rd(7)
Z,C,N,V
Rd(7)←C,Rd(n)← Rd(n+1),C←Rd(0)
Z,C,N,V
Rd(n) ← Rd(n+1), n=0..6
Z,C,N,V
Rd(3..0)←Rd(7..4),Rd(7..4)←Rd(3..0)
None
Flag Set
SREG(s) ← 1
SREG(s) ← 0
T ← Rr(b)
Rd(b) ← T
C ← 1
SREG(s)
s
Flag Clear
SREG(s)
Rr, b
Rd, b
Bit Store from Register to T
Bit load from T to Register
Set Carry
T
None
C
C
N
N
Z
Clear Carry
C ← 0
Set Negative Flag
N ← 1
Clear Negative Flag
Set Zero Flag
N ← 0
Z ← 1
Clear Zero Flag
Z ← 0
Z
Global Interrupt Enable
Global Interrupt Disable
Set Signed Test Flag
Clear Signed Test Flag
Set Twos Complement Overflow.
Clear Twos Complement Overflow
Set T in SREG
I ← 1
I
CLI
I ← 0
I
SES
CLS
SEV
CLV
SET
CLT
SEH
CLH
S ← 1
S
S
V
V
T
S ← 0
V ← 1
V ← 0
T ← 1
Clear T in SREG
T ← 0
T
Set Half Carry Flag in SREG
Clear Half Carry Flag in SREG
H ← 1
H
H
H ← 0
DATA TRANSFER INSTRUCTIONS
MOV
MOVW
LDI
LD
Rd, Rr
Rd, Rr
Rd, K
Move Between Registers
Copy Register Word
Rd ← Rr
None
None
None
None
None
None
None
None
None
None
None
None
None
None
None
None
None
None
None
None
None
None
None
None
None
None
None
None
None
None
None
None
1
1
1
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
2
3
3
3
3
3
Rd+1:Rd ← Rr+1:Rr
Load Immediate
Rd ← K
Rd, X
Load Indirect
Rd ← (X)
LD
Rd, X+
Rd, - X
Rd, Y
Load Indirect and Post-Inc.
Load Indirect and Pre-Dec.
Load Indirect
Rd ← (X), X ← X + 1
X ← X - 1, Rd ← (X)
Rd ← (Y)
LD
LD
LD
Rd, Y+
Rd, - Y
Rd,Y+q
Rd, Z
Load Indirect and Post-Inc.
Load Indirect and Pre-Dec.
Load Indirect with Displacement
Load Indirect
Rd ← (Y), Y ← Y + 1
Y ← Y - 1, Rd ← (Y)
Rd ← (Y + q)
LD
LDD
LD
Rd ← (Z)
LD
Rd, Z+
Rd, -Z
Rd, Z+q
Rd, k
Load Indirect and Post-Inc.
Load Indirect and Pre-Dec.
Load Indirect with Displacement
Load Direct from SRAM
Store Indirect
Rd ← (Z), Z ← Z+1
Z ← Z - 1, Rd ← (Z)
Rd ← (Z + q)
LD
LDD
LDS
ST
Rd ← (k)
X, Rr
(X) ← Rr
ST
X+, Rr
- X, Rr
Y, Rr
Store Indirect and Post-Inc.
Store Indirect and Pre-Dec.
Store Indirect
(X) ← Rr, X ← X + 1
X ← X - 1, (X) ← Rr
(Y) ← Rr
ST
ST
ST
Y+, Rr
- Y, Rr
Y+q,Rr
Z, Rr
Store Indirect and Post-Inc.
Store Indirect and Pre-Dec.
Store Indirect with Displacement
Store Indirect
(Y) ← Rr, Y ← Y + 1
Y ← Y - 1, (Y) ← Rr
(Y + q) ← Rr
ST
STD
ST
(Z) ← Rr
ST
Z+, Rr
-Z, Rr
Z+q,Rr
k, Rr
Store Indirect and Post-Inc.
Store Indirect and Pre-Dec.
Store Indirect with Displacement
Store Direct to SRAM
(Z) ← Rr, Z ← Z + 1
Z ← Z - 1, (Z) ← Rr
(Z + q) ← Rr
ST
STD
STS
LPM
LPM
LPM
ELPM
ELPM
(k) ← Rr
Load Program Memory
Load Program Memory
Load Program Memory and Post-Inc
Extended Load Program Memory
Extended Load Program Memory
R0 ← (Z)
Rd, Z
Rd ← (Z)
Rd, Z+
Rd ← (Z), Z ← Z+1
R0 ← (RAMPZ:Z)
Rd ← (RAMPZ:Z)
Rd, Z
420
ATmega640/1280/1281/2560/2561
2549L–AVR–08/07
ATmega640/1280/1281/2560/2561
Mnemonics
Operands
Description
Operation
Flags
#Clocks
ELPM
SPM
IN
Rd, Z+
Extended Load Program Memory
Rd ← (RAMPZ:Z), RAMPZ:Z ←RAMPZ:Z+1
None
3
-
Store Program Memory
In Port
(Z) ← R1:R0
Rd ← P
None
None
None
None
None
Rd, P
P, Rr
Rr
1
1
2
2
OUT
PUSH
POP
Out Port
P ← Rr
Push Register on Stack
Pop Register from Stack
STACK ← Rr
Rd ← STACK
Rd
MCU CONTROL INSTRUCTIONS
NOP
No Operation
Sleep
None
None
None
None
1
1
SLEEP
WDR
(see specific descr. for Sleep function)
(see specific descr. for WDR/timer)
For On-chip Debug Only
Watchdog Reset
Break
1
BREAK
N/A
Note:
EICALL and EIJMP do not exist in ATmega640/1280/1281.
ELPM does not exist in ATmega640.
421
2549L–AVR–08/07
35. Ordering Information
35.1 ATmega640
Speed (MHz)(2)
Power Supply
Ordering Code
Package(1)(3)
Operation Range
ATmega640V-8AU
ATmega640V-8CU
100A
8
1.8 - 5.5V
Industrial (-40°C to 85°C)
100C1
ATmega640-16AU
ATmega640-16CU
100A
16
2.7 - 5.5V
Industrial (-40°C to 85°C)
100C1
Notes: 1. This device can also be supplied in wafer form. Please contact your local Atmel sales office for detailed ordering information
and minimum quantities.
2. See “Speed Grades” on page 372.
3. Pb-free packaging, complies to the European Directive for Restriction of Hazardous Substances (RoHS directive). Also
Halide free and fully Green.
Package Type
64A
64-lead, Thin (1.0 mm) Plastic Gull Wing Quad Flat Package (TQFP)
64-pad, 9 x 9 x 1.0 mm Body, Quad Flat No-lead/Micro Lead Frame Package (QFN/MLF)
100-lead, Thin (1.0 mm) Plastic Gull Wing Quad Flat Package (TQFP)
100-ball, Chip Ball Grid Array (CBGA)
64M2
100A
100C1
422
ATmega640/1280/1281/2560/2561
2549L–AVR–08/07
ATmega640/1280/1281/2560/2561
35.2 ATmega1281
Speed (MHz)(2)
Power Supply
Ordering Code
Package(1)(3)
Operation Range
ATmega1281V-8AU
ATmega1281V-8MU
64A
64M2
Industrial
(-40°C to 85°C)
8
1.8 - 5.5V
2.7 - 5.5V
ATmega1281-16AU
ATmega1281-16MU
64A
64M2
Industrial
(-40°C to 85°C)
16
Notes: 1. This device can also be supplied in wafer form. Please contact your local Atmel sales office for detailed ordering information
and minimum quantities.
2. See “Speed Grades” on page 372
3. Pb-free packaging, complies to the European Directive for Restriction of Hazardous Substances (RoHS directive). Also
Halide free and fully Green.
Package Type
64A
64-lead, Thin (1.0 mm) Plastic Gull Wing Quad Flat Package (TQFP)
64-pad, 9 x 9 x 1.0 mm Body, Quad Flat No-lead/Micro Lead Frame Package (QFN/MLF)
100-lead, Thin (1.0 mm) Plastic Gull Wing Quad Flat Package (TQFP)
100-ball, Chip Ball Grid Array (CBGA)
64M2
100A
100C1
423
2549L–AVR–08/07
35.3 ATmega1280
Speed (MHz)(2)
Power Supply
Ordering Code
Package(1)(3)
Operation Range
ATmega1280V-8AU
ATmega1280V-8CU
100A
8
1.8 - 5.5V
2.7 - 5.5V
Industrial (-40°C to 85°C)
100C1
ATmega1280-16AU
ATmega1280-16CU
100A
16
Industrial (-40°C to 85°C)
100C1
Notes: 1. This device can also be supplied in wafer form. Please contact your local Atmel sales office for detailed ordering information
and minimum quantities.
2. See “Speed Grades” on page 372
3. Pb-free packaging, complies to the European Directive for Restriction of Hazardous Substances (RoHS directive). Also
Halide free and fully Green.
Package Type
64A
64-lead, Thin (1.0 mm) Plastic Gull Wing Quad Flat Package (TQFP)
64-pad, 9 x 9 x 1.0 mm Body, Quad Flat No-lead/Micro Lead Frame Package (QFN/MLF)
100-lead, Thin (1.0 mm) Plastic Gull Wing Quad Flat Package (TQFP)
100-ball, Chip Ball Grid Array (CBGA)
64M2
100A
100C1
424
ATmega640/1280/1281/2560/2561
2549L–AVR–08/07
ATmega640/1280/1281/2560/2561
35.4 ATmega2561
Speed (MHz)(2)
Power Supply
Ordering Code
Package(1)(3)
Operation Range
ATmega2561V-8AU
ATmega2561V-8MU
64A
64M2
Industrial
(-40°C to 85°C)
8
1.8 - 5.5V
4.5 - 5.5V
ATmega2561-16AU
ATmega2561-16MU
64A
64M2
Industrial
(-40°C to 85°C)
16
Notes: 1. This device can also be supplied in wafer form. Please contact your local Atmel sales office for detailed ordering information
and minimum quantities.
2. See “Speed Grades” on page 372
3. Pb-free packaging, complies to the European Directive for Restriction of Hazardous Substances (RoHS directive). Also
Halide free and fully Green.
Package Type
64A
64-lead, Thin (1.0 mm) Plastic Gull Wing Quad Flat Package (TQFP)
64-pad, 9 x 9 x 1.0 mm Body, Quad Flat No-lead/Micro Lead Frame Package (QFN/MLF)
100-lead, Thin (1.0 mm) Plastic Gull Wing Quad Flat Package (TQFP)
100-ball, Chip Ball Grid Array (CBGA)
64M2
100A
100C1
425
2549L–AVR–08/07
35.5 ATmega2560
Speed (MHz)(2)
Power Supply
Ordering Code
Package(1)(3)
Operation Range
ATmega2560V-8AU
ATmega2560V-8CU
100A
8
1.8 - 5.5V
4.5 - 5.5V
Industrial (-40°C to 85°C)
100C1
ATmega2560-16AU
ATmega2560-16CU
100A
16
Industrial (-40°C to 85°C)
100C1
Notes: 1. This device can also be supplied in wafer form. Please contact your local Atmel sales office for detailed ordering information
and minimum quantities.
2. See “Speed Grades” on page 372.
3. Pb-free packaging, complies to the European Directive for Restriction of Hazardous Substances (RoHS directive). Also
Halide free and fully Green.
Package Type
64A
64-lead, Thin (1.0 mm) Plastic Gull Wing Quad Flat Package (TQFP)
64-pad, 9 x 9 x 1.0 mm Body, Quad Flat No-lead/Micro Lead Frame Package (QFN/MLF)
100-lead, Thin (1.0 mm) Plastic Gull Wing Quad Flat Package (TQFP)
100-ball, Chip Ball Grid Array (CBGA)
64M2
100A
100C1
426
ATmega640/1280/1281/2560/2561
2549L–AVR–08/07
ATmega640/1280/1281/2560/2561
36. Packaging Information
36.1 100A
PIN 1
B
PIN 1 IDENTIFIER
E1
E
e
D1
D
C
0˚~7˚
A2
A
A1
L
COMMON DIMENSIONS
(Unit of Measure = mm)
MIN
–
MAX
1.20
NOM
NOTE
SYMBOL
A
–
–
A1
A2
D
0.05
0.95
15.75
13.90
15.75
13.90
0.17
0.09
0.45
0.15
1.00
16.00
14.00
16.00
14.00
–
1.05
16.25
D1
E
14.10 Note 2
16.25
Notes:
1. This package conforms to JEDEC reference MS-026, Variation AED.
2. Dimensions D1 and E1 do not include mold protrusion. Allowable
protrusion is 0.25 mm per side. Dimensions D1 and E1 are maximum
plastic body size dimensions including mold mismatch.
E1
B
14.10 Note 2
0.27
C
–
0.20
3. Lead coplanarity is 0.08 mm maximum.
L
–
0.75
e
0.50 TYP
10/5/2001
TITLE
DRAWING NO. REV.
2325 Orchard Parkway
San Jose, CA 95131
100A, 100-lead, 14 x 14 mm Body Size, 1.0 mm Body Thickness,
0.5 mm Lead Pitch, Thin Profile Plastic Quad Flat Package (TQFP)
100A
C
R
427
2549L–AVR–08/07
36.2 100C1
0.12
Z
E
Marked A1 Identifier
SIDE VIEW
D
A
TOP VIEW
A1
Øb
e
A1 Corner
0.90 TYP
10
8
7
6
9
5
4
3
2
1
A
B
C
D
0.90 TYP
COMMON DIMENSIONS
E
F
(Unit of Measure = mm)
D1
MIN
1.10
0.30
8.90
8.90
7.10
7.10
0.35
MAX
1.20
0.40
9.10
9.10
7.30
7.30
0.45
NOM
–
NOTE
SYMBOL
G
e
A
H
I
A1
D
0.35
J
9.00
E
9.00
E1
D1
E1
Øb
e
7.20
7.20
BOTTOM VIEW
0.40
0.80 TYP
5/25/06
DRAWING NO. REV.
100C1
TITLE
2325 Orchard Parkway
San Jose, CA 95131
100C1, 100-ball, 9 x 9 x 1.2 mm Body, Ball Pitch 0.80 mm
Chip Array BGA Package (CBGA)
A
R
428
ATmega640/1280/1281/2560/2561
2549L–AVR–08/07
ATmega640/1280/1281/2560/2561
36.3 64A
PIN 1
B
PIN 1 IDENTIFIER
E1
E
e
D1
D
C
0°~7°
A2
A
A1
L
COMMON DIMENSIONS
(Unit of Measure = mm)
MIN
–
MAX
1.20
NOM
–
NOTE
SYMBOL
A
A1
A2
D
0.05
0.95
15.75
13.90
15.75
13.90
0.30
0.09
0.45
–
0.15
1.00
16.00
14.00
16.00
14.00
–
1.05
16.25
D1
E
14.10 Note 2
16.25
Notes:
E1
B
14.10 Note 2
0.45
1.This package conforms to JEDEC reference MS-026, Variation AEB.
2. Dimensions D1 and E1 do not include mold protrusion. Allowable
protrusion is 0.25 mm per side. Dimensions D1 and E1 are maximum
plastic body size dimensions including mold mismatch.
C
–
0.20
3. Lead coplanarity is 0.10 mm maximum.
L
–
0.75
e
0.80 TYP
10/5/2001
TITLE
DRAWING NO. REV.
2325 Orchard Parkway
San Jose, CA 95131
64A, 64-lead, 14 x 14 mm Body Size, 1.0 mm Body Thickness,
0.8 mm Lead Pitch, Thin Profile Plastic Quad Flat Package (TQFP)
64A
B
R
429
2549L–AVR–08/07
36.4 64M2
D
Marked Pin# 1 ID
E
SEATING PLANE
C
A1
TOP VIEW
A
K
0.08
C
L
Pin #1 Corner
SIDE VIEW
D2
Pin #1
Triangle
Option A
1
2
3
COMMON DIMENSIONS
(Unit of Measure = mm)
MIN
0.80
–
MAX
1.00
0.05
0.30
9.10
7.80
9.10
NOM
0.90
0.02
0.25
9.00
7.65
9.00
NOTE
SYMBOL
E2
Option B
Option C
A
Pin #1
Chamfer
(C 0.30)
A1
b
0.18
8.90
7.50
8.90
D
D2
E
K
Pin #1
Notch
(0.20 R)
e
b
E2
e
7.50
7.65
0.50 BSC
0.40
7.80
BOTTOM VIEW
L
0.35
0.20
0.45
0.40
K
0.27
1. JEDEC Standard MO-220, (SAW Singulation) Fig. 1, VMMD.
2. Dimension and tolerance conform to ASMEY14.5M-1994.
Note:
5/25/06
DRAWING NO. REV.
TITLE
2325 Orchard Parkway
San Jose, CA 95131
64M2, 64-pad, 9 x 9 x 1.0 mm Body, Lead Pitch 0.50 mm,
7.65 mm Exposed Pad, Micro Lead Frame Package (MLF)
64M2
D
R
430
ATmega640/1280/1281/2560/2561
2549L–AVR–08/07
ATmega640/1280/1281/2560/2561
37. Errata
37.1 ATmega640 rev. A
• Inaccurate ADC conversion in differential mode with 200x gain
• High current consumption in sleep mode
1. Inaccurate ADC conversion in differential mode with 200x gain
With AVCC < 3.6V, random conversions will be inaccurate. Typical absolute accuracy may
reach 64 LSB.
Problem Fix/Workaround
None
2. High current consumption in sleep mode.
If a pending interrupt cannot wake the part up from the selected sleep mode, the current
consumption will increase during sleep when executing the SLEEP instruction directly after
a SEI instruction.
Problem Fix/Workaround
Before entering sleep, interrupts not used to wake the part from the sleep mode should be
disabled.
37.2 ATmega1280 rev. A
• Inaccurate ADC conversion in differential mode with 200x gain
• High current consumption in sleep mode
1. Inaccurate ADC conversion in differential mode with 200x gain
With AVCC < 3.6V, random conversions will be inaccurate. Typical absolute accuracy may
reach 64 LSB.
Problem Fix/Workaround
None
2. High current consumption in sleep mode.
If a pending interrupt cannot wake the part up from the selected sleep mode, the current
consumption will increase during sleep when executing the SLEEP instruction directly after
a SEI instruction.
Problem Fix/Workaround
Before entering sleep, interrupts not used to wake the part from the sleep mode should be
disabled.
37.3 ATmega1281 rev. A
• Inaccurate ADC conversion in differential mode with 200x gain
• High current consumption in sleep mode
1. Inaccurate ADC conversion in differential mode with 200x gain
With AVCC < 3.6V, random conversions will be inaccurate. Typical absolute accuracy may
reach 64 LSB.
Problem Fix/Workaround
None
431
2549L–AVR–08/07
2. High current consumption in sleep mode.
If a pending interrupt cannot wake the part up from the selected sleep mode, the current
consumption will increase during sleep when executing the SLEEP instruction directly after
a SEI instruction.
Problem Fix/Workaround
Before entering sleep, interrupts not used to wake the part from the sleep mode should be
disabled.
37.4 ATmega2560 rev. E
No known errata.
37.5 ATmega2560 rev. D
Not sampled.
37.6 ATmega2560 rev. C
• High current consumption in sleep mode
1. High current consumption in sleep mode.
If a pending interrupt cannot wake the part up from the selected sleep mode, the current
consumption will increase during sleep when executing the SLEEP instruction directly after
a SEI instruction.
Problem Fix/Workaround
Before entering sleep, interrupts not used to wake the part from the sleep mode should be
disabled.
37.7 ATmega2560 rev. B
Not sampled.
37.8 ATmega2560 rev. A
• Non-Read-While-Write area of flash not functional
• Part does not work under 2.4 volts
• Incorrect ADC reading in differential mode
• Internal ADC reference has too low value
• IN/OUT instructions may be executed twice when Stack is in external RAM
• EEPROM read from application code does not work in Lock Bit Mode 3
1. Non-Read-While-Write area of flash not functional
The Non-Read-While-Write area of the flash is not working as expected. The problem is
related to the speed of the part when reading the flash of this area.
Problem Fix/Workaround
- Only use the first 248K of the flash.
- If boot functionality is needed, run the code in the Non-Read-While-Write area at maximum
1/4th of the maximum frequency of the device at any given voltage. This is done by writing
the CLKPR register before entering the boot section of the code
2. Part does not work under 2.4 volts
The part does not execute code correctly below 2.4 volts
432
ATmega640/1280/1281/2560/2561
2549L–AVR–08/07
ATmega640/1280/1281/2560/2561
Problem Fix/Workaround
Do not use the part at voltages below 2.4 volts.
3. Incorrect ADC reading in differential mode
The ADC has high noise in differential mode. It can give up to 7 LSB error.
Problem Fix/Workaround
Use only the 7 MSB of the result when using the ADC in differential mode.
4. Internal ADC reference has too low value
The internal ADC reference has a value lower than specified
Problem Fix/Workaround
- Use AVCC or external reference
- The actual value of the reference can be measured by applying a known voltage to the
ADC when using the internal reference. The result when doing later conversions can then be
calibrated.
5. IN/OUT instructions may be executed twice when Stack is in external RAM
If either an IN or an OUT instruction is executed directly before an interrupt occurs and the
stack pointer is located in external ram, the instruction will be executed twice. In some cases
this will cause a problem, for example:
- If reading SREG it will appear that the I-flag is cleared.
- If writing to the PIN registers, the port will toggle twice.
- If reading registers with interrupt flags, the flags will appear to be cleared.
Problem Fix/Workaround
There are two application work-arounds, where selecting one of them, will be omitting the
issue:
- Replace IN and OUT with LD/LDS/LDD and ST/STS/STD instructions
- Use internal RAM for stack pointer.
6. EEPROM read from application code does not work in Lock Bit Mode 3
When the Memory Lock Bits LB2 and LB1 are programmed to mode 3, EEPROM read does
not work from the application code.
Problem Fix/Workaround
Do not set Lock Bit Protection Mode 3 when the application code needs to read from
EEPROM.
37.9 ATmega2561 rev. E
No known errata.
37.10 ATmega2561 rev. D
Not sampled.
433
2549L–AVR–08/07
37.11 ATmega2561 rev. C
• High current consumption in sleep mode
1. High current consumption in sleep mode.
If a pending interrupt cannot wake the part up from the selected sleep mode, the current
consumption will increase during sleep when executing the SLEEP instruction directly after
a SEI instruction.
Problem Fix/Workaround
Before entering sleep, interrupts not used to wake the part from the sleep mode should be
disabled.
37.12 ATmega2561 rev. B
Not sampled.
37.13 ATmega2561 rev. A
• Non-Read-While-Write area of flash not functional
• Part does not work under 2.4 Volts
• Incorrect ADC reading in differential mode
• Internal ADC reference has too low value
• IN/OUT instructions may be executed twice when Stack is in external RAM
• EEPROM read from application code does not work in Lock Bit Mode 3
1. Non-Read-While-Write area of flash not functional
The Non-Read-While-Write area of the flash is not working as expected. The problem is
related to the speed of the part when reading the flash of this area.
Problem Fix/Workaround
- Only use the first 248K of the flash.
- If boot functionality is needed, run the code in the Non-Read-While-Write area at maximum
1/4th of the maximum frequency of the device at any given voltage. This is done by writing
the CLKPR register before entering the boot section of the code.
434
ATmega640/1280/1281/2560/2561
2549L–AVR–08/07
ATmega640/1280/1281/2560/2561
2. Part does not work under 2.4 volts
The part does not execute code correctly below 2.4 volts
Problem Fix/Workaround
Do not use the part at voltages below 2.4 volts.
3. Incorrect ADC reading in differential mode
The ADC has high noise in differential mode. It can give up to 7 LSB error.
Problem Fix/Workaround
Use only the 7 MSB of the result when using the ADC in differential mode
4. Internal ADC reference has too low value
The internal ADC reference has a value lower than specified
Problem Fix/Workaround
- Use AVCC or external reference
- The actual value of the reference can be measured by applying a known voltage to the
ADC when using the internal reference. The result when doing later conversions can then be
calibrated.
5. IN/OUT instructions may be executed twice when Stack is in external RAM
If either an IN or an OUT instruction is executed directly before an interrupt occurs and the
stack pointer is located in external ram, the instruction will be executed twice. In some cases
this will cause a problem, for example:
- If reading SREG it will appear that the I-flag is cleared.
- If writing to the PIN registers, the port will toggle twice.
- If reading registers with interrupt flags, the flags will appear to be cleared.
Problem Fix/Workaround
There are two application workarounds, where selecting one of them, will be omitting the
issue:
- Replace IN and OUT with LD/LDS/LDD and ST/STS/STD instructions
- Use internal RAM for stack pointer.
6. EEPROM read from application code does not work in Lock Bit Mode 3
When the Memory Lock Bits LB2 and LB1 are programmed to mode 3, EEPROM read does
not work from the application code.
Problem Fix/Workaround
Do not set Lock Bit Protection Mode 3 when the application code needs to read from
EEPROM.
435
2549L–AVR–08/07
38. Datasheet Revision History
Please note that the referring page numbers in this section are referring to this document.The
referring revision in this section are referring to the document revision.
38.1 Rev. 2549L-08/07
1.
Updated note in Table 10-10 on page 47.
2.
Updated Table 10-3 on page 42, Table 10-5 on page 43, Table 10-8 on page
46.
3.
4.
5.
6.
7.
8.
9.
Updated typos in “DC Characteristics” on page 370
Updated “Clock Characteristics” on page 374
Updated “External Clock Drive” on page 374.
Added “System and Reset Characteristics” on page 375.
Updated “SPI Timing Characteristics” on page 377.
Updated “ADC Characteristics – Preliminary Data” on page 379.
Updated ordering code in “ATmega640” on page 422.
38.2 Rev. 2549K-01/07
1.
2.
3.
4.
5.
Updated Table 1-1 on page 3.
Updated “Pin Descriptions” on page 7.
Updated “Stack Pointer” on page 15.
Updated “Bit 1 – EEPE: EEPROM Programming Enable” on page 35.
Updated Assembly code example in “Thus, when the BOD is not enabled,
after setting the ACBG bit or enabling the ADC, the user must always
allow the reference to start up before the output from the Analog Compar-
ator or ADC is used. To reduce power consumption in Power-down mode,
the user can avoid the three conditions above to ensure that the reference
is turned off before entering Power-down mode” on page 63.
6:
7.
Updated “EIMSK – External Interrupt Mask Register” on page 115.
Updated Bit description in “PCIFR – Pin Change Interrupt Flag Register”
on page 116.
8.
9.
Updated code example in “USART Initialization” on page 211.
Updated Figure 26-8 on page 284.
10. Updated “DC Characteristics” on page 370.
38.3 Rev. 2549J-09/06
1.
Updated “Calibrated Internal RC Oscillator” on page 46.
2.
Updated code example in “Moving Interrupts Between Application and
Boot Section” on page 109.
3.
Updated “Timer/Counter Prescaler” on page 187.
436
ATmega640/1280/1281/2560/2561
2549L–AVR–08/07
ATmega640/1280/1281/2560/2561
4.
5.
6.
Updated “Device Identification Register” on page 304.
Updated “Signature Bytes” on page 340.
Updated “Instruction Set Summary” on page 419.
38.4 Rev. 2549I-07/06
1.
2.
Added “Data Retention” on page 10.
Updated Table 16-3 on page 129, Table 16-6 on page 130, Table 16-8 on
page 131, Table 17-2 on page 148, Table 17-4 on page 160, Table 17-5 on
page 160, Table 20-3 on page 188, Table 20-6 on page 189 and Table 20-8
on page 190.
3.
Updated “Fast PWM Mode” on page 150.
38.5 Rev. 2549H-06/06
1.
2.
3.
Updated “Calibrated Internal RC Oscillator” on page 46.
Updated “OSCCAL – Oscillator Calibration Register” on page 50.
Added Table 31-1 on page 374.
38.6 Rev. 2549G-06/06
1.
2.
3.
4.
5.
6.
7.
8.
9.
Updated “Features” on page 1.
Added Figure 1-2 on page 3, Table 1-1 on page 3.
Updated “Calibrated Internal RC Oscillator” on page 46.
Updated “Power Management and Sleep Modes” on page 52.
Updated note for Table 12-1 on page 68.
Updated Figure 26-9 on page 285 and Figure 26-10 on page 285.
Updated “Setting the Boot Loader Lock Bits by SPM” on page 325.
Updated “Ordering Information” on page 422.
Added Package information “100C1” on page 428.
10. Updated “Errata” on page 431.
38.7 Rev. 2549F-04/06
1.
Updated Figure 9-3 on page 29, Figure 9-4 on page 30 and Figure 1 on
page 30.
2.
3.
4.
Updated Table 20-2 on page 188 and Table 20-3 on page 188.
Updated Features in “ADC – Analog to Digital Converter” on page 275.
Updated “Fuse Bits” on page 338.
437
2549L–AVR–08/07
38.8 Rev. 2549E-04/06
1.
2.
3.
4.
Updated “Features” on page 1.
Updated Table 12-1 on page 62.
Updated note for Table 12-1 on page 62.
Updated “Bit 6 – ACBG: Analog Comparator Bandgap Select” on page
272.
5.
5.
6.
Updated “Prescaling and Conversion Timing” on page 278.
Updated “Maximum speed vs. VCC” on page 373.
Updated “Ordering Information” on page 422.
38.9 Rev. 2549D-12/05
1.
2.
3.
Advanced Information Status changed to Preliminary.
Changed number of I/O Ports from 51 to 54.
Updatet typos in “TCCR0A – Timer/Counter Control Register A” on page
129.
4.
5.
6.
Updated Features in “ADC – Analog to Digital Converter” on page 275.
Updated Operation in“ADC – Analog to Digital Converter” on page 275
Updated Stabilizing Time in “Changing Channel or Reference Selection”
on page 282.
7.
8.
9.
Updated Figure 26-1 on page 276, Figure 26-9 on page 285, Figure 26-10
on page 285.
Updated Text in “ADCSRB – ADC Control and Status Register B” on page
291.
Updated Note for Table 4 on page 42, Table 13-14 on page 86, Table 26-3
on page 290 and Table 26-6 on page 296.
10. Updated Table 31-7 on page 379 and Table 31-8 on page 380.
11. Updated “Filling the Temporary Buffer (Page Loading)” on page 324.
12. Updated “Typical Characteristics” on page 387.
13. Updated “Packaging Information” on page 427.
14. Updated “Errata” on page 431.
38.10 Rev. 2549C-09/05
1.
2.
3.
Updated Speed Grade in section “Features” on page 1.
Added “Resources” on page 10.
Updated “SPI – Serial Peripheral Interface” on page 196. In Slave mode,
low and high period SPI clock must be larger than 2 CPU cycles.
4.
5.
6.
7.
Updated “Bit Rate Generator Unit” on page 247.
Updated “Maximum speed vs. VCC” on page 373.
Updated “Ordering Information” on page 422.
Updated “Packaging Information” on page 427. Package 64M1 replaced
by 64M2.
8.
Updated “Errata” on page 431.
438
ATmega640/1280/1281/2560/2561
2549L–AVR–08/07
ATmega640/1280/1281/2560/2561
38.11 Rev. 2549B-05/05
1.
2.
3.
4.
JTAG ID/Signature for ATmega640 updated: 0x9608.
Updated Table 13-7 on page 81.
Updated “Serial Programming Instruction set” on page 354.
Updated “Errata” on page 431.
38.12 Rev. 2549A-03/05
1.
Initial version.
439
2549L–AVR–08/07
440
ATmega640/1280/1281/2560/2561
2549L–AVR–08/07
ATmega640/1280/1281/2560/2561
Table of Contents
Features ..................................................................................................... 1
Pin Configurations ................................................................................... 2
Disclaimer ................................................................................................. 4
Overview ................................................................................................... 5
1
2
3
3.1
3.2
3.3
Block Diagram ...................................................................................................5
Comparison Between ATmega1281/2561 and ATmega640/1280/2560 ...........7
Pin Descriptions .................................................................................................7
4
5
6
7
Resources ............................................................................................... 10
About Code Examples ........................................................................... 10
Data Retention ........................................................................................ 10
AVR CPU Core ........................................................................................ 11
7.1
7.2
7.3
7.4
7.5
7.6
7.7
7.8
Introduction ......................................................................................................11
Architectural Overview .....................................................................................11
ALU – Arithmetic Logic Unit .............................................................................12
Status Register ................................................................................................13
General Purpose Register File ........................................................................14
Stack Pointer ...................................................................................................15
Instruction Execution Timing ...........................................................................16
Reset and Interrupt Handling ...........................................................................17
8
9
AVR Memories ........................................................................................ 20
8.1
8.2
8.3
8.4
In-System Reprogrammable Flash Program Memory .....................................20
SRAM Data Memory ........................................................................................20
EEPROM Data Memory ..................................................................................22
I/O Memory ......................................................................................................26
External Memory Interface .................................................................... 27
9.1
9.2
9.3
9.4
Overview ..........................................................................................................27
Register Description ........................................................................................34
General Purpose registers ...............................................................................36
External Memory registers ...............................................................................36
10 System Clock and Clock Options ......................................................... 39
10.1
Overview ..........................................................................................................39
i
2549L–AVR–08/07
10.2
10.3
10.4
10.5
10.6
10.7
10.8
10.9
Clock Systems and their Distribution ...............................................................39
Clock Sources .................................................................................................40
Low Power Crystal Oscillator ...........................................................................41
Full Swing Crystal Oscillator ............................................................................43
Low Frequency Crystal Oscillator ....................................................................45
Calibrated Internal RC Oscillator .....................................................................46
128 kHz Internal Oscillator ..............................................................................47
External Clock .................................................................................................47
10.10 Clock Output Buffer .........................................................................................48
10.11 Timer/Counter Oscillator ..................................................................................49
10.12 System Clock Prescaler ..................................................................................49
10.13 Register Description ........................................................................................50
11 Power Management and Sleep Modes ................................................. 52
11.1
11.2
11.3
11.4
11.5
11.6
11.7
11.8
11.9
Sleep Modes ....................................................................................................52
Idle Mode .........................................................................................................52
ADC Noise Reduction Mode ............................................................................53
Power-down Mode ...........................................................................................53
Power-save Mode ............................................................................................53
Standby Mode .................................................................................................54
Extended Standby Mode .................................................................................54
Minimizing Power Consumption ......................................................................54
Register Description ........................................................................................56
12 System Control and Reset .................................................................... 59
12.1
12.2
12.3
12.4
12.5
Resetting the AVR ...........................................................................................59
Reset Sources .................................................................................................59
Internal Voltage Reference ..............................................................................62
Watchdog Timer ..............................................................................................63
Register Description ........................................................................................67
13 I/O-Ports .................................................................................................. 70
13.1
13.2
13.3
13.4
Introduction ......................................................................................................70
Ports as General Digital I/O .............................................................................71
Alternate Port Functions ..................................................................................75
Register Description for I/O-Ports ..................................................................100
14 Interrupts .............................................................................................. 105
14.1
Interrupt Vectors in ATmega640/1280/1281/2560/2561 ................................105
ii
ATmega640/1280/1281/2560/2561
2549L–AVR–08/07
ATmega640/1280/1281/2560/2561
14.2
14.3
14.4
Reset and Interrupt Vector placement ...........................................................106
Moving Interrupts Between Application and Boot Section .............................109
Register Description ......................................................................................110
15 External Interrupts ............................................................................... 112
15.1
15.2
Pin Change Interrupt Timing ..........................................................................112
Register Description ......................................................................................113
16 8-bit Timer/Counter0 with PWM .......................................................... 118
16.1
16.2
16.3
16.4
16.5
16.6
16.7
16.8
16.9
Features ........................................................................................................118
Overview ........................................................................................................118
Timer/Counter Clock Sources .......................................................................119
Counter Unit ..................................................................................................119
Output Compare Unit .....................................................................................120
Compare Match Output Unit ..........................................................................122
Modes of Operation .......................................................................................123
Timer/Counter Timing Diagrams ...................................................................127
Register Description ......................................................................................129
17 16-bit Timer/Counter (Timer/Counter 1, 3, 4, and 5) .......................... 136
17.1
17.2
17.3
17.4
17.5
17.6
17.7
17.8
17.9
Features ........................................................................................................136
Overview ........................................................................................................136
Accessing 16-bit Registers ............................................................................138
Timer/Counter Clock Sources .......................................................................141
Counter Unit ..................................................................................................142
Input Capture Unit .........................................................................................143
Output Compare Units ...................................................................................145
Compare Match Output Unit ..........................................................................147
Modes of Operation .......................................................................................148
17.10 Timer/Counter Timing Diagrams ...................................................................156
17.11 Register Description ......................................................................................158
18 Timer/Counter 0, 1, 3, 4, and 5 Prescaler ........................................... 170
18.1
18.2
18.3
18.4
Internal Clock Source ....................................................................................170
Prescaler Reset .............................................................................................170
External Clock Source ...................................................................................170
Register Description ......................................................................................171
19 Output Compare Modulator (OCM1C0A) ........................................... 173
iii
2549L–AVR–08/07
19.1
19.2
Overview ........................................................................................................173
Description .....................................................................................................173
20 8-bit Timer/Counter2 with PWM and Asynchronous Operation ...... 175
20.1
20.2
20.3
20.4
20.5
20.6
20.7
20.8
20.9
Overview ........................................................................................................175
Timer/Counter Clock Sources .......................................................................176
Counter Unit ..................................................................................................176
Modes of Operation .......................................................................................177
Output Compare Unit .....................................................................................181
Compare Match Output Unit ..........................................................................183
Timer/Counter Timing Diagrams ...................................................................184
Asynchronous Operation of Timer/Counter2 .................................................185
Timer/Counter Prescaler ...............................................................................187
20.10 Register Description ......................................................................................188
21 SPI – Serial Peripheral Interface ......................................................... 196
21.1
21.2
SS Pin Functionality ......................................................................................201
Register Description ......................................................................................203
22 USART ................................................................................................... 206
22.1
22.2
22.3
22.4
22.5
22.6
22.7
22.8
22.9
Features ........................................................................................................206
Clock Generation ...........................................................................................207
Frame Formats ..............................................................................................210
USART Initialization .......................................................................................211
Data Transmission – The USART Transmitter ..............................................213
Data Reception – The USART Receiver .......................................................215
Asynchronous Data Reception ......................................................................219
Multi-processor Communication Mode ..........................................................222
Register Description ......................................................................................223
22.10 Examples of Baud Rate Setting .....................................................................228
23 USART in SPI Mode ............................................................................. 232
23.1
23.2
23.3
23.4
23.5
23.6
Overview ........................................................................................................232
USART MSPIM vs. SPI .................................................................................232
SPI Data Modes and Timing ..........................................................................233
Frame Formats ..............................................................................................234
Data Transfer .................................................................................................236
USART MSPIM Register Description ............................................................237
iv
ATmega640/1280/1281/2560/2561
2549L–AVR–08/07
ATmega640/1280/1281/2560/2561
24 2-wire Serial Interface .......................................................................... 241
24.1
24.2
24.3
24.4
24.5
24.6
24.7
24.8
24.9
Features ........................................................................................................241
2-wire Serial Interface Bus Definition ............................................................241
Data Transfer and Frame Format ..................................................................242
Multi-master Bus Systems, Arbitration and Synchronization .........................245
Overview of the TWI Module .........................................................................246
Using the TWI ................................................................................................249
Transmission Modes .....................................................................................252
Multi-master Systems and Arbitration ............................................................265
Register Description ......................................................................................266
25 AC – Analog Comparator .................................................................... 271
25.1
25.2
Analog Comparator Multiplexed Input ...........................................................271
Register Description ......................................................................................272
26 ADC – Analog to Digital Converter ..................................................... 275
26.1
26.2
26.3
26.4
26.5
26.6
26.7
26.8
Features ........................................................................................................275
Operation .......................................................................................................276
Starting a Conversion ....................................................................................277
Prescaling and Conversion Timing ................................................................278
Changing Channel or Reference Selection ...................................................282
ADC Noise Canceler .....................................................................................283
ADC Conversion Result .................................................................................288
Register Description ......................................................................................290
27 JTAG Interface and On-chip Debug System ...................................... 297
27.1
27.2
27.3
27.4
27.5
27.6
27.7
27.8
27.9
Features ........................................................................................................297
Overview ........................................................................................................297
TAP - Test Access Port .................................................................................298
Using the Boundary-scan Chain ....................................................................300
Using the On-chip Debug System .................................................................300
On-chip Debug Specific JTAG Instructions ...................................................301
Using the JTAG Programming Capabilities ...................................................302
Bibliography ...................................................................................................302
On-chip Debug Related Register in I/O Memory ...........................................302
28 IEEE 1149.1 (JTAG) Boundary-scan ................................................... 303
28.1
28.2
Features ........................................................................................................303
System Overview ...........................................................................................303
v
2549L–AVR–08/07
28.3
28.4
28.5
28.6
28.7
28.8
Data Registers ...............................................................................................303
Boundary-scan Specific JTAG Instructions ...................................................305
Boundary-scan Chain ....................................................................................306
Boundary-scan Related Register in I/O Memory ...........................................309
ATmega640/1280/1281/2560/2561 Boundary-scan Order ............................309
Boundary-scan Description Language Files ..................................................309
29 Boot Loader Support – Read-While-Write Self-Programming ......... 318
29.1
29.2
29.3
29.4
29.5
29.6
29.7
Features ........................................................................................................318
Application and Boot Loader Flash Sections .................................................318
Read-While-Write and No Read-While-Write Flash Sections ........................318
Boot Loader Lock Bits ...................................................................................321
Addressing the Flash During Self-Programming ...........................................323
Self-Programming the Flash ..........................................................................324
Register Description ......................................................................................334
30 Memory Programming ......................................................................... 337
30.1
30.2
30.3
30.4
30.5
30.6
30.7
30.8
30.9
Program And Data Memory Lock Bits ...........................................................337
Fuse Bits ........................................................................................................338
Signature Bytes .............................................................................................340
Calibration Byte .............................................................................................340
Page Size ......................................................................................................340
Parallel Programming Parameters, Pin Mapping, and Commands ...............340
Parallel Programming ....................................................................................343
Serial Downloading ........................................................................................351
Programming via the JTAG Interface ............................................................357
31 Electrical Characteristics .................................................................... 370
31.1
31.2
31.3
31.4
31.5
31.6
31.7
31.8
31.9
DC Characteristics .........................................................................................370
Speed Grades ...............................................................................................372
Clock Characteristics .....................................................................................374
External Clock Drive ......................................................................................374
System and Reset Characteristics ................................................................375
2-wire Serial Interface Characteristics ...........................................................375
SPI Timing Characteristics ............................................................................377
ADC Characteristics – Preliminary Data ........................................................379
External Data Memory Timing .......................................................................381
32 Typical Characteristics ........................................................................ 387
vi
ATmega640/1280/1281/2560/2561
2549L–AVR–08/07
ATmega640/1280/1281/2560/2561
32.1
32.2
32.3
32.4
32.5
32.6
32.7
32.8
32.9
Active Supply Current ....................................................................................388
Idle Supply Current ........................................................................................390
Power-down Supply Current ..........................................................................394
Power-save Supply Current ...........................................................................395
Standby Supply Current ................................................................................396
Pin Pull-up .....................................................................................................397
Pin Driver Strength ........................................................................................400
Pin Threshold and Hysteresis ........................................................................402
BOD Threshold and Analog Comparator Offset ............................................405
32.10 Internal Oscillator Speed ...............................................................................406
32.11 Current Consumption of Peripheral Units ......................................................409
32.12 Current Consumption in Reset and Reset Pulsewidth ..................................412
33 Register Summary ............................................................................... 414
34 Instruction Set Summary ..................................................................... 419
35 Ordering Information ........................................................................... 422
35.1
35.2
35.3
35.4
35.5
ATmega640 ...................................................................................................422
ATmega1281 .................................................................................................423
ATmega1280 .................................................................................................424
ATmega2561 .................................................................................................425
ATmega2560 .................................................................................................426
36 Packaging Information ........................................................................ 427
36.1
36.2
36.3
36.4
100A ..............................................................................................................427
100C1 ............................................................................................................428
64A ................................................................................................................429
64M2 ..............................................................................................................430
37 Errata ..................................................................................................... 431
37.1
37.2
37.3
37.4
37.5
37.6
37.7
37.8
ATmega640 rev. A .........................................................................................431
ATmega1280 rev. A .......................................................................................431
ATmega1281 rev. A .......................................................................................431
ATmega2560 rev. E .......................................................................................432
ATmega2560 rev. D ......................................................................................432
ATmega2560 rev. C ......................................................................................432
ATmega2560 rev. B .......................................................................................432
ATmega2560 rev. A .......................................................................................432
vii
2549L–AVR–08/07
37.9
ATmega2561 rev. E .......................................................................................433
37.10 ATmega2561 rev. D ......................................................................................433
37.11 ATmega2561 rev. C ......................................................................................434
37.12 ATmega2561 rev. B .......................................................................................434
37.13 ATmega2561 rev. A .......................................................................................434
38 Datasheet Revision History ................................................................. 436
38.1
38.2
38.3
38.4
38.5
38.6
38.7
38.8
38.9
Rev. 2549L-08/07 ..........................................................................................436
Rev. 2549K-01/07 ..........................................................................................436
Rev. 2549J-09/06 ..........................................................................................436
Rev. 2549I-07/06 ...........................................................................................437
Rev. 2549H-06/06 .........................................................................................437
Rev. 2549G-06/06 .........................................................................................437
Rev. 2549F-04/06 ..........................................................................................437
Rev. 2549E-04/06 ..........................................................................................438
Rev. 2549D-12/05 .........................................................................................438
38.10 Rev. 2549C-09/05 .........................................................................................438
38.11 Rev. 2549B-05/05 ..........................................................................................439
38.12 Rev. 2549A-03/05 ..........................................................................................439
Table of Contents....................................................................................... i
viii
ATmega640/1280/1281/2560/2561
2549L–AVR–08/07
相关型号:
ATMEGA1280V-8CUR
8-bit Atmel Microcontroller with 64K 128K 256K Bytes In-System Programmable Flash
ATMEL
ATMEGA1281-16AUR
8-bit Atmel Microcontroller with 64K/128K/256K Bytes In-System Programmable Flash
ATMEL
ATMEGA1281-16MUR
RISC Microcontroller, 8-Bit, FLASH, AVR RISC CPU, 16MHz, CMOS, 9 X 9 MM, 1 MM HEIGHT, 0.50 MM PITCH, GREEN, MO-220VMMD, MLF-64
ATMEL
ATMEGA1281V-8AU-SL383
Microcontroller, 8-Bit, FLASH, AVR RISC CPU, 8MHz, CMOS, PQFP64, 14 X 14 MM, 1 MM HEIGHT, 0.80 MM PITCH, GREEN, PLASTIC, MS-026AEB, TQFP-64
ATMEL
ATMEGA1281V-8AUR
RISC Microcontroller, 8-Bit, FLASH, AVR RISC CPU, 8MHz, CMOS, PQFP64, 14 X 14 MM, 1 MM HEIGHT, 0.80 MM PITCH, GREEN, PLASTIC, MS-026AEB, TQFP-64
ATMEL
©2020 ICPDF网 联系我们和版权申明